You are on page 1of 1066

STAAD.

Pro
V8i (SELECTseries 2)

International Design Codes Manual


DAA037810-1/0003 Last updated: 6 March 2011

Copyright Information
TRADEMARK NOTICE
Bentley, the "B" Bentley logo, STAAD.Pro are registered or nonregistered trademarks of Bentley Sytems, Inc. or Bentley Software, Inc. All other marks are the property of their respective owners.

COPYRIGHT NOTICE
2011, Bentley Systems, Incorporated. All Rights Reserved. Including software, file formats, and audiovisual displays; may only be used pursuant to applicable software license agreement; contains confidential and proprietary information of Bentley Systems, Incorporated and/or third parties which is protected by copyright and trade secret law and may not be provided or otherwise made available without proper authorization.

ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
Windows, Vista, SQL Server, MSDE, .NET, DirectX are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Adobe, the Adobe logo, Acrobat, the Acrobat logo are registered trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated.

International Design Codes Manual i

RESTRICTED RIGHTS LEGENDS


If this software is acquired for or on behalf of the United States of America, its agencies and/or instrumentalities ("U.S. Government"), it is provided with restricted rights. This software and accompanying documentation are "commercial computer software" and "commercial computer software documentation," respectively, pursuant to 48 C.F.R. 12.212 and 227.7202, and "restricted computer software" pursuant to 48 C.F.R. 52.227-19(a), as applicable. Use, modification, reproduction, release, performance, display or disclosure of this software and accompanying documentation by the U.S. Government are subject to restrictions as set forth in this Agreement and pursuant to 48 C.F.R. 12.212, 52.227-19, 227.7202, and 1852.227-86, as applicable. Contractor/Manufacturer is Bentley Systems, Incorporated, 685 Stockton Drive, Exton, PA 19341- 0678. Unpublished - rights reserved under the Copyright Laws of the United States and International treaties.

END USER LICENSE AGREEMENTS


To view the End User License Agreement for this product, review: eula_en.pdf.

ii STAAD.Pro

Table of Contents
About STAAD.Pro About the STAAD.Pro Documentation
Getting Started and Tutorials Examples Manual Graphical Environment Technical Reference Manual International Design Codes

2 4
4 4 4 4 5

Section 1 Australian Codes


Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001 Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

7
9 19

Section 2 British Codes


British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110 British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000 British Codes - Design per BS5400 British Codes - Design per BS8007 British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

57
59 81 113 119 123

International Design Codes Manual iii

Section 3 Canadian Codes

153
155 163 207 215

Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94 Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSAS16-01 Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94 Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA086-01

Section 4 Chinese Codes


Chinese Codes - Concrete Design Per GB50010-2002 Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003

247
249 261

Section 5 European Codes


European Codes - Concrete Design Per Eurocode EC2 European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3 5B.5(B).4.1 Basic stress check 5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

273
275 283 313 316 405

Section 6 Egyptian Codes


Egyptian Codes - Concrete Design Per Egyptian Code ECCS203 Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205

431
433 441

Section 7 French Codes


French Codes - ConcreteDesign per B.A.E.L French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code

451
453 459

Section 8 German Codes


German Codes - ConcreteDesign Per DIN 1045 iv STAAD.Pro

471
473

German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code

481

Section 9 Indian Codes


Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456 Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984 Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802 Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code

493
495 521 547 569 593

Section 10 Japanese Codes


Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

601
603 613

Section 11 Mexican Codes


Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987 Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code

649
651 669

Section 12 Russian Codes


Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

683
685

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) 715

Section 13 South African Codes


South African Codes - Concrete Design Per SABS-0100-1

737
739

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB01621:1993 747

Section 14 American Aluminum Code Section 15 American Transmission Tower Code


American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97

773 791
793

International Design Codes Manual v

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports

801

Section 16 Steel Design per American Petroleum Institute Code 807 Section 17 ANSI/AISC N690 Design Codes
ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

823
825 845

Section 18 American Society of Mechanical Engineers Nuclear Facility (ASME NF) Codes 869
ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes ASME NF 3000 - 1989 Code ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code 871 883 897 910

Section 19 Norwegian Codes


Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004 Norwegian Codes - Concrete Design per NS 3473

923
925 983 1008

Section 20 Cypriot Codes


Cypriot Codes - Concrete Design in Cyprus

1013
1013

Section 21 Danish Codes


Danish Codes - Steel Design per DS412

1019
1019

Section 22 Dutch Codes


Dutch Codes - Steel Design per NEN 6770

1023
1023

Section 23 Finnish Codes


Finnish Codes - Concrete Design per B4 Finnish Codes - Steel Design per B7 vi STAAD.Pro

1027
1027 1030

Section 24 Singaporian Codes


Singaporean Codes - Concrete Design per CP65

1035
1035

Section 25 Spanish Codes


Spanish Codes - Concrete Design per EHE

1041
1041

Section 26 Swedish Codes


Swedish Codes - Concrete Design per BBK 94

1045
1045

Technical Support Index

1049 1051

International Design Codes Manual vii

This documentation has been prepared to provide information pertaining to the various international codes supported by STAAD. These codes are provided as additional codes by Research Engineers. In other words, they do not come with the standard package. Hence, information on only some of the codes presented in this document may be actually pertinent to the individual user's package. This document is to be used in conjunction with the STAAD Technical Reference Manual and the STAAD Application Examples Manual. Effort has been made to provide some basic information about the analysis considerations and the logic used in the design approach. A brief outline of the factors affecting the design along with references to the corresponding clauses in the codes is also provided. Examples are provided at the appropriate places to facilitate ease of understanding of the usage of the commands and design parameters. Users are urged to refer to the Examples Manual for solved problems that use the commands and features of STAAD. Since the STAAD output contains references to the clauses in the code that govern the design, users are urged to consult the documentation of the code of that country for additional details on the design criteria.

International Design Codes Manual 1

About STAAD.Pro
STAAD.Pro is a general purpose structural analysis and design program with applications primarily in the building industry - commercial buildings, bridges and highway structures, industrial structures, chemical plant structures, dams, retaining walls, turbine foundations, culverts and other embedded structures, etc. The program hence consists of the following facilities to enable this task. 1. Graphical model generation utilities as well as text editor based commands for creating the mathematical model. Beam and column members are represented using lines. Walls, slabs and panel type entities are represented using triangular and quadrilateral finite elements. Solid blocks are represented using brick elements. These utilities allow the user to create the geometry, assign properties, orient cross sections as desired, assign materials like steel, concrete, timber, aluminum, specify supports, apply loads explicitly as well as have the program generate loads, design parameters etc. 2. Analysis engines for performing linear elastic and pdelta analysis, finite element analysis, frequency extraction, and dynamic response (spectrum, time history, steady state, etc.). 3. Design engines for code checking and optimization of steel, aluminum and timber members. Reinforcement calculations for concrete beams, columns, slabs and shear walls. Design of shear and moment connections for steel members. 4. Result viewing, result verification and report generation tools for examining displacement diagrams, bending moment and shear force diagrams, beam, plate and solid stress contours, etc. 5. Peripheral tools for activities like import and export of data from and to other widely accepted formats, links with other popular softwares for niche areas like reinforced and prestressed concrete slab design, footing design, steel connection design, etc. 6. A library of exposed functions called OpenSTAAD which allows users to access STAAD.Pros internal functions and routines as well as its graphical commands to tap into STAADs database and link input and output data to third-party software written using languages like C, C++, VB, VBA,

2 STAAD.Pro

FORTRAN, Java, Delphi, etc. Thus, OpenSTAAD allows users to link in-house or third-party applications with STAAD.Pro.

International Design Codes Manual 3

About the STAAD.Pro Documentation


The documentation for STAAD.Pro consists of a set of manuals as described below. These manuals are normally provided only in the electronic format. All the manuals can be accessed from the Help facilities of STAAD.Pro. If you want to obtain a printed copy of the books, visit the docs.bentley.com site to check availability and order. Bentley also supplies the manuals in the PDF format at no cost for those who want to print them on their own. See the back cover of this book for addresses and phone numbers.

Getting Started and Tutorials


This manual contains information on the contents of the STAAD.Pro package, computer system requirements, installation process, copy protection issues and a description on how to run the programs in the package. Tutorials that provide detailed and step-by-step explanation on using the programs are also provided.

Examples Manual
This book offers examples of various problems that can be solved using the STAAD engine. The examples represent various structural analyses and design problems commonly encountered by structural engineers.

Graphical Environment
This document contains a detailed description of the Graphical User Interface (GUI) of STAAD.Pro. The topics covered include model generation, structural analysis and design, result verification, and report generation.

Technical Reference Manual


This manual deals with the theory behind the engineering calculations made by the STAAD engine. It also includes an explanation of the commands available in the STAAD command file.

4 STAAD.Pro

International Design Codes


This document contains information on the various Concrete, Steel, and Aluminum design codes, of several countries, that are implemented in STAAD. The documentation for the STAAD.Pro Extension component(s) is available separately.

International Design Codes Manual 5

6 STAAD.Pro

Section 1

Australian Codes

International Design Codes Manual 7

8 STAAD.Pro

Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001


1A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capabilities for performing concrete design based on the Australian code AS 3600-2001 Australian Standard-Concrete Structures.

1A.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections for concrete members can be designed.
l

For Beams: Prismatic (Rectangular & Square) For Columns: Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)

1A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members which will be designed by the program must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTY command. The following example shows the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTY 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 250. 11 13 PR YD 350.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. It is absolutely imperative that the user not provide the cross section area (AX) as an input.

1A.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform the design. Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 1A.1 of this manual contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to

International Design Codes Manual 9

Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001

declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 1A.1 - Australian Concrete Design per AS 3600 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description Must be specified as AUSTRALIAN to invokes design per AS 3600 2001. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual. CLEAR 25 mm 40 mm DEPTH YD For beam members. For column members Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

10 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name FMC

Default Value 40 N/mm2

Description Concrete Yield Stress. Applicable values per Clause 6.1.1.1 of AS 3600-2001: 20 25 32 40 50 65

FYMAIN

450 N/mm2

Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. Applicable values per Table 6.2.1 of AS 36002001: 250 400 450 500

FYSEC

450 N/mm2

Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Applicable values per Table 6.2.1 of AS 3600-2001: 250 400 450 500

International Design Codes Manual 11

Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001 Parameter Name MAXMAIN MINMAIN MAXSEC MINSEC RATIO Default Value 60 mm 10 mm 12 mm 8 mm 4.0 Description Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum percentage of longitudinal reinforcement in columns. Tied column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral reinforcement.

REINF

0.0

12 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name TRACK

Default Value 0.0

Description BEAM DESIGN: For TRACK = 0.0, output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE and END. For TRACK = 1.0, critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. For TRACK = 2.0, required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. COLUMN DESIGN: With TRACK = 0.0, reinforcement details are printed.

International Design Codes Manual 13

Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001 Parameter Name WIDTH Default Value ZD Description Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

1A.5 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Consideration


Slenderness effects are extremely important in designing compression members. There are two options by which the slenderness effect can be accommodated. One option is to perform an exact analysis which will take into account the influence of axial loads and variable moment of inertia on member stiffness and fixed end moments, the effect of deflections on moment and forces and the effect of the duration of loads. Another option is to approximately magnify design moments. STAAD has been written to allow the use of the first option. To perform this type of analysis, use the command PDELTA ANALYSIS instead of PERFORM ANALYSIS. The PDELTA ANALYSIS will accommodate the requirements of the second- order analysis described by AS 3600, except for the effects of the duration of the loads. It is felt that this effect may be safely ignored because experts believe that the effects of the duration of loads are negligible in a normal structural configuration. Although ignoring load duration effects is somewhat of an approximation, it must be realized that the evaluation of slenderness effects is also by an approximate method. In this method, additional moments are calculated based on empirical formula and assumptions on sidesway. Considering all of the above information, a PDELTA ANALYSIS, as performed by STAAD may be used for the design of concrete members. However the user must note that to take advantage of this analysis, all the combinations of loading must be provided as primary load cases and not as load combinations. This is due to the fact that load combinations are just algebraic combinations of forces and moments, whereas a primary load case is revised during the P-delta analysis based on the deflections. Also, note that the proper factored loads (like 1.5 for dead load etc.) should be provided by the user. STAAD does not factor the loads automatically.

14 STAAD.Pro

1A.6 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are prescanned to identify the critical load cases at different sections of the beams. The total number of sections considered is 13 (e.g., 0., .1, .2, .25, .3, .4, .5, .6, .7, .75, .8, .9, and 1). All of these sections are scanned to determine the design force envelopes.

Design for Flexure


Maximum sagging (creating tensile stress at the bottom face of the beam) and hogging (creating tensile stress at the top face) moments are calculated for all active load cases at each of the above mentioned sections. Each of these sections is designed to resist both of these critical sagging and hogging moments. Currently, design of singly reinforced sections only is permitted. If the section dimensions are inadequate as a singly reinforced section, such a message will be permitted in the output. Flexural design of beams is performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexure design is performed again in a second pass taking into account the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provided after the preliminary design. Final provisions of flexural reinforcements are made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the curtailment of reinforcements as per AS 3600. Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (finally which will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account of other practical consideration), user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 13 equally spaced sections from which the final detailed drawing can be prepared.

Design for Shear


Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Shear design is performed at 13 equally spaced sections (0. to 1.) for the maximum shear forces amongst the active load cases and the associated torsional moments. Shear capacity calculation at different sections without the shear reinforcement is based on the actual tensile reinforcement provided by STAAD. Two-legged stirrups are provided to take care of the balance shear forces acting on these sections. Example of Input Data for Beam Design: International Design Codes Manual 15

Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001

UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE AUSTRALIAN FYMAIN 415 ALL FYSEC 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEM 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN

1A.7 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial forces and biaxial moments at the ends. All active load cases are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which yields maximum reinforcement is called the critical load. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. By default, square and rectangular columns are designed with reinforcement distributed on each side equally. That means the total number of bars will always be a multiple of four (4). This may cause slightly conservative results in some cases. All major criteria for selecting longitudinal and transverse reinforcement as stipulated by AS 3600 have been taken care of in the column design of STAAD. Example of Input Data for Column Design:
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE AUSTRALIAN FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6

16 STAAD.Pro

END CONCRETE DESIGN

1A.8 Slab/Wall Design


To design a slab or wall, it must be modeled using finite elements. The command specifications are in accordance with Chapter 2 and Chapter 6 of the specification. Elements are designed for the moments Mx and My. These moments are obtained from the element force output (see Section 3.8 of the Technical Reference Manual). The reinforcement required to resist Mx moment is denoted as longitudinal reinforcement and the reinforcement required to resist My moment is denoted as transverse reinforcement. The parameters FYMAIN, FC, MAXMAIN, MINMAIN, and CLEAR listed in Table 1A.1 are relevant to slab design. Other parameters mentioned in Table 1A.1 are not applicable to slab design.
Figure 1.1 - Element moments: Longitudinal (L) and Transverse (T)

Example of Input Data for Slab/Wall Design


UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE AUSTRALIAN FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 25 ALL CLEAR 40 ALL DESIGN ELEMENT 15 TO 20

International Design Codes Manual 17

Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001

END CONCRETE DESIGN

18 STAAD.Pro

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 1998


1B.1 General
This section presents some general statements regarding the implementation of the specifications recommended by Standards Australia for structural steel design (AS 4100 - 1998 Steel Structures) in STAAD. The design philosophy and procedural logistics are based on the principles of elastic analysis and limit state method of design. Facilities are available for member selection as well as code checking. The design philosophy embodied in this specification is based on the concept of limit state design. Structures are designed and proportioned taking into consideration the limit states at which they would become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit-state are recognized - ultimate and serviceability. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability, while that in serviceability is deflection. Appropriate load and resistance factors are used so that a uniform reliability is achieved for all steel structures under various loading conditions and at the same time the chances of limits being surpassed are acceptably remote. In the STAAD implementation, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength, stability, and serviceability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria as augmented by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type, or other such parameters. The code checking portion of the program checks whether code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The following sections describe the salient features of the STAAD implementation of AS 4100. A detailed description of the design process along with its underlying concepts and assumptions is available in the specification document.

Strength Limit States


Strength design capacities (Ru) are calculated and compared to user-defined design action effects (S*), so as to ensure that S* Ru in accordance with AS 4100 3.4. Details for design capacity calculations are outlined in the sections that follow.

International Design Codes Manual 19

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

Deflection Limit States


STAAD.Pros AS 4100 implementation does not generally check deflections. It is left to the user to check that both local member and frame deflections are within acceptable limits. Note: Local member deflections parallel to the local member y-axis can be checked against a user-defined maximum span / deflection ratio. This can be performed using the DFF, DJ1, and DJ2 design parameters, however this is only available for MEMBER Design. Details are provided in the sections that follow.

Eccentric Beam Reactions


STAAD.Pro does not automatically account for minimum eccentricity distances for beam reactions being transferred to columns as per AS 4100 4.3.4. However member offsets can be used to model these eccentricities. Refer to Section 5.25 for further information on the Member Offset feature.

Limit States Not Considered


The following limit states are not directly considered in STAAD.Pros implementation of AS 4100. Table 1B.1 - Limit States Not Considered in STAAD.Pro AS 4100 Design Limit State Code Reference AS 4100 3.3 AS 4100 3.5 AS 4100 3.7 AS4100

Stability Serviceability Brittle Fracture Fire

20 STAAD.Pro

Limit State

Code Reference 3.9

Other Design Requirements

AS 4100 3.11

Connection Design
STAAD.Pro and Bentleys RAM Connection program currently do not support design of connections in accordance with AS 4100. In some cases connection design may govern the size of members. Such considerations are not considered in STAAD.Pros AS 4100 and should be checked by separately.

Bolts and Welds


Bolt holes and welds are not generally considered in STAAD.Pros AS 4100 member design. Note: NSC and NSF design parameters are used to manually specify a reduction in net section area for compression or tension capacity calculations. These can be used to account for bolt hole area reductions. Further details are provided in the sections that follow.

1B.2 Analysis Methodology


Either the elastic or dynamic analysis methods may be used to obtain the forces and moments for design as per AS4100 section 4.4. Analysis is done for the specified primary and repeat loading conditions. Therefore, it is your responsibility to enter all necessary loads and load combination factors for design in accordance with the AS/NZS 1170 Series or other relevant design codes. You are allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis or P-Delta analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results. Note: Plastic analysis and design in accordance with AS 4100 section 4.5 is not implemented in STAAD.Pro.

International Design Codes Manual 21

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

Elastic Analysis
Two types of elastic analysis can be performed using STAAD.Pro in accordance with AS4100: i. First Order Linear, Elastic Analysis - used to perform a regular elastic stiffness analysis as per AS 4100 4.4.2.1. Refer to Section 5.37.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on this feature. ii. Second Order PDelta Linear, Elastic Analysis - Depending on the type of structure, a PDelta analysis may be required in order to capture secondorder effects as per AS 4100 4.4.1.2. Second-order effects can be captured in STAAD.Pro by performing a PDelta second-order elastic analysis as per AS 4100 Appendix E. Refer to Section 5.37.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on this feature. Note: Moment amplification as per AS 4100 clause 4.4.2 is not considered.

Hint: In order to correctly capture second-order effects for combination load cases using a PDelta Analysis, the Repeat Load feature must be used. Second-order effects will not be correctly evaluated if the Load Combination feature is used. Load Combinations are combinations of results where Repeat Loads instruct the program to perform the analysis on the combined load actions. Refer to Section 5.32.11 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on using Repeat Loads.

Dynamic Analysis
Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results. Refer Section 5.32.10 of the Technical Reference Manual for further information on Dynamic Loading and Analysis features.

1B.3 Member Property Specifications


For specification of member properties, either the steel section library available in STAAD or the User Table facility may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. For

22 STAAD.Pro

more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

1B.4 Built-in Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered during the analysis of these members. An example of the member property specification in an input file is provided at the end of this section. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained by using the tools of the graphical user interface. Refer to Section 1.7.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information. Table 1B.2 - Available Australian Sections for STAAD.Pro AS 4100 Design General Profile Type I-SECTION Australian Sections WB, WC UB, UC T-SECTION CHANNEL ANGLE TUBE PIPE BT, CT PFC EA, UA SHS, RHS CHS Description

Welded beams and columns Universal beams and columns Tees cut from universal beams and columns Parallel flange channels Equal and unequal angles Square and rectangular hollow sections Circular hollow sections

Note: STAAD.Pro will not design the following section types to AS 4100: Double Profiles (D), Composite Sections (C), Top Cover Plates (TC), Bottom Cover Plates (BC), and Top & Bottom Cover Plates (TB), Double Channels (D, BA, & FR) and Double Angles (LD & SD). Refer to Section Profile Tables in the Graphical Environment for these options.

International Design Codes Manual 23

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

Hint: When adding and assigning sections using the built-in steel section library through the Graphical Environment, STAAD.Pros default tables are American. To change the default tables to Australian, select File > Configuration from the STAAD.Pro Start page (no input file open). Set the Default Profile Table to Australian on the Configure Program dialog Section Profile Table. Following are the descriptions of different types of sections.

UB Shapes
These shapes are designated in the following way.
20 TO 30 TA ST UB150X14.0 36 TO 46 TA ST UB180X16.1

UC Shapes
The designation for the UC shapes is similar to that for the UB shapes.
25 TO 35 TA ST UC100X14.8 23 56 TA ST UC310X96.8

Welded Beams
Welded Beams are designated in the following way.
25 TO 35 TA ST WB700X115 23 56 TA ST WB1200X455

Welded Columns
Welded Columns are designated in the following way.
25 TO 35 TA ST WC400X114 23 56 TA ST WC400X303

24 STAAD.Pro

Parallel Flange Channels


Shown below is the syntax for assigning names of channel sections.
1 TO 5 TA ST PFC75 6 TO 10 TA ST PFC380

Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without a spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel.
11 TA D PFC230 17 TA D C230X75X25 SP 0.5

In the above set of commands, member 11 is a back-to-back double channel PFC230 with no spacing in between. Member 17 is a double channel PFC300 with a spacing of 0.5 length units between the channels.

Angles
Two types of specification may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
16 20 TA ST A30X30X6

The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 30 mm and a leg thickness of 6 mm. This specification may be used when the local Z axis corresponds to the zz axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local Y axis corresponds to the z-z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.
17 21 TA RA A150X150X16

Note: Single angles must be specified with an RA (Single Angle w/Reverse YZ Axis) in order to be designed to AS 4100. This is to ensure that the major and minor principal axes align with the local member z and y axes respectively, similar to other section profiles.

International Design Codes Manual 25

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by means of input of the words SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose.
33 35 TA SD A65X50X5 SP 0.6 37 39 TA LD A75X50X6 43 TO 47 TA LD A100X75X10 SP 0.75

Tubes (Rectangular or Square Hollow Sections)


Tubes can be assigned in 2 ways. In the first method, the designation for the tube is as shown below. This method is meant for tubes whose property name is available in the steel table. In these examples, members 1 to 5 consist of a 2X2X0.5 inch size tube section, and members 6 to 10 consist of 10X5X0.1875 inch size tube section. The name is obtained as 10 times the depth, 10 times the width, and 16 times the thickness.
1 TO 5 TA ST TUB20202.5 6 TO 10 TA ST TUB100503.0

In the second method, tubes are specified by their dimensions. For example,
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5

is a tube that has a height of 8 length units, width of 6 length units, and a wall thickness of 0.5 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, will be performed for TUBE sections specified in this latter manner.

Pipes (Circular Hollow Sections)


Pipes can be assigned in 2 ways. In the first method, the designation for the pipe is as shown below. This method is meant for pipes whose property name is available in the steel table.
1 TO 5 TA ST PIP180X5

26 STAAD.Pro

6 TO 10 TA ST PIP273X6.5

In the second method, pipe sections may be provided by specifying the word PIPE followed by the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0

specifies a pipe with outside diameter of 25 length units and inside diameter of 20 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, will be performed on pipes specified in this latter manner.

Sample File Containing Australian Shapes


STAAD SPACE UNIT METER KN JOINT COORD 1 0 0 0 11 100 0 0 MEMB INCI 1 1 2 10 UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTIES AUSTRALIAN * UB SHAPES 1 TA ST UB200X25.4 * UC SHAPES 2 TA ST UC250X89.5 * CHANNELS 3 TA ST PFC125 * DOUBLE CHANNELS 4 TA D PFC200 * ANGLES 5 TA ST A30X30X6 * REVERSE ANGLES

International Design Codes Manual 27

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

6 TA RA A150X150X16 * DOUBLE ANGLES - SHORT LEGS BACK TO BACK 7 TA SD A65X50X5 SP 0.6 * DOUBLE ANGLES - LONG LEGS BACK TO BACK 8 TA LD A100X75X10 SP 0.75 * TUBES (RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE HOLLOW SECTIONS) 9 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5 * PIPES (CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS) 10 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0 PRINT MEMB PROP FINISH

1B.5 Section Classification


The AS 4100 specification allows inelastic deformation of section elements. Thus, local buckling becomes an important criterion. Steel sections are classified as compact, noncompact, or slender; depending upon their local buckling characteristics. This classification is a function of the geometric properties of the section. The design procedures are different depending on the section class. STAAD determines the section classification for the standard shapes and user specified shapes. Design is performed for all three categories of section described above.

1B.6 Material Properties


For specification of material properties, the user can use either: a. built-in material constants b. user-defined materials Refer Section 5.26.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for further information on the Built-in Material Constants feature. Refer Section 2.26.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for further information on the Define Material feature.

28 STAAD.Pro

Youngs Modulus of Elasticity (E)


STAAD.Pros default steel materials E value is 205,000 MPa. However AS 4100 section 1.4 states that the modulus of elasticity should be taken as 200,000 MPa. There are a number of options to change this value:
l

change the steel material through the input file or GUI for each file created define a new steel material for each file created change the default STAAD.Pro metric E value in the file C:/WINDOWS/STAADPRO20070.INI, going to the [Material-Metric] section, and changing E1=205.0e6 to E1=200.0e6. Restart STAAD.Pro for this to take effect. Warning: Virtualization features of Windows Vista and Windows 7 may require additional files to be modified. Contact Bentley Technical Support for assistance.

1B.7 Member Resistances


The member resistance is calculated in STAAD according to the procedures outlined in AS 4100. Calculated design capacities are compared to corresponding axial, bending moment, and shear forces determined from the STAAD.Pro analysis. These are used to report the fail or pass status for the members designed. Two types of design checks are typically performed per AS 4100:
l

Nominal section checks Nominal member checks

The nominal section capacity refers to the capacity of a cross-section to resists applied loads, and accounts for cross-section yielding and local buckling effects. The nominal member capacity on the other hand refers to the capacity of a member to resist applied loads, and includes checks for global member buckling effects including Euler buckling, lateral-torsional buckling, etc.

Axial Tension
The criteria governing the capacity of tension members are based on two limit states per AS 4100 Section 7. The limit state of yielding of the gross section is

International Design Codes Manual 29

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

intended to prevent excessive elongation of the member. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area N section axial tension capacities are calculated (Cl.7.2). Through the t use of the NSF parameter (see Table 1B.1), you may specify the net section area. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limit states per Cl.7.1 and Cl.7.2 respectively of AS 4100. Eccentric end connections can be taken into account using the KT correction factor, perCl.7.3. The f yield stress is y based on the minimum plate yield stress. Parameters FYLD, FU, and NSF are applicable for these calculations.

Axial Compression
The compressive strength of members is based on limit states per AS 4100 Section 6. It is taken as the lesser of nominal section capacity and nominal member capacity. Nominal section capacity, N , is a function of form factor (Cl.6.2.2), net s area of the cross section, and yield stress of the material. Through the use of the NSC parameter (see Table 1B.1), you may specify the net section area. Note that this parameter is different from that corresponding to tension. The program automatically calculates the form factor. The k form factors are calculated based f on effective plate widths per Cl.6.2.4, and the f yield stress is based on the y minimum plate yield stress. Nominal member capacity, N , is a function of nominal section capacity and c member slenderness reduction factor (Cl.6.3.3). This value is calculated about both principal x and y axes. Here, you are required to supply the value of b (Cl.6.3.3) through the ALBparameter (see Table 1B.1). The effective length for the calculation of compressive strength may be provided through the use of the parameters KY, KZ, LY, and LZ (see Table 1B.1).

Bending
Bending capacities are calculated to AS 4100 Section 5. The allowable bending moment of members is determined as the lesser of nominal section capacity and nominal member capacity (ref. Cl.5.1). The nominal section moment capacity, M , is calculated about both principal x s and y axes and is the capacity to resist cross-section yielding or local buckling and is expressed as the product of the yield stress of the material and the effective section modulus (ref. Cl.5.2). The effective section modulus is a function of section type (i.e., compact, noncompact, or slender) and minimum plate yield stress f .
y

30 STAAD.Pro

The nominal member capacity depends on overall flexural-torsional buckling of the member (ref.Cl.5.3). Note: For sections where the web and flange yield stresses (f and f y,web y.flange respectively) are different, the lower of the two yield stresses is applied to both the web and flange to determine the slenderness of these elements. Member moment capacity, M , is calculated about the principal x axis only (ref. b Cl.5.6). Critical flange effective cross-section restraints and corresponding design segment and sub-segments are used as the basis for calculating capacities.

Interaction of Axial Force and Bending


Combined section bending and shear capacities are calculated using the shear and bending interaction method as per Cl.5.12.3. Note: This check is only carried out where V section web shear capacities are v calculated. Refer Table 1B.6-1 for details. The member strength for sections subjected to axial compression and uniaxial or biaxial bending is obtained through the use of interaction equations. Here, the adequacy of a member is also examined against both section (ref. Cl.8.3.4) and member capacity (ref.Cl.8.4.5). These account for both in-plane and out-of-plane failures. If the summation of the left hand side of the equations, addressed by the above clauses, exceeds 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 1B.1), the member is considered to have FAILed under the loading condition.

Shear
Section web shear capacity, V , is calculated per Cl.5.11, including both shear v yield and shear buckling capacities. Once the capacity is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on the cross section to the shear capacity of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z-axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 1B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear. Table 1B.6-1 below highlights which shear capacities are calculated for different profile types.

International Design Codes Manual 31

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Table 1B.3 - Section Type Shear Checks General Profile Type Australian Section WB, WC, UB, UC Shear Checks

I-SECTION (i.e., parallel to minor principal y-axis) T-SECTION CHANNEL ANGLE TUBE PIPE

Calculated for web only

BT, CT PFC EA, UA SHS, RHS CHS No checks performed Calculated parallel to both x & y principal axes Per AS 4100 5.11.4

Note: Only unstiffened web capacities are calculated. Stiffened webs are not considered. Bearing capacities are not considered.

Torsion
STAAD.Pro does not design sections or members for torsion for AS4100.

1B.8 Design Parameters


The design parameters outlined in Table 1B.1 are used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program and thus allow the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The design scope indicates whether design parameters are applicable for MEMBER Design, PMEMBER Design, or both. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

32 STAAD.Pro

Table 1B.4 - Australian Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Design Scope Description

Must be specified as AUSTRALIAN to invoke design per AS 4100 - 1998. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

ALB

0.0

Member section constant (refer cl. 6.3.3) If ALB is 0.0, it is automatically calculated based on TABLE 6.3.3(1), 6.3.3(2); otherwise the input value is used.

ALM

0.0

Moment modification factor (refer cl. 5.6.1.1) If ALM is 0.0, it is automatically calculated based cl.5.6.1.1; otherwise the input value is used.

BEAM

0.0

0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION

International Design Codes Manual 33

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Parameter Name Default Value Design Scope Description

command. 1.0 = Perform design for moments at twelfth points along the beam. DFF None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member Analytical Deflection Length/ members Maximum Allowable only local deflection. Joint No. denoting start point for calculation of deflection length Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of deflection length Maximum allowable depth (Applicable for member selection) Minimum required depth (Applicable for member selection) Physical Used to specify the members type of end cononly nection to account for eccentric connection effects for compression and tension members. Steel type - 1 - SR, 2 - HR, 3 - CF, 4 -

DJ1

DJ2

End Joint of member

DMAX

45.0 [in.]

DMIN

0.0 [in.]

EEC

0.0

IST

34 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Design Scope

Description

LW, 5 - HW FU FYLD KT 500.0 [MPa] 250.0 [MPa] 1.0 Ultimate strength of steel. Yield strength of steel. Correction factor for distribution of forces (refer cl. 7.2) K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. Physical Load height position members as described in Table only 5.6.3(2)of AS 4100:1998 0 = at Shear center 1 = At top flange LY Member Length Length for general column flexural

KY

1.0

KZ

1.0

LHT

International Design Codes Manual 35

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Parameter Name Default Value Design Scope Description

buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. LZ Member Length Length for general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. 0.0 = Check slenderness ratio against the limits.
l

MAIN

0.0

Default limit for compression = 180.0 Default limit in tension = 400.0

1.0 = Suppress the slenderness ratio check. Any value greater than 1.0 is used as the limit for slenderness in compression. NSC 1.0 Net section factor for compression members = An / Ag (refer cl. 6.2.1)

36 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name NSF PBRACE

Default Value

Design Scope

Description

1.0 None

Net section factor for tension members. Physical Refer to section members 1B.11 for details on only the PBRACE parameter. Capacity reduction factor Permissible ratio of actual load effect to the design strength. Steel Grade. Refer to Note a below. 0= Normal grade 1 = High strength grade of steel

PHI RATIO

0.9 1.0

SGR

SKT

1.0

A twist restraint factor given in Table 5.6.3(1) A load height factor given in Table 5.6.3(2) A lateral rotation restraint factor given in Table 5.6.3(3) Physical Used to specify members whether eccentric only

SKL

1.0

SKR

1.0

TEE

0.0

International Design Codes Manual 37

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Parameter Name Default Value Design Scope Description

effects for tension members are checked based on simplified kt corrections factors to AS 4100 7.3.2, or by using calculated eccentric moments in combination with axial tension per AS 4100 Section 8. TMAIN 180.0 Slenderness limit in tension. Slenderness limit is checked based MAIN parameter. Output detail 0.0 = Report only minimum design results. 1.0 = Report design strengths also. 2.0 = Provide full details of design. UNB Member Length Unsupported length

TRACK

0.0

38 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Design Scope

Description

in bending compression of the bottom flange for calculating moment resistance.

UNT

Member Length

Unsupported length in bending compression of the top flange for calculating moment resistance.

Notes
a. Deflection calculations

b. LHT Parameter If the shear force is constant within the segment, longitudinal position of the load is assumed to be at the segment end. If there is any variation of the shear force and the load is acting downward determined from shear force variation and load height parameter indicates the load is acting on top flange (flange at the positive local y axis) and restraints at the end of the segment is not FU (FRU) or PU (PRU) Kl is assumed to be 1.4. If there is any variation of the shear force and the load is acting upward determined from shear force variation and load height parameter indicates the load is acting on top flange (flange at the positive local y axis) and restraints at the end of the segment is not FU (FRU) or PU (PRU) Kl is assumed to be 1.0 as the load acting at the top flange is contributing to stabilize against local torsional buckling. c. SGR Parameter

International Design Codes Manual 39

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

AS 4100 defines the values of steel grades that are used as either normal steel or high grade steel. The following table explains the material values used when either option is specified for a particular shape: Table 1B.5 - Steel Grades used for the SGR Parameter Section Type SGR Value Steel Grade Used 300 400 300 350 250 350

WB, WC, Tee section cut from WB and WC WB, WC, Tee section cut from WB and WC

0 (Normal) 1 (High)

UB, UC, Tee section cut from UB and 0 (Normal) UC, EA, UA and all UPT sections UB, UC, Tee section cut from UB and UC, 1 (High) EA, UA and all UPT sections Pipe, Tube, CHS, RHS, SHS Pipe, Tube, CHS, RHS, SHS 0 (Normal) 1 (High)

Note: If a value for theFYLDparameter has been specified, then that value will be used. Otherwise, the SGR value will be used to determine the yeild strength and tensile strength values for the steel. based on maximum thickness of the individual elements of the section. Only for shear capacity calculation web thickness is used. Similarly, Tensile Strength is determined either from FU parameter or from SGR parameter.

Warning: A check is introduced to see if yield stress is more than 450 MPa or not. If it is, a warning is issued and the yield stress is set to 450 MPa. The following example uses the Member design facility in STAAD.Pro. However, it is strongly recommended to use the Physical member design capabilities for AS4100:
PARAMETER 1 CODE AUSTRALIAN ALB 0.0 MEMBER ALL

40 STAAD.Pro

ALM 1.13 MEMBER ALL BEAM 1.0 MEMBER ALL DFF 250.0 MEMBER ALL DMAX 0.4 MEMBER ALL DMIN 0.25 MEMBER ALL FU 400.0 MEMBER ALL FYLD 310.0 MEMBER ALL IST 2.0 MEMBER ALL KT 0.85 MEMBER ALL KX 0.75 MEMBER ALL KY 1.0 MEMBER ALL LX 4.5 MEMBER ALL LY 6.0 MEMBER ALL MAIN 1.0 MEMBER ALL TMAIN 135.0 MEMBER ALL NSC 0.9 MEMBER ALL NSF 1.0 MEMBER ALL PHI 0.9 MEMBER ALL RATIO 0.9 MEMBER ALL SGR 1.0 MEMBER ALL SKT 1.0 MEMBER ALL SKL 1.0 MEMBER ALL SKR 1.0 MEMBER ALL TRACK 2.0 MEMBER ALL UNB 3.4 MEMBER ALL UNT 6.8 MEMBER ALL CHECK CODE MEMBER ALL

International Design Codes Manual 41

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

1B.9 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to evaluate whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate for the specified loads as per AS 4100 requirements. Hint: The member selection facility can be used to instruct the program to select a different section if the specified section is found to be inadequate. Code checking for an analytical member is done using forces and moments at every twelfth point along the beam. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from the start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. The extent of detail of the output can be controlled by using the TRACK parameter. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Example of commands for code checking:
UNIT NEWTON METER PARAMETER CODE AUSTRALIAN FYLD 330E6 MEMB 3 4 NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 3 4

Note: Code checking cannot be performed on composite and prismatic sections.

42 STAAD.Pro

Physical Members
For physical members (PMEMBERs), code checks are performed at section stations positioned at 1/12th points along each analytical member included in the PMEMBER. It is up to you to determine if these locations cover critical sections for design, and adjust as necessary. The number of stations for PMEMBER Design cannot be altered, however the analytical members can be split so that in effect more stations are checked for a PMEMBER. For each section station along a PMEMBER, section capacity checks are carried for design actions at that station location. Member capacity checks are also carried out for each station. For these the program searches each side of the station to find adjacent effective restraints and design forces and moments. This allows the program to determine the segment / sub-segment that the section station resides in, and then proceeds to calculate the member capacities. Enough section stations should be included to capture all segments / sub-segments for checking. Note: When checking combined actions for the section capacities, the design actions at the section station are used. However when checking combined actions for the member capacities, the maximum forces from anywhere along the segment / sub-segment being considered are used. This is as stipulated in AS 4100 8.2. The output reports whether the member has PASSed or FAILed the design checks, as well as the critical condition, critical load case, magnitudes of design actions for the most critical cross-section location (distance from the start joint), and complete calculations for design. The TRACK design parameter can be used to control the level of detail provided in the output. Color-coded results can also be viewed in the GUIs Post Processing Beam |Unity Check page. In some cases some of the output will report N/A values. This occurs where a calculation does not apply to a member. For example if a member never goes into tension then no values can be reported in the tension capacity output sections. Note: As per AS 4100 1.4, the TRACK 2.0 detailed level of output for PMEMBER Design uses x and y subscripts to refer to major and minor principal axes respectively. These differ to STAAD.Pro local member axes, where z and y refer to major and minor principal axes.

International Design Codes Manual 43

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

1B.10 Member Selection


This process incrementally checks increasing section profile sizes until a size is found that is AS 4100 compliant, or the largest section has been checked. Only section profiles of the same type as modeled are incrementally checked, with the increasing sizes based on a least weight per unit length criteria. For example, a member specified initially as a channel will have a channel selected for it. Selection of members whose properties are originally provided from a user table will be limited to sections in the user table. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. The design calculations for Member Selection are the same as for Code Checking. Hint: A Fixed Group command is also available, and can be used to force all members within a user-defined group to take the same section size based on the most critical governing design criteria for all members within that group. This is particularly useful when you want to use the Member Selection feature, but want a group of elements to have the same size. Refer to Section 5.49 of the Technical Reference Manual for information on using this feature.

Note: Member Selection will change member sizes, and hence will change the structures stiffness matrix. In order to correctly account for this, a subsequent analysis and Code Check should be performed to ensure that the final structure is acceptable. This may need to be carried out over several iterations. Example of commands for member selection:
UNIT NEWTON METER PARAMETER FYLD 330E6 MEMB 3 4 NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL SELECT MEMB 3 4

44 STAAD.Pro

Note: Composite and prismatic sections cannot be selected.

1B.11 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


Results of code checking and member selection are presented in a tabular format. The term CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the AS 4100 specification which governs the design.

1B.12 Physical Member Design


There are two methods available in STAAD.Pro for checking members against the requirements of AS 4100: a. Analytical member method b. Physical member method Herein these are referred to as MEMBER Design and PMEMBER Design respectively. Note: This feature requires STAAD.Pro V8i (SELECTseries 2) build 2007.07 or higher. Traditionally STAAD.Pro performed code checks based on single analytical members (i.e., single members between two nodes). This implementation remains in place as shown in the example in Section 1B.8. Physical Member (PMEMBER) Design on the other hand allows you to group single or multiple analytical members into a single physical design member for the purposes of design to AS 4100. PMEMBER Design also has additional features, including:
l

automated steel grades based on section type; automated tensile stress (f ) and yield stress (f ) values based on plate thicku y nesses; automated segment / sub-segment design; improved detailed design calculation output; and

Thus, it is strongly recommended that PMEMBER Design be used, even for the design of single analytical members.

International Design Codes Manual 45

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

Modeling with Physical Members


Physical Members may be grouped by either of the following methods:
l

STAAD.Pro Editor - Directly specify physical members in the input file. Refer to Section 5.16.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information. Graphical Environment - Using the tools in the Steel Design toolbar, members can be manually or automatically formed. Refer to Section 1.4 of the Graphical Environment manual for additional information.

Note: When creating PMEMBERs for AS 4100, this must be performed in STAAD.Pros Modeling mode. Do not use the Steel Design mode.

Segment and Sub-Segment Layout


For calculation of member bending capacities about the principal x-axis, the PMEMBER Design uses the concept of segment / sub-segment design. By default PMEMBERs are automatically broken up into design segments and sub-segments based on calculated effective restraints. User-defined restraints assigned using the PBRACE design parameter are checked to see if they are effective (i.e., if they are placed on the critical flange as per AS 4100 5.5). Restraints not applied to the critical flange are ineffective and hence are completely ignored. Refer to Section 1B.7 for further information on how user-defined restraints are applied using the PBRACE design parameter, including available restraint types, and restraint layout rules. Note: Segment and sub-segment layouts for PMEMBERs may change for different load cases considered for design. Some restraints may be effective for one particular load case as they are found to apply to the critical flange, however for another load case may be found not to act on the critical flange, and found to be ineffective. In other words the critical flange can change for each load case considered. Typically the critical flange will be the compression flange, except for segments with a U restraint at one end, in which case it will be the tension flange (as is the case for a cantilever).

46 STAAD.Pro

The PMEMBER Design uses the following routine to determine effective crosssection restraints for each load case considered: i. first all user-defined restraints are checked to see if they are applied to the compression flange, with those that arent ignored; ii. next a check is made to see if a U type restraint is found at either end of the PMEMBER. If this is the case then any adjacent L restraints up to the next F, FR, P or PR restraint are also ignored, regardless of whether they are placed on the critical or non-critical flange. Refer AS 4100 5.4.2.4. The compression flange in step 1 of the routine above is calculated based on the bending moments at the locations of the restraints being considered. If the bending moment is zero at the same location as a restraint then the following method is used to determine which flange is critical at the zero moment location: a. If the zero moment is at the end of the PMEMBER, then the compression flange is based on the bending moment at a small increment from then end; b. If the zero moment is along the PMEMBER and is a peak value, then the compression flange is based on the bending moment at a small increment from that location; c. If neither 1 or 2 above is valid, then the stiffer of the restraints at that location is taken. The stiffness of different restraint types from the most stiff to least stiff are taken as outlined in Table 1B.9-3. Table 1B.6 - Assumed Order of Restraint Stiffness for Zero Moment Critical Flange Stiffness Most Stiff Restraint Type FR F PR P L U Least Stiff None

International Design Codes Manual 47

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

Once the effective restraints have been determined, the PMEMBER is divided into segments bounded by F, P, FR, PR or U effective restraints. These segments are then further divided into sub-segments by effective L restraints. Note: Sub-segment lengths are not automatically checked to determine if they provide full lateral restraint as per AS 4100 5.3.2.4. For design of cantilevers, the free tip should have user-defined U restraints applied to both top and bottom flanges. Note: If the effective restraints for any load case consist of U or L restraints only, an error will be reported.

Physical Member Restraints Specification


The PBRACE parameter is used to specify the restraint condition along the top and bottom flange of a PMEMBER.

General Format
PBRACE { TOP | BOTTOM } f1 r1 f2 r2 f52 r52 (PMEMBpmemberlist) Where: f is a fraction of the PMEMBER length where restraint condition is n being specified. This value is any ratio between 0.0 and 1.0. r is one of the possible restraint condition as in the following:
n

Table 1B.7 - Physical Member Restraint Types Designation, r


1

Restraint Type Fully restrained Partially restrained

Description

F P

48 STAAD.Pro

Designation, r
1

Restraint Type Laterally restrained Unrestrained

Description

Cannot be specified at the ends of design members. Can only be applied at the ends of design members, and must be applied to both flanges to be effective. Warning: Both top and bottom flanges can not be unrestrained at the same location (as this is unstable).

FR

Fully and rotationally restrained Partially and rotationally restrained Continuously The flange is assumed restrained to be continuously supported at that flange up to next restraint location. For continuously supported flange unbraced length is assumed to be zero.

PR

Example
PBRACE TOP 0.85 FR 0.33 PR 0.33 PR 0.25 F 0.75 L 0.5 PR 1.0 U 0.0

International Design Codes Manual 49

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

U PBRACE BOTTOM 0.75 L 0.0 U 0.25 P 0.5 L 1.0 U PMEMB 3 7

Description
Refer to AS 4100 Section 5.5 for a full definition of the critical flange. Typically this will be the compression flange, except for segments with U restraint at one end, then it will be the tension flange (as is the case for cantilever portion at the end).
l

when gravity loads are dominant (i.e., negative local y-axis direction), the critical flange of a segment shall be the top flange (i.e., tension). when upward wind loads are dominant (i.e., positive local y-axis direction), the critical flange shall be the bottom flange (i.e., tension).

Design physical members are divided into segments by F, P, FR, PR or U effective section restraints. Segments are further broken down into sub-segments by L restraints, but only if the L restraints are deemed to be effective. L restraints are only considered to be effective when positioned on the critical flange between F, P, FR or FP restraints. If an L restraint is positioned on the non-critical flange it shall be completely ignored. Further, if an L restraint is positioned between a U and an F, P, FR or PR restraint, it shall be ignored (regardless of whether it is on the critical or non-critical flange). Design members must have either a F, P, FR, PR, or U restraint specified at both ends, for both flanges.
l

If UNL is not specified, segment length is used as UNL and used as L in effective length calculation as per 5.6.3. If ALM i.e., _m is not provided, automatic calculation of ALM is done based on moments within the segment. If SKR i.e., Kr is not provided, it is automatically calculated based on table 5.6.3(3) considering restraint conditions are the end of the segment. If FR or PR is found at only one of the end, Kr is assumed to be 0.85; if FR or PR is found at both the ends, 0.70 is used as Kr. If SKT i.e., Kt is not provided, it is automatically calculated based on Table 5.6.3(1) considering end restraints of the segment and section geometric information and segment length.

50 STAAD.Pro

If SKL i.e., Kl is not provided, it is automatically calculated based on Table 5.6.3(2) considering end restraints of the segment, Load Height Position parameter, LHT and shear force variation within the segment.

Notes
a. If PMEMBER list is not provided, all the PMEMBERS are restrained by same configuration. b. It is not necessary to provide the restraint locations in sequence as the program sorts them automatically. c. Unless specified, PMEMBER ends are assumed to be Fully Restrained (F). d. While designing any section of the member, effective restraints are searched on each side of the section along the critical flange. e. The types of restraints applied to the top and bottom flanges at each location determines the effective section restraints. These are outlined in the table below: Table 1B.8 - Restraint Meanings in Critical and Noncritical Flanges Case Flange Restraint on a Critical Flange U 1 2 III 1 2 L Nothing P or F Nothing or U Restraint on a NonCritical Flange U Nothing L Nothing or U P or F Effective Section Restraint

I II

U L None F P

International Design Codes Manual 51

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998

Case

Flange

Restraint on a Critical Flange PR or FR Nothing or U L, P or F FR or PR

Restraint on a NonCritical Flange Nothing or U PR or FR L, P, F, FR or PR L, P, F, FR or PR

Effective Section Restraint

IV

1 2

FR PR F FR

1 2

Note: The critical flange can change for each load case considered.

Automated PMEMBER Design Calculations


The AS 4100 PMEMBER Design automates many design calculations, including those required for segment / sub-segment design. Table 1B.9 - Automated PMEMBER AS 4100 Design Parameters and Calculations Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter comb pression member section constant per AS 4100 6.3.3. moment m modification factor per AS 4100 ALB Comments

ALM

Calculated based on moments distribution for individual segments and sub-segments.

52 STAAD.Pro

Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter 5.6.1.1. f tensile u strength per AS 4100 2.1.2. f yield stress y per AS 4100 2.1.1. residual stress category for AS 4100 Table 5.2 and AS 4100 Table 6.2.4. correction factor for distribution of forces in a tension member per AS 4100 7.3. Load height position for automated calculation of the kl load height factor per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2). FU

Comments

Based on nominal steel grade specified using SGR design parameter and section type. Based on nominal steel grade specified using SGR design parameter and section type. Based on section type.

FYLD

IST

KT

Based on section type and eccentric end connection specified using EEC design parameter.

LHT

LHT is used for automating calculation of kl load height factors for segments and sub-segments, per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2). When LHT is set to 1.0 to specify a top flange load height position, STAAD.Pro takes the top to be the positive local y-axis of the member. Note: This may not literally be

International Design Codes Manual 53

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter Comments

the top flange for say a column or beam with a beta angle. The local member axes can be viewed in the GUI by selecting Beam Orientation in the Diagrams Labels dialog (or Ctrl+O keyboard shortcut). To automate kl using AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2), the longitudinal position of the load also needs to be considered, i.e., as either within segment or at segment end. To determine which of these applies, the shear forces at the ends of each design segment / subsegment is considered. If the shear force is found to have the same direction and magnitude at both ends, it is assumed that loads act at the segment end. If on the other hand the shear force at each end is found to have different directions or magnitudes, loads are assumed to act within the segment. Note: The above method includes an allowance for the self-weight of the member to be considered, as the self-weight always acts through the shear center.

54 STAAD.Pro

Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter

Comments

The net sum of the end shears is also used to determine if the load is acting in the positive or negative local member y-axis direction. If LHT is set to 1.0 for top flange loading, the net sum is used to determine whether the top flange loading is acting to stabilise or destabilise the member for lateral torsional buckling. Negative local yaxis net loads act to destabilise the segments / sub-segments, whereas positive local y-axis net loads act to stabilise segments / sub-segments. Segment and sub-segment layout. Nominal steel grade. k twist t restraint factor as per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(1). k load height l factor as per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2). k lateral rotar tion restraint factor as per AS 4100 PBRACE Refer to the Segment and Sub-Segment Layout section above for details. Based on section types. Based on effective end restraints for each segment / sub-segment.

SGR SKT

SKL

Based on effective end restraints for each segment / sub-segment, and LHT design parameter (refer above). Based on effective end restraints for each segment / sub-segment. This is where the distinction between F and FR, as well as P and PR is used.

SKR

International Design Codes Manual 55

Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter Table 5.6.3(3). Comments

Example
PARAMETER 1 CODE AUSTRALIAN DMAX 0.4 PMEMBER ALL DMIN 0.25 PMEMBER ALL KX 0.75 PMEMBER ALL KY 1.0 PMEMBER ALL LX 4.5 PMEMBER ALL LY 6.0 PMEMBER ALL LHT 0.0 PMEMBER ALL NSC 0.9 PMEMBER ALL NSF 1.0 PMEMBER ALL PBRACE BOTTOM 0.0 F 1.0 F PMEMBER ALL PBRACE TOP 0.0 P 0.5 L 1.0 P PMEMBER ALL SGR 0.0 PMEMBER ALL TRACK 2.0 PMEMBER ALL CHECK CODE PMEMBER ALL

56 STAAD.Pro

Section 2

British Codes

International Design Codes Manual 57

58 STAAD.Pro

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110


2A.1 Design Operations
Warning: It is strongly recommended that you perform new concrete design using the RC Designer Module. The following is provided to allow old STAAD files to be run. STAAD has the capability of performing design of concrete beams, columns and slabs according to the 1997 revision of BS8110. Given the width and depth (or diameter for circular columns) of a section, STAAD will calculate the required reinforcement to resist the forces and moments.

2A.2 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to BS8110. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 2A.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 2A.1 - British Concrete Design BS 8110 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as BRITISH to invoke design per BS8110. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BRACE

0.0

0.0 = Column braced in both directions. 1.0 = Column unbraced about local Z

International Design Codes Manual 59

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110 Parameter Name Default Value Description

direction only 2.0 = Column unbraced about local Y direction only 3.0 = Column unbraced in both Y and Z directions CLEAR 20 mm Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. ELY ELZ FC FYMAIN 1.0 1.0 30 N/mm2 460 N/mm2 460 N/mm2 Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams

DEPTH

YD

EFACE

0.0

FYSEC

60 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name MAXMAIN

Default Value 50mm

Description

Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 20. Serviceability checks: 0.0 = No serviceability check performed. 1.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever beams.

MINMAIN

8mm

MINSEC

8mm

MMAG NSECTION

1.0 10

SERV

0.0

SFACE

0.0

Face of support location at start of

International Design Codes Manual 61

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110 Parameter Name Default Value Description

beam, in current units. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) SRA 0.0 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy -slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design. A = skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. TRACK 0.0 0.0 = Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1.0 = For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2.0 = Output of TRACK 1.0 List of design sag/hog moments and corresponding required steel area at each section of member WIDTH ZD Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.

2A.3 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Considerations


STAAD provides the user with two methods of accounting for the slenderness effects in the analysis and design of concrete members. The first method is

62 STAAD.Pro

equivalent to the procedure presented in BS8110 Part 1 1985 Section 3.8.2.2 In this section, the code recognizes that additional moments induced by deflection are present and states that these 'secondary' moments are accounted for by the design formula in Section 3.8.3. This is the method used in the design for concrete in STAAD. Alternatively STAAD houses a PDELTA ANALYSIS facility, which allows the effects of these second order moments to be considered in the analysis rather than the design. In a PDELTA analysis, after solving the joint displacements of the structure, the additional moments induced in the structure are calculated. These can be compared to those calculated using the formulation of BS8110.

2A.4 Member Dimensions


Concrete members that are to be designed by STAAD must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTIES command. The following example demonstrates the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTIES *RECTANGULAR COLUMN 300MM WIDE X 450MM DEEP 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 300. *CIRCULAR COLUMN 300MM DIAMETER 11 13 PR YD 300. * T-SECTION - FLANGE 1000.X 200.(YD-YB) * - STEM 250(THICK) X 350.(DEEP) 14 PRISM YD 550. ZD 1000. YB 350. ZB 250.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450mm depth x 300mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 300mm diameter. Note that area (AX) is not provided for these members. If shear area areas ( AY & AZ ) are to be considered in analysis, the user may provide them along with YD and ZD. Also note that if moments of inertias are not provided, the program will calculate them from YD and ZD. Finally a T section can be considered by using the third definition above.

International Design Codes Manual 63

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

2A.5 Beam Design


Beam design includes both flexure and shear. For both types of beam action, all active beam loadings are scanned to create moment and shear envelopes and locate the critical sections. The total number of sections considered is ten, unless that number is redefined with the NSECTION parameter. From the critical moment values, the required positive and negative bar pattern is developed with cut-off lengths calculated to include required development length. Shear design as per BS8110 clause 3.4.5 has been followed and the procedure includes critical shear values plus torsional moments. From these values, stirrup sizes are calculated with proper spacing. The program will scan from each end of the member and provide a total of two shear regions at each, depending on the change of shear distribution along the beam. If torsion is present, the program will also consider the provisions of BS8110 - Part 2 -section 2.4. A table of shear and/or combined torsion is then provided with critical shear. Stirrups not bent up bars are assumed in the design. The example output below shows a sample output of an actual reinforcement pattern developed by STAAD. The following annotations apply:
l

LEVEL - Serial number of the bar center which may contain one or more bar groups. HEIGHT - Height of bar level from the soffit of the beam in relation to its local y axis. BAR INFO - Reinforcement bar information specifying number of bars and their size. FROM - Distance from the start of the beam to the start of the reinforcing bar. TO - Distance from the start of the beam to the end of the reinforcing bar. ANCHOR - States whether anchorage, either a hook or (STA,END) continuation, is needed at start (STA) or at the end (END).

The following is an example TRACK 2.0 beam design output:


==================================================================== B E A M N O. 13 D E S I G N R E S U L T S - FLEXURE LEN - 1500. mm FY - 460. FC - 30. SIZE - 300. X 300. mm LEVEL HEIGHT BAR INFO FROM TO ANCHOR

64 STAAD.Pro

mm mm mm STA END ------------------------------------------------------------------1 29. 4- 8 MM 467. 1500. NO YES 2 264. 4- 8 MM 0. 1158. YES NO REQUIRED REINF. STEEL SUMMARY : ------------------------------SECTION REINF STEEL(+VE/-VE) MOMENTS(+VE/-VE) LOAD(+VE/VE) ( MM ) (SQ. MM ) (KN-METER) 0. 0.0/ 184.4 0.00/ 19.71 0/ 3 125. 0.0/ 157.2 0.00/ 16.80 0/ 3 250. 0.0/ 129.9 0.00/ 13.89 0/ 3 375. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 10.98 0/ 3 500. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 8.07 0/ 3 625. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 5.16 0/ 3 750. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 2.25 0/ 3 875. 117.0/ 0.0 2.15/ 0.00 1/ 0 1000. 117.0/ 0.0 5.25/ 0.00 1/ 0 1125. 117.0/ 0.0 8.36/ 0.00 1/ 0 1250. 117.0/ 0.0 11.46/ 0.00 1/ 0 1375. 136.3/ 0.0 14.57/ 0.00 1/ 0 1500. 165.3/ 0.0 17.67/ 0.00 1/ 0 N O. 13 D E S I G N R E S U L T S - SHEAR PROVIDE SHEAR LINKS AS FOLLOWS |----------------------------------------------------------------| | FROM - TO | MAX. SHEAR | LOAD | LINKS | NO. | SPACING C/C | |----------------|------------|------|-------|-----|-------------| | END 1 749 mm | 24.8 kN | 1 | 8 mm | 5 | 187 mm | | 749 END 2 | 24.8 kN | 1 | 8 mm | 5 | 187 mm | |----------------------------------------------------------------| ___ 7J____________________ 1500.X 300.X 300_____________________ 8J____ | | ||========================================================= | | 4No8 H 264. 0.TO 1158 | | | | | 5*8 c/c187 | | | 5*8 c/c187 | | 4No8 H |29. 467.TO 1500 | | | ====================================================|| | | |_____________________________________________________________________ ______| _______________ _______________ _______________ _________ ______ | | | | | | | | B E A M

International Design Codes Manual 65

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

oooo | | | 4T8 | | | | | | | | | | oooo | | | | |_______________| _______|

| | 4T8 | | 4T8 | |

oooo

| | | |

| | 4T8 | | 4T8 | |

oooo

| | | |

| | | | 4T8 | | |________

oooo

| |

oooo

| |

|_______________|

|_______________|

2A.6 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial force and biaxial bending at the ends. All active loadings are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which produces maximum reinforcement is called the critical load and is displayed. The requirements of BS8110 Part 1 - section 3.8 are followed, with the user having control on the effective length in each direction by using the ELZ and ELY parameters as described in Table 2A.1. Bracing conditions are controlled by using the BRACE parameter. The program will then decide whether or not the column is short or slender and whether it requires additional moment calculations. For biaxial bending, the recommendations of 3.8.4.5 of the code are considered. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. For rectangular and square sections, the reinforcement is always assumed to be arranged symmetrically. This causes slightly conservative results in certain cases. Below is a typical column design results. Using parameter TRACK 1.0, the detailed output below is obtained. TRACK 0.0 would merely give the bar configuration, required steel area and percentage, column size and critical load case.
==================================================================== C O L U M N N O. 1 D E S I G N R E S U L T S FY - 460. FC -30. N/MM2 SQRE SIZE - 300. X 300. MM, AREA OF STEEL REQUIRED = 940. SQ. MM. BAR CONFIGURATION REINF PCT. LOAD LOCATION ---------------------------------------------------12 10 MM 1.047 1 EACH END (PROVIDE EQUAL NUMBER OF BARS AT EACH FACE) ---------------------------------------------------|BRACED /SLENDER in z E.L.z= 4500 mm (3.8.1.3 & 5)|

66 STAAD.Pro

|BRACED /SLENDER in y E.L.y= 4500 mm (3.8.1.3 & 5)| |END MOMS. MZ1= -12 MZ2= -24 MY1= -15 MY2= -31| |SLENDERNESS MOMTS. KNM: MOMZ= 2 MOMY= 2 | |DESIGN LOADS KN METER: MOM.= 55 AXIAL LOAD= 74| |DESIGNED CAP. KN METER: MOM.= 55 AXIAL CAP.= 74| ----------------------------------------------------

2A.7 Slab Design


Slabs are designed to BS8110 specifications. To design a slab, it must first be modeled using finite elements. The command specifications are in accordance with Section 5.52 of the Technical Reference Manual. A typical example of element design output is shown in below. The reinforcement required to resist the Mx moment is denoted as longitudinal reinforcement and the reinforcement required to resist the My moment is denoted as transverse reinforcement ( Fig. 4.1 ). The following parameters are those applicable to slab design:
l

FYMAIN - Yield stress for all reinforcing steel FC - Concrete grade CLEAR - Distance from the outer surface to the edge of the bar. This is considered the same on both surfaces. SRA - Parameter which denotes the angle of the required transverse reinforcement relative to the longitudinal reinforcement for the calculation of Wood & Armer design moments.

Other parameters, as shown in Table 2A.1 are not applicable.

Wood & Armer equations


Ref: R H WOOD CONCRETE 1968 (FEBRUARY) If the default value of zero is used for the parameter SRA, the design will be based on the Mx and My moments which are the direct results of STAAD analysis. The SRA parameter (Set Reinforcement Angle) can be manipulated to introduce Wood & Armer moments into the design replacing the pure Mx, My moments. These new design moments allow the Mxy moment to be considered when designing the section. Orthogonal or skew reinforcement may be considered. SRA set to -500 will assume an orthogonal layout. If however a skew is to be considered, an angle is given in degrees measured anticlockwise (positive) from the element local x-axis to

International Design Codes Manual 67

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

the reinforcement bar. The resulting Mx* and My* moments are calculated and shown in the design format. The design of the slab considers a fixed bar size of 16 mm in both directions with the longitudinal bar being the layer closest to the slab exterior face. Typical output is as follows:
ELEMENT DESIGN SUMMARY-BASED ON 16mm BARS ----------------------------------------MINIMUM AREAS ARE ACTUAL CODE MIN % REQUIREMENTS. PRACTICAL LAYOUTS ARE AS FOLLOWS: FY=460, 6No.16mm BARS AT 150mm C/C = 1206mm2/metre FY=250, 4No.16mm BARS AT 250mm C/C = 804mm2/metre ELEMENT LONG. REINF MOM-X /LOAD TRANS. REINF MOM-Y /LOAD (mm2/m) (kN-m/m) (mm2/m) (kN-m/m) ------------------------------------------------------------------------| WOOD & ARMER RESOLVED MOMENTS FOR ELEMENT: 47 UNITS: METRE kN | | LOAD MX MY MXY MX* MY*/Ma* ANGLE | | 1 -10.441 -13.347 1.270 0.000 0.000 0.000 TOP | | 1 -10.441 -13.347 1.270 -11.710 -14.617 0.000 BOTT | | 3 -9.541 -11.995 0.986 0.000 0.000 0.000 TOP | | 3 -9.541 -11.995 0.986 -10.527 -12.981 0.000 BOTT | ------------------------------------------------------------------------47 TOP : 195. 0.00 / 0 195. 0.00 / 0 BOTT: 229. -11.71 / 1 329. -14.62 / 1

2A.8 Shear Wall Design


Design of shear walls in accordance with BS 8110 has been added to the features of the program. The program implements the provisions of BS 8110 for the design of shear walls. It performs in-plane shear, compression, as well as in-plane and out-of-plane bending design of reinforcing. The shear wall is modeled by a single or a combination of Surface elements. The use of the Surface element enables the designer to treat the entire wall as one entity. It greatly simplifies the modeling of the wall and adds clarity to the analysis and design output. The results are

68 STAAD.Pro

presented in the context of the entire wall rather than individual finite elements thereby allowing users to quickly locate required information. The program reports shear wall design results for each load case/combination for user specified number of sections given by SURFACE DIVISION (default value is 10) command. The shear wall is designed at these horizontal sections. The output includes the required horizontal and vertical distributed reinforcing, the concentrated (in-plane bending) reinforcing and the link required due to out-ofplane shear.

General Format
START SHEARWALL DESIGN CODE BRITISH FYMAIN f1 FC f2 HMIN f3 HMAX f4 VMIN f5 VMAX f6 EMIN f7 EMAX f8 LMIN f9 LMAX f10 CLEAR f11 TWOLAYERED f12 KSLENDER f13 DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST shearwall-list END

International Design Codes Manual 69

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

The next table explains parameters used in the shear wall design command block above. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 2A.2 - Shear Wall Design Parameters Parameter Name FYMAIN FC HMIN Default Value 460 Mpa 30 Mpa 6 Description

Yield strength of steel, in current units. Compressive strength of concrete, in current units. Minimum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Maximum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge

HMAX

36

VMIN

VMAX

36

EMIN

70 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. EMAX 36 Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Maximum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Clear concrete cover, in current units. Reinforcement placement mode: 0. single layer, each direction 1. two layers, each direction KSLENDER 1.5 Slenderness factor for finding effective height.

LMIN

LMAX

16

CLEAR TWOLAYERED

25 mm 0

The following example starts from the definition of shear wall and ends at the shear wall design.

Example
.

International Design Codes Manual 71

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

. SET DIVISION 12 SURFACE INCIDENCES 2 5 37 34 SUR 1 19 16 65 68 SUR 2 11 15 186 165 SUR 3 10 6 138 159 SUR 4 . . . SURFACE PROPERTY 1 TO 4 THI 18 SUPPORTS 1 7 14 20 PINNED 2 TO 5 GEN PIN 6 TO 10 GEN PIN 11 TO 15 GEN PIN 19 TO 16 GEN PIN . . SURFACE CONSTANTS E 3150 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 8.68E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 . . START SHEARWALL DES CODE BRITISH UNIT NEW MMS

72 STAAD.Pro

FC 25 FYMAIN 460 TWO 1 VMIN 12 HMIN 12 EMIN 12 DESIGN SHEA LIST 1 TO 4 END

Notes
1. Command SET DIVISION 12 indicates that the surface boundary node-tonode segments will be subdivided into 12 fragments prior to finite element mesh generation. 2. Four surfaces are defined by the SURFACE INCIDENCES command. 3. The SUPPORTS command includes the new support generation routine. For instance, the line 2 TO 5GEN PIN assigns pinned supports to all nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As the node-to-node distances were previously subdivided by the SET DIVISION 12 command, there will be an additional 11 nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As a result, all 13 nodes will be assigned pinned supports. Please note that the additional 11 nodes are not individually accessible to the user. They are created by the program to enable the finite element mesh generation and to allow application of boundary constraints. 4. Surface thickness and material constants are specified by the SURFACE PROPERTY and SURFACE CONSTANTS, respectively. 5. The shear wall design commands are listed between lines START SHEARWALL DES and END. The CODE command selects the design code that will be the basis for the design. For British code the parameter is BRTISH. The DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST command is followed by a list of previously defined Surface elements intended as shear walls and/or shear wall components.

International Design Codes Manual 73

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

Technical Overview
The program implements provisions of section 3.9 of BS 8110:Part 1:1997 and relevant provisions as referenced therein, for all active load cases. The wall is designed as unbraced reinforced wall. The following steps are performed for each of the horizontal sections of the wall set using the SURFACE DIVISION command (see Description above).

Checking of slenderness limit


The slenderness checking is done for out-of-plane direction. For out-of-plane direction, the wall is assumed to be simply supported. Hence, the provisions of clause 3.9.3.2.2 and 3.9.4.2 are applicable. The default effective height is 1.5 times the clear height. User can change the effective height. The limit for slenderness is as per table 3.23 for unbraced wall, which is taken as 30. Design for in-plane bending (denoted by Mz in the shear wall force output) Walls are assumed to be cantilever beams fixed at their base and carrying loads to the foundation. Extreme compression fibre to centroid of tension (concentrated) reinforcement distance, d, is taken as 0.8 horizontal length of the wall. Flexural design of the wall is carried out in accordance with the provisions of clause no. 3.4.4. The flexural (concentrated vertical ) reinforcing is located at both ends (edges) of the length of the wall. The edge reinforcement is assumed to be distributed over a length of 0.2 times horizontal length on each side. This length is inclusive of the thickness of the wall. Minimum reinforcements are according to table 3.25. Design for in-plane shear (denoted by Fxy in the shear wall force output) Limit on the nominal shear strength, v is calculated as per clause no. 3.4.5.2. Nominal shear strength of concrete is computed as per table 3.8. The design shear stress is computed as per clause no. 3.4.5.12 taking into consideration the effect of axial load. The area of reinforcement is calculated and checked against the minimum area as per clause no. 3.12.7.4. Design for compression and out-of-plane vertical bending (denoted by Fy and My respectively in the shear wall force output)

74 STAAD.Pro

The wall panel is designed as simply supported (at top and bottom), axially loaded with out-of-plane uniform lateral load, with maximum moments and deflections occurring at mid-height. Design is done as per clause no. 3.8.4 for axially loaded column with uni-axial bending. The minimum reinforcement percentage is as per table 3.25. The maximum reinforcement percentage of vertical reinforcement is as per clause no. 3.12.6.3. Links if necessary are calculated as per the provisions of clause 3.12.7.5. Design for out-of-plane shear (denoted by Qy in the shear wall force output) The out-of-plane shear arises from out-of-plane loading. The design shear stress is calculated as per 3.4.5.2 and shear strength of concrete section is calculated as per table 3.8 considering vertical reinforcement as tension reinforcement. Shear reinforcements in the form of links are computed as per table 3.7 and the provisions of clause 3.12.7.5. Design for out-of-plane horizontal bending (denoted by Mx in the shear wall force output) The horizontal reinforcement already calculated from in-plane shear is checked against the whole section subjected to out-of-plane bending and axial load. The axial load in this case is the in-plane shear. The section is again designed as axially loaded column under uni-axial bending as per the provisions of clause 3.8.4. Extra reinforcement in the form of horizontal bars, if necessary, is reported. Shear Wall Design With Opening The Surface element has been enhanced to allow design of shear walls with rectangular openings. The automatic meshing algorithm has been improved to allow variable divisions along wall and opening(s) edges. Design and output are available for user selected locations.

Description
Shear walls modeled in STAAD.Pro may include an unlimited number of openings. Due to the presence of openings, the wall may comprise up with different wall panels. 1. Shear wall set-up Definition of a shear wall starts with a specification of the surface element perimeter nodes, meshing divisions along node-to-node segments,

International Design Codes Manual 75

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

opening(s) corner coordinates, and meshing divisions of four edges of the opening(s). SURFACE INCIDENCE n1, ..., ni SURFACE s DIVISION sd1, ..., sdj RECOPENING x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 DIVISION od1, ..., odk Where: n1, ..., ni -node numbers on the perimeter of the shear wall, s -surface ordinal number, sd1, ..., sdj - number of divisions for each of the node-to-node distance on the surface perimeter, x1 y1 z1 (...)- od1, ..., odk- coordinates of the corners of the opening, divisions along edges of the opening.

Note: If the sd1, ..., sdj or the od1, ..., odk list does not include all node-to-node segments, or if any of the numbers listed equals zero, then the corresponding division number is set to the default value (=10, or as previously input by the SET DIVISION command). Default locations for stress/force output, design, and design output are set as follows: SURFACE DIVISION X xd SURFACE DIVISION Y yd where: xd - number of divisions along X axis, yd - number of divisions along Y axis. Note: xd and yd represent default numbers of divisions for each edge of the surface where output is requested. The output is provided for sections located between division segments. For example, if the number

76 STAAD.Pro

of divisions = 2, then the output will be produced for only one section (at the center of the edge).

2. Stress/force output printing Values of internal forces may be printed out for any user-defined section of the wall. The general format of the command is as follows: PRINT SURFACE FORCE (ALONG ) (AT a) (BETWEEN d1, d2) LIST s1, ...,si where: - local axis of the surface element (X or Y), a - distance along the full cross-section of the wall, axis from start of the member to the

d1, d2 - coordinates in the direction orthogonal to , delineating a fragment of the full cross-section for which the output is desired.** s1, ...,si - list of surfaces for output generation ** The range currently is taken in terms of local axis. If the local axis is directed away from the surface, the negative range is to be entered. Note: If command ALONG is omitted, direction Y (default) is assumed. If command AT is omitted, output is provided for all sections along the specified (or default) edge. Number of sections will be determined from the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values. If the BETWEEN command is omitted, the output is generated based on full cross-section width.

3. Definition of wall panels Input syntax for panel definition is as follows: START PANEL DEFINITION

International Design Codes Manual 77

British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110

SURFACE i PANEL j ptype x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 ENDPANEL DEFINITION where: i - ordinal surface number, j - ordinal panel number, ptype - WALL x1 y1 z1 (...) - coordinates of the corners of the panel

Note: Design of COLUMN and BEAM panels is currently not available. 4. Shear wall design The program implements different provisions of design of walls as per code BS 8110. General syntax of the design command is as follows: START SHEARWALL DESIGN (...) DESIGN SHEARWALL (AT c) LIST s TRACK tr ENDSHEARWALL DESIGN Parameter TRACK specifies how detailed the design output should be: 0 - indicates a basic set of results data (default), 1 - full design output will be generated. If the command AT is omitted, the design proceeds for all cross sections of the wall or panels, as applicable, defined by the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values.

78 STAAD.Pro

a. No panel definition. Design is performed for the specified horizontal full cross-section, located at a distance c from the origin of the local coordinates system. If opening is found then reinforcement is provided along sides of openings. The area of horizontal and vertical bars provided along edges of openings is equal to that of the respective interrupted bars. b. Panels have been defined. Design is performed for all panels, for the cross-section located at a distance c from the start of the panel.

International Design Codes Manual 79

80 STAAD.Pro

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000


2B.1 General
The design philosophy embodied in BS5950:2000 is built around the concept of limit state design, used today in most modern steel design codes. Structures are designed and proportioned taking into consideration the limit states at which they become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit state are recognized - serviceability and ultimate. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability while that in serviceability limit state is deflection. Appropriate safety factors are used so that the chances of limits being surpassed are acceptably remote. In the STAAD implementation of BS5950:2000, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength and stability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. This procedure is controlled by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type or other such parameters. The code checking portion of the program checks that code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The complete B.S.C. steel tables for both hot rolled and hollow sections are built into the program for use in specifying member properties as well as for the actual design process. See section 2B.4 for information regarding the referencing of these sections. In addition to universal beams, columns, joists, piles, channels, tees, composite sections, beams with cover plates, pipes, tubes, and angles, there is a provision for user provided tables. STAAD.Pro 2006 and later have the additional option to design tapered I shaped (wide flange) beams according to Annex G of BS5950. See Section 2B.13 for a complete description.

Single Angle Sections


Angle sections are un-symmetrical and when using BS 5950:2000 table 25 you must consider four axes: two principal, u-u and v-v and two geometric, a-a and bb. The effective length for the v-v axis, Lvv, is taken as the LVV parameter or LY * KY, if not specified. The a-a and b-b axes are determined by which leg of the angle is fixed by the connection and should be specified using the LEG parameter, see

International Design Codes Manual 81

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

section 5B.6 for more information on the LEG parameter. The effective length in the a-a axis is taken as LY * KY and the effective length in the b-b axis as LZ * KZ. The following diagram shows the axes for angles which have been defined with either an ST or RA specification and is connected by its longer leg (i.e., a-a axis is parallel to the longer leg).
Figure 2.1 - Single angle sections A) STangle & USERtable angles and B) RAangle

2B.2 Analysis Methodology


Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis or P-Delta analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results.

2B.3 Member Property Specifications


For specification of member properties, the steel section library available in STAAD may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility. Any user-defined section may be specified, except for

82 STAAD.Pro

GENERAL or PRISMATIC sections. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

2B.4 Built-In Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered during the analysis of these members. Almost all BSI steel sections are available for input. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained by using the tools of the graphical user interface. Refer to Section 1.7.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information. Following are the descriptions of different types of sections available:

Universal Beams, Columns, and Piles


All rolled universal beams, columns and pile sections are available. The following examples illustrate the designation scheme.
20 TO 30 TA ST UB305X165X54 33 36 TA ST UC356X406X287 100 102 106 TA ST UP305X305X186

Rolled Steel Joists


Joist sections may be specified as they are listed in BSI-80 with the weight omitted. In those cases where two joists have the same specifications but different weights, the lighter section should be specified with an "A" at the end.
10 TO 20 TA ST JO152X127 1 2 TA ST JO127X114A

International Design Codes Manual 83

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

Channels
All rolled steel channel sections from the BSI table have been incorporated in STAAD. The designation is similar to that of the joists. The same designation scheme as in BSI tables may be used with the weight omitted.
10 TO 15 TA ST CH305X102 55 57 59 61 TA ST CH178X76

Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are available. The letter "D" in front of the section name will specify a double channel (e.g., D CH102X51, D CH203X89, etc.)
51 52 53 TA D CH152X89 70 TO 80 TA D CH305X102 SP 5.

(specifies a double channel with a spacing of 5 length units) Note: Face-to-face double channels can not be used in a CHECK CODE command.

Tee Sections
Tee sections are not input by their actual designations, but instead by referring to the universal beam shapes from which they are cut. For example,
54 55 56 TA T UB254X102X22

(tee cut from UB254X102X22)

Angles
All equal and unequal angles are available for analysis. Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle section, either a standard, ST specification or reversed angle, RA specification. Note, however, that only angles specified with an RA specification can be designed.

84 STAAD.Pro

The standard angle section is specified as follows:


15 20 25 TA ST UA200X150X18

This specification may be used when the local STAAD z-axis corresponds to the V-V axis specified in the steel tables. If the local STAAD y-axis corresponds to the V-V axis in the tables, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.
35 TO 45 TA RA UA200X150X18

Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by inputting the word SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either LD or SD will serve the purpose. For example,
14 TO 20 TA LD UA200X200X16 SP 1.5 23 27 TA SD UA80X60X6

"SP" denotes spacing between the individual angle sections. Note: If the section is defined from a Double Angle User Table, then the section properties must be defined with an 11th value which defines the radius of gyration about an individual sections principal v-v axis (See Technical Reference Manual, 5.19 User Steel Table Specification)

Pipes (Circular Hollow Sections)


To designate circular hollow sections from BSI tables, use PIP followed by the numerical value of diameter and thickness of the section in mm omitting the decimal section of the value provided for diameter. The following example will illustrate the designation.
10 15 TA ST PIP213.2

(specifies a 21.3 mm dia. pipe with 3.2 mm wall thickness) Circular hollow sections may also be provided by specifying the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,

International Design Codes Manual 85

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0

(specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 and inside dia. of 20 in current length units) Only code checking and no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.

Rectangular or Square Hollow Sections (Tubes)


Designation of tubes from the BSI steel table is illustrated below:
Figure 2.2 - BSI tube nomenclature

Example:
15 TO 25 TA ST TUB160808.0

Tubes, like pipes, can also be input by their dimensions (Height, Width and Thickness) and not by any table designations.
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5 (A TUBE THAT HAS A HEIGHT OF 8, A WIDTH OF 6, AND A WALL THICKNESS OF 0.5 LENGTH UNITS)

Note: Only code checking and no member selection is performed for TUBE sections specified this way.

2B.5 Member Capacities


The basic measure of capacity of a beam is taken as the plastic moment of the section. This is a significant departure from the standard practice followed in

86 STAAD.Pro

BS449, in which the limiting condition was attainment of yield stress at the extreme fibres of a given section. With the introduction of the plastic moment as the basic measure of capacity, careful consideration must be given to the influence of local buckling on moment capacity. To assist this, sections are classified as either Class 1, plastic, Class 2, compact, Class 3, semi-compact or Class 4, slender, which governs the decision whether to use the plastic or the elastic moment capacity. The section classification is a function of the geometric properties of the section. STAAD is capable of determining the section classification for both hot rolled and built up sections. In addition, for slender sections, BS5950 recommends the use of a 'stress reduction factor' to reduce the design strength. This factor is again a function of the geometry of the section and is automatically determined by STAAD for use in the design process.

Axial Tension
In members with axial tension, the tensile load must not exceed the tension capacity of the member. The tension capacity of the member is calculated on the basis of the effective area as outlined in Section 4.6 of the code. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a given member per this procedure, based on a user supplied net section factor (NSF-a default value of 1.0 is present but may be altered by changing the input value - see Table 2B.1), proceeding with member selection or code check accordingly. BS5950 does not have any slenderness limitations for tension members.

Compression
Compression members must be designed so that the compression resistance of the member is greater than the axial compressive load. Compression resistance is determined according to the compressive strength, which is a function of the slenderness of the gross section, the appropriate design strength and the relevant strut characteristics. Strut characteristics take into account the considerable influence residual rolling and welding stresses have on column behavior. Based on data collected from extensive research, it has been determined that sections such as tubes with low residual stresses and Universal Beams and Columns are of intermediate performance. It has been found that I-shaped sections are less sensitive to imperfections when constrained to fail about an axis parallel to the flanges. These research observations are incorporated in BS5950 through the use of four strut curves together with a selection of tables to indicate which curve to use for a particular case. Compression strength for a particular section is calculated in

International Design Codes Manual 87

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

STAAD according to the procedure outlined in Annex C of BS5950 where compression strength is seen to be a function of the appropriate Robertson constant ( representing Strut Curve) corresponding Perry factor, limiting slenderness of the member and appropriate design strength. A departure from BS5950:1990, generally compression members are no longer required to be checked for slenderness limitations, however, this option can be included by specifying a MAIN parameter. Note, a slenderness limit of 50 is still applied on double angles checked as battened struts as per clause 4.7.9.

Axially Loaded Members With Moments


In the case of axially loaded members with moments, the moment capacity of the member must be calculated about both principal axes and all axial forces must be taken into account. If the section is plastic or compact, plastic moment capacities will constitute the basic moment capacities subject to an elastic limitation. The purpose of this elastic limitation is to prevent plasticity at working load. For semicompact or slender sections, the elastic moment is used. For plastic or compact sections with high shear loads, the plastic modulus has to be reduced to accommodate the shear loads. The STAAD implementation of BS5950 incorporates the procedure outlined in section 4.2.5 and 4.2.6 to calculate the appropriate moment capacities of the section. For members with axial tension and moment, the interaction formula as outlined in section 4.8.2 is applied based on effective tension capacity. For members with axial compression and moment, two principal interaction formulae must be satisfied Cross Section Capacity check (4.8.3.2) and the Member Buckling Resistance check (4.8.3.3 ). Three types of approach for the member buckling resistance check have been outlined in BS5950:2000 - the simplified approach (4.8.3.3.1), the more exact approach (4.8.3.3.2) and Annex I1 for stocky members. As noted in the code, in cases where neither the major axis nor the minor axis moment approaches zero, the more exact approach may be more conservative than the simplified approach. It has been found, however, that this is not always the case and STAAD therefore performs both checks, comparing the results in order that the more appropriate criteria can be used. Additionally the equivalent moment factors, m m and m , can be specified by x y yx the user or calculated by the program. Members subject to biaxial moments in the absence of both tensile and compressive axial forces are checked using the appropriate method described

88 STAAD.Pro

above with all axial forces set to zero. STAAD also carries out cross checks for compression only, which for compact/plastic sections may be more critical. If this is the case, COMPRESSION will be the critical condition reported despite the presence of moments.

Shear
A member subjected to shear is considered adequate if the shear capacity of the section is greater than the shear load on the member. Shear capacity is calculated in STAAD using the procedure outlined in section 4.2.3, also 4.4.5 and Annex H3 if appropriate, considering the appropriate shear area for the section specified.

Lateral Torsional Buckling


Since plastic moment capacity is the basic moment capacity used in BS5950, members are likely to experience relatively large deflections. This effect, coupled with lateral torsional buckling, may result in severe serviceability limit state. Hence, lateral torsional buckling must be considered carefully. The procedure to check for lateral torsional buckling as outlined in section 4.3 has been incorporated in the STAAD implementation of BS5950. According to this procedure, for a member subjected to moments about the major axis, the 'equivalent uniform moment' on the section must be less than the lateral torsional buckling resistance moment. For calculation of the buckling resistance moment, the procedure outlined in Annex B.2 has been implemented for all sections with the exception of angles. In Annex B.2., the resistance moment is given as a function of the elastic critical moment, Perry coefficient, and limiting equivalent slenderness, which are calculated within the program; and the equivalent moment factor, m , LT which is determined as a function of the loading configuration and the nature of the load (stabilizing, destabilizing, etc).

RHS Sections - Additional Provisions


Rectangular Hollow sections are treated in accordance with S.C.I. recommendations in cases when the plastic axis is in the flange. In such cases, the following expressions are used to calculate the reduced plastic moduli: For n 2t(D-2t)/A

International Design Codes Manual 89

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

For n 2t(B-2t)/A

2B.6 Design Parameters


Available design parameters to be used in conjunction with BS5950 are listed in table 2B.1 along with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 2B.1 - British Steel Design BS5950:2000 Parameters Parameter Name Default Value Description Must be specified as BS5950 CODE Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. AD Depth at end/2 Distance between the reference axis and the axis of restraint. See G.2.3 Beam divisions 0. Design only for end moments or those locations specified by the SECTION command. 1. Calculate forces and moments at 12th points along the member. Establish the location where Mz is the maximum. Use the forces and moments at that location. Clause checks at one location.

BEAM

3.0

90 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description 2. Same as BEAM = 1.0 but additional checks are carried out for each end. 3. Calculate moments at 12th points along the member. Clause checks at each location including the ends of the member. Deflection check method. See Note 1 below. 0. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type (see note below) Moment calculation: 1. BS5950 per clause B.2.5 (continuous) to calculate Mb. 2. To calculate Mbs (simple) as per Clause 4.7.7 as opposed to Mb.

CAN

CB

1.0

DFF

None (Mandatory for deflection check, TRACK 4.0)

"Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection See Note 1d below.

International Design Codes Manual 91

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000 Parameter Name

Default Value

Description Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" . See Note 1 below. Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length". See Note 1 below. Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Clauses 4.8.3.3.1 and 4.8.3.3.2 0.0 = Fail ratio uses MIN of 4.8.3.3.1, 4.8.3.3.2. and Annex I1 checks. 1.0 = Fail ratio uses MAX of 4.8.3.3.1, 4.8.3.3.2. and Annex I1 checks.

DJ1

Start Joint of member

DJ2 DMAX * DMIN *

End Joint of member 100.0cm 0.0 cm

ESTIFF

0.0

KY KZ

1.0 1.0

K factor value in local y - axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K factor value in local z - axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Valid range from 0 7 and 10. The values correspond to table 25 of BS5950 for fastener conditions. See note 2 below.

LEG

0.0

92 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value Maximum of Lyy

Description

LVV *

and Lzz (Lyy is a term used by BS5950)

Used in conjunction with LEG for Lvv as per BS5950 table 25 for double angles. See note 6 below. Length in local y - axis (current units) to calculate (KY)(LY)/Ryy slenderness ratio. Length in local z - axis (current units) to calculate (KZ)(LZ)/Rzz slenderness ratio. Equivalent moment factor for lateral torsional buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Equivalent moment factor for major axis flexural buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Equivalent moment factor for minor axis flexural buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Equivalent moment factor for minor axis lateral flexural buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Net section factor for tension members.

LY *

Member Length

LZ *

Member Length

MLT

1.0

MX

1.0

MY

1.0

MYX

1.0

NSF

1.0

International Design Codes Manual 93

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000 Parameter Name

Default Value

Description Transverse stiffener spacing (a in Annex H1)

PNL *

0.0

0.0 = Infinity Any other value used in the calculations.

PY *

Set according to Design strength of steel steel grade (SGR) Slenderness limit for members with compression forces, effective length/ radius of gyration, for a given axis: 0.0 = Slenderness not performed.

MAIN

0.0

1.0 = Main structural member (180) 2.0 = Secondary member. (250) 3.0 = Bracing etc (350)

RATIO

1.0

Permissible ratio of the actual capacities.

94 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description Controls the sections to try during a SELECT process. 0.0 = Try every section of the same type as original 1.0 = Try only those sections with a similar name as original, e.g., if the original is an HEA 100, then only HEA sections will be selected, even if there are HEMs in the same table. Identify Section type for section classification 0.0 = Rolled Section

SAME**

0.0

SBLT

0.0 1.0 = Built up Section 2.0 = Cold formed section Specifies a load case number to provide the sway loading forces in clause 4.8.3.3.4 (See additional notes)

SWAY

none

International Design Codes Manual 95

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000 Parameter Name

Default Value

Description Steel Grade per BS4360 0.0 = Grade S 275

SGR

0.0

1.0 = Grade S 355 2.0 = Grade S 460 3.0 = As per GB 1591 16 Mn 0.0 = Elastic stress analysis

TB

0.0 1.0 = Plastic stress analysis Output details 0.0 = Suppress all member capacity info. 1.0 = Print all member capacities.

TRACK

0.0

2.0 = Print detailed design sheet. 4.0 = Deflection Check (separate check to main select / check code) Factor applied to unsupported length for Lateral Torsional Buckling effective length per section 4.3.6.7 of BS5950.

UNF

1.0

96 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description Unsupported Length for calculating Lateral Torsional Buckling resistance moment section 4.3.6.7 of BS5950. Weld Type, see AISC steel design 1.0 = Closed sections. Welding on one side only (except for webs of wide flange and tee sections) 2.0 = Open sections. Welding on both sides (except pipes and tubes)

UNL *

Member Length

1.0 closed WELD 2.0 open

* current units must be considered. **For angles, if the original section is an equal angle, then the selected section will be an equal angle and vice versa for unequal angles. Note: There was an NT parameter in STAAD.Pro 2005 build 1003 which is now automatically calculated during the design as it is load case dependant.

Notes
1. CAN, DJ1, and DJ2 Deflection a. When performing the deflection check, you can choose between two methods. The first method, defined by a value 0 for the CAN parameter, is based on the local displacement. Local displacement is described in Section 5.44 of the Technical Reference Manual.

International Design Codes Manual 97

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

If the CAN parameter is set to 1, the check will be based on cantilever style deflection. Let (DX1, DY1, DZ1) represent the nodal displacements (in global axes) at the node defined by DJ1 (or in the absence of DJ1, the start node of the member). Similarly, (DX2, DY2, DZ2) represent the deflection values at DJ2 or the end node of the member. Compute Delta = SQRT((DX2 - DX1)2 + (DY2 - DY1)2 + (DZ2 - DZ1)2) Compute Length = distance between DJ1 & DJ2 or, between start node and end node, as the case may be. Then, if CAN is specified a value 1, dff = L/Delta Ratio due to deflection = DFF/dff b. If CAN = 0, deflection length is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the Deflection Length will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the Deflection Length may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.

D = Maximum local deflection for members 1, 2, and 3.


PARAMETERS DFF 300. ALL DJ1 1 ALL DJ2 4 ALL

98 STAAD.Pro

c. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. d. It is important to note that unless a DFF value is specified, STAAD will not perform a deflection check. This is in accordance with the fact that there is no default value for DFF. e. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design. 2. LEG follows the requirements of BS5950 table 28. This table concerns the fastener restraint conditions for angles, double angles, tee sections and channels for slenderness. The following values are available: Table 2B.2 - LEG Parameter values Clause Bold Configuration (a) - 2 bolts 4.7.10.2 Single Angle (b) - 1 bolts long leg short leg (a) - 2 bolts long leg short leg (b) - 1 bolts 4.7.10.3 Double Angles (c) - 2 bolts short leg long leg (d) - 1 bolts short leg 4.0 5.0 0.0 long leg long leg 6.0 1.0 7.0 2.0 2.0 3.0 long leg short leg 3.0 0.0 Leg short leg LEG Parameter 1.0

International Design Codes Manual 99

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

Clause

Bold Configuration

Leg

LEG Parameter 1.0 0.0 1.0 0.0

4.7.10.4 Channels

(a) - 2 or more rows of bolts (b) - 1 row of bolts

(a) - 2 or more rows of 4.7.10.5 Tee Sec- bolts tions (b) - 1 row of bolts

The slenderness of single and double angle, channel and tee sections are specified in BS 5950 table 25 depending on the connection provided at the end of the member. To define the appropriate connection, a LEG parameter should be assigned to the member. The following list indicates the value of the LEG parameter required to match the BS5950 connection definition: Clause 4.7.10.2 Single Angle: a. 2 Bolts: Short leg = 1.0, Long Leg = 3.0 b. 1 Bolt: Short Leg = 0.0, Long Leg = 2.0 For single angles, the slenderness is calculated for the geometric axes, a-a and b-b as well as the weak v-v axis. The effective lengths of the geometric axes are defined as: La = KY * KY Lb = KZ * LZ The slenderness calculated for the v-v axis is then used to calculate the compression strength p for the weaker principal axis (z-z for ST angles or yc y for RA specified angles). The maximum slenderness of the a-a and b-b axes is used to calculate the compression strength p for the stronger c principal axis. Alternatively for single angles where the connection is not known or Table 25 is not appropriate, by setting the LEG parameter to 10, slenderness is calculated for the two principal axes y-y and z-z only. The LVV parameter is not used.

100 STAAD.Pro

For double angles, the LVV parameter is available to comply with note 5 in table 25. In addition, if using double angles from user tables, (Technical Reference Manual section 5.19) an eleventh value, r , should be supplied at vv the end of the ten existing values corresponding to the radius of gyration of the single angle making up the pair. 3. PY Steel Design Strength The design parameter PY should only be used when a uniform design strength for an entire structure or a portion thereof is required. Otherwise the value of PY will be set according to the stipulations of BS5950 table 9 in which the design strength is seen as a function of cross sectional thickness for a particular steel grade (SGR parameter) and particular element considered. Generally speaking this option is not required and the program should be allowed to ascertain the appropriate value. 4. UNL, LY, and LZ Relevant Effective Length The values supplied for UNL, LY and LZ should be real numbers greater than zero in current units of length. They are supplied along with or instead of UNF, KY and KZ (which are factors, not lengths) to define lateral torsional buckling and compression effective lengths respectively. Please note that both UNL or UNF and LY or KY values are required even though they are often the same values. The former relates to compression flange restraint for lateral torsional buckling while the latter is the unrestrained buckling length for compression checks. 5. TRACK Control of Output Formats When the TRACK parameter is set to 0.0, 1.0 or 2.0, member capacities will be printed in design related output (code check or member selection) in kilonewtons per square metre. TRACK 4.0 causes the design to carry out a deflection check, usually with a different load list to the main code check. The members that are to be checked must have the parameters, DFF, DJ1 and DJ2 set. An example of each TRACK setting follows: Example output for TRACK 0.0
MEMBER RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= TABLE

International Design Codes Manual 101

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

1 ST UC305X305X118 PASS 179.66 C

BS-4.3.6 0.00

0.769 334.46

3 0.00

Example output for TRACK 1.0


MEMBER RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST UC305X305X118 PASS BS-4.3.6 0.769 3 179.66 C 0.00 334.46 0.00 |---------------------------------------------------------------------| | CALCULATED CAPACITIES FOR MEMB 1 UNIT - kN,m SECTION CLASS 1 | |MCZ= 519.4 MCY= 234.3 PC= 2455.9 PT= 0.0 MB= 435.0 PV= 600.1| | BUCKLING CO-EFFICIENTS mLT = 1.00, mx = 1.00, my = 1.00, myx = 1.00 | | PZ= 3975.00 FX/PZ = 0.05 MRZ= 516.9 MRY= 234.3 | |---------------------------------------------------------------------| TABLE

Example output for TRACK 2.0


MEMBER RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST UC305X305X118 PASS BS-4.3.6 0.769 3 179.66 C 0.00 334.46 0.00 ======================================================================= MATERIAL DATA Grade of steel = S 275 Modulus of elasticity = 210 kN/mm2 Design Strength (py) = 265 N/mm2 SECTION PROPERTIES (units - cm) Member Length = 600.00 Gross Area = 150.00 Net Area = 127.50 Eff. Area = 150.00 z-z axis y-y axis Moment of inertia : 27700.004 9060.001 Plastic modulus : 1960.000 895.000 Elastic modulus : 1761.526 589.460 Effective modulus : 1960.000 895.000 Shear Area : 103.471 37.740 DESIGN DATA (units - kN,m) BS5950-1/2000 Section Class : PLASTIC Squash Load : 3975.00 Axial force/Squash load : 0.045 z-z axis y-y axis Compression Capacity : 3551.7 2455.9 Moment Capacity : 519.4 234.3 Reduced Moment Capacity : 516.9 234.3 Shear Capacity : 1645.2 600.1 BUCKLING CALCULATIONS (units - kN,m) (axis nomenclature as per design code) x-x axis y-y axis Slenderness : 44.153 77.203 Radius of gyration (cm) : 13.589 7.772 TABLE

102 STAAD.Pro

Effective Length : 6.000 6.000 LTB Moment Capacity (kNm) and LTB Length (m): 435.00, 6.000 LTB Coefficients & Associated Moments (kNm): mLT = 1.00 : mx = 1.00 : my = 1.00 : myx = 1.00 Mlt = 334.46 : Mx = 334.46 : My = 0.00 : My = 0.00 CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (units- kN,m): CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY BS-4.2.3-(Y) 0.143 3 85.6 BS-4.3.6 0.769 3 85.6 334.5 BS-4.7 (C) 0.098 1 239.7 BS-4.8.3.2 0.647 3 179.7 85.6 0.0 334.5 0.0 BS-4.8.3.3.1 0.842 3 179.7 334.5 0.0 BS-4.8.3.3.2 0.842 3 179.7 334.5 0.0 ANNEX I.1 0.714 3 179.7 334.5 0.0 Torsion and deflections have not been considered in the design.

6. MX, MY, MYX, and MLT Equivalent Moment Factors The values for the equivalent moment factors can either be specified directly by the user as a positive value between 0.4 and 1.0 for MX, MY and MYX and 0.44 and 1.0 for MLT. The program can be used to calculate the values for the equivalent moment factors by defining the design member with a GROUP command (see the Technical Reference Manual section 5.16 Listing of Members/Elements/Joints by Specification of GROUPS). The nodes along the beam can then be defined as the location of restraint points with J settings. Additionally for the MLT parameter, the joint can be defined as having the upper flange restrained (positive local Y) with the a U setting or the lower flange restrained (negative local Y) with a L setting. For example, consider a series of 5 beam elements as a single continuous member as shown below:

International Design Codes Manual 103

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

To enable the steel design, the beam needs to be defined as a group, called MainBeam:
START GROUP DEFINITION MEMBER _MAINBEAM 11 2 38 12 3 END GROUP DEFINITION

Note: This can be done in the User Interface by selecting Tools > Create New Group. Therefore, this 5 beam member has 6 joints such that: Joint 1 = Node 3 Joint 2 = Node 1 Joint 3 = Node 33 Joint 4 = Node 14 Joint 5 = Node 7 Joint 6 = Node 2

104 STAAD.Pro

a. Consider MX, MY and MYX Say that this member has been restrained in its major axis (local Y) only at the ends. In the minor axis (local Z) it has been restrained at the ends and also at node number 33 (joint 3). For local flexural buckling, it has only been restrained at its ends. Hence: For the major axis, local Y axis: MX _MainBeam J1 J6 For the minor axis, local Z axis: MY _ MainBeam J1 J3 J6 For the lateral flexural buckling, local X axis: MYX _ MainBeam J1 J6 b. Consider MLT Say that this member has been restrained at its ends against lateral torsional buckling and the top flange has been restrained at node number 33 (joint 3) and only the lower flange at node number 7, (joint 5). Hence: MLT _MainBeam J1 T3 L5 J6 To split the beam into two buckling lengths for L at joint 14:
y

MY _groupname J1 J4 J6 7. SWAY Sway Loadcase This parameter is used to specify a load case that is to be treated as a sway load case in the context of clause 4.8.3.3.4. This load case would be set up to represent the k M mentioned in this clause and the steel design module amp s would add the forces from this load case to the forces of the other load case it is designed for. Note that the load case specified with this parameter will not be designed as a separate load case. The following is the correct syntax for the parameter:

International Design Codes Manual 105

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

Parameter Name SWAY

Default Value

Description

(load case number)

ALL MEMBER (member list) _(group name)

Example
SWAY 5 MEM 1 TO 10 SWAY 6 _MAINBEAMS

2B.7 Design Operations


STAAD contains a broad set of facilities for the design of structural members as individual components of an analyzed structure. The member design facilities provide the user with the ability to carry out a number of different design operations. These facilities may be used selectively in accordance with the requirements of the design problem. The operations to perform a design are:
l

Specify the load cases to be considered in the design; the default is all load cases. Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection along with the list of members.

These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements.

2B.8 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to ascertain whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked as per BS5950. Code checking is done using the forces and moments at specific sections of the members. If no sections are specified, the program uses the start and end forces for code checking.

106 STAAD.Pro

When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks; the critical condition of BS5950 code (like any of the BS5950 specifications for compression, tension, shear, etc.); the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value); the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the member of forces in the member where the critical condition occurs). Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2B.4 or any of the user defined sections as described in Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual, GENERAL and ISECTION. In BS5950, these will only be considered for design as I-shape sections. Note: PRISMATIC sections are also not acceptable steel sections for design per BS5950 in STAAD.Pro. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

2B.9 Member Selection


STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section, i.e., the lightest section, which fulfills the code requirements for the specified member. The section selected will be of the same type section as originally designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN, which limits the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Member selection can be performed with all the types of steel sections with the same limitations as defined in section 2B.8 Code Checking. Selection of members, whose properties are originally input from a user created table, will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic or as above limitations for code checking. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

International Design Codes Manual 107

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

2B.10 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


For code checking or member selection, the program produces the results in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. MEMBER refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b. TABLE refers to steel section name, which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c. RESULTS prints whether the member has PASSED or FAILED. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark on front of the member. d. CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the BS5950 code which governs the design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number, which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis and the moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. i. TRACK If the parameter TRACK is set to 1.0, the program will block out part of the table and will print the allowable bending capacities in compression (MCY & MCZ) and reduced moment capacities (MRY & MRZ), allowable axial capacity in compression (PC) and tension (PT) and shear capacity (PV). TRACK 2.0 will produce the design results as shown in section 2B.9.

2B.11 Plate Girders


Sections will be considered for the Plate Girder checks (BS 5950 Section 4.4) if d/t > 70 for rolled sections or d/t >62 for welded sections. The parameter SBLT should be used to identify sections as rolled or welded; see the parameter list for more information. If the plate girder has intermediate stiffeners, the spacing is set with the PNL parameter. These are then used to check against the code clauses 4.4.3.2 -

108 STAAD.Pro

Minimum web thickness for serviceability and 4.4.3.3 - Minimum web thickness to avoid compression flange buckling. The following printout is then included if a TRACK 2.0 output is selected:
Shear Buckling check is required: Vb = 1070 kN : qw = 118 N/mm2 d = 900 mm : t = 10 mm : a = 200 mm : pyf = 275 N/mm2 BS-4.4.3.2 status = PASS : BS-4.4.3.3 status = PASS

The section is then checked for shear buckling resistance using clause 4.4.5.2 Simplified method and the result is included in the ratio checks.

2B.12 Composite Sections


Sections that have been defined as acting compositely with a concrete flange either from a standard database section using the CM option, or from a modified user WIDE FLANGE database with the additional composite parameters, cannot be designed with BS5950:2000.

2B.13 Design of Tapered Beams


Design Procedure
Sections will be checked as tapered members provided that are defined either as a Tapered I section or from a USERtable. Example using a Tapered I section:
UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTY 1 TO 5 TAPERED 100 2.5 75 25 4 25 4

Example using a USER table:


START USER TABLE TABLE1 UNIT CM ISECTION 1000MM_TAPER 100 2.5 75 25 4 25 4 0 0 0

International Design Codes Manual 109

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

750MM_TAPER 75 2.5 50 25 4 25 4 0 0 0 END

You must specify the effective length of unrestrained compression flange using the parameter UNL. The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with BS 5950-1:2000. Code checking is carried out for locations specified by the user via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. The user may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. The beam is designed as other wide flange beams apart from the Lateral Torsional Buckling check which is replaced by the Annex G.2.2. check.

Design Equations
A beam defined with tapered properties as defined above will be checked as a regular wide flange (e.g., UB or UC), except that the following is used in place of clause 4.3.6, the lateral torsional buckling check.

Check Moment for Taper Members as per clause G.2.2


The following criterion is checked at each defined check position in the length of the member defined by the BEAM parameter. M M (1 - F /P )
xi bi c c

Where: F is the longitudinal compression at the check location;


c

M is the buckling resistance moment M from 4.3.6 for an equivalent bi b slenderness , see G.2.4.2, based on the appropriate modulus S, TB S , Z or Z of the cross-section at the point i considered;
eff eff

M is the moment about the major axis acting at the point i xi considered;

110 STAAD.Pro

P is the compression resistance from 4.7.4 for a slenderness . , see c TC y G.2.3, based on the properties of the minimum depth of cross-section within the segment length L

G.2.3 Slenderness lTC

TC

= y

Where:

= L /r Where:

y y

a is the distance between the reference axis and the axis of restraint, h is the distance between the shear centers of the flanges;
s

L is the length of the segment;


y

r is the radius of gyration for buckling about the minor axis;


y

x is the torsional index

G.2.4.2 Equivalent slenderness lTB for Taper members

TB

= cn
t t

Where, for a two-flange haunch:

Where: C is the taper factor, see G.2.5;

International Design Codes Manual 111

British Codes - Steel Design per BS5950:2000

G.2.5 Taper factor


For an I-section with D 1.2B and x 20, the taper factor, c, is as follows:

Where: D is the maximum depth of cross-section within the length Ly, see max Figure G.3; D is the minimum depth of cross-section within the length Ly, see min Figure G.3; x is the torsional index of the minimum depth cross-section, see 4.3.6.8 Otherwise, c is taken as 1.0 (unity).

112 STAAD.Pro

British Codes - Design per BS5400


2C.1 General Comments
Note: BS5400 is an additional code available from Bentley Systems. It does not come as standard with British versions. The British Standard, BS5400 adopts the limit state design philosophy and is applicable to steel, concrete and composite construction. The code is in ten parts covering various aspects of bridge design. The implementation of part 3, Code of practice for design of steel bridges, in STAAD is restricted in its scope to simply supported spans. It is assumed that the depth remains constant and both construction and composite stages of steel I-Sections can be checked. The following sections describe in more detail features of the design process currently available in STAAD.

2C.2 Shape Limitations


The capacity of sections could be limited by local buckling if the ratio of flange outstand to thickness is large. In order to prevent this, the code sets limits to the ratio as per clause 9.3.2. In the event of exceeding these limits, the design process will terminate with reference to the clause.

2C.3 Section Class


Sections are further defined as compact or noncompact. In the case of compact sections, the full plastic moment capacity can be attained. In the case of noncompact sections, local buckling of elements may occur prior to reaching the full moment capacity and for this reason the extreme fibre stresses are limited to first yield. In STAAD, section types are determined as per clause 9.3.7 and the checks that follow will relate to the type of section considered.

2C.4 Moment Capacity


Lateral torsional buckling may occur if a member has unrestrained elements in compression. The code deals with this effect by limiting the compressive stress to a value depending on the slenderness parameter which is a modified form of the ratio Le/Ry. Le is the effective length governed by the provision of lateral restraints satisfying the requirements of clause 9.12.1. Once the allowable compressive stress

International Design Codes Manual 113

British Codes - Design per BS5400

is determined then the moment capacity appropriate to the section type can be calculated. STAAD takes the effective length as that provided by the user, defaulting to the length of the member during construction stage and as zero, assuming full restraint throughout, for the composite stage. The program then proceeds to calculate the allowable compressive stress based on appendix G7 from which the moment capacity is then determined.

2C.5 Shear Capacity


The shear capacity, as outlined in clause is a function of the limiting shear strength, l, which is dependant on the slenderness ratio. STAAD follows the iterative procedure of appendix G8 to determine the limiting shear strength of the web panel. The shear capacity is then calculated based on the formula given under clause 9.9.2.2.

2C.6 Design Parameters


Available design parameters to be used in conjunction with BS5400 are listed in table 2C.1. Depending on the value assigned to the 'WET' parameter, the users can determine the stage under consideration. For a composite design check, taking into consideration the construction stage, two separate analyses are required. In the first, member properties are non-composite and the WET parameter is set to 1.0 . In the second, member properties should be changed to composite and the WET parameter set to 2.0. Member properties for composite or non-composite sections should be specified from user provided tables (refer to section 5.19 of the manual for specification of user tables). Rolled sections, composite or noncomposite, come under WIDE FLANGE section-type and built-up sections under ISECTION. When specifying composite properties the first parameter is assigned a negative value and four additional parameters provided giving details of the concrete section. See user table examples provided. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 2C.1 - BS5400 Design Parameters Parameter Name UNL Default Value *Member Length Description

Unsupported Length for calculating allowable compressive bending stress.

114 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name PY NSF SGR

Default Value * *1.0 *0.0

Description

Set according to Design Strength of steel SGR Net section factor for tension members. Steel Grade per BS4360 0.0 = Grade 43 1.0 = Grade 50 2.0 = Grade 55

SBLT

0.0

0.0 = Rolled Section 1.0 = Built up Section

MAIN

1.0

1.0 = Grade of concrete 30 N/mm2 2.0 = Grade of concrete 40 N/mm2 3.0 = Grade of concrete 50 N/mm2

WET

0.0

0.0 = Wet stage with no data saved for composite stage. 1.0 = Wet stage with data saved for composite stage. 2.0 = Composite and wet stage combined. 3.0 = Composite stage only.

TRACK

1.0

1.0 = Print all member capacities. 0.0 = suppress all member capacities.

BEAM LY

0.0

MUST BE CHANGED TO 1.0 FOR ALL RUNS

*Member Length to calculate slenderness ratio Length for bending about Y-axis.

International Design Codes Manual 115

British Codes - Design per BS5400 Parameter Name LZ KY KZ STIFF Default Value Description

*Member Length to calculate slenderness ratio Length for bending about Z-axis. 1.0 1.0 1.0 K value for bending about Y-axis. Usually this is minor axis. K value for bending about Z-axis. Usually this is major axis. Factor of length for panel length in the shear calculation.

* Provided in current unit systems.

2C.7 Composite Sections


The definition of composite sections has been provided for in the standard sections definition (refer to Section 5.20.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details). This is purely for analysis and for obtaining the right section properties. It uses the American requirement of 18 times depth (CT) as the effective depth. For more control with British sections two new options are available in user provided tables.

Wide Flange Composite


Using the standard definition of I sections in WIDE FLANGE, 4 additional values can now be provided. The first is the width of concrete to the left of center of the steel web (b1). The second is the concrete width to the right (b2). The third is the concrete depth (d1) to be considered. The last is the modular ratio. The above values are accepted in the program by adding a '-' at the first position on the first line of data. The program now awaits four extra values on line 2 as described above. If (-) is provided on the second line the program requires another 2 breadths + 1 thickness for the bottom plate.

ISection
The same is true for ISECTION definition in user table.

116 STAAD.Pro

Example
UNIT CM WIDE FLANGE C45752 -66.5 44.98 .76 15.24 1.09 21345 645 21.3 34.185 33.223 150 150 30 10 ISECTION PG9144 -92.05 2.15 92.05 42.05 3.66 42.05 3.66 197.9 153.9 1730 40 40 12 1

The larger British sections have been coded as USER TABLES under wide flange and are available on request to any existing user. Please note however that composite design is not available in this portion of STAAD.

International Design Codes Manual 117

118 STAAD.Pro

British Codes - Design per BS8007


2D.1 General Comments
Note: BS8007 is an additional code available from Bentley Systems. It does not come as standard with British versions. STAAD has the capability of performing concrete slab design according to BS8007. BS8007 provides recommendations for the design of reinforced concrete structures containing aqueous liquids. It is recommended that the design of the structure is carried out according to BS8110, unless modified by the recommendations given in BS8007. Please use the following in conjunction with Section 2A of this Manual - BS8110.

2D.2 Design Process


The design process is carried out in three stages. 1. Ultimate Limit States The program is structured so that ultimate design is first carried out in accordance with recommendations given in BS8110. All active design load cases are considered in turn and a tabulated output is printed showing possible reinforcement arrangements. 12, 16, and 20 mm bars are considered with possible spacings from 100,125,150,175, and 200 mm. Within these spacings, the layout providing the closest area of steel is printed under each bar size. Longitudinal and transverse moments together with critical load cases for both hogging and sagging moments are also printed. Minimum reinforcement is in any case checked and provided in each direction. Wood & Armer moments may also be included in the design. 2. Serviceability Limit States In the second stage, flexural crack widths under serviceability load cases are calculated. The first and every other occurring design load case is considered as a serviceability load case and crack widths are calculated based on bar sizes and spacings proposed at the ultimate limit state check. Crack widths due to longitudinal and transverse moments are calculated directly under bars, midway between and at corners. A tabulated output

International Design Codes Manual 119

British Codes - Design per BS8007

indicating critical serviceability load cases and moments for top and bottom of the slab is then produced. 3. Thermal crack widths Finally thermal, crack width calculations are carried out. Through available parameters, the user is able to provide information on the type of slab, temperature range and crack width limits. Surface zone depths are determined based on the type of slab and critical areas of reinforcements are calculated and printed in a tabulated form. Four bar sizes are considered and for each, max crack spacing, Smax and crack widths are calculated for the critical reinforcements and printed under each bar size. Maximum bar spacing to limit crack widths to the user's limit is also printed under each bar size.

2D.3 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to BS8007. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used values for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 2D.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 2D.1 - BS8007 Design Parameters Parameter Name FC CLEAR SRA Default Value * 30 N/mm2 * 20 mm 0.0 Concrete grade. Distance from the outer surface to the edge of the bar. both surfaces. Description

Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering t 500. orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calcu

120 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value for design.

Description

A* Skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations. SCON 1

Parameter which indicates the type of slab ee. ground o BS8007 1 = Suspended Slab 2 = Ground Slab

TEMP CRACK *

30C *0.2 mm

Temperature range to be considered in thermal crack w Limiting thermal crack width

* Provided in current unit systems

2D.4 Structural Model


Structural slabs that are to be designed to BS8007 must be modeled using finite elements. Refer to Section 1.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for information on the sign convention used in the program for defining elements It is recommended to connect elements in such a way that the positive local z axis points outwards away, from the center of the container. In this manner the "Top" of elements will consistently fall on the outer surface and internal pressure loads will act in the positive direction of the local z axis. An example of a rectangular tank is provided to demonstrate the above procedure. Element properties are based on the thickness given under ELEMENT PROPERTIES command. The following example demonstrates the required input for a 300 mm slab modeled with ten elements.
UNIT MM ELEMENT PROPERTIES 1 TO 10 THI 300.0

2D.5 Wood & Armer Moments


This is controlled by the SRA parameter. If the default value of zero is used, the design will be based on the Mx and My moments which are the direct results of

International Design Codes Manual 121

British Codes - Design per BS8007

STAAD analysis. The SRA parameter (Set Reinforcement Angle) can be manipulated to introduce Wood & Armer moments into the design replacing the pure Mx, My moments. These new design moments allow the Mxy moment to be considered when designing the section. Orthogonal or skew reinforcement may be considered. SRA set to -500 will assume an orthogonal layout. If however a skew is to be considered, an angle is given in degrees, measured between the local element x axis anti-clockwise (positive). The resulting Mx* and My* moments are calculated and shown in the design format.

122 STAAD.Pro

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code


2E.1 General
Provisions of BS 5950-5:1998, have been implemented. The program allows design of single (non-composite) members in tension, compression, bending, shear, as well as their combinations. Cold work of forming strengthening effects have been included as an option.

2E.2 Cross-Sectional Properties


The user specifies the geometry of the cross-section by selecting one of the section shape designations from the Gross Section Property Tables published in the The Steel Construction Institute, (Design of Structures using Cold Formed Steel Sections). The Tables are currently available for the following shapes:
l

Channel with Lips Channel without Lips Z with Lips Pipe Tube

Shape assignment may be done using the General |Property page of the graphical user interface (GUI) or by specifying the section designation symbol in the input file. The properties listed in the tables are gross section properties. STAAD.Pro uses unreduced section properties in the structure analysis stage. Both unreduced and effective section properties are used in the design stage, as applicable.

2E.3 Design Procedure


The following two design modes are available:

International Design Codes Manual 123

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

1. Code Checking The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with BS 5950-5:1998. Code checking is carried out for locations specified by the user via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. The user may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. 2. Member Selection The user may request that the program search the cold formed steel shapes database (BS standard sections) for alternative members that pass the code check and meet the least weight criterion. In addition, a minimum and/or maximum acceptable depth of the member may be specified. The program will then evaluate all database sections of the type initially specified (i.e., channel, angle, etc.) and, if a suitable replacement is found, presents design results for that section. If no section satisfying the depth restrictions or lighter than the initial one can be found, the program leaves the member unchanged, regardless of whether it passes the code check or not. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. The program calculates effective section properties in accordance with Section 4 of the subject code. Cross-sectional properties and overall slenderness of members are checked for compliance with:
l

Clause 6.2.2, Maximum Effective Slenderness Ratio for members in Compression Clause 4.2, Maximum Flat Width Ratios for Elements in Compression

124 STAAD.Pro

2E.4 Design Equations


Tensile Strength
The allowable tensile strength, as calculated in STAAD as per BS5950-5, section 7 is described below. The tensile strength, P of the member should be determined from clause 7.2.1
t

P =Ap
t

e y

Where: A is the net area An determined in accordance with cl.3.5.4


e

p is the design strength


y

Combined bending and tension


As per clause 7.3 of BS 5950-5:1998 members subjected to both axial tension and bending should be proportioned such that the following relationships are satisfied at the ultimate limit state F /P +M /M
t t z cz

+M /M
y

cy

M /M
z

cz

and M /M
y cy

Where F is the applies tensile strength


t

P is the tensile capacity determined in accordance with clause 7.2.1 of t the subject code M ,M ,M ,M
z y cz cy

are as defined in clause 6.4.2 of the subject code

Compressive Strength
The allowable Compressive strength, as calculated in STAAD as per BS5950-5, section 6 is described below

International Design Codes Manual 125

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

For sections symmetrical about both principal axes or closed cross-sections which are not subjected to torsional flexural buckling, the buckling resistance under axial load, Pc, may be obtained from the following equation as per clause 6.2.3 of the subject code

For Sections symmetrical about a single axis and which are not subject to torsional flexural buckling, the buckling resistance under axial load, Pc, may be obtained from the following equation as per clause 6.2.4 of the subject code

Where the meanings of the symbols used are indicated in the subject clauses.

Torsional flexural buckling


Design of the members which have at least one axis of symmetry, and which are subject to torsional flexural buckling should be done according to the stipulations of the clause 6.3.2 using factored slenderness ratio L /r in place of actual E slenderness ratio while reading Table 10 for the value of Compressive strength(p ).
c

Where: = (P /P ) when P >P


E TF E TF

= 1, otherwise Where the meanings of the symbols used are indicated in the subject clause.

Combined bending and compression


Members subjected to both axial compression and bending should be checked for local capacity and overall buckling Local capacity check as per clause 6.4.2 of the subject code F /P +M /M
c cs z cz

+M /M
y

cy

126 STAAD.Pro

Overall buckling check as per clause 6.4.3 of the subject code


For Beams not subjected to lateral buckling, the following relationship should be satisfied

For Beams subjected to lateral buckling, the following relationship should be satisfied

F is the applied axial load


c

cs z

is the short strut capacity as per clause 6.2.3

M is the applied bending moment about z axis M is the applied bending moment about y axis
y

M is the moment capacity in bending about the local Z axis in the cz absence of F and M , as per clause 5.2.2 and 5.6
c y

M is the moment capacity in bending about the local Y axis, in the cy absence of F and M ,as per clause 5.2.2 and 5.6
c z

M- is the lateral buckling resistance moment as per clause 5.6.2


b

P is the flexural buckling load in compression for bending about the Ez local Z axis P is the flexural buckling load in compression for bending about the Ey local Y axis C ,C
bz by

are taken as unity unless their values are specified by the user

International Design Codes Manual 127

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

The M M and M are calculated from clause numbers 5.2.2 and 5.6 in cz, cy b the manner described herein below.

Calculation of moment capacities


For restrained beams, the applied moment based on factored loads should not be greater then the bending moment resistance of the section, M
c

M M

cz cy

=S

zz yy

xp
o

=S xp

Where M is the Moment resistance of the section in z axis


cz cz

M is the Moment resistance of the section in z axis p is the limiting stress for bending elements under stress gradient and o should not greater then design strength p
y

For unrestrained beams the applied moment based on factored loads should not be greater than the smaller of the bending moment resistance of the section , M , c and the buckling resistance moment of the beam, M
b

Then buckling resistance moment, M may be calculated as follows


b,

= [M +(1 +)M ]/2


B y E

M is the yield moment of the section , product of design strength p Y y and elastic modules of the gross section with respect to the compression flange Zc M is the elastic lateral buckling resistance as per clause 5.6.2.2
E

is the Perry coefficient

128 STAAD.Pro

Please refer clause numbers 5.2.2 and 5.6 of the subject code for a detailed discussion regarding the parameters used in the abovementioned equations.

Shear Strength
The maximum shear stress should not be greater then 0.7 p as per clause 5.4.2
y

The average shear stress should not exceed the lesser of the shear yield strength, p or the shear buckling strength, q as stipulated in clause 5.4.3 of the subject v cr code. The parameters are calculated as follows : p = 0.6p
v cr v y

q = (1000t/D)2 N/mm2 P = Amin(p , q )


v cr

Where: P is the shear capacity in N/mm2


v y

p is the design strength in N/mm2 t is the web thickness in mm D is the web depth in mm

Combined bending and Shear


For beam webs subjected to both bending and shear stresses the member should be designed to satisfy the following relationship as per the stipulations of clause 5.5.2 of the subject code (F /P )2 + (M/M )2 1
v v c

Where: F is the shear force


v

M is the bending moment acting at the same section as F


c

M is the moment capacity determined in accordance with 5.2.2

International Design Codes Manual 129

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

2E.5 Design Parameters


The design parameters outlined in Table 2E.1 are used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program and thus allow the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 2E.1 - British Cold Formed Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name Default Value CODE BS5950 COLD Description Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

130 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name Default Value BEAM 1.0

Description When this parameter is set to 1.0 (default), the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member. If the BEAM value is 0.0, the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details. For TRUSS members only start and end locations are designed. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending C . See b BS:5950-5:1998,5.6. Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending C . See b BS:5950-5:1998,5.6. Used for Combined axial load and bending design.

CMZ

1.0

CMY

1.0

International Design Codes Manual 131

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value CWY 1.0 Description Specifies whether the cold work of forming strengthening effect should be included in resistance computation. See BS:5950-5:1998,3.4 0 effect should not be included 1 effect should be included FLX 1 Specifies whether torsional-flexural buckling restraint is provided or is not necessary for the member. See BS:59505:1998, 5.6 Values: 0 Section subject to torsional flexural buckling 1 Section not subject to torsional flexural buckling FU 430 MPa Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units.

132 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name Default Value FYLD KX 250 MPa 1.0

Description Yield strength of steel in current units. Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall buckling about the local Y-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression.

KY

1.0

International Design Codes Manual 133

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value KZ 1.0 Description Effective length factor for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression.

LX

Member length

134 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name Default Value LY Member length

Description Effective length for overall buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression.

LZ

Member length

International Design Codes Manual 135

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value MAIN 0 Description Specify the design for slenderness against the maximum slenderness as per Clause 6.2.2: 0 Do not check slenderness ratio 1 Check members resisting normal loads (180) 2 - Check members resisting selfweight and wind loads (250) 3 - Check members resisting reversal of stress (350) NSF DMAX 1.0 2540.0 cm. RATIO 1.0 Net section factor for tension members Maximum allowable depth. It is input in the current units of length. Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stresses

136 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name Default Value TRACK 0

Description This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 0 - Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 1 - Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 1 2 - Prints member and material properties in addition to that printed by TRACK 2.

2E.5 Verification Problem


Shown below is a verification example for reference purposes. In this problem, we have assigned Channel sections with lips to different members. Member numbers 28 to 31 have been assigned section 230CLHS66X16,member numbers 3 TO 6 and 15 TO 19 have been assigned the section 230CLMIL70X30 and member numbers 1, 2, 7 TO 14 have been assigned the section 170CLHS56X18. These members have been designed as per BS 5950 Part 5. Other sections have

International Design Codes Manual 137

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

been assigned from the AISI shapes database (American cold-formed steel) and designed in accordance with that code. The excerpts from the design output for member number 1 are as follows:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (BS59505-V1.1) *********************** UNITS : MM, KN, KNM, MPA -----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MEMBER# 1 SECTION: 170CLHS56X18 LEN: 609.60 LOCATION: 609.60 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.278 GOV.MODE: 6.4-BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MATERIAL DATA: YIELD STRENGTH OF STEEL : ULTIMATE TENSILE STRENGTH : SECTION PROPERTIES:(UNITS - CM) SECTION NAME : MEMBER LENGTH : GROSS AREA(AG) : (AE): 4.58 AXIS MOMENT OF INERTIA (I) 21.93 MOMENT OF INERTIA (IE) 19.42 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZET) 5.20 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZEC) 10.42 DESIGN DATA: Z-Z AXIS AXIS COMPRESSION CAPACITY (PC) MOMENT CAPACITY (MC) 3.47 SHEAR CAPACITY (PV) 33.50 LTB CAPACITY (MB) : 9.17 EACH CLAUSE CHECK UNDER CRITICAL LOAD : CLAUSE COMBINATION BS-6.3 COMPRESSION RATIO - AXIAL BS-6.4 BEND-COMPRESSION RATIO BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Z BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Y BS-5.1 BIAXIAL BENDING RATIO BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Z BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Y BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Z & SHEAR - Y RATIO : 21.00 : : 93.70 9.17 Y-Y : 27.55 : 27.85 : 235.46 : 237.27 379.21 N/MM2 430.00 N/MM2 170CLHS56X18 60.96 5.45 NET AREA Z-Z AXIS Y-Y

RATIO 0.037 0.278 0.236 0.006 0.241 0.168 0.003 0.084

138 STAAD.Pro

BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Y & SHEAR - Z RATIO 0.000 TORSION AND DEFLECTIONS HAVE NOT BEEN CONSIDERED IN THE DESIGN.

1. Bending Check As per Clause 5.2.2.2 of BS 5950 Part 5 the limiting compressive stress(p ) for stiffened webs is given by the minimum of
o

p = Py, where Py = Min ( FYLD, 0.84FU) = 361.2 N/mm2


0

So that p = [1.13 - 0.0019(170/1.8)(279.212/280)1/2]361.2 = 332.727 N/mm2


0

The limiting compressive moments in local Y and Z axes will be given by M = S p = 27,632.4(332.727) = 9.19(10) Nmm
cz zz o 6

cy

= S p = 27,632.4(5,427.50) = 3.46(10) Nmm


yy o 6

Maximum bending moment about local Z = 2159 Nm at node 7 Maximum bending moment about local Y = 19.755 Nm at node 7 Bending Ratio Z = 2.15 X106 / 9.19 X106 = 0.235 hence verified Bending Ratio Y = 19755.3 / 3.46 X106 = 0.0057 hence verified Buckling resistance moment M As per section 5.6.2, The buckling resistance moment
b

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 139

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

The Yield moment of section is given by M = S p = 9.19(10)6 Nmm


Y zz o

The elastic buckling resistance moment as per clause 5.6.2.2 is calculated to be M = 4.649(10)6 Nmm
E

And = [M +(1 +)M ]/2


B y E

So that = [9.19(10)6 + (1 +0.0)4.649(10)6]/2 = 2.325(10)10


B

Which yields M = (4.6491069.19106 )/{2.3251010 +[(2.3251010)2 b 4.6491069.19106 ] 1/2} = 9.98(10)6 Nmm 2. Compression Check The Axial force induced in member# 1 is 3,436.75 N The elastic flexural buckling load P = 1.185(10)6 N
E

The short strut capacity (Pcs ) is given by A py = 457.698(344) = 157,448 N


eff

Perry Coefficient () = 0.02074 = [P +(1 +)P ]/2 = 683,512.45 N


cs E

Buckling resistance

P = 153,782 N
c

For Channel section (being singly symmetric), Buckling Resistance as per clause 6.2.4 is

140 STAAD.Pro

Where: The limiting compressive moment, M , in the relevant directionis equal to c 9.19(10)6 Nmm,as calculated above And the distance, e , of the geometric neutral axis of the gross cross section s and that of the effective cross section is equal to 38.24 m So that, P' = (9.19106 153,782)/[9.19106 +153,782(38.24)] = 93,788.7 N
c

Compression ratio = 3,436.75/93,788.7 = 0.0366 hence verified 3. Axial Compression and Bending Local capacity check as per clause 6.4.2 F /P +M /M
c cs z cz

+M /M
y

cy

= 3,436.75/[457.698(379.212)] +2.15106/(9.19106) +19,755.3/(1.81106) = 0.26 Overall buckling check per 6.4.3

= 0.2773 hence verified 4. Shear Check as per clause 5.4.2 and 5.4.3 p = 0.6p = 0.6(379.212) = 227.52 N/mm2
v y

q = (1000t/D)2 = (10001.8/170)2 = 112.11 N/mm2


cr v

P = Amin(p , q )
v cr

Shear resistance Y = 33,579.4 N

International Design Codes Manual 141

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

Shear resistance Z = 21,148.6 N Shear Ratio Y = 5,627.72/33,579.4 = 0.1675 hence verified Shear Ratio Z = 5,627.72/21,148.6 = 0.0031 hence verified 5. Shear Check with Bending as per clause 5.5.2 Shear with bending on Z (F /P )2 + (M /M )2 = (5,627.72/33,579.4)2 +[2.15106 /(9.19106 )] 2 = v v z cz 0.08327 hence verified Shear with bending on Y (F /P )2 + (M /M )2 = (67.114/21,148.6)2 +[19,755.3/(3.46106 )] 2 = v v y cy 0.0000427 hence verified

Input File
STAAD SPACE SET ECHO OFF INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 5 0; 2 0 5 10; 3 10 5 0; 4 10 5 10; 5 5 5 0; 6 5 5 10; 7 0 5 2; 8 0 5 4; 9 0 5 6; 10 0 5 8; 11 10 5 2; 12 10 5 4; 13 10 5 6; 14 10 5 8; 15 5 5 2; 16 5 5 4; 17 5 5 6; 18 5 5 8; 19 10 0 0; 20 10 0 10; 21 0 0 10; 22 0 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 7; 2 3 11; 3 1 5; 4 2 6; 5 5 3; 6 6 4; 7 7 8; 8 8 9; 9 9 10; 10 10 2; 11 11 12; 12 12 13; 13 13 14; 14 14 4; 15 5 15; 16 15 16; 17 16 17; 18 17 18;

142 STAAD.Pro

19 18 6; 20 7 15; 21 15 11; 22 8 16; 23 16 12; 24 9 17; 25 17 13; 26 10 18; 27 18 14; 28 1 22; 29 2 21; 30 3 19; 31 4 20; 32 1 21; 33 21 4; 34 4 19; 35 19 1; 36 2 20; 37 20 3; 38 3 22; 39 22 2; MEMBER PROPERTY COLDFORMED AMERICAN 32 TO 39 TABLE ST 3LU3X060 20 TO 27 TABLE ST 3HU3X075 MEMBER PROPERTY COLDFORMED BRITISH 28 TO 31 TABLE ST 230CLHS66X16 3 TO 6 15 TO 19 TABLE ST 230CLMIL70X30 1 2 7 TO 14 TABLE ST 170CLHS56X18 UNIT MMS PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES LIST 32 20 28 3 1 SUPPORTS 19 TO 22 PINNED UNIT FEET DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 4.176E+006 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 0.489024 ALPHA 6.5E-006 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL CONSTANTS BETA 90 MEMB 20 TO 27 MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 1 TO 39 MEMBER TENSION 32 TO 39 UNIT FEET KIP

International Design Codes Manual 143

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

LOAD 1 VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL MEMBER LOAD 3 TO 6 20 TO 27 UNI GY -0.3 0 5 JOINT LOAD 1 2 FX 0.6 2 4 FZ -0.6 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK UNIT KGS CM PRINT JOINT DISP LIST 1 4 16 PRINT SUPPORT REACTIONS PRINT MEMBER FORCES LIST 3 24 28 UNIT KIP INCH PARAMETER 1 CODE AISI FYLD 55 ALL CWY 1 ALL BEAM 1 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 20 21 PARAMETER 2 CODE BS5950 COLD TRACK 2 MEMB 1 TO 19 28 TO 31 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 2 FINISH

Resulting Output File

**************************************************** * *

144 STAAD.Pro

* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *

STAAD.PRO V8I SELECTSERIES2 VERSION 20.07.07.27

PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF BENTLEY SYSTEMS, INC. DATE= TIME= FEB 9, 2011

16: 0:53

USER ID: BENTLEY SYSTEMS

**************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE INPUT FILE: BRITISH COLD FORMED VERIFICATION.STD 2. SET ECHO OFF STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 2 MEMBER PROPERTIES. UNIT - CM ----------------MEMB PROFILE AX/ IZ/ IX/ AY AZ SY 32 ST 3LU3X060 2.26 21.81 5.17 0.02 1.51 1.51 4.05 1.93 20 ST 3HU3X075 4.91 63.15 40.66 0.06 1.24 2.40 10.63 9.59 28 ST 230CLHS66X16 8.78 663.30 42.82 0.17 5.31 2.76 60.05 9.06 3 ST 230CLMIL70X30 11.40 868.90 66.93 0.35 6.61 3.61 79.03 13.84 1 ST 170CLHS56X18 5.23 224.50 20.49 0.06 2.93 1.75 27.47 5.28 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 4

IY/ SZ

22/

39/

International Design Codes Manual 145

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

SOLVER USED IS THE IN-CORE ADVANCED SOLVER TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 120 STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 3 **START ITERATION NO. 2 **NOTE-TENSION/COMPRESSION CONVERGED AFTER 2 ITERATIONS, CASE= 1 STATIC LOAD/REACTION/EQUILIBRIUM SUMMARY FOR CASE NO. 1 VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL CENTER OF FORCE BASED ONFORCES ONLY (FEET). (FORCES IN NON-GLOBAL DIRECTIONS WILL INVALIDATE RESULTS) = 0.000000000E+00 Y = 0.500000015E+01 Z = 0.500000015E+01 CENTER OF FORCE BASED ON Y FORCES ONLY (FEET). (FORCES IN NON-GLOBAL DIRECTIONS WILL INVALIDATE RESULTS) = 0.500000015E+01 Y = 0.500000015E+01 Z = 0.500000015E+01 CENTER OF FORCE BASED ON Z FORCES ONLY (FEET). (FORCES IN NON-GLOBAL DIRECTIONS WILL INVALIDATE RESULTS) = 0.500000015E+01 Y = 0.500000015E+01 Z = 0.100000003E+02 ***TOTAL APPLIED LOAD ( KIP FEET ) SUMMARY (LOADING 1 ) SUMMATION FORCE-X = 1.20 SUMMATION FORCE-Y = -18.00 SUMMATION FORCE-Z = -1.20 SUMMATION OF MOMENTS AROUND THE ORIGINMX= 84.00 MY= 12.00 MZ= 96.00

***TOTAL REACTION LOAD( KIP FEET ) SUMMARY (LOADING 1 ) SUMMATION FORCE-X = -1.20 SUMMATION FORCE-Y = 18.00 SUMMATION FORCE-Z = 1.20 SUMMATION OF MOMENTS AROUND THE ORIGINMX= -84.00 MY= -12.00 MZ= 96.00 STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 4 MAXIMUM DISPLACEMENTS ( INCH /RADIANS) (LOADING 1) MAXIMUMS AT NODE = 1.56273E-02 1 Y = -4.80478E-01 16 Z = -1.74875E-02 4 RX= -8.28315E-03 6 RY= -2.09547E-05 14

146 STAAD.Pro

RZ= -8.32083E-03

************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 5 JOINT DISPLACEMENT (CM RADIANS) STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE -----------------JOINT LOAD X-TRANS Y-TRANS Z-TRANS X-ROTAN YROTAN Z-ROTAN 1 1 0.0397 -0.0184 -0.0339 0.0074 0.0000 -0.0027 4 1 0.0305 -0.0185 -0.0444 -0.0074 0.0000 0.0025 16 1 0.0352 -1.2204 -0.0392 0.0025 0.0000 0.0000 ************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 6 SUPPORT REACTIONS -UNIT KGS CM STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE ----------------JOINT LOAD FORCE-X FORCE-Y FORCE-Z MOM-X MOM-Y MOM Z 19 1 -447.20 2312.64 85.07 0.00 0.00 0.00 20 1 -446.98 2041.85 186.40 0.00 0.00 0.00 21 1 174.14 1768.33 187.80 0.00 0.00 0.00 22 1 175.72 2041.85 85.04 0.00 0.00 0.00 ************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 7 MEMBER END FORCES STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE ----------------ALL UNITS ARE -- KGS CM (LOCAL ) MEMBER LOAD JT AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOM-Y MOM-Z 3 -214.95 1 1 669.35 61567.53 5 -669.35 -195.56 107264.16 24 1 9 -0.62 -0.08 0.91 17 0.62 8362.12 -9.69 28 1 1 2155.99 12959.61 -61571.77 22 -2155.99 0.00 0.00 1448.01 -767.63 -0.06 0.06 -404.01 404.01 2.69 -2.69 -285.32 -395.06 -85.04 85.04

TORSION -1.67 1.67 -0.04 0.04 0.00 0.00 -

International Design Codes Manual 147

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 8 STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (AISI) *********************** UNITS ARE: IN, KIP, KIP-IN, KSI |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMBER# 20 SECTION: 3HU3X075 LEN: 60.00 GOV.LOC: 60.00 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.285 GOV.MODE: BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | | | | RESISTANCES: AX.TENS: 0.00 ECC.TENS: 0.00 COMPRESS: 7.51 | | BEND. Z: 28.21 BEND. Y: 30.98 SHEAR Z: 11.76 SHEAR Y: 5.88 | | | | FYLD: 55.00 COLD WORK FYLD: 55.71 FU: 58.00 A: 0.76 AE: 0.76 | | IZ: 1.5173E+00 IZE: 1.5173E+00 IY: 9.7684E-01 IYE: 9.7684E-01 | | SZE_T: 6.4841E-01 SZE_C: 6.4841E-01 SYE_T: 5.8539E-01 SYE_C: 7.3374E-01 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMBER# 21 SECTION: 3HU3X075 LEN: 60.00 GOV.LOC: 0.00 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.284 GOV.MODE: BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | | | | RESISTANCES: AX.TENS: 0.00 ECC.TENS: 0.00 COMPRESS: 7.51 | | BEND. Z: 28.21 BEND. Y: 30.98 SHEAR Z: 11.76 SHEAR Y: 5.88 | | | | FYLD: 55.00 COLD WORK FYLD: 55.71 FU: 58.00 A: 0.76 AE: 0.76 | | IZ: 1.5173E+00 IZE: 1.5173E+00 IY: 9.7684E-01 IYE: 9.7684E-01 | | SZE_T: 1.0115E+00 SZE_C: 1.0115E+00 SYE_T: 7.3374E-01 SYE_C: 5.8539E-01 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 9 STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 10

148 STAAD.Pro

STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (BS59505-V1.1) *********************** UNITS : MM, KN, KNM, MPA -----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MEMBER# 1 SECTION: 170CLHS56X18 LEN: 609.60 LOCATION: 609.60 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.278 GOV.MODE: 6.4-BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MATERIAL DATA: YIELD STRENGTH OF STEEL : ULTIMATE TENSILE STRENGTH : SECTION PROPERTIES:(UNITS - CM) SECTION NAME : MEMBER LENGTH : GROSS AREA(AG) : (AE): 4.58 AXIS MOMENT OF INERTIA (I) MOMENT OF INERTIA (IE) ELASTIC MODULUS (ZET) 5.20 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZEC) 10.42 DESIGN DATA: Z-Z AXIS AXIS COMPRESSION CAPACITY (PC) : 93.70 MOMENT CAPACITY (MC) : 9.17 3.47 SHEAR CAPACITY (PV) : 21.00 33.50 LTB CAPACITY (MB) : 9.17 EACH CLAUSE CHECK UNDER CRITICAL LOAD : CLAUSE COMBINATION RATIO BS-6.3 COMPRESSION RATIO - AXIAL 0.037 BS-6.4 BEND-COMPRESSION RATIO 0.278 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Z 0.236 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Y 0.006 BS-5.1 BIAXIAL BENDING RATIO 0.241 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Z 0.168 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Y 0.003 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Z & SHEAR - Y RATIO 0.084 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Y & SHEAR - Z RATIO 0.000 TORSION AND DEFLECTIONS HAVE NOT BEEN CONSIDERED IN THE DESIGN. ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------| MEMBER# 2 SECTION: 170CLHS56X18 LEN: 609.60 LOCATION: 609.60 | Y-Y : 27.55 : : : 237.27 235.46 27.85 21.93 19.42 379.21 N/MM2 430.00 N/MM2 170CLHS56X18 60.96 5.45 NET AREA Z-Z AXIS Y-Y

International Design Codes Manual 149

British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code

| STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.283 GOV.MODE: 6.4-BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 11 MATERIAL DATA: YIELD STRENGTH OF STEEL : 379.21 N/MM2 ULTIMATE TENSILE STRENGTH : 430.00 N/MM2 SECTION PROPERTIES:(UNITS - CM) SECTION NAME : 170CLHS56X18 MEMBER LENGTH : 60.96 GROSS AREA(AG) : 5.45 NET AREA (AE): 4.58 Z-Z AXIS Y-Y AXIS MOMENT OF INERTIA (I) : 237.27 21.93 MOMENT OF INERTIA (IE) : 235.46 21.93 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZET) : 27.85 14.17 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZEC) : 27.55 5.41 DESIGN DATA: Z-Z AXIS AXIS COMPRESSION CAPACITY (PC) MOMENT CAPACITY (MC) 1.80 SHEAR CAPACITY (PV) 33.50 LTB CAPACITY (MB) : 9.17 EACH CLAUSE CHECK UNDER CRITICAL LOAD : CLAUSE COMBINATION RATIO BS-6.3 COMPRESSION RATIO - AXIAL 0.037 BS-6.4 BEND-COMPRESSION RATIO 0.283 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Z 0.236 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Y 0.010 BS-5.1 BIAXIAL BENDING RATIO 0.246 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Z 0.168 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Y 0.003 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Z &L SHEAR - Y RATIO 0.084 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Y & SHEAR - Z RATIO 0.000 TORSION AND DEFLECTIONS HAVE NOT BEEN CONSIDERED IN THE DESIGN. -----------------------------------------------------------------------------STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 12 *********** END OF THE STAAD.PRO RUN *********** **** DATE= FEB 9,2011 TIME= 16: 0:54 **** : 21.00 : : 93.70 9.17 Y-Y

150 STAAD.Pro

************************************************************ * FOR QUESTIONS ON STAAD.PRO, PLEASE CONTACT * * BENTLEY SYSTEMS OFFICES AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS * * * * TELEPHONE WEB / EMAIL * * * * USA: +1 (714)974-2500 * * UK +44(1454)207-000 * * SINGAPORE +65 6225-6158 * * EUROPE +31 23 5560560 * * INDIA +91(033)4006-2021 * * JAPAN +81(03)5952-6500 HTTP://WWW.CTCG.CO.JP * * CHINA +86 10 5929 7000 * * THAILAND +66(0)2645-1018/19 PARTHA.P@REISOFTWARETH.COM * * * * WORLDWIDE HTTP://SELECTSERVICES.BENTLEY.COM/EN-US/ * * * ***********************************************************

International Design Codes Manual 151

152 STAAD.Pro

Section 3

Canadian Codes

International Design Codes Manual 153

154 STAAD.Pro

Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94


3A.1 Design Operations
STAAD can perform design of concrete beams, columns and slabs according to CSA STANDARD A23.3-94. Given the dimensions of a section, STAAD will calculate the required reinforcement necessary to resist the various input loads.

3A.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections for concrete members can be designed.
l

For Beams - Prismatic (Rectangular, Square & Tee) For Columns - Prismatic (Rectangular, Square and Circular) For Slabs - 4-noded Plate Elements

3A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members that are to be designed by STAAD must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTIES command. The following example demonstrates the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTIES 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 300. 11 14 PR YD 300.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450mm depth and 300mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with a 300mm diameter

3A.4 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Considerations


STAAD provides the user with two methods of accounting for the slenderness effect in the analysis and design of concrete members. The first method is equivalent to the procedure presented in CSA STANDARD A23.3-94 Clause 10.13. STAAD

International Design Codes Manual 155

Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94

accounts for the secondary moments, due to axial loads and deflections, when the PDELTA ANALYSIS command is used. After solving for the joint displacements of the structure, the program calculates the additional moments induced in the structure due to the P-Delta effect. Therefore, by performing a P-Delta analysis, member forces are calculated which will require no user modification before beginning member design. Refer to Section 5.37.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on this analysis facility. The second method by which STAAD allows the user to account for the slenderness effect is through user supplied moment magnification factors (see the parameter MMAG in Table 3A.1). Here the user approximates the additional moment by supplying a factor by which moments will be multiplied before beginning member design. This second procedure allows slenderness to be considered in accordance with Clause 10.14 of the code. It should be noted that STAAD does not factor loads automatically for concrete design. All the proper factored loads must be provided by the user before the ANALYSIS specification. While performing a P-Delta analysis, all load cases must be defined as primary load cases. If the effects of separate load cases are to be combined, it should be done either by using the REPEAT LOAD command or by specifying the load information of these individual loading cases under one single load case. Usage of the LOAD COMBINATION command will yield incorrect results for P-Delta Analysis in STAAD.Pro.

3A.5 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform design per CSA STANDARD A23.3-94. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the engineer control over the actual design process. Default values, which are commonly used numbers in conventional design practice, have been used for simplicity. Table 3A.1 contains a list of available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

156 STAAD.Pro

Table 3A.1 - Canadian Concrete Design CSA-A23.3-94 Parameters Parameter Name CLB CLS CLT DEPTH Default Value 40mm 40mm 40mm YD Description

Clear cover to reinforcing bar at bottom of cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar along the side of the cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar at top of cross section. Depth of the concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. Distance of face of support from end node of beam. Used for shear and torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.

EFACE

0.0 Face of Support

FC FYMAIN FYSEC MAXMAIN MINMAIN MINSEC MMAG NSECTION

30 N/mm2

Specified compressive strength of concrete.

400N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. 400 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Number 55 bar Number 10 bar Number 10 bar 1.0 12 Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Minimum secondary (stirrup) reinforcement bar size. A factor by which the column design moments will be magnified. Number of equally-spaced sections to be

International Design Codes Manual 157

Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94 Parameter Name Default Value Description

considered in finding critical moments for beam design. REINF SFACE 0.0 0.0 Tied Column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral. Distance of face of support from start node of beam. Used for shear and torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. TRACK 0.0 0. Critical Moment will not be printed out with beam design report. 1. Moments will be printed. WIDTH ZD Width of the concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

3A.6 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are scanned to create moment and shear envelopes, and locate critical sections. The total number of sections considered is thirteen (start, end, and 11 intermediate), unless that number is redefined with the NSECTION parameter.

Design for Flexure


Design for flexure is performed per the rules of Chapter 10 of CSA Standard A23.3-94. Maximum sagging (creating tensile stress at the bottom face of the beam) and hogging (creating tensile stress at the top face) moments are calculated for all active load cases at each of the thirteen sections. Each of these sections are designed to resist the critical sagging and hogging moments. Currently, design of singly reinforced sections only is permitted. If the section dimensions are inadequate as a singly reinforced section, such a message will be printed in the

158 STAAD.Pro

output. Flexural design of beams is performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexure design is performed again in a second pass taking into account the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provided after the preliminary design. Final provision of flexural reinforcements are made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the curtailment of reinforcements as per CSA Standard A23.3-94. Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (which finally will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account other practical considerations), the user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 13 equally spaced sections from which the final detailed drawing can be prepared. The following annotations apply to the output for Beam Design. 1. LEVEL - Serial number of bar level which may contain one or more bar group. 2. HEIGHT - Height of bar level from the bottom of beam. 3. BAR INFOrmation - Reinforcement bar information specifying number of bars and size. 4. FROM - Distance from the start of the beam to the start of the rebar. 5. TO - Distance from the start of the beam to the end of the rebar. 6. ANCHOR - States whether anchorage, either a hook (STA,END) or continuation, is needed at start (STA) or at the end (END) of the bar.

Design for Shear and Torsion


Design for shear and torsion is performed per the rules of Chapter 11 of CSA Standard A23.3-94. Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Shear design is performed at the start and end sections. The location along the member span for design is chosen as the effective depth + SFACE at the start, and effective depth + EFACE at the end. The load case which gives rise to the highest stirrup area for shear & torsion is chosen as the critical

International Design Codes Manual 159

Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94

one. The calculations are performed assuming 2-legged stirrups will be provided. The additional longitudinal steel area required for torsion is reported. The stirrups are assumed to be U-shaped for beams with no torsion, and closed hoops for beams subjected to torsion. Example of Input Data for Beam Design
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE CANADA FYMAIN 415 ALL FYSEC 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN

3A.7 Column Design


Column design is performed per the rules of Chapters 7 & 8 of the CSA Standard A23.3-94. Columns are designed for axial force and biaxial moments at the ends. All active loadings are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which produces maximum reinforcement is called the critical load. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. For rectangular and square sections, the reinforcement is always assumed to be equally distributed on each side. That means the total number of bars will always be a multiple of four (4). This may cause slightly conservative results in some cases. Example of Input Data for Column Design
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE CANADIAN FYMAIN 415 ALL

160 STAAD.Pro

FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6 END CONCRETE DESIGN

3A.8 Slab/Wall Design


To design a slab or wall, it must be modeled using finite elements. The commands for specifying elements are in accordance with the relevant sections of the Technical Reference Manual. Elements are designed for the moments Mx and My using the same principles as those for beams in flexure. The width of the beam is assumed to be unity for this purpose. These moments are obtained from the element force output (see Section 3.8 of the Technical Reference Manual). The reinforcement required to resist Mx moment is denoted as longitudinal reinforcement and the reinforcement required to resist My moment is denoted as transverse reinforcement. The effective depth is calculated assuming #10 bars are provided. The parameters FYMAIN, FC, CLT, and CLB listed in Table 3A.1 are relevant to slab design. Other parameters mentioned in Table 3A.1 are not applicable to slab design. The output consists only of area of steel required. Actual bar arrangement is not calculated because an element most likely represents just a fraction of the total slab area.
Figure 3.1 - Element moments: Longitudinal (L) and Transverse (T)

Example of Input Data for Slab/Wall Design

International Design Codes Manual 161

Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94

UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE CANADA FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLB 40 ALL DESIGN ELEMENT 15 TO 20 END CONCRETE DESIGN

162 STAAD.Pro

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01


3B.1 General Comments
The design of structural steel members in accordance with the specification CAN/CSA S16-01 Limit States Design of Steel Structures is can be used in STAAD.Pro. This code supercedes the previous edition of the code CAN/CSA S16.1-94. The design philosophy embodied in this specification is based on the concept of limit state design. Structures are designed and proportioned taking into consideration the limit states at which they would become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit-states are recognized - ultimate and serviceability. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability, while that in serviceability is deflection. Appropriate load and resistance factors are used so that a uniform reliability is achieved for all steel structures under various loading conditions and at the same time the probability of limits being surpassed is acceptably low. In the STAAD.Pro implementation, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength, stability and serviceability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria as augmented by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type, or other such parameters. The code checking portion of the program checks whether code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The following sections describe the salient features of the STAAD.Pro implementation of CAN/CSA-S16-01. A detailed description of the design process along with its underlying concepts and assumptions is available in the specification document.

3B.2 Analysis Methodology


The elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the specified primary and combination loading condition. You are allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis or P-Delta analysis may be

International Design Codes Manual 163

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results.

3B.3 Member Property Specifications


For specification of member properties, the steel section library available in STAAD.Pro may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to the STAAD.Pro Technical Reference Manual.

3B.4 Built-in Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered during the analysis of these members. Almost all Canadian steel sections are available for input. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained by using the tools of the graphical user interface. Following is the description of the different types of sections available:

Welded Wide Flanges (WW shapes)


Welded wide flange shapes listed in the CSA steel tables can be designated using the same scheme used by CSA. The following example illustrates the specification of welded wide flange shapes.
100 TO 150 TA ST WW400X444 34 35 TA ST WW900X347

Wide Flanges (W shapes)


Designation of wide flanges in STAAD is the same as that in CSA tables. For example,
10 TO 75 95 TO 105 TA ST W460X106

164 STAAD.Pro

100 TO 200 TA ST W610X101

S, M, HP shapes
In addition to welded wide flanges and regular wide flanges, other I shaped sections like S, M and HP shapes are also available. The designation scheme is identical to that listed in the CSA tables. While specifying the sections, it should be remembered that the portion after the decimal point should be omitted. Thus, M310X17.6 should be specified as M310X17 and S180X22.8 should be specified as S180X22. Examples illustrating specifications of these shapes are provided below.
10 TO 20 BY 2 TA ST S510X98 45 TO 55 TA ST M150X6 88 90 96 TA ST HP310X79

Channel Sections (C & MC shapes)


C and MC shapes are designated as shown in the following example. As in S, M and HP sections, the portion after the decimal point must be omitted in section designations. Thus, MC250X42.4 should be designated as MC250X42.
55 TO 90 TA ST C250X30 30 TO 45 TA ST MC200X33

Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are specified by preceding the section designation by the letter D. For example, a back-to-back double channel section C200X28 without any spacing in between should be specified as:
100 TO 120 TA D C200X28

If a spacing of 2.5 length units is used, the specification should be as follows:


100 TO 120 TA D C200X28 SP 2.5

International Design Codes Manual 165

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

Note that the specification SP after the section designation is used for providing the spacing. The spacing should always be provided in the current length unit.

Angles
To specify angles, the angle name is preceded by the letter L. Thus, a 200X200 angle with a 25mm thickness is designated as L200X200X25. The following examples illustrate angle specifications.
75 TO 95 TA ST L100X100X8 33 34 35 TA ST L200X100X20

Note that the above specification is for standard angles. In this specification, the local z-axis (see Fig. 2.6 in the Technical Reference Manual) corresponds to the YY axis shown in the CSA table. Another common practice of specifying angles assumes the local y-axis to correspond to the Y-Y axis. To specify angles in accordance with this convention, the reverse angle designation facility has been provided. A reverse angle may be specified by substituting the word ST with the word RA. Refer to the following example for details.
10 TO 15 TA RA L55X35X4

The local axis systems for STANDARD and REVERSE angles is shown in Fig. 2.6 of the STAAD Technical Reference manual.

Double Angles
To specify double angles, the specification ST should be substituted with LD (for long leg back-to-back) or SD (short leg back-to-back). For equal angles, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. Spacing between angles may be provided by using the word SP followed by the value of spacing (in current length unit) after section designation.
25 35 45 TA LD L150X100X16 80 TO 90 TA SD L125X75X6 SP 2.5

The second example above describes a double angle section consisting of 125X75X6 angles with a spacing of 2.5 length units.

166 STAAD.Pro

Tees
Tee sections obtained by cutting W sections may be specified by using the T specification instead of ST before the name of the W shape. For example:
100 TO 120 TA T W200X42

will describe a T section cut from a W200X42 section.

Rectangular Hollow Sections


These sections may be specified in two possible ways. Those sections listed in the CSA tables may be specified as follows.
55 TO 75 TA ST TUB80X60X4

In addition, any tube section may be specified by using the DT(for depth), WT(for width), and TH(for thickness) specifications. For example:
100 TO 200 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5

will describe a tube with a depth of 8 in., width of 6 in. and a wall thickness of 0.5 inches. Note that the values of depth, width and thickness must be provided in current length unit.

Circular Hollow Sections


Sections listed in the CSA tables may be provided as follows:

International Design Codes Manual 167

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

15 TO 25 TA ST PIP33X2.5

In addition to sections listed in the CSA tables, circular hollow sections may be specified by using the OD (outside diameter) and ID (inside diameter) specifications. For example:
70 TO 90 TA ST PIPE OD 10.0 ID 9.0

will describe a pipe with an outside diameter of 10 length units and inside diameter of 9.0 length units. Note that the values of outside and inside diameters must be provided in terms of current length unit. Sample input file to demonstrate usage of Canadian shapes
STAAD SPACE UNIT METER KNS JOINT COORD 1 0 0 0 17 160 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2 16 UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTIES CANADIAN *W SHAPES 1 TA ST W250X18 *WW SHAPES 2 TA ST WW700X185 *S SHAPES

168 STAAD.Pro

3 TA ST S200X27 *M SHAPES 4 TA ST M130X28 *HP SHAPES 5 TA ST HP310X132 *MC CHANNELS 6 TA ST MC150X17 *C CHANNELS 7 TA ST C180X18 * DOUBLE CHANNELS 8 TA D C250X37 SP 1.0 *ANGLES 9 TA ST L55X35X5 *REVERSE ANGLES 10 TA RA L90X75X5 *DOUBLE ANGLES, LONG LEG BACK TO BACK 11 TA LD L100X90X6 SP 2.0 *DOUBLE ANGLES, SHORT LEG BACK TO BACK 12 TA SD L125X75X6 SP 2.5 *TUBES 13 TA ST TUB120807 *TUBES 14 TA ST TUBE DT 16.0 WT 8.0 TH 0.8 *PIPES 15 TA ST PIP273X6.3 *PIPES 16 TA ST PIPE OD 16.0 ID 13.0 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH

International Design Codes Manual 169

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

3B.5 Section Classification


The CSA specification allows inelastic deformation of section elements. Thus, local buckling becomes an important criterion. Steel sections are classified as plastic (Class 1), compact (Class 2), noncompact (Class 3), or slender element (Class 4) sections depending upon their local buckling characteristics (See Clause 11.2 and Table 1 of CAN/CSA-S16-01). This classification is a function of the geometric properties of the section. The design procedures are different depending on the section class. STAAD.Pro determines the section classification for the standard shapes and user specified shapes. Note: The design of Class 4 sections requires STAAD.Pro V8i (SELECTseries 2) build 2007.07 or higher. Otherwise, design is performed for sections that fall into the category of Class 1,2 or 3 sections only.

3B.6 Member Resistances


The member resistances are calculated in STAAD.Pro according to the procedures outlined in section 13 of the specification. These depend on several factors such as members unsupported lengths, cross-sectional properties, slenderness factors, unsupported width to thickness ratios and so on. Note that the program automatically takes into consideration appropriate resistance factors to calculate member resistances. Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD.Pro for calculating the member resistances. Note: The design of Class 4 sections requires STAAD.Pro V8i (SELECTseries 2) build 2007.07 or higher.

Nomenclature
A = Area. A = Effective area.
e f

A = Area of flange. A = Area of web.


w

b = Effective Flange width.


e f

C = Compressive force in a member or component under factored load.

170 STAAD.Pro

C = Factored compressive resistance. r C = Warping torsional constant.


w y

C = Axial compressive load at yield stress. D = Outside diameter of pipe section. E = Elastic modulus of steel. F = Elastic critical buckling stress.
e y

F = Yield strength. F = Effective yield stress of section in compression to account for elastic local ye buckling. h = Clear depth of web. K = Effective length factor. L = Length or span of member. M = Bending moment in a member or component under factored load.
f

M = Factored moment resistance of a member.


r

M = Yield moment resistance.


y

S = Elastic section modulus. S = Effective section modulus.


e

W = Web thickness. = Non-dimensional slenderness parameter in column formula. = Effective non-dimensional slenderness parameter in column formula ye considering effective yield stress. = Resistance factor

Axial Tension
The criteria governing the capacity of tension members is based on two limit states. The limit state of yielding in the gross section is intended to prevent excessive elongation of the member. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net section area may be specified by the

International Design Codes Manual 171

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 3B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limits states per Cl.13.2 of CAN/CSA-S16-01. Parameters FYLD, FU, and NSF are applicable for these calculations.

Axial Compression
The compressive resistance of columns is determined based on Clause 13.3 of the code. The equations presented in this section of the code assume that the compressive resistance is a function of the compressive strength of the gross section (Gross section Area times the Yield Strength) as well as the slenderness factor (KL/r ratios). The effective length for the calculation of compression resistance may be provided through the use of the parameters KT, KY, KZ, LT, LY, and LZ (see Table 3B.1). Some of the aspects of the axial compression capacity calculations are : 1. For frame members not subjected to any bending, and for truss members, the axial compression capacity in general column flexural buckling is calculated from Cl.13.3.1 using the slenderness ratios for the local Y-Y and Z-Z axis. The parameters KY, LY, KZ and LZ are applicable for this. 2. For single angles, which are frame members not subjected to any bending or truss members, the axial compression capacity in general column flexural buckling and local buckling of thin legs is calculated using the rules of the AISC - LRFD code, 2nd ed., 1994. The reason for this is that the Canadian code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. The parameters KY, LY, KZ, and LZ are applicable for this. 3. The axial compression capacity is also calculated by taking flexural-torsional buckling into account. The rules of Appendix D, page 1-109 of CAN/CSAS16-01are used for this purpose. Parameters KT and LT may be used to provide the effective length factor and effective length value for flexuraltorsional buckling. Flexural-torsional buckling capacity is computed for single channels, single angles, Tees and Double angles. 4. The variable n in Cl.13.3.1 is assumed as 2.24 for WWF shapes and 1.34 for all other shapes. 5. While computing the general column flexural buckling capacity of sections with axial compression + bending, the special provisions of 13.8.1(a),

172 STAAD.Pro

13.8.1(b) and 13.8.1(c) are applied. For example, Lambda = 0 for 13.8.1(a), K=1 for 13.8.1(b), etc.) For Class 4 members subjected to axial compression, factored compressive resistance should be determined by either of the following equations. a. C = A F (1+2n )-1n
r e y

Where: n = 1.34 = (F /F )
y e

F =(2 E)/(KL/r)2
e

Ae is calculated using reduced element widths meeting the maximum width to thickness ratio specified in Table 1. Effective width required for the calculation of effective area Ae, for different section shapes are as follows.
l

For flanges of I-section, T-section and channel section and legs of angle section b = 200t/((F )
e y

For stem of T-section b = 340t/((F )


e y

For flanges of HSS rectangular or Tube sections b = 670t/((F )


e y

For circular HSS or Pipe section D= 23000t/(F


y 2n )-1n

b. C = AF
r

ye

(1+

ye

Where: n = 1.34
ye e

= (F /F_e )
ye

F =(2 E)/(KL/r)2

International Design Codes Manual 173

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

With an effective yield stress, F , determined from the maximum width (or ye diameter)-to-thickness ratio meeting the limit specified in Table 1. Following are the expressions for effective yield stress for different shaped section.
l

For I-section, T-section, channel section and angle section F = 40000/(b/t)2


ye

For rectangular HSS section F = 448900/(b/t)2


ye

For circular HSS section F = 23000/(D/t)


ye

Bending
The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange for the purpose of computing the factored moment resistance is specified in STAAD with the help of the parameter UNL. If UNL is less than one tenth the member length (member length is the distance between the joints of the member), the member is treated as being continuously laterally supported. In this case, the moment resistance is computed from Clause 13.5 of the code. If UNL is greater than or equal to one tenth the member length, its value is used as the laterally unsupported length. The equations of Clause 13.6 of the code are used to arrive at the moment of resistance of laterally unsupported members. Some of the aspects of the bending capacity calculations are : 1. The weak axis bending capacity of all sections except single angles is calculated as For Class 1 & 2 sections, P For Class 3 sections, S where = Resistance factor = 0.9 P = Plastic section modulus about the local Y axis
y y y

174 STAAD.Pro

S = Elastic section modulus about the local Y axis


y

F = Yield stress of steel


y

2. For single angles, the bending capacities are calculated for the principal axes. The specifications of Section 5, page 6-283 of AISC-LRFD 1994, 2nd ed., are used for this purpose because the Canadian code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. 3. For calculating the bending capacity about the Z-Z axis of singly symmetric shapes such as Tees and Double angles, CAN/CSA-S16-01 stipulates in Clause 13.6(d), page 1-31, that a rational method, such as that given in SSRCs Guide to Stability Design Criteria of Metal Structures, be used. Instead, STAAD uses the rules of Section 2c, page 6-55 of AISC-LRFD 1994, 2nd ed.

Laterally Supported Class 4 members subjected to bending


i. When both the web and compressive flange exceed the limits for Class 3 sections, the member should be considered as failed and an error message will be thrown. ii. When flanges meet the requirements of Class 3 but web exceeds the limits for Class 3, resisting moment shall be determined by the following equation. M_r^'= M_r [1-0.0005 A_w/A_f (h/w-1900/(M_fS)) ] Where Mr = factored moment resistance as determined by Clause 13.5 or 13.6 but not to exceed My = factored moment resistance for Class 3 sections = My If axial compressive force is present in addition to the moment, modified moment resistance should be as follows. M_r^'= M_r [1-0.0005 A_w/A_f (h/w-1900(1-0.65 C_f(C_y ))/(M_fS)) ] Cy = AFy. S = Elastic section modulus of steel section. iii. For sections whose webs meet the requirements of Class 3 and whose flanges exceed the limit of Class 3, the moment resistance shall be calculated as

International Design Codes Manual 175

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

Mr = SeFy Where: Se = effective section modulus determined using effective flange width.
l

For Rectangular HSS section, effective flange width b_e= 670t/(F_y )

For I-section, T-section, Channel section, effective flange width and for Angle section, effective length width b_e= 200t/(F_y ) But shall not exceed 60t.

Laterally Unsupported Class 4 members subjected to bending


As per clause 13.6(b) the moment resistance for class-4 section shall be calculated as follows i. When Mu>0.67My M_r=1.15M_y (1-(0.28M_y)/M_u ) Mr should not exceed SeFy. ii. When Mu<=0.67My M_r=M_u Where, as per clause 13.6(a), M_u=(_2 )/L (EI_y GJ+(E/L)^2 I_y C_w ) For unbraced length subjected to end moments =1.75+1.05k+0.3k^22.5
2

When bending moment at any point within the unbraced length is larger than the larger end moment or when there is no effective lateral support for the compression flange at one of the ends of unsupported length = 1.0
2

176 STAAD.Pro

k = Ratio of the smaller factored moment to the larger moment at opposite ends of the unbraced length, positive for double curvature and negative for single curvature. Se = effective section modulus determined using effective flange width.
l

For Rectangular HSS section, effective flange width b_e= 670t/(F_y )

For I-section, T-section, Channel section, effective flange width and for Angle section, effective length width b_e= 200t/(F_y ) But shall not exceed 60t.

This clause is applicable only for I shaped and Channel shaped section as there is no guide line in the code for other sections.

Axial compression and bending


The member strength for sections subjected to axial compression and uniaxial or biaxial bending is obtained through the use of interaction equations. In these equations, the additional bending caused by the action of the axial load is accounted for by using amplification factors. Clause 13.8 of the code provides the equations for this purpose. If the summation of the left hand side of these equations exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 3B.1), the member is considered to have FAILed under the loading condition.

Axial tension and bending


Members subjected to axial tension and bending are also designed using interaction equations. Clause 13.9 of the code is used to perform these checks. The actual RATIO is determined as the value of the left hand side of the critical equation.

Shear
The shear resistance of the cross section is determined using the equations of Clause 13.4 of the code. Once this is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on

International Design Codes Manual 177

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

the cross section to the shear resistance of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 3B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear. The code also requires that the slenderness ratio of the web be within a certain limit (See Cl.13.4.1.3, page 1-29 of CAN/CSA-S16-01). Checks for safety in shear are performed only if this value is within the allowable limit. Users may by-pass this limitation by specifying a value of 2.0 for the MAIN parameter.

3B.7 Design Parameters


The design parameters outlined in Table 3B.1 may be used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program and thus allow the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 3B.1 - Canadian Steel Design CSA-S16-01 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

178 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name BEAM

Default Value 1.0

Description 0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION command. 1.0 = Perform design for moments at twelfth points along the beam.

CB

1.0

Greater than 0.0 and less than 2.5 : Value of Omega_2 (Cl.13.6) to be used for calculation. Equal to 0.0 : Calculate Omega_2

CMY

1.0

1.0 = Do not calculate Omega1 for local Y axis. 2.0 = Calculate Omega-1 for local Y axis. Used in Cl.13.8.4 of code

CMZ

1.0

1.0 = Do not calculate Omega-

International Design Codes Manual 179

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01 Parameter Name Default Value Description 1 for local Z axis. 2.0 = Calculate Omega-1 for local Z axis. Used in Cl.13.8.4 of code DFF None(Mandatory for deflection check) Deflection Length/Maxm. Allowable local deflection. Joint No. denoting start point for calculation of deflection length Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of deflection length Maximum allowable depth (Applicable for member selection) Minimum required depth (Applicable for member selection) Yield strength of

DJ1

Start Joint of member

DJ2

End Joint of member

DMAX

45.0 in.

DMIN

0.0 in.

FYLD

300.0 MPa

180 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description steel.

FU KT

345.0 MPa 1.0

Ultimate strength of steel. K value for flexural torsional buckling. K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. Length for flexural torsional buckling. Length for general column flexural buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. Length for

KY

1.0

KZ

1.0

LT

Member Length

LY

Member Length

LZ

Member Length

International Design Codes Manual 181

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01 Parameter Name Default Value Description general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. MAIN 0.0 0.0 = Check slenderness ratio against the limits. 1.0= Suppress the slenderness ratio check. 2.0 = Check slenderness ratio only for column buckling, not for web (See Section 3B.6, Shear) NSF 1.0 Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of actual load effect to the design strength. 0.0 = Report only minimum design results. 1.0 = Report design strengths also. 2.0 = Provide

RATIO

1.0

TRACK

0.0

182 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description full details of design.

UNB

Member Length

Unsupported length in bending compression of the bottom flange for calculating moment resistance. Unsupported length in bending compression of the top flange for calculating moment resistance.

UNT

Member Length

3B.8 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to check whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked as per the CAN/CSA-S1601 requirements. Code checking is done using forces and moments at specified sections of the members. If the BEAM parameter for a member is set to 1, moments are calculated at every twelfth point along the beam. When no sections are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero (default), design will be based on member start and end forces only. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from the start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. The extent of detail of the output can be controlled by using the TRACK parameter. Example of commands for CODE CHECKING:

International Design Codes Manual 183

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

UNIT NEWTON METER PARAMETER CODE CANADIAN FYLD 330E6 MEMB 3 4 NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 UNL 15 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 3 4

3B.9 Member Selection


The member selection process basically involves determination of the least weight member that PASSes the code checking procedure based on the forces and moments of the most recent analysis. The section selected will be of the same type as that specified initially. For example, a member specified initially as a channel will have a channel selected for it. Selection of members whose properties are originally provided from a user table will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on TUBES, PIPES or members listed as PRISMATIC. Example of commands for MEMBER SELECTION:
UNIT NEWTON METER PARAMETER FYLD 330E6 MEMB 3 4 NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 UNL 15 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL SELECT MEMB 3 4

184 STAAD.Pro

3B.10 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


Results of code checking and member selection are presented in a tabular format. The term CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the CAN/CSA-S16-01 specification which governed the design. If the TRACK parameter is set to 1.0, factored member resistances will be printed. Following is a description of some of the items printed. CR = Factored compressive resistance TR = Factored tensile resistance VR = Factored shear resistance MRZ = Factored moment resistance (about z-axis) MRY = Factored moment resistance (about y-axis) Further details can be obtained by setting TRACK to 2.0. CR1 = CAPACITY (C ) PER 13.8.2(a)
r r

CR2 = CAPACITY (C ) PER 13.8.2(b) CRZ = SEE 13.8.2(b) for uniaxial bending (called C CTORFLX = Capacity in accordance with 13.8.2(c)
RX

in that Clause)

3B.11 Verification Problems


In the next few pages are included several verification examples for reference purposes. Since the S16-01 code is similar in many respects to the previous edition of the code (CAN/CSA S16.1-94), the solved examples of the 1994 edition of the CISC Handbook have been used as reference material for these examples.

Verification Problem No. 1


Title
Steel beam with uniform load, wide flange section

Type
Static analysis, 3D beam element. International Design Codes Manual 185

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

Reference
CAN/CSA-S16.1-94, National Standard of Canada, Limit States Design of Steel Structures. The Canadian Standards Association, 1994 with CISC (Canadian Institute of Steel Construction) handbook. CISC Example 1 page 5_91.

Problem
Find the interaction ratio, beam resistance and beam deflection.

Given
E = 200000 MPa (STEEL) F = 300 Mpa CSA G40.21-M
y

Simply supported beam has a 8.0 m span; Ky is 1.0, Kz 1.0, unsupported length 1.0 m Allowable Live Load deflection, L/300 = 8000/300 = 27 mm Factored Uniform Load IS 7 kN/m DEAD, 15 kN/m LIVE. Steel section is W410X54

Comparison
Table 3B.2 - CAN/CSA-S16 Verification Problem comparison Source Interaction Beam Beam Ratio Resistance Deflection (kN*m) (mm) 0.88 0.883 284 283.20 21 20.81

Reference STAAD.Pro

**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO *

186 STAAD.Pro

* VERSION BLD * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * RESEARCH ENGINEERS, INTL. * * DATE= * * TIME= * * * * USER ID: * **************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 5-91 3. * CISC EXAMPLE 1 PAGE 5-91, LIMIT STATES DESIGN, CSA-S16.1-94 4. * SIMPLY SUPPORTED BEAM WITH UNIFORM LOAD 5. * LIVE LOAD DEFLECTION OF L/300 7. UNIT MMS KN 8. JOINT COORDINATES 9. 1 0 0 0; 2 8000 0 0 10. MEMBER INCIDENCES 11. 1 1 2 13. MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 14. 1 TABLE ST W410X54 16. CONSTANTS 17. E STEEL ALL 18. POISSON 0.3 ALL 20. SUPPORTS 21. 1 PINNED 22. 2 FIXED BUT MY MZ 24. UNIT METER KN 25. LOAD 1 DEAD 26. MEMBER LOAD 27. 1 UNI GY -7 29. LOAD 2 LIVE 30. MEMBER LOAD 31. 1 UNI GY -15 33. LOAD COMB 3 1.25DL + 1.5 LL 34. 1 1.25 2 1.5 36. PERFORM ANALYSIS P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 2/ 1/ 2 ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 1/ 1/ 5 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 2, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 5 SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 1 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.0/ 19641.6 MB 37. LOAD LIST 2 38. PRINT SECTION DISPLACEMENTS MEMBER SECTION DISPLACEMENTS

International Design Codes Manual 187

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

---------------------------UNIT =INCHES FOR FPS AND CM FOR METRICS/SI SYSTEM MEMB LOAD GLOBAL X,Y,Z DISPL FROM START TO END JOINTS AT 1/12TH PTS 1 2 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 -0.5471 0.0000 0.0000 -1.0528 0.0000 0.0000 -1.4824 0.0000 0.0000 -1.8086 0.0000 0.0000 -2.0120 0.0000 0.0000 -2.0812 0.0000 0.0000 -2.0120 0.0000 0.0000 -1.8086 0.0000 0.0000 -1.4824 0.0000 0.0000 -1.0528 0.0000 0.0000 -0.5471 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 MAX LOCAL DISP = 2.08115 AT 400.00 LOAD 2 L/DISP= 384 ************ END OF SECT DISPL RESULTS *********** 40. LOAD LIST 3 41. PARAMETER 42. CODE CANADIAN 43. TRACK 2 ALL 44. UNL 1 ALL 45. FYLD 300000 ALL 46. BEAM 1 ALL 47. CHECK CODE ALL STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (CAN/CSAS16-01) ****************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST W410X54 (CANADIAN SECTIONS) PASS CSA-13.8.2+ 0.883 3 0.00 C 0.00 250.00 4.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 6.84E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 8.00E+02 IZ = 1.86E+04 SZ = 9.26E+02 PZ = 1.05E+03 IY = 1.02E+03 SY = 1.15E+02 PY = 1.77E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 1.846E+03 CR2 = 2.732E+02 CRZ = 1.570E+03 CTORFLX = 2.732E+02

188 STAAD.Pro

TENSILE CAPACITY = 1.805E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 2.732E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 4.778E+01 MRZ = 2.832E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 5.379E+02 VRZ = 4.604E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 207.170 KL/RZ = 48.447 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 1.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 0.000E+00 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 5.08E+01 48. STEEL TAKE OFF ALL STEEL TAKE-OFF -------------PROFILE LENGTH(METE) WEIGHT(KN ) IN STEEL TAKEOFF THE DENSITY OF STEEL IS ASSUMED FOR MEMBERS WITH NO DENSITY. ST W410X54 8.00 4.203 PRISMATIC STEEL 0.00 0.000 ---------------TOTAL = 4.203 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 49. FINISH

Verification Problem No. 2


Title
Steel beam/column, wide flange section.

Type
Static Analysis, 3D beam element.

Reference
CAN/CSA-S16.1-94, National Standard of Canada, Limit States Design of Steel Structures. The Canadian Standards Association, 1994 with CISC (Canadian Institute of Steel Construction) handbook. CISC Handbook Example, Page 4_106.

International Design Codes Manual 189

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

Problem
Find the interaction ratio, beam and column resistance.

Given
E = 200000 MPa (STEEL). F = 300 MPa CSA G40.21-M
y

Simply supported beam/column has a 3.7 m span, Ky is 1.0, Kz 1.0 factored axial load is 2000 kN and end moments of 200 kN*m and 300 kN*m Steel section is W310X129

Comparison
CAN/CSAS16 Interaction Ratio Beam Resistance (kN*m) REFERENCE STAAD.Pro 0.96 0.98 583 584 Column Resistance (kN) 3800 3820

**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO * * VERSION BLD * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * RESEARCH ENGINEERS, INTL. * * DATE= * * TIME= * * *

190 STAAD.Pro

* USER ID: * **************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 4-106 2. * 3. * COMPRESSION + MAJOR AXIS BENDING 4. * 5. UNIT METER KN 6. JOINT COORDINATES 7. 1 0 0 0; 2 0 3.7 0 8. * 9. MEMBER INCIDENCES 10. 1 1 2 11. * 12. MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 13. 1 TABLE ST W310X129 14. * 15. CONSTANTS 16. E STEEL ALL 17. POISSON STEEL ALL 18. * 19. SUPPORTS 20. 1 FIXED BUT MX MZ 21. 2 FIXED BUT FY MY MZ 22. * 23. LOAD 1 FACTORED LOAD 24. JOINT LOAD 25. 2 FY -2000 26. 2 MZ 200 27. 1 MZ 300 28. * 29. PDELTA 3 ANALYSIS P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 2/ 1/ 2 ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 1/ 1/ 5 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 5 SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 1 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.0/ 19641.2 MB ++ ADJUSTING DISPLACEMENTS 8:54:35 ++ ADJUSTING DISPLACEMENTS 8:54:35 ++ ADJUSTING DISPLACEMENTS 8:54:35 31. PRINT MEMBER FORCES MEMBER END FORCES STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE ----------------ALL UNITS ARE -- KN METE MEMBER LOAD JT AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z TORSION MOM-Y MOM-Z

International Design Codes Manual 191

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

1 1 1 2000.00 135.14 0.00 0.00 0.00 300.00 2 -2000.00 -135.14 0.00 0.00 0.00 200.00 ************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** 33. PARAMETER 34. CODE CANADIAN 35. TRACK 2 ALL 36. FYLD 300000 ALL 37. LY 3.7 ALL 38. LZ 3.7 ALL 39. CHECK CODE ALL STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (CAN/CSAS16-01) ****************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST W310X129 (CANADIAN SECTIONS) PASS CSA-13.8.2C 0.980 1 2000.00 C 0.00 300.00 0.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 1.65E+02 MEMBER LENGTH = 3.70E+02 IZ = 3.08E+04 SZ = 1.94E+03 PZ = 2.16E+03 IY = 1.00E+04 SY = 6.51E+02 PY = 9.90E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 4.459E+03 CR2 = 3.820E+03 CRZ = 4.296E+03 CTORFLX = 3.820E+03 TENSILE CAPACITY = 4.359E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 3.820E+03 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 2.672E+02 MRZ = 5.840E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 7.419E+02 VRZ = 1.505E+03 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 47.477 KL/RZ = 27.094 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 3.700 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00

192 STAAD.Pro

SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 1.351E+02 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 2.12E+01 40. STEEL MEMBER TAKE OFF ALL STEEL TAKE-OFF -------------PROFILE LENGTH(METE) WEIGHT(KN ) IN STEEL TAKEOFF THE DENSITY OF STEEL IS ASSUMED FOR MEMBERS WITH NO DENSITY. ST W310X129 3.70 4.694 PRISMATIC STEEL 0.00 0.000 ---------------TOTAL = 4.694 MEMBER PROFILE LENGTH WEIGHT (METE) (KN ) 1 ST W310X129 3.70 4.694 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 42. FINISH

Verification Problem No. 3


Title
Steel beam/column, wide flange section.

Type
Static Analysis, 3D beam element.

Reference
CAN/CSA-S16.1-94, National Standard of Canada, Limit States Design of Steel Structures. The Canadian Standards Association, 1994 with CISC (Canadian Institute of Steel Construction) handbook. CISC Handbook Example, Page 4_108.

Problem
Find the interaction ratio, beam and column resistance.

Given
E = 200000 MPa (STEEL).

International Design Codes Manual 193

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

F = 300 MPa CSA G40.21-M


y

Simply supported beam/column has a 3.7 m span, Ky is 1.0, Kz 1.0, Lu = 3.7 m factored axial load is 2000 kN and end moments of 200 kN*m and 300 kN*m in the strong axis and 100 kN*m at each end in the weak axis. Steel section is W310X143.

Comparison
CAN/CSA-S16 Interaction Ratio Beam Resistance Column Resistance (kN*m) (kN)

Weak REFERENCE STAAD.Pro 0.998 1.00 300 299

Strong 630 650 4200 4222

**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO * * VERSION BLD * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * RESEARCH ENGINEERS, INTL. * * DATE= * * TIME= * * * * USER ID: * **************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 4-108

194 STAAD.Pro

* * ( COMPRESSION + BIAXIAL BENDING ) * UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 3.7 0 * MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2 * MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 1 TABLE ST W310X143 * CONSTANTS E STEEL ALL POISSON STEEL ALL * SUPPORTS 1 FIXED BUT MX MZ 2 FIXED BUT FY MX MY MZ * LOAD 1 FACTORED LOAD JOINT LOAD 2 FY -2000 2 MZ 200 2 MX 100 1 MZ 300 1 MX 100 * PERFORM ANALYSIS P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 2/ 1/ 2 ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 1/ 1/ 6 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 6 SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 1 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.0/ 19641.2 MB 33. PARAMETER 34. CODE CANADIAN 35. CMY 2 ALL 36. CMZ 2 ALL 37. CB 1 ALL 38. TRACK 2 ALL 39. FYLD 300000 ALL 40. CHECK CODE ALL STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (CAN/CSAS16-01) ****************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION

2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31.

International Design Codes Manual 195

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

======================================================================= * 1 ST W310X143 (CANADIAN SECTIONS) FAIL CSA-13.8.2A 1.000 1 2000.00 C -100.00 300.00 0.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 1.82E+02 MEMBER LENGTH = 3.70E+02 IZ = 3.47E+04 SZ = 2.15E+03 PZ = 2.41E+03 IY = 1.12E+04 SY = 7.28E+02 PY = 1.11E+03 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 4.912E+03 CR2 = 4.222E+03 CRZ = 4.737E+03 CTORFLX = 4.222E+03 TENSILE CAPACITY = 4.802E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 4.912E+03 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 2.987E+02 MRZ = 6.504E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 8.037E+02 VRZ = 1.678E+03 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 47.077 KL/RZ = 26.802 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 3.700 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 0.40 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 0.40 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 1.351E+02 Z AXIS = 5.405E+01 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 1.98E+01 41. STEEL MEMBER TAKE OFF ALL STEEL TAKE-OFF -------------PROFILE LENGTH(METE) WEIGHT(KN ) IN STEEL TAKEOFF THE DENSITY OF STEEL IS ASSUMED FOR MEMBERS WITH NO DENSITY. ST W310X143 3.70 5.171 PRISMATIC STEEL 0.00 0.000 ---------------TOTAL = 5.171 MEMBER PROFILE LENGTH WEIGHT (METE) (KN ) 1 ST W310X143 3.70 5.171 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 42. FINISH

196 STAAD.Pro

Verification Problem No. 4


Title
A slender, cantilever beam subjected to a uniform load

Type
Static analysis, 3D beam element.

Reference
CISC Example 1, page 5-91, Limit State Design, CSA-S16.1-94

Problem
A cantilever beam of length 4 meter is subjected to uniformly distributed load of 3 KN/Meter in both major and minor axis. Axial compression of 8 KN is also applied to the member. User defined steel section Sect_Class-4 from is assigned to the member.

Given
Design forces 8.0 KN (Compression) 6.0 KNm (Bending-Y) 6.0 KNm (Bending-Z) 6.0 KN (Shear-Y) 6.0 KN (Shear-Z) Section Properties(Sect_Class-4): Area = 2766 mm2 Depth of section, D = 150 mm Thickness of web Tw = 7 mm

International Design Codes Manual 197

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

Width of flange Bf = 150 mm Thickness of flange Tf = 6 mm Moment of inertia about Z axis, Iz = 1086.96X104 mm4 Moment of inertia about Y axis, Iy = 337.894X104 mm4 Moment of inertia about X axis, Ix = 3.7378X104 mm4 Warping constant, Cw = 1.752X1010 mm6 Member Length L = 2 m, Unbraced length = 100mm. Material FYLD = 300 MPa E = 2.05E+05 MPa G = E/2.6 MPa

Solution

Slenderness Ratio
Effective Length factor along Local Y-Axis = KY = 1 Effective Length factor along Local Z-Axis = KZ = 1 Slenderness ratio about Z axis, L/Rz = 31.9 Slenderness ratio about Y axis, L/Ry = 57.22 Maximum Slenderness Ratio, L/Rmax = 57.22

Section Classification
Bf/Tf = 150*0.5/6 = 12.5 > 200/sqrt(Fy) = 11.54 Flange is Class 4. d/Tw = (150-2.0*6)/7 = 19.714 (1100/sqrt(Fy))*(1-0.39*Cf/*Cy)=(1100/sqrt(300))*(10.39*8000/(0.9*2766*300)) = 63.24 Web is Class 1.

198 STAAD.Pro

Overall section is Class 4 section.

Check against axial compression (Clause 13.3.3)


Effective width, Beff = 200*Tf/sqrt(300) = 69.24 Effective area, Aeff = 69.24*6*4+(150-2*6)*7 = 2627.76 mm4. Effective yield stress, FYLDeff =40000/( 0.5*Bf/Tf)4 =256 MPa. As per Clause 13.3.3(a), Elastic critical buckling, Fe = 4*E/ L_Rmax4 = 617.956 MPa. Non-dimensional slenderness ratio, = sqrt(FYLD/Fe) =0.697 Axial compressive resistance, Cr = *Aeff*FYLD*(1+0.697^(2*1.34))^(-1/1.34) = 557886.104 N. As per Clause 13.3.3(b), Elastic critical buckling, Fe = 4*E/ L_Rmax4 = 617.956 MPa. Effective non-dimensional slenderness ratio, eff = sqrt(FYLDeff/Fe) = 0.644 Axial compressive resistance, Cr = *Area*FYLDeff*(1+0.644^(2*1.34))^(1/1.34) = 521726.94 N. Axial compressive resistance Min(557886.104, 521726.94) = 521726.94 N.

Check against bending (Clause 13.5(c))


As the web of the section meets the requirement of Class 3 and flange exceeds Class 3 limit, flexural resistance should be calculated as per clause 13.5(c).iii. Effective moment of inertia about Z axis, Izeff =2*(2*69.24*63)/12 + 2*(2*69.24*6)*(150-6)*(150-6)/4 + (7*(150-2*6)3)/12 =10152591.12 mm4. Effective section modulus about Z axis, Szeff = 10152591.12*2/150 = 135367.88 mm3. Effective moment of inertia about Y axis, Iyeff =(2*6*(2*69.24)3)/12 +(0.5*(150-6)*73)/12 =2657648.856

International Design Codes Manual 199

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01 mm4. Effective section modulus about Y axis, Syeff = 2657648.856/69.24 = 38383.144 mm3. Major axis bending resistance if member is laterally supported, Mrz1 = *Szeff*FYLD= 0.9*135367.88*300 =36549327.6 N-mm. Minor axis bending resistance, Mry = *Syeff*FYLD = 0.9*38383.144*300 = 10363448.88 N-mm. If the member is laterally unsupported major axis bending resistance is determined by clause 13.6(b). As the value of one of the end moments is 0.0, 2 = 1.75. Where, as per clause 13.6(a), Mu = (1.75*3.14/2000)*sqrt(205000*337.894X10 4*78846.154*3.7378X104 + (3.14*205000/2000)4*337.894X104*1.752X10^10) =2.48X108 My = Sz*FYLD = (1086.96X104X2/150) *300 =43478400. Since Mu > 0.65My, Moment of resistance Mrz2 = 1.15*0.9*43478400*(1-0.28*43478400/2.48X108) =42791153.71 N-mm = 42.79 KN-m. Mrz2 should not be more than Mrz1. Since, Mrz2 > Mrz1 in this example, Mrz2 = Mrz1. Mrz2 = 36549327.6 N-mm = 36.549 KN-m

200 STAAD.Pro

Comparison
Hand Calculation Axial compressive resistance Major axis bending resistance Minor axis bending resistance 521.73 KN 36.549KNm 10.363 KNm STAAD.Pro Result 5.219X102 KN Comments

Negligible difference.

36.57 KN-m Negligible difference. 10.38 KN-m Negligible difference.

**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO V8I SELECTSERIES2 * * VERSION 20.07.07.XX * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * BENTLEY SYSTEMS, INC. * * DATE= AUG 17, 2010 * * TIME= 17: 6:23 * * * * USER ID: BENTLEY * ****************************************************

1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 5-91 INPUT FILE: S-16-01 VERIFICATION EXAMPLE.STD 2. START JOB INFORMATION 3. ENGINEER DATE 16-FEB-10 4. END JOB INFORMATION 5. * CISC EXAMPLE 1 PAGE 5-91, LIMIT STATES DESIGN, CSA-S16.1-94 6. * SIMPLY SUPPORTED BEAM WITH UNIFORM LOAD 7. * LIVE LOAD DEFLECTION OF L/300 8. UNIT MMS KN 9. JOINT COORDINATES 10. 1 0 0 0; 2 2000 0 0 11. MEMBER INCIDENCES

International Design Codes Manual 201

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

12. 1 1 2 13. START USER TABLE 14. TABLE 1 15. UNIT METER KN 16. WIDE FLANGE 17. SECT_CLASS-4 18. 0.002766 0.15 0.007 0.15 0.006 1.08696E-005 3.37894E-006 3.7378E-008 19. 0.00105 0.0018 20. END 21. UNIT METER KN 22. DEFINE MATERIAL START 23. ISOTROPIC MATERIAL1 24. E 2.05E+008 25. POISSON 0.3 26. ISOTROPIC STEEL 27. E 2.05E+008 28. POISSON 0.3 29. DENSITY 76.8195 30. ALPHA 1.2E-005 31. DAMP 0.03 32. END DEFINE MATERIAL 33. MEMBER PROPERTY 34. 1 UPTABLE 1 SECT_CLASS-4 35. UNIT MMS KN 36. CONSTANTS 37. MATERIAL STEEL ALL 38. SUPPORTS 39. 1 FIXED 40. UNIT METER KN 41. LOAD 1 LC1 42. MEMBER LOAD 43. 1 UNI GY -3 44. 1 UNI GZ -3 45. JOINT LOAD 46. 2 FX -8 47. PERFORM ANALYSIS

P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 1 2/

1/

SOLVER USED IS THE IN-CORE ADVANCED SOLVER TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = DOM = 6 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREE-

48. LOAD LIST 1 49. PRINT MEMBER FORCES LIST 1 VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 5-91 -- PAGE NO. 3

202 STAAD.Pro

MEMBER END FORCES ----------------ALL UNITS ARE -- KN MEMBER MOM-Y LOAD JT MOM-Z

STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE METE AXIAL (LOCAL ) SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z TORSION

1 -6.00 0.00

1 6.00 2 0.00

8.00 -8.00

6.00 0.00

6.00 0.00

0.00 0.00

************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT **************

50. 51. 52. 53. 54. 55.

PARAMETER 1 CODE CANADIAN CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (CAN/CSAS16-01 ) V2.0

********************************************

ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE LOADING/ LOCATION

MET

(UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) CRITICAL COND/ MY RATIO/ MZ

RESULT/ FX

=======================================================================

1 ST 1

SECT_CLASS-4 PASS 8.00 C

(UPT) CSA-13.8.3B -6.00

0.760 6.00

0.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 2.77E+01 2.00E+02 IZ = 1.09E+03 SZ = 1.45E+02 IY = 3.38E+02 SY = 4.51E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = PZ = PY = 1.63E+02 6.92E+01

International Design Codes Manual 203

Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01

IX =

3.74E+00

CW =

1.75E+04

EFFECTIVE MEMBER PROPERTIES FOR CLASS-4 SECTION(UNIT = CM) --------------------------------------------------------EFFECTIVE CROSS SECTION AREA = 2.63E+01 EFFECTIVE IZ = 1.02E+03 EFFECTIVE SZ = EFFECTIVE IY = 2.66E+02 EFFECTIVE SY = EFFECTIVE YILED STRESS = 256.0 MPA

1.35E+02 3.85E+01

COMPRESSIVE CAPACITIES FOR CLASS 4 SECTION(UNIT = MPA) -----------------------------------------------------BASED ON EFFECTIVE AREA CR1 = 7.098E+02 CR2 = CTORFLX = 5.582E+02

5.582E+02

CRZ =

6.705E+02

BASED ON EFFECTIVE YIELD STRENGTH CR1 = 6.373E+02 CR2 = 5.219E+02 CTORFLX = 5.219E+02

CRZ =

6.084E+02

MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 7.88E+04 FU = 345.0 E = 2.05E+05 G =

SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 6.373E+02 CR2 = 5.219E+02 SECTION CLASS 4 CRZ = 6.084E+02 CTORFLX = 5.219E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 7.300E+02 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 5.219E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 1.038E+01 MRZ = 3.657E+01 MU = 2.486E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 1.871E+02 VRZ = 3.208E+02

MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 57.222 KL/RZ = 31.904 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 2.000

204 STAAD.Pro

OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.75 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 6.000E+00 Z AXIS = 6.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 1.97E+01 56. FINISH

*********** END OF THE STAAD.PRO RUN *********** **** DATE= AUG 17,2010 TIME= 17: 6:28 ****

************************************************************ * FOR QUESTIONS ON STAAD.PRO, PLEASE CONTACT * * BENTLEY SYSTEMS OFFICES AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS * * * * TELEPHONE WEB / EMAIL * * * * USA: +1 (714)974-2500 * * UK +44(1454)207-000 * * SINGAPORE +65 6225-6158 * * EUROPE +31 23 5560560 * * INDIA +91(033)4006-2021 * * JAPAN +81(03)5952-6500 HTTP://WWW.CTCG.CO.JP * * CHINA +86 10 5929 7000 * * THAILAND +66(0)2645-1018/19 PARTHA.P@REISOFTWARETH.COM * * * * WORLDWIDE HTTP://SELECTSERVICES.BENTLEY.COM/EN-US/ * * * ************************************************************

International Design Codes Manual 205

206 STAAD.Pro

Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94
3C.1 General
Provisions of CSA S136-94, including revisions dated May, 1995, have been implemented. The program allows design of single (non-composite) members in tension, compression, bending, shear, as well as their combinations. For laterally supported members in bending, the Initiation of Yielding method has been used. Cold work of forming strengthening effects have been included as an option.

3C.2 Cross-Sectional Properties


The user specifies the geometry of the cross-section by selecting one of the section shape designations from the Gross Section Property Tables published in the "ColdFormed Steel Design Manual", AISI, 1996 Edition. The Tables are currently available for the following shapes:
l

Channel with Lips Channel without Lips Angle with Lips Angle without Lips Z with Lips Z without Lips Hat

Shape selection may be done using the member property pages of the graphical user interface (GUI) or by specifying the section designation symbol in the input file. The properties listed in the tables are gross section properties. STAAD.Pro uses unreduced section properties in the structure analysis stage. Both unreduced and effective section properties are used in the design stage, as applicable.

3C.3 Design Procedure


The following two design modes are available:

International Design Codes Manual 207

Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94

a. Code Checking The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with CSA 136. Code checking is carried out for locations specified via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. You may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. b. Member Selection You may request that the program search the cold formed steel shapes database (AISI standard sections) for alternative members that pass the code check and meet the least weight criterion. In addition, a minimum and/or maximum acceptable depth of the member may be specified. The program will then evaluate all database sections of the type initially specified (i.e., channel, angle, etc.) and, if a suitable replacement is found, present design results for that section. If no section satisfying the depth restrictions or lighter than the initial one can be found, the program leaves the member unchanged, regardless of whether it passes the code check or not. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. The program calculates effective section properties in accordance with Clauses 5.6.2.1 through 3 and 5.6.2.6 through 8. Cross-sectional properties and overall slenderness of members are checked for compliance with
l

Clause 5.3, Maximum Effective Slenderness Ratio for members in Compression Clause 5.4, Maximum Flat Width Ratios for Elements in Compression Clause 5.5, Maximum Section Depths.

The program will check member strength in accordance with Clause 6 of the Standard as follows:

208 STAAD.Pro

Resistance factors listed in Clauses 6.2 (a), (b), and (e) are used, as applicable. Members in tension - Resistance is calculated in accordance with Clauses 6.3.1 and 6.3.2. Members in bending and shear

Resistance calculations are based on Clauses:


l

6.4.1 General, 6.4.2 and 6.4.2.1 Laterally Supported Members, compressive limit stress based on Initiation of Yielding, 6.4.3 Laterally Unsupported Members, 6.4.4 Channels and Z-Shaped Members with Unstiffened Flanges - additional limitations, 6.4.5 Shear in Webs, 6.4.6 Combined Bending and Shear in Webs. Members in compression Resistance calculations are based on Clauses:
o o o o o

6.6.1.1, 6.6.1.2 (a) and (d), and 6.6.1.3 General, 6.6.2 Sections Not Subject to Torsional-Flexural Buckling, 6.6.3 Singly Symmetric Sections, 6.6.4 Point-Symmetric Sections, 6.6.5 Cylindrical Tubular Sections.

Members in compression and bending Resistance calculations are based on Clause 6.7.1, Singly and Doubly Symmetric Sections. Input for the coefficients of uniform bending must be provided.

3C.4 Design Parameters


The following table contains the input parameters for specifying values of design variables and selection of design options.

International Design Codes Manual 209

Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94

Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 3C.1 - Canadian Cold Formed Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified S136. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

1.0

When this parameter is set to 1.0 (default), the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member. If the BEAM value is 0.0, the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details). If neither the BEAM parameter nor any SECTION command is specified, STAAD will terminate the run and ask the user to provide one of those 2 commands. This rule is not enforced for TRUSS members. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending W . See CSA 136, 6.7.2. z Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0.

CMZ

1.0

210 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name CMY

Default Value 0.0

Description

Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending W . See CSA 136, 6.7.2. y Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. Specifies whether the cold work of forming strengthening effect should be included in resistance computation. See CSA 136, 5.2. 0. effect should not be included 1. effect should be included

CWY

DMAX

1000.0

Maximum depth permissible for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Minimum depth required for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Specifies whether torsionalflexural buckling restraint is provided or is not necessary for the member. See CSA 136, 6.6.2 0. Section subject to torsional flexural buckling and restraint not provided 1. restraint provided or unnecessary

DMIN

0.0

FLX

FU FYLD

450 MPa 350 MPa

Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. Yield strength of steel in current units.

International Design Codes Manual 211

Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94 Parameter Name KT Default Value 1.0 Description

Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall column buckling about the local Yaxis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression.

KY

1.0

KZ

1.0

LT

Member length

212 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name LY

Default Value Member length

Description

Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Net section factor for tension members, See CSA 136, 6.3.1. Spacing in the longitudinal direction of shear stiffeners for stiffened flat webs. It is input in the current units of length. See section CSA 136, 6.4.5

LZ

Member length

NSF STIFF

1.0 Member length

International Design Codes Manual 213

Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94 Parameter Name TRACK 0 Default Value Description

This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 0. Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 1. Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 1 2. Prints member and material properties in addition to that printed by TRACK 2.

TSA

Specifies whether bearing and intermediate transverse stiffeners satisfy the requirements of CSA 136, 6.5. If true, the program uses the more liberal set of interaction equations in 6.4.6. 0. stiffeners do not comply with 6.5 1. stiffeners comply with 6.5

214 STAAD.Pro

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01


3D.1 General Comments
The Canadian Wood Design facility in STAAD is based on CSA086-01. A timber section library consisting of Sawn and Glulam timber is available for member property specification. The design philosophy of this specification is based on the concept of limit state design. Structures are designed and proportioned taking into consideration the limit states at which they would become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit-state are recognized - ultimate and serviceability. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability, while that in serviceability is deflection. Appropriate load and resistance factors are used so that a uniform reliability is achieved for the entire structure under various loading conditions and at the same time the chances of limits being surpassed are acceptably remote. In the STAAD implementation, the code checking portion of the program checks whether code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The following sections describe the salient features of the STAAD implementation of CSA086-01. A detailed description of the design process along with its underlying concepts and assumptions is available in the specification document.

3D.2 Analysis Methodology


Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations.

3D.3 Member Property Specifications


For specification of member properties, for Sawn timber the timber section library available in STAAD may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in timber table. For Glulam timber, member properties can be specified using the YD (depth) and ZD (width) specifications and selecting Combination and Species specifications

International Design Codes Manual 215

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

from the built-in table. The assignment is done with the help of the PRISMATIC option (Refer to Section 5.20 of the Technical Reference Manual)

3D.4 Built-in Timber Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in timber tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Following are the description of the different types of species combination available:

Douglas Fir-Larch
The following example illustrates the specification of Douglas Fir-Larch species combination.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST DFL_SELSTR_2X2_BM

Hem-Fir
Designation of Hem-Fir species combination in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST HEM-FIR_SELSTR_2X10_BM

Northern Species
Designation of Northern species combination in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST NORTHERN_SELSTR_3X12_BM

216 STAAD.Pro

Spruce-Pine-Fir
Designation of Spruce-Pine-Fir species combination in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST SPF_SELSTR_3X8_BM

Glu Laminated timber


Designation of Glu-lam timber in STAAD involves defining the material, specifying the dimensions, and associating the material with the member through the CONSTANTS command.
UNIT CM KN DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT_D.FIR-L-24F-EX E 51611.7 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 2.5E-005 ALPHA 1.2E-011 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 PRIS YD 12 ZD 6 CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT_D.FIR-L-24F-EX MEMB 1

Sample input file to demonstrate usage of Canadian timber


STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER

International Design Codes Manual 217

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

UNIT FEET POUND JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 6 0 0; 3 12 0 0; 4 18 0 0; 5 24 0 0; 6 6 3 0; 7 12 6 0; 8 18 3 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; 2 2 3; 3 3 4; 4 4 5; 5 1 6; 6 6 7; 7 7 8; 8 8 5; 9 2 6; 10 3 7; 11 4 8; 12 6 3; 13 3 8; UNIT FEET POUND DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM E 1224 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY TIM CAN 1 TO 4 9 TO 11 TABLE ST SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM 5 TO 8 12 13 TABLE ST SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM CONSTANTS MATERIAL SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM MEMB 1 TO 4 9 TO 11 MATERIAL SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM MEMB 5 TO 8 12 13 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH

3D.5 Member Resistance


The member resistances are calculated in STAAD according to the procedures outlined in section 5 (for sawn lumber) and 6 (for Glulam) of CSA086-01. These depend on several adjustment factors as follows:

218 STAAD.Pro

a. KD = Load duration factor (Clause 4.3.2.2-CSA086-01, Table 4.3.2.2) b. KH = System factor(Clause 5.4.4 and 6.4.3 and Table 5.4.4 -CSA086-01) c. K_T = Treatment factor(Clause 5.4.3 and 6.4.4 -CSA086-01) d. KSB = Service condition factor applicable to Bending at extreme fibre (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 -CSA086-01) e. KSV = Service condition factor applicable to longitudinal shear (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) f. KSC = Service condition factor applicable to Compression parallel to the grain (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) g. K_SCP = Service condition factor applicable to Compression perpendicular to the grain (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) h. KSE = Service condition factor applicable to modulus of elasticity (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) i. KST = Service condition factor applicable to tension parallel to the grain (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) j. KZB = Size factor applicable to bending (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 CSA086-01) k. KZV = size factor applicable to shear(Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA08601) l. KZT = size factor applicable to tension parallel to grain (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA086-01) m. KZCP = size factor applicable to compression perpendicular to grain (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA086-01) n. K_ZC = size factor applicable to compression parallel to grain (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA086-01) o. CHIX = Curvature factor (Clause 6.5.6.5.2-CSA086-01) p. CV = shear load coefficient (Table 6.5.7.4A- CSA086-01) q. KN = Notch factor(Clause 5.5.5.4-CSA086-01) All of these factors must be specified as input according to the classification of timber and stress grade.

International Design Codes Manual 219

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating the member resistances.

Axial Tension
i. For Sawn timber The criterion governing the capacity of tension members is based on one limit state. The limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net section area may be specified by the user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 3B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on this limit state per Clause 5.5.9 of CSA08601. ii. For Glulam timber The design of glulam tension members differs from sawn timber since CSA 086-01 assigns different specified strength for gross and net section. The specified strength at net section is slightly higher than the strength of the gross section. Therefore, Glulam tension members are designed based on two limit states. The first one is the limit state of yielding in the gross section. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net-section area may be specified by the user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 3B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limits states per Clause.6.5.11 of CSA086-01.

Axial Compression
The compressive resistance of columns is determined based on Clause.5.5.6 and Clause.6.5.8.4 of CSA086-01. The equations presented in this section of the code assume that the compressive resistance is a function of the compressive strength of the gross section (Gross section Area times the Yield Strength) as well as the slenderness factor (Kc). The effective length for the calculation of compression resistance may be provided through the use of the parameters KX, KY, KZ, LX, LY and LZ (see Table 3B.1).

220 STAAD.Pro

Bending
The bending resistance of Sawn members are determined based on Clause 5.5.4 of CSA086-01 and for glulam members are determined based on Clause 6.5.6.5 of CSA086-01. The allowable stress in bending is multiplied by Lateral stability factor, KL to take in account whether lateral support is provided at points of bearing to prevent lateral displacement and rotation

Axial compression and bending


The member strength for sections subjected to axial compression and uni-axial or biaxial bending is obtained through the use of interaction equations. Clause 5.5.10 and 6.5.12 of the code provides the equations for this purpose. If the summation of the left hand side of these equations exceeds 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 3B.1), the member is considered to have FAILed under the loading condition.

Axial tension and bending


The member strength for sections subjected to axial tension and uniaxial or biaxial bending is obtained through the use of interaction equations. Clause 5.5.10 and 6.5.12 of the code provides the equations for this purpose. If the summation of the left hand side of these equations exceeds 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 3B.1), the member is considered to have FAILed under the loading condition.

Shear
The shear resistance of the cross section is determined using the equations of Clause 5.5.5 and 6.5.7.2 of the code. Once this is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on the cross section to the shear resistance of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 3B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear.

3D.6 Design Parameters


The design parameters outlined in Table below may be used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to

International Design Codes Manual 221

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

the program and thus allows the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 3D.1 - Canadian Timber Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as TIMBERCANADIAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.51.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

CHIX CV KD KH KN KSB

1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0

Curvature Factor for Compression [Clause 6.5.6.5.2] Shear Load Coefficient [Table 6.5.7.4A] Load Duration Factor [Clause.4.3.2, Table 4.3.2] System Factor [Clause 5.4.4/6.4.3, Table 5.4.4] Notch Factor [Clause 5.4.7.2.2] Service Condition Factor for Bending at Extreme Fibre Applicable for bending at extreme fibre [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]

222 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name KSC

Default Value 1.0

Description

Service Condition Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression parallel to grain [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]

KSE

1.0

Service Condition Factor for Modulus of Elasticity, Applicable for modulus of elasticity [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]

KST

1.0

Service Condition Factor for Tension, Applicable for tension parallel to grain [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]

KSV

1.0

Service Condition Factor for Shear, Applicable for longitudinal shear [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]

KX KY KZ KZB

1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0

K value for flexural torsional buckling K value in local Y-axis, usually minor axis K value in local Z-axis, usually major axis Size Factor for Bending, Applicable for bending [Clause.5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]

KZCP

1.0

Size Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression perpendicular to grain [Clause .5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]

International Design Codes Manual 223

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01 Parameter Name KZT Default Value 1.0 Description

Size Factor for Tension, Applicable for tension parallel to grain [Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]

KZV K_SCP

1.0 1.0

Size Factor for Shear [Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5] Service Condition Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression perpendicular to grain [Clause 5.4.2 and Table 6.4.2]

K_T K_ZC

1.0 1.0

Treatment Factor [Clause 5.4.3/6.4.4] Size Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression parallel to grain [Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]

LX LY LZ NSF RATIO

Member length Member length Member length 1.0 1.0

Length for flexural torsional buckling Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Net section factor for tension members Permissible Ratio of Actual to Allowable Value

224 STAAD.Pro

3D.7 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to check whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked as per the CSA086-01 requirements. Code checking is done using forces and moments at specified sections of the members. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from the start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Refer to Section 4.4 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.51.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.
PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CAN KD 0.99 ALL KH 0.99 ALL K_T 0.99 ALL KSB 0.99 ALL KSV 0.99 ALL KSC 0.99 ALL KSE 0.99 ALL KST 0.99 ALL KZB 0.99 ALL KZV 0.99 ALL KZT 0.99 ALL KZCP 0.99 ALL K_ZC 0.99 ALL CV 0.99 ALL KN 0.99 ALL K_SCP 0.99 ALL CHIX 0.99 ALL

International Design Codes Manual 225

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

RATIO 0.99 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

3D.8 Member Selection


Member selection based CSA086-2001 is not available.

3D.9 Tabulated Results of Timber Design


Results of code checking and member selection are presented in a tabular format. The term CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the CSA086-01 specification, which governed the design. Pu = Actual Load in Compression Tu = Actual Load in Tension Muy = Ultimate moment in y direction Muz = Ultimate moment in z direction V = Ultimate shear force SLENDERNESS_Y = Actual Slenderness ratio in y direction SLENDERNESS_Z = Actual Slenderness ratio in z direction PY = Factored Compressive capacity in y direction PZ = Factored Compressive capacity in z direction T = Factored tensile capacity MY = Factored moment of resistance in y direction MZ = Factored moment of resistance in z direction V = Factored shear resistance SLENDERNESS = Allowable slenderness ratio

3D.10 Verification Problems


In the next few pages are included 6 verification examples for reference purposes.

226 STAAD.Pro

Verification Problem No. 1 Reference


Example 4, page 116, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001

Problem
To determine the Canadian Glulam section column in axial compression, with design per Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01 . Column is effectively pinned at both ends and braced at mid-height in all direction.

Given
Length = 9000 mm

Comparison
Table 3D.2 - CAN/CSA-086-01 Verification Problem 1 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Design Strength (kN) 295 293.793 0.43% (Negligible)

Input File
This file is included in as \STAAD\EXAMP\CAN\CANADA_GLULAMCOLUMN.STD.
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR GLULAM DESIGN INPUT FILE: GLULAMCOLUMN.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 10-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79

International Design Codes Manual 227

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 9 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; UNIT INCHES KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-12C-E E 9.7 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 PRIS YD 0.748031 ZD 0.574147 UNIT INCHES KIP CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-12C-E MEMB 1 SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY -214 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KY 0.5 ALL KZ 0.5 ALL

228 STAAD.Pro

CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output for Member Design


STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (S086) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 175.00X228.00 CANADIAN GLULAM GRADE:GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-12C-E PASS CL.5.5.10/6.5 0.728 1 214.00 C 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 4500.000 LEY = 4500.000 LUZ = 9000.000 LUY = 9000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 1.000 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.000 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 214.000 | | Tu = 0.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | SLENDERNESS_Y = 19.737 | | SLENDERNESS_Z = 25.714 | METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-

International Design Codes Manual 229

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

| ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 413.943 | | PZ = 293.793 | | T = 0.000 | | MY = 0.000 | | MZ = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | SLENDERNESS = 50.000 | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------|

Verification Problem: 2
Objective:- To determine the bending capacity of a Canadian Glulam section single span floor beam. The compression edge assumed fully supported. Design Code:- Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference: - Example 2, page 59, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Length =7500mm, Beam Spacing = 5000mm, Standard load condition, Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in bending (kNm) 208 208.323 0.155% Design Strength in shear (kN) 101 100.776 -0.221 %

Theory STAAD Difference Input: -

STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR GLULAM DESIGN INPUT FILE: GLULAMBEAM.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 10-JUN-05

230 STAAD.Pro

END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 7.5 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 UNIT INCHES KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-12C-E E 9.7 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 ISOTROPIC GLT_D.FIR-L-20F-E E 12.4 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 ISOTROPIC CONCRETE E 3150 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 8.68E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 DAMP 0.05 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 PRIS YD 2.11942 ZD 0.426508 UNIT INCHES KIP

International Design Codes Manual 231

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT_D.FIR-L-20F-E MEMB 1 SUPPORTS 1 2 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -27.1 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Relevant portion of Output:

STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (S086)

*********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================== 1 130.00X646.00 CANADIAN GLULAM GRADE:GLT_D.FIR-L-20F-E FAIL CL.5.5.5/6.5. 1.008 1 0.00 T 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 7500.000 LEY = 7500.000 LUZ = 7500.000 LUY = 7500.000mm | | |

232 STAAD.Pro

| KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 1.000 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.000 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = 0.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 101.625 | | SLENDERNESS_Y = 16.932 | | SLENDERNESS_Z = 1.529 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 | | PZ = 0.000 | | T = 0.000 | | MY = 41.923 | | MZ = 208.323 | | V = 100.776 | | SLENDERNESS = 50.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| 46. FINISH

International Design Codes Manual 233

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

Verification Problem: 3
Objective:- To determine the capacity of a Canadian Glulam section in axial tension. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 3, page 158, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in Tension (kN) 257 256.636 -0.141 %

Theory STAAD Difference Input: -

STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR GLULAM DESIGN INPUT FILE: GLULAMTENSION.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 10-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 9 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 UNIT INCHES KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-14T-E

234 STAAD.Pro

E 10.7 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 ISOTROPIC CONCRETE E 3150 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 8.68E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 DAMP 0.05 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 PRIS YD 0.872702 ZD 0.262467 UNIT INCHES KIP CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-14T-E MEMB 1 SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY 250 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KY 0.5 ALL KZ 0.5 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

International Design Codes Manual 235

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

Relevant portion of Output: STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (S086) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================== 1 80.00X266.00 CANADIAN GLULAM GRADE:GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-14T-E PASS CL.5.5.10/6.5 0.974 1 250.00 T 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 4500.000 LEY = 4500.000 LUZ = 9000.000 LUY = 9000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 1.000 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.000 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = -250.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 |

236 STAAD.Pro

| PZ = 0.000 | | T = 256.636 | | MY = 0.000 | | MZ = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

Verification Problem: 4
Objective:- To determine the Canadian Sawn section column in axial compression. Column is effectively pinned at both ends. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 2, page 113, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given: - Unbraced Length = 5000mm Comparison: Solution Design Strength (kN) 130 129.223 -0.597 %

Theory STAAD Difference Input: -

STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER INPUT FILE: SAWN_ LUMBER_ COLUMN.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 08-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT FEET POUND JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 16.4042 0

International Design Codes Manual 237

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFL_NO2_8X8_POST E 1.368E+006 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT METER KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFL_NO2_8X8_POST MEMB 1 UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 TABLE ST DFL_NO2_8X8_POST SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 DEAD+LIVE LOAD JOINT LOAD 2 FY -114 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KSC 0.91 ALL K_ZC 1.05 ALL CHECK CODE FINISH

Relevant portion of Output: STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (S086) 238 STAAD.Pro

*********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION

========================================================= 1 ST DFL_NO2_8X8_POST PASS CL.5.5.10/6.5.12 0.882 1 114.00 C 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 5000.000 LEY = 5000.000 LUZ = 5000.000 LUY = 5000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 0.910 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.050 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 114.000 | | Tu = 0.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | SLENDERNESS_Y = 26.178 | | SLENDERNESS_Z = 26.178 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 129.223 |

International Design Codes Manual 239

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

| PZ = 129.223 | | T = 0.000 | | MY = 0.000 | | MZ = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | SLENDERNESS = 50.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

Verification Problem: 5
Objective: - To determine the bending capacity of a Canadian sawn section single span floor beam. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 1, page 58, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Length =6000mm, Beam Spacing = 3000mm, Standard load condition, Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in bending (kNm) 79.8 79.732 -0.085% Design Strength in shear (kN) 46.1 46.170 No

Theory STAAD Difference Input: -

STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER: SAWN_ LUMBER_BEAM.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 08-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN

240 STAAD.Pro

JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 6 0 0; 3 3 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 2; UNIT FEET POUND DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFL_NO1_10X16_BM E 1.728E+006 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT METER KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFL_NO1_10X16_BM MEMB 1 2 UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 2 TABLE ST DFL_NO1_10X16_BM SUPPORTS 1 2 FIXED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 DEAD+LIVE LOAD MEMBER LOAD 1 2 UNI GY -16.4 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KD 1.0 ALL K_T 1.0 ALL KSB 1.0 ALL

International Design Codes Manual 241

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

KZB 0.90 ALL KZV 0.90 ALL K_ZC 1.05 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Relevant portion of Output:

ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED)

MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================== 2 ST DFL_NO1_10X16_BM FAIL CL.5.5.5/6.5.6 1.066 1 0.00 T 0.00 49.20 3.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 3000.000 LEY = 3000.000 LUZ = 3000.000 LUY = 3000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 1.000 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 0.900 | | KZV = 0.900 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.050 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = 0.000 | | Muy = 0.000 |

242 STAAD.Pro

| Muz = 49.200 | | V = -49.200 | | SLENDERNESS_Y = 4.511 | | SLENDERNESS_Z = 2.158 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 | | PZ = 0.000 | | T = 0.000 | | MY = 79.800 | | MZ = 79.732 | | V = 46.170 | | SLENDERNESS = 50.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

Verification Problem: 6
Objective:- To determine the capacity of a Canadian Sawn section in axial tension. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 2, page 158, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in Tension (kN) 185 184.338 -0.357 %

Theory STAAD Difference Input: -

International Design Codes Manual 243

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER SAWN_ LUMBER_TENSION.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 08-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT FEET POUND JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 16.4042 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFL_NO1_6X8_BM E 1.728E+006 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT METER KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFL_NO1_6X8_BM MEMB 1 UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 TABLE ST DFL_NO1_6X8_BM SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 DEAD+LIVE LOAD JOINT LOAD 2 FY 144 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK

244 STAAD.Pro

PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KH 1.1 ALL KSC 0.91 ALL K_ZC 1.05 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Relevant portion of Output:


STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (S086)

*********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION

========================================================= 1 ST DFL_NO1_6X8_BM PASS CL.5.5.10/6.5.12 0.781 1 144.00 T 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 5000.000 LEY = 5000.000 LUZ = 5000.000 LUY = 5000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.100 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 0.910 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.050 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) |

International Design Codes Manual 245

Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01

| Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = -144.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 | | PZ = 0.000 | | T = 184.338 | | MY = 0.000 | | MZ = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

246 STAAD.Pro

Section 4

Chinese Codes

International Design Codes Manual 247

248 STAAD.Pro

Chinese Codes - Concrete Design Per GB500102002


4A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capabilities for performing concrete design per GB50010-2002. It can calculate the reinforcement needed for sections assigned through the PRISMATIC attribute. The concrete design calculations are based on the limit state method of GB50010-2002.

4A.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections for concrete members can be designed.
l

For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, Tee, and Trapezoidal) For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)

4A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members which will be designed by the program must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTY command. The following example shows the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTY 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 250. 11 13 PR YD 350. 14 TO 16 PRIS YD 400. ZD 750. YB 300. ZB 200.

will be done accordingly. In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. The third set numbers in the above example represents a T-shape with 750 mm flange width, 200 width, 400 mm overall depth and 100 mm flange depth (See section 6.20.2). The program will determine whether the section is rectangular, flanged or circular and the beam or column design.

International Design Codes Manual 249

Chinese Codes - Concrete Design Per GB50010-2002

4A.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform design as per GB50010-2002. Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 9A.1 of this manual contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Please note as per GB500102002, STAAD supports Characteristic Values of Concrete Strength and Design Value of Strength of Steel Bar only as per Table 4.1.4 and Table 4.2.3-1 respectively. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 4A.1 - Chinese Concrete Design GB50010-2002 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value CHINESE Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual. Description

250 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name BRACING

Default Value 0.0

Description

BEAM DESIGN A value of 1.0 means the effect of axial force will be taken into account for beam design. COLUMN DESIGN A value of 1.0 means the column is unbraced about major axis. A value of 2.0 means the column is unbraced about minor axis. A value of 3.0 means the column is unbraced about both axis.

CLEAR

25 mm 40 mm

For beam members. For column members Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

DEPTH

YD

ELZ

1.0

Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about major axis.

ELY

1.0

Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about minor axis.

International Design Codes Manual 251

Chinese Codes - Concrete Design Per GB50010-2002

Parameter Name FC

Default Value 15 N/mm2

Description

Concrete Yield Stress.

FYMAIN

210 N/mm2

Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel.

FYSEC

210 N/mm2

Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Maximum main reinforcement bar size.

MAXMAIN

60 mm

MAXSEC

12 mm

Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size.

MINMAIN

10 mm

Minimum main reinforcement bar size.

MINSEC

8 mm

Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size.

RATIO

4.0

Maximum percentage of longitudinal reinforcement in columns.

REINF

0.0

Tied column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral reinforcement.

RFACE

4.0

A value of 4.0 means longitudinal reinforcement in column is arranged equally along 4 faces. A value of 2.0 invokes 2 faced distribution about major axis. A value of 3.0 invokes 2 faced distribution about minor axis.

252 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name TRACK

Default Value 0.0

Description

BEAM DESIGN: 0.0 = , output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE and END. 1.0 = critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. COLUMN DESIGN: 0.0 = reinforcement details are printed. 1.0 = column interaction analysis results are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output 9.0 = details of section capacity calculations.

International Design Codes Manual 253

Chinese Codes - Concrete Design Per GB50010-2002

Parameter Name WIDTH

Default Value ZD

Description

Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

4A.5 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. If required the effect the axial force may be taken into consideration. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are prescanned to identify the critical load cases at different sections of the beams. The total number of sections considered is 13 (e.g., 0., .1, .2, .25, .3, .4, .5, .6, .7, .75, .8, .9, and 1). All of these sections are scanned to determine the design force envelopes.

Design for Flexure


Maximum sagging (creating tensile stress at the bottom face of the beam) and hogging (creating tensile stress at the top face) moments are calculated for all active load cases at each of the above mentioned sections. Each of these sections are designed to resist both of these critical sagging and hogging moments. Where ever the rectangular section is inadequate as singly reinforced section, doubly reinforced section is tried. However, presently the flanged section is designed only as singly reinforced section under sagging moment. It may also be noted all flanged sections are automatically designed as rectangular section under hogging moment as the flange of the beam is ineffective under hogging moment. Flexural design of beams are performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexure design is performed again in a second pass taking into account of the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provide after the preliminary design. Final provision of flexural reinforcements is made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the reinforcement detailing as per GB50010-2002 Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (finally which will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account of other practical

254 STAAD.Pro

consideration), user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 11 equally spaced sections from which the final detail drawing can be prepared.

Design for Shear


Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Shear design are performed at 11 equally spaced sections (0. to 1.) for the maximum shear forces amongst the active load cases and the associated torsional moments. Shear capacity calculation at different sections without the shear reinforcement is based on the actual tensile reinforcement provided by STAAD program. Two-legged stirrups are provided to take care of the balance shear forces acting on these sections.

Beam Design Output


The default design output of the beam contains flexural and shear reinforcement provided at 5 equally spaced (0, .25, .5, .75, and 1.) sections along the length of the beam. User has option to get a more detail output. All beam design outputs are given in IS units. An example of rectangular beam design output with the default output option (TRACK 0.0) is presented below: ============================================================================ B E A M N O. 12 D E S I G N R E S U L T S C20 HRB400 (Main) HRB400 (Sec.) LENGTH: 4000.0 mm SIZE: 250.0 mm X 350.0 mm COVER: 30.0 mm DESIGN LOAD SUMMARY (KN MET) ---------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION |FLEXTURE (Maxm. Sagging/Hogging moments)| SHEAR (in mm) | P MZ MX Load Case | VY MX Load Case ---------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 29.64 1.23 4

International Design Codes Manual 255

Chinese Codes - Concrete Design Per GB50010-2002

| 0.00 -25.68 1.23 4 | 400.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 27.97 1.23 4 | 0.00 -16.05 1.23 4 | 800.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 25.12 1.23 4 | 0.00 -7.17 1.23 4 | 1200.0 | 0.00 0.97 0.49 5 | 21.11 1.23 4 | 0.00 -0.14 1.32 6 | 1600.0 | 0.00 6.77 1.23 4 | 15.93 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 2000.0 | 0.00 11.06 1.23 4 | 9.59 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 2400.0 | 0.00 13.04 1.23 4 | 2.08 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 2800.0 | 0.00 12.45 1.23 4 | -5.43 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 3200.0 | 0.00 9.55 1.23 4 | -11.77 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 3600.0 | 0.00 4.73 1.23 4 | -16.95 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 4000.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | -25.48 1.23 4 | 0.00 -17.36 1.23 4 | ---------------------------------------------------------------------------SUMMARY OF REINF. AREA (Sq.mm) ----------------------------------------------------------------------------

256 STAAD.Pro

SECTION 0.0 mm 1000.0 mm 2000.0 mm 3000.0 mm 4000.0 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP 259.04 161.29 0.00 0.00 176.31 REINF. (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) BOTTOM 0.00 160.78 160.78 160.78 0.00 REINF. (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) ---------------------------------------------------------------------------SUMMARY OF PROVIDED REINF. AREA ---------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION 0.0 mm 1000.0 mm 2000.0 mm 3000.0 mm 4000.0 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP 4-10 3-10 2-10 2-10 3-10 REINF. 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) BOTTOM 2-12 2-12 2-12 2-12 2-12 REINF. 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) SHEAR 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 REINF. @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c ----------------------------------------------------------------------------

=====================================================

International Design Codes Manual 257

Chinese Codes - Concrete Design Per GB50010-2002

4A.6 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial forces and biaxial moments at the ends. All active load cases are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which yield maximum reinforcement is called the critical load. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. By default, square and rectangular columns and designed with reinforcement distributed on each side equally for the sections under biaxial moments and with reinforcement distributed equally in two faces for sections under uniaxial moment. User may change the default arrangement of the reinforcement with the help of the parameter RFACE (see Table 4A.1). Depending upon the member lengths, section dimensions and effective length coefficients specified by the user STAAD automatically determine the criterion (short or long) of the column design. All major criteria for selecting longitudinal and transverse reinforcement as stipulated by GB50010-2002 have been taken care of in the column design of STAAD.

Column Design Output


Default column design output (TRACK 0.0) contains the reinforcement provided by STAAD and the capacity of the section. With the option TRACK 1.0, the output contains intermediate results such as the design forces, effective length coefficients, additional moments etc. A special output TRACK 9.0 is introduced to obtain the details of section capacity calculations. All design output is given in SI units. An example of a long column design output (with option TRACK 1.0) is given below. ============================================================================ C O L U M N No. 1 D E S I G N R E S U L T S C20 HRB400 (Main) HRB400 (Sec.) LENGTH: 3000.0 mm CROSS SECTION: 250.0 mm dia. COVER: 40.0 mm ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 5 BRACED LONG COLUMN DESIGN FORCES (KNS-MET) -----------------------

258 STAAD.Pro

DESIGN AXIAL FORCE (Pu) : 62.0 About Z About Y INITIAL MOMENTS : 2.21 32.29 MOMENTS DUE TO MINIMUM ECC. : 1.24 1.24 SLENDERNESS RATIOS : 12.00 12.00 MOMENTS DUE TO SLENDERNESS EFFECT : 1.12 1.12 MOMENT REDUCTION FACTORS : 1.00 1.00 ADDITION MOMENTS (Maz and May) : 1.12 1.12 TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 3.32 33.40 REQD. STEEL AREA : 1822.71 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 17 - 12 dia. (3.92%, 1922.65 Sq.mm.) (Equally distributed) TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 8 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 190 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY (KNS-MET) -------------------------Puz : 992.70 Muz1 : 36.87 Muy1 : 36.87 INTERACTION RATIO: 1.00

=====================================================

International Design Codes Manual 259

260 STAAD.Pro

Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 500172003


4B.1 General
his section presents some general statements regarding the implementation in STAAD of the National Standard of the Peoples Republic of China specifications for Design of Steel Structures (GB50017-2003). The design philosophy and procedural logistics are based on the principles of limit state design method. Facilities are available for member selection as well as code checking. The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceedance of the capacities. The most economical section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program also checks the slenderness requirements and the stability criteria. It is generally assumed that the user will take care of the detailing requirements like flange buckling, web crippling etc. Users are recommended to adopt the following steps in performing the steel design: 1. Specify the geometry and factored loads. Perform the analysis. 2. Specify the design parameter values if different from the default values. 3. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection.

4B.2 Analysis Methodology


Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis, P-Delta analysis or Non-linear analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results.

4B.3 Member Property Specifications


For specification of member properties, the steel section library available in STAAD may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. Member properties may also be specified

International Design Codes Manual 261

Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003

using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to the STAAD Program Technical Reference manual.

4B.4 Built-in Chinese Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered for these members. An example of the member property specification in an input file is provided at the end of this section. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained by using the tools of the graphical user interface. Following are the descriptions of different types of sections.

I Shapes
I shaped sections are designated in the following way.
1 TO 5 15 16 TABLE ST I22B

H Shapes
H shaped sections are designated in the following way.
6 TO 8 TABLE ST HW250X250

T Shapes
T shaped sections are designated in the following way.
24 25 33 TO 36 TABLE ST TM244X300

Channels
Channels are specified in the following way.

262 STAAD.Pro

29 30 TABLE ST CH25A

Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without a spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel.
11 TABLE D CH22B 17 TABLE D CH40C SP 0.15

In the above set of commands, member 11 is a back-to-back double channel CH22B with no spacing in between. Member 17 is a double channel CH40C with a spacing of 0.15 length units between the channels.

Angles
Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
19 TABLE ST L100X100X7

Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
27 TABLE RA L40X25X3

The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 40mm and 25mm and a leg thickness of 3 mm. This specification may be used when the local Z axis corresponds to the z-z axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local Y axis corresponds to the z-z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.

Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by means of input of the words SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose.
22 TABLE LD L56X36X3

International Design Codes Manual 263

Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003

32 TABLE SD L45X28X4 20 TABLE LD L56X36X3 SP 0.15 28 TABLE SD L56X36X4 SP 0.15

Tubes (Rectangular or Square Hollow Sections)


Tubes can be assigned in 2 ways. In the first method, the designation for the tube is as shown below. This method is meant for tubes whose property name is available in the steel table. In these examples, member 12 consist of a 10X6X0.3 cm size tube section,
12 TABLE ST TUB100603.0

In the second method, tubes are specified by their dimensions. For example,
13 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.15 WT 0.8 DT 0.6

is a tube that has a height of 0.6 length units, width of 0.6 length units, and a wall thickness of 0.15 length units.

Pipes (Circular Hollow Sections)


Pipes can be assigned in 2 ways. In the first method, the designation for the pipe is as shown below. This method is meant for pipes whose property name is available in the steel table.
21 31 TABLE ST PIP203X6.5

In the second method, pipe sections may be provided by specifying the word PIPE followed by the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
9 10 14 18 23 26 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.6 ID 0.55

specifies a pipe with outside diameter of 0.6 length units and inside diameter of .55 length units. Sample File Containing Chinese Shapes

264 STAAD.Pro

STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 04-AUG-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 4 0 0; 3 9 0 0; 4 0 0 4; 5 4 0 4; 6 0 0 8; 7 4 0 8; 8 9 0 8; 9 0 3.5 0; 10 4 3.5 0; 11 9 3.5 0; 12 0 3.5 4; 13 4 3.5 4; 14 0 3.5 8; 15 4 3.5 8; 16 9 3.5 8; 17 0 7 0; 18 4 7 0; 19 9 7 0; 20 0 7 4; 21 4 7 4; 22 0 7 8; 23 4 7 8; 24 9 7 8; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 9; 2 2 10; 3 3 11; 4 4 12; 5 5 13; 6 6 14; 7 7 15; 8 8 16; 9 9 17; 10 10 18; 11 11 19; 12 12 20; 13 13 21; 14 14 22; 15 15 23; 16 16 24; 17 9 10; 18 10 11; 19 12 13; 20 14 15; 21 15 16; 22 17 18; 23 18 19; 24 20 21; 25 22 23; 26 23 24; 27 9 12; 28 12 14; 29 10 13; 30 13 15; 31 11 16; 32 17 20; 33 20 22; 34 18 21; 35 21 23; 36 19 24; MEMBER PROPERTY CHINESE *I SHAPES 1 TO 5 15 16 TABLE ST I22B *H SHAPES 6 TO 8 TABLE ST HW250X250 *T SHAPES 24 25 33 TO 36 TABLE ST TM244X300 *CHANNELS 29 30 TABLE ST CH25A *DOUBLE CHANNELS 11 TABLE D CH22B 17 TABLE D CH40C SP 0.15 *ANGLES 19 TABLE ST L100X100X7

International Design Codes Manual 265

Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003

*DOUBLE ANGLES 27 TABLE RA L40X25X3 22 TABLE LD L56X36X3 32 TABLE SD L45X28X4 20 TABLE LD L56X36X3 SP 0.15 28 TABLE SD L56X36X4 SP 0.15 *TUBES 12 TABLE ST TUB100603.0 13 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.15 WT 0.8 DT 0.6 *PIPES 21 31 TABLE ST PIP203X6.5 9 10 14 18 23 26 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.6 ID 0.55 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH

4B.5 Member Capacities


The basic measure of member capacities are the allowable stresses on the member under various conditions of applied loading such as allowable tensile stress, allowable compressive stress etc. These depend on several factors such as cross sectional properties, slenderness factors, unsupported width to thickness ratios and so on. Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating such capacities. Allowable stress for Axial Tension In members with axial tension, the tensile load must not exceed the tension capacity of the member. The tension capacity of the member is calculated on the basis of allowable tensile stresses provided in Table 3.4.1-1 of the code. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a given member per this allowable stress value and a user supplied net section factor (NSF-a default value of 1.0 is present but may be altered by changing the input value, see Table 1) and proceeds with member selection or code checking. Allowable stress for Axial Compression

266 STAAD.Pro

The allowable stress for members in compression is determined according to Table 3.4.1-1. Compressive resistance is a function of the slenderness of the crosssection (Kl/r ratio) and the user may control the slenderness value by modifying parameters such as KY, LY, KZ and LZ. The provisions of Section 5 are used to check the adequacy of sections in compression. Allowable stress for Bending and Shear Sections subjected to bending moments and shear forces are to be designed according to the provisions of section 4. The permissible bending compressive and tensile stresses are dependent on such factors as outstanding legs and thickness of flanges, unsupported length of the compression flange (UNL, defaults to member length) etc. Shear capacities are calculated according to Table 3.4.1-1 and Section 4 and are a function of web depth, web thickness etc. Users may use a value of 1.0 or 2.0 for the TRACK parameter to obtain a listing of the bending and shear capacities. Allowable stress for Combined Loading For members experiencing combined loading (axial force, bending and shear), applicable interaction formulas are checked at different locations of the member for all modeled loading situations. The procedure of Section 5 is implemented for combined axial load and bending.

4B.6 Combined Loading


For members experiencing combined loading (axial force, bending and shear), applicable interaction formulas are checked at different locations of the member for all modeled loading situations. The procedure of Section 5 is implemented for combined axial load and bending.

4B.7 Design Parameters


The user is allowed complete control over the design process through the use of parameters mentioned in Table 4B.1. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements of an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure.

International Design Codes Manual 267

Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003

Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 4B.1 - Chinese Steel Design GBJ 50017-2003 Parameters Parameter Name Default Value Definition Code Reference Notes

Design Code to follow. CODE CHINESE See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. -

BEAM

Beam parameter

0 = Perform design at ends and those locations specified in the section command. 1 = Perform design at ends and 1/12th section locations along member length.

COM PRESSION DMAX DMIN

150

Allowable KL/r value in compression Maximum allowable depth Minimum required depth

100 cm 0 cm

268 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Definition

Code Reference

Notes

The Following values represent the various grades of steel. Q235 -1 Q345 -2 Q390 -3 Q420 -4 KY 1 K value in local Yaxis, usually minor axis K value in local Zaxis, usually major axis Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Flag for controlling slenderness check -

GRADE

Grade of steel

Clause 3.4.1

KZ

LY

Default is selected beam's length Default is selected beam's length 0 = Check for slenderness.

LZ

MAIN

1 = Do not check for slenderness

International Design Codes Manual 269

Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003 Parameter Name NSF Default Value 1 Definition Code Reference Notes

Net section factor for tension members Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stress Plasticity adaptation factor Y direction Plasticity adaptation factor Z direction Overall Stability factor for Y direction Overall Stability factor for Z direction -

RATIO

PFY

1.2

Table 5.2.1 Table 5.2.1 AppendixB AppendixB

PFZ

1.05

SBY

SBZ

Stability factor for axial compression members shall be selected from appendix C based on its slenderness ratio, yield strength, classification of the section in Table 5.1.2-1 and Table 5.1.22

SFY

Stability factor for Y direction

AppendixC

270 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Definition

Code Reference

Notes

SFZ

Stability factor for Z direction

AppendixC

Stability factor for axial compression members shall be selected from appendix C based on its slenderness ratio, yield strength, classification of the section in Table 5.1.2-1 and Table 5.1.22 0 = Suppress critical member stress.

TENSION

300

Allowable KL/r value in tension

TRACK

Track parameter

1 = Print all critical member stress. 2 = Print expanded output.

4B.8 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to check whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked per the GB50017-2003 requirements. Code checking is done using forces and moments at specified sections of the members. If the BEAM parameter for a member is set to 1, moments are calculated

International Design Codes Manual 271

Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003

at every twelfth point along the beam, and the maximum moment about the major axis is used. When no sections are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero (default), design will be based on member start and end forces. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for further information on this feature.

Example
Sample Input data for Chinese Code Steel Design
UNIT METER PARAMETER CODE CHINESE NSF 0.85 ALL GRADE 3.0 MEMBER 7 KY 1.2 MEMBER 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE AL

4B.9 Member Selection


The member selection process basically involves determination of the least weight member that PASSes the code checking procedure based on the forces and moments of the most recent analysis. The section selected will be of the same type as that specified initially. For example, a member specified initially as a channel will have a channel selected for it. Selection of members whose properties are originally provided from a user table will be limited to sections in the user table. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for further information on this feature.

272 STAAD.Pro

Section 5

European Codes

International Design Codes Manual 273

274 STAAD.Pro

European Codes - Concrete Design Per Eurocode EC2


5A.1 Design Operations
STAAD provides a comprehensive set of national codes for the design of concrete structures. In general, all the available codes, including EC2, follow the same procedure for the design of the concrete members. The main steps in performing a design operation are: 1. Selecting the applicable load cases to be considered in the design process. 2. Providing appropriate parameter values if different from the default values. 3. Perform the design for the member as appropriate. These operations can be repeated by the user any number of times depending on the design requirements. The parameters referred to above provide the user with the ability to allocate specific design properties to individual members considered in the design operation.

5A.2 Eurocode 2 (EC2)


Eurocode 2, Design of concrete structures, Part 1, General rules and rules for buildings, provides design rules applicable to plain, reinforced or prestressed concrete used in buildings and civil engineering works. It is based on the limit state philosophy common to modern standards.
The objective of this method of design is to ensure that possibility of failure is reduced to a negligible level. This is achieved through application of factors to both the applied loads and the material properties. The code also provides guidelines on the global method of analysis to be used for calculating internal member forces and moments. STAAD provides a number of methods for analysis, allowing Geometric Nonlinearity as well as P-Delta effects to be considered.

5A.3 National Application Documents


Various authorities of the CEN member countries have prepared National Application Documents to be used with EC2. These documents provide alternative factors for loads and may also provide supplements to the rules in EC2.

International Design Codes Manual 275

European Codes - Concrete Design Per Eurocode EC2

The current version of EC2 implemented in STAAD adheres to the factors and rules provided in EC2 and has not been modified by any National Application Documents.

5A.4 Material Properties and Load Factors


Design resistances are obtained by dividing the characteristic yield strengths, as given in table 2.3 of EC2, by the material partial safety factors for concrete and c for reinforcements. The magnitude in STAAD is 1.5 for concrete and 1.15 for s reinforcements. Material coefficients in STAAD take the following default values unless replaced by numerical values provided in the input file. Modulus of Elasticity, E = 21.71 KN/mm2 Shear Modulus, G = E / 2 (1 + v) Poisson's Ratio, v = 0.25 Unit weight, = 23.56 KN/m3 The magnitude of design loads is dependent on , the partial safety factor for the F action under consideration. In STAAD the user is allowed total control in providing applicable values for the factors and their use in various load combinations.

5A.5 Columns
Columns are designed for axial compressive loads and possible moments at the ends of the member. If a particular load case causes tension in the column being designed that load case is ignored, the design proceeds with a warning message given to that affect. All active load cases will be considered in the design and reinforcements are assumed symmetrically arranged in the cross section. The maximum reinforcement calculated after all design load cases have been considered is then reported as the critical required area of reinforcement. Slender columns are also covered in the design process, the program will make due allowance for the additional moment that has to be considered in the design.

276 STAAD.Pro

Note: Sway type structures are not directly covered in the current implementation of EC2. This effect, however, can be accounted for by the PDELTA analysis option.

5A.6 Beams
Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. For all these actions active load cases are scanned to create appropriate envelopes for the design process. Maximum torsional moment is also identified and incorporated in the design.

Design for flexure


Reinforcement for both positive and negative moments is calculated on the basis of the section properties provided by the user. If the required reinforcement exceeds the maximum allowable then the section size is inadequate and a massage to that effect is given in the output. Parabolic-rectangular stress distribution for the concrete section is adopted and as moment redistribution is not available in STAAD analysis, the limit for N.A to depth ratio is set according to clause 2.5.3.4.2 (5) of the code. If required, compression reinforcement will be provided in order to satisfy the above limits. It is important to know that beams are designed for the flexural moment MZ only. The moment MY is not considered in the design at all.

Design for Shear


Shear reinforcement design is based on the standard method mentioned in clause 4.3.2.4.3 where it is assumed the notional strut inclination is constant. Depending on the shear distribution within the member it may be possible that nominal shear reinforcement will be sufficient to cater for the design shear forces. If this is not the case an attempt is made to identify regions where nominal reinforcement is insufficient and appropriate reinforcement is then calculated to cover the excess design shear force. The maximum shear force that can be carried without crushing the concrete is also checked and if exceeded, a message to revise the section size is given in the output file.

International Design Codes Manual 277

European Codes - Concrete Design Per Eurocode EC2

Design for Torsion


Torsional moments arising as a result of equilibrium requirements need to be designed for at the ultimate limit state. Reinforcement for torsional moments consists of stirrups combined with longitudinal bars. The combined magnitude of shear stress arising from shear forces and torsional moments are checked in order to establish whether the section size is adequate. If section size is inadequate a massage is given in the output file, otherwise, full design is carried out and both shear links and longitudinal bars required are calculated and, where necessary, links are combined with the shear force links and printed in a tabulated manner in the output file.

5A.7 Slabs
Slabs can only be designed for if finite elements are used to represent them in the model of the structure. In the main the design follows the same procedure as for flexure except that shear forces are assumed to be resisted without the provision of shear reinforcements. In cases where this may not be the case users must ensure that necessary checks are carried out. The output for the slab design refers to longitudinal reinforcements, which coincides with the local x direction of the element, and, transverse reinforcement, which coincides with the local y direction of the element. Also, reference is made to 'TOP' and BOTT' reinforcement which relates to the element's 'TOP' and 'BOTTOM' as determined from the connectivity of the element. This may not coincide with the slab's actual top and bottom and, if desired, you must ensure this through the numbering scheme of the elements. The design of the slab considers a fixed bar size of 16mm in both directions with the longitudinal bar being the layer closest to the slab exterior faces. Refer to Figure 1.21 in Section 1.61. of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information.

5A.8 Design Parameters


Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular structure. Depending on the model being designed, the user may have to change some or all of the parameter default values. Some parameters are unit dependent and when altered, the new setting must be compatible with the active "unit" specification. Table 5A.1 lists all the relevant EC2 parameters together with description and default values.

278 STAAD.Pro

Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 5A.1 - Concrete Design EC2 Parameters Parameter Name FYMAIN Default Value *460 N/mm2 Description

Yield Stress for main reinforcement (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement. Applicable to shear bars in beams Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter. Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Face of support location at start of beam. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) Face of support location at end of beam.

FYSEC

*460N/mm2

FC MINMAIN

* 30N/mm2 8mm

MINSEC

8mm

CLEAR

* 20mm

MAXMAIN

50mm

SFACE

*0.0

EFACE

*0.0

International Design Codes Manual 279

European Codes - Concrete Design Per Eurocode EC2 Parameter Name Default Value Description

Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. TRACK 0.0 0.0 = Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1.0 = For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2.0 = Output of TRACK 1.0 List of design sag/hog moments and corresponding required steel area at each section of member MMAG NSECTION 1.0 10 Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 20. Width of concrete member. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Depth of concrete member. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. 0.0 = Column braced in both directions. 1.0 = Column unbraced about local Z direction only

WIDTH

*ZD

DEPTH

*YD

BRACE

0.0

280 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

2.0 = Column unbraced about local Y direction only 3.0 = Column unbraced in both Y and Z directions ELY ELZ SRA 1.0 1.0 0.0 Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design. A = Skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. SERV 0.0 0.0 = No serviceability check performed. 1.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever beams. * Provided in current unit system

International Design Codes Manual 281

282 STAAD.Pro

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3


The design of structural steel members in accordance with the specification Eurocode 3: Design of steel structures - part 1-1: General Rules and rules for buildings has been implemented. Two versions of the code are currently implemented, the EC3_94/1 and BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Additionally, STAAD.Pro has implemented several countries' National Annex documents. To access the EC3_94/1 edition, specify the commands.
PARAMETERS CODE EC3

Or
PARAMETERS CODE EURO

To access the BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 edition, specify the commands:


PARAMETERS CODE EC3 EN 1993-1-1:2005

5B.(A) European Codes - Steel Design to Eurocode 3 [DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992]


5B.1(A) General Description
Introduction
STAAD provides a comprehensive set of national codes for the design of steel structures. In general, all the available codes, including EC3, follow the same

International Design Codes Manual 283

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

procedure to either code-check or select suitable members of an analyzed structure. The main steps in performing a design operation are: 1. Selecting the applicable load cases to be considered in the design process. 2. Providing appropriate Parameter values if different from the default values. 3. Specify whether to perform code-checking and/or member selection. These operations can be repeated by the user any number of times depending on the design requirements. The Parameters referred to above provide the user with the ability to allocate specific design properties to individual members or member groups considered in the design operation.

Eurocode 3 DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 (EC3 DD)


The DD ENV version of Eurocode 3, Design of steel structures, Part 1.1 General rules and rules for buildings (EC3 DD) provides design rules applicable to structural steel used in buildings and civil engineering works. It is based on the ultimate limit states philosophy that is common to modern standards. The objective of this method of design is to ensure that possibility of failure is reduced to a negligible level. This is achieved through application of safety factors to both the applied loads and the material properties. The code also provides guidelines on the global methods of analysis to be used for calculating internal member forces and moments. STAAD uses the elastic method of analysis which may be used in all cases. Also there are three types of framing referred to in EC3. These are Simple, Continuous, and Semi-continuous which reflect the ability of the joints to developing moments under a specific loading condition. In STAAD only Simple and Continuous joint types can be assumed when carrying out global analysis.

National Application Documents


Various authorities of the CEN member countries have prepared National Application Documents to be used with EC3. These documents provide alternative factors for loads and may also provide supplements to the rules in EC3. The current version of EC3 DD implemented in STAAD adheres to the factors and rules provided in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 and has not been modified by any National Application Document.

284 STAAD.Pro

Axes convention in STAAD and EC3


By default, STAAD defines the major axis of the cross-section as Z-Z and the minor axis as Y-Y. A special case where Z-Z is the minor axis and Y-Y is the major axis is available if the SET Z UP command is used and is discussed in Section 5.5 of the Technical Reference Manual. The longitudinal axis of the member is defined as X and joins the start joint of the member to the end with the same positive direction. EC3, however, defines the principal cross-section axes in reverse to that of STAAD, but the longitudinal axis is defined in the same way. Both of these axes definitions follow the orthogonal right hand rule. See figure below. Bear this difference in mind when examining the code-check output from STAAD.
Figure 5.1 - Axis convention in STAAD and EC3

5B.2(A) AnalysisMethodology
Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations.

5B.3(A) Material Properties and Load Factors


The characteristic yield strength of steel used in EC3 DD design is based on table 3.1 of the code. Design resistances are obtained by dividing the characteristic yield strength by the material partial safety factor m. The magnitude of min STAAD is 1.1 which is applicable to all section types. A separate safety factor parameter named GB1 is used to check the resistance of a member to buckling and also has a default value of 1.1.

International Design Codes Manual 285

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

Material coefficients for steel in STAAD take the following default values unless replaced by users numerical values provided in the input file. Modulus of Elasticity, E = 205000 N/mm2 Shear Modulus, G = E/2(1+ ) Poissons Ratio, = 0.3 Unit weight, = 76.8 KN/m3 The magnitude of design loads is dependent on , the partial safety factor for the f action under consideration. In STAAD the user is allowed total control in providing applicable values for the factors and their use in various load combinations.

5B.4(A) Section Classification


The occurrence of local buckling of the compression elements of a cross-section prevents the development of full section capacity. It is therefore imperative to establish this possibility prior to determining the section capacities. Cross sections are classified in accordance with their geometrical properties and the stress pattern on the compression elements. For each load case considered in the design process, STAAD determines the section class and calculates the capacities accordingly. The EC3 DD design module in STAAD can design members with all section profiles that are of Class 1 2 or 3 as defined in section 5.3.2 of the code. However, the design of members that have a Class 4 section profile are limited to WIDE FLANGE, TEE, SINGLE CHANNEL, SINGLE ANGLE, and RECTANGULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS. Also built-up user sections that are class 4 sections are not dealt with in the current version of EC3 design in STAAD.Pro. Laced and battened members are not considered in the current version of EC3 DD design module in STAAD.Pro.

5B.5(A) Member Design

5B.5(A).1 Design of Beams as per DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992


EC3 DD design in STAAD.Pro considers members that are primarily in bending and/or shear as beams and performs cross section and member capacity checks in

286 STAAD.Pro

accordance with the code. The main requirement for a beam is to have sufficient cross-section resistance to the applied bending moment and shear force. The possibility of lateral-torsional buckling is also taken into consideration when the full length of the member has not been laterally restrained. The bending capacity is primarily a function of the section type and the material yield strength and is determined according to Cl. 5.4.5 of the code. The shear capacity and the corresponding shear checks are done as per section 5.4.6 of the code. There are four classes of cross-sections defined in EC3. Class 1 and 2 sections can both attain full capacity with the exception that the class 2 sections cannot sustain sufficient rotation required for plastic analysis of the model. Hence the full plastic section modulus is used in the design calculations. Class 3 sections, due to local buckling, cannot develop plastic moment capacity and the yield stress is limited to the extreme compression fibre of the section. The elastic section modulus is used to determine the moment capacity for class 3 sections. Class 4 sections do suffer from local buckling and explicit allowance must be made for the reduction in section properties before the moment capacity can be determined. Further, because of interaction between shear force and bending moment, the moment resistance of the cross-section may be reduced. This, however, does not occur unless the value of applied shear forces exceeds 50% of the plastic shear capacity of the section. In such cases the web is assumed to resist the applied shear force as well as contributing towards the moment resistance of the cross-section. As mentioned in the previous section, the design of class 4 sections is limited to WIDE FLANGE, TEE, SINGLE CHANNEL, SINGLE ANGLE, and RECTANGULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS. The effective section properties are worked out as described in Cl. 5.3.5 of the code. Beams are also checked for lateral-torsional buckling according to section 5.5.2 of the code. The buckling capacity is dependent on the section type as well as the unrestrained length, restraint conditions and type of applied loading. The lateral torsional buckling checks involves the calculation of the Elastic critical moment, Mcr, which is calculated in STAAD as per the method given in Annex F of the code. In the presence of a shear force, beams are also checked for shear as per section 5.4.6 of the code. In cases where the members are subject to combined bending and shear, the combined bending and shear checks are done in STAAD as per clause 5.4.7 of the code.

International Design Codes Manual 287

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

5B.5(A).2 Design of Axially Loaded Members


The design of members subject to tension loads alone are performed as per Cl 5.4.3 of the code. The tension capacity is calculated based on yield strength, material factor m and cross-sectional area of the member with possible reduction due to bolt holes. When bolt holes need to be considered in the capacity calculations the value used for m is 1.2 and the yield strength is replaced with the ultimate tensile strength of the material. The tension capacity is then taken as the smaller of the full section capacity and the reduced section capacity as stated above. The design of members subject to axial compression loads alone are performed as per Cl 5.4.4 of the code. For members with class 1 2 or 3 section profiles, the full section area is considered in calculating the section capacity. However in case of class 4 sections, the effective cross-section is considered to calculate the compressive strength. Also any additional moments induced in the section due to the shift of the centroidal axis of the effective section will also be taken into account as per clause 5.4.8.3 of the code. The effective section properties for class 4 sections will be worked out as given in Cl.5.3.5 of the code. In addition to the cross section checks, buckling resistance will also be checked for such members. This is often the critical case as the buckling strength of the member is influenced by a number of factors including the section type and the unbraced length of the member. The buckling capacity is calculated as per Cl. 5.5 of the code. DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 does not specifically deal with single angle, double angles, double channels or Tee sections and does give a method to work out the slenderness of such members. In these cases, the EC3 DD design module of STAAD.Pro uses the methods specified in BS 5950-1:2000 to calculate the slenderness of these members. Cl. 4.7.10 and table 25 of BS 5950-1:2000 are used in the current version of the EC3 DD design module

Single Angle Sections


Angle sections are un-symmetrical and when using BS 5950:2000 table 25 you must consider four axes: two principal, u-u and v-v and two geometric, a-a and bb. The effective length for the v-v axis, Lvv, is taken as the LVV parameter or LY * KY, if not specified. The a-a and b-b axes are determined by which leg of the angle

288 STAAD.Pro

is fixed by the connection and should be specified using the LEG parameter, see section 5B.6 for more information on the LEG parameter. The effective length in the a-a axis is taken as LY * KY and the effective length in the b-b axis as LZ * KZ. The following diagram shows the axes for angles which have been defined with either an ST or RA specification and is connected by its longer leg (i.e., a-a axis is parallel to the longer leg).
Figure 5.2 - Single angle sections A) STangle & USERtable angles and B) RAangle

5B.5(A).3 Design of members with combined axial load and bending


The bending resistance of members could be reduced by the presence of a coexistent axial load. This is then checked against the lateral-torsional buckling resistance of the section. The EC3 DD design module in STAAD takes such a scenario into account and performs the necessary checks as per Cl. 5.4.8 of the code. Class 1 and class 2 sections are checked as per cl. 5.4.8.1 and Class 3 and Class 4 sections are checked as per clauses 5.4.8.2 and 5.4.8.3 respectively. The effective section properties for class 4 sections are worked out as given in Cl. 5.3.5 of the code. Generally, EC3 requires checking cross-section resistance for local capacity and also checking the overall buckling capacity of the member. In the case of members subject to axial tension and bending, there is provision to take the stabilizing effect of the tension load into consideration. This is achieved by modifying the extreme

International Design Codes Manual 289

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

compression fibre stress and calculating an effective applied moment for the section. The checks are done as per Cl. 5.5.3 of the code. In case of a combined axial compressive load and bending moment, the member will be checked as per the rules in section 5.5.4 of the code. The presence of large shear force can also reduce the bending resistance of the section under consideration. If the shear load is large enough to cause a reduction in bending resistance, then the reduction due to shear has to be taken into account before calculating the effect of the axial load on the bending resistance of the section. If the member is subject to a combined shear, axial load and bending moment then the section capacity checks will be done as per Cl. 5.4.9 of the code. As stated in the previous section, DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 does not specifically deal with single angle, double angles, double channels or Tee sections and does give a method to work out the slenderness of such members. In these cases, the EC3 DD design module of STAAD.Pro uses the methods specified in BS 59501:2000 to calculate the slenderness of these members. Cl. 4.7.10 of BS 59501:2000 is used in the current version of the EC3 DD design module. Please refer to the note in section 5B.5.2 for St and RA angle specifications. Please note that laced or battened compression members are not dealt within the current version of EC3 DD design module in STAAD.Pro.

5B.6(A) Design Parameters


Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular structure. Depending on the model being designed, the user may have to change some or all of the parameter default values. Some parameters are unit dependent and when altered, the new setting must be compatible with the active unit specification. Table 5B.1(A) lists all the relevant EC3 parameters together with description and default values. Table 5B.1 - Steel Design Parameters EC3 DD Parameter Name CODE Undefined You must specify EC3 or EUROPE. Default Value Description

290 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 3 Parameter to control the number of sections to checked along the length of a beam: 0. Check sections with end forces only 1. Check at location of maximum Mz along beam 2. Check sections with end forces and forces at location of BEAM1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th point along the beam and report the maximum Refer to Note 2 below. CAN 0 Member will be considered as a cantilever type member for deflection checks. 0 indicates that member will not be treated as a cantilever member 1 indicates that the member will be treated as a cantilever member

International Design Codes Manual 291

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3 Parameter Name CMM 1.0 Indicates type of loading on member. Valid values range from 1 to 6. Refer to Table 5B.2 for more information on its use. CMN 1.0 Indicates the level of EndRestraint. 1.0 = No fixity 0.5 = Full fixity 0.7 = One end free and other end fixed DMAX 100.0 cm Maximum allowable depth for the member. DMIN 0 Minimum required depth for the member. DFF None (Mandatory for deflection check) DJ1 Start Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length". DJ2 End Joint of member Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length". FU Ultimate tensile strength of Deflection limit Default Value Description

292 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

steel GB1 1.1 Partial safety factor used in buckling checks for compression members GM0 1.1 Corresponds to the
m0

factor

in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 GM1 1.1 Corresponds to the


m1

factor

in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 GM2 1.1 Corresponds to the


m2

factor

in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 KY KZ LEG 1.0 1.0 0.0 K factor in local y axis. K factor in local z axis. Connection type Refer to Note 1 below. LVV Maximum of Lyy and Lzz (Lyy is a term used by BS5950) LY Member Length Compression length in local y axis, Slenderness ratio = (KY)*(LY)/(Ryy) LZ Member Length Compression length in local z axis, Slenderness ratio = (KZ)*(LZ)/(Rzz) Buckling length for angle about its principle axis

International Design Codes Manual 293

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3 Parameter Name PY Yield Strength The yield strength default value is set based on the default value of the "SGR" parameter. NSF 1.0 Net tension factor for tension capacity calculation. RATIO 1 Permissible ratio of loading to capacity. SBLT 0.0 Indicates if the section is rolled or built-up. 0.0 = Rolled 1.0 = Built-up SGR 0.0 Steel grade as per table 3.1 in EC3. 0.0 = Fe 360 1.0 = Fe 430 2.0 = Fe 510 TRACK 0 Controls the level of detail of output. 0 = minimum 1 = intermediate 2 = maximum 4 = perform a deflection check Default Value Description

294 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

See note 3 below. UNF 1.0 Unsupported buckling length as a factor of the beam length UNL Member Length Unrestraint length of member used in calculating the lateraltorsional resistance moment of the member. ZIV 0.8 Specifies a reduction factor for vectoral effects to be used in axial tension checks [Cl 5.5.3(2)] Notes: 1. LEG (Ref: Table 25 BS5950) The slenderness of single and double angle, channel and tee sections are specified in BS 5950 table 25 depending on the connection provided at the end of the member (Refer to section 5B.5(A).2). To define the appropriate connection, a LEG parameter should be assigned to the member. The following table indicates the value of the LEG parameter required to match the BS5950 connection definition:

International Design Codes Manual 295

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

Table 5B.2 - LEG Parameter values Clause Bold Configuration (a) - 2 bolts Leg LEG Parameter 1.0 3.0 0.0 2.0 3.0 7.0 2.0 6.0 1.0 5.0 0.0 4.0 1.0 0.0

4.7.10.2 Single Angle

short leg long leg

(b) - 1 bolts

short leg long leg

4.7.10.3 Double Angles

(a) - 2 bolts

short leg long leg

(b) - 1 bolts

short leg long leg

(c) - 2 bolts

long leg short leg

(d) - 1 bolts

long leg short leg

4.7.10.4 Channels

(a) - 2 or more rows of bolts (b) - 1 row of bolts

296 STAAD.Pro

Clause

Bold Configuration

Leg

LEG Parameter 1.0 0.0

4.7.10.5 Tee Sections

(a) - 2 or more rows of bolts (b) - 1 row of bolts

For single angles, the slenderness is calculated for the geometric axes, a-a and b-b as well as the weak v-v axis. The effective lengths of the geometric axes are defined as: La = KY * KY Lb = KZ * LZ The slenderness calculated for the v-v axis is then used to calculate the compression strength pc for the weaker principal axis (z-z for ST angles or yy for RA specified angles). The maximum slenderness of the a-a and b-b axes is used to calculate the compression strength pc for the stronger principal axis. Alternatively for single angles where the connection is not known or Table 25 is not appropriate, by setting the LEG parameter to 10, slenderness is calculated for the two principal axes y-y and z-z only. The LVV parameter is not used. For double angles, the LVV parameter is available to comply with note 5 in table 25. In addition, if using double angles from user tables, (Refer to Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual) an eleventh value, rvv, should be supplied at the end of the ten existing values corresponding to the radius of gyration of the single angle making up the pair. 2. BEAM Ensure that this parameter is set to either 1 or 2 while performing code checking for members susceptible to Lateral - Torsional Buckling.

International Design Codes Manual 297

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

Table 5B.3 - Values for the CMM Parameter CMM Value 1 Loading and Support Conditions

3. Checking beam deflection With the TRACK parameter set to 4, the members included in a CHECK CODE command will be checked for the local axis deflection rather than for the stress capacity using the current LOAD LIST. If both stress capacity and deflection checks are required, then 2 parameter blocks with code checks are required, one with a TRACK 4 command and one with a TRACK 0, 1, or 2, thus:
LOAD LIST 1 TO 10 PARAMETER 1 CODE EN 1993 TRACK 2 ALL

298 STAAD.Pro

CHECK CODE MEMBER 1 *************************** LOAD LIST 100 TO 110 PARAMETER 2 TRACK 4 ALL DFF 300 MEMB 1 DJ1 1 MEMB 1 DJ2 4 MEMB 1 CODE MEMB 1

Note: While both sets of code checks will be reported in the output file, only the last code check results are reported in the GUI.

5B.7(A) CodeChecking
The purpose of code checking is to ascertain whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked as per DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. Code checking is done using the forces and moments at specific sections of the members. When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks; the critical condition ; the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value); the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the member of forces in the member where the critical condition occurs). Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2B.4 or any of the user defined sections as described in Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual, with two exceptions; GENERAL and ISECTION. The EC3 DD design module does not consider these sections or PRISMATIC sections in its design process. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

International Design Codes Manual 299

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

5B.8(A) MemberSelection
STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section, i.e., the lightest section, which fulfills the code requirements for the specified member. The section selected will be of the same type section as originally designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN, which limits the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Member selection can be performed with all the types of steel sections with the same limitations as defined in section 5B.7(A) Code Checking. Selection of members, whose properties are originally input from a user created table, will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic or as the limitations specified in section 5.B.7(A).

5B.9(A) TabulatedResultsofSteelDesign
For code checking or member selection, the program produces the results in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. MEMBER refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b. TABLE refers to steel section name, which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c. RESULTS prints whether the member has PASSED or FAILED. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark on front of the member. d. CRITICAL COND refers to the clause in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code which governs the design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number, which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis and the moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the

300 STAAD.Pro

member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. Note: For a TRACK 2 output, the module will also report all the relevant clause checks that have been performed and will also indicate the critical ratio and the load case that caused the critical ratio as well as the corresponding forces that were used for the respective checks. A TRACK 2 output will also include the various design data used for the calculations such as the section modulii, section class, section capacity etc.

5B.(B) European Codes - Steel Design to Eurocode 3 [EN 1993-1-1:2005]


5B.1(B) General Description
STAAD provides a comprehensive set of national codes for the design of steel structures. In general, all the available codes, including EC3, follow the same procedure to either code-check or select suitable members of an analyzed structure. The main steps in performing a design operation are: 1. Selecting the applicable load cases to be considered in the design process. 2. Providing appropriate Parameter values if different from the default values. 3. Specify whether to perform code-checking and/or member selection. These operations can be repeated by the user any number of times depending on the design requirements. The Parameters referred to above provide the user with the ability to allocate specific design properties to individual members or member groups considered in the design operation.

Eurocode 3 - EN 1993-1-1:2005 (EN 1993)


The EN 1993 version of Eurocode 3, Design of steel structures, Part 1.1 General rules and rules for buildings (EN 1993) provides design rules applicable to structural steel used in buildings and civil engineering works. It is based on the

International Design Codes Manual 301

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

ultimate limit states philosophy that is common to modern standards. The objective of this method of design is to ensure that possibility of failure is reduced to a negligible level. This is achieved through application of safety factors to both the applied loads and the material properties. The code also provides guidelines on the global methods of analysis to be used for calculating internal member forces and moments. STAAD uses the elastic method of analysis which may be used in all cases. Also there are three types of framing referred to in EC3. These are Simple, Continuous, and Semi-continuous which reflect the ability of the joints to developing moments under a specific loading condition. In STAAD only Simple and Continuous joint types can be assumed when carrying out global analysis.

National Annex Documents


Various authorities of the CEN member countries have prepared National Annex Documents to be used with EC3. These documents provide alternative factors for loads and may also provide supplements to the rules in EC3. The current version of EC3 (EN 1993)implemented in STAAD adheres to the factors and rules provided in EN 1993-1-1:2005. The current version of STAAD.Pro includes the following National Annexes viz. a. British National Annex [NA to BS EN 1993-1-1:2005] b. The Dutch National Annex [NEN-EN 1993-1-1/NB] and c. Norwegian National Annex [NS-EN 1993-1-1:2005/NA2008] d. French National Annex [Annexe Nationale a la NF EN 1993-1-1:2005] e. Finnish National Annex [SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005] f. Polish National Annex [PN EN 1993-1-1:2005] g. Singaporean National Annex [SS EN 1993-1-1:2005] h. Belgian National Annex [NBN EN 1993-1-1:2005] The choice of a particular National Annex is based on the value of a new NA parameter that is set by the user when specifying the EN 1993 version of Eurocode 3. Please refer to section 5B.6 (B) for a description of the NA parameter.

302 STAAD.Pro

Axes convention in STAAD and EC3


By default, STAAD defines the major axis of the cross-section as Z-Z and the minor axis as Y-Y. A special case where Z-Z is the minor axis and Y-Y is the major axis is available if the SET Z UP command is used and is discussed in Section 5.5 of the Technical Reference Manual. The longitudinal axis of the member is defined as X and joins the start joint of the member to the end with the same positive direction. EC3, however, defines the principal cross-section axes in reverse to that of STAAD, but the longitudinal axis is defined in the same way. Both of these axes definitions follow the orthogonal right hand rule. See figure below. Bear this difference in mind when examining the code-check output from STAAD.
Figure 5.3 - Axis convention in STAAD and EC3

5B.2 (B) AnalysisMethodology


Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations.

5B.3 (B) Material Properties and Load Factors


The characteristic yield strength of steel used in EC3 (EN 1993) design is based on table 3.1 of the code. Design resistances are obtained by dividing the characteristic value of a particular resistance by the global partial safety factor for the resistance, m. The magnitude of mis based on Cl. 6.1 of EN1993-1-1:2005 and can change depending on the selected National Annex.

International Design Codes Manual 303

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

Material coefficients for steel in STAAD take the following default values unless replaced by users numerical values provided in the input file. Modulus of Elasticity, E = 205000 N/mm2 Shear Modulus, G = E/2(1+ ) Poissons Ratio, = 0.3 Unit weight, = 76.8 KN/m3 The magnitude of design loads is dependent on , the partial safety factor for the f action under consideration. In STAAD the user is allowed total control in providing applicable values for the factors and their use in various load combinations.

5B.4 (B) Section Classification


The occurrence of local buckling of the compression elements of a cross-section prevents the development of full section capacity. It is therefore imperative to establish this possibility prior to determining the section capacities. Cross sections are classified in accordance with their geometrical properties and the stress pattern on the compression elements. For each load case considered in the design process, STAAD determines the section class and calculates the capacities accordingly. The EC3 (EN 1993) design module in STAAD can design members with all section profiles that are of Class 1, 2, or 3 as defined in section 5.5 of the code. However, the design of members that have a Class 4 section profile are limited to:
l

wide flange tee single channel single angle rectangular hollow sections circular hollow sections

Also built-up user sections that are class 4 sections are not dealt with in the current version of EC3 design in STAAD.Pro. The design of laced and battened members is not considered in the current version of EC3 (EN 1993) design module in STAAD.Pro.

304 STAAD.Pro

5B.5 (B) Member Design


EN 1993-1-1:2005, together with any specified National Annex, is used for code check or selection of all cross sections and shapes listed in Section 5B.4 (B). However, where EN 1993 or the National Annex has not specified a method or values for a specific clause or parameter, STAAD.Pro uses Non-Contradictory Complimentary Information (NCCI) documents as explained in the following corresponding sections. The design philosophy and procedural logistics are based on the principles of elastic analysis and ultimate limit state design. Two major failure modes are recognized:
l

failure by overstressing failure by stability considerations

The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the characteristic stresses or capacities. Member selection is done on the basis of selecting the most economic section on the basis of the least weight criteria. It is generally assumed that you (the engineer) will take care of the detailing requirements, such as the provision of stiffeners, and check the local effects like flange buckling, web crippling, etc. Note: The design of class 4 (slender) sections is limited to WIDE FLANGE, TEE, SINGLE CHANNEL, SINGLE ANGLE, and RECTANGULAR & CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS. The effective section properties are evaluated as described in Cl. 6.2.2.5 of the code. You are allowed complete control over the design process through the use of the parameters listed in Table 5B.3. Default values of parameters will yield reasonable results in most circumstances. However, you should control the design and verify results through the use of the design parameters.

5B.5(B).1 Members Subject to Axial Loads


The cross section capacity of tension only members is checked for ultimate limit state as given in Cl. 6.2.3 of the code.

International Design Codes Manual 305

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

Compression members will be checked for axial capacity of the cross section in addition to lateral buckling/stability. The cross section capacity will be checked as given in section 6.2.4 of the code. Lateral stability of a pure compression member will be checked as per the method given in Cl. 6.3 of the code. The compression member stability will be verified as:

Where N

b,Rd

is the design buckling resistance given by: for Class 1, 2, or 3 cross-sections for Class 4 cross-sections

Where: is the reduction factor as given in section 6.3.12 of the code. The buckling curves used to evaluate the reduction factor are selected from Table 6.2 of the code based on the cross section type and the steel grade. Note: Only the five grades of steel given in table 6.2 will be used when selecting the buckling curve. The steel grade used for this selection is based on the SGR design input parameter (See Section 5B.(6)B). Even if you have specified a custom yield strength (using the PY parameter), the choice of a buckling curve will be based on the value of SGR parameter. Compression members that are susceptible to torsional or torsional flexural buckling are checked for these modes of failure as well. The non-dimensional slenderness for these members is evaluated per Cl. 6.3.1.4 of the EN 1993 T code. The maximum slenderness among the flexural buckling slenderness, torsional slenderness, and torsional-flexural slenderness is used to evaluate the reduction factor, , for such members. The elastic torsional buckling load, N , cr,T and the elastic torsional-flexural buckling load, N , are evaluated based on the cr,TF method given in the NCCI SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes (unless otherwise specified by a particular National Annex). EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not specifically deal with single angle, double angles, double channels, or Tee sections and does not provide a method to work out the

306 STAAD.Pro

slenderness of such members. In these cases, the EC3 (EN 1993) design module of STAAD.Pro uses the methods specified in BS 5950-1:2000 to calculate the slenderness of these members. Cl. 4.7.10 and Table 25 of BS 5950-1:2000 are used in the current version of the Eurocode 3 design module.

Single Angle Sections


Angle sections are un-symmetrical and when using BS 5950:2000 table 25, four axes must be considered; two principal ( u-u and v-v) and two geometric (a-a and b-b). The effective length for the v-v axis, Lvv, is taken as the LVV parameter or LY KY, if not specified. The a-a and b-b axes are determined by which leg of the angle is fixed by the connection and should be specified using the LEG parameter, see section 5B.6 (B) for more information on the LEG parameter. The effective length in the a-a axis is taken as LY KY and the effective length in the b-b axis as LZ KZ. The following diagram shows the axes for angles which have been defined with either an ST or RA specification and is connected by its longer leg (i.e., a-a axis is parallel to the longer leg).
Figure 5.4 - Axis orientation for single angles

ST angle and USER table angles

RAangle

5B.5(B).2 Members Subject to Bending Moments


The cross section capacity of a member subject to bending is checked as per Cl .6.2.5 of the code. The condition to be satisfied is:

International Design Codes Manual 307

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

Where M

c,Rd

is the is the design resistance given by: for class 1 and 2 cross-sections for class 3 cross-sections for class 4 cross-sections

Cross sectional bending capacity checks will be done for both major and minor axis bending moments. Members subject to major axis bending will also be checked for Lateral Torsional Buckling resistance as per Section 6.3.2 of the code. The design buckling resistance moment M will be calculated as:
b,Rd

Where: is the reduction factor for lateral torsional buckling. This reduction LT factor is evaluated per Cl. 6.3.2.2 or Cl 6.3.2.3 of the EN 1993 code depending on the section type. For I sections, the program will by default use Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evalute and for all other sections the LT program will resort to Cl 6.3.2.2. However, if a particular National Annex has been specified, the program will check if the National Annex expands on Cl.6.3.2.3 (Table 6.5) to include sections other than I sections. If so, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 for the cross-section(s) included in Cl. 6.2.2.3 (or Table 6.5). For all other cases the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2. Note: You have the option to choose the clause to be used to calculate through the MTH design parameter. Setting MTH to 0 LT (default value) will cause the program to choose Cl.6.3.2.3 for I Sections and Cl 6.2.3.2 for all other section types. As mentioned above, if the National Annex expands on Cl. 6.3.2.3 to include

308 STAAD.Pro

sections other than I Sections, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 by default.

The non-dimensional slenderness (used to evaluate ) for both the above LT LT cases is evaluated as:

Where: M is the elastic critical moment for lateral torsional buckling. EN 1993cr 1-1 does not however specify a method to work out M . Hence, the cr program will make use of the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1 to work out M by default.
cr

Note: The method specified in Annex F will be used only when the raw EN 1993-1-1:2005 code is used without any National Annex. If a National Annex has been specified, the calculation of M (and ) cr LT will be done based on the specific National Annex. (See "5B.(C) European Codes - National Annexes to Eurocode 3 [EN 1993-11:2005]" on page 343 for specific details). If the National Annex does not specify a particular method or specify a reference document, the program will use the NCCI document SN-003a-ENEU for doubly symmetric sections and SN030a-EN-EU for monosymmetric sections that are symmetric about their weak axis. For all other sections types the program will use Annex F of DD ENV 19931-1 to calculate Mcr.

5B.5(B).3 Members Subject to Shear


The cross section capacity of a member subject to shear is checked as per Cl. 6.2.6 of the code. The condition to be satisfied is:

Where: V
c,Rd

is the is the shear design resistance given by:

International Design Codes Manual 309

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

Av is the shear area and is worked out for the various section types as given in Cl. 6.2.6(3) of the code.

5B.5(B).4 Members Subject to Torsion


Note: This feature requires STAAD.Pro V8i (SELECTseries 2) build 2007.07 or later.

General
Eurocode 3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005) gives very limited guidance for the analysis and design of torsion members. While both elastic and plastic analyses are permitted generally, the design analysis methods for torsion discussed within EC3 are primarily based on elastic methods. Also, only the first yield design resistance is specifically discussed for torsion members. Furthermore, there is no guidance on section classification nor on how to allow for the effects of local buckling on the design resistance for combined torsional effects. EC3 also does not specifically deal with members subject to combined bending and torsion and loosely states that the yield criteria (Eqn 6.1 in the code) can be used for elastic verification. The method used by STAAD.Pro is therefore based on the SCI publication P057: Design of members subject to combined bending and torsion. Though this publication is based on the British standard BS 5950-1, the principles from this document are applied in the context of Eurocode 3. Note: At the time this feature has been implemented in STAAD.Pro, SCI are in the process of updating document P057 to be in accordance with Eurocode 3. Hence this method might be subject to modifications subject to the publication of a newer version of P057. The NCCI document SN007b-EN-EU: Torsion will also be referenced where appropriate.

Code Basis
Torsion design in EC3 is given in Cl. 6.2.7 of EN 1993-1-1:2005. Therefore, this clause is used primarily for this implementation.

310 STAAD.Pro

EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not deal with members subject to the combined effects of torsion and lateral torsional buckling. However, EN 1993-1-6 considers such a condition in Appendix A. Therefore, STAAD.pro uses Appendix A of EN 1993-1-6 to check for members subject to combined torsion and LTB. The following clauses from EC3 are then considered:
l

Cl. 6.2.7(1) Cl. 6.2.7(9) Cl. 6.2.7(5) EC-3 -6 App A

Note: STAAD.Pro does, however, use this clause (6.2.7) to report the output for all torsion checks. Also any distortional deformations and any amplification in the torsional or shear stresses due to distortions will be neglected by the program.

Clause 6.2.7(1)
States that for members subject to torsion, the design torsional moment T Ed at each cross section should satisfy: T
Ed

/R

Rd

1.0

Where: T
Rd

is the design torsional resistance of the cross section.

This is the primary condition that will need to be satisfied for members subject to torsion. The method for working out the torsional resistance T , Rd for the various cases is dealt in the following sections.
l

Cl. 6.2.7(9)
States that: For combined shear force and torsional moment, the plastic shear resistance accounting for torsional effects should be reduced from

International Design Codes Manual 311

European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3

pl,Rd

to V V
Ed

pl,T,Rd

and the design shear force should satisfy: 1.0

/V

pl,T,Rd

The code also gives means to evaluate V in equations 6.26 to 6.28. pl,T,Rd These equations, however, only deal with I/H sections, Channel sections, and structural hollow sections (RHS, SHS, CHS). Therefore, the application of Cl. 6.2.7(9) is only performed for these section profiles.
l

Cl 6.2.7(5)
States that the yield criteria given in Cl. 6.2.1(5) of EN 1993-1-1:2005 may be used for elastic verification. STAAD.Pro evaluates the stresses due to the various actions on the cross section and applies this yield criterion.

The program allows for two types of checks for members subject to torsion for EC3 design: I. Basic Stress Check: This method is intended to be a simplified stress check for torsional effects. This method will produce the output corresponding to Cl. 6.2.7(5) of EN 1993-1-1. II. Detailed Checks: This method will perform a full torsional analysis of the member. All four of the clause checks mentioned earlier will be performed. The details of these checks are as described below. You have the option to choose the method to be used for a specific member or group of members. This will be facilitated by setting the value of the TORSION design parameter to one of the following values: TORSION value 0 Description (Default)Include basic stress checks, only if member is subject to torsion. Include torsion (Basic stress check excluding warping effects). Include torsion (Detailed checks including warping effects). Ignore all torsion checks

1 2 3

312 STAAD.Pro

The TORSION parameter will have a value of zero (0) by default. This will cause the program to trigger the torsion checks only if the member is subject to torsional moments. For this default setting, the program will ignore torsion checks if there is no torsional moment in the member. Setting the value of the TORSION parameter to three (3) will cause the program to ignore all torsional moments. The detailed output (i.e., TRACK 2) will indicate that torsion has been ignored for that particular member. The details of setting the values to one (1) or two (2) and the corresponding checks performed are as described below. Note: If the TORSION parameter is set to 1 or 2, the program will perform the appropriate checks even if the member is not subject to torsional moments. In such cases, the program will perform the checks with a value of zero for the torsional moment.

5B.5(B).4.1 Basic stress check


This method is used when the TORSIONparameter is specified as one (1). This method is intended to be a simplified stress check for torsional effects per Cl. 6.2.7(5). Any warping stresses that may develop due to the end conditions will be ignored for this option. The program will consider the forces (including torsion) at various sections along the length of the member and for each section, will calculate the resultant stress (Von Mieses) at various points on the cross section. The location and number of points checked for a cross section will depend on the cross section type and will be as described below. The stress check will be performed using equation 6.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005 as given below:

Where:
x,Ed z,Ed

is the longitudinal stress is the transverse stress and

Ed

is the resultant shear stress.

International Design Codes Manual 313

5B.5(B).4.1 Basic stress check

Note: Since transverse stresses are very small under normal loading conditions (excluding hydrostatic forces), the term will be negligible and hence is taken as zero.
x,Ed

= +
x

bz

+
y

by

= F /A + M /Z + M /Z
x x z z y z z y

Ed

= T/J t + V Q/(I t) + V Q/(I *t)

Where: T is the torsion at the particular section along the length of the member J is the torsion constant t is the thickness of the web/flange V is the shear force Q is the statical moment about the relevant axis I is the second moment of area about the relevant axis The stress check as per equation 6.1 is performed at various stress points of a cross section as shown in figures below: Shape Doubly symmetric wide flange profile Section Sketch

314 STAAD.Pro

Shape Pipe profiles

Section Sketch

Tube profiles = tan1(M /M )


z y

International Design Codes Manual 315

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Shape Channel profiles Section Sketch

The resultant ratio will be reported under Cl. 6.2.7(5) in the detailed design output.

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check


This method is used when the TORSIONparameter is specified as two (2). This method performs a detailed torsional analysis of a member depending on the torsion loading conditions and the support conditions at the member ends. This method is based on the SCI publication P057 and includes any warping stresses (direct warping stresses and warping shear stresses) depending on the end conditions of the member. This implementation considers seven different cases of loading and end conditions as given in publication P057 Section 6. The loading/end conditions for a member are specified by the use of the CMT design parameter (refer to Table 5B1.5(B) for parameter values and descriptions). All the equations used to evaluate the torsional moments and associated stresses are as given in Appendix B of P057. The resultant stresses are evaluated at various sections along the length of the member and the following checks will be performed:

316 STAAD.Pro

Clause 6.2.7(1) Torsional resistance of the section.


In general, the torsion at any section T
Ed

is resolved into two components, viz.


t,Ed

The pure torsional (St. Venants) moment (T The warping torsional moment(T Therefore, T
Ed w,Ed

) and

=T

t,Ed

+T

w,Ed

= GJ = EH

[Ref SCI pub. P057] Where: and are the first and third derivates of twist ( ), respectively, and depend on the end conditions and loading. These are evaluated from the equations in Annex B of P057 and are based the specified CMT parameter. Note: Although the equation given the NCCI document SN007b-EN-EU can be used to evaluate T , the NCCI does not give the eqn. to evaluate . wrd Therefore, Annex B of P057 is used. The torsional resistance of the section is also considered as the sum of the pure torsion resistance and the warping torsion resistance. The pure torsion resistance (T ) and the warping torsional resistance (T ) are evaluated as:
t,Rd w,Rd

For closed sections: T


t,Rd

=2A t
c

max

Where: A is the area enclosed by the mean perimeter


c

t is the max thickness


max

is the max. allowable shear stress = (fy/3)/ m0

For open sections (I & channel): T


t,Rd

max

J/t

Where: International Design Codes Manual 317

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

J is the torsion const t is the max thickness. T Where: b is the width of the section t is the thickness of the flange for I- sections; minimum of flange or web thickness channel sections The check according to Cl 6.2.7(1) will then be performed to ensure that the following conditions are satisfied: T T T
t,Ed w,Ed Ed w,Rd

= (f /
y

m0

) t b2 / 6

/T

t,Rd

1 1

/T

w,Rd

/T

Rd

Clause 6.2.7(9) Plastic shear resistance due to torsion.


STAAD.Pro checks for shear resistance of a section based on Cl. 6.2.6 for EC3 and the plastic shear resistance (in the absence of torsion) is evaluated as:

Where: A is as pre Cl.6.2.6 (3) for the various sections


v

When torsion is present, along with the shear force, the design shear resistance will be reduced to V , where V is evaluated as follows:
pl,T,Rd pl,T,Rd

i. For I or H Sections:

ii. For Channel Sections:

318 STAAD.Pro

iii. For Structural Hollow Sections:

Where
t,Ed

is the shear stress due to direct (St. Venants) torsion and is the shear stress due to warping torsion.
t,Ed

w,Ed

The various shear stresses due to torsion i. For Closed sections:

and

w,Ed

are evaluated as follows:

The shear stresses due to warping can be ignored as they will be insignificant and hence:
t,Ed

=T

Ed

/(2A t)
c

[Ref NCCI Sn007b-EN-EU] Where: T


Ed c

is the applied torsion,

A is the area delimited by the mean perimeter and t is the thickness of the cross section
w,Ed

= 0, since warping is ignored

ii. For Open sections [I, H, Channel] sections: For I and H sections, the web will not be subject to warping stresses and therefore warping shear can be ignored ( =0).
w,Ed

The stress due to pure torsion is evaluated as:


t,Ed

= Gt

[Ref SCI pub. P057] Where:

International Design Codes Manual 319

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

G is the shear modulus is a function depending on the end condition and loading(T). This will be taken from section 6 and Annex B of P057. Note: Although the maximum stress is at the thickest section of the profile, the program uses the web thickness for this clause (since the shear capacity is based on the web area) unless the load is parallel to the flanges, in which case the flange thickness is used. For channel sections that are free to warp at the supports and, thus, are not subject to warping stresses: The warping shear stress is evaluated as:
w,Ed

= ES / t
w

[Ref SCI pub. P057] Where: E is the elastic modulus, S is the warping statistical moment and
w

is a function depending on the end condition and loading(T). This will be taken from section 6 and Annex B of P057. t is the thickness of the element.

Clause 6.2.7(5) Check for elastic verification of yield


Eurocode 3 gives yield criterion as per eqn. 6.1 and STAAD.Pro uses the yield criterion given in EC-3. When a member is subject to combined bending and torsion, some degree of interaction occurs between the two effects. The angle of twist caused by torsion is amplified by the bending moments and will induce additional warping moments and torsional shears. Account must also be taken of the additional minor axis moments produced by the major axis moments acting through the torsional deformations, including the amplifications mentioned earlier.

320 STAAD.Pro

For members subject to bending and torsion, the stresses are evaluated as follows: Direct bending stress (major axis): Direct bending stress (minor axis):
bz by

=M /Z
z

z y

=M /Z
y ns

Direct stress due to warping: w = EW Direct stress due to twist (min. axis):
byt c

=M /Z
yt

Direct stress due to axial load (if any): = P/ A Where: M is the major axis moment & My is the minor axis moment.
z

is the differential function based on twist (ref P057 Annex B. & Table 6) W
ns yt

is the normalized warping function.


z

M = M (see Appendix B of P057 to evaluate ) Shear stresses due to torsion and/or warping is evaluated as described above for Clause 6.2.7(9). Check for yield (capacity checks) is then done according to Eqn 6.1 of EN 1993-11:2005, as described for the Basic Stress Check (TORSION = 1):

Clause EC-3:6 App A Check for combined Torsion and Lateral Torsional buckling
The interaction check due to the combined effects of bending (including lateral torsional buckling) and torsion will be checked using Annex A of EN 1993-1-6: 2007. Note that this interaction equation does not include the effects of any axial load. Warning: At present, SCI advises that no significant work has been published for this case and work is still ongoing. So at present is advisable not to allow for torsion in a member with large axial load. Members subject to combined bending and torsion will be checked to satisfy:

International Design Codes Manual 321

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Where: C is the equivalent uniform moment factor for bending about the z-z mz axis, according to EN 1993-1-1 Table B.3.

M and M are the design values of the maximum moment about y,Ed z,Ed the y-y and z-z axis, respectively. M and M are the characteristic values of the resistance moment y,Rk z,Rk of the cross-section about it y-y and z-z axis, respectively, from EN 1993-1-1, Table 6.7. M is the elastic critical lateral-torsional buckling moment about the y,cr y-y axis. T
w,Ed

is the design value of the warping torsional moment.

T is the characteristic value of the warping torsional resistance w,Rk moment. is the reduction factor for lateral torsional buckling according to LT 6.3.2 of EN 1993-1-1. Note: For all of the above checks the effective length of the member to be used for torsion can be set by using the EFT design parameter.

322 STAAD.Pro

5B.5(B).5 Members Subject to Combined Forces

Members subject to Bending and Axial Force


When a member is subject to a combined axial load and a bending moment, the program evaluates a reduced moment capacity based on Cl. 6.2.9 of the code. For Class 1, 2, and 3 sections, the program evaluates the reduced moment from the equations given in Cl. 6.2.9.1 of the code. For class 4 sections, the interaction equation given by equation 6.44 are checked. In the case of members subject to axial load and biaxial bending, the program will consider the interaction equation 6.41 of the code. Note: By default, the program will use the values of the constants and as given in the code for the different sections types. However, you can override these values using the ALPHA and BETA design parameters (See Section 5B.6(B)).

Note: The program uses the parameter ELB (See Section 5B.6(B)) to override the Cl.6.2.9 checks for combined axial load and bending case. When specfied as 1, the program uses the more general equation 6.2 of EN 1993-1-1, instead.

Members subject to Bending, Shear, and Axial Force


When a member is subject to a combined axial load, shear force, and a bending moment, the program evaluates the reduced yield strength as given in Cl 6.2.10 (3) of the code. The reduction in the yield strength is done only when the applied shear force exceeds 50% of the design shear resistance V . This reduced yield pl,Rd strength is then used to evaluate the reduced moment capacity of the section.

Members subject to Bending and Axial Compression


The bending resistance of members could be reduced by the presence of a coexistent axial load. This is then checked against the lateral-torsional buckling

International Design Codes Manual 323

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

resistance of the section. The EN 1993 design module in STAAD takes such a scenario into account and performs the necessary checks as per Cl. 6.3.3 of the code. Generally, EC3 requires checking cross-section resistance for local capacity and also checking the overall buckling capacity of the member. In the case of members subject to axial tension and bending, there is provision to take the stabilizing effect of the tension load into consideration. This is achieved by modifying the extreme compression fibre stress and calculating an effective applied moment for the section. The checks are done as per Cl. 6.2.9 of the code. In case of a combined axial compressive load and bending moment, the member is checked per the rules in section 6.3.3 of the code. The program checks to ensure that both the interaction equations 6.61 and 6.62 of the code are satisfied. The interaction factors kzz, kyy, kzy & kyz will be evaluated using Annex B of EN 1993-1-1 by default. Hence for the EN 1993-1-1 code in STAAD.Pro (without National Annexes), uses Annex B. The choice between using Annex A and Annex B will be based on the choice specified by a particular National Annex, if used. If the National Annex itself gives a choice between Annex A and Annex B, the program uses Annex B to evaluate the interaction factors. Note: EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not specifically deal with single angle, double angles, double channels or Tee sections and does give a method to work out the slenderness of such members. In these cases, the Eurocode 3 (EN 1993-11) design module of STAAD.Pro uses the methods specified in BS 5950-1:2000 to calculate the slenderness of these members. Cl. 4.7.10 of BS 5950-1:2000 is used in the current version of the EC3 design module. Please refer to Section 5B.5.2 for ST and RA angle specifications.

Note: Laced or battened compression members are not dealt within the current version of EC3 (EN 1993) design module in STAAD.Pro.

5B.6(B) Design Parameters


Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular structure.

324 STAAD.Pro

Depending on the model being designed, you may have to change some or all of the parameter default values. Some parameters are unit dependent and when altered, the n setting must be compatible with the active unit specification. Table 5B.1 (B) lists all the relevant EC3 parameters together with description and default values. Table 5B.4 - Steel Design Parameters EC3 EN Parameter Name CODE Default Value Must be specified as EN 1993-11:2005 to invoke design per Eurocode 3:2005 (EN 1993). Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. ALH 0.5 The ratio of the distance of the point torque (from the start of the member) to the length of the member. The default value of 0.5 represents torque acting at the mid-span of a symmetrically loaded member. Values can range from 0 to 1. ALPHA 1.0 Used to input a user defined value for the factor in equation 6.41 for combined bending and axial force checks. BEAM 3 Parameter to control the number of sections to checked along the length of a beam: 0. Check sections with end Description

International Design Codes Manual 325

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name Default Value forces only 1. Check at location of maximum Mz along beam 2. Check sections with end forces and forces at location of BEAM1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th point along the beam and report the maximum BETA 1.0 Used to input a user defined value for the factor in equation 6.41 for combined bending and axial force checks. C1 1.132 Corresponds to the C1 factor to be used to calculate Elastic critical moment M as per Clause 6.3.2.2
cr

Description

C2

0.459

Corresponds to the C2 factor to be used to calculate Elastic critical moment M as per Clause 6.3.2.2
cr

C3

Corresponds to the C3 factor to be used to calculate Elastic critical moment M as per Clause 6.3.2.2
cr

CAN

Member will be considered as a cantilever type member for deflection checks. 0 indicates that member will not be

326 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

treated as a cantilever member 1 indicates that the member will be treated as a cantilever member CMM 1.0 Indicates type of loading and support conditions on member. Can take a value from 1 to 8. Refer to Table 5B1.4(B) for more information on its use. CMN 1.0 Indicates the level of EndRestraint. 1.0 = No fixity 0.5 = Full fixity 0.7 = One end free and other end fixed CMT 1 Used to indicate the loading and support condition for torsion. Can take a value of 1-7. Refer to table 5B1.5(B) for more information DFF None for deflection "Deflection Length" / Maxm.

(Mandatory allowable local deflection See Note 1d below.

International Design Codes Manual 327

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name Default Value check, TRACK 4.0) DJ1 Start Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" . See Note 1 below. DJ2 End Joint of member Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length". See Note 1 below. DMAX 100.0 cm Maximum allowable depth for the member. DMIN 0 Minimum required depth for the member. EFT Member Length Effective length for torsion. A value of 0 defaults to the member length. ELB 0 Used to specify the method for combined axial load + bending checks 0. Uses Cl. 6.2.9 of EN 1993-11:2005 1. Uses Cl. 6.2.1(7) - Eqn. 6.2 of EN 1993-1-1:2005 ESTIFF 0 (For use with the Dutch NA only) Method for checking columns forming part of (non)/buttressed framework: Description

328 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

0. Checks per Cl 12.3.1.2.3 of NEN 6770: Section 1 1. Checks per Cl 12.3.1.2.3 of NEN 6770: Section 2 FU GM0 0 1.1 Ultimate tensile strength of steel. Corresponds to the EN 1993-1-1:2005 GM1 1.1 Corresponds to the EN 1993-1-1:2005 GM2 1.1 Corresponds to the EN 1993-1-1:2005 GST 0 Used to specify the section type to be used for designing a General Section from the user table. The member will be considered as the specified type with the user defined properties. The available options and corresponding values are as below: 0. I-Section 1. Single Channel 2. Rectangular Hollow Section 3. Circular Hollow Section 4. Angle Section 5. Tee Section
m2 m1 m0

factor in

factor in

factor in

International Design Codes Manual 329

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name Default Value Note: This parameter will be ignored if it has been assigned to any section other than a General Section. KC 1.0 Corresponds to the correction factor as per Table 6.6 of EN 1993-11:2005. Program will calculate kc automatically if this parameter is set to 0. KY KZ LEG 1.0 1.0 0 K factor in local y axis. K factor in local z axis. Slenderness values for angles as determined from BS 5950-2000 Table 25. See "2B.6 Design Parameters" on page 90 LVV Max. value Leg length for Lvv (length about vof Lyy v- aces of single angle section), as per Lyy. Used for slenderness calculations. LY Member Length Compression length in local y axis, Slenderness ratio = (KY)*(LY)/(Ryy) LZ Member Length Compression length in local z axis, Slenderness ratio = (KZ)*(LZ)/(Rzz) Description

330 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name MU

Default Value 0

Description

To be used with CMM values of 7 and 8. See Table 5B1.4(B). Currently valid only with the French NA.

MTH

Used to select the clause to be used to calculate the LTB reduction factor, . The available options
LT

and corresponding values are as below: 0. Use default method based on section type (default) 1. Use Cl.6.3.2.2 2. Use Cl.6.3.2.3 By default, the program will use Cl 6.3.2.3 for rolled & built-up Isections and Cl. 6.3.2.2 for all other sections. If, however, the specified National Annex expands on Cl. 6.3.2.3 to include other section types (e.g., the UK NA), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 by default for that particular section type. See "5B.(C) European Codes National Annexes to Eurocode 3 [EN 1993-1-1:2005]" on page 343 for additional details on NAdocuments.

International Design Codes Manual 331

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name NA Default Value 0 Choice of National Annex to be used for EC3 design. (see 5B1.2(B) for more information) NSF 1.0 Net tension factor for tension capacity calculation. PLG 0 To be used to determine whether to include the additional interaction checks as per CL. NA.20(2) and NA.20(3) of the Polish National Annex. Note: This parameter will be applicable only to the Polish NA PY Yield Strength The yield strength default value is set based on the default value of the SGR parameter. RATIO 1 Permissible ratio of loading to capacity. SBLT 0.0 Indicates if the section is rolled or built-up. 0.0 = Rolled 1.0 = Built-up SGR 0 Steel grade as in table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005 Description

332 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

0.0 - indicates S 235 grade steel 1.0 - indicates S 275 grade steel 2.0 - indicates S 355 grade steel 3.0 - indicates S 420 grade steel 4.0 - indicates S 460 grade steel Note: As EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not provide a buckling curve in table 6.2 for grade S 450 steel (in Table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005), the program will use the same buckling curves as for grade S 460 when calculating the buckling resistance as per clause 6.3. STIFF Member Length or depth of beam, whichever is greater Distance between transverse stiffener plates, used to prevent web shear buckling. If not specified or if a value of 0 is provided, the program will assume the web is unstiffened.

International Design Codes Manual 333

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name TOM Default Value 0 Total torsion for design used for torsion checks. TORSION 0 Method to be used for a specific member or group of members: 0. Perform basic torsion checks if member is subject to torsion. 1. Perform basic stress check (Ignore warping effects). 2. Perform detailed checks (including warping effects). 3. Ignore all torsion checks Note: For options 1 or 2, the program will perform the torsion related checked even if torsional moment is absent and will use a value of zero for the torsional moment. TRACK 0 Specify level of detail in output. 0. Summary of results only. 1. Summary with member capacities. 2. Detailed results. 3. Deflection check results. Description

334 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name UNF

Default Value 1

Description

Unsupported length as a fraction of the actual member length.

UNL

Member Length

Unrestraint length of member used in calculating the lateral-torsional resistance moment of the member.

ZG

+Section Depth/2

Distance of transverse load from shear center. Used to calculate M .


cr

Note: For Tee sections, ZG will have a default value of (+Flange thickness/2) Notes: 1. CAN, DJ1, and DJ2 Deflection a. When performing the deflection check, you can choose between two methods. The first method, defined by a value 0 for the CAN parameter, is based on the local displacement. Local displacement is described in Section 5.44 of the Technical Reference Manual. If the CAN parameter is set to 1, the check will be based on cantilever style deflection. Let (DX1, DY1, DZ1) represent the nodal displacements (in global axes) at the node defined by DJ1 (or in the absence of DJ1, the start node of the member). Similarly, (DX2, DY2, DZ2) represent the deflection values at DJ2 or the end node of the member. Compute Delta = SQRT((DX2 - DX1)2 + (DY2 - DY1)2 + (DZ2 - DZ1)2) Compute Length = distance between DJ1 & DJ2 or, between start node and end node, as the case may be. Then, if CAN is specified a value 1, dff = L/Delta Ratio due to deflection = DFF/dff

International Design Codes Manual 335

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

b. If CAN = 0, deflection length is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the Deflection Length will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the Deflection Length may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.

D = Maximum local deflection for members 1, 2, and 3.


PARAMETERS DFF 300. ALL DJ1 1 ALL DJ2 4 ALL

c. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. d. It is important to note that unless a DFF value is specified, STAAD will not perform a deflection check. This is in accordance with the fact that there is no default value for DFF (see Table 2B.1). e. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design. 2. NA Parameter The values for NA parameter are as follows:

336 STAAD.Pro

Table 5B.5 - Table 5B1.2(B) - Numerical Code for Eurocode National Annex NAValue 0 Country Uses the base EN 1993-1-1:2005 code. The default values specified in En 1993-1-1:2005 will be used for the partial safety factors and various parameter values where applicable (default). United Kingdom (British NA) Uses the BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of Eurocode 3 along with the UK National Annex. Netherlands (Dutch NA) Uses the NEN EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of the code. The Dutch National Annex [NEN-EN 1993-11/NB] has been added in this module. Please note that the Dutch National requires additional checks as per NEN 6770 and NEN 6771 which will also be performed during design checks with this parameter value 3 Norway (Norwegian NA) Uses the NS-EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of the code. The Norwegian National Annexe [ NS-EN 1993-11:2005/Na 2008] has been added to this implementation. France (French NA) Uses the Annexe Nationale a la NF EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of the code along with the French National Annex.. Finland (Finnish NA) - Uses the SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of Eurocode 3 along with the Finnish National Annex. Poland (Polish NA) - Uses the PN EN 1993-11:2005 version of Eurocode 3 along with the Polish National Annex.

International Design Codes Manual 337

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

3. CMM Parameter The values of CMM for various loading and support conditions are as given below: Table 5B.6 - Values for the CMM Parameter CMM Value 1 Loading and Support Conditions

varying end moments and uniform loading 8

varying end moments and central point load 4. Checking beam deflection

338 STAAD.Pro

With the TRACK parameter set to 4, the members included in a BEAM CHECK command will be checked for the local axis deflection rather than for the stress capacity using the current LOAD LIST. If both stress capacity and deflection checks are required, then 2 parameter blocks with code checks are required, one with a TRACK 4 command and one with a TRACK 0, 1 or 2, thus:
LOAD LIST 1 TO 10 PARAMETER 1 CODE EN 1993 TRACK 2 ALL CODE CHECK MEMBER 1 *************************** LOAD LIST 100 TO 110 PARAMETER 2 TRACK 4 ALL DFF 300 MEMB 1 DJ1 1 MEMB 1 DJ2 4 MEMB 1 CHECK CODE MEMB 1

Note: While both sets of code checks will be reported in the output file, only the last code check results are reported in the STAAD.Pro graphical interface. 5. CMT Parameter The values of CMM for various loading and support conditions are as given below:

International Design Codes Manual 339

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Table 5B.7 - Loading and Support Conditions represented by CMT Parameter Values CMT Value 1 Description Diagram

(Default) : Concentrated Torque at Ends. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Concentrated Torque along length of member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping free Concentrated Torque along length of member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Uniform Torque in member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping free Uniform Torque in member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Concentrated Torque in cantilever. End Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Uniform Torque in cantilever. End Torsion fixed and Warping fixed

Note: For CMT = 2 and CMT = 3, you have the option of specifying the distance at which the concentrated torque acts, measured from the start of the member. This can be done by using the ALH design parameter. The ALH parameter indicates the ratio of the distance of the point torque

340 STAAD.Pro

(from the start of the member) to the length of the member. This parameter will have a default value of 0.5 (i.e., the torque acts at the center of the span) and will accept values ranging from 0 to 1.

5B.7(B) CodeChecking
The purpose of code checking is to ascertain whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked as per EN 19931-1:2005 and a corresponding National Annex (if specified). Code checking is done using the forces and moments at specific sections of the members. When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks; the critical condition; the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value); the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the member of forces in the member where the critical condition occurs). Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2B.4 or any of the user defined sections as described in Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual, with the exception of ISECTION. ISECTION has been currently excluded since the option of Tapered section design is currently not supported in the EC3 module. The EC3 (EN 1993) design module does not consider these sections or PRISMATIC sections in its design process. Note: Checks for slender sections to EN 1993-1-1 are limited to I-SECTIONS, TEE, SINGLE CHANNEL, SINGLE ANGLE and CIRCULAR & RECTANGULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS. Code checking for GENERAL sections can be also done using the EN1993 module. The program will design GENERAL sections as I sections by default. However, you are given the option to choose a section type to be considered while designing the member. Refer to the description of the GST design parameter in Section 5B.6 (B) for details.

5B.8(B) Member Selection


STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section,

International Design Codes Manual 341

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

i.e., the lightest section, which fulfills the code requirements for the specified member. The section selected will be of the same type section as originally designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN, which limits the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Member selection can be performed with all the types of steel sections with the same limitations as defined in Section 5B.7(B) - Code Checking. Selection of members, whose properties are originally input from a user created table, will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic or as the limitations specified in Section 5.B.7(B)

5B.9(B) TabulatedResultsofSteelDesign
For code checking or member selection, the program produces the results in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. MEMBER refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b. TABLE refers to steel section name, which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c. RESULTS prints whether the member has PASSED or FAILED. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark on front of the member. d. CRITICAL CONDrefers to the clause in EN 1993-1-1:2005 code which governs the design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number, which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZprovide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis and the moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern.

342 STAAD.Pro

Note: For a TRACK 2 output, the module will also report all the relevant clause checks that have been performed and will also indicate the critical ratio and the load case that caused the critical ratio as well as the corresponding forces that were used for the respective checks. A TRACK 2 output will also include the various design data used for the calculations such as the section modulii, section class, section capacity etc. If an NA parameter (other than 0) has been specified and if the particular National Annex requires additional checks outside those specified in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (e.g., The Dutch National Annex), the respective NA clauses and any associated code clauses will be listed along with the critical ratios and the forces that were used for these clause checks.

5B.(C) European Codes - National Annexes to Eurocode 3 [EN 1993-1-1:2005]


A number of countries that have signed up to the replace their current steel design standards with the Eurocode, EN 1993-1-1:2005, known commonly as Eurocode 3, have published their National Annex documents. These documents make small changes to thebase document and STAAD.Pro has been updated to incorporate some of these NationalAnnex documents.

Description
The parameter NA sets the default material gamma factors and any additionalchanges outlined in the country specific National Annex such as specific equations ormethods. The output file printout has been updated to indicate which National Annex (if any) hasbeen used in a code check / select process. (For all TRACK settings) Note: This Eurocode 3 design code is secured using the 'Eurocode Design' code pack.

General Format
The format of the EN 1993-1-1:2005 National Annex is as follows:
CODE EN 1993

International Design Codes Manual 343

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

NA

f1

{Code parameters: See Eurocode 3 parameters} Where: f1 represents the number designation for a specific country's National Annex: Table 5B.8 - Numerical Code for Eurocode National Annex NAValue 0 Country None. This value represents using the base code only, with no national annex changes or additions (default). United Kingdom (British NA) Netherlands (Dutch NA) Norway (Norwegian NA) France (French NA) Finland (Finnish NA) Poland (Polish NA)

1 2 3 4 5 6

Specifying the design engine to use a National Annex with EC 3


Use the following procedure to include additional check specified by a National Annex: 1. In the Modeling mode, select the Design |Steel tab. The Steel Design - Whole Structure dialog box opens. 2. In the Current Code drop-down menu, select EN 1993-1-1:2005. 3. Click Define Parameters. The Design Parameters dialog box opens.

344 STAAD.Pro

4. Select the NAparameter in the list box. 5. Select the option corresponding to the National Annex document you want to use . 6. Click Add. This will insert the following commands into the STAAD input file: CODE EN 1993-1-1:2005 NA 8 Refer to EC3 steel design for additional information on steel design per EC3. A design performed to the new Eurocode 3 National Annex is displayed in the outputfile (*.ANL) with the following header, in addition to the base EC3 output.

5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex


Purpose
Adds values from the Dutch National Annex - titled NEN-EN 1993-1-1/NB - for use with Eurocode 3, or EN 1993-1-1:2005. The NA document makes small changes to the base document.

International Design Codes Manual 345

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that require additional clauses from the Dutch National Annex (hereafter referred to as D-NA) are:
l

6.1 General 6.2.8 Bending and shear 6.2.10 Bending shear and axial force 6.3 Buckling resistance of members 6.3.1.3 Slenderness for flexural buckling 6.3.1.4 Slenderness for torsional and torsional-flexural buckling 6.3.2.2 Lateral torsional buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3 Lateral torsional buckling curves for rolled sections or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.4 Simplified assessment methods for beams 6.3.3 Members in bending and axial compression

Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the UK-NA.

Note: The local axis convention in the Dutch codes is: Y major axis & Z minor axis (as opposed to the convention followed in STAAD.Pro).

346 STAAD.Pro

Clause 6.1 General


The partial safety factors will use the following values: Resistance of cross-sections- M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability- M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension- M2 = 1.25 The design function in STAAD.Pro will set these values as the default values for the D-NA. The user is still however allowed to modify these factors using the parameters in the design input.

Clause 6.2.8 Bending and shear


The D-NA requires the implementation of causes 11.3.1.1 and 11.3.1.3 of NEN 6770.

Clause 11.3.1.1 (NEN 6770): Class 1 and Class 2 Isection profiles


Class 1 and class 2 I section profiles must satisfy the interaction formulae given in tables 10 & 11 of NEN 6770.

International Design Codes Manual 347

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Table 10: Provides interaction checks for bending about the major axis (All necessary terms and formulae are described below):
l

Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.1 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.2 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-3 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-4

Where: Vz;s;d= Actual Shear force in the section along Z- axis Vz;pl;d= Shear capacity of section along Z - axis = Aw x fy;d / 3 - See fig below for Aw ; fy;d = yield stress
Figure 5.5 - Definition of A
w

Aw = A - 2 (bf - tw - 2r) tf Ns;d= Axial force in the section Npl;d= Axial capacity of section = A x fy;d My;s;d= Bending moment about major axis

348 STAAD.Pro

My;pl;d= Plastic moment capacity of section = fy;d x Wy;pl Wy;pl = Plastic section modulus a1 = = min( A-2bfx tf)/A , 0.5)- used in tables 10 & 11 a2 = = see eqn 11.3-10- used in tables 10 & 11 Mv;y;ud= see eqn 11.3.12 N;v;u;d= see eqn 11.3-13 Table 11: Provides interaction formulae for bending about the minor axis
l

Check #1 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3-5 Check #2 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3-6 Check #3 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-7 Check #4 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-8

Where: Vy;s;d= Actual Shear force in the section along Y- axis Vy;pl;d= Shear capacity of section along Y - axis = Aw x fy;d / 3 - See fig below for Aw ; fy;d = yield stress

Mv;z;u;d = q x Mz;pld = q x fy;d x Wpl;z;d (Wpl;z;d = plastic section modulus about minor axis) & q as per eqn 11.3-14 Nv;u;d = N;pl;d 2(1-q)bf x tf x fy;d

Clause 11.3.1.3 ( NEN 6770) : Class 1 and Class 2 Square and rectangular hollow sections
This clause requires class 1 and class 2 square and rectangular tube profiles to satisfy the interaction equations in Table 13.

International Design Codes Manual 349

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.22 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.23 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-24 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-25

Where Vz;s;d= Actual Shear force in the section along Z- axis Vz;pl;d= Shear capacity of section along Z axis [ b breadth and h = height of section ; A= area of section]

a3 = min( (A-2xbxt)/A , 0.5) a4 = from equation 11.3.27

Clause 6.2.10 Bending shear and axial force


Requires the implementation of clauses 11.3.1.1 to 11.3.1.3 and 11.3.2.1 to 11.3.2.3 of NEN 6770 and clause 11.3 of NEN 6771

Clause 11.3.1.1 (NEN 6770) and Clause 11.3.1.3 ( NEN 6770)


See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document described above.

Clause 11.3.1.2 (NEN 6770): Class 1 and class 2 circular hollow (CHS) profiles
Class 1 and class 2 sections with circular hollow profiles should satisfy the interaction equations given in table 12.

350 STAAD.Pro

Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d check equation 11.3.17 Check #2 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d check equation 11.3.18.

See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to derive Vz;s;d Vz;pl;d = Shear capacity of CHS sections

See equations 11.3-19 and 11.3-20 to evaluate Mv;y;u;d and N;v;u;d. To check for these conditions about the y axis, substitute the index z in the above equations with y (should be the same of CHS sections).

Clause 11.3.2 ( NEN 6770)


Section 11.3.2 in general deals with Biaxial bending with axial force and shear. The general condition to be satisfied in this case is given by equation 11.3-31 of NEN 6770

Clause 11.3.2.1 : Class 1 and class2 I-sections with biaxial bending + shear + axial force
The formula to evaluate M;N;v;y;u;d and M;N;v;z;u;d are to be taken from tables 14 and 15 of NEN 6770 respectively. Checks for table 14:
l

Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.32 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.33 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d use equation 11.3-34 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d use equation 11.3-35

International Design Codes Manual 351

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vz;s;d, My;pl;d, Npl;d, Mv;y;ud, N;v;u;d, a1 ,a2 and Vz;pl;d. Checks for table 15:
l

Check #1 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.36 Check #2 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.37 Check #3 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-38 Check #4 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-39

See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vy;s;d, Mz;pl;d, Npl;d, Mv;z;ud, N;v;u;d, a1 ,a2 and Vy;pl;d. See table 16 for 1, 1, 0 and 1 use in tables 14 and 15.

Clause 11.3.2.2 : Class 1 and Class 2 Circular hollow tubes


The formula to evaluate M;N;v;y;u;d and M;N;v;z;u;d (to be used in equation 113-31, see description of clause 11.3.2 above) are to be taken from table 17 of NEN 6770.
l

Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d use equation 11.3.44 Check #2 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d use equation 11.3.45.

See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vz;pl;d, My;pl;d, and Npl;d use in equations 11.3.44 & 11.3.45. For values to be used for 1, 2, 1 and 2 in this case refer to table 18 of NEN 6770.

352 STAAD.Pro

Clause 11.3.2.3 : Class 1 and class2 Rectangular and square hollow tubes
The formula to evaluate M;N;v;y;u;d and M;N;v;z;u;d (to be used in equation 113-31, see description of clause 11.3.2 above) are to be taken from table 19 of NEN 6770.
l

Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d use equation 11.3-48 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.49 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d use equation 11.3-50 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-51

See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vz;pl;d, My;pl;d, Npl;d, Mv;y;ud, N;v;u;d, a3, a4 and Vz;pl;d to be used in the above equations. For values to be used for 1, 2, 1 and 2 in this case refer to table 20 of NEN 6770. To check for these conditions about the y axis, substitute the index z in the above equations with y.

Clause 11.3 ( NEN 6771)


In general, this section deals with Biaxial bending with axial force and shear for class 3 and class 4 sections. Check for class 3 sections: For class 3 sections use the method in section 11.3 NEN 6770. For class 3 sections the methods and equations discussed above can be used with the plastic section modulus being substituted with the elastic modulus. Check for class 4 sections: Class 4 sections can be treated as class 3 sections if the effective section properties are used as given in clause 10.2.4.2.3 of NEN 6771. Working out the effective section properties for slender sections has already been done in STAAD.Pro. For I- section profiles and tubular sections the following procedure should be adopted:

International Design Codes Manual 353

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

1. Case 1: -If M;y;s;d / MN;y;f;u;d 1 check equation 11.2-7 ( given below) V Where V
z;s;d z;s;d

/V

z;u;d

is the shear for in the Z direction

V is the shear capacity in the Z direction for ultimate limit z;u;d state. For an I section,

Where Aw,ef = effective web area as given in section 10.2.4.2.3 . MN;y;f;u;d is the moment capacity about the Y axis for the effective section. = ( fyW,eff) 2. Case 2: If M;y;s;d / MN;y;f;u;d > 1 and M;y;s;d / M;y;f;u;d 1 check equation 11.2-13 (given below):

Clause 6.3 Buckling resistance of members


The D-NA introduces a new clause 6.3.0, which in turns requires the checks as per clauses 12.1.2.2, 12.13.2 and 12.1.4.2 of NEN 6771 to be applied.

Clause 12.1.2.2 (NEN 6771)


This clause in NEN 6771 determines the relative torsional slenderness and is given as:

Where: N
c;u;d

= Af

y;d

354 STAAD.Pro

A = area of section f
y;d E;

= the yield stress is the Euler-torsion formula

This value of slenderness is to be used to calculate the modification factors used in section 6.3 of EC-3.

Clause 12.1.3.2 (NEN 6771)


This clause works out the relative torsional-flexural buckling slenderness for compression members. The relative torsional-flexural buckling slenderness is given as:

Where N
c;u;d

= Af

y;d

A = area of section f
y;d

= yield stress is the Euler torsional buckling strength

E;tk

Clause 12.1.4.2 (NEN 6771)


Buckling lengths of rotationally restrained bars with intermediate spring supports. Note: STAAD.Pro does not allow for these end conditions, specifically. The effective length factors may be used to accommodate this requirement.

Clause 6.3.1.3 Slenderness for flexural buckling


The Dutch NA requires the implementation of clause 12.1.1.3 and 12.1.5.3.2 of NEN 6770 and clause 12.1.1.3 of NEN 6771.

International Design Codes Manual 355

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Clause 12.1.1.3 (NEN 6770)


This clause gives the equations to evaluate the effective lengths for various support conditions. STAAD.Pro uses the effective length factor K which allows the user to set/modify the effective lengths for a member.

Clause 12.1.5.3.2 (NEN 6770)


This clause gives methods to evaluate the buckling length of lattice sections. We do not deal with latticed section in the current version of STAAD.Pro. In any case the buckling length can be adjusted using the K factor.

Clause 12.1.1.3 (NEN 6771)


This clause again deals with working out the effective lengths of prismatic and non-prismatic rods. Again, the K factor in the current implementation of STAAD.Pro is adequate to cater for adjusting the effective lengths as necessary.

Clause 6.3.1.4 Slenderness for torsional and torsional-flexural buckling


The D-NA requires the implementation of clauses 12.1.2 and 12.1.3 of NEN 6770

Clause 12.1.2 (NEN 6770): Torsional stability


IPE, HEA, HEB & HEM sections and pipe sections do not need to be checked for torsional instability. If torsional checks need to be performed they should be done according to 12.1.2 of NEN 6771.

Clause 12.1.2 (NEN 6771)


This clause gives the condition to check for torsion instability. The condition being:

Where: N
c;s;d

= the applied axial load

356 STAAD.Pro

C;u;d

= the axial capacity = A x fy.

Clause 12.1.3 (NEN 6770): Torsional flexural stability


Doubly symmetric sections need not be checked for torsional flexural instability. However for I sections that have rigid supports that is not along the axis of the section and any other sections will need to be checked as per clause 12.1.3 of NEN 6771.

Clause 12.1.3 (NEN 6771)


This clause gives the condition to check for torsional flexural instability. The condition being:

Where N;c;s;d and N;c;u;d as in clause 12.1.2 above.

Clause 6.3.2.2 Lateral torsional buckling curves - general


The D-NA states that the values for the imperfection factor LT to be used in equation 6.56 of EC-3 are to be obtained from table 6.3 of EC-3. This is what STAAD.Pro currently implements.

Clause 6.3.2.3 Lateral torsional buckling curves for rolled sections or equivalent welded sections
The D-NA states that: 1. The values for the #. Imperfection factor LT0 = 0.4 (to be used in equation 6.57 of EC-3) #. = 0.75(to be used in equation 6.57 of EC-3)

International Design Codes Manual 357

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

These are the default values used in the current implementation in STAAD.Pro. 2. The buckling curves shall be selected as per table 6.5. Again this is what is being used in the current implementation of EC3 (BS) in STAAD.Pro. 3. The reduction factor, f, is given by F = 1 0.5(1-kc)[1-2x (LT -0.8)^2]. And Kc to be determined from table 6.6. The current implementation of STAAD.Pro conservatively uses a value of f = 1.0. This implementation use a new parameter KC to identify the moment distribution as given in table 6.6, thus determining the value of the correction factor kc.

Clause 6.3.2.4 Simplified assessment method for restrained beams in buildings


The current implementation only uses the more accurate method (6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 in EC-3). Hence STAAD will ignore this clause for this implementation.

Clause 6.33 Uniform members in bending and axial compression


The D-NA recommends the use of the method in Annex B of EC-3 to determine the values of kyy, kyz, kzy and kzz to be used in 6.3.3 ( EC-3) checks. The current implementation in STAAD.Pro uses the method in Annex B. The Dutch NA also requires additional checks as per clause 12.3.1.2.3 of NEN 6770

Clause 12.3.1.2.3 (NEN 6770): Rotation/bending capacity


The checks given in this clause deals with additional checks for columns that form part of a buttressed or non-butressed framework. The program uses the ESTIFF parameter with two different values to identify the framework type:
l

ESTIFF = 0 (default) Column part of a buttressed framework Selecting this value will internally perform the checks as per section 1 of clause

358 STAAD.Pro

12.3.1.2.3
l

ESTIFF = 1 (default) Column is not part of a buttressed framework Selecting this value will internally perform the checks as per section 2 of clause 12.3.1.2.3

These checks are described below: 1. For columns in buttressed frameworks the buckling length is to be taken based on either
l

the system length or the distance between adjacent lateral supports

The following conditions should also be satisfied: If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d < 0.15, no additional checks are required If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d 0.15 and the steel grade is S235 or S 275 then

Where N N
c;s;d pl;d

is the axial load in the section


y;d

= Axial capacity of section = Af

= Slenderness of the section about the major axis ( Y-axis)


y

If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d 0.15 and the steel grade is S355 then

Where N N
c;s;d pl;d

= the axial load in the section


y;d

= Axial capacity of section = Af

= Slenderness of the section about the major axis ( Y-axis)


y

2. For columns that are not part of buttressed frameworks the following additional checks need to be done: If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d < 0.15, no additional checks are required

International Design Codes Manual 359

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d 0.15 and the steel grade is S235 or S 275 then

Where N N
c;s;d pl;d

= the axial load in the section and


y;d

= Axial capacity of section = Af

= Slenderness of the section about the major axis ( Y-axis)


y

If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d 0.15 and the steel grade is S355 then

5B.2 (C) EC3 NA Norwegian National Annex


Purpose
Adds values from the Norwegian National Annex - titled NA to BS EN 1993-11:2005 - for use with Eurocode 3, or EN 1993-1-1:2005. The NA document makes small changes to the base document.

Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that require additional clauses from the Norwegian National Annex are:

Section 6.1(1)
The partial safety factors will use the following values: Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.05 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.05 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = 1.25 This implementation will set the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.05, GM1 = 1.05 and GM2 = 1.25. (Note: When NA 3 has been specified)

360 STAAD.Pro

The user will be allowed to override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, this implementation will ignore the user specified value (i.e., 0) and use the default values as given above. The design functions in STAAD.Pro will set these values as the default values for the French-NA. The user is still however allowed to modify these factors using the parameters in the design input. These values will also need to be reported in the design output. Note: The GB1 parameter that is being used for compression checks in builds preceding this release (STAAD.Pro 2007 build 06) has been removed as this parameter is no longer required in EN 1993-1-1:2005. Hence any legacy files that use GB1 parameter will indicate an error message and the user will need to substitute GB1 with GM1 in line with EN 1993-1-1:2005.

Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the Norwegian -NA.

5B.3 (C) EC3 NA UK National Annex


Purpose
Adds values from the UK National Annex - titled NA to BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 - for use with Eurocode 3, or EN 1993-1-1:2005. The NA document makes small changes to the base document.

Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 that have been dealt with in the UK National Annex (hereafter referred to as the UK-NA) are:
l

6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.2.4(1)B Slenderness limit c0

International Design Codes Manual 361

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

6.3.2.4(2)B Modification factor kfl 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex B Members in bending and axial compression 6.3.1.4 Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling

Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the UK-NA.

Clause 6.1(1) General: Partial Safety Factors for buildings


EN 1993-1-1:2005 specifies the use of the partial safety factors to be used in for design as given in Cl. 6.1 of the code. These factors are M0, M1 & M2. EN 1993 provides default values for these factors. However any National Annex is allowed to override these default values. The partial safety factors will use the following values for the UK National Annex: Resistance of cross-sections- M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability- M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension- M2 = 1.1 This implementation will hence set the default values of the design parameters GM0, GM1 and GM2 in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.0, GM1 = 1.0 and GM2 = 1.10. (Note: When NA 1 has been specified) The design function in STAAD.Pro will set these values as the default values for the UK-NA. You may override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. These values will also be reported in the design output. Note: If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, STAAD.Pro will ignore the user specified value (i.e., 0) and use the default values as given above.

Warning: The GB1 parameter that is being used for compression checks in builds preceding this release (STAAD.Pro 2007 build 06) has been removed as

362 STAAD.Pro

this parameter is no longer required in EN 1993-1-1:2005. Hence any legacy files that use GB1 parameter will indicate an error message and the user will need to substitute GB1 with GM1 in line with EN 1993-1-1:2005.

Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The UK-NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks. The calculation of the LTB reduction factor X , requires the calculation of the LT Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The UK National Annex does not specify a particular method to calculate Mcr. Hence the calculation of Mcr has been based on the following NCCI documents: 1. SN003a-EN-EU Elastic critical moment for Lateral torsional Buckling: This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method in the proposed implementation. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given in the NCCI as

C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions of the member. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in the tables below:

International Design Codes Manual 363

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

This NCCI considers three separate loading conditions:


l

Members with end moments Members with transverse loading

364 STAAD.Pro

Members with end moments and transverse loading.

The implementation of EC3 in STAAD.Pro accounts for the loading condition and the bending moment diagram through the CMM parameter. The first two loading conditions mentioned above and its variants can be dealt with by using the existing values of the CMM parameter (i.e., 1 to 6). Hence the appropriate values from this NCCI will be used for C1 and C2 coefficients depending on the value of CMM specified. The default value of CMM is 1, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. The user will also have the option to specify specific values for C1 & C2 using the new C1 and C2 parameters in the design input mode. However for cases with end moments and transverse loading, the NCCI provides graphs to evaluate the C1 and C2 coefficients. It does not however, provide a set of equations for these graphs. However the end moments and transverse loading condition cannot be currently specified in the design input. Hence this implementation will introduce two new values for the CMM parameter viz. CMM 7:Member with varying end moments and uniform loading. CMM 8: Member with varying end moments and central point load. For these two conditions, the UK National Annex (nor the NCCI) does not provide equations to evaluate C1 and C2. Hence in STAAD.Pro the user will have to use the new C1 & C2 parameters to input the required values for C1 & C2 to be used in calculating Mcr. For values of 7 or 8 for the CMM parameter, the program will issue a warning if C1 and C2 have not been specified. Note: If the NA parameter has not been specified, the program obtains the values of C1 and C2 from Annex F of DD ENV version of 1993-11:1992. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence for this implementation the elastic critical moment for TeeSections will be worked out using the method in this NCCI.

International Design Codes Manual 365

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric builtup sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. In any case, the actual LTB capacity will still be worked out as per BS 5950-1 as in the current EC3 implementation. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :

The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:

The CMM parameter (see section (i) above) specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 1, which

366 STAAD.Pro

considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. As described in section (i) above, the user must use C1, C2 and C3 parameters along with CMM values of 7 and 8. Both the NCCI documents mentioned above assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member ( k = kw = 1.0). The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD takes into account of the end conditions using the CMN parameter. A value of K = kw =1 is indicated by a value of CMN = 1.0 in the design input. Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints, i.e., CMN = 1.0. For members with partial or end fixities (ie, CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), the proposed implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) the proposed implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The user will be allowed to modify this value by using the new ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero.

Clause 6.3.2.3(1) LTB for rolled sections or equivalent welded section


The UK-NA specifies different values for the LT,0 and factors to be used in equation 6.57 of BS EN 1993-1-1 for rolled and equivalent welded sections. The current implementation in STAAD.pro does not differentiate between rolled and welded sections and uses the default values in BS EN 1993-1-1 for LT,0 and .

International Design Codes Manual 367

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

The values specified in the UK-NA are: For rolled sections and hot-rolled & cold formed hollow sections: LT,0 = 0.4 = 0.75 For welded sections: LT,0 = 0.2 = 1.00 The current implementation of STAAD.Pro uses the buckling curves based on Table 6.5 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. The UK-NA specifies different limits and buckling curves to be used in this clause as given below:

This table again does not specify which buckling curve is to be used in case of welded doubly symmetric sections with h/b 3.1 and welded non-doubly symmetric sections. Hence for these cases the new implementation will still use the method specified in the base code as per clause 6.3.2.2(2).

Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 Calculation of LTB Reduction factor, as per UK NA


LT

Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005), both give equations to evaluate the LTB reduction factor to be used in eqn. 6.55 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005.
LT

Cl. 6.3.2.2 uses tables 6.3 and 6.4 to choose the buckling curve and the imperfection factors to be used for calculating . Table 6.4 specifies the choice of LT buckling curves for Rolled I Sections, Welded I Sections and Any other

368 STAAD.Pro

sections. Cl 6.3.2.3 on the other hand uses tables 6.5 and 6.3 to choose the buckling curves and imperfection factors. Table 6.5 however only deals with Rolled I Sections and Welded I Sections. Cl. 6.3.2.2 states Unless otherwise specified, see 6.3.2.3, for bending members of constant cross section the value of should be determined from.... Hence in the LT implementation of EC3 (and the UK Annex) in STAAD.Pro, by default the program will consider clause Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evaluate . For any case that is not dealt with LT by Cl. 6.3.2.3, the program will consider Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT

Cl. 6.3.2.3 in the UK National Annex states that Table 6.5 in BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 should be replaced with the table given in the NA (See section 4.3 of this document). Hence for all cases dealt with by the table in the UK NA, this implementation will choose the buckling curves from the UK National Annex. For any case that is not dealt with by the table in the UK NA, the program will use the method given in Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Hence for the following cross sections the program will use the Table in the UK NA for choosing a buckling curve for LTB checks (when the UK NA has been specified):
l

Rolled doubly symmetric I & H Sections Rolled doubly symmetric hollow sections (SHS, RHS, CHS) Angle Sections Any other rolled section Welded doubly symmetric sections with h/b < 3.1

For the following cross sections, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 of BS EN 1993-11:2005 to evaluate LT
l

Welded I & H Sections with h/b 3.1.

For any other type of cross section that is not dealt with by the National Annex or Cl.6.3.2.3, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate LT . In any case the Elastic critical moment Mcr (used to evaluate the non dimensional slenderness) will be worked out as given in section 4.2 of this document. Since the UK National Annex uses the NCCIs mentioned in the sections above, this implementation will only consider end restraint conditions corresponding to the CMN parameter=1.0 (See section 4.2 above). For all other cases of the CMN parameter values, this implementation will use the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992.

International Design Codes Manual 369

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Note: If a National Annex has not been specified (i.e., NA parameter in the design input = 0), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 only in the case of Rolled or welded I & H Sections. For all other cases, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Also, I sections with plates will be treated as built-up sections only if the section has been explicitly specified as a built-up section (i.e., SBLT parameter = 1.0 in design input).

Clause 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor, f for LTB checks


The UK NA specifies the use of eqn. 6.58 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 to evaluate the modification factor f for the LTB reduction factor LT. To evaluate the modification factor BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 uses a correction factor kc given by Table 6.6 in the code. The UK-NA however, specifies that the correction factor kc is to be obtained as below: Kc = 1 / C1, where C1 is to be obtained from the NCCI documents given in section 4.2 of this document. The NCCI document SN003a-EN-EU specifies the values of C1 to be used in table 3.1 as shown below. This proposed implementation will allow for the reduction factor based on the UK-NA.

370 STAAD.Pro

These values are for an end restraint factor of k=1 (ie CMN=1.0). Hence for all other values of CMN (ie 0.7 or 0.5) this implementation will use the values of C1 from DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F.

International Design Codes Manual 371

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

The program will use a default value of 1.0 for kc. However the user can also input a custom value of kc by setting the design parameter KC to the desired value. The user can also get the program to calculate the value of kc automatically by setting the value of the KC parameter in the design input to 0. This will cause the program to evaluate a value of C1 corresponding to the end conditions and the Bending moment of the member and in turn calculate kc as given in the NA. To evaluate C1, the program will use the NCCI documents mentioned in section 4.2 of this document.

Clause 6.3.2.4(1) B Slenderness for flexural buckling


The UK NA specifies the value of c0 for I, H channel or box section to be used in equation 6.59 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 as 0.4. Note: STAAD.Pro does not use this clause in the current implementation of EC-3. Hence this clause will be ignored for the UK National Annex.

Clause 6.3.2.4(2)BModification factor kfl


The value of the modification factor kfl to be used in equation 6.60 of BS EN 19931-1 to be as follows: = 1.0 for hot rolled I sections = 1.0 for welded I section with h/b 2 = 0.9 for other sections Note: STAAD.Pro does not use this clause in the current implementation of EC-3. Hence this clause will be ignored for the UK National Annex.

Clause 6.3.3(5) Interaction factors kyy, kyz, kzy and kzz


The UK-NA recommends that the method in Annex A or Annex B of BS EN 1993-11:2005 can be used to calculate the interaction factors for Cl. 6.3.3 checks in the case of doubly symmetric sections. The proposed implementation will hence use equations in Annex B of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 to calculate these interaction factors for doubly symmetric sections. The current implementation of EC3 BS in

372 STAAD.Pro

STAAD.pro uses the method in Annex B. However for non-doubly symmetric sections, the UK NA gives the option of using Annex B with some modifications as given in the NA. (Cl. NA-3.2 of the UK NA). The UK NA requires additional checks to be done to check for the maximum allowable values of and X to be used in equations 6.61 and 6.62 of BS EN 19931-1:2005. As per the UK NA, for non-doubly symmetric sections, the slenderness about the weak axis (y in STAAD) and the corresponding reduction factor y should be taken as the values from the highest values of slenderness () among the flexural buckling slenderness (y), torsional slenderness ( ) and torsional-flexural T slenderness ( ) as given in Clauses 6.3.1.3 and 6.3.1.4 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. TF Hence for non-doubly symmetric sections the program will calculate the critical non-dimensional slenderness as:

y = max

is calculated as =
T T

Ncr = min (N

CrT

,N

crTF

).

The UK NA or EC3 does not however specify a method to evaluate NCrT or NcrTF. Hence this implementation will use the method specified in the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes to calculate these. See section 4.9 below for details. Note: The UK National Annex or EC3 does not deal with angle sections in specific and hence this implementation will use the method used in the current EC3 implementation to deal with slenderness of angle sections. In the current implementation this is done as per cl 4.7.10 of BS 5950. This proposed implementation will still use the same method for single and double angle sections to evaluate the slenderness. Clause NA 3.2 of the UK NA also requires that Where the section is not an I Section or a hollow section and is a class1 or class 2 section, it will be treated as a class 3 section for the purposes of this clause. Hence for all Class 1 or Class 2 cross sections that are NOT I, H, SHS, RHS or CHS sections, the elastic properties will be used for the purposes of 6.3.3 checks.

International Design Codes Manual 373

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Clause 6.3.1.4 - Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling


Equations 6.52 and 6.53 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 are to be used to calculate the non-dimensional slenderness , to be used for torsional and torsional-flexural T buckling checks. The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD.pro does not allow for this clause as BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not provide equations to calculate the elastic critical loads Ncr,T,F and Ncr,T (refer 6.3.14 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005). The NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes provides methods to calculate the Ncr,TF and NcrT factors and hence will to be included in the proposed implementation of the UK NA. The critical axial load for Torsional buckling is worked out as:

where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is worked out as:

For details on these equations refer to the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU.

374 STAAD.Pro

5B.4 (C) EC3 NA French National Annex


Purpose
Adds values from the French National Annex - titled Annexe Nationale a la NF EN 1993-1-1:2005 - for use with Eurocode 3, or EN 1993-1-1:2005. The NA document makes small changes to the base document.

Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that have been dealt with in the French National Annex (hereafter referred to as FR-NA) and that are relevant to the proposed implementation are:
l

3.2.1(1) Material properties 6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.2.4(1)B Slenderness limit c0 6.3.2.4(2)B Modification factor kfl 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex A Members in bending and axial compression 6.3.1.4 Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling

Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the French-NA.

Clause 3.2.1(1)- Material Properties


The material strengths (i.e., - steel grade strengths) to be used with NF EN 1993-11 is given in Table 3.1 of the code. The French National Annex however, specifies a separate table (Table 3.1 NF) for the yield and tensile strengths of steel grades.

International Design Codes Manual 375

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

This new table replaces Table 3.1 in NF EN 1993-1-1:2005. Table 3.1 NF excludes steel grades from standards EN 10210-1 and EN 10219-1 that are given in EC-3. STAAD.Pro uses the steel grades and values from the table given in the National Annex (i.e., - Table 3.1 NF). Table 3.1 NF is similar to table 3.1 in EC3, apart from the fu values for S 355 and S355 W grade steel.

If you specify a steel grade that is not given in the Annex Table 3.1 (NF) but is present in Table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005, this implementation will use the values from Table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005. The appropriate yield strength used (fy) will be shown in the design output file.

376 STAAD.Pro

Clause 6.1(1) General


The partial safety factors will use the following values:
l

Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = 1.25

STAAD.Pro sets the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.0 GM1 = 1.0 GM2 = 1.25 Note: When NA 4 has been specified. You may override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. Note: If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, STAAD.Pro will ignore the specified value and use the default values as given above.

Warning: The GB1 parameter (which, in fact was common to the base EC-3 and was a reminiscent of the previous DD ENV implementation of EC-3) has been removed. Hence any legacy STAAD files that have the GB1 Parameter defined will need to be revised to take out this parameter as it is no longer valid as per the latest EN1993.

Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The French NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of NF EN 1993-1-1:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks.

International Design Codes Manual 377

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

The calculation of the LTB reduction factor LT, requires the calculation of the Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The French NA gives a method to evaluate Mcr in its Annex MCR. This implementation will make use of this method to evaluate Mcr. Annex MCR however deals with the calculation of Mcr for doubly symmetric sections. Hence this implementation will use this method only for doubly symmetric sections. For mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the minor axis (i.e Tee sections) this implementation will use the method from the NCCI document SN030a-EN-EU as given in the section below. For any other type of section that is not dealt with by the Annex, this implementation will use the method and tables given in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. 1. Annex MCR This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method in this implementation. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given as :

C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in Table1 and Table 2 of the Annex. Table 1 deals with the condition of a simply supported member with end moments and the value of C1 is determined by the end moment ratio (Refer to the NA for details). Clause 3.2 of the National Annex however gives a formula to evaluate C1 as :

This formula however does not match the values given in Table 1 of the NA. Hence this implementation will use the values of C1 from Table 1 if the end moment ration () is exactly equal to the values of in the table. For all other cases this implementation will calculate the value of C1 from equation (6) in the Annex.

378 STAAD.Pro

The value of C2 will be determined from Table 2 of the Annex based on the loading and end conditions (i.e the CMM parameter in STAAD). The user will also have the option to specify specific values for C1 & C2 using the new C1 and C2 parameters in the design input mode. The French NA considers three separate loading conditions:
l

Members with end moments Members with transverse loading Members with end moments and transverse loading.

The first two cases and its variants can be defined using with the existing CMM parameter values in STAAD.Pro. However the third condition cannot be currently specified in the design input. Hence this implementation will introduce two new values for CMM viz. CMM 7:Member with varying end moments and uniform loading. CMM 8: Member with varying end moments and central point load. The load to moment ratio () will then be used in the calculations will then be used to calculate C1 and C2 as given in section 3.5 of Annex MCR (See Annex MCR in the NA for details). This implementation will also introduce a new parameter MU to be specified when using CMM = 7 or 8. The load to moment ratio () to be used in the calculations is to be input using the new MU parameter. This implementation will require that for the French National Annex if CMM = 7 or 8 has been specified, the user should also either specify a value for MU or input the values for C1 and C2 using the C1 and/or C2 parameters directly. Note: The new parameter MU will currently be applicable only in the context of the French NA. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence for this implementation the elastic critical moment for TeeSections will be worked out using the method in this NCCI.

International Design Codes Manual 379

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric built-up sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :

The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:

The CMM parameter specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 0, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not

380 STAAD.Pro

however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. Note: If MU as well as C1, C2 and C3 have been specified, the program will ignore MU and use the user input values of C1, C2 and C3. The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD.Pro obtains these values from Annex F of DD ENV version of 1993-1-1:1992. Also, the NCCI document and Annex MCR of the FR-NA assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member( k = kw=1 .i.e., CMN parameter =1.0). Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints. For members with partial or end fixities (ie, CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), this implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) this implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive, if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The use will be allowed to modify this value by using the ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero. Note: There is a separate method specified in the NCCI document SN006aEN-EU to calculate Mcr for cantilever beams. Again this document does not give any specific formulae to evaluate the coefficients. Hence, this has not been implemented in STAAD.Pro.

Clause 6.3.2.3(1) LTB for rolled sections or equivalent welded section


The FR-NA provides equations to evaluate the
LT0

and

LT

factors given in clause

International Design Codes Manual 381

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

6.3.2.3 For rolled doubly symmetric sections use:

Since EN 1993-1-1:2005 limits the value of LT0 to 0.4, this implementation will only allow a maximum value of 0.4 for .
LT0

For welded doubly symmetric sections use:

For other sections

And for all sections use = 1.0 These equations and factors are then applied to equation 6.57 of NF EN 1993-1-1 to evaluate the Lateral Torsional Buckling reduction factor .
LT

Clause 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor, f for LTB checks


The French NA specifies that the modification factor is to be obtained as per the default method given in EC-3. Hence this implementation will use the existing functionality to evaluate the correction factor kc to be used in the modification factor f. The program uses a default value of 1.0 for kc. However the user can also input a custom value of kc by setting the design parameter KC to the desired value. The user can also get the program to calculate the value of kc automatically by setting the value of the KC parameter in the design input to 0. This will cause the program to evaluate kc from table 6.6 of NF EN 1993-1-1:2005. This will correspond to the end conditions and the bending moment of the member (i.e the value of CMM parameter specified). For CMM = 7 the program will choose the value of kc to be either 0.90 or 0.91 based on the end moment ratio. For CMM = 8 the program will choose the value of kc to be either 0.77 or 0.82 based on the end moment ratio. An additional check will also be performed as given below:

382 STAAD.Pro

The French Annex specifies that the modification factor is applicable only to members that are free to rotate on plan (i.e., CMN =1.0). Hence for all other values of CMN, this implementation will ignore f and hence will use = .
LT,mod LT

Clause 6.3.2.4(1) B Slenderness for flexural buckling


Note: STAAD does not use this clause in the current implementation of EC-3. Hence this clause will be ignored for the French National Annex.

Clause 6.3.2.4(2) BModification factor kfl


Note: STAAD does not use this clause in the current implementation of EC-3. Hence this clause will be ignored for the French National Annex.

Clause 6.3.3(5) Interaction factors kyy, kyz, kzy and kzz


The French NA recommends the use of equations in Annex A of NF EN 1993-11:2005 to calculate these interaction factors. The current implementation of EC3 BS in STAAD.pro uses the method in Annex B. Hence the method in Annex A will be added into this implementation. The NA mentions that this method can be extended to singly symmetric I-Sections (symmetric about the minor axis) if the elastic properties are used instead of the plastic properties. However since STAAD does not have a provision to specify such sections, this case will not be considered for this implementation. The NA also mentions that torsional flexural buckling needs to be taken into account in case of mono symmetric sections. Torsional flexural buckling will need to be taken into account based on the method given in the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes. See section below for details. The NA also recommends a lower limit as given below for the term Cmi,0 in table A.2 of Annex A:

International Design Codes Manual 383

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Clause 6.3.1.4 - Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling


Equations 6.52 and 6.53 of NF EN 1993-1-1:2005 are to be used to calculate the non-dimensional slenderness T, to be used for torsional and torsional-flexural buckling checks. The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD.pro does not allow for this clause as NF EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not provide equations to calculate the elastic critical loads Ncr,T,F and Ncr,T (refer 6.3.14 of NF EN 1993-1-1:2005). The NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes provides methods to calculate the Ncr,TF and NcrT factors and hence will to be included in this implementation of the French NA. The critical axial load for Torsional buckling is worked out as:

where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is worked out as:

For details on these equations refer to the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU.

384 STAAD.Pro

5B.5 (C) EC3 NA Finnish National Annex


Purpose
Adds values from the Finnish National Annex - titled National Annex to Standard SFS-EN 1993-1-1 - for use with Eurocode 3, or EN 1993-1-1:2005. The NA document makes small changes to the base document.

Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that have been dealt with in the Finnish National Annex (hereafter referred to as SFS-NA) and that are relevant to the proposed implementation are:
l

3.2.1(1) Material properties 6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.2.4(1) B Slenderness limit c0 6.3.2.4(2) B Modification factor kfl 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex B Members in bending and axial compression

Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the Finnish-NA.

Clause 3.2.1(1)- Material Properties


The material strengths (i.e., steel grade strengths) to be used with SFS-EN 1993-11 are given in Table 3.1 of the code. These steel grade values are specified using the SGRparameter (refer to table 5B.1(B) ).

International Design Codes Manual 385

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

The Finnish National Annex states in Cl. 3.1(2) that, apart from the steel grades specified in Table 3.1 of SFS EN 1993-1-1, the following steel grades can also be used:
l

Steel grades S315MC, S355MC, S420MC and S460MC according to SFS-EN 10149-2 Steel grades S260NC, S315NC, S355NC and S420NC according to SFS-EN 10149-3

These grades of steel can be specified by using the PY(Yield Strength) and FU (Ultimate Strength)parameters in STAAD.Pro. Set these parameters to the respective values as given in SFS-EN 10149-2/3 for the steel grades specified above. The choice of the buckling curve to be used is based on the value of the SGR parameter specified. The output will include the appropriate yield strength used for design.

Clause 6.1(1) General


The partial safety factors will use the following values:
l

Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = 1.25

STAAD.Pro sets the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.0 GM1 = 1.0 GM2 = 1.25 Note: When NA 5 has been specified. You may override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. These parameters are reported in the design output.

386 STAAD.Pro

Note: If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, STAAD.Pro will ignore the specified value and use the default values as given above.

Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The Finnish NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of SFS EN 1993-11:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks. The calculation of the LTB reduction factor XLT, requires the calculation of the Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The Finnish National Annex does not specify a particular method to calculate Mcr. Hence the calculation of Mcr has been based on the following NCCI documents: 1. SN003a-EN-EU Elastic critical moment for Lateral torsional Buckling: This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given in the NCCI as:

C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions of the member. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in the tables below:

International Design Codes Manual 387

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Table 5B.9 - Values of C for 1 end moment loading (for k=1) +1,00 +0,75 +0,50 +0,25 0,00 -0,25 -0,50 -0,75 C
1

1,00 1,14 1,31 1,52 1,77 2,05 2,33 2,57

This NCCI considers three separate loading conditions:


l

Members with end moments Members with transverse loading Members with end moments and transverse loading.

STAAD.Pro accounts for the loading condition and the bending moment diagram through the CMM parameter. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence, the elastic critical moment for Tee-Sections will be worked out using the method in this NCCI. Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric built-up sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :

388 STAAD.Pro

The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:

The CMM parameter specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 0, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. Note: If MU as well as C1, C2 and C3 have been specified, the program will ignore MU and use the user input values of C1, C2 and C3. STAAD.Pro obtains these values from Annex F of DD ENV version of 1993-1-1:1992.

International Design Codes Manual 389

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Both the NCCI documents mentioned above assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member ( k = kw = 1.0). STAAD.Pro takes into account of the end conditions using the CMN parameter for EC3. A value of K = kw =1 is indicated by a value of CMN = 1.0 in the design input. Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints (i.e., CMN = 1.0). For members with partial or end fixities (i.e., CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), this implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) this implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-11:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive, if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The use will be allowed to modify this value by using the ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero. Note: There is a separate method specified in the NCCI document SN006aEN-EU to calculate Mcr for cantilever beams. Again this document does not give any specific formulae to evaluate the coefficients. Hence, this has not been implemented in STAAD.Pro.

Clause 6.3.2.3(1) LTB for rolled sections or equivalent welded section


The Finnish-NA provides the values for the terms and factors given in clause LT0 6.3.2.3(1) as follows: For rolled doubly symmetric sections and hollow sections, use:
LT0

=0.4 and = 0.75

For welded doubly symmetric sections and hollow sections use:

390 STAAD.Pro

LT0

= 0.2 and = 1.0

The Finnish NA specifies the following limits for choosing the buckling curves: Table 5B.10 - Selection of lateral torsional buckling curve for cross sectiosn using equation (6.57) Cross-section (constant cross-section) Rolled double symmetric I- and H- sections and hot finished hollow sections. Limits Buckling Curve h/b 2 2< h/b <3.1 Welded double symmetric I- section and H- sections and cold-formed hollow sections h/b 2 2< h/b < 3.1 The NA says that for all other cases the rules given in Cl 6.3.2.2 should be used. Hence even for rolled or welded doubly symmetric sections with h/b ratio 3.1, this implementation will resort to checks as per clause 6.3.2.2. These equations and factors are then applied to equation 6.57 of SFS-EN 1993-1-1 to evaluate the Lateral Torsional Buckling reduction factor .
LT

b c

c d

Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 Calculation of LTB Reduction factor, LT as per Finnish NA
Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005), both give equations to evaluate the LTB reduction factor to be used in eqn. 6.55 of SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005.
LT

Cl. 6.3.2.2 uses tables 6.3 and 6.4 to choose the buckling curve and the imperfection factors to be used for calculating . Table 6.4 specifies the choice of LT buckling curves for Rolled I Sections, Welded I Sections and Any other sections. Cl 6.3.2.3 on the other hand uses tables 6.5 and 6.3 to choose the

International Design Codes Manual 391

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

buckling curves and imperfection factors. Table 6.5 however only deals with Rolled I Sections and Welded I Sections. Cl. 6.3.2.2 states Unless otherwise specified, see 6.3.2.3, for bending members of constant cross section the value of should be determined from.... Hence in LT the implementation of EC3 (and the Finnish Annex) in STAAD.Pro: by default the program will consider clause Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evaluate . For any case that is not LT dealt with by Cl. 6.3.2.3, the program will consider Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT

Cl. 6.3.2.3 in the Finnish National Annex gives equations to evaluate the imperfection factors to be used for various section types. (See above). Hence for all cases dealt with by the equations in the Finnish NA, this implementation will use Cl 6.3.2.3 to evaluate .
LT

For any other type of cross section that is not dealt with by the National Annex or Cl.6.3.2.3, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT

In any case, the elastic critical moment,Mcr, (used to evaluate the non dimensional slenderness) will be worked out as given above. Since this implementation uses the NCCIs mentioned in the sections above, only end restraint conditions corresponding to the CMN parameter=1.0 (See section above) will be considered. For all other cases of the CMN parameter values, this implementation will use the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. Note: If a National Annex has not been specified (i.e., NA parameter in the design input = 0), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 only in the case of Rolled or welded I & H Sections. For all other cases, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Also, I sections with plates will be treated as built-up sections only if the section has been explicitly specified as a built-up section (i.e., SBLT parameter = 1.0 in design input).

Clause 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor, f for LTB checks


STAAD.Pro uses the value of the modification factor f = 1.0 as given in the Finnish NA.

Clause 6.3.2.4(1) B Slenderness for flexural buckling


Note: STAAD does not use this clause in the current implementation of EC-3.

392 STAAD.Pro

Hence this clause will be ignored for the Finnish National Annex.

Clause 6.3.2.4(2) B Modification factor kfl


Note: STAAD does not use this clause in the current implementation of EC-3. Hence this clause will be ignored for the Finnish National Annex.

Clause 6.3.3(5) Interaction factors kyy, kyz, kzy and kzz


The Finnish NA recommends the use of equations in Annex A or Annex B of SFS-EN 1993-1-1 to calculate these interaction factors. STAAD.Pro uses the method in Annex B by default. This implementation of the Finnish NA will also use Annex B for Cl.6.3.3 checks.

Clause 6.3.1.4 - Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling


Equations 6.52 and 6.53 of SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005 are to be used to calculate the non-dimensional slenderness T, to be used for torsional and torsional-flexural buckling checks. The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD.pro does not allow for this clause as SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not provide equations to calculate the elastic critical loads Ncr,T,F and Ncr,T (refer 6.3.14 of SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005). The NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes provides methods to calculate the Ncr,TF and NcrT factors and hence will to be included in this implementation of the Finnish NA. The critical axial load for Torsional buckling is worked out as:

International Design Codes Manual 393

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is worked out as:

The program will only consider Channel Sections and Tee- sections while working out the critical torsional and Flexural Torsional buckling loads as per Cl 6.3.1.4. For details on these equations, refer to the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU.

5B.6 (C) EC3 NA Polish National Annex


Purpose
Adds values from the Polish National Annex - titled National Annex to Standard PN-EN 1993-1-1 - for use with Eurocode 3, or EN 1993-1-1:2005. The NA document makes small changes to the base document.

Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that have been dealt with in the Polish National Annex (hereafter referred to as PN-NA) and that are relevant to the proposed implementation are:
l

3.2.1(1) Material properties 6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex B Members in bending and axial compression

394 STAAD.Pro

Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the Polish-NA.

Clause 3.2.1(1)- Material Properties


The material strengths (i.e., steel grade strengths) to be used with PN-EN 1993-1-1 are given in Table 3.1 of the code. The Polish National Annex states in Cl. 3.1(2) that the steel grades to be used will be based on Table 3.1 of PN EN 1993-1-1. These steel grade values are specified using the SGRparameter (refer to table 5B.1(B) ).

Clause 6.1(1) General


The partial safety factors will use the following values:
l

Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = minimum of 1.1 or 0.9 x fu/fy

STAAD.Pro sets the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.0 GM1 = 1.0 Note: When NA 6 has been specified. STAAD.Pro determines the value for GM2 based on the value of the SGR design parameter or the fy and/or fu values specified using the PY and FU design parameters. If any of these parameters have not been specified, the program will use the SGR parameter to determine fy or fu and use them to evaluate GM2. Thus, GM2 is taken as the minimum of:
l

1.1, or 0.9 x (fu/fy)

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 395

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

fu is the ultimate steel strength fy is the yield strength of steel You may override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. These parameters are reported in the design output. Note: If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, STAAD.Pro will ignore the specified value and use the default values as given above.

Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The Polish NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of PN EN 1993-1-1:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks. The calculation of the LTB reduction factor XLT, requires the calculation of the Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The Polish National Annex does not specify a particular method to calculate Mcr. Hence the calculation of Mcr has been based on the following NCCI documents: 1. SN003a-EN-EU Elastic critical moment for Lateral torsional Buckling: This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given in the NCCI as:

C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions of the member. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in the tables below:

396 STAAD.Pro

Table 5B.11 - Values of C for 1 end moment loading (for k=1) +1,00 +0,75 +0,50 +0,25 0,00 -0,25 -0,50 -0,75 C
1

1,00 1,14 1,31 1,52 1,77 2,05 2,33 2,57

This NCCI considers three separate loading conditions:


l

Members with end moments Members with transverse loading Members with end moments and transverse loading.

STAAD.Pro accounts for the loading condition and the bending moment diagram through the CMM parameter. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence, the elastic critical moment for Tee-Sections will be evaluated using the method in this NCCI. Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric built-up sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :

International Design Codes Manual 397

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:

The CMM parameter specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 0, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. Note: If MU as well as C1, C2 and C3 have been specified, the program will ignore MU and use the user input values of C1, C2 and C3.

398 STAAD.Pro

STAAD.Pro obtains these values from Annex F of DD ENV version of 1993-1-1:1992.

Both the NCCI documents mentioned above assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member ( k = kw = 1.0). STAAD.Pro takes into account of the end conditions using the CMN parameter for EC3. A value of K = kw =1 is indicated by a value of CMN = 1.0 in the design input. Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints (i.e., CMN = 1.0). For members with partial or end fixities (i.e., CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), this implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) this implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive, if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The use will be allowed to modify this value by using the ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero. Note: There is a separate method specified in the NCCI document SN006aEN-EU to calculate Mcr for cantilever beams. Again this document does not give any specific formulae to evaluate the coefficients. Hence, this has not been implemented in STAAD.Pro.

Clause 6.3.2.3(1) LTB for rolled sections or equivalent welded section


The Polish-NA provides the values for the terms and factors given in clause LT0 6.3.2.3(1) as follows: For all sections, use:

International Design Codes Manual 399

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

LT0

=0.4 and = 0.75

The Polish NA specifies the use of uses table 6.5 to work out the buckling curves for use in Cl. 6.3.2.3. Hence table 6.5 in PN-EN 1993-1-1 will be used for this. These equations and factors are then applied to equation 6.57 of PN-EN 1993-1-1 to evaluate the Lateral Torsional Buckling reduction factor .
LT

Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 Calculation of LTB Reduction factor, as per Polish NA
LT

Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005) both give equations to evaluate the LTB reduction factor to be used in eqn. 6.55 of PN EN 1993-1-1:2005.
LT

Cl. 6.3.2.2 uses tables 6.3 and 6.4 to choose the buckling curve and the imperfection factors to be used for calculating . Table 6.4 specifies the choice of LT buckling curves for Rolled I Sections, Welded I Sections and Any other sections. Cl 6.3.2.3 on the other hand uses tables 6.5 and 6.3 to choose the buckling curves and imperfection factors. Table 6.5 however only deals with Rolled I Sections and Welded I Sections. Cl. 6.3.2.2 states Unless otherwise specified, see 6.3.2.3, for bending members of constant cross section the value of should be determined from.... Hence in LT the implementation of EC3 (and the Polish Annex) in STAAD.Pro: by default the program will consider clause Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evaluate . For any case that is not LT dealt with by Cl. 6.3.2.3, the program will consider Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT

Cl. 6.3.2.3 in the Polish National Annex gives equations to evaluate the imperfection factors to be used for various section types. (See above). Hence for all cases dealt with by the equations in the Polish NA, this implementation will use Cl 6.3.2.3 to evaluate .
LT

For any other type of cross section that is not dealt with by the National Annex or Cl.6.3.2.3, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT

In any case, the elastic critical moment,Mcr, (used to evaluate the non dimensional slenderness) will be evaluated as given above. Since this implementation uses the NCCIs mentioned in the sections above, only end restraint conditions corresponding to the CMN parameter=1.0 (See section above) will be considered. For all other cases of the CMN parameter values, this implementation will use the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992.

400 STAAD.Pro

Note: If a National Annex has not been specified (i.e., NA parameter in the design input = 0), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 only in the case of Rolled or welded I & H Sections. For all other cases, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Also, I sections with plates will be treated as built-up sections only if the section has been explicitly specified as a built-up section (i.e., SBLT parameter = 1.0 in design input).

Clause 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor, f for LTB checks


STAAD.Pro uses the value of the modification factor f as per eqn 6.58 of PN-EN 1993-1-1. The correction factor kc will be evaluated as: Kc = (CmLT) Where: CmLT is the equivalent uniform moment factor from table B.3 of PN-EN 1993-1-1. CmLT will be evaluated based on the end conditions of the member and the shape of the bending moment diagram. However, if the KC parameter has been used, then the program will use the specified value.

Clause 6.3.3(5) Interaction factors kyy, kyz, kzy and kzz


The Polish NA recommends the equations in Annex B of PN-EN 1993-1-1 to calculate these interaction factors. The current implementation of EC3 BS in STAAD.pro uses the method in Annex B by default. The proposed implementation of the Polish NA will also use Annex B for Cl.6.3.3 checks. The Polish NA also gives two additional simplified checks. This implementation will provide for these additional checks as well. However as they are intended as optional checks, by default, the program will not perform these checks. However, the user can invoke these checks by using the PLG parameter. This parameter can have the following values:
l

PLG = 0 (default) : Ignore additional Cl. 6.3.3 checks PLG = 1 : Include additional Cl. 6.3.3 checks.

If the value of the PLG parameter is set to 1, the following two checks will be performed as per Cl. NA.20.(2) and NA.20(3) respectively:

International Design Codes Manual 401

5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check

Cl. NA.20.(2): The following condition will be checked n/ and + C where: n = N /N


Ed Rd my

m /
y

LT

+ C mz m with 1- (I = y or z)
0

m = max M (+ M )/M ; m = max M (+ M y y,Ed y, Ed y, Rd z ,Z Ed , )/M


Ed Z Rd,

and buckling factor,


LT m

- LTB factor

C - moment factor from table B 3 of PN EN 1993-1-1, -correction factor (estimation of maximum reduction) and will 0 be worked out as: = 0,1 + 0,2 (w 1), przy czym w = W /W , 0 i i pl,i el,i or = 0,1 in case of class 3 and 4 sections.
0
l

Cl. NA.20.(3): This condition will only be checked for circular hollow sections. n/ + [(k m )2 + (C
i ii i mj

m )2] 1/2 1 (i,j =y,z)


j

where: k - the interaction factor from table B.1 of PN-EN 1993-1-1 and n, m, Cmj are as above. If the PLG parameter has been set to 1, the maximum among the following ratios will be taken as being critical for Cl 6.3.3: 6.3.3: Eqn6.61 6.3.3: Eqn6.62 NA.20(2) and NA.20(3) If however PLG has been set to 0 or not specified at all, the program will ignore the last two checks in the list above.

402 STAAD.Pro

Clause 6.3.1.4 - Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling


Equations 6.52 and 6.53 of PN EN 1993-1-1:2005 are to be used to calculate the non-dimensional slenderness T, to be used for torsional and torsional-flexural buckling checks. The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD.pro does not allow for this clause as PN EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not provide equations to calculate the elastic critical loads Ncr,T,F and Ncr,T (refer 6.3.14 of PN EN 1993-1-1:2005). The NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes provides methods to calculate the Ncr,TF and NcrT factors and hence will to be included in this implementation of the Polish NA. The critical axial load for Torsional buckling is evaluated as:

where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is evaluated as:

The program will only consider Channel Sections and Tee- sections while working out the critical torsional and Flexural Torsional buckling loads as per Cl 6.3.1.4. For details on these equations, refer to the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU.

International Design Codes Manual 403

404 STAAD.Pro

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1


5C.1 General Comments
The Timber Design facility as per EC5 in STAAD is based on the European Standard Eurocode 5: Design of Timber Structures - Part 1-1 - General - Common rules and rules for buildings. Principles of Limit States Design of Timber Structures are adopted as specified in the code. The application is limited to the PRISMATIC rectangular shapes only. There is no Eurocode-specific timber section database / library consisting of pre-defined shapes for analysis or for design. The feature of member selection is thus not applicable to this code. The design philosophy of this specification is based on the concept of limit state design. Structures are designed and proportioned taking into consideration the limit states at which they would become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit-state are recognized - ultimate and serviceability. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability, while that in serviceability is deflection. Appropriate load and resistance factors are used so that a uniform reliability is achieved for all timber structures under various loading conditions and at the same time the chances of limits being surpassed are acceptably remote. In the STAAD implementation, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength, stability and serviceability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria as augmented by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type, or other such parameters. The code checking portion of the program checks whether code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The following sections describe the salient features of the STAAD implementation of EC 5. A detailed description of the design process along with its underlying concepts and assumptions is available in the specification document.

International Design Codes Manual 405

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

Axes convention in STAAD and EC5


STAAD defines the major axis of the cross-section as zz and the minor axis as yy. The longitudinal axis of the member is defined as x and joins the start joint of the member to the end with the same positive direction. EC5, however, defines the principal cross-section axes in reverse to that of STAAD, but the longitudinal axis is defined in the same way. Both of these axes definitions follow the orthogonal right hand rule.
Figure 5.6 - STAAD and EC5 axis conventions

Determination of Factors
A. Kmod Modification factor taking into account of Load-duration (LDC) and Moisture-content (Service Class - SCL). Reference Table 3.1 of EC-5-2004. For Solid Timber, the values are incorporated in the program. B. Partial factor for Material Property values. Reference Table 2.3 of EC-5m 2004. For Solid Timber, the value of = 1.3 is incorporated in the program.
m

C. Kh Size Factor. For members, subjected to tension, whose maximum c/s dimension is less than the reference width in tension the characteristic strength in tension (ft0k) is to be increased by the factor Kh.

406 STAAD.Pro

For members, subjected to bending, whose depth is less than reference depth in bending, the characteristic strength in bending (fmk) is to be increased by the factor Kh. As per clause 3.2(3) of EC 5- 2004, for rectangular solid timber with a characteristic timber density 700 kg/m3 the reference depth in bending k or the reference width (maximum cross-sectional dimension) is 150 mm. The value of Kh = Minimum of {(150/h) 0.2 and 1.3) for such solid timber is incorporated in the software. Please refer clause numbers 3.3 and 3.4 for the value of Kh for Glued laminated timber and Laminated veener lumber respectively. D. KC90 Factor taking into account the load configuration, possibility of splitting and degree of compressive deformation. For members, subjected to compression, perpendicular to the direction of grain alignment, this factor should be taken into account. Default value of 1 is used in STAAD.Pro. User may override the value. Please refer clause 6.1.5 of EC-5-2004 in this regard. E. Km Factor considering re-distribution of bending stress in cross section. For members, subjected to bending, this factor is taken into account for stress checking. For rectangular section the value of Km is 0.7, and this value is incorporated in STAAD.Pro. User may override the value. Please refer clause 6.1.6 of EC-5-2004 in this regard. F. Kshape Factor depending on shape of cross section. For members, subjected to torsional force, design torsional stress should be less than equal design shear strength multiplied by the factor Kshape. This factor is determined by STAAD.Pro internally using the guidelines of clause 6.1.8 of EC-5-2004.

International Design Codes Manual 407

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

5C.2 Analysis Methodology


Table 5C.1 - EC5 Nomenclature Symbol S S
t0d

Description Design tensile stress parallel (at zero degree) to grain alignment. Design tensile stress perpendicular (at 90 degrees) to grain alignment. Design compressive stress parallel to grain alignment. Design compressive stress perpendicular to grain alignment. Design bending stress about zz axis. Design bending stress about yy axis. Design shear stress. Design torsional stress. Design tensile strength - parallel to the grain alignment. Design tensile strength - perpendicular to the grain alignment. Design compressive strength - parallel to the grain alignment. Design compressive strength - perpendicular to the grain alignment. Design bending strength - about zz-axis. Design bending strength - about yy-axis. Design shear strength about yy axis. Permissible ratio of stresses as input using the RATIOparameter. The default value is 1.

t90d

S S S S S

c0d

c90d mzd

myd vd

S F F F F F F

tor_d t0d

t90d c0d

c90d mzd myd vd

RATIO

l ,l l ,l E G

z rel,z y rel,y 0,05 0,05

Slenderness ratios corresponding to bending about zz axis. Slenderness ratios corresponding to bending about yy axis. Fifth percentile value of modulus of elasticity parallel to grain. Fifth percentile value of shear modulus parallel to grain. Second moment of area about the strong z-axis. Second moment of area about the weak y-axis. Torsional moment of inertia. Characteristic bending strength. Width and depth of beam.

I I I f

z y

tor

mk

b, h

408 STAAD.Pro

Equations for Characteristic Values of Timber Species as per Annex-A of EN 338:2003 The following equations were used to determine the characteristic values: For a particular Timber Strength Class (TSC), the following characteristic strength values are required to compute the other related characteristic values. i. Bending Strength f
m,k 0, mean

ii. Mean Modulus of Elasticity in bending E iii. Density - SI No.


k

Property

Symbol

Wood Type Softwood Hardwood (C) (D)

1. Tensile Strength parallel to grain 2. Tensile Strength perpendicular to grain 3. Compressive Strength parallel to grain 4. Compressive Strength perpendicular to grain 5. Shear Strength 6. Modulus of Elasticity parallel to grain 7. Mean Modulus of Elasticity perpendicular to grain 8. Mean Shear Modulus 9. Shear Modulus

f f

t,0,k

0.6 * f

m,k

t,90,k c,0,k

f f

Minimum of {0.6 and (0.0015*r )} k 5 * (f ) 0.45


m,k

c,90,k

0.007*r

0.0015*r

f E E

v,k

0,05

90,mean mean 0,05

Minimum of {3.8 and 0.8)} (0.2*f m,k 0.67* 0.84* E E 0,mean 0,mean E /30 E /15
0,mean 0,mean

0,mean

/16

0,05

/16

The values of the characteristic strengths computed using the above equations, may differ with the tabulated values in Table-1 of EN 338:2003. However, in all such cases, the values obtained from the provided equations are treated as actual and is used by the program, as the values of Table-1 are based on these equations.

International Design Codes Manual 409

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

Design values of Characteristic Strength


As per clause 2.4.1, Design values of a strength property shall be calculated as: X = K mod(X / )
d k m

Where: X is design value of strength property


d k

X characteristic value of strength property is partial factor for material properties.


m

The member resistance in timber structure is calculated in STAAD according to the procedures outlined in EC5. This depends on several factors such as cross sectional properties, different load and material factors, timber strength class, load duration class, service class and so on. The methodology adopted in STAAD for calculating the member resistance is explained here.

Check for Tension stresses


If the direction of applied axial tension is parallel to the direction of timber grain alignment, the following formula should be checked per Equation 6.1 of EC-5 2004: S
t0d

/F

t0d

RATIO

If the direction of applied axial tension is perpendicular to the direction of timber grain alignment, the following formula should be checked: S
t90d

/F

t90d

RATIO

Check for Compression stresses


If the direction of applied axial compression is parallel to the direction of timber grain alignment, the following formula should be checked per Equation 6.2 of EC5 2004: S
c0d

/F

c0d

RATIO

410 STAAD.Pro

If the direction of applied axial compression is perpendicular to the direction of timber grain alignment, the following formula should be checked per Equation 6.3 of EC-5 2004: S
t0d

/(F

t0d

Kc90) RATIO

Check for Bending stresses


If members are under bending stresses, the following conditions should be satisfied per Equations 6.11 and 6.12 of EC-5 2004. Note: In STAAD z-z axis is the strong axis. (S /F ) +Km(S
mzd

mzd

mzd

myd myd

/F /F

myd myd

) RATIO ) RATIO

Km(S

mzd

/F

) +(S

Check for Shear stresses


Horizontal stresses are calculated and checked against allowable values per Equation 6.13 of EC-5 2004: S /F
vd vd

RATIO

Check for Torsional stresses


Members subjected to torsional stress should satisfy Equation 6.14 of EC-5 2004: S
tor_d

/(KshapeF

tor_d

) RATIO

Check for combined Bending and Axial tension


Members subjected to combined action of bending and axial tension stress should satisfy Equations 6.17 and 6.18 of EC-5 2004: Note: In STAAD z-z axis is the strong axis. (S (S /F /F ) +(S /F ) +Km(S
mzd

t0d t0d

t0d t0d

mzd

mzd

myd myd

/F /F

myd myd

) RATIO ) RATIO

) +Km(S

mzd

/F

) +(S

International Design Codes Manual 411

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

Check for combined Bending and axial Compression


If members are subjected to bending and axial compression stress, Equations 6.19 and 6.20 of EC-5 2004 should be satisfied: Note: In STAAD z-z axis is the strong axis. (S (S /F /F )2 +(S /F ) +Km(S
mzd

c0d c0d

c0d c0d

mzd

mzd

myd myd

/F /F

myd myd

) RATIO ) RATIO

)2 +Km(S

mzd

/F

) +(S

Stability check
A. Column Stability check The relative slenderness ratios should be calculated per Equations 6.21 and 6.22 of EC-5 2004. Note: In STAAD z-z axis is the strong axis. = /(S
z y

rel,z rel,y

c0k

/E

0,05

)1/2 )1/2

= /(S

c0k

/E

0,05

If both and are less than or equal to 0.3 the following conditions rel,z rel,y should be satisfied: (S (S
c0d c0d

/F /F

c0d c0d

)2 +(S

mzd

/F

mzd

) +Km(S
mzd

myd myd

/F /F

myd myd

) RATIO ) RATIO

)2 +Km(S

mzd

/F

) +(S

In other cases, the conditions in Equations 6.23 and 6.24 of EC-5 2004 should be satisfied. Note: In STAAD z-z axis is the strong axis. S S /(KczF ) +(S /F ) +Km(S
mzd

c0d c0d

c0d

mzd

mzd

myd

/F

myd

) RATIO ) RATIO

/(KcyF

c0d

) +Km(S

mzd

/F

) +(S

myd

/F

myd

Where (Equations 6.25 through 6.28 of EC-5 2004):

412 STAAD.Pro

Kcz = 1/{K +[(K )2 - (


z z y zy

rel,z

)2]1/2} )2]1/2}
rel,z

Kcy = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( Kz = 0.5[1 + (


c c rel,z rel,y

rel,y

- 0.3) +(

)2] )2]

Ky = 0.5[1 + (

- 0.3) +(

rel,y

The value of incorporated in the software is the one for solid timber (i.e., c 0.2). B. Beam Stability check If members are subjected to only a moment about the strong axis z, the stresses should satisfy Equation 6.33 of EC-5 2004: S
mzd

/(KcritF

mzd

) RATIO

Where a combination of moment about the strong z-axis and compressive force exists, the stresses should satisfy Equation 6.35 of EC-5 2004 (ref. to Equations 6.32 and 6.34 of the same): [S Where: Kcrit = 1.0 when
rel,m mzd

/(KcritF

mzd

)] 2 +S

c0d

/(KczF

c0d

) RATIO

0.75 when 0.75 <


rel,m rel,m

Kcrit = 1.56 - 0.75 Kcrit = 1/(


rel,m rel,m

rel,m

1.4

)2 when 1.4 < )1/2

= (f

mk

/S

m,crit

For hardwood, use Equation 6.30 of EC-5 2004: S


m,crit

= (E

0,05 y

I G

0,05 tor

)1/2/(l W )
ef z

For softwood, use Equation 6.31 of EC-5 2004: S


m,crit

= 0.78b2E

0,05

/(hl )
ef

5C.3 Design Parameters


Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular structure.

International Design Codes Manual 413

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

Depending on the model being designed, the user may have to change some or all of the parameter default values. Some parameters are unit dependent and when altered, the new setting must be compatible with the active unit specification. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 5C.2 - Timber Design EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Must be specified as TIMBER EC5 Design Code to follow. See section 5.51.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. ALPHA 0.0 Angle of inclination of load to the grain alignment. (Ref. Cl.6.1.1, Cl.6.1.2, Cl.6.1.3, Cl.6.1.4)
l

Description

0.0 = Load parallel to grain,

90.0 = Load Perpendicular to grain

414 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name DFF

Default Value None

Description

Deflection Length / Max. Allowable Net Final Local Deflection. In this case, deflection check will be performed, if both the parameters SERV and DFF are present with specific values. For appropriate range of values, please refer Cl.7.2 (Table 7.2)

DJ1

Start node number for a physical member under consideration for Deflection Check.

DJ2

End node number for a physical member under consideration for Deflection Check.

International Design Codes Manual 415

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameter Name KC90 Default Value 1.0 Factor taking into account the load configuration, possibility of splitting and degree of compressive deformation. (Ref. Cl.6.1.5(2))
l

Description

Range: 1.0 KC90 4.0

Other than the default value, user may specify any value within the range, depending on load-position, load-dispersion, contact length at support locations etc.

KLEF

1.0 (Member Length)

Effective Length Factor to check Lateral Torsional Buckling. (Ref. Table 6.1) Span of the beam depending on the support conditions and load configurations. The user will put the appropriate value from the Table 6.1. Required only for MTYP has a value of 1 (Beam).

416 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name KLY

Default Value 1.0 (Member Length)

Description

Effective Length Factor for Local-y-axis. (Ref. Cl.6.3.2), for the computation of the relative slenderness ratios. Effective Length Factor for Local-z-axis. (Ref. Cl.6.3.2), for the computation of the relative slenderness ratios. Load Duration Class (Ref. Cl.2.3.1.2), required to get the K-MOD value from Table 3.1. 1. Permanent action 2. Long term action 3. Medium term action 4. Short term action 5. Instantaneous action

KLZ

1.0 (Member Length)

LDC

International Design Codes Manual 417

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameter Name MTYP Default Value 0 Member Type: Beam/Column. (Ref. Cl.6.3.2, Cl.6.3.3) 0. Not defined by the user checks both clauses (Default). 1. Beam Member 2. Column Member This information is required to find which stability check will be performed as per the Cl 6.3 according to the Member Type. RATIO SCL 1.0 3 Permissible ratio of actual to allowable value. Service Class (Ref. Cl.2.3.1.3) 1. = Class 1, Moisture content <= 12% 2. = Class 2, Moisture content <= 20% 3. = Class 3, Moisture content > 20% Description

418 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name SERV

Default Value None

Description

Defines the load case numbers those are to be considered for serviceability (deflection) check.
l

The list of this parameter must contain only the valid load-case numbers.

Deflection checks will be performed only on those load-case results.

If this parameter is not provided, then in-spite of the presence of the parameter DFF the deflection check will NOT be performed.

TRACK

Degree/Level of Details of design output results. 1. Print the design output at the minimal detail level 2. Print the design output at the intermediate detail level 3. Print the design output that the maximum detail level

International Design Codes Manual 419

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameter Name TSC Default Value 6 (C24) Timber Strength Class (Ref. Reference EN338 2003) Softwood: 1 = C14, 2 = C16, 3 = C18, 4 = C20, 5 = C22, 6 = C24, 7 = C27, 8 = C30, 9 = C35, 10 = C40, 11 = C45, 12 = C50. Hardwood: 13 = D30, 14 = D35, 15 = D40, 16 = D50, 17 = D60, 18 = D70. This TSC definition will calculate the corresponding characteristic strength values using the equations as given in BSEN-338, Annex - A. Description

5C.4 Verification Problems


Verification Problem No.1 - Timber Column

Problem
A Timber Column of length 1.0 meter, having c/s dimension of 73 mm X 198 mm, is subjected to an axial compressive force of 50.0 kN. Design the member for the ultimate limit state. Material properties: Timber class: C24 Service classes: Class 2, moisture content 20% Load duration classes: Medium-term

420 STAAD.Pro

Cross section properties: Length of the member is 1 m. Rectangular cross section, b = 73 mm, h = 198 mm, Effective cross sectional area A = 14,454 mm, Radius of gyration of cross section about y-axis r = 21 mm,
y

Radius of gyration of cross section about z-axis r = 57 mm,


z

Section modulus of cross section about z-axis: W = 4.770x105 mm


z

Section modulus of cross section about y-axis: W = 1.759x105 mm


y

Solution
Characteristic material properties for timber: Modification factor Kmod = 0.80 from table 3.1 Material factors f
c0k m

= 1.30 from table 2.3

= 21.00 N/mm = (Kmodf


c0k

c0d

)/ = (0.8021.00)/1.30 = 12.92 N/mm [Cl 2.4.1(1)P]


m

Cross section loads: F = 50.000 kN


x

Compression parallel to the grain: S = (1000xF )/A = (1000x50.000)/14454 = 3.46N/mm < 12.92N/mm c0d x (F )
c0d

The ratio of actual compressive stress to allowable compressive strength: S


c0d

/F

c0d

= 3.46 / 12.92 = 0.268 < 1.0 [Cl. 6.1.4.(1)P]

Check for Slenderness: Slenderness ratios: = (1000/57) = 17.54


z

= (1000/21) = 47.62
y

0,mean =

1.1031 kN/m2

International Design Codes Manual 421

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

As timber grade is C24 (i.e., Soft Wood) E


0,05

= 0.67E

0,mean

= 0.739 kN/m2

[Annex A,EN 338:2003]


rel,z rel,y

= /(f
z y

c0k

/E

0,05

)1/2 = 17.54/(21.00/0.739)1/2 = 0.298 )1/2 = 47.62/(21.00/0.739)1/2 = 0.809

= /(f

c0k

/E

0,05

Since, S S

rel,y

is greater than 0.3, following conditions should be satisfied:


c0d

c0d c0d

/(KczF

) +(S

mzd

/F

mzd

) +Km(S
mzd

myd

/F

myd

) RATIO ) RATIO

/(KcyF

c0d

) +Km(S

mzd

/F

) +(S

myd

/F

myd

Where: Kz = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.298 - 0.3) c rel,z rel,z +(0.298)2] = 0.541 Ky = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.809 - 0.3) c rel,y rel,y +(0.809)2] = 0.878 Kcz = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.541 +[(0.541)2 - (0.298)2]1/2}= z z rel,z 1.008 Kcy = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.878 +[(0.878)2 - (0.809)2]1/2} y zy rel,y = 0.820 For Rectangular cross section Km = 0.70. The member is subjected to Compression only, so actual bending stress is zero. S /(KczF ) +(S /F ) +Km(S /F ) = 3.46/(1.00812.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +0.0 +0.0 = 0.268 +0.0 + 0.0 = 0.266 S /(KcyF ) +Km(S /F ) +(S /F ) = 3.46 /(0.82012.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +0.0 +0.0 = 0.326 ++0.0 + 0.0 = 0.326 Hence the critical ratio is 0.326 < 1.0 and the section is safe.

422 STAAD.Pro

Comparison
Table 5C.3 - EC 5: Part 1-1 Verification Problem 1 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Critical Ratio (Cl. 6.3.2) 0.326 0.327 Negligible

Input File
The following file is included AS C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\EUR\EC5 VER 1.STD.
STAAD SPACE INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 1.0 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC WOOD E 1.10316E+007 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 0.00231749 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL CONSTANTS MATERIAL WOOD MEMB 1 MEMBER PROPERTY 1 PRIS YD 0.198 ZD 0.073 SUPPORTS

International Design Codes Manual 423

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

1 FIXED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -50 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER EC5 ALPHA 0 ALL LDC 3 ALL SCL 2 ALL TSC 6 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
The member checking part of the output file:
STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (EC5 ) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 PRIS ZD = 0.073 YD = 0.198 PASS CL.6.3.2 0.327 1 50.00 C 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | AX = 0.01 IY = 0.00 IZ = 0.00 | | LEZ = 1.00 LEY = 1.00 | | | METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-

424 STAAD.Pro

| ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (NEW MMS) | | FBY = 14.769 FBZ = 14.769 | | FC = 12.859 | | ACTUAL STRESSES : (NEW MMS) | | fby = 0.000 fbz = 0.000 | | fc = 3.459 | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------|

Verification Problem No. 2

Problem
A Timber Column of length 1.0 meter, having c/s dimension of 73 mm X 198 mm, is subjected to an axial compressive force of 5.0 kN and moments of 2.0 kN.m and 1.0 kN.m about its major and minor axes respectively. Design the member for the ultimate limit state. Material properties: Timber Strength Class: C24 Service classes: Class 2, moisture content <=20% Load duration: Medium-term Cross section properties: Length of the member is 1 m. Rectangular cross section, b = 73 mm, h = 198 mm, Effective cross sectional area A = 14454 mm, Radius of gyration of cross section about y-axis r = 21 mm,
y

Radius of gyration of cross section about z-axis r = 57 mm,


z

Section modulus of cross section about z-axis: W = 4.770x105 mm


z

Section modulus of cross section about y-axis: W = 1.759x105 mm


y

International Design Codes Manual 425

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

Solution
Characteristic material properties for timber: Modification factor Kmod = 0.80 from table 3.1 Material factors f
c0k m

= 1.30 from table 2.3

= 21.00 N/mm = 7370 N/mm2


c0k

E F f

0,05

c0d

= (Kmodf

)/ = (0.8021.00)/1.30 = 12.92 N/mm [Cl 2.4.1(1)P]


m

myk

= 24.00 N/mm = Kmodf


myk

F f

myd

/ = (0.80x24.00)/1.30 = 14.77N/mm
m

mzk

= 24.00 N/mm = Kmodf


mzk

mzd

/ = (0.80x24.00)/1.30 = 14.77N/mm
m

Cross section loads: F = 5.000 kN


x

M = 2.000 kNm
z

M = 1.000 kNm
y

Check for Slenderness: Slenderness ratios: = (1000/57) = 17.54


z

= (1000/21) = 47.62
y

rel,z rel,y

= /(f
z y

c0k

/E

0,05

)1/2 = 17.54/(21.00/7370)1/2 = 0.298 )1/2 = 47.62/(21.00/7370)1/2 = 0.809

= /(f

c0k

/E

0,05

Since, is greater than 0.3, following conditions should be satisfied [Cl rel,y 6.3.2.3]: S S
c0d c0d

/(KczF

c0d

) +(S

mzd

/F

mzd

) +Km(S
mzd

myd

/F

myd

) RATIO ) RATIO

/(KcyF

c0d

) +Km(S

mzd

/F

) +(S

myd

/F

myd

Where:

426 STAAD.Pro

Kz = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.298 - 0.3) c rel,z rel,z +(0.298)2] = 0.541 Ky = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.809 - 0.3) c rel,y rel,y +(0.809)2] = 0.878 Kcz = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.541 +[(0.541)2 - (0.298)2]1/2}= z z rel,z 1.008 Kcy = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.878 +[(0.878)2 - (0.809)2]1/2} y zy rel,y = 0.820 For Rectangular cross section Km = 0.70. S S S
c0d

= (1000F /A) = (10005.000)/14454 = 0.35 N/mm


x

mzd myd

= (106M )/W = (1062.000)/(4.770x105) = 4.19 N/mm


z z

= (106M )/W = (1061.000)/(1.759x105) = 5.69 N/mm


y y

Combined stress ratio: S /(KczF ) +(S /F ) +Km(S /F ) = 0.35/(1.00812.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +4.19/14.77 +0.70(5.69/14.77) = 0.027 +0.283 +0.269 = 0.266 S /(KcyF ) +Km(S /F ) +(S /F ) = 0.35 /(0.82012.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +0.70(4.19/14.77) +5.69/14.77 = 0.033 +0.385 +0.198 = 0.616 Hence the critical ratio is 0.616 < 1.0 and the section is safe.

Comparison
Table 5C.4 - EC 5: Part 1-1 Verification Problem 2 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Critical Ratio (Cl. 6.3.2) 0.616 0.616 None

Input File
The following file is included AS C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\EUR\EC5 VER 2.STD.

International Design Codes Manual 427

European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1

STAAD SPACE INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 1 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC WOOD E 1.10316E+007 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 0.00231749 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL CONSTANTS MATERIAL WOOD MEMB 1 MEMBER PROPERTY 1 PRIS YD 0.198 ZD 0.073 SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY -5.0 MX 1.0 MZ 2.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER EC5 ALPHA 0 ALL LDC 3 ALL SCL 2 ALL TSC 6 ALL

428 STAAD.Pro

TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
The member checking part of the output file:
STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (EC5 ) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 PRIS ZD = 0.073 YD = 0.198 PASS CL.6.3.2 0.616 1 5.00 C 1.00 -2.00 0.0000 |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | AX = 0.01 IY = 0.00 IZ = 0.00 | | LEZ = 1.00 LEY = 1.00 | | | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (NEW MMS) | | FBY = 14.769 FBZ = 14.769 | | FC = 12.859 | | ACTUAL STRESSES : (NEW MMS) | | fby = 5.686 fbz = 4.193 | | fc = 0.346 | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-

International Design Codes Manual 429

430 STAAD.Pro

Section 6

Egyptian Codes

International Design Codes Manual 431

432 STAAD.Pro

Egyptian Codes - Concrete Design Per Egyptian Code - ECCS203


6A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capability of performing design of concrete beams, columns, and slabs according to 2004 revision of ECCS 203. Given the width and depth of a section, STAAD will calculate the required reinforcement to resist the forces and moments. Note: Design per ECCS203 is performed using the RCDesigner Module. Select ECCS203 as the Design Code for a Design Brief.

6A.2 Member Dimensions


Concrete members which will be designed by the program must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTY command. The following example shows the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTY 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 250. 11 13 PR YD 350.

6A.3 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform the design. Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. The following Beam Design Brief contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values.

International Design Codes Manual 433

Egyptian Codes - Concrete Design Per Egyptian Code - ECCS203

Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

6A.4 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Considerations


STAAD provides the user with two methods of accounting for the slenderness effects in the analysis and design of concrete members. The first method is equivalent to the procedure presented in ECCS203-2004 equation 4-11. In this section, the code recognizes that additional moments induced by deflection are present and states that these 'secondary' moments are accounted for by the design formula in equation 6-38, 6-37 etc. This is the method used in the design for concrete in STAAD. Alternatively STAAD houses a PDELTA ANALYSIS facility, which allows the effects of these second order moments to be considered in the analysis rather than the design. In a PDELTA analysis, after solving the joint displacements of the structure, the additional moments induced in the structure are calculated. These can be compared to those calculated using the formulation of ECCS203-2004.

434 STAAD.Pro

6A.5 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are pre scanned to identify the critical load cases at different sections of the beams. The total number of sections considered is 13(e.g., 0., .1, .2, .25, .3, .4, .5, .6, .7, .75, .8, .9 and 1). All of these sections are scanned to determine the design force envelopes.

Design for Flexure


Maximum sagging (creating tensile stress at the bottom face of the beam) and hogging (creating tensile stress at the top face) moments are calculated for all active load cases at each of the above mentioned sections. Each of these sections is designed to resist both of these critical sagging and hogging moments. Currently, design of singly reinforced sections only is permitted. If the section dimensions are inadequate as a singly reinforced section, such a message will be permitted in the output. Flexural design of beams is performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexure design is performed again in a second pass taking into account the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provided after the preliminary design. Final provisions of flexural reinforcements are made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the curtailment of reinforcements as per ECCS203-2004. Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (finally which will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account of other practical consideration), user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 13 equally spaced sections from which the final detailed drawing can be prepared.

Design for Shear


Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Shear design is performed at 13 equally spaced sections (0.to 1.) for the maximum shear forces amongst the active load cases and the associated torsional moments. Shear capacity calculation at different sections without the shear reinforcement is based on the actual tensile reinforcement provided by STAAD

International Design Codes Manual 435

Egyptian Codes - Concrete Design Per Egyptian Code - ECCS203

program. Two-legged stirrups are provided to take care of the balance shear forces acting on these sections. The following represents a sample Beam Design Output:

6A.6 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial force and biaxial bending at the ends. All active loadings are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which produces maximum reinforcement is called the critical load and is displayed. The requirements of ECCS203-2004 equation 6-37,6-38,6-41 etc are followed, with the user having control on the effective length parameters. Bracing conditions are controlled by using the BRACE parameter. The program will then decide whether or not the column is short or slender and whether it requires additional moment calculations.

436 STAAD.Pro

The following represents a sample Column Design output:

International Design Codes Manual 437

Egyptian Codes - Concrete Design Per Egyptian Code - ECCS203

The following represents a sample Shear Design Output:

438 STAAD.Pro

International Design Codes Manual 439

440 STAAD.Pro

Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205


6B.1 General Comments
This section presents some general statements regarding the implementation of the 2001 revision of the Egyptian code of practice for structural steel construction and bridges Code No. 205 (Min Dec #279/2001) design in STAAD. The design philosophy and procedural logistics for member selection and code checking are based upon the principles of allowable stress design. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing and failure by stability considerations. The flowing sections describe the salient features of the allowable stresses being calculated and the stability criteria being used. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the allowable stresses and the most economic section is selected on the basis of least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program checks stability and strength requirements and reports the critical loading condition and the governing code criteria. It is generally assumed that the user will take care of the detailing requirements like provision of stiffeners and check the local effects such as flange buckling and web crippling. Note: Design per Code No. 205 is performed using the User Interface Steel Design mode. Select EGPT205-2001 as the Design Code in the Brief Details dialog.

6B.2 Allowable Stresses


The member design and code checking in STAAD are based upon the allowable stress design method as per Egyptian Code No. 205, It is a method for proportioning structural members using design loads and forces, allowable stresses, and design limitations for the appropriate material under service conditions. It would not be possible to describe every aspect of Egyptian Code: 205 in this manual. This section, however, will discuss the salient features of the allowable stresses specified by Egyptian Code: 205 and implemented in STAAD. Appropriate sections of Egyptian Code: 205 will be referenced during the discussion of various types of allowable stresses.

International Design Codes Manual 441

Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205

6B.2.1 Axial Stress


Tensile Stress
The allowable tensile stress, as calculated in STAAD as per Egyptian Code: 205 is described below. The estimated stress on the net effective sectional area in various members, multiplied by the appropriate factor of safety shall not exceed minimum guaranteed yield stress of the material. The permissible stress in axial tension, in MPa on the net effective area of the at sections shall not exceed: Clause: 2.6.2 F = 0.58f
t y

Where: f = minimum yield stress of steel in Mpa


y

Compressive Stress
Allowable compressive stress on the gross section of axially loaded compression members shall not exceed the permissible stress calculated based on the following formula: (Clause: 2.6.4)

For all grade of steel: For = kl/r 100 F = 7500/2


c

Where: F = Permissible stress in axial compression, in Mpa


c

f = Yield stress of steel, in Mpa


y

442 STAAD.Pro

= l/r = Slenderness ratio of the member, ratio of the effective length to appropriate radius of gyration

6B.2.2 Bending Stress


The allowable bending stress in a member subjected to bending is calculated based on the following formula: (Clause: 2.6.5) The laterally unsupported length (Lu) of the compression flange is limited by L = 20b /f
u f y

bt

or F

bc

= 0.64f

Clause 2.6.5.5 Tension F F


bt

bt

= 0.58F

y bc

Clause 2.6.5.5 Compression F

I. Compression flange is braced laterally at intervals exceeding L , the allowable u bending stress in compression F will be taken as follows.
bc

i. For shallow thick flanged sections, where approximately t L /(b d) > 4 f u f the lateral tensional buckling stress is governed by the torsion strength given by: F
ltb1

= [800/(L

ud

/A )]C 0.58F
f b

ii. For Deep flanged sections, where approximately t L /(b d) > 4 the f u f lateral torsional buckling stress governed by the buckling strength given by: a. When L /r 84(C /F )1/2, then
u T b y u T b y y

F b. When

1tb2

= 0.58F

84(C /F )1/2 b y

<L /r 188(C /F )1/2, then

c. When L /r > 188(C /F )1/2, then


u T b y

F Where:

1tb2

= [1200/(L /r )2]C 0.58F


u T b

International Design Codes Manual 443

Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205

L = Effective laterally unsupported length of compression u flange. k = Effective length factor r = radius of gyration about minor axis of a section T compressing the compression web area (in cms) b = Compression flange width
f

d = Total depth C = Coefficient depending on the type of load and support b conditions as given in table 2.2 I. Compression on extreme fibers of channels bent about their major axis F
ltb

= [800/(L d/A )]C 0.58F


u f b

Where: F F f
bt bc

= Bending stress in tension = Bending stress in compression = Yield stress of steel, in MPa

6B.2.3 Shear Stress


Allowable shear stress calculations are based on Section 2.6.3 of Egyptian code 205. For shear on the web, the gross section taken into consideration consists of the product of the total depth and the web thickness. q
all

= 0.35F

Where: q
all

= Allowable shear stress

6B.2.4 Combined Stress


Members subjected to both axial and bending stresses are proportioned accordingly to following

444 STAAD.Pro

Axial Compression and Bending


All the members subjected to bending and axial compression are required to satisfy the equation of section 2.6.7.1

Where:

ca c

= Actual compression stress

F = Allowable compressive stress, clause 2.6.4 f


bcx

,f

bcy

= Actual Bending stress about x and y-axes respectively. = Allowable compressive bending stress, clause 2.6.5

bcx Ex m

,F

bcy

F ,F

Ey

= Euler stress in t/cm2

C = Moment modification factor

Axial Tension and Bending


All the members subject to bending and axial tension are required to satisfy the equation of section 2.6.7.2

6B.3 Stability Requirements


Slenderness ratios are calculated for all members and checked against the appropriate maximum values. Table 5.1 of Egyptian code #205: summarizes the maximum slenderness ratios for different types of members. In STAAD implementation of Egyptian code #205, appropriate maximum slenderness ratio can be provided for each member. If no maximum slenderness ratio is provided,

International Design Codes Manual 445

Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205

compression members will be checked against a maximum value of 180 and tension members will be checked against a maximum value of 300

6B.4 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to verify whether the specified section is capable of satisfying applicable design code requirements. The code checking is based on the Egyptian code #205 requirements. Forces and moments at specified sections of the members are utilized for the code checking calculations. Sections may be specified using the BEAM parameter or the SECTION command. If no sections are specified, the code checking is based on forces and moments at the member ends. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from the start) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed out.

6B.5 Member Selection


STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section, that is, the lightest section, which satisfies the applicable code requirements. The section selected will be of the same type (I-Section, Channel etc.) as originally specified by the user. Member selection may be performed with all types of steel sections and user provided tables. Selection of members, whose properties are originally provided from user specified table, will be limited to sections in the user provided table. Member selection can not be performed on members whose cross sectional properties are specified as PRISMATIC. The process of MEMBER SELECTION may be controlled using the parameters listed in Table 6B.1. It may be noted that the parameters DMAX and DMIN may be used to specify member depth constraints for selection. If PROFILE parameter is provided, the search for the lightest section is restricted to that profile. Up to three (3) profiles may be provided for any member with a section being selected from each one. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

446 STAAD.Pro

6B.6 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


For code checking or member selection, the program produces the result in a tabulated fashion as well as step by step procedure. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Design of Member No. 1 As Per Egyptian Steel Code 205

6B.7 Design Parameters


Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 447

Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205 Table 6B.1 - Egyptian Steel Design Code #205 Parameters Parameter Name CB Default Value Member length Description Coefficient depending on the type of load and conditions as g. Location of section force calculations: 0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate section forces at twelfth points along the beam, design at each intermediate location and report the critical location where ratio is maximum. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway Cm value in local y & z axes

BEAM

3.0

448 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name DFF

Default Value None (Mandatory for deflection check) 100.0 cm. 0.0 cm. 250 MPA (36.25 KSI)

Description "Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. Yield strength of steel.

DMAX DMIN FYLD

MAIN

180 (Comp. Memb.)

Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for compression members. Net section factor for tension members. Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Sidesway 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis. 1.0 = No sidesway

NSF PROFILE

1.0 -

RATIO

1.0

SSY

0.0

International Design Codes Manual 449

Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205 Parameter Name SSZ TMAIN Default Value 0.0 300 (Tension Memb) Description Same as above except in local z-axis. Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for tension members. Design for weld: 1 = Weld for Closed sections 2 = Weld for Open sections WMIN WSTR 0.4 Fyld Minimum welding thickness. Absolute welding stress.

WELD

450 STAAD.Pro

Section 7

French Codes

International Design Codes Manual 451

452 STAAD.Pro

French Codes - ConcreteDesign per B.A.E.L


7A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capabilities for performing design of concrete beams, columns, and slabs according to the 1991 edition of Bton Arm aux tats Limites (hereafter referred to as BAEL). Given the width and depth (or diameter for circular columns) of a section, STAAD will calculate the required reinforcing to resist the various input loads. Design per B.A.E.L. is invoked by using the CODE BAEL command.

7A.2 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform design per B.A.E.L. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the engineer control over the actual design process. Default values, of commonly used numbers in conventional design practice, have been used for simplicity. Table 7A.1 contains a complete list of available parameters and their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 7A.1 - French Concrete Design B.A.E.L. Parameters Parameter Default Name Value CODE BAEL Description

Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

CLEAR

* 20 mm YD

Clearance of reinforcing bar. Value is automatically set to 20 mm for C35 and higher. Depth of concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

DEPTH

International Design Codes Manual 453

French Codes - ConcreteDesign per B.A.E.L Parameter Default Name Value EFACE *0.0 Description

Face of Support Location at end of beam. Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.

FC FYMAIN FYSEC MAXMAIN MINMAIN MINSEC MMAG SFACE

* 30 N/ mm2 * 300 N/mm2 * 300 N/mm2 50 mm 8 mm 8 mm 1.0 *0.0

Concrete Yield Stress. Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Maximum main reinforcement bar size. (8mm - 60mm). Minimum main reinforcement bar size. (8mm - 60mm). Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. (8mm - 60mm). A factor by which the design moments will be magnified. Face of support location at start of beam. Only considers shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending. Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moments for beam design. Critical Moment will not be printed out with beam design report. A value of 1.0 will mean a print out. Width of the concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

NSECTION

10

TRACK

0.0

WIDTH

ZD

454 STAAD.Pro

* These values must be provided in the units currently being used for input.

7A.3 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Consideration


STAAD provides the user two methods of accounting for the slenderness effect in the analysis and design of concrete members. The first method is a procedure which takes into account second order effects. Here, STAAD accounts for the secondary moments, due to axial loads and deflections, when the PDELTA ANALYSIS command is used. STAAD, after solving for the joint displacements of the structure, calculates the additional moments induced in the structure. Therefore, by using PDELTA ANALYSIS, member forces are calculated which will require no user modification before beginning member design. The second method by which STAAD allows the user to account for the slenderness effect is through user supplied moment magnification factors. Here the user approximates the additional moment by supplying a factor by which moments will be multiplied before beginning member design.

7A.4 Member Dimensions


Concrete members that are to be designed by STAAD must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTIES command. The following example demonstrates the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTIES 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450 ZD 300. 11 13 PR YD 300.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 300 mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with a 300 mm diameter. Note that area (AX) is not provided for these members. If shear areas (AY & AZ) are to be considered in analysis, the user may provide them along with YD and ZD. Also note that moments of inertia may be provided, but if not provided, the program will calculate values from YD and ZD.

International Design Codes Manual 455

French Codes - ConcreteDesign per B.A.E.L

7A.5 Beam Design


Beam design includes both flexure and shear. For both types of beam action, all active beam loadings are scanned to create moment and shear envelopes, and locate critical sections. The total number of sections considered is twelve, unless that number is redefined with the NSECTION parameter. From the critical moment values, the required positive and negative bar pattern is developed, with cut-off lengths calculated to include required development length. Shear design includes critical shear values plus torsional moments. From these values, stirrup sizes are calculated with proper spacing. The stirrups are assumed to be U-shaped for beams with no torsion, and closed hoops for beams subject to torsion. Example of Input Data for Beam Design:
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE BAEL FYMAIN 415 ALL FYSEC 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEM 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 SFACE 100 MEMB 7 TO 9 EFACE 100 MEMB 7 TO 9 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 6 TRACK 2.0 MEMB 7 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN

7A.6 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial force and biaxial moments at the ends. All active loadings are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which produces maximum reinforcement is called the critical load. Column design is done for

456 STAAD.Pro

square, rectangular, and circular sections. For rectangular and square sections, the reinforcement is always assumed to be equally distributed on each side. That means the total number of bars will always be a multiple of four (4). This may cause slightly conservative results in some cases. Example of Input Data for Column Design:
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE BAEL FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MMAG 1.5 MEMB 4 5 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6 END CONCRETE DESIGN

7A.7 Slab/Wall Design


Slab and walls are designed per BAEL 1983 specifications. To design a slab or wall, it must be modeled using finite elements. The command specifications are in accordance with Chapter II, section 6.40. Elements are designed for the moments Mx and My. These moments are obtained from the element force output (see Section 3.8 of the Technical Reference Manual). The reinforcement required to resist Mx moment is denoted as longitudinal reinforcement and the reinforcement required to resist My moment is denoted as transverse reinforcement. The parameters FYMAIN, FC, and CLEAR listed in Table 7A.1 are relevant to slab design. Other parameters mentioned in Table 7A.1 are not applicable to slab design.
Figure 7.1 - Element moments: Longitudinal (L) and Transverse (T)

International Design Codes Manual 457

French Codes - ConcreteDesign per B.A.E.L

Example of Input Data for Slab/Wall Design:


UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE BAEL FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 25 ALL CLEAR 40 ALL DESIGN ELEMENT 15 TO 20 END CONCRETE DESIGN

458 STAAD.Pro

French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code


7B.1 General Comments
The STAAD implementation of French Steel Design is based the 1977 edition of Centre Technique Industriel de la Construction Metallique (hereafter referred to as CM66) publication entitled "Design Rules for Structural Steelwork." The design philosophy embodied in this specification is based on the concept of limit state design. Structures are designed and proportioned according to the limit states of which they would become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit-states are recognized: ultimate and serviceability. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability; that in serviceability is deflection. Appropriate load and resistance factors are used so that uniform reliability is achieved for all steel structures under various loading conditions and at the same time the chances of limits being surpassed are acceptably remote. In the STAAD implementation, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength, stability and serviceability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria, as augmented by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type, or other related parameters. The code checking portion of the program verifies that code requirements for each selected section are met and also identifies the governing criteria. The next few sections describe the salient features of STAAD implementation of "Design Rules for Structural Steelwork." A detailed description of the design process, along with its underlying concepts and assumptions, is available in the specification document.

7B.2 Basis of Methodology


The "Design Rules for Structural Steelwork (Revision 80)" permits the usage of elastic analysis. Thus, in STAAD, linear elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments in the members. However, strength and stability considerations are based on the principles of plastic behavior. Axial compression buckling and lateral torsional buckling are taken into consideration for calculation

International Design Codes Manual 459

French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code

of axial compression resistance and flexural resistance of members. Slenderness calculations are made and overall geometric stability is checked for all members.

7B.3 Member Capacities


The member strengths are calculated in STAAD according to the procedures outlined in section 4 of this specification. Note that the program automatically considers co-existence of axial force, shear and bending in calculating section capacities. For axial tension capacity, procedures of section 4.2 are followed. For axial compression capacity, formulas of section 5.3 are used. Moment capacities about both axes are calculated using the procedures of sections 4.5 and 4.6. Lateral torsional buckling is considered in calculating ultimate twisting moment per section 5.22 of the specification. The parameter UNL (see Table 7B.1) must be used to specify the unsupported length of the compression flange for a laterally unsupported member. Note that this length is also referred to as twisting length.

7B.4 Combined Axial Force and Bending


The procedures of sections 4.55 and 5.32 are implemented for interaction of axial forces and bending. Appropriate interaction equations are used and the governing criterion is determined.

7B.5 Design Parameters


The design parameters outlined in Table 7B.1 may be used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program, thus allowing the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected as frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

460 STAAD.Pro

Table 7B.1 - French Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value FRENCH Description

Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

0.0

0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate moments at tenth points long the beam, and use maximum Mz for design.

C1

1.0

Parameter used in clause 5.21 in the calculation of M(D), the critical twisting moment and as shown in CM 66 Addendum 80, table 5, usual range from 0.71 to 4.10 Parameter used in clause 5.21 in the calculation of M(D), the critical twisting moment and as shown in CM 66 Addendum 80, table 5, usual range from 0.0 to 1.56 "Deflection Length" divided by the Maximum allowable local deflection

C2

1.0

DFF

None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member

DJ1

Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1)

DJ2

End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for calmember culation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1)

International Design Codes Manual 461

French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code Parameter Name DMAX DMIN FYLD KY Default Value 100.0 cm. 0.0 cm. 250.0 MPa 1.0 Description

Maximum allowable depth (used in member selection). Minimum allowable depth (used in member selection). Yield strength of steel. K value for axial compression buckling about local Y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value for axial compression buckling about local Z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio about Y-axis for axial compression. Length to calculate slenderness ratio about Z-axis for axial compression. Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of actual load effect and design strength.

KZ

1.0

LY

Member Length Member Length 1.0 1.0

LZ

NSF RATIO

462 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name SAME*

Default Value 0.0

Description

Controls the sections to try during a SELECT process. 0.0 = Try every section of the same type as original 1.0 = Try only those sections with a similar name as original, e.g., if the original is an HEA 100, then only HEA sections will be selected, even if there are HEMs in the same table.

TRACK

0.0

0.0 = Suppress printing of all design strengths. 1.0 = Print all design strengths.

UNF UNL

1.0 Member Length

Same as above provided as a fraction of member length. Unsupported length of compression flange for calculating moment resistance.

*For angles, if the original section is an equal angle, then the selected section will be an equal angle and vice versa for unequal angles.

7B.6 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available in the STAAD.Pro implementation of CM 66 (Revn. 80). Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

International Design Codes Manual 463

French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code

Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

7B.7 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


Results of code checking and member selection are presented in the output file in a tabular format. Note: COND CRITIQUE refers to the section of the CM 66 (Revn. 80) specification which governed the design. If the TRACK parameter is set to 1.0, calculated member capacities will be printed. The following is a detailed description of printed items: PC = Member Compression Capacity TR = Member Tension Capacity MUZ = Member Moment Capacity (about z-axis) MUY = Member Moment Capacity (about y-axis) VPZ = Member Shear Capacity (z-axis) VPY = Member Shear Capacity (y-axis) STAAD contains a broad set of facilities for designing structural members as individual components of an analyzed structure. The member design facilities provide the user with the ability to carry out a number of different design operations. These facilities may be used selectively in accordance with the requirements of the design problem. The operations to perform a design are:
l

Specify the members and the load cases to be considered in the design. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection. Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values.

These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements. Currently STAAD supports steel design of wide flange, S, M, HP shapes, angle, double angle, channel, double channel, beams with cover plate, composite beams and code checking of prismatic properties.

464 STAAD.Pro

Sample Input data for Steel Design:


UNIT METER PARAMETER CODE FRENCH NSF 0.85 ALL UNL 10.0 MEMBER 7 KY 1.2 MEMBER 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

7B.8 Built-in French Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered for these members. An example of the member property specification in an input file is provided at the end of this section. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained by using the tools of the graphical user interface. Following are the descriptions of different types of sections.

IPE Shapes
These shapes are designated in the following way.
10 15 TA ST IPE140 20 TO 30 TA ST IPEA120 33 36 TO 46 BY 2 TA ST IPER180

International Design Codes Manual 465

French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code

HE shapes
HE shapes are specified as follows.
3 5 TA ST HEA120A 7 10 TA ST HEM140 13 14 TA ST HEB100

IPN Shapes
The designation for the IPN shapes is similar to that for the IPE shapes.
25 TO 35 TA ST IPN200 23 56 TA ST IPN380

T Shapes
Tee sections are not input by their actual designations, but instead by referring to the I beam shapes from which they are cut. For example,
1 5 TA T IPE140 2 8 TA T HEM120

U Channels
Shown below is the syntax for assigning 4 different names of channel sections.
1 TO 5 TA ST UAP100 6 TO 10 TA ST UPN220 11 TO 15 TA ST UPN240A 16 TO 20 TA ST UAP250A

466 STAAD.Pro

Double U Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without a spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel.
11 TA D UAP150 17 TA D UAP250A SP 0.5

In the above set of commands, member 11 is a back-to-back double channel UAP150 with no spacing in between. Member 17 is a double channel UAP250A with a spacing of 0.5 length units between the channels.

Angles
Two types of specification may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
16 20 TA ST L30X30X2.7

The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 30mm and a leg thickness of 2.7mm. This specification may be used when the local Z axis corresponds to the z-z axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local Y axis corresponds to the z-z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) should be used instead of ST.
17 21 TA RA L25X25X4 22 24 TA RA L100X100X6.5

Note that if the leg thickness is a round number such as 4.0, only the number 4 appears in the section name, the decimal part is not part of the section name.

Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by means of input of the words SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose.
33 35 TA SD L30X20X4 SP 0.6 37 39 TA LD L80X40X6

International Design Codes Manual 467

French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code

43 TO 47 TA LD L80X80X6.5 SP 0.75

Tubes (Rectangular or Square Hollow Sections)


Section names of tubes, just like angles, consist of the depth, width and wall thickness as shown below.
64 78 TA ST TUB50252.7 66 73 TA ST TUB2001008.0

Members 64 and 78 are tubes with a depth of 50mm, width of 25mm and a wall thickness of 2.7mm. Members 66 and 73 are tubes with a depth of 200mm, width of 100mm and a wall thickness of 8.0mm. Unlike angles, the ".0" in the thickness is part of the section name. Tubes can also be input by their dimensions instead of by their table designations. For example,
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5

is a tube that has a depth of 8 length units, width of 6 length units, and a wall thickness of 0.5 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, will be performed for TUBE sections specified in this way.

Pipes (Circular Hollow Sections)


To designate circular hollow sections, use PIP followed by numerical value of the diameter and thickness of the section in mm omitting the decimal portion of the value provided for the diameter. The following example illustrates the designation.
8 TO 28 TA ST PIP422.6 3 64 78 TA ST PIP21912.5

Members 8 to 28 are pipes 42.4mm in dia, having a wall thickness of 2.6mm. Members 3, 64 and 78 are pipes 219.1mm in dia, having a wall thickness of 12.5mm. Circular hollow sections may also be provided by specifying the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,

468 STAAD.Pro

1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0

specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 length units and inside dia. of 20 length units. Only code checking, no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.
SAMPLE FILE CONTAINING FRENCH SHAPES STAAD SPACE UNIT METER KN JOINT COORD 1 0 0 0 15 140 0 0 MEMB INCI 1 1 2 14 UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTIES FRENCH * IPE SHAPES 1 TA ST IPEA120 * IPN SHAPES 2 TA ST IPN380 *HE SHAPES 3 TA ST HEA200 * T SHAPES 4 TA T HEM120 * U CHANNELS 5 TA ST UAP100 * DOUBLE U CHANNELS 6 TA D UAP150SP 0.5 * ANGLES 7 TA ST L30X30X2.7 * REVERSE ANGLES 8 TA RA L25X25X4

International Design Codes Manual 469

French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code

* DOUBLE ANGLES - SHORT LEGS BACK * TO BACK 9 TA SD L30X20X4 SP 0.25 * DOUBLE ANGLES - LONG LEGS BACK * TO BACK 10 TA LD L80X40X6 SP 0.75 * TUBES (RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE * HOLLOW SECTIONS) 11 TA ST TUB50252.7 * TUBES (RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE * HOLLOW SECTIONS) 12 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5 * PIPES (CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS) 13 TA ST PIP422.6 * PIPES (CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS) 14 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0 PRINT MEMB PROP FINI

470 STAAD.Pro

Section 8

German Codes

International Design Codes Manual 471

472 STAAD.Pro

German Codes - ConcreteDesign Per DIN 1045


8A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capabilities of performing concrete design based on the DIN 1045 November 1989. Slab design is also available but this follows the requirements of Baumann, Munich, which is the basis for Eurocode 2. Design for a member involves calculation of the amount of reinforcement required for the member. Calculations are based on the user specified properties and the member forces obtained from the analysis. In addition, the details regarding placement of the reinforcement on the cross section are also reported in the output.

8A.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections for concrete members can be designed.
l

For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular & Square) For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)

8A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members which will be designed by the program must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTY command. The following example shows the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTY 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 250. 11 13 PR YD 350.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250 mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. It is absolutely imperative that the user not provide the cross section area (AX) as an input.

International Design Codes Manual 473

German Codes - ConcreteDesign Per DIN 1045

8A.4 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Considerations


Slenderness effects are extremely important in designing compression members. There are two options by which the slenderness effect can be accommodated. The first method is equivalent to the procedure presented in DIN 1045 17.4.3/17.4.4 which is used as the basis for commonly used design charts considering e/d and sk/d for conditions where the slenderness moment exceeds 70. This method has been adopted in the column design in STAAD per the DIN code. The second option is to compute the secondary moments through an analysis. Secondary moments are caused by the interaction of the axial loads and the relative end displacements of a member. The axial loads and joint displacements are first determined from an elastic stiffness analysis and the secondary moments are then evaluated. To perform this type of analysis, use the command PDELTA ANALYSIS instead of PERFORM ANALYSIS in the input file. The user must note that to take advantage of this analysis, all the combinations of loading must be provided as primary load cases and not as load combinations. This is due to the fact that load combinations are just algebraic combinations of forces and moments, whereas a primary load case is revised during the P-delta analysis based on the deflections. Also, note that the proper factored loads (like 1.5 for dead load etc.) should be provided by the user. STAAD does not factor the loads automatically. The column is designed for the total moment which is the sum of the primary and secondary forces. The secondary moments can be compared to those calculated using the charts of DIN 1045.

8A.5 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are prescanned to identify the critical load cases at different sections of the beams. The total number of sections considered is 13 (e.g., 0., .1, .2, .25, .3, .4, .5, .6, .7, .75, .8, .9 and 1). All of these sections are scanned to determine the design force envelopes.

Design for Flexure


Maximum sagging (creating tensile stress at the bottom face of the beam) and hogging (creating tensile stress at the top face) moments are calculated for all

474 STAAD.Pro

active load cases at each of the above mentioned sections. Each of these sections is designed to resist these critical sagging and hogging moments. Currently, design of singly reinforced sections only is permitted. If the section dimensions are inadequate as a singly reinforced section, such a message will be printed in the output. Flexural design of beams is performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexural design is performed again in a second pass taking into account the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provided after the preliminary design. Final provisions of flexural reinforcements are made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the curtailment of reinforcements as per the DIN code. Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (finally which will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account of other practical considerations), the user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 13 equally spaced sections from which the final detailed drawing can be prepared.

Design for Shear and Torsion


Shear design in STAAD conforms to the specifications of section 17.5 of DIN 1045. Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Shear and torsional design is performed at the start and end sections of the member at a distance "d" away from the node of the member where "d" is the effective depth calculated from flexural design. The maximum shear forces from amongst the active load cases and the associated torsional moments are used in the design. The capacity of the concrete in shear and torsion is determined at the location of design and the balance, if any, is carried by reinforcement. It is assumed that no bent-up bars are available from the flexural reinforcement to carry and "balance" shear. Two-legged stirrups are provided to take care of the balance shear forces acting on these sections. Stirrups are assumed to be U-shaped for beams with no torsion, and closed hoops for beams subject to torsion. Example of Input Data for Beam Design
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE GERMAN FYMAIN 415 ALL

International Design Codes Manual 475

German Codes - ConcreteDesign Per DIN 1045

FYSEC 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEM 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN

8A.6 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial forces and biaxial moments at the ends. All active load cases are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which yields maximum reinforcement is called the critical load. The requirements of DIN 1045figure 13, for calculating the equilibrium equations for rectangular and circular sections from first principles, is implemented in the design. The user has control of the effective length (sk) in each direction by using the ELZ and ELY parameters as described on Table 8A.1. This means that the slenderness will be evaluated along with e/d to meet the requirements of DIN 1045 section 17.4.3 and 17.4.4. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. Square and rectangular columns are designed with reinforcement distributed on all four sides equally. That means the total number of bars will always be a multiple of four (4). This may cause slightly conservative results in some cases. The TRACK parameter may be used to obtain the design details in various levels of detail. Example of Input Data for Column Design
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE GERMAN FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6

476 STAAD.Pro

END CONCRETE DESIGN

8A.7 Slab Design


To design a slab, it must first be modeled using finite elements and analyzed. The command specifications are in accordance with Section 5.52 of the Technical Reference Manual. Slabs are designed to specifications as described by BAUMANN of MUNICH which is the basis for Eurocode 2. Elements are designed for the moments Mx and My. These moments are obtained from the element force output (see Chapter 2 of the Technical Reference Manual). The reinforcement required to resist the Mx moment is denoted as longitudinal reinforcement and the reinforcement required to resist the My moment is denoted as transverse reinforcement. The following parameters are those applicable to slab design:
l

FYMAINYield stress for all reinforcing steel FCConcrete grade CLEARDistance from the outer surface of the element to the edge of the bar. This is considered the same on both top and bottom surfaces of the element. SRAParameter which denotes the angle of direction of the required transverse reinforcement relative to the direction of the longitudinal reinforcement for the calculation of BAUMANN design forces.

The other parameters shown in Table 8A.1 are not applicable to slab design.

BAUMANN equations
If the default value of zero is used, the design will be based on Mx and My forces which are obtained from the STAAD analysis. The SRA parameter (Set Reinforcement Angle) can be manipulated to introduce resolved BAUMANN forces into the design replacing the pure Mx and My moments. These new design moments allow the Mxy moment to be considered when designing the section, resolved as an axial force. Orthogonal or skew reinforcement may be considered. If SRA is set to -500, an orthogonal layout will be assumed. If however a skew is to be considered, an angle is given in degrees measured from the local element X axis anticlockwise (positive). The resulting Mx* and My* moments are calculated and shown in the design format.

International Design Codes Manual 477

German Codes - ConcreteDesign Per DIN 1045

The design of the slab considers a fixed bar size of 10 mm in the longitudinal direction and 8 mm in the transverse. The longitudinal bar is the layer closest to the slab exterior face.

8A.8 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform the design. Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 8A.1 of this manual contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 8A.1 - German Concrete Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as DIN1045. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

CLEAR

25 mm

Clear cover for reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter. Depth of concrete member. The default value is provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.

DEPTH

YD

478 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name EFACE

Default Value 0.0

Description

Face of support location at end of beam, measured from the end joint. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.

ELY ELZ FC FYMAIN

1.0 1.0 25 N/mm2

Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength

420 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcement (For slabs, it is 500 N/mm2 for both directions) 420 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a. Applicable to shear and torsion reinforcement in beams 50 mm Maximum required reinforcement bar size. Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 14 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Applicable to shear and torsion reinforcement in beams. Factor by which column design moments are magnified for column design

FYSEC

MAXMAIN

MINMAIN

16 mm

MINSEC

8 mm

MMAG

1.0

International Design Codes Manual 479

German Codes - ConcreteDesign Per DIN 1045 Parameter Name NSECTION Default Value 10 Description

Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 20. Face of support location at start of beam, measured from the start joint. (Only applicable for shear use MEMBER OFFSET for bending) 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy -slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout considering Mxy A = Skew angle considered in BAUMANN equations. A is the angle in degrees.

SFACE

0.0

SRA

0.0

TRACK

0.0

Level of detail in output 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. For beams gives area of steel required at intermediate sections. (see NSECTION)

WIDTH

ZD

Width of concrete member. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.

480 STAAD.Pro

German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code


8B.1 General
This section presents some general statements regarding the implementation of the DIN code of practice for structural steel design (DIN 18800 Parts 1 & 2) in STAAD. The design philosophy and procedural logistics are based on the principles of elastic analysis and allowable stress design. Facilities are available for member selection as well as code checking. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing and failure by stability considerations. The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceedance of the allowable stresses or capacities and the most economical section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program also checks the slenderness requirements and the stability criteria. It is recommended that you use the following steps in performing the steel design: 1. Specify the geometry and loads and perform the analysis. 2. Specify the design parameter values if different from the default values. 3. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection.

8B.2 AnalysisMethodology
Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and in using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis or P-Delta analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results.

8B.3 Member Property Specifications


For specification of member properties of standard German steel sections, the steel section library available in STAAD may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. Member

International Design Codes Manual 481

German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code

properties may also be specified using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

8B.4 Built-in German Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, these properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered for these members during the analysis. An example of member property specification in an input file is provided at the end of this section. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained using the tools of the graphical user interface. Refer to Section 1.7.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information. Following are the descriptions of different types of sections.

IPE Shapes
These shapes are designated in the following way:
20 TO 30 TA ST IPEA120 33 36 TO 46 BY 2 TA ST IPER140

HE Shapes
The designation for HE shapes is similar to that for IPE shapes.
25 TO 35 TA ST HEB300 23 56 TA ST HEA160

I Shapes
I shapes are identified by the depth of the section. The following example illustrates the designation.

482 STAAD.Pro

14 15 TA ST I200(INDICATES AN I-SECTION WITH 200MM DEPTH)

T Shapes
Tee sections are not input by their actual designations, but instead by referring to the I beam shapes from which they are cut. For example,
1 5 TA T HEA220 2 8 TA T IPE120

U Channels
The example below provides the command for identifying two channel sections. The former (U70X40) has a depth of 70mm and a flange width of 40mm. The latter (U260) has a depth of 260mm.
11 TA D U70X40 27 TA D U260

Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel, e.g., D U180. The spacing between the double channels is provided following the expression SP.
11 TA D U180 27 TA D U280 SP 0.5 (INDICATES 2 CHANNELS BACK-TO-BACK SPACED AT 0.5 LENGTH UNITS)

Angles
Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
16 20 TA ST L20X20X2.5

International Design Codes Manual 483

German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code

The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 20mm and a leg thickness of 2.5mm. The above specification may be used when the local z-axis corresponds to the Z-Z axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local y-axis corresponds to the Z-Z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.
17 21 TA RA L40X20X5

Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by using the word SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. Spacing between the angles is provided by using the word SP and the spacing value following the section name.
14 TO 20 TA SD L40X20X4 SP 0.5 21 TO 27 TA LD L40X20X4 SP 0.5

Pipes (Circular Hollow Sections)


To designate circular hollow sections, use PIP followed by numerical value of the diameter and thickness of the section in mm omitting the decimal section of the value provided for diameter. The following example will illustrate the designation.
8 TO 28 TA ST PIP602.9(60.3MM DIA, 2.9MM WALL THICKNESS) 3 64 67 TA ST PIP40612.5(406.4MM DIA, 12.5MM WALL THICKNESS)

Circular hollow sections may also be provided by specifying the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0

specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 and inside dia. of 20 in current length units. Only code checking and no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.

484 STAAD.Pro

Tubes (Rectangular or Square Hollow Sections)


Tube names are input by their dimensions. For example,
15 TO 25 TA ST TUB100603.6

is the specification for a tube having sides of 100mm x 60mm and the wall thickness of 3.6mm. Tubes, like pipes can also be input by their dimensions (Height, Width and Thickness) instead of by their table designations.
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5

is a tube that has a height of 8, a width of 6, and a wall thickness of 0.5 in current length units. Only code checking and no member selection will be performed for TUBE sections specified this way.
SAMPLE INPUT FILE CONTAINING GERMAN SHAPES STAAD SPACE UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0 15 140 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2 14 UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTIES GERMAN * IPE SHAPES 1 TA ST IPEA120 * HE SHAPES 2 TA ST HEB300 * I SHAPES 3 TA ST I200 * T SHAPES

International Design Codes Manual 485

German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code

4 TA T HEA220 * U CHANNELS 5 TA ST U70X40 * DOUBLE U CHANNELS 6 TA D U260 * ANGLES 7 TA ST L20X20X2.5 * REVERSE ANGLES 8 TA RA L40X20X5 * DOUBLE ANGLES - LONG LEGS BACK TO BACK 9 TA LD L40X20X4 SP 0.5 * DOUBLE ANGLES - SHORT LEGS BACK TO BACK 10 TA SD L40X20X4 SP 0.5 * PIPES 11 TA ST PIP602.9 * PIPES 12 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0 * TUBES 13 TA ST TUB100603.6 * TUBES 14 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 WT 0.5 * PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH

8B.5 Member Capacities


The allowable stresses used in the implementation are based on DIN 18800 (Part 1) - Section 7. The procedures of DIN 18800 Part 2 are used for stability analysis. The basic measure of member capacities are the allowable stresses on the member under various conditions of applied loading such as allowable tensile stress, allowable compressive stress etc. These depend on several factors such as cross

486 STAAD.Pro

sectional properties, slenderness factors, unsupported width to thickness ratios and so on. Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating such capacities.

Checks for Axial Tension


In members with axial tension, the tensile load must not exceed the tension capacity of the member. The tension capacity of the member is calculated on the basis of the member area. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a given member based on a user supplied net section factor (NSF -a default value of 1.0 is present but may be altered by changing the input value, see Table 8B.1) and proceeds with member selection or code checking.

Checks for Axial Compression


The compression capacity for members in compression is determined according to the procedure of DIN 18800- Part 2. Compressive resistance is a function of the slenderness of the cross-section (Kl/r ratio) and the user may control the slenderness value by modifying parameters such as KY, LY, KZ and LZ.

Checks for Bending and Shear


The bending compressive and tensile capacities are dependent on such factors as length of outstanding legs, thickness of flanges, unsupported length of the compression flange (UNL, defaults to member length) etc. Shear capacities are a function of web depth, web thickness etc. Users may use a value of 1.0 or 2.0 for the TRACK parameter to obtain a listing of the bending and shear capacities.

8B.6Combined Loading
For members experiencing combined loading (axial force, bending, and shear), applicable interaction formulas are checked at different locations of the member for all modeled loading situations. Members subjected to axial force and bending are checked using the criteria of DIN 18800 (Part 1) - Section 6.1.6. In addition, for members with axial loads and bending, the criteria of DIN 18800(Part 2) - Sections 3.4 and 3.5 are used.

International Design Codes Manual 487

German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code

8B.7 Design Parameters


You are allowed complete control over the design process through the use of parameters described in the following table. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements of the situation, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 8B.1 - German Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as DIN18800. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

0.0

Number of sections to be checked per member: 0. Design only for end sections. 1. Check at location of maximum MZ along member. 2. Check ends plus location of beam 1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th of the member length and report the maximum.

CB

Beam coefficient n, defined in Table 9: If Cb = 0, program will use n = 2.5 for rolled sections and 2.0 for welded sections.

488 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name CMM

Default Value 1.0

Description

Moment factor, Zeta, defined in Table 10: 1. fixed ended member with constant moment, Zeta = 1.0 2. pin ended member with UDL, Zeta = 1.12 3. pin ended member with central point load, Zeta = 1.35 4. fixed ended member, Zeta calculated from end moments.

DMAX DMIN KY KZ LY LZ PY NSF RATIO SAME

1.0 m 0.0 m 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 240 N/sq.mm 1.0 1.0 0.0

Maximum allowable depth during member selection Minimum required depth during member selection K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Length in local z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Strength of steel. Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stresses Control of sections to try during a SELECT process:

International Design Codes Manual 489

German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

0. Try every section of the same type as the original. 1. Try only those with a similar name. SBLT 0 Specify section as either rolled or built-up: 0. Rolled 1. Built-up SGR 0.0 Grade of steel: 0. St 37-2 1. St 52-3 2. St E 355 TRACK 0.0 Level of detail in output file: 0. Output summary of results 1. Output summary of results plus member capacities 2. Output detailed results UNF UNL 1.0 Member Length Same as above provided as a factor of actual member length. Unrestrained member length in lateral torsional buckling checks.

8B.8 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to check whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate to carry the forces transmitted to it by the loads on the structure. The adequacy is checked per the DIN requirements. Code checking is done using forces and moments at specified sections of the members. If the BEAM parameter for a member is set to 1, moments are calculated at every twelfth point along the beam, and the maximum moment about the major

490 STAAD.Pro

axis is used. When no sections are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero (default), design will be based on member start and end forces. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

8B.9 Member Selection


The member selection process basically involves determination of the least weight member that PASSes the code checking procedure based on the forces and moments of the most recent analysis. The section selected will be of the same type as that specified initially. For example, a member specified initially as a channel will have a channel selected for it. Selection of members whose properties are originally provided from a user table will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on TUBES, PIPES, or members listed as PRISMATIC. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. Sample Input data for Steel Design
UNIT METER PARAMETER CODE GERMAN NSF 0.85 ALL UNL 10.0 MEMBER 7 KY 1.2 MEMBER 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

International Design Codes Manual 491

492 STAAD.Pro

Section 9

Indian Codes

International Design Codes Manual 493

494 STAAD.Pro

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456


9A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capabilities of performing concrete design based on the limit state method of IS: 456 (2000).

9A.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections for concrete members can be designed.
l

For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular & Square), T-Beams, and L-shapes For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)

9A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members which will be designed by the program must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTY command. The following example shows the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTY 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 250. 11 13 PR YD 350. 14 TO 16 PRIS YD 400. ZD 750. YB 300. ZB 200.

will be done accordingly. In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. The third set numbers in the above example represents a T-shape with 750 mm flange width, 200 width, 400 mm overall depth and 100 mm flange depth (See section 6.20.2). The program will determine whether the section is rectangular, flanged or circular and the beam or column design.

9A.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform design as per IS:456(2000). Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values

International Design Codes Manual 495

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 9A.1 of this manual contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 9A.1 - Indian Concrete Design IS456 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as INDIAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BRACING

0.0

Beam Design: A value of 1.0 means the effect of axial force will be taken into account for beam design. Column Design: correspond to the terms "Braced" and "Unbraced" described in Notes 1, 2, and 3 of Clause 39.7.1 of IS456:2000. 1. The column is unbraced about major axis. 2. The column is unbraced about minor axis. 3. The column is unbraced about both axis.

496 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name CLEAR

Default Value 25 mm 40 mm

Description

For beam members. For column members Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the end of the member. Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.

DEPTH

YD

EFACE

0.0

ELZ

1.0

Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about major axis. See Note b below. Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about minor axis. See Note b below. Perform shear check against enhanced shear strength as per Cl. 40.5 of IS456:2000.
l

ELY

1.0

ENSH

0.0

ENSH = 1.0 means ordinary shear check to be performed ( no enhancement of shear strength at sections close to support) For ENSH = a positive value(say x ), shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance x from the start of the member. This is used only

International Design Codes Manual 497

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456 Parameter Name Default Value Description

when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. (Refer note )
l

For ENSH = a negative value(say y), shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance y from the end of the member. This is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts.(Refer note)

If default value (0.0) is used the program will calculate Length to Overall Depth ratio. If this ratio is greater than 2.5, shear strength will be enhanced at sections (<2d) close to support otherwise ordinary shear check will be performed. FC FYMAIN FYSEC MINMAIN MAXMAIN MINSEC MAXSEC RATIO 30 N/mm2 Concrete Yield Stress.

415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. 415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. 10 mm 60 mm 8 mm 12 mm 4.0 Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum percentage of

498 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

longitudinal reinforcement in columns. REINF RENSH 0.0 0.0 Tied column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral reinforcement. Distance of the start or end point of the member from its nearest support. This parameter is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. (Refer note) 2. Two faced distribution about major axis. 3. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 4. Longitudinal reinforcement in column is arranged equally along 4 faces. SFACE 0.0 Face of support location at start of beam. It is used to check against shear at the face of the support in beam design. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the start of the member. Minimum clear distance between main reinforcing bars in beam and column. For column center to center distance between main bars cannot exceed 300 mm.

RFACE

4.0

SPSMAIN

25 mm

International Design Codes Manual 499

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456 Parameter Name TORSION Default Value 0.0 Description

0. torsion to be considered in beam design. 1. torsion to be neglected in beam design.

TRACK

0.0

Beam Design: 0. output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE, and END. 1. critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2. required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. Column Design: 0. reinforcement details are printed. 1. column interaction analysis results are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2. a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. 9. the details of section capacity calculations are printed.

ULY

1.0

Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about minor axis. See Note c below.

500 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name ULZ

Default Value 1.0

Description

Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about major axis. See Note c below. Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

WIDTH

ZD

Notes
a. You may specify reinforcing bar combinations through the BARCOMBINATIONcommand. Refer to Section 9A.8 for details. b. ELY and ELZ parameters are used to calculate effective length of column to find whether it is a short or long column. Please refer CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000. In CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000, you will find two term, l and l , which STAAD ex ey calculates as:
l

l = ELZ multiplied by the member length (distance between the two ex nodes of the member) l = ELY multiplied by the member length (distance between the two ey nodes of the member)

For the term "D" in CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000, STAAD uses the YD dimension of the column. For the term "b" in CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000, STAAD uses the ZD dimension of the column. c. ULY and ULZ parameters are used to calculate unsupported length of column to find minimum eccentricity. Please refer CL 25.4 of IS456:2000. In CL 25.4 of IS456:2000, you will find an expression "unsupported length of column". This term is calculated as
l

ULZ multiplied by the member length for the Z axis ULY multiplied by the member length for the Y axis

d. The value of the ENSH parameter (other than 0.0 and 1.0) is used only when

International Design Codes Manual 501

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

the span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. When this condition occurs, the RENSH parameter is also to be used.

The span of the beam is subdivided four parts, each of length L meter. The shear strength will be enhanced up to X meter from both supports. The input should be the following: Steps: 1. ENSH L MEMB 1 => Shear strength will be enhanced throughout the length of the member 1, positive sign indicates length measured from start of the member 2. ENSH (X-L) MEMB 2 => Shear strength will be enhanced up to a length (X-L) of the member 2, length measured from the start of the member 3. ENSH L MEMB 4 => Shear strength will be enhanced throughout the length of the member 4, negative sign indicates length measured from end of the member 4. ENSH (X-L) MEMB 3 => Shear strength will be enhanced up to a length (X-L) of the member 3, length measured from the end of the member 5. RENSH L MEMB 2 3 => Nearest support lies at a distance L from both the members 2 and 3. 6. DESIGN BEAM 1 TO 4=> This will enhance the shear strength up to length X from both ends of the beam consisting of members 1 to 4 and gives spacing accordingly. At section = y1 from start of member 1 av = y1 At section = y2 from the start of member 2 av = y2+L At section = y3 from the end of member 3 av = y3+L At section = y4 from end of member 4 av = y4

502 STAAD.Pro

where tc, enhanced = 2dtc/av At section 0.0, av becomes zero. Thus enhanced shear strength will become infinity. However for any section shear stress cannot exceed tc, max. Hence enhanced shear strength is limited to a maximum value of tc, max.

9A.5 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Consideration


Slenderness effects are extremely important in designing compression members. The IS:456 code specifies two options by which the slenderness effect can be accommodated (Clause 39.7). One option is to perform an exact analysis which will take into account the influence of axial loads and variable moment of inertia on member stiffness and fixed end moments, the effect of deflections on moment and forces and the effect of the duration of loads. Another option is to approximately magnify design moments. STAAD has been written to allow the use of the first option. To perform this type of analysis, use the command PDELTA ANALYSIS instead of PERFORM ANALYSIS. The P-Delta analysis will accommodate all requirements of the second- order analysis described by IS:456, except for the effects of the duration of the loads. It is felt that this effect may be safely ignored because experts believe that the effects of the duration of loads are negligible in a normal structural configuration. Although ignoring load duration effects is somewhat of an approximation, it must be realized that the approximate evaluation of slenderness effects is also an approximate method. In this method, additional moments are calculated based on empirical formula and assumptions on sidesway (Clause 39.7.1 and 39.7.1.1,IS: 456 - 2000). The rules of Clause 39.7.1 have been implemented in STAAD.Pro. They will be checked if the ELY and ELZ parameters are specified. Considering all these information, a P-Delta analysis, as performed by STAAD may be used for the design of concrete members. Note: To take advantage of this analysis, all the combinations of loading must be provided as primary load cases and not as load combinations. This is due to the fact that load combinations are just algebraic combinations of forces and moments (i.e., analysis results), whereas a primary load case is revised during

International Design Codes Manual 503

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

the P-delta analysis based on the deflections. Loads can be combined prior to analysis using the REPEATLOADcommand.

Note: You must specify the appropriate load factors (e.g., 1.5 for dead load, etc.) as STAAD does not factor the loads automatically.

9A.6 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. If required the effect the axial force may be taken into consideration. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are prescanned to identify the critical load cases at different sections of the beams. The total number of sections considered is 13 (e.g., 0., .1, .2, .25, .3, .4, .5, .6, .7, .75, .8, .9, and 1). All of these sections are scanned to determine the design force envelopes.

Design for Flexure


Maximum sagging (creating tensile stress at the bottom face of the beam) and hogging (creating tensile stress at the top face) moments are calculated for all active load cases at each of the above mentioned sections. Each of these sections is designed to resist both of these critical sagging and hogging moments. Where ever the rectangular section is inadequate as singly reinforced section, doubly reinforced section is tried. However, presently the flanged section is designed only as singly reinforced section under sagging moment. It may also be noted all flanged sections are automatically designed as rectangular section under hogging moment as the flange of the beam is ineffective under hogging moment. Flexural design of beams is performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexure design is performed again in a second pass taking into account of the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provide after the preliminary design. Final provisions of flexural reinforcements are made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the curtailment of reinforcements as per IS:456-2000 (Clause 26.2.3). Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (finally which will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account of other practical consideration), user has the choice of printing

504 STAAD.Pro

reinforcements provided by STAAD at 11 equally spaced sections from which the final detail drawing can be prepared.

Design for Shear


Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Shear design are performed at 11 equally spaced sections (0.0 to 1.0) for the maximum shear forces amongst the active load cases and the associated torsional moments. Shear capacity calculation at different sections without the shear reinforcement is based on the actual tensile reinforcement provided by STAAD program. Two-legged stirrups are provided to take care of the balance shear forces acting on these sections. As per Clause 40.5 of IS:456-2000 shear strength of sections (< 2d where d is the effective depth) close to support has been enhanced, subjected to a maximum value of .
cmax

Beam Design Output


The default design output of the beam contains flexural and shear reinforcement provided at 5 equally spaced (0, .25, .5, .75 and 1.) sections along the length of the beam. User has option to get a more detail output. All beam design outputs are given in IS units. An example of rectangular beam design output with TRACK 2.0 output is presented below:
B E A M M20 LENGTH: 25.0 mm 6400.0 mm N O. 1 D E S I G N R E S U L T S Fe415 (Main) Fe250 (Sec.) SIZE: 300.0 mm X 400.0 mm COVER:

DESIGN LOAD SUMMARY (KN MET) --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION |FLEXURE (Maxm. Sagging/Hogging moments)| SHEAR (in mm) | P MZ MX Load Case | VY MX Load Case --------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 60.61 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 533.3 | 0.00 29.63 0.00 1 | 50.51 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1066.7 | 0.00 53.88 0.00 1 | 40.41 0.00 1

International Design Codes Manual 505

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

| 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1600.0 | 0.00 72.73 0.00 1 | 30.31 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 2133.3 | 0.00 86.20 0.00 1 | 20.20 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 2666.7 | 0.00 94.28 0.00 1 | 10.10 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 3200.0 | 0.00 96.98 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 3733.3 | 0.00 94.28 0.00 1 | -10.10 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 4266.7 | 0.00 86.20 0.00 1 | -20.20 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 4800.0 | 0.00 72.73 0.00 1 | -30.31 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 5333.3 | 0.00 53.88 0.00 1 | -40.41 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 5866.7 | 0.00 29.63 0.00 1 | -50.51 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 6400.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | -60.61 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------SUMMARY OF REINF. AREA (Sq.mm) --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | TOP | BOTTOM | STIRRUPS (in mm) | Reqd./Provided reinf. | Reqd./Provided reinf. | (2 legged) --------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 533.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 237.32/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1066.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1600.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 2133.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm

506 STAAD.Pro

2666.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3200.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 894.99/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3733.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4266.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4800.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5333.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5866.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 237.32/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 6400.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------

9A.7 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial forces and biaxial moments at the ends. All active load cases are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which yield maximum reinforcement is called the critical load. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. By default, square and rectangular columns and designed with reinforcement distributed on each side equally for the sections under biaxial moments and with reinforcement distributed equally in two faces for sections under uniaxial moment. User may change the default arrangement of the reinforcement with the help of the parameter RFACE (see Table 8A.1). Depending upon the member lengths, section dimensions and effective length coefficients specified by the user STAAD automatically determine the criterion (short or long) of the column design. All major criteria for selecting longitudinal and transverse reinforcement as stipulated by IS:456 have been taken care of in the column design of STAAD. Default clear spacing between main reinforcing bars is taken to be 25 mm while arrangement of longitudinal bars.

Column Design Output


Default column design output (TRACK 0.0) contains the reinforcement provided by STAAD and the capacity of the section. With the option TRACK 1.0, the output contains intermediate results such as the design forces, effective length coefficients, additional moments etc. All design output is given in SI units. An example of a TRACK 2.0 output follows:
C O L U M N N O. 1 D E S I G N R E S U L T S

International Design Codes Manual 507

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

M20 Fe415 (Main) Fe250 (Sec.) LENGTH: 3000.0 mm CROSS SECTION: 400.0 mm X 600.0 mm COVER: 40.0 mm ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 1 END JOINT: 1 SHORT COLUMN DESIGN FORCES (KNS-MET) ----------------------DESIGN AXIAL FORCE (Pu)

About Y INITIAL MOMENTS : 120.00 MOMENTS DUE TO MINIMUM ECC. : 40.00 SLENDERNESS RATIOS : MOMENTS DUE TO SLENDERNESS EFFECT : MOMENT REDUCTION FACTORS : ADDITION MOMENTS (Maz and May) : TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 120.00 REQD. STEEL AREA : 3587.44 Sq.mm. REQD. CONCRETE AREA: 236412.56 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 32 - 12 dia. (1.51%, 3619.11 Sq.mm.) (Equally distributed) TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 8 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 190 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY BASED ON REINFORCEMENT REQUIRED (KNS-MET) ---------------------------------------------------------Puz : 3244.31 Muz1 : 269.59 Muy1 : 168.42 INTERACTION RATIO: 0.98 (as per Cl. 39.6, IS456:2000) SECTION CAPACITY BASED ON REINFORCEMENT PROVIDED (KNS-MET) ---------------------------------------------------------WORST LOAD CASE: 1 END JOINT: 1 Puz : 3253.88 Muz : 271.48 Muy : 170.09 IR: 0.96 ============================================================================

2000.00 About Z 160.00 52.00 160.00

9A.8 Bar Combination


Initially the program selects only one bar to calculate the number of bars required and area of steel provided at each section along the length of the beam. You may use the BARCOMBINATIONcommand to specify two bar diameters to calculate a combination of each bar to be provided at each section. The syntax for bar combination is given below. START BAR COMBINATION MD1 <bar diameter> MEMB <member list> MD2 <bar diameter> MEMB <member list> END BAR COMBINATION

508 STAAD.Pro

Note: The bar sizes should be specified in the order of increasing size (i.e., MD2 bar diameter should be greater than MD1 bar diameter). The beam length is divided into three parts, two at its ends and one at span. Ld gives the development length to be provided at the two ends of each section. The typical output for bar combination is shown below:
OUTPUT FOR BAR COMBINATION --------------------------------------------------------------------------| M A I N R E I N F O R C E M E N T | --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | 0.0- 1600.0 | 1600.0- 4800.0 | 4800.06400.0 | | mm | mm | mm | --------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP | 2-16 | 2-16 | 2-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 0.00 | 0.00 | 0.00 | Prov| 402.29 | 402.29 | 402.29 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------BOTTOM | 4-16 | 2-16 + 2-25 | 4-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 632.82 | 894.99 | 632.82 | Prov| 804.57 | 1384.43 | 804.57 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------============================================================================

9A.9 Wall Design in accordance with IS 456-2000


The design of walls in accordance with IS 456-2000 is available in STAAD.Pro.

International Design Codes Manual 509

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

The design is performed for in-plane shear, in-plane & out-of-plane bending, and out-of-plane shear. The wall has to be modeled using STAADs Surface elements (Refer to Section 5.13.3 of the Technical Reference Manual). The use of the Surface element enables the designer to treat the entire wall as one entity. It greatly simplifies the modeling of the wall and adds clarity to the analysis and design output. The results are presented in the context of the entire wall rather than individual finite elements thereby allowing users to quickly locate required information. The program reports shear wall design results for each load case/combination for the specified number of sections given in the SURFACE DIVISION command (default value is 10) command. The shear wall is designed at these horizontal sections. The output includes the required horizontal and vertical distributed reinforcing, the concentrated (in-plane bending) edge reinforcing and the link required for out-of-plane shear. Refer to Section 5.54 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on shear wall design.

General Format
START SHEARWALL DESIGN CODE INDIAN FYMAIN f1 FC f2 HMIN f3 HMAX f4 VMIN f5 VMAX f6 EMIN f7 EMAX f8 LMIN f9 LMAX f10 CLEAR f11

510 STAAD.Pro

TWOLAYERED f12 KSLENDER f13 DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST shearwall-list END The following table explains the parameters used in the shear wall design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 9A.2 - Shear Wall Design Parameters Parameter Name CLEAR EMAX Default Value 25 mm 36 Description

Clear concrete cover, in current units. Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Yield strength of steel, in current units. Compressive strength of concrete, in current units. Minimum size of

EMIN

FYMAIN FC

415 Mpa 30 Mpa

HMIN

International Design Codes Manual 511

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456 Parameter Name Default Value Description

horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. HMAX 36 Maximum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Slenderness factor for finding effective height. Maximum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Reinforcement placement mode: 0. single layer, each direction 1. two layers, each direction

KSLENDER LMAX

1.0 16

LMIN

TWOLAYERED

512 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name VMAX

Default Value 36

Description

Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar.

VMIN

The following example illustrates the input for the definition of shear wall and design of the wall.

Example
. . SET DIVISION 12 SURFACE INCIDENCES 2 5 37 34 SUR 1 19 16 65 68 SUR 2 11 15 186 165 SUR 3 10 6 138 159 SUR 4 . . . SURFACE PROPERTY 1 TO 4 THI 18 SUPPORTS

International Design Codes Manual 513

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

1 7 14 20 PINNED 2 TO 5 GEN PIN 6 TO 10 GEN PIN 11 TO 15 GEN PIN 19 TO 16 GEN PIN . . . SURFACE CONSTANTS E 2.17185E+007 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 23.5616 ALPHA 1E-005 . . START SHEARWALL DES CODE INDIAN UNIT NEW MMS FC 25 FYMAIN 415 TWO 1 VMIN 12 HMIN 12 EMIN 12 DESIGN SHEA LIST 1 TO 4 END

514 STAAD.Pro

Notes
1. Command SET DIVISION 12 indicates that the surface boundary node-tonode segments will be subdivided into 12 fragments prior to finite element mesh generation. 2. Four surfaces are defined by the SURFACE INCIDENCES command. 3. The SUPPORTS command includes the new support generation routine. For instance, the line 2 to 5 gen pin assigns pinned supports to all nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As the node-to-node distances were previously subdivided by the SET DIVISION 12 command, there will be an additional 11 nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As a result, all 13 nodes will be assigned pinned supports. Please note that the additional 11 nodes are not individually accessible to the user. They are created by the program to enable the finite element mesh generation and to allow application of boundary constraints. 4. Surface thickness and material constants are specified by the SURFACE PROPERTY and SURFACE CONSTANTS, respectively. 5. The shear wall design commands are listed between lines START SHEARWALL DES and END. The CODE command selects the design code that will be the basis for the design. For Indian code the parameter is INDIAN. The DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST command is followed by a list of previously defined Surface elements intended as shear walls and/or shear wall components.

Technical Overview
The program implements provisions of section 32 of IS 456-2000 and relevant provisions as referenced therein, for all active load cases. The following steps are performed for each of the horizontal sections of the wall.

Checking of slenderness limit


The slenderness checking is done as per clause no. 32.2.3. The default effective height is the height of the wall. User can change the effective height. The limit for slenderness is taken as 30.

International Design Codes Manual 515

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

Design for in-plane bending and vertical load (denoted by Mz & Fy in the shear wall force output)
Walls when subjected to combined in-plane horizontal and vertical forces produce in-plane bending in conjunction with vertical load. According to clause no. 32.3.1, in-plane bending may be neglected in case a horizontal cross section of the wall is always under compression due combined effect of horizontal and vertical loads. Otherwise, the section is checked for combined vertical load and in-plane moment as column with axial load and uni-axial bending. For this purpose, the depth is taken as 0.8 x horizontal length of wall and breadth is the thickness of the wall. The reinforcement is concentrated at both ends (edges) of the wall. The edge reinforcement is assumed to be distributed over a length of 0.2 times horizontal length on each side. Minimum reinforcements are according to clause no. 32.5.(a). Maximum 4% reinforcement is allowed.

Design for in-plane shear (denoted by Fxy in the shear wall force output)
By default, the program does not design only at the critical section but at all the horizontal sections. By suitable use of the surface division command, design at critical section as per clause no. 32.4.1 can be performed. The design for in-plane shear is done as per clause no. 32.4. The nominal shear stress is calculated as per clause no. 32.4.2 and it is checked with the maximum allowable shear stress as per clause no. 32.4.2.1. The design shear strength of concrete is calculated as per clause no. 32.4.3. Design of shear reinforcement is done as per clause no. 32.4.4. Minimum reinforcements are as per clause no. 32.5.

Design for vertical load and out-of-plane vertical bending (denoted by Fy and My respectively in the shear wall force output)
Apart from the in-plane bending and horizontal shear force, the wall is also subjected to out-of-plane bending in the vertical and horizontal directions. The part of the wall which is not having edge reinforcements (i.e., a zone of depth 0.6 x Length of the wall), is designed again as column under axial load (i.e., vertical load) and out-of-plane vertical bending. The minimum reinforcements and maximum allowable spacings of reinforcements are as per clause no. 32.5

516 STAAD.Pro

Design for out-of-plane horizontal bending (denoted by Mx in the shear wall force output)
The horizontal reinforcement which is already provided for in-plane shear is checked against out-of-plane horizontal bending. The wall is assumed as a slab for this purpose.

Design for out-of-plane shears (denoted by Qx and Qy in the shear wall force output)
The out-of-plane shear arises from out-of-plane loading. The nominal shear stresses are calculated as per clause no. 40.1. Maximum allowable shear stresses are as per table 20. For shear force in the vertical direction, shear strength of concrete section is calculated as per section 4.1 of SP 16 : 1980 considering vertical reinforcement as tension reinforcement. Similarly, for shear force in the horizontal direction, shear strength of concrete section is calculated considering horizontal reinforcement as tension reinforcement. Shear reinforcements in the form of links are computed as per the provisions of clause no. 40.4.

Shear Wall Design With Opening


The Surface element has been enhanced to allow design of shear walls with rectangular openings. The automatic meshing algorithm has been improved to allow variable divisions along wall and opening(s) edges. Design and output are available for user selected locations.

Description
Shear walls modeled in STAAD.Pro may include an unlimited number of openings. Due to the presence of openings, the wall may be comprise of different wall panels of varying types. 1. Shear wall set-up Definition of a shear wall starts with a specification of the surface element perimeter nodes, meshing divisions along node-to-node segments, opening(s) corner coordinates, and meshing divisions of four edges of the opening(s).

International Design Codes Manual 517

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

SURFACE INCIDENCE n1, ..., ni SURFACE s DIVISION sd1, ..., sdj RECOPENING x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 DIVISION od1, ..., odk Where: n1, , ni node numbers on the perimeter of the shear wall, s surface ordinal number, sd1, , sdj number of divisions for each of the node-to-node distance on the surface perimeter, x1 y1 z1 () coordinates of the corners of the opening, od1, , odk divisions along edges of the opening. Note: If the sd1, , sdj or the od1, , odk list does not include all node-to-node segments, or if any of the numbers listed equals zero, then the corresponding division number is set to the default value (=10, or as previously input by the SET DIVISION command). Default locations for stress/force output, design, and design output are set as follows: SURFACE DIVISION X xd SURFACE DIVISION Y yd Where: xd number of divisions along X axis, yd number of divisions along Y axis. Note: xd and yd represent default numbers of divisions for each edge of the surface where output is requested. The output is provided for sections located between division segments. For example, if the number of divisions = 2, then the output will be produced for only one section (at the center of the edge). 2. Stress/force output printing

518 STAAD.Pro

Values of internal forces may be printed out for any user-defined section of the wall. The general format of the command is as follows: PRINT SURFACE FORCE (ALONG ) (AT a) (BETWEEN d1, d2) LIST s1, ,si Where: local axis of the surface element (X or Y), a distance along the axis from start of the member to the full cross-section of the wall, d1, d2 coordinates in the direction orthogonal to , delineating a fragment of the full cross-section for which the output is desired. ** s1, ,si list of surfaces for output generation ** The range currently is taken in terms of local axis. If the local axis is directed away from the surface, the negative range is to be entered. Note: If command ALONG is omitted, direction Y (default) is assumed. If command AT is omitted, output is provided for all sections along the specified (or default) edge. Number of sections will be determined from the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values. If the BETWEEN command is omitted, the output is generated based on full cross-section width. 3. Definition of wall panels Input syntax for panel definition is as follows: START PANEL DEFINITION SURFACE i PANEL j ptype x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 END PANEL DEFINITION Where: i = ordinal surface number, j = ordinal panel number,

International Design Codes Manual 519

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456

ptype = panel type, one of: WALL, COLUMN, BEAM x1 y1 z1 () = coordinates of the corners of the panel, 4. Shear wall design The program implements different provisions of design of walls as per code BS 8110. General syntax of the design command is as follows: START SHEARWALL DESIGN () DESIGN SHEARWALL (AT f2) LIST s ENDSHEARWALL DESIGN Note: If the command AT is omitted, the design proceeds for all cross sections of the wall or panels, as applicable, defined by the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values. a. No panel definition. Design is performed for the specified horizontal full cross-section, located at a distance c from the origin of the local coordinates system. If opening is found then reinforcement is provided along sides of openings. The area of horizontal and vertical bars provided along edges of openings is equal to that of the respective interrupted bars. b. Panels have been defined. Only wall panel design is supported in Indian code.

520 STAAD.Pro

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920


9A1.1 Design Operations
Earthquake motion often induces force large enough to cause inelastic deformations in the structure. If the structure is brittle, sudden failure could occur. But if the structure is made to behave ductile, it will be able to sustain the earthquake effects better with some deflection larger than the yield deflection by absorption of energy. Therefore ductility is also required as an essential element for safety from sudden collapse during severe shocks. STAAD has the capabilities of performing concrete design as per IS 13920. While designing it satisfies all provisions of IS 456 2000 and IS 13920 for beams and columns.

9A1.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections for concrete members can be designed.
l

For Beams: Prismatic (Rectangular & Square) and T-shape For Columns:Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)

9A1.3 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters that are needed to perform design as per IS 13920. It accepts all parameters that are needed to perform design as per IS:456. Over and above it has some other parameters that are required only when designed is performed as per IS:13920. Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 8A1.1 of this manual contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 521

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Table 9A1.1 - Indian Concrete Design IS 13920 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as IS13920 Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BRACING

0.0

Beam Design 1.0 = the effect of axial force will be taken into account for beam design. Column Design Correspond to the terms "Braced" and "Unbraced" described in Notes 1, 2, and 3 of Clause 39.7.1 of IS456:2000. 1.0 = the column is unbraced about major axis. 2.0 = the column is unbraced about minor axis. 3.0 = the column is unbraced about both axis.

DEPTH

YD

Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD (depth of section in Y direction) as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. For beam members.

CLEAR

25 mm

522 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value 40 mm

Description

For column members Default value means there will be no member combination. 1.0 = no printout of sectional force and critical load for combined member in the output. 2.0 = printout of sectional force for combined member in the output. 3.0 = printout of both sectional force and critical load for combined member in the output. ***

COMBINE

0.0

EFACE

0.0

Face of support location at end of beam. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the end of the member. Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.*

ELZ ELY ENSH

1.0 1.0 0.0

Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about major axis. Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about minor axis. Perform shear check against enhanced shear strength as per Cl. 40.5 of IS456:2000.

International Design Codes Manual 523

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description

1.0 = ordinary shear check to be performed ( no enhancement of shear strength at sections close to support) a positive value(say x ) = shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance x from the start of the member. This is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. (Refer note after Table 8A.1 ) a negative value(say y) = shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance y from the end of the member. This is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts.(Refer note after Table 8A.1) 0.0 = the program will calculate Length to Overall Depth ratio. If this ratio is greater than 2.5, shear strength will be enhanced at sections (<2d) close to support otherwise ordinary shear check will be performed.

524 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name EUDL

Default Value None

Description

Equivalent u.d.l on span of the beam. This load value must be the unfactored load on span. During design the load value is multiplied by a factor 1.2. If no u.d.l is defined factored shear force due to gravity load on span will be taken as zero. No elastic or plastic moment will be calculated. Shear design will be performed based on analysis result.(Refer note)

FYMAIN FYSEC FC GLD

415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. 415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. 30 N/mm2 None Concrete Yield Stress. Gravity load number to be considered for calculating equivalent u.d.l on span of the beam, in case no EUDL is mentioned in the input. This loadcase can be any static loadcase containing MEMBER LOAD on the beam which includes UNI, CON, LIN and TRAP member loading. CMOM member loading is considered only when it is specified in local direction. FLOOR LOAD is also considered. The load can be primary or combination load. For combination load only load numbers included in load combination is considered. The load factors are ignored.

International Design Codes Manual 525

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description

Internally the unfactored load is multiplied by a factor 1.2 during design. If both EUDL and GLD parameters are mentioned in the input mentioned EUDL will be considered in design Note: No dynamic (Response spectrum, 1893, Time History) and moving load cases are considered. CMOM member loading in global direction is not considered. UMOM member loading is not considered. HLINK Spacing of longitudinal bars measured to the outer face Longer dimension of the rectangular confining hoop measured to its outer face. It shall not exceed 300 mm as per Cl. 7.4.8. If the HLINK value as provided in the input file does not satisfy the clause the value will be internally assumed as the default one. This parameter is valid for rectangular column. Default value calculates elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam at its ends. 1.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments

IPLM

0.0

526 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

of resistance of beam to be ignored at start node of beam. This implies no support exists at start node. -1.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be considered at start node of beam. . This implies support exists at start node. 2.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be ignored at end node of beam. This implies no support exists at end node. -2.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be considered at end node of beam. . This implies support exists at end node. ** IMB 0.0 Default value calculates elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam at its ends. 1.0 = calculation of

International Design Codes Manual 527

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description

elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be ignored at both ends of beam. This implies no support exist at either end of the member. -1.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be considered at both ends of beam. This implies support exist at both ends of the member.** MINMAIN MAXMAIN MINSEC MAXSEC PLASTIC 10 mm 60 mm 8 mm 12 mm 0.0 Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Default value calculates elastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam at its ends. 1.0 = plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be calculated at its ends.

528 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name RATIO

Default Value 4.0

Description

Maximum percentage of longitudinal reinforcement in columns. 0.0 = Tied column (default) 1.0 = spiral reinforcement

REINF

0.0

RENSH

0.0

Distance of the start or end point of the member from its nearest support. This parameter is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. Refer note after Table 9A.1

RFACE

4.0

4.0 = longitudinal reinforcement in column is arranged equally along four faces. 2.0 invokes two faced distribution about major axis. 3.0 invokes two faced distribution about minor axis.

SFACE

0.0

Face of support location at start of beam. It is used to check against shear at the face of the support in beam design. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the start of the member.* Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.*

SPSMAIN

25 mm

Minimum clear distance between main reinforcing bars in beam and column. For column center to

International Design Codes Manual 529

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description

center distance between main bars cannot exceed 300 mm. TORISION 0.0 0.0 = torsion to be considered in beam design. 1.0 = torsion to be neglected in beam design. TRACK 0.0 Beam Design: 0.0 = output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE and END. 1.0 = critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. Column Design: 0.0 = reinforcement details are printed. 1.0 = column interaction analysis results are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values are printed in

530 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

addition to TRACK 1.0 output. ULY 1.0 Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about minor axis. Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about major axis. Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

ULZ

1.0

WIDTH

ZD

Bar combination has been introduced for detailing. Please refer section 9A1.6 for details. * EFACE and SFACE command is not valid for member combination. ** IPLM and IMB commands are not valid for member combination. These commands are ignored for members forming physical member. *** The purpose of COMBINE command is the following: 1. If a beam spanning between two supports is subdivided into many subbeams this parameter will combine them into one member. It can also be used to combine members to form one continuous beam spanning over more than two supports. 2. When two or more members are combined during design plastic or elastic moments will be calculated at the column supports. At all the intermediate nodes (if any) this calculation will be ignored. Note: Please note that the program only recognizes column at right angle to the beam. Inclined column support is ignored. 3. It will calculate sectional forces at 13 sections along the length of the combined member. 4. It will calculate critical loads (similar to that of Design Load Summary) for all

International Design Codes Manual 531

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920

active load cases during design. Beams will be combined only when DESIGN BEAM command is issued. The following lines should be satisfied during combination of members: 1. Members to be combined should have same sectional properties if any single span between two column supports of a continuous beam is subdivided into several members. 2. Members to be combined should have same constants (E, Poi ratio, alpha, density, and beta angle) 3. Members to be combined should lie in one straight line. 4. Members to be combined should be continuous. 5. Vertical members (i.e., columns) cannot be combined. 6. Same member cannot be used more than once to form two different combined members. 7. The maximum number of members that can be combined into one member is 299. Note: Sectional forces and critical load for combined member output will only be available when all the members combined are successfully designed in both flexure and shear. ENSH and RENSH parameters will have to be provided (as and when necessary) even if physical member has been formed.

Example
The following lines show a standard example for design to be performed in IS 13920.
STAAD SPACE UNIT METER MTON JOINT COORDINATES ..

532 STAAD.Pro

MEMBER INCIDENCES .. MEMBER PROPERTY INDIAN .. CONSTANTS . SUPPORTS . DEFINE 1893 LOAD ZONE 0.05 I 1 K 1 B 1 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT . LOAD 1 SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIR 1893 LOAD X 1 LOAD 2 SEISMIC LOAD IN Z DIR 1893 LOAD Z 1 LOAD 3 DL MEMBER LOAD UNI GY -5 LOAD 4 LL MEMBER LOAD . UNI GY -3 LOAD COMB 5 1.5(DL+LL) 3 1.5 4 1.5 LOAD COMB 6 1.2(DL+LL+SLX) 1 1.2 3 1.2 4 1.2 LOAD COMB 7 1.2(DL+LL-SLX) 1 1.2 3 1.2 4 -1.2 LOAD COMB 8 1.2(DL+LL+SLZ)

International Design Codes Manual 533

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920

2 1.2 3 1.2 4 1.2 LOAD COMB 9 1.2(DL+LL-SLZ) 2 1.2 3 1.2 4 -1.2 PDELTA ANALYSIS LOAD LIST 5 TO 9 START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE IS13920 UNIT MMS NEWTON FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 20 ALL MINMAIN 12 ALL MAXMAIN 25 ALL TRACK 2.0 ALL *** UNFACTORED GRAVITY LOAD ON MEMBERS 110 TO 112 IS 8 T/M (DL+LL) I.E., 78.46 NEW/MM EUDL 78.46 MEMB 110 TO 112 ** MEMBERS TO BE COMBINED INTO ONE PHYSICAL MEMBER COMBINE 3.0 MEMB 110 TO 112 *** PLASTIC MOMENT CONSIDERED PLASTIC 1.0 MEMB 110 TO 112 DESIGN BEAM 110 TO 112 DESIGN COLUMN END CONCRETE DESIGN FINISH

9A1.4 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. If required the effect of the axial force may be taken into consideration. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are prescanned to identify the critical load cases at different sections of the beams. The total number of sections considered is 13. All of these sections are scanned to determine the design force envelopes.

534 STAAD.Pro

For design to be performed as per IS:13920 the width of the member shall not be less than 200mm(Clause 6.1.3). Also the member shall preferably have a width-to depth ratio of more than 0.3 (Clause 6.1.2). The factored axial stress on the member should not exceed 0.1fck (Clause 6.1.1) for all active load cases. If it exceeds allowable axial stress no design will be performed.

Design for Flexure


Design procedure is same as that for IS 456. However while designing following criteria are satisfied as per IS-13920: 1. The minimum grade of concrete shall preferably be M20. (Clause 5.2) 2. Steel reinforcements of grade Fe415 or less only shall be used. (Clause 5.3) 3. The minimum tension steel ratio on any face, at any section, is given by (Clause 6.2.1b)
min

= 0.24fck/fy

The maximum steel ratio on any face, at any section, is given by (Clause 6.2.2)
max

= 0.025

4. The positive steel ratio at a joint face must be at least equal to half the negative steel at that face. (Clause 6.2.3) 5. The steel provided at each of the top and bottom face, at any section, shall at least be equal to one-fourth of the maximum negative moment steel provided at the face of either joint. (Clause 6.2.4)

Design for Shear


The shear force to be resisted by vertical hoops is guided by the Clause 6.3.3 of IS 13920:1993 revision. Elastic sagging and hogging moments of resistance of the beam section at ends are considered while calculating shear force. Plastic sagging and hogging moments of resistance can also be considered for shear design if PLASTIC parameter is mentioned in the input file. (Refer Table 8A1.1) Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Procedure is same as that of IS 456.

International Design Codes Manual 535

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920

The following criteria are satisfied while performing design for shear as per Cl. 6.3.5 of IS-13920: The spacing of vertical hoops over a length of 2d at either end of the beam shall not exceed a. d/4 b. 8 times the diameter of the longitudinal bars In no case this spacing is less than 100 mm. The spacing calculated from above, if less than that calculated from IS 456 consideration is provided.

Beam Design Output


The default design output of the beam contains flexural and shear reinforcement provided at 5 equally spaced sections along the length of the beam. User has option to get a more detail output. All beam design outputs are given in IS units. An example of rectangular beam design output with the TRACK 2.0 is presented below:
B E A M M20 (Sec.) LENGTH: 25.0 mm 6400.0 mm SIZE: 300.0 mm X 400.0 mm COVER: N O. 1 D E S I G N Fe415 (Main) R E S U L T S Fe250

DESIGN LOAD SUMMARY (KN MET) --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION |FLEXURE (Maxm. Sagging/Hogging moments)| SHEAR (in mm) | P MZ MX Load Case | VY MX Load Case --------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 60.61 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 533.3 | 0.00 29.63 0.00 1 | 50.51 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1066.7 | 0.00 53.88 0.00 1 | 40.41 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1600.0 | 0.00 72.73 0.00 1 | 30.31 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 |

536 STAAD.Pro

2133.3 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 2666.7 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 3200.0 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 3733.3 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 4266.7 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 4800.0 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 5333.3 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 5866.7 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 6400.0 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 *** DESIGN SHEAR FORCE

86.20 0.00 94.28 0.00 96.98 0.00 94.28 0.00 86.20 0.00 72.73 0.00 53.88 0.00 29.63 0.00 0.00

0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00

1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1

| | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | |

20.20

0.00

10.10

0.00

0.00

0.00

-10.10

0.00

-20.20

0.00

-30.31

0.00

-40.41

0.00

-50.51

0.00

-60.61

0.00

0.00 0.00 1 AT SECTION 0.0 IS

| 60.61 KN. - CLAUSE 6.3.3 OF IS60.61 KN. - CLAUSE 6.3.3 OF IS-

13920 *** DESIGN SHEAR FORCE AT SECTION

6400.0 IS

13920 NOTE : MOMENT OF RESISTANCE IS CALCULATED BASED ON THE AREA OF STEEL PROVIDED. IF AREA OF STEEL PROVIDED IS MUCH HIGHER COMPARED TO AREA OF STEEL REQUIRED MOMENT OF RESISTANCE WILL INCREASE WHICH MAY INCREASE DESIGN SHEAR FORCE. --------------------------------------------------------------------------STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 7 0.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 100 mm 533.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 281.26/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1066.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1600.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm

International Design Codes Manual 537

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920

2133.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 2666.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3200.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 894.99/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3733.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4266.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4800.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5333.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5866.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 281.26/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 6400.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 100 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------

9A1.5 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial forces and biaxial moments per IS 456:2000. Columns are also designed for shear forces as per Clause 7.3.4. All major criteria for selecting longitudinal and transverse reinforcement as stipulated by IS:456 have been taken care of in the column design of STAAD. However following clauses have been satisfied to incorporate provisions of IS 13920:
l

The minimum grade of concrete shall preferably be M20. (Clause 5.2) Steel reinforcements of grade Fe415 or less only shall be used. (Clause 5.3) The minimum dimension of column member shall not be less than 200 mm. For columns having unsupported length exceeding 4m, the shortest dimension of column shall not be less than 300 mm. (Clause 7.1.2) The ratio of the shortest cross-sectional dimension to the perpendicular dimension shall preferably be not less than 0.4. (Clause 7.1.3) The spacing of hoops shall not exceed half the least lateral dimension of the column, except where special confining reinforcement is provided. (Clause 7.3.3) Special confining reinforcement shall be provided over a length l from each o joint face, towards mid span, and on either side of any section, where

538 STAAD.Pro

flexural yielding may occur. The length l shall not be less than a) larger o lateral dimension of the member at the section where yielding occurs, b) 1/6 of clear span of the member, and c) 450 mm. (Clause 7.4.1)
l

The spacing of hoops used as special confining reinforcement shall not exceed of minimum member dimension but need not be less than 75 mm nor more than 100 mm. (Clause 7.4.6) The area of cross-section of hoops provided are checked against the provisions for minimum area of cross-section of the bar forming rectangular, circular or spiral hoops, to be used as special confining reinforcement. (Clause 7.4.7 and 7.4.8)

Column Design Output


Default column design output (TRACK 0.0) contains the reinforcement provided by STAAD and the capacity of the section. With the option TRACK 1.0, the output contains intermediate results such as the design forces, effective length coefficients, additional moments etc. A special output TRACK 9.0 is introduced to obtain the details of section capacity calculations. All design output is given in SI units. An example of a column design output (with option TRACK 1.0) is given below.
============================================================================ C O L U M N N O. 3 D E S I G N R E S U L T S M20 Fe415 (Main) Fe415 (Sec.) LENGTH: 3000.0 mm CROSS SECTION: 350.0 mm X 400.0 mm COVER: 40.0 mm ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 5 END JOINT: 2 SHORT COLUMN DESIGN FORCES (KNS-MET) ----------------------DESIGN AXIAL FORCE (Pu) : 226.7 About Z About Y INITIAL MOMENTS : 0.64 146.28 MOMENTS DUE TO MINIMUM ECC. : 4.53 4.53 SLENDERNESS RATIOS : - -

International Design Codes Manual 539

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920

MOMENTS DUE TO SLENDERNESS EFFECT : - MOMENT REDUCTION FACTORS : - ADDITION MOMENTS (Maz and May) : - TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 4.53 146.28 ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 5 Along Z Along Y DESIGN SHEAR FORCES : 43.31 76.08 REQD. STEEL AREA : 3313.56 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 12 - 20 dia. (2.69%, 3769.91 Sq.mm.) (Equally distributed) CONFINING REINFORCEMENT : Provide 10 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 85 mm c/c over a length 500.0 mm from each joint face towards midspan as per Cl. 7.4.6 of IS-13920. TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 10 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 175 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY (KNS-MET) -------------------------Puz : 2261.52 Muz1 : 178.71 Muy1 : 150.75 INTERACTION RATIO: 1.00 (as per Cl. 39.6, IS456:2000) ============================================================================ ********************END OF COLUMN DESIGN RESULTS********************

9A1.6 Bar Combination


Initially the program selects only one bar to calculate the number of bars required and area of steel provided at each section along the length of the beam. You may use the BARCOMBINATIONcommand to specify two bar diameters to calculate a combination of each bar to be provided at each section. The syntax for bar combination is given below. START BAR COMBINATION MD1 <bar diameter> MEMB <member list> MD2 <bar diameter> MEMB <member list>

540 STAAD.Pro

ENDBAR COMBINATION Note: The bar sizes should be specified in the order of increasing size (i.e., MD2 bar diameter should be greater than MD1 bar diameter). The beam length is divided into three parts, two at its ends and one at span. Ld gives the development length to be provided at the two ends of each section. The typical output for bar combination is shown below:
OUTPUT FOR BAR COMBINATION --------------------------------------------------------------------------| M A I N R E I N F O R C E M E N T | --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | 0.0- 1600.0 | 1600.0- 4800.0 | 4800.06400.0 | | mm | mm | mm | --------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP | 2-16 | 2-16 | 2-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 0.00 | 0.00 | 0.00 | Prov| 402.29 | 402.29 | 402.29 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------BOTTOM | 4-16 | 2-16 + 2-25 | 4-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 632.82 | 894.99 | 632.82 | Prov| 804.57 | 1384.43 | 804.57 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------============================================================================

International Design Codes Manual 541

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920

Verification Example
Sample example showing calculation of design shear force as per Clause 6.3.3
Figure 9.1 - Example problem

For Beam No. 1 and 2


Section width, b = 250 mm and depth, D = 500 mm Characteristic strength of steel, fy = 415 N/mm2 Characteristic strength of concrete, fck = 20 N/mm2 Clear cover = 25 mm Bar diameter = 12 mm Effective depth, d = 469 mm Eudl, w = 6.5 N/mm2 Length, L = 4,000 mm A A A A Steps Calculation of Simple Shear Simple shear from gravity load on span = Va = Vb = 1.2 * w * L / 2 = 15600N
st_Top_A st_Bot_A st_Top_B st_Bot_B

= 339.29 mm2 = 226.19 mm2 = 226.19 mm2 = 339.29 mm2

542 STAAD.Pro

Calculation of Moment Of Resistances Based On Area Of Steel Provided Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu, as = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Micah = Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu, bs = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mob = Calculation of shear force due to the formation of a plastic hinge at both ends of the beam plus the factored gravity load on the span.
Figure 9.2 - Sway to right

0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Top_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Top_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_B * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_B * fy / b * d * fck)

= 36768130.05 N = 54003057.45 N = 54003057.45 N

0.87 * fy * Ast_Top_B * d * ( 1 - Ast_ = 36768130.05 Top_B* fy / b * d * fck) N

FIG1: SWAY TO RIGHT Vur,a = Vur,b = Va - 1.4 [ ( Mu,as + Mu,bh ) / L ] = Va + 1.4 [ ( Mu,as + Mu,bh ) / L ] =
Figure 9.3 - Sway to left

-10137.69104 N 41337.69104 N

Vul,a =

Va + 1.4 [ ( Mu,ah + Mu,bs ) / L 53402.14022 N

International Design Codes Manual 543

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 ] = Vul,b = Va - 1.4 [ ( Mu,ah + Mu,bs ) / L ] - 22202.14022 N =

Design Shear Force


Shear Force From Analysis At End A , Va,anl = = Shear Force From Analysis At End B , Vb,anl = = 11.56 N N -6.44 N N

Design Shear Force At End A, Vu,a = Max ( Va,anl, Vur,a, Vul,a) 53402.14022

Design Shear Force At End B, Vu,b = Max ( Vb,anl, Vur,b, Vul,b) 41337.69104

For Beam No. 3


Section Characteristic Strength of Steel fy Characteristic Strength of Concrete fck Clear Cover Bar Diameter Effective Depth d Eudl w Length L Ast_Top_A Ast_Bot_A Ast_Top_B Ast_Bot_B Calculation of Simple Shear Simple shear from gravity load on span = Va = Vb = 1.2 * w * L / 2 = 11700N Width b Depth D 300 mm 450 mm 415 N/sq. mm 20 N/sq. mm 25 mm 12 mm 419 mm 6.5 N/sq. mm 3000 mm 226.19 sq. mm 339.29 sq. mm 452.39 sq. mm 226.19 sq. mm

544 STAAD.Pro

Calculation of Moment Of Resistances Based On Area Of Steel Provided Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,as = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,ah = Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,bs = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,bh = 0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Top_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Top_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_B * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_B * fy / b * d * fck) = 48452983 N = 32940364.5 N = 32940364.5 N 63326721.3 N

0.87 * fy * Ast_Top_B * d * ( 1 - Ast_Top_ = B* fy / b * d * fck)

Calculation of shear force due to the formation of a plastic hinge at both ends of the beam plus the factored gravity load on the span.
Figure 9.4 - Sway to right

Vur,a = Vur,b =

Va - 1.4 [ ( Mu,as + Mu,bh ) / L ] = Va + 1.4 [ ( Mu,as + Mu,bh ) / L ] = Sway to left

-40463.862 N 63863.862 N

Vul,a =

Va + 1.4 [ ( Mu,ah + Mu,bs ) / L ] =

42444.3402 N

Vul,b =

Va - 1.4 [ ( Mu,ah + Mu,bs ) / L ] =

-15144.34 N

International Design Codes Manual 545

Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920

Design Shear Force


Shear Force From Analysis At End A , Va,anl = -10.31 N Design Shear Force At End A, Vu,a = Max ( Va,anl, Vur,a, Vul,a) = Shear Force From Analysis At End B , Vb,anl = -23.81 N Design Shear Force At End B, Vu,b = Max ( Vb,anl, Vur,b, Vul,b) = 63863.862 N 42444.3402 N

546 STAAD.Pro

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984


9B.1 Design Operations
STAAD contains a broad set of facilities for designing structural members as individual components of an analyzed structure. The member design facilities provide the user with the ability to carry out a number of different design operations. These facilities may be used selectively in accordance with the requirements of the design problem. The operations to perform a design are:
l

Specify the members and the load cases to be considered in the design. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection. Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform member selection by optimization.

These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements. The entire ISI steel section table is supported. Section 9B.13 describes the specification of steel sections.

9B.2 General Comments


This section presents some general statements regarding the implementation of Indian Standard code of practice (IS:800-1984) for structural steel design in STAAD. The design philosophy and procedural logistics for member selection and code checking are based upon the principles of allowable stress design. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing, and failure by stability considerations. The flowing sections describe the salient features of the allowable stresses being calculated and the stability criteria being used. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the allowable stresses and the most economic section is selected on the basis of least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program checks stability and strength requirements and reports the critical loading condition and the governing code criteria. It is generally assumed that the user will take care of the detailing requirements like provision of stiffeners and check the local effects such as flange buckling and web crippling.

9B.3 Allowable Stresses


The member design and code checking in STAAD are based upon the allowable stress design method as per IS:800 (1984). It is a method for proportioning

International Design Codes Manual 547

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984

structural members using design loads and forces, allowable stresses, and design limitations for the appropriate material under service conditions. It would not be possible to describe every aspect of IS:800 in this manual. This section, however, will discuss the salient features of the allowable stresses specified by IS:800 and implemented in STAAD. Appropriate sections of IS:800 will be referenced during the discussion of various types of allowable stresses.
l

Axial Stress Bending Stress Shear Stress Combined Stress

9B.3.1 Axial Stress

Tensile Stress
The allowable tensile stress, as calculated in STAAD as per IS:800 is described below. The permissible stress in axial tension, in MPa on the net effective area of the at sections shall not exceed
at

= 0.6f

Where: f = minimum yield stress of steel in Mpa


y

Compressive Stress
Allowable compressive stress on the gross section of axially loaded compression members shall not exceed 0.6f nor the permissible stress s calculated based on y ac the following equation (per Clause: 5.1.1):
ac

= 0.6{( f

cc

f )/[( f )n +(f )n] 1/n}


y cc y

Where:
ac

= Permissible stress in axial compression, in Mpa

f = Yield stress of steel, in Mpa


y

f = Elastic critical stress in compression = 2 E/2


cc

548 STAAD.Pro

E = Modulus of elasticity of steel, 2 X 105 Mpa =l/r = Slenderness ratio of the member, ratio of the effective length to appropriate radius of gyration n = A factor assumed as 1.4.

9B.3.2 Bending Stress


The allowable bending stress in a member subjected to bending is calculated based on the following formula: (Clause: 6.2.1)
bt

or

bc

= 0.66 f

Where: f
bt bc

= Bending stress in tension = Bending stress in compression = Yield stress of steel, in MPa

For an I-beam or channel with equal flanges bent about the axis of maximum strength (z-z axis), the maximum bending compressive stress on the extreme fibre calculated on the effective section shall not exceed the values of maximum permissible bending compressive stress. The maximum permissible bending compressive stress shall be obtained by the following formula: (Clause: 6.2.2)

Clause 6.2.3 Where: f


y

= Yield stress of steel, in Mpa

n = A factor assumed as 1.4. f = Elastic critical stress in bending, calculated by the following cb formula:

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 549

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984

in MPa

k = a coefficient to allow for reduction in thickness or breadth of 1 flanges between points of effective lateral restraint and depends on y, the ratio of the total area of both flanges at the point of least bending moment to the corresponding area at the point of greatest bending moment between such points of restraint. k = a coefficient to allow for the inequality of flanges, and 2 depends on w, the ratio of the moment of inertia of the compression flange alone to that of the sum of the moment of the flanges each calculated about its own axis parallel to the y-yaxis of the girder, at the point of maximum bending moment. 1 =effective length of compression flange r = radius of gyration of the section about its axis of y minimum strength (y-y axis) T = mean thickness of the compression flange, is equal to the area of horizontal portion of flange divided by width. D = overall depth of beam c ,c =respectively the lesser and greater distances from the section 1 2 neutral axis to the extreme fibres.

9B.3.3 Shear Stress


Allowable shear stress calculations are based on Section 6.4 of IS:800. For shear on the web, the gross section taken into consideration consist of the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear parallel to the flanges, the gross section is taken as 2/3 times the total flange area.

9B.3.4 Combined Stress


Members subjected to both axial and bending stresses are proportioned accordingly to section 7 of IS:800. All members subject to bending and axial

550 STAAD.Pro

compression are required to satisfy the equation of Section 7.1.1.(a) for intermediate points, and equation of Section 7.1.1.(b) for support points. For combined axial tension and bending the equation of Section 7.1.2. is required to be satisfied. Cm coefficients are calculated according to the specifications of Section 7.1.3. information regarding occurrence of sidesway can be provided through the use of parameters SSY and SSZ. In the absence of any user provided information, sidesway will be assumed.

9B.4 Design Parameters


In STAAD implementation of IS:800, the user is allowed complete control of the design process through the use of design parameters. Available design parameters to be used in conjunction with IS:800 are listed in Table 7B.1 of this section along with their default values and applicable restrictions. Users should note that when the TRACK parameter is set to 1.0 and use in conjunction with this code, allowable bending stresses in compression (FCY & FCZ), tension (FTY & FTZ), and allowable shear stress (FV) will be printed out in Member Selection and Code Check output in Mpa. When TRACK is set to 2.0, detailed design output will be provided. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 9B.1 - Indian Steel Design IS 800:1984 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as INDIAN Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

3.0

0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by the SECTION command.

International Design Codes Manual 551

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984 Parameter Name Default Value Description

1.0 = calculate section forces at twelfth points along the beam, design at each intermediate location and report the critical location where ratio is maximum. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway Cm value in local y & z axes

DFF

None "Deflection Length" / (Mandatory for Maxm. allowable local deflection check) deflection Start Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1) Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1) Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. Yield strength of steel.

DJ1

DJ2

End Joint of member

DMAX DMIN FYLD

100.0 cm. 0.0 cm. 250 MPA (36.25 KSI)

KY KZ

1.0 1.0

K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis.

552 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name LY

Default Value

Description

Member Length

Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Same as above except in local z-axis (major). Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for compression members. Net section factor for tension members. Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis. 1.0 = No sidesway

LZ MAIN

Member Length 180 (Comp. Memb.)

NSF PROFILE

1.0 -

RATIO

1.0

SSY

0.0

SSZ TMAIN

0.0 400 (Tension Memb) 0.0

Same as above except in local z-axis. Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for tension members. 0.0 = Suppress critical member stresses

TRACK

International Design Codes Manual 553

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984 Parameter Name Default Value Description

1.0 = Print all critical member stresses 2.0 = Print expanded output. If there is deflection check it will also print the governing load case number for deflection check whenever critical condition for design is not DEFLECTION. (see fig.8B.1) UNF 1.0 Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length. Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress.

UNL

Member Length

Notes
a. "Deflection Length" is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the "Deflection Length" will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the "Deflection Length" may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.

554 STAAD.Pro

D = Maximum local deflection for members 1, 2, and 3.


PARAMETERS DFF 300. ALL DJ1 1 ALL DJ2 4 ALL

b. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. c. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design.

9B.5 Stability Requirements


Slenderness ratios are calculated for all members and checked against the appropriate maximum values. Section 3.7 of IS:800 summarizes the maximum slenderness ratios for different types of members. In STAAD implementation of IS:800, appropriate maximum slenderness ratio can be provided for each member. If no maximum slenderness ratio is provided, compression members will be checked against a maximum value of 180 and tension members will be checked against a maximum value of 400.

9B.6 Truss Members


As mentioned earlier, a truss member is capable of carrying only axial forces. So in design no time is wasted in calculating bending or shear stresses, thus reducing design time considerably. Therefore, if there is any truss member in an analysis

International Design Codes Manual 555

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984

(like bracing or strut, etc.), it is wise to declare it as a truss member rather than as a regular frame member with both ends pinned.

9B.7 Deflection Check


This facility allows the user to consider deflection as a criteria in the CODE CHECK and MEMBER SELECTION processes. The deflection check may be controlled using three parameters which are described in Table 9B.1. Note that deflection is used in addition to other strength and stability related criteria. The local deflection calculation is based on the latest analysis results.

9B.8 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to verify whether the specified section is capable of satisfying applicable design code requirements. The code checking is based on the IS:800 (1984) requirements. Forces and moments at specified sections of the members are utilized for the code checking calculations. Sections may be specified using the BEAM parameter or the SECTION command. If no sections are specified, the code checking is based on forces and moments at the member ends. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition (applicable IS:800 clause no.), governing load case, location (distance from the start) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed out. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

9B.9 Member Selection


STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section, that is, the lightest section, which satisfies the applicable code requirements. The section selected will be of the same type (I-Section, Channel etc.) as originally specified by the user. Member selection may be performed with all types of steel sections listed in Section 9B.12 and user provided tables. Selection of members, whose properties are originally provided from user specified table, will be limited to sections in the user provided table. Member selection can not be performed on members whose cross sectional properties are specified as PRISMATIC.

556 STAAD.Pro

The process of MEMBER SELECTION may be controlled using the parameters listed in Table 9B.1. It may be noted that the parameters DMAX and DMIN may be used to specify member depth constraints for selection. If PROFILE parameter is provided, the search for the lightest section is restricted to that profile. Up to three (3) profiles may be provided for any member with a section being selected from each one. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

9B.10 Member Selection By Optimization


Steel section selection of the entire structure may be optimized. The optimization method utilizes a state-of-the -art numerical technique which requires automatic multiple analysis. The user may start without a specifically designated section. However, the section profile type (BEAM, COLUMN, CHANNEL, ANGLE etc.) must be specified using the ASSIGN command (see Chapter 6). The optimization is based on member stiffness contributions and corresponding force distributions. An optimum member size is determined through successive analysis/design iterations. This method requires substantial computer time and hence should be used with caution. Refer to Section 5.48.4 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details.

9B.11 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


For code checking or member selection, the program produces the result in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. MEMBER refers to the member number for which the design is performed b. TABLE refers to the INDIAN steel section name which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c. RESULT prints whether the member has PASSED or FAILed. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark in front of the member number. d. CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the IS:800 code which governs the design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number which governs the design.

International Design Codes Manual 557

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984

g. FX, MY and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local y-axis and moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX,MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. i. If the parameter TRACK is set to 1.0, the program will block out part of the table and will print allowable bending stresses in compression (FCY & FCZ) and tension (FTY & FTZ), allowable axial stress in compression (FA), and allowable shear stress (FV). When the parameter TRACK is set to 2.0 for all members parameter code values are as shown in the following example.
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ----------- | |MEMBER 7 * | INDIAN SECTIONS | | AX = 85.0 | | * | ST ISWB400 | | --Z AY = 34.4 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 34.7 | | IS-800 * =============================== ===|=== SY = 138.8 | | * SZ = 1171.3 | | * |<---LENGTH (ME= 3.00 --->| RY = 4.0 | |************* RZ = 16.6 | | | | 112.1( KN-METR) | |PARAMETER |L1 STRESSES | |IN NEWT MM | IN NEWT MM| |--------------- + ------------| | KL/R-Y= 74.2 | FA = 150.0 | IS-800)

558 STAAD.Pro

| KL/R-Z= 18.1 + 1.0 | | UNL = 3000.0 | 139.9 | | C = 400.0 + 165.0 | | CMY = 0.60 | 165.0 | | CMZ = 0.40 + 165.0 | | FYLD = 249.9 | L3 95.7 | | NSF = 0.9 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| 0.0 | | DFF = 0.0 90.5 100.0 | | dff = 0.0 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE 17.1 | | (WITH LOAD NO.) | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY ( KN-METR) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y Z | | | | VALUE -23.9 60.6 0.0 0.0 | | LOCATION 0.0 3.0 0.0 0.0 | | LOADING 3 1 0 0 | | |

fa

FCZ = FTZ = FCY = FTY = fbz = fby = FV fv = =

MOMENT-

112.1 0.0 1

|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION |

International Design Codes Manual 559

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984

| | | | | | |* *|

====================================================== PASS 7.39 T 7.1.2 BEND C 0.0 0.684 -112.1 1 0.00

|**************************************************************************|

9B.12 Indian Steel Table


This is an important feature of the program since the program will read section properties of a steel member directly from the latest ISI steel tables (as published in ISI-800). These properties are stored in memory corresponding to the section designation (e.g., ISMB250, etc.). If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built in to these tables, shear deformation is always considered for these members. Almost all ISI steel tables are available for input. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained using the tools of the graphical user interface. Following are the descriptions of all the types of sections available:

Rolled Steel Beams (ISJB, ISLB, ISMB and ISHB)


All rolled steel beam sections are available the way they are designated in the ISI handbook (e.g., ISJB225, ISWB400, etc.)
20 TO 30 TA ST ISLB325

Note: In case of two identical beams, the heavier beam is designated with an A on the end (e.g., ISHB400 A, etc.).

1 TO 5 TA ST ISHB400A

Rolled Steel Channels (ISJC, ISLC and ISMC)


All these shapes are available as listed in ISI section handbook. Designation of the channels are per the scheme used by ISI.

560 STAAD.Pro

10 TO 20 BY 2 TA ST ISMC125 12 TA ST ISLC300

Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel (e.g., D ISJC125, D ISMC75, etc.).
21 22 24 TA D ISLC225

Rolled Steel Angles


Both rolled steel equal angles and unequal angles are available for use in the STAAD implementation of ISI steel tables. The following example with explanations will be helpful in understanding the input procedure:

At present there is no standard way to define the local y and z axes for an angle section. The standard section has local axis system as illustrated in Fig.2.4 of this manual. The standard angle is specified as:
51 52 53 TA ST ISA60X60X6

This specification has the local z-axis (i.e., the minor axis corresponding to the V-V axis specified in the steel tables. Many engineers are familiar with a convention used by some other programs in which the local y-axis is the minor axis. STAAD provides for this convention by accepting the command:
54 55 56 TA RA ISA50X30X6

Hint: RA denotes reverse angle

International Design Codes Manual 561

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984

Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by inputting the word SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle either LD or SD will serve the purpose. For example,
14 TO 20 TA LD ISA50X30X5 SP 1.5 23 27 TA SD ISA75X50X6

Rolled Tees (ISHT, ISST, ISLT and ISJT)


All the rolled tee sections are available for input as they are specified in the ISI handbook. The following example illustrates the designated method.
1 2 5 8 TA ST ISNT100 67 68 TA ST ISST250

Pipes (Circular Hollow Sections)


To designate circular hollow sections from ISI tables, use PIP followed by the numerical value of diameter and thickness of the section in mm omitting the decimal section of the value provided for diameter. The following example will illustrate the designation.
10 15 TA ST PIP 213.2

specifies a 213 mm dia. pipe with 3.2 mm wall thickness Circular pipe sections can also be specified by providing the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0ID 20.0

specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 and inside dia. of 20 in current length units Only code checking and no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.

562 STAAD.Pro

Tubes (Rectangular or Square Hollow Sections)


Designation of tubes from the ISI steel table is illustrated below.

For example,
15 TO 25 TA ST TUB 160808

Tubes, like pipes, can also be input by their dimensions (Height, Width and Thickness) and not by any table designations.
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5

is a tube that has a height of 8, a width of 6, and a wall thickness of 0.5. Note: Only code checking and no member selection is performed for TUBE sections specified this way.

Plate And Angle Girders (With Flange Plates)


All plate and angle grinders (with flange plates) are available as listed in ISI section handbook. The following example with explanations will be helpful in understanding the input procedure.

International Design Codes Manual 563

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984

A. Plate and angle girder symbol. B. Web plate width in mm. C. Web plate thickness in mm. D. Flange angle, A X BX t, all in mm. Table 9B.2 - Flange angle key Symbol A B C E E. Flange plate width in mm. F. Flange plate thickness in mm. Angle 150X150X18 200X100X15 200X150X18 200X200X18

Single Joist with Channels and Plates on the Flanges to be Used as Girders
All single joist with channel and plates on the flanges to be used as girders are available as listed in ISI section handbook. The following example with explanations will be helpful in understanding the input procedure.

A. Joist Designation IW450 = ISWB450 B. Top flange channel designation: 350 = ISMC350 C. Constant (always X).

564 STAAD.Pro

D. Top flange plate thickness in mm. Note: D = 0 for no plate. E. Bottom flange plate thickness in mm. Note: The heavier ISWB600 has been omitted, since the lighter ISWB600 is more efficient.

9B.13 Column With Lacings And Battens


For columns with large loads it is desirable to build rolled sections at a distance and inter-connect them. The joining of element sections is done by two ways: a. Lacing b. Batten Double channel sections (back-to-back and face-to-face) can be joined either by lacing or by batten plates having riveted or welded connection. Table 9B.3 gives the parameters that are required for Lacing or batten design. These parameters will have to be provided in unit NEW MMS along with parameters defined in Table 9B.1. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

Table 9B.3 - Parameters used in Indian Lacing or Batten steel member design. Parameter Name CTYPE Default Value 1 Description

Type of joining 1. implies single lacing with riveted connection 2. implies double lacing with riveted connection

International Design Codes Manual 565

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984 Parameter Name Default Value Description

3. implies single lacing with welded connection 4. implies double lacing with welded connection 5. implies batten with riveted connection 6. implies batten with welded connection COG 0.0 mm Center of gravity of the channel. This parameter is used when member properties are defined through user provided table using GENERAL option. Nominal diameter of rivet Used when member properties are defined through user provided table using GENERAL option. 0. double channel back-to-back. 1. double channel face-to-face. EDIST 32 mm Edge Distance. (Rivetted Connection) 25 mm (Welded Connection) FVB FYB SPA 100 N/mm2 300 N/mm2 0.0 mm Allowable shear stress in rivet Allowable bearing stress in rivet Spacing between double channels. This parameter is used when member properties are defined through user provided table using

DBL DCFR

20 mm 0.0

566 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

GENERAL option. THETA 50 degree Angle of inclination of lacing bars. It should lie between 40 degree and 70 degree. Minimum thickness of weld Allowable welding stress

WMIN WSTR

6 mm 108 N/mm2

International Design Codes Manual 567

568 STAAD.Pro

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802


Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802 9C.1 General Comments
This section presents some general statements regarding the implementation of Indian Standard code of practice (IS:802-1995 Part 1) for structural steel design for overhead transmission line towers in STAAD. The design philosophy and procedural logistics for member selection and code checking are based upon the principles of allowable stress design. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing, and failure by stability considerations. The flowing sections describe the salient features of the allowable stresses being calculated and the stability criteria being used. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the allowable stresses and the most economic section is selected on the basis of least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program checks stability and strength requirements and reports the critical loading condition and the governing code criteria.

9C.2 Allowable Stresses


The member design and code checking in STAAD are based upon the allowable stress design method as per IS:802 (1995). It is a method for proportioning structural members using design loads and forces, allowable stresses, and design limitations for the appropriate material under service conditions. This section discusses the salient features of the allowable stresses specified by IS:802 and implemented in STAAD.

9C.2.1 Axial Stress

Tensile Stress
The allowable tensile stress, as calculated in STAAD as per IS:802 is described below. The estimated tensile stresses on the net effective sectional area in various members, multiplied by the appropriate factor of safety shall not exceed minimum guaranteed yield stress of the material.

International Design Codes Manual 569

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

Thus, the permissible stress in axial tension, in MPa on the net effective area of at the sections shall not exceed
at

=F

Where: F = minimum yield stress of steel in Mpa


y

Compressive Stress
The estimated compressive stresses in various members multiplied by the appropriate factor of safety shall not exceed the value given by the formulae described below. I. Condition: when (b/t) [ (b/t)
c lim

= 210/F ]:
y

i. When KL/r C , the allowable compressive stress is (in N/mm2) F = F {1 - 0.5[(KL/r)/C ] 2}


a y c

ii. When KL/r > C , the allowable compressive stress is (in N/mm2) F =
a c 2E/(KL/r)2 lim

II. Condition: when (b/t)

< (b/t) 378/F :


y

The equations in condition 1 shall be used, substituting for F the value F y cr given by: F
cr

= F [1.677 - 0.677(b/t)/(b/t)
y y

lim

III. Condition: when (b/t) > 378/F

The equations in condition 1 shall be used, substituting for F the value F y cr given by: F Where: F = allowable unit stress in compression, Mpa
a y cr

= 65,550/(b/t)

F = minimum guaranteed yield stress of the material, Mpa K = restraint factor, L = unbraced length of the compression member in cm, and

570 STAAD.Pro

R = appropriate radius of gyration in cm. E = modulus of elasticity of steel in N/mm2 KL/r = largest effective slenderness ratio of any unbraced segment of the member, b = distance from edge of the fillet to the extreme fibre in mm, and t = thickness of flange in mm. Note: The maximum permissible value of b/t for any type of steel shall not exceed 25.

9C.3 Stability Requirements


Slenderness ratios are calculated for all members and checked against the appropriate maximum values. Following are the default values used in STAAD:

Compression Member
Table 9C.1 - Slenderness ratio limits of compression members Type of Member Slenderness Limit 120

Leg Members, ground wire peak member and lower members of cross arms in compression Other members carrying computed stress Redundant members and those carrying nominal stresses

200 250

Slenderness ratios of compression members are determined as follows:

International Design Codes Manual 571

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802 Table 9C.2 - Compression slenderness ratio calculation depending on ELA parameter ELA Value 1 2 Type of Member Calculation of KL/r L/r L/r

Leg sections or joint members bolted at connections in both faces Members with concentric loading at both ends of the unsupported panel with values of L/r up to and including 120 Member with concentric loading at one end and normal eccentricities at the other end of the unsupported panel for value of L/r up to and including 120 Members with normal framing eccentricities at both ends of the unsupported panel for values of L/r up to and including 120 Member unrestrained against rotation at both ends of the unsupported panel for value of L/r from 120 to 200 Members partially restrained against rotation at one end of the unsupported panel for values of L/r over 120 and up to and including 225 Members partially restrained against rotation at both ends of the unsupported panel for values of L/r over 120 and up to and including 250

30 + 0.75L/r

60 + 0.5L/r

L/r

28.6 + 0.762L/r

46.2 + 0.615L/r

If the value for ELA is given in the input for any particular member is such that condition for L/r ratio to fall within the specified range is not satisfied, STAAD goes on by the usual way of finding slenderness ratio using KL/r formula.

572 STAAD.Pro

Tension Members
Slenderness ratio KL/r of a member carrying axial tension only, shall not exceed 400.

9C.4 Minimum Thickness Requirement


As per Clause7.1 of IS: 802-1995 minimum thickness of different tower members shall be as follows: Members Minimum Thickness (mm) Galvanized Leg Members, ground wire peak member and lower members of cross arms in compression Other members 5 4 Painted 6 5

9C.5 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to verify whether the specified section is capable of satisfying applicable design code requirements. The code checking is based on the IS:802 (1995) requirements. Axial forces at two ends of the members are utilized for the code checking calculations. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from the start) and magnitudes of the governing forces are also printed out. Using TRACK 9 option calculation steps are also printed. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

9C.5.1 Design Steps


The following are the steps used by the program in member design:

International Design Codes Manual 573

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

1. Thickness of the member (maximum of web and flange thicknesses) is checked against minimum allowable thickness, depending upon whether the member is painted or galvanised. 2. If the minimum thickness criterion is fulfilled, the program determines whether the member is under compression or tension for the loadcase under consideration. Depending upon whether the member is under tension or compression the slenderness ratio of the member is calculated. This calculated ratio is checked against allowable slenderness ratio. 3. If the slenderness criterion is fulfilled check against allowable stress is performed. Allowable axial and tensile stresses are calculated. If the member is under tension and there is no user defined net section factor (NSF), the net section factor is calculated by the program itself (Refer Section 8C.10). Actual axial stress in the member is calculated. The ratio for actual stress to allowable stress, if less than 1.0 or user defined value, the member has passed the check. 4. Number of bolts required for the critical loadcase is calculated.

9C.6 Member Selection


STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section, that is, the lightest section, which satisfies the applicable code requirements. The section selected will be of the same type (either angle or channel) as originally specified by the user. Member selection may be performed with all angle or channel sections and user provided tables. Selection of members, whose properties are originally provided from user specified table, will be limited to sections in the user provided table. The process of MEMBER SELECTION may be controlled using the parameters listed in Table 9C.3. It may be noted that the parameters DMAX and DMIN may be used to specify member depth constraints for selection. If PROFILE parameter is provided, the search for the lightest section is restricted to that profile. Up to three (3) profiles may be provided for any member with a section being selected from each one. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

574 STAAD.Pro

9C.7 Member Selection by Optimization


Steel section selection of the entire structure may be optimized. The optimization method utilizes a state-of-the -art numerical technique which requires automatic multiple analysis. The optimization is based on member stiffness contributions and corresponding force distributions. An optimum member size is determined through successive analysis/design iterations. This method requires substantial computer time and hence should be used with caution. Refer to Section 5.48.4 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details.

9C.8 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


An example of a TRACK2.0 output for a compression member is shown here:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ==| |== ----------- | |MEMBER 8 * | INDIAN SECTIONS | | | AX = 17.0 | | * | ST ISA125x95x8 | | | --Z AY = 6.7 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | | AZ = 5.1 | | IS-802 * =============================== ==| |== SY = 38.8 | | * SZ = 16.6 | | * |<---LENGTH (ME= 1.80 --->| RY = 4.4 | |************* RZ = 2.0 | | | | | |PARAMETER BOLTING STRESSES | |IN NEWT MM IN NEWT MM| IS-802)

International Design Codes Manual 575

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

|---------------------| | L/R-Y = 40.5 188.4 | | L/R-Z = 87.9 80.7 | | KL/R = 87.9 436.0 | | FYLD = 250.0 218.0 | | GALVA = 0.0 | | C = 1.0 | | LEG = 1.0 | | ELA = 1.0 | | NSF = 1.0 | | |

------------BOLT DIA = 12 MM BOLT CAP = # BOLT = 24.66 KN 6

-----FA fa = =

FYB = FVB =

|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS COMPRESSION 0.428 1 | | 137.13 C 0.0 0.0 0.00 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------|

Using TRACK 9.0 also adds the following set of calculation details:
DETAILS OF CALCULATION

576 STAAD.Pro

---------------------CHECK FOR MINIMUM THICKNESS --------------------------TYPE : PAINTED MIN. ALLOWABLE THICKNESS : 6.0 MM ACTUAL THICKNESS : 8.0 MM RESULT : PASS CHECK FOR SLENDERNESS RATIO --------------------------VALUE OF L/r : 87.94 EQN. USED TO FIND KL/r : L/r ACTUAL VALUE OF KL/r : 87.94 ALLOWABLE KL/r : 120.00 RESULT : PASS CALCULATION OF ALLOWABLE STRESS --------------------------------CRITICAL CONDITION : COMPRESSION Cc : sqrt(2*3.14159265*3.14159265*E : 127.53 b : LENGTH OF LEG - WEB THICKNESS - ROOT RADIUS : 125.0 - 8.0 9.0 : 108.0 MM (b/t)lim : 210/sqrt(fy) : 13.28 (b/t)cal : 13.50 (b/t)cal > (b/t)lim (b/t)lim (modified) : 378/sqrt(fy) : 23.91 (b/t)cal <= (b/t)lim (modified) AND KL/r <= Cc Fcr : (1.677 - (0.677*(b/t)cal/(b/t)lim))*fy : 247.18 MPA ALLOWABLE AXIAL COMP. STRESS : (1-0.5*(KL/r/Cc)*(KL/r/Cc))*Fcr : 188.41 MPA CHECK AGAINST PERMISSIBLE STRESS -------------------------------LOAD NO. : 1 DESIGN AXIAL FORCE : 137131.16 N ACTUAL AXIAL COMP. STRESS : 137131.16 / 1700.0 : 80.67 MPA RESULT : PASS EXAMPLE PROBLEM NO.1 -- PAGE NO. 24 BOLTING ------BOLT DIA : 12 MM SHEARING CAP : 24.66 KN BEARING CAP : 41.86 KN BOLT CAP : 24.66 KN NO. OF BOLTS REQD. : 6 ************** END OF TABULATED RESULT OF DESIGN **************

International Design Codes Manual 577

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

9C.9 Design Parameters


Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 9C.3 - Indian Steel Design IS 802 Parameters Parameter Name CNSF Default Value 0.0 Description

This parameter indicates whether user has defined the net section factor or the program will calculate it. 0. Use specified NSF value 1. Net section factor will be calculated.

DANGLE

0.0

This parameter indicates how the pair of angles are connected to each other. This is required to find whether the angle is in single or double shear and the net section factor. 0. Double angle placed back-toback and connected to each side of a gusset plate 1. Pair of angle placed back-toback connected by only one leg of each angle to the same side of a gusset plate

DBL

12 mm

Diameter of bolt for calculation of number of bolts and net section factor. Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. This parameter indicates what type

DMAX DMIN ELA

100.0 cm. 0.0 cm. 1.0

578 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

of end conditions is to be used. Refer Section 9C.3. FVB FYB FYLD GUSSET 218 MPA 436 MPA 250 MPA 5 mm Allowable shear stress in bolt Allowable bearing stress in bolt Yield Strength of steel Thickness of gusset plate. Minimum of the thicknesses of the gusset plate and the leg is used for calculation of the capacity of bolt in bearing KY KZ LEG 1.0 1.0 1.0 K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. This parameter is meant for plain angles. 0. The angle is connected by shorter leg 1. The angle is connected by longer leg LY LZ MAIN Member Length Member Length 1.0 Unbraced length in local z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Unbraced length in local z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Type of member to find allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for members. 1. Leg, Ground wire peak and lower members of cross arms

International Design Codes Manual 579

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802 Parameter Name Default Value Description

in compression (KL/r = 120) 2. Members carrying computed stress (KL/r = 200) 3. Redundant members and members carrying nominal stresses (KL/r = 250) 4. Tension members (KL/r = 400) 10. Do not perform KL/r check Any value greater than 10.0 indicates user defined allowable KL/r ratio. For this case KY and KZ values are must to find actual KL/r ratio of the member. NSF NHL 1.0 0.0 mm Net section factor for tension members Deduction for holes. Default value is one bolt width plus 1.5 mm. If the area of holes cut by any straight, diagonal or zigzag line across the member is different from the default value, this parameter is to be defined. TRACK 0.0 Level of output detail: 0. Suppress critical member stresses 1. Print all critical member stresses 2. Print expanded output. 9. Print design calculations along with expanded output

580 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

(not available in GUI input).

9C.10 Calculation of Net Section Factor


The procedure for calculating the net section factor for an angle section is as follows:
l

For a channel section, net section factor is taken to be 1.0. For an angle section, it is the ratio of the net effective area, A , to the gross net area, where: a. Single angle connected by only one leg A Where: A = net cross-sectional area of the connected leg
1 2 1 net

=A +A K
1 2

A = gross cross-sectional area of the unconnected leg K = 3A /(3A +A )


1 1 2

The area of a leg of an angle = Thickness of angle x (length of leg 0.5x thickness of leg) b. Pair of angles placed back-to-back connected by only one leg of each angle to the same side of a gusset plate A Where: A = net cross-sectional area of the connected leg
1 2 1 net

=A +A K
1 2

A = gross cross-sectional area of the unconnected leg K = 5A /(5A +A )


1 1 2

The area of a leg of an angle = Thickness of angle x (length of leg 0.5x thickness of leg)

International Design Codes Manual 581

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

c. Double angles placed back-to-back and connected to each side of a gusset plate A
net

= gross area minus the deduction for holes

9C.11 Example Problem No. 28


A transmission line tower is subjected to different loading conditions. Design some members as per IS-802 and show detailed calculation steps for the critical loading condition.

Given
End Condition = Members with normal framing eccentricities at both ends of the unsupported panel for values of L/r up to and including 120 Diameter of the bolt = 16 mm 582 STAAD.Pro

Thickness of the gusset plate = 8 mm Net Section Factor is to be calculated.

STAADInput File
This input file is included with the program as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\IND\EXAMP28.STD.
STAAD TRUSS INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 3 0 3; 2 1.2 27 1.2; 3 2.8 3 2.8; 4 2.6 6 2.6; 5 2.4 9 2.4; 6 2.2 12 2.2; 7 2 15 2; 8 1.8 18 1.8; 9 1.6 21 1.6; 10 1.4 24 1.4; 11 -3 0 3; 12 -1.2 27 1.2; 13 -2.8 3 2.8; 14 -2.6 6 2.6; 15 -2.4 9 2.4; 16 -2.2 12 2.2; 17 -2 15 2; 18 -1.8 18 1.8; 19 -1.6 21 1.6; 20 -1.4 24 1.4; 21 3 0 -3; 22 1.2 27 -1.2; 23 2.8 3 -2.8; 24 2.6 6 -2.6; 25 2.4 9 -2.4; 26 2.2 12 -2.2; 27 2 15 -2; 28 1.8 18 -1.8; 29 1.6 21 -1.6; 30 1.4 24 1.4; 31 -3 0 -3; 32 -1.2 27 -1.2; 33 -2.8 3 -2.8; 34 -2.6 6 -2.6; 35 -2.4 9 2.4; 36 -2.2 12 -2.2; 37 -2 15 -2; 38 -1.8 18 -1.8; 39 -1.6 21 -1.6; 40 -1.4 24 -1.4; 41 1.2 30 1.2; 42 -1.2 30 1.2; 43 1.2 30 -1.2; 44 -1.2 30 -1.2; 45 4.2 27 1.2; 46 7.2 27 1.2; 47 4.2 30 1.2; 48 4.2 27 -1.2; 49 7.2 27 -1.2; 50 4.2 30 -1.2; 51 -4.2 27 1.2; 52 -7.2 27 1.2; 53 -4.2 30 1.2; 54 -4.2 27 -1.2; 55 -7.2 27 -1.2; 56 -4.2 30 -1.2; 57 1.2 33 1.2; 58 -1.2 33 1.2; 59 1.2 33 -1.2; 60 -1.2 33 -1.2; 61 0 35 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 4; 3 4 5; 4 5 6; 5 6 7; 6 7 8; 7 8 9; 8 9 10; 9 10 2; 10 11 13;

International Design Codes Manual 583

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

11 13 14; 12 14 15; 13 15 16; 14 16 17; 15 17 18; 16 18 19; 17 19 20; 18 20 12; 19 13 3; 20 14 4; 21 15 5; 22 16 6; 23 17 7; 24 18 8; 25 19 9; 26 20 10; 27 12 2; 28 11 3; 29 1 13; 30 13 4; 31 3 14; 32 14 5; 33 15 4; 34 15 6; 35 16 5; 36 16 7; 37 17 6; 38 17 8; 39 18 7; 40 18 9; 41 19 8; 42 19 10; 43 20 9; 44 20 2; 45 12 10; 46 21 23; 47 23 24; 48 24 25; 49 25 26; 50 26 27; 51 27 28; 52 28 29; 53 29 30; 54 30 22; 55 3 23; 56 4 24; 57 5 25; 58 6 26; 59 7 27; 60 8 28; 61 9 29; 62 10 30; 63 2 22; 64 1 23; 65 21 3; 66 3 24; 67 23 4; 68 4 25; 69 5 24; 70 5 26; 71 6 25; 72 6 27; 73 7 26; 74 7 28; 75 8 27; 76 8 29; 77 9 28; 78 9 30; 79 10 29; 80 10 22; 81 2 30; 82 31 33; 83 33 34; 84 34 35; 85 35 36; 86 36 37; 87 37 38; 88 38 39; 89 39 40; 90 40 32; 91 23 33; 92 24 34; 93 25 35; 94 26 36; 95 27 37; 96 28 38; 97 29 39; 98 30 40; 99 22 32; 100 21 33; 101 31 23; 102 23 34; 103 33 24; 104 24 35; 105 25 34; 106 25 36; 107 26 35; 108 26 37; 109 27 36; 110 27 38; 111 28 37; 112 28 39; 113 29 38; 114 29 40; 115 30 39; 116 30 32; 117 22 40; 118 33 13; 119 34 14; 120 35 15; 121 36 16; 122 37 17; 123 38 18; 124 39 19; 125 40 20; 126 32 12; 127 31 13; 128 11 33; 129 33 14; 130 13 34; 131 34 15; 132 35 14; 133 35 16; 134 36 15; 135 36 17; 136 37 16; 137 37 18; 138 38 17; 139 38 19; 140 39 18; 141 39 20; 142 40 19; 143 40 12; 144 32 20; 145 32 44; 146 12 42; 147 2 41;

584 STAAD.Pro

148 22 43; 149 42 41; 150 41 43; 151 43 44; 152 44 42; 153 12 41; 154 42 2; 155 22 41; 156 43 2; 157 43 32; 158 44 22; 159 12 44; 160 32 42; 161 41 47; 162 47 45; 163 45 2; 164 47 46; 165 46 45; 166 41 45; 167 43 50; 168 50 48; 169 48 22; 170 50 49; 171 49 48; 172 43 48; 173 47 50; 174 46 49; 175 45 48; 176 41 50; 177 50 46; 178 43 47; 179 47 49; 180 22 50; 181 2 47; 182 22 45; 183 2 48; 184 47 48; 185 50 45; 186 45 49; 187 48 46; 188 42 53; 189 53 51; 190 51 12; 191 53 52; 192 52 51; 193 42 51; 194 44 56; 195 56 54; 196 54 32; 197 56 55; 198 55 54; 199 44 54; 200 53 56; 201 52 55; 202 51 54; 203 42 56; 204 56 52; 205 44 53; 206 53 55; 207 32 56; 208 12 53; 209 32 51; 210 12 54; 211 53 54; 212 56 51; 213 51 55; 214 54 52; 215 44 60; 216 42 58; 217 41 57; 218 43 59; 219 60 59; 220 59 57; 221 57 58; 222 58 60; 223 44 58; 224 42 60; 225 42 57; 226 41 58; 227 44 59; 228 43 60; 229 43 57; 230 41 59; 231 60 57; 232 59 58; 235 33 3; 236 13 23; 237 34 4; 238 14 24; 239 35 5; 240 15 25; 241 36 6; 242 16 26; 243 37 7; 244 17 27; 245 38 8; 246 18 28; 247 39 9; 248 19 29; 249 40 10; 250 20 30; 251 32 2; 252 22 12; 253 44 41; 254 43 42; 255 60 61; 256 58 61; 257 57 61; 258 59 61; MEMBER PROPERTY INDIAN 1 TO 18 46 TO 54 82 TO 90 145 TO 148 215 TO 218 TA LD ISA200X150X18 SP 0.01 19 TO 26 28 TO 45 55 TO 62 64 TO 81 91 TO 98 100 TO 125 127 TO 144 155 156 159 160 223 224 229 230 235 TO 250 TA ST ISA150X150X10

International Design Codes Manual 585

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

27 63 99 126 149 TO 154 157 158 161 TO 214 219 TO 222 225 TO 228 231 232 251 252 TO 258 TA ST ISA80X50X6 CONSTANTS E 2.05E+008 ALL POISSON 0.3 ALL DENSITY 76.8195 ALL ALPHA 6.5E-006 ALL SUPPORTS 1 11 21 31 FIXED UNIT METER KG LOAD 1 VERT SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 61 FX 732 46 49 52 55 FX 153 61 FX 1280 FY -1016 FZ 160 46 49 52 55 FX 9006 FY -7844 FZ 1968 2 12 22 32 FX 4503 FY -3937 FZ 1968 LOAD 2 GWBC SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 61 FX 549 46 49 52 55 FX 1148 61 FX 515 FY -762 FZ 2342 46 49 52 55 FX 6755 FY -5906 2 12 22 32 FX 3378 FY -2953 LOAD 3 LEFT PCBC SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD

586 STAAD.Pro

61 FX 549 46 49 52 55 FX 1148 61 FX 960 FY -762 46 49 FX 6755 FY -5906 52 55 FX 4211 FY -4551 FZ 13293 2 12 22 32 FX 3378 FY -2953 LOAD 4 RIGHT PCBC SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 61 FX 549 46 49 52 55 FX 1148 61 FX 960 FY -762 52 55 FX 6755 FY -5906 46 49 FX 4211 FY -4551 FZ 13293 2 12 22 32 FX 3378 FY -2953 PERFORM ANALYSIS UNIT NEW MMS PARAMETER CODE IS802 LY 2800 MEMB 28 LZ 2800 MEMB 28 MAIN 1.0 MEMB 1 ELA 4 MEMB 1 CNSF 1.0 MEMB 28 DBL 16 ALL GUSSET 8 ALL TRACK 9 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 1 28 FINISH

International Design Codes Manual 587

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

Output
A portion of the output for the TRACK9.0 member code check follows:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ==||== ----------- | |MEMBER 1 * | INDIAN SECTIONS | || AX = 120.0 | | * | LD ISA200X150X18 | || --Z AY = 48.0 | |DESIGN CODE * | | || AZ = 36.0 | | IS-802 * |-----------------------------| || SY = 297.3 | | * SZ = 350.6 | | * |<---LENGTH (ME= 3.01 --->| RY = 6.2 | |************* RZ = 6.3 | | | | | |PARAMETER BOLTING STRESSES | |IN NEWT MM IN NEWT MM| |--------------------------------------| | L/R-Y = 48.6 BOLT DIA = 16 MM FA = 195.1 | | L/R-Z = 47.7 BOLT CAP = 55.81 KN fa = 145.2 | | KL/R = 84.3 # BOLT = 32 FYB = 436.0 | | FYLD = 250.0 FVB = 218.0 | | GALVA = 0.0 | | C = 1.0 | IS-802)

588 STAAD.Pro

| LEG | | ELA | | NSF | | |

= = =

1.0 4.0 1.0

|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS COMPRESSION 0.744 1 | | 1742.26 C 0.0 0.0 0.00 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 5 DETAILS OF CALCULATION ---------------------CHECK FOR MINIMUM THICKNESS --------------------------TYPE : PAINTED MIN. ALLOWABLE THICKNESS : 6.0 MM ACTUAL THICKNESS : 18.0 MM RESULT : PASS CHECK FOR SLENDERNESS RATIO --------------------------VALUE OF L/r : 48.63 EQN. USED TO FIND KL/r : 60.0 + 0.5*L/r ACTUAL VALUE OF KL/r : 84.31 ALLOWABLE KL/r : 120.00

International Design Codes Manual 589

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

RESULT : PASS CALCULATION OF ALLOWABLE STRESS --------------------------------CRITICAL CONDITION : COMPRESSION Cc : sqrt(2*3.14159265*3.14159265*E : 127.24 b : LENGTH OF LEG - WEB THICKNESS - ROOT RADIUS : 200.0 - 18.0 - 15.0 : 167.0 MM (b/t)lim : 210/sqrt(fy) : 13.28 (b/t)cal : 9.28 (b/t)cal <= (b/t)lim AND KL/r <= Cc ALLOWABLE AXIAL COMP. STRESS : (1-0.5*(KL/r/Cc)*(KL/r/Cc))*fy : 195.07 MPA CHECK AGAINST PERMISSIBLE STRESS -------------------------------LOAD NO. : 1 DESIGN AXIAL FORCE : 1742259.75 N ACTUAL AXIAL COMP. STRESS :1742259.75 / 12000.0 : 145.19 MPA RESULT : PASS STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 6 BOLTING ------BOLT DIA : 16 MM SHEARING CAP : 87.66 KN BEARING CAP : 55.81 KN BOLT CAP : 55.81 KN NO. OF BOLTS REQD. : 32 STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 7 STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( IS-802) v1.0 ******************************************** |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ==| |== ----------- | |MEMBER 28 * | INDIAN SECTIONS | | | AX = 29.2 | | * | ST ISA150X150X10 | | | --Z AY = 10.0 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | | AZ = 10.0 | | IS-802 * =============================== ==| |== SY = 95.7 | | * SZ = 44.8 |

590 STAAD.Pro

| * |<---LENGTH (ME= 6.53 --->| 5.9 | |************* 3.0 | | | | | |PARAMETER BOLTING STRESSES | |IN NEWT MM NEWT MM| |--------------------------------| | L/R-Y = 47.5 BOLT DIA = 16 MM 249.9 | | L/R-Z = 94.0 BOLT CAP = 43.83 KN 48.5 | | KL/R = 94.0 # BOLT = 3 436.0 | | FYLD = 250.0 218.0 | | GALVA = 0.0 | | C = 1.0 | | LEG = 1.0 | | ELA = 1.0 | | NSF = 0.8 | | |

RY = RZ =

IN ------FA fa = =

FYB = FVB =

|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS TENSION 0.194 3 | | 112.86 T 0.0 0.0 6.53 |

International Design Codes Manual 591

Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802

|* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 8 DETAILS OF CALCULATION ---------------------CHECK FOR MINIMUM THICKNESS --------------------------TYPE : PAINTED MIN. ALLOWABLE THICKNESS : 6.0 MM ACTUAL THICKNESS : 10.0 MM RESULT : PASS CHECK FOR SLENDERNESS RATIO --------------------------VALUE OF L/r : 93.96 EQN. USED TO FIND KL/r : K*L/r ACTUAL VALUE OF KL/r : 93.96 ALLOWABLE KL/r : 400.00 RESULT : PASS CALCULATION OF ALLOWABLE STRESS --------------------------------CRITICAL CONDITION : TENSION ALLOWABLE AXIAL TENSILE STRESS : 249.94 MPA CHECK AGAINST PERMISSIBLE STRESS -------------------------------LOAD NO. : 3 DESIGN AXIAL FORCE : 112855.91 N ACTUAL AXIAL TENSILE STRESS : 112855.91 / ( 2920.0*0.797 ) : 48.51 MPA RESULT : PASS BOLTING ------BOLT DIA : 16 MM SHEARING CAP : 43.83 KN BEARING CAP : 55.81 KN BOLT CAP : 43.83 KN NO. OF BOLTS REQD. : 3 STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 9 ************** END OF TABULATED RESULT OF DESIGN **************

592 STAAD.Pro

Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code


9D.1 General
Provisions of IS:801-1975, including revisions dated May, 1988, have been implemented. The program allows design of single (non-composite) members in tension, compression, bending, shear, as well as their combinations. Cold work of forming strengthening effects has been included as an option.

9D.2 Cross-Sectional Properties


The user specifies the geometry of the cross-section by selecting one of the section shape designations from the Gross Section Property Tables from IS:811-1987 (Specification for cold formed light gauge structural steel sections). The Tables are currently available for the following shapes:
l

Channel with Lips Channel without Lips Angle without Lips Z with Lips Hat

Shape selection may be done using the member property pages of the graphical user interface (GUI) or by specifying the section designation symbol in the input file. The properties listed in the tables are gross section properties. STAAD.Pro uses unreduced section properties in the structure analysis stage. Both unreduced and effective section properties are used in the design stage, as applicable.

9D.3 Design Procedure


The program calculates effective section properties in accordance with Clause 5.2.1.1. Cross-sectional properties and overall slenderness of members are checked for compliance with

International Design Codes Manual 593

Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code

Clause 6.6.3, Maximum Effective Slenderness Ratio for members in Compression Clause 5.2.3, Maximum Flat Width Ratios for Elements in Compression Clause 5.2.4, Maximum Section Depths.

The program will check member strength in accordance with Clause 6 of the Standard as follows:

Members in tension
Resistance is calculated in accordance with Clauses 6.1

Members in bending and shear


Resistance calculations are based on Clauses:
l

Clause 6.4.1 Shear stress in webs, Clause 6.4.2 Bending stress in webs Clause 6.4.3 Combined Bending and Shear in Webs.

Members in compression
Resistance calculations are based on Clauses:
l

Clause 6.2 Compression on flat unstiffened element, Clause 6.6.1.1 Shapes not subject to torsional-flexural buckling, Clause 6.6.1.2 Singly-symmetric sections and nonsymmetrical shapes of open cross section or intermittently fastened singly-symmetrical components of built-up shapes having Q = 1.0 which may be subject to torsional-flexural buckling, Clause 6.6.1.3 Singly-symmetric sections and nonsymmetrical shapes or intermittently fastened singly-symmetrical components of built-up shapes having Q < 1.0 which may be subject to torsional-flexural buckling, Clause 6.8 Cylindrical Tubular Sections.

Members in compression and bending


Resistance calculations are based on Clauses:

594 STAAD.Pro

All clauses for members in compression Clause 6.3 Laterally Unsupported Members, Clause 6.7.1 Doubly-symmetric shapes or Shapes not subjected to torsional or torsional-flexural buckling Clause 6.7.2. Singly-symmetric shapes or Intermittently fastened singly-symmetric components of built-up shapes having Q=1.0 which may be subjected to torsional-flexural buckling Clause 6.7.3. Singly-symmetric shapes or Intermittently fastened singly-symmetric components of built-up shapes having Q<1.0 which may be subjected to torsional-flexural buckling.

9D.4 Code Checking and Member Selection


The following two design modes are available:

Code Checking
The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with IS:801-1975. Code checking is carried out for locations specified by the user via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. The user may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

Member Selection
The user may request that the program search the cold formed steel shapes database (IS standard sections) for alternative members that pass the code check and meet the least weight criterion. In addition, a minimum and/or maximum acceptable depth of the member may be specified. The program will then evaluate all database sections of the type initially specified (i.e., channel, angle, etc.) and, if a suitable replacement is found, presents design results for that section. If no section satisfying the depth restrictions or lighter than the initial one can be found, the program leaves the member unchanged, regardless of whether it passes the code check or not.

International Design Codes Manual 595

Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code

Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

9D.5 Design Parameters


Input for the coefficients of uniform bending must be specified. The following table contains the input parameters for specifying values of design variables and selection of design options. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 9D.1 - Indian cold formed steel design parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as IS801 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

1.0 BEAM

When this parameter is set to 0. the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details. For TRUSS members only start and end locations are designed. 1. the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member.

596 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name CMY

Default Value 0.85

Description

Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending . See IS:801-1975, 6.7. y Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending . See IS:801-1975, 6.7. z Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. Specifies whether the cold work of forming strengthening effect should be included in resistance computation. See IS:801-1975, 6.1.1 0. effect should not be included 1. effect should be included

CMZ

1.0

CWY

0.85

FLX

Specifies whether torsionalflexural buckling restraint is provided or is not necessary for the member. See IS:801-1975, 6.6.1 0. Section not subject to torsional flexural buckling 1. Section subject to torsional flexural buckling

FU

450 MPa (4588.72 kg/cm2)

Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units.

FYLD

353.04 MPa

(3600.0

Yield strength of steel in current units.

International Design Codes Manual 597

Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value kg/cm2) KX 1.0 Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall buckling about the local Y-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for Description

KY

1.0

KZ

1.0

LX

Member length

598 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. LY Member length Effective length for overall buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. 0 Check slenderness ratio 0 Do not check slenderness ratio NSF DMAX 1.0 2540.0 cm. RATIO STIFF 1.0 Member Length Net section factor for tension members Maximum allowable depth, in the current units. Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stresses Spacing of shear stiffeners for stiffened flat webs, in current units.

LZ

Member length

MAIN

International Design Codes Manual 599

Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name TRACK 0 Default Value Description

This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 0. Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 1. Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 0 2. Prints member and material properties in addition to that printed by TRACK 1.

TSA

Specifies whether webs of flexural members are adequately stiffened to satisfy the requirements of IS:801-1975, 5.2.4. 0. Do not comply with 5.2.4 1. Comply with 5.2.4

600 STAAD.Pro

Section 10

Japanese Codes

International Design Codes Manual 601

602 STAAD.Pro

Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ


10A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capabilities of performing concrete design based on the AIJ standard for structural calculation of Reinforced Concrete Structures (1991 edition). Design for a member involves calculation of the amount of reinforcement required for the member. Calculations are based on the user specified properties and the member forces obtained from the analysis. In addition, the details regarding placement of the reinforcement on the cross section are also reported in the output.

10A.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections for concrete members can be designed:
l

For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular andSquare) For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)

10A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members which will be designed by the program must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTY command. These are the D (YD) and b (ZD) dimensions for rectangular or square cross sections and the D (YD) for circular cross sections. The following is an example the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTY 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 250. 11 13 PR YD 350.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250 mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with a 350 mm diameter.

International Design Codes Manual 603

Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ

Warning: It is absolutely imperative that you do not provide the cross section area (AX) as an input.

10A.4 Slenderness Effects and Analysis Considerations


Slenderness effects are extremely important in designing compression members. Slenderness effects result in additional forces being exerted on the column over and above those obtained from the elastic analysis. There are two options by which the slenderness effects can be accommodated. The first option is to compute the secondary moments through an exact analysis. Secondary moments are caused by the interaction of the axial loads and the relative end displacements of a member. The axial loads and joint displacements are first determined from an elastic stiffness analysis and the secondary moments are then evaluated. The second option is to approximately magnify the moments from the elastic analysis and design the column for the magnified moment. It is assumed that the magnified moment is equivalent to the total moment comprised of the sum of primary and secondary moments. STAAD provides facilities to design according to both of the above methods. To utilize the first method, the command PDELTA ANALYSIS must be used instead of PERFORM ANALYSIS in the input file. The user must note that to take advantage of this analysis, all the combinations of loading must be provided as primary load cases and not as load combinations. This is due to the fact that load combinations are just algebraic combinations of forces and moments, whereas a primary load case is revised during the P-delta analysis based on the deflections. Also, note that the proper factored loads (like 1.5 for dead load etc.) should be provided by the user. STAAD does not factor the loads automatically. The second method mentioned above is utilized by providing the magnification factor as a concrete design parameter (See the parameter MMAG in Table 10A.1). The column is designed for the axial load and total of primary and secondary biaxial moments if the first method is used and for the axial load and magnified biaxial moments if the second method is used.

604 STAAD.Pro

10A.5 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. The program considers 12 equally spaced divisions of the beam member. However this number can be redefined by NSECTION parameter. All these sections are designed for flexure, shear and torsion for all load cases. The results include design results for most critical load case. Example
UNIT KG CM START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE JAPAN FYMAIN SRR295 ALL FYSEC SRR295 ALL FC 350 ALL CLEAR 2.5 MEM 2 TO 6 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN

10A.5.1 Design for Flexure


Reinforcement for positive and negative moments are calculated on the basis of section properties provided by the user. Program first try to design the section for g = 0 and pt = balanced reinforcement ratio. If allowable moment is lower than the actual moment program increases g value for same pt and checks the satisfactory conditions. If conditions are not satisfied this procedure continues until g reaches to 1.0 and then pt value is increased keeping g = 1.0. This procedure continues until pt reaches to its maximum value( 2 % ). But if the allowable moment for pt = maximum value and g = 1.0 is lower than the actual moment the program gives message that the section fails. This program automatically calculates the Bar size and no. of bars needed to design the section. It arranges the bar in layers as per the requirements and recalculate the effective depth and redesign the sections for this effective depth. Notes:

International Design Codes Manual 605

Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ

a. Beams are designed for MZ only. The moment MY is not considered in flexure design b. MMAG parameter can be used to increase design moment c. 1.4 cm. is added to the clear cover to take stirrup size into consideration for flexure design. d. STAAD beam design procedure is based on the local practice and considering the fact that Japan is a high seismic zone area.

10A.5.2 Design for Shear


The Design Shear value, Q , is evaluated for the beam. The update effective depth D is used to then calculate the allowable shear stress. The allowable shear stress of concrete, f , is automatically calculated from design load type (permanent or s temporary) and given density of concrete. The program then calculates the required bar size, aw, and spacing of stirrups. The reinforcement ratio for the stirrup, p , is calculated for design Bar size and stirrup pitch and all the necessary w checking is done. For seismic loading it is needed to increase shear force 1.5 times the actual value and this can be done utilizing the Design Shear Modification factor, k (SMAG parameter) without changing the Design Moment. Notes: a. Stirrups are always assumed to be 2-legged b. Governing density to determine Light weight or Normal Weight Concrete is 2.3 kg/sq. cm

10A.5.4 Design for Torsion


Torsion design for beam is optional. If the TORSION parameter value is 1.0, the program will design the assigned beam(s) for torsion. The program first checks whether extra reinforcement is needed for torsion or not. If additional reinforcement is needed, this additional pt is added to flexure pt and additional Pw is added to shear design Pw.

606 STAAD.Pro

10A.6 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial force, MZ moment, MY moment, and shear force. Both the ends of the members are designed for all the load cases and the loading which produces largest amount of reinforcement is called as critical load. If Track 0 or Track 1 is used, design results will be printed for critical load only. But if Track 2 is used, you can get detailed design results of that member. The value of Pt needed for minimum axial force, maximum axial force, maximum MZ, maximum MY among all the load cases for both the ends will be printed. If the MMAG parameter is used, the column moments will be multiplied by that value. If the SMAG parameter is used, column shear force will be multiplied by that value. Column design is done for Rectangular, Square and Circular sections. For rectangular and square sections Pt value is calculated separately for MZ and MY, while for circular sections Pg value is calculated for MZ and MY separately. Column design for biaxial moments is optional. If the BIAXIAL parameter value is 1.0, the program will design the column for biaxial moments. Otherwise column design is always uniaxial. Steps involved: 1. Depending on the axial force zone is determined for Pt = 0.0 . 2. If the column is in "zone A", design is performed by increasing Pt and checking allowable load for that known Pt and known actual eccentricity of the column. 3. If the column is in "zone B" or in "zone C", xn is calculated for given P and Pt and checking is done for allowable moment, if allowable moment is less than the actual moment, program increases Pt and this procedure continues until the column design conditions are satisfied or the column fails as the required Pt is higher than Pt maximum value. 4. If the column is in tension, design is done by considering allowable tensile stress of steel only. 5. If biaxial design is requested program solve the following interaction equation 6. where, a = 1.0+1.66666666 (ratio-0.2), ratio = P/Pcap & 1.0 a 2.0, Mycap, Mzcap & Pcap represents section capacity 7. If the interaction equation is not satisfied program increases Pt and calculates

International Design Codes Manual 607

Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ

Pcap, Mycap and Mzcap and solve the interaction equation again and this process continues until the eqn. is satisfied or the column fails as Pt exceeds its maximum limit. 8. If biaxial design is not requested program assumes that interaction equation is satisfied (if uniaxial design is performed successfully). 9. If the interaction equation is satisfied program determines bar size and calculates no. of bars and details output is written. Example
UNIT KGS CMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE JAPAN FYMAIN SRR295 ALL FC 210 ALL CLEAR 2.5 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6 END CONCRETE DESIGN

10A.7 Slab/Wall Design


To design a slab or a wall, it must first be modeled using finite elements and analyzed. The command specifications are in accordance with Chapter 2 and Chapter 6 of the Technical Reference Manual. Elements are designed for the moments Mx and My. These moments are obtained from the element force output (see Chapter 2 of the Technical Reference Manual). The reinforcement required to resist the Mx moment is denoted as longitudinal reinforcement and the reinforcement required to resist the My moment is denoted as transverse reinforcement. The longitudinal bar is the layer closest to the exterior face of the slab or wall. The following parameters are those applicable to slab and wall design: 1. FYMAIN Yield stress for reinforcing steel - transverse and longitudinal. 2. FC Concrete grade 3. CLEAR Distance from the outer surface of the element to the edge of the

608 STAAD.Pro

bar. This is considered the same on both top and bottom surfaces of the element. 4. MINMAIN Minimum required size of longitudinal/transverse reinforcing bar The other parameters shown in Table 10A.1 are not applicable to slab or wall design.

10A.8 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform the design. Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 10A.1 contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to declare length and force units as centimeters and Kilograms before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 10A.1 - Japanese Concrete Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as JAPAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BIAXIAL

0.0

Value to define biaxial or uniaxial design type for Column 0. uniaxial design only 1. design for biaxial moments

CLEAR

3.0 cm (beam) 4.0 cm (Column)

Clear cover for Beam or clear side cover for column.

International Design Codes Manual 609

Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ Parameter Name DEPTH Default Value YD Description

Depth of concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam. (Note: Both SFACE & EFACE are input as positive numbers). Compressive Strength of Concrete. Steel grade. Acceptable values for steel grade and their associated yield stress values are shown in the following table. Program automatically calculates yield stress value depending on design load type (permanent or temporary). Same as FYMAIN except this is for secondary steel. Value to define design load type 0. Permanent Loading 1. Temporary Loading

EFACE

0.0

FC FYMAIN

210 Kg/cm2 SR235

FYSEC LONG

SR235 0.0

MAXMAIN MAXSEC MINMAIN MINSEC MMAG NSECTION

41.0 cm 41.0 cm 10 mm 10 mm 1.0 12

Maximum main reinforcement bar size Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Design moment magnification factor Number of equally-spaced sections

610 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

to be considered in finding critical moments for beam design. REINF SFACE SMAG TORSION 0.0 0.0 1.0 0.0 Tied Column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral. Face of support location at start of beam. Design shear magnification factor Value to request for torsion design for beam 0. torsion design not needed 1. torsion design needed TRACK 0.0 Beam Design: 0. Critical section design results. 1. Five section design results & design forces. 2. 12 section design results & design forces. Column Design: 1. Detail design results for critical load case only. 2. Design results for minimum P, maximum P, maximum MZ and maximum MY among all load cases for both ends. WIDTH ZD Width of concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

International Design Codes Manual 611

Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ Table 10A.2 - Table of permissible Steel Grades and associated Yield Stresses for FYMAIN and FYSEC parameters Steel Grade Long Term Loading Tension &Compression 1600 Shear Reinforcement 1600 Short Term Loading Tension &Compression 2400 Shear Reinforcement 2400

SR235 SRR235 SDR235 SR295 SRR295 SD295A SD295B SDR295 SDR345 SD345 SD390

1600 2000

2000 2000

3000 3000

3000 3000

2200 (2000) 2200 (2000)

2000 2000

3500 4000

3500 4000

612 STAAD.Pro

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ


10B.(A) Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2002 AIJ
10B.1(A) General
This section presents some general statements regarding the implementation of the Architectural Institute of Japan (AIJ) specifications for structural steel design (1986 and 2002 editions) in STAAD. The design philosophy and procedural logistics are based on the principles of elastic analysis and allowable stress design. Facilities are available for member selection as well as code checking. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing and failure by stability considerations. The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceedance of the allowable stresses or capacities and the most economical section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program also checks the slenderness requirements and the stability criteria. Users are recommended to adopt the following steps in performing the steel design:
l

Specify the geometry and loads and perform the analysis. Specify the design parameter values if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection.

10B.2(A) Analysis Methodology


Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and in using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis or P-Delta analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results.

International Design Codes Manual 613

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

10B.3(A) MemberPropertySpecifications
For specification of member properties of standard Japanese steel shapes, the steel section library available in STAAD may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. Members properties may also be specified using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

10B.4(A) Built-in Japanese Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, these properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered for these members during the analysis. An example of member property specification in an input file is provided at the end of this section. A complete listing of the sections available in the built-in steel section library may be obtained using the tools of the graphical user interface. Following are the descriptions of different types of sections.

I shapes
I shapes are specified in the following way:

Note: While specifying the web thickness, the portion after the decimal point should be excluded.

1 TO 9 TA ST I300X150X11 12 TO 15 TA ST I350X150X9

614 STAAD.Pro

H shapes
H shapes are specified as follows:

Note: While specifying the web thickness, the portion after the decimal point should be excluded.

1 TO 8 TA ST H200X100X4 13 TO 17 TA ST H350X350X12

T shapes
T shapes are specified as follows:

Note: While specifying the web thickness, the portion after the decimal point should be excluded.

20 TO 25 TA ST T250X19

Channels
Channel sections are specified as follows.

International Design Codes Manual 615

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

25 TO 34 TA ST C125X65X6 46 TO 49 TA ST C200X90X8

Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without a spacing in between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name is used to specify a double channel.
17 TO 27 TA D C300X90X10 45 TO 76 TA D C250X90X11 SP 2.0

In the above commands, members 17 to 27 are a back-to-back double channel C300X90X10 with no spacing in between. Members 45 to 76 are a double channel C250X90X11 with a spacing of 2 length units.

Angles
Two types of specification may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle specification is as follows.

The letter L (signifying that the section is an angle) is followed by the length of the legs and then the thickness of the leg, all in millimetres. The word ST signifies that the section is a STandard angle meaning that the major principal axis coincides with the local YY axis specified in Chapter 1 of Section 1.5.2 of the User's Manual.

616 STAAD.Pro

1 4 TA ST L150X90X9

If the minor principal axis coincides with the local YY axis specified in Chapter 2 of the User's Manual, the word RA (Reverse Angle) should be used instead of ST as shown below.
7 TO 23 TA RA L90X75X9

Double angles
Short leg back-to-back and long leg back-to-back double angles may be specified by using the words SD or LD in front of the angle size. In the case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. The spacing between the angles may be specified by using the word SP after the angle size followed by the value of the spacing.
8 TO 25 TA SD L100X65X7 SP 2.0 36 TO 45 TA LD L300X90X11 SP 3.0

The first example indicates a short legs back-to-back double angle comprised of 100X65X7 angles separated by 2 length units. The latter is a long legs back-to-back double angle comprised of 300X90X11 angles separated by 3 length units.

Tubes
Tube names are input by their dimensions. For example,
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5

is a tube that has a height of 8 length units, width of 6 length units and a wall thickness of 0.5 length units. Only code checking, no member selection can be performed on TUBE sections.

Pipes (Circular Hollow sections)


Circular hollow sections may be provided by specifying the word PIPE followed by the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0

International Design Codes Manual 617

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

specifies a pipe with outside diameter of 25 length units and an inside diameter of 20 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, can be performed on PIPE sections. Sample Input file containing Japanese shapes
STAAD SPACE UNIT KIP FEET JOINT COORD 1 0 0 0 12 11 0 0 MEMB INCIDENCE 1 1 2 11 UNIT INCH MEMBER PROPERTY JAPANESE * H-SHAPE 1 TA ST H200X100X4 * I SHAPE 2 TA ST I250X125X10 * T SHAPE 3 TA ST T200X19 * CHANNEL 4 TA ST C125X65X6 * DOUBLE CHANNEL 5 TA D C200X90X8 * REGULAR ANGLE 6 TA ST L100X75X7 * REVERSE ANGLE 7 TA RA L90X75X9 * DOUBLE ANGLE - LONG LEG BACK TO BACK 8 TA LD L125X75X7 SP 2.0 * DOUBLE ANGLE - SHORT LEG BACK TO BACK 9 TA SD L300X90X11 SP 1.5

618 STAAD.Pro

* TUBE 10 TA ST TUBE DT 3.0 WT 2.5 TH 0.25 * PIPE 11 TA ST PIPE OD 3.0 ID 2.5 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH

10B.5(A) Member Capacities


Member design and code checking per AIJ 2002 are based upon the allowable stress design method. It is a method for proportioning structural members using design loads and forces, allowable stresses, and design limitations for the appropriate material under service conditions. The basic measure of member capacities are the allowable stresses on the member under various conditions of applied loading such as allowable tensile stress, allowable compressive stress etc. These depend on several factors such as cross sectional properties, slenderness factors, unsupported width to thickness ratios and so on. Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating such capacities.

Design Capabilities
All types of available shapes like H-Shape, I-Shape, L-Shapes, CHANNEL, PIPE, TUBE, Prismatic section etc. can be used as member property and STAAD will automatically adopt the design procedure for that particular shape if Steel Design is requested. STEEL TABLE available within STAAD or UPTABLE facility can be used for member property.

Methodology
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as required by AIJ specifications. The design procedure consist of following three steps. 1. Calculation of sectional properties The program extract sectional properties like sectional area ( A ), Moment of Inertia about Y axis and Z axis ( Iyy, Izz) from in-built Japanese Steel Table

International Design Codes Manual 619

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

and calculates Zz, Zy, iy, iz using appropriate formula. For calculation of i ( radius of gyration needed for bending ), program calculates moment of inertia ( Ii )and sectional area ( Ai ) for 1/6th section and then uses following formula: i = (I /A )
i i

Note: The above mentioned procedure for calculation of i is applicable for I shape, H shape and Channel sections. 2. Calculation of actual and allowable stresses Allowable stresses for structural steel under permanent loading shall be determined on the basis of the values of F given in the following table. Table 10B.1 - Table: Values of F (N/mm2) Steel for Construction Structures Thickness SN400 SNR400 SN490 SNR490 Steel for General Structures Steel for Welded

SN490 SNR490 STKN490

SS400 STK400 STKR400

SS490 SS540 SM400 SMA400

SM

STKN400 STKN490

SSC400 t 40 40< t 100 235 215 325 295 235 215 275 255 375 235 215 325 295

Note: In checking members for temporary loading be the combination of stresses described in Chap.3, allowable stresses specified in this chapter may be increases by 50% Program calculates actual and allowable stresses by following methods:

620 STAAD.Pro

i. Axial Stress: Actual tensile stresses ( F ) = Force / ( A x NSF ),


T

NSF = Net Section Factor for tension Actual compressive stress ( F ) = Force / A
C

Allowable tensile stress ( f )


t

= F / 1.5 (For Permanent Case) = F ( For Temporary Case ) Allowable compressive stress (f ) = {1 - 0.4x(/2)} x F/v when
c

= 2.77 x F/ (/2) when > = f x 1.5 (for Temporary case)


c

where: = (2E/(.6 x F)) =F v = 3/2 + 2/3x(/2) ii. Bending Stress: Actual bending stress for My for compression (F
bcy

)=M /Z
y

cy

Actual bending stress for Mz for compression (F


bcz

)=M /Z
z

cz

Actual bending stress for My for tension (F


bty

)=M /Z
y

ty

Actual bending stress for Mz for tension (F Where:


btz

)=M /Z
z

tz

International Design Codes Manual 621

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

cy ty

,Z

cz

are section modulus for compression

Z , Z are section modulus for tension


tz

Allowable bending stress for M (f


bcy

)=f

Allowable bending stress for Mz (f


bcz

) = { 1 - .4 x (lb / i)2 / (C 2)} ft max


f

= 900/ (lb x h / A ) For Temporary case, f Where: C = 1.75 - 1.05 (M2 / M1) +0.3 (M2 / M1)2 Allowable bending stress for M , f
y z bty bcz

= 1.5 x (f

bcz

for Permanent case)

=f =f

Allowable bending stress for M , f

btz

bcz

Note: The parameter CB can be used to specify a value for C directly. iii. Shear Stress Actual shear stresses are calculated by the following formula: q =Q /A
y y ww

Where: A = web shear area = product of depth and web ww thickness q =Q /A


z z ff

Where: A = flange shear area = 2/3 times total flange area


ff

Allowable shear stress, f = F / 1.5, F = F / (3)


s s s

3. Checking design requirements:

622 STAAD.Pro

User provided RATIO value (default 1.0) is used for checking design requirements The following conditions are checked to meet the AIJ specifications. For all the conditions calculated value should not be more than the value of RATIO. If for any condition value exceeds RATIO , program gives the message that the section fails. 1. Checking design requirements: User provided RATIO value (default 1.0) is used for checking design requirements The following conditions are checked to meet the AIJ specifications. For all the conditions calculated value should not be more than the value of RATIO. If for any condition value exceeds RATIO, program gives the message that the section fails. Conditions: i. Axial tensile stress ratio = F / f
T t C c

ii. Axial compressive stress ratio = F / f

iii. Combined compression & bending ratio = F / C f +F /f +F /f


c bcz bcz bcy bcy

iv. Combined compression & bending ratio = (F v. Combined tension & bending ratio = (F +F
T

btz

+F

bty

-F ) / f
C t

btz

+F

bty

)/f /f

vi. Combined tension & bending ratio = F vii. Shear stress ratio for q = q / f
y z y z s s

bcz bcz

/f

+F

bcy bcy

- F /f

T t

viii. Shear stress ratio for q = q / f

ix. von Mises stress ratio (if the von Mises stresses were set to be checked)= f /(k f )
m t

Output Format ( TRACK 3 )


One new output format has been introduced which provides details step by step information of Steel Design for guiding load case only. If Section command is used before Parameter command this output will provide details information for all the sections specified by Section Command.

International Design Codes Manual 623

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

Note: This output format is available only when the BEAMparameter value is 0 and the TRACK parameter value is 3. If section command is not used design information will be printed for two ends only. If Member Truss option is used no Shear Design information will be printed. Example:
SECTION 0.0 0.25 0.5 0.75 1.0 ALL PARAMETER CODE JAPANESE 2002 BEAM 0.0 ALL TMP 0.0 MEMB 1 TO 4 TMP 1.0 MEMB 5 TO 8 TRACK 3 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Allowable stress for Axial Tension


Allowable axial stress in tension is calculated per section 5.1 (1) of the AIJ code. In members with axial tension, the tensile load must not exceed the tension capacity of the member. The tension capacity of the member is calculated on the basis of the member area. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a given member based on a user supplied net section factor (NSF-a default value of 1.0 is present but may be altered by changing the input value, see Table 8B.1) and proceeds with member selection or code checking.

Allowable stress for Axial Compression


The allowable stress for members in compression is determined according to the procedure of section 5.1 (3). Compressive resistance is a function of the slenderness of the cross-section (Kl/r ratio) and the user may control the slenderness value by modifying parameters such as KY, LY, KZ and LZ. In the absence of user provided values for effective length, the actual member length will be used. The slenderness ratios are checked against the permissible values specified in Chapter 11 of the AIJ code.

624 STAAD.Pro

Allowable stress for Bending


The permissible bending compressive and tensile stresses are dependent on such factors as length of outstanding legs, thickness of flanges, unsupported length of the compression flange (UNL, defaults to member length) etc. The allowable stresses in bending (compressive and tensile) are calculated as per the criteria of Clause 5.1 (4) of the code.

Allowable stress for Shear


Shear capacities are a function of web depth, web thickness etc. The allowable stresses in shear are computed according to Clause 5.1 (2) of the code.

10B.6(A) Combined Loading


For members experiencing combined loading (axial force, bending and shear), applicable interaction formulas are checked at different locations of the member for all modeled loading situations. Members subjected to axial tension and bending are checked using the criteria of clause 6.2. For members with axial compression and bending, the criteria of clause 6.1 is used.

10B.7(A) Design Parameters


The user is allowed complete control over the design process through the use of parameters mentioned in Table 9B.1 of this chapter. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements of the situation, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 10B.2 - Japanese Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as JAPANESE

International Design Codes Manual 625

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Parameter Name Default Value Description

2002 to invoke the AIJ 2002. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 0.0 Locations of design: 0. Design only for end moments or those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1. Calculate moments at twelfth points along the beam, and use the maximum Mz location for design. CB 0 C value from the AIJ code. See "10B.5(A) Member Capacities" on page 619 Bending Stress for how C is calculated and applied. Use 0.0 to direct the program to calculated Cb. Any other value be used in lieu of the program calculated value. DFF None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member "Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection

DJ1

Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a)

DJ2

End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a)

626 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name DMAX DMIN KY KZ LY LZ FYLD MAIN

Default Value 100 cm 0.0 cm 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 235 MPA 0.0

Description

Maximum allowable depth for member. Minimum allowable depth for member. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Same as above except in z-axis Yield strength of steel in Megapascal. Check for slenderness: 0. Perform check for slenderness 1. Suppress slenderness check

MISES

Option to include check for von Mises stresses 0. Do not include check. 1. Perform Von Mises stress check.

NSF RATIO SSY

1.0 1.0 0.0

Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Sidesway: 0. Sidesway in local y-axis.

International Design Codes Manual 627

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Parameter Name Default Value Description

1. No sidesway SSZ TMAIN 0.0 400 Same as above except in local zaxis. Allowable Slenderness Limit for Tension Member 1.0 = suppress slenderness check . Any value greater than 1 = Allowable KL/r in tension. TMP 0 Loading condition: 0. Permanent Loading 1. Temporary Loading TRACK 0.0 Level of output detail: 0. = Suppress critical member stresses 1. = Print all critical member stresses 2. = Print expanded output 3. = Print maximum details. Note: Only produces results when BEAM0 is used. 4. = Perform and print deflection check. UNL UNF Member Length 1.0 Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress. Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length.

628 STAAD.Pro

Notes
a. "Deflection Length" is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the "Deflection Length" will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the "Deflection Length" may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.

D = Maximum local deflection for members 1, 2, and 3.


PARAMETERS DFF 300. ALL DJ1 1 ALL DJ2 4 ALL

b. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. c. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design.

10B.8 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to check whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate to carry the forces transmitted to it by the loads on the structure. The adequacy is checked per the AIJ requirements. Code checking is done using forces and moments at specified sections of the members. If the BEAM parameter for a member is set to 1, moments are calculated

International Design Codes Manual 629

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

at every twelfth point along the beam, and the maximum moment about the major axis is used. When no sections are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero (default), design will be based on the forces at the start and end joints of the member. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

10B.9 Member Selection


The member selection process basically involves determination of the least weight member that PASSes the code checking procedure based on the forces and moments obtained from the most recent analysis. The section selected will be of the same type as that specified initially. For example, a member specified initially as a channel will have a channel selected for it. Selection of members whose properties are originally provided from a user table will be limited to sections in the user table. Note: Member selection cannot be performed on TUBES, PIPES, or members listed as PRISMATIC. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. Sample Input data for Steel Design
UNIT METER PARAMETER CODE JAPANESE 2002 NSF 0.85 ALL UNL 10.0 MEMBER 7 KY 1.2 MEMBER 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL

630 STAAD.Pro

CHECK CODE ALL SELECT ALL

10B.10(A) Von Mises Stresses Check


Note: This feature requires STAAD.Pro V8i (SELECTseries 2) build 2007.07 or higher. The von Mises stress equation shown below, which is modified for beam elements based on the corresponding equation in AIJ steel design code (both 2002 and 2005 editions of AIJ), indicates that the left-hand side in the equation should be less than unity. These checks are performed at locations indicated by the BEAMparameter. The default is set that this check is not performed. The MISESparameter must be set to 1 to initiate the checks. Note: As with other design checks, the unity check value can be modified by use of the RATIO parameter. The von Mises stresses are evaluated and checked as follows:

Where: Longitudinal stress in beam element:

F = Axial force
x

M = Bending moment about y-axis


y z

M = Bending moment about z-axis A = Cross-sectional area,


x

Z = Section modulus about y-axis


y z

Z = Section modulus about z-axis

International Design Codes Manual 631

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

M = Torsional moment
x

F = shear stress in y direction


y z

F = shear stress in z direction Z = Torsional section modulus = 2I /D


x x x

D = Depth of the member


x

I = Torsional constant
x

A = Effective shear area in the y direction


y z

A = Effective shear area in the z direction f = Allowable tensile stress


t

k = Loading duration factor, as specified by the TMPparameter (1.0 for permanent and 1.5 for temporary). In the STRESSES output category, stress value of (numerator of the von Mises stress equation) is output as the value of fm. Along with slenderness ratios, stresses, and deflections, von Mises stress equation is checked. When its left-hand side yields the maximum ratio value, it is printed as RATIO and VON MISES is printed as CRITICAL COND.

Japanese Codes - Steel Design Per 2005 AIJ


10B.1(B) General
This section presents some general statements regarding the implementation of the Architectural Institute of Japan (AIJ) specifications for structural steel design (2005 edition) in STAAD. The design philosophy and procedural logistics are based on the principles of elastic analysis and allowable stress design. Facilities are available for member selection as well as code checking. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing and failure by stability considerations. The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach.

632 STAAD.Pro

Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceedance of the allowable stresses or capacities and the most economical section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program also checks the slenderness requirements and the stability criteria. Users are recommended to adopt the following steps in performing the steel design:
l

Specify the geometry and loads and perform the analysis. Specify the design parameter values if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection.

The method for calculating allowable bending stress was updated for the AIJ 2005 from the AIJ 2002 code. All other allowable limit states, analysis and design methods, etc., remain unchanged. Refer to the AIJ 2002 documentation for additional details.

10B.2(B) Member Capacities


Member design and code checking per AIJ 2005 are based upon the allowable stress design method. It is a method for proportioning structural members using design loads and forces, allowable stresses, and design limitations for the appropriate material under service conditions. The basic measure of member capacities are the allowable stresses on the member under various conditions of applied loading such as allowable tensile stress, allowable compressive stress etc. These depend on several factors such as cross sectional properties, slenderness factors, unsupported width to thickness ratios and so on. Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating such capacities.

Design Capabilities
All types of available shapes like H-Shape, I-Shape, L-Shapes, CHANNEL, PIPE, TUBE, Prismatic section etc. can be used as member property and STAAD will automatically adopt the design procedure for that particular shape if Steel Design is requested. STEEL TABLE available within STAAD or UPTABLE facility can be used for member property.

Methodology
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as required by AIJ specifications. The design procedure consist of following three

International Design Codes Manual 633

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

steps. 1. Calculation of sectional properties The program extract sectional properties like sectional area ( A ), Moment of Inertia about Y axis and Z axis ( I , I ) from in-built Japanese Steel Table yy zz and calculates Z , Z , i , i using appropriate formula. For calculation of i ( z y y z radius of gyration needed for bending ), program calculates moment of inertia ( I )and sectional area ( A ) for 1/6th section and then uses following i i formula: i = (I /A )
i i

Note: The above mentioned procedure for calculation of i is applicable for I shape, H shape and Channel sections. 2. Calculation of actual and allowable stresses Program calculates actual and allowable stresses by following methods: i. Axial Stress: Actual tensile stresses ( F ) = Force / ( A x NSF ),
T

NSF = Net Section Factor for tension Actual compressive stress ( F ) = Force / A
C

Allowable tensile stress ( f )


t

= F / 1.5 (For Permanent Case) = F ( For Temporary Case ) Allowable compressive stress (f ) = {1 - .4x(/2)} x F/v when
c

= 2.77 x F/ ( = f x 1.5 (for Temporary case)


c

Where: = (2E/(.6 x F)) =F

634 STAAD.Pro

v = 3/2 + 2/3x(/2) ii. Bending Stress: Actual bending stress for My for compression: (F
bcy

)=M /Z
y

cy

Actual bending stress for Mz for compression (F


bcz

)=M /Z
z

cz

Actual bending stress for My for tension (F


bty

)=M /Z
y

ty

Actual bending stress for Mz for tension (F Where: Z


cy ty btz

)=M /Z
z

tz

,Z

cz

are section modulus for compression

Z , Z are section modulus for tension


tz

Allowable bending stress for M (f


bcy

)=f

t z

Allowable bending stress for M When , f = F/


b p b b b

When < ,
p b e b

When < ,
e b b

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 635

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

For Temporary case, f Where:

bcz

= 1.5 x (f

bcz

for Permanent case)

C = 1.75 - 1.05 (M2 / M1) +0.3 (M2 / M1)2 Allowable bending stress for M , f
y z bty

=f =f

Allowable bending stress for M , f

btz

bcz

Note: The parameter CB can be used to specify a value for C directly. iii. Shear Stress Actual shear stresses are calculated by the following formula: q =Q /A
y y ww

Where: A = web shear area = product of depth and web ww thickness q =Q /A


z z ff

Where: A = flange shear area = 2/3 times total flange area


ff

Allowable shear stress, f = F / 1.5, F = F / (3)


s s s

3. Checking design requirements: User provided RATIO value (default 1.0) is used for checking design requirements: The following conditions are checked to meet the AIJ specifications. For all the conditions calculated value should not be more than the value of RATIO. If for any condition value exceeds RATIO, program gives the message that the section fails. Conditions:

636 STAAD.Pro

i. Axial tensile stress ratio = F / f


T

t C c C c bcz bcz C t

ii. Axial compressive stress ratio = F / f

iii. Combined compression & bending ratio = F / f +F iv. Combined compression & bending ratio = (F v. Combined tension & bending ratio = (F +F
T btz

/f

+F
t

bcy bcy

/f

+F

bty

-F ) / f

btz

+F

bty

)/f /f

vi. Combined tension & bending ratio = F vii. Shear stress ratio for q = q / f
y z y z s s

bcz bcz

/f

+F

bcy bcy

- F /f

T t

viii. Shear stress ratio for q = q / f

ix. von Mises stress ratio (if the von Mises stresses were set to be checked)= f /(k f )
m t

Note: All other member capacities (axial tension, axial compression, and shear) are calculated as for AIJ 2002. See "10B.5(A) Member Capacities" on page 619

10B.3(B) Design Parameters


You are allowed complete control over the design process through the use of parameters mentioned in Table 10B.3 of this chapter. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements of the situation, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 637

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Table 10B.3 - Japanese Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as JAPANESE 2005 to invoke the AIJ 2005. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

0.0

0.0 = design only for end moments or those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate moments at twelfth points along the beam, and use the maximum Mz location for design.

CB

C value from the AIJ code. See "10B.5(A) Member Capacities" on page 619 Bending Stress for how C is calculated and applied. Use 0.0 to direct the program to calculated Cb. Any other value be used in lieu of the program calculated value.

DFF

None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member

"Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection

DJ1

Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a)

638 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name DJ2

Default Value

Description

End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a) 100 cm 0.0 cm 235 MPA 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 0.0 Maximum allowable depth for member. Minimum allowable depth for member. Yield strength of steel in Megapascal. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Same as above except in z-axis 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check

DMAX DMIN FYLD KY KZ LY LZ MAIN

MISES

Option to include check for von Mises stresses 0 = Do not include check. 1 = Perform Von Mises stress check.

NSF RATIO SSY

1.0 1.0 0.0

Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis.

International Design Codes Manual 639

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Parameter Name Default Value Description

1.0 = No sidesway SSZ TMAIN 0.0 400 Same as above except in local zaxis. Allowable Slenderness Limit for Tension Member 1.0 = suppress slenderness check . Any value greater than 1 = Allowable KL/r in tension. TMP 0 0 = Permanent Loading 1 = Temporary Loading TRACK 0.0 Level of output detail: 0. = Suppress critical member stresses 1. = Print all critical member stresses 2. = Print expanded output 3. = Print maximum details. Note: Only produces results when BEAM0 is used. 4. = Perform and print deflection check. UNF UNL 1.0 Member Length Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length. Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress.

640 STAAD.Pro

Notes
a. "Deflection Length" is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the "Deflection Length" will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the "Deflection Length" may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.

D = Maximum local deflection for members 1, 2, and 3.


PARAMETERS DFF 300. ALL DJ1 1 ALL DJ2 4 ALL

b. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. c. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design.

10B.4(B) Von Mises Stresses Check


Note: This feature requires STAAD.Pro V8i (SELECTseries 2) build 2007.07 or higher. The von Mises stress equation shown below, which is modified for beam elements based on the corresponding equation in AIJ steel design code (both 2002 and 2005

International Design Codes Manual 641

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

editions of AIJ), indicates that the left-hand side in the equation should be less than unity. These checks are performed at locations indicated by the BEAMparameter. The default is set that this check is not performed. The MISESparameter must be set to 1 to initiate the checks. Note: As with other design checks, the unity check value can be modified by use of the RATIO parameter. The von Mises stresses are evaluated and checked as follows:

Where: Longitudinal stress in beam element:

F = Axial force
x

M = Bending moment about y-axis


y z

M = Bending moment about z-axis A = Cross-sectional area,


x

Z = Section modulus about y-axis


y z

Z = Section modulus about z-axis

M = Torsional moment
x

F = shear stress in y direction


y z

F = shear stress in z direction Z = Torsional section modulus = 2I /D


x x x

D = Depth of the member


x

I = Torsional constant
x

642 STAAD.Pro

A = Effective shear area in the y direction


y z

A = Effective shear area in the z direction f = Allowable tensile stress


t

k = Loading duration factor, as specified by the TMPparameter (1.0 for permanent and 1.5 for temporary). In the STRESSES output category, stress value of (numerator of the von Mises stress equation) is output as the value of fm. Along with slenderness ratios, stresses, and deflections, von Mises stress equation is checked. When its left-hand side yields the maximum ratio value, it is printed as RATIO and VON MISES is printed as CRITICAL COND.

10B.5(B) Verification Problems


In the next few pages are included verification examples for reference purposes.

Verification Problem No. 1


Title
A slender, cantilever beam subjected to a load at the end

Type
Static analysis, 3D beam element.

Reference

Problem
A cantilever beam of length 2 meter is subjected to a permanent joint load of 3 kN in the Y direction and 2 kN in the Z direction as well as a 0.008 kNm torque applied at the end. Axial tension of 10 kN is also applied to the member. An H100x50x5 section is used from the Japanese steel tables.

International Design Codes Manual 643

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

Given
Section properties D = 100 mm
x

I = 15,000 mm4
x

A = 1185 mm2, A = 500 mm2, A = 467 mm2


x y z

Z = 2I /D = 215000/100 = 300 mm3, Z = 5920 mm3, Z = 37400 x x x y z mm3 The maximum of the left hand side of the von Mises stress equation apparently occurs at the fixed end of the beam. Section forces at the fixed end are ass follow: 10.0 kN (Tension) 6.0 kNm (Bending-Y) 6.0 kNm (Bending-Z) 3.0 kN (Shear-Y) 2.0 kN (Shear-Z) -0.008 kNm (Torsion Member Length L = 2 m, Unbraced length = 100mm. Material FYLD = 300 MPa E = 2.05E+05 MPa G = E/2.6 MPa

Solution
From these section forces, and at the section of the fixed end are calculated x xy as follows:

= 8.44 + 101.35 + 24.06 = 133.85 N/mm2

644 STAAD.Pro

= 26.67 + (62 + 4.282) = 33.04 N/mm2 From and , f is calculated:


x xy m 2+3 2) x xy

=(

= [(133.85)2+3(33.04)2] = 146.26 N/mm2

Since f = FYLD/1.5 = 300.0 MPa/15 = 200.0 N/mm2 and k = 1 for permanent t loading, Ratio = 146.26/(200.0 1) = 0.731 < 1, So OK.

Comparison
Table 10B.4 - Comparison of results for a AIJ 2005 verification problem Hand Calculation von Mises Stress (f )
m

STAAD.Pro Result 146.3 N/mm2

Comments

146.26 N/mm2

None

STAAD Input File


STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION EXAMPLE NO.1 START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-AUG-10 END JOB INFORMATION * VERIFICATION FOR VON MISES STRESSES IN AIJ 2005 UNIT MMS KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 300 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 UNIT METER KN

International Design Codes Manual 645

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ

DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY JAPANESE 1 TABLE ST H100X50X5 UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LC1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX 10 FY 3 FZ 2 MX 0.008 PERFORM ANALYSIS LOAD LIST 1 PRINT MEMBER FORCES LIST 1 PARAMETER 1 CODE JAPANESE 2005 TMP 0 ALL UNL 0.002 ALL MISES 1 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

646 STAAD.Pro

FINISH

Output
The TRACK 2.0 output portion is as follows:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( AIJ 2005) ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 1 * | JAPANESE SECTIONS | | AX = 11.85 | | * | ST H100X50X5 | | --Z AY = 5.00 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 4.67 | | AIJ-2005 * =============================== ===|=== ZY = 5.92 | | * ZZ = 37.40 | | * |<---LENGTH (ME= 0.30 --->| iY = 1.12 | |************* iZ = 3.97 | | ZX = 0.30 | | 0.90(KN-MET) | |PARAMETER |L1 STRESSES | |IN N MM | L1 L1 IN N MM| |--------------- + L1 L1 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 26.8 | L1 FA = 189.5 | | KL/R-Z= 7.6 + L1 fa = 8.4 | | UNL = 2.5 | L1 L1 FCZ = 200.0 | | CB = 1.75 + FTZ = 200.0 | | CMY = 0.85 | L1 L1 FCY = 200.0 | | CMZ = 0.85 + L1 L1 FTY = 200.0 | | FYLD = 300.0 | L0 fbz = 24.1 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 101.4 | | DFF = 0.0 -0.05 FV = 115.5 | | dff = 0.0 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE fv = 6.0 | | (WITH LOAD NO.) FT = 200.0 | | fm = 146.3 | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KN-MET) Sx = 133.9 | | ------------------------Tou = 34.0 | | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | | | VALUE -10.00 3.00 2.00 0.60 0.90 | | LOCATION 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 | | LOADING 1 1 1 1 1 | | | |**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY (KN-MET) *| |* -------------*| |* *|

International Design Codes Manual 647

Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ


|* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS VON MISES 0.731 1 | | 10.00 T 0.60 -0.90 0.000 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

648 STAAD.Pro

Section 11

Mexican Codes

International Design Codes Manual 649

650 STAAD.Pro

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987


11A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capabilities for performing concrete design. It will calculate the reinforcement needed for the specified concrete section. All the concrete design calculations are based on the current: Complementary Technical Standards for the Design and Construction of Concrete Structures Nov. 1987. (Normas Tcnicas Complementarias para Diseo y construccin de Estructuras de Concreto) of the Mexican Construction Code for the Federal District Aug. 1993 (Reglamento de Construcciones para el Distrito Federal).

11A.2 Section Types for Concrete Design


The following types of cross sections can be defined for concrete design.
l

Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular) Beams Prismatic (Rectangular & Square), Trapezoidal, and T-shapes Walls Finite element with a specified thickness
Figure 11.1 - Concrete shape nomenclature for beams and columns

11A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members which will be designed by the program must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTY command. The following example shows the required input:
UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTY

International Design Codes Manual 651

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987

13 TO 79 PRISM YD 40. ZD 20. IZ 53333 IY 13333 11 13 PR YD 20. 14 TO 16 PRIS YD 24. ZD 48. YB 18. ZB 12. 17 TO 19 PR YD 24. ZD 18. ZB 12.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (40 cm depth and 20 cm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 20 cm diameter. Note that no area (AX) is provided for these members. For concrete design, this property must not be provided. If shear areas and moments of inertias are not provided, the program calculates these values from YD and ZD. Notice that in the above example the IZ and IY values provided are actually 50% of the values calculated using YD and ZD. This is a conventional practice which takes into consideration revised section parameters due to cracking of section. Note that the third and the fourth set of members in the above example represent a T-shape and a TRAPEZOIDAL shape respectively. Depending on the properties (YD, ZD, YB, ZB, etc.) provided, the program will determine whether the section is rectangular, trapezoidal or T-shaped and the BEAM design will be done accordingly.

11A.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform design by the Mexican code. Default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design requirements. These values may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 3.1 is a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. The manual describes the commands required to provide these parameters in the input file. For example, the values of SFACE and EFACE (parameters that are used in shear design), the distances of the face of supports from the end nodes of a beam, are assigned values of zero by default but may be changed depending on the actual situation. Similarly, beams and columns are designed for moments directly obtained from the analyses without any magnification. The factors MMY and MMZ may be used for magnification of column moments. For beams, the user may generate load cases which contain loads magnified by the appropriate load factors.

652 STAAD.Pro

Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 11A.1 - Mexican Concrete Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Parameters

Must be specified as MEXICAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BTP

Bar type to use: 0. IMPERIAL (No 3 to 18) 1. METRIC (4.2 to 60mm) 2. MEXICAN (No 2 to 18)

CCL

Concrete class according to 1.4.1d) to define Modulus of Elasticity 1. Class 1 Concrete 2. Class 2 Concrete

CFB

FALSE

Cold formed Barclassification to define development multipliers according to table 3.1 NTC
l

FALSE - Not cold formed bar TRUE - Cold formed bar

CLB CLS CLT DAG

3 cm 3 cm 3 cm 2 cm

Clear cover for bottom reinforcement Clear cover for side reinforcement Clear cover for top reinforcement Maximum diameter of aggregate, in current units.

International Design Codes Manual 653

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987 Parameter Name DCP Default Value TRUE Parameters

Beam Loads and reactions in direct compressionCl-2.1.5.a.I 2nd paragraph


l

FALSE - Loads applied indirectly TRUE - Direct compression

DEPTH

YD

Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
l

DIM

TRUE

FALSE: Not precautions taken - Section reduction to section 1.5 NTC Concrete TRUE: Precautions are taken to assure dimensions

DSD

TRUE

Ductile frames in accordance with Section 5 of the code. Some design conditions are considered (not including, for the time being, geometric or confinement ones)
l

FALSE - Non-Ductile frames TRUE - Ductile Frames

EFACE

Face to support location of end of beam. If specified, for shear force at start is computed at a distance of EFACE+d from the start joint of the member. Positive number.

654 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name EXP

Default Value FALSE

Parameters

Exposition to soil or weather to define cover and min Steel reinforcement


l

FALSE - Not exposed to soil or weather TRUE - Exposed to soil or weather

FC FYMAIN FYSEC LSS

200 Kg/cm2 Compressive Strength of Concrete 4,200 Kg/cm2 4,200 Kg/cm2 0 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel Yield Stress for secondary (stirrup) reinforcing steel Part of the longitudinal steel considered to reduce shear. 0 (zero) is conservative. Value between 1 and 0. Light Concrete to define development multipliers according to table 3.1 NTC
l

LTC

FALSE

FALSE - Regular concrete TRUE - Lightweight concrete

MAXMAIN MINMAIN MINSEC MMY

12 2.5 2.5 1.0

Maximum main reinforcement bar size (Number 2 -18) Minimum main reinforcement bar size (Number 2 -18) Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size(Number 2 -18) Moment magnification factor for columns, about My.

International Design Codes Manual 655

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987 Parameter Name MMZ MOE NSECTION Default Value 1.0 198,000 Kg/cm2 12 Parameters

Moment magnification factor for columns, about Mz. Concrete modulus of elasticiy. Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moments for beam design Stirrups angle with the axis of the element Slab beared perimeter. To calculate min steel required according to 2.1.2 Tied Column. A value of 1 will mean spiral. Face to support location of start of beam. If specified, for shear force at start is computed at a distance of SFACE+d from the start joint of the member. Positive number Beam needed for torsional equilibrium Cl.2.1.6a) 2nd paragraph
l

PHI PSS

90 degrees TRUE

REINF SFACE

0 0

TEQ

FALSE

FALSE - No TRUE - Yes

656 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name TRACK

Default Value 0

Parameters

Beam Design 0. Critical Moment will not be printed out with beam design report. 1. Will mean a print out. 2. Will print out required steel areas for all intermediate sections specified by NSECTION. Column Design 0. Will print out detailed design results. 1. Will mean a print out column interation analysis results in addition to TRACK 0 output. 2. will print out a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values in addition to all of the above.

WIDTH

ZD

Width of concrete member, in current units. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES

* These values must be provided in the current unit system being used. Note: When using metric bars for design, provide values for these parameters in actual mm units instead of the barnumber. The following metric bar sizes are available: 4.2mm, 6 mm, 8 mm, 10 mm, 12 mm, 16 mm, 20 mm, 25 mm, 32 mm, 40 mm, 50 mm and 60 mm.

International Design Codes Manual 657

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987

11A.5 Beam Design


Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. For all these forces, all active beam loadings are prescanned to locate the possible critical sections. The total number of sections considered is 12 (twelve) unless this number is redefined with an NSECTION parameter. All of these equally spaced sections are scanned to determine moment and shear envelopes.

Design for Flexure


Reinforcement for positive and negative moments are calculated on the basis of the section properties provided by the user. If the section dimensions are inadequate to carry the applied load, that is if the required reinforcement is greater than the maximum allowable for the cross section, the program reports that beam fails in maximum reinforcement. Rectangular sections are also designed with compression reinforcement. Effective depth is chosen as Total depth - (Clear cover + diameter of stirrup + half the dia. of main reinforcement), and a trial value is obtained by adopting proper bar sizes for the stirrups and main reinforcements. The relevant clauses in Sections 1.5, 1.6, 2.1.1-2-5, 3.10 and 5.2.2 of NTC Concrete are utilized to obtain the actual amount of steel required as well as the maximum allowable and minimum required steel. These values are reported as ROW, ROWMX and ROWMN in the output and can be printed using the parameter TRACK 1.0 (see Table 11A.1). In addition, the maximum, minimum and actual bar spacing are also printed. It is important to note that beams are designed for flexural moment MZ only. The moment MY is not considered in the flexural design.

Design for Shear


Shear reinforcement is calculated to resist both shear forces and torsional moments. Shear forces are calculated at a distance (d+SFACE) and (d+EFACE) away from the end nodes of the beam. SFACE and EFACE have default values of zero unless provided under parameters (see Table 11A.1). Note that the value of the effective depth "d" used for this purpose is the update value and accounts for the actual c.g. of the main reinforcement calculated under flexural design. Clauses 2.1.5-6 and 5.2.4 of NTC Concrete are used to calculate the reinforcement for shear forces and torsional moments. Based on the total stirrup reinforcement required, the size of bars, the spacing, the number of bars and the distance over

658 STAAD.Pro

which they are provided are calculated. Stirrups due to geometric conditions are assumed to be 2-legged, due to design conditions could be 2 or 4-legged.

Design for Anchorage


In the output for flexural design, the anchorage details are also provided. At any particular level, the START and END coordinates of the layout of the main reinforcement is described along with the information whether anchorage in the form of a hook or continuation is required or not at these START and END points. Note that the coordinates of these START and END points are obtained after taking into account the anchorage requirements. Anchorage length is calculated on the basis of the Clauses described in Section 3.1 of NTC concrete. In case the program selects 2 different diameters for the main or compression reinforcement, only the anchorage for the largest diameter is analyzed.

Output
Level Serial number of bar level which may contain one or more bar group Height Height of bar level from the bottom of the beam Bar Info Reinforcement bar information specifying number of bars and bar size From Distance from the start of the beam to the start of the reinforcement bar To Distance from the start of the beam to the end of the reinforcement bar Anchor (STA/END) States whether anchorage, either hook or continuation, is needed at the start (STA) or at the end (END). Row Actually required flexural reinforcement (As/bd) where b = width of cross section (ZD for a rectangular or square section) and d = effective depth of cross section (YD minus the distance from extreme tension fiber to the centroid of main reinforcement). ROWMN Minimum required flexural reinforcement (Amin/bd) ROWMX

International Design Codes Manual 659

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987

Maximum required flexural reinforcement (Amax/bd) Spacing Distance between centers of adjacent bars of main reinforcement Vu Factored shear force at section Vc Nominal shear strength provided by concrete Vs Nominal shear strength provided by shear reinforcement Tu Factored torsional moment at section Tc Nominal torsional moment strength provided by concrete Ts Nominal torsional moment strength provided by torsion reinforcement ACTUAL OUTPUT FROM DESIGN ===================================================================== BEAM NO. 1 DESIGN RESULTS - FLEXURE PER CODE NTC FOR THE DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION OF CONCRETE STRUCTURES,DDF LEN - 525.00(cm) FY - 4200. FC - 250. SIZE - 30.00 X 80.00(cm) LEVEL HEIGHT BAR INFO FROM TO ANCHOR (cm) (cm) (cm) STA END ____________________________________________________ _________________ 1 4. 8 - -NUM, 5 0. 39. YES NO 1 4. 1 - -NUM, 4 0. 39. 2 8. 3 - -NUM, 5 0. 39. YES NO

660 STAAD.Pro

|----------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL MOMENT=5978000.50 Kg cm AT 0.00 (cm)LOAD 1| | REQD STEEL= 24.41 (cm2)ROW=0.0109 ROWMX=0.0190 ROWMN=0.0026 | | REQD COMP STEEL= 0.00 (cm2) | | MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 24.14/ 3.18/ 3.45 (cm) | | COMP MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 0.00/ 0.00/ 0.00 (cm) | | BASIC/REQD. DEVELOPMENT LENGTH = 40.07/ 39.08(cm) | |----------------------------------------------------------------| Cracked Moment of Inertia Iz at above location = 1015658.4 cm^4 3 77. 10 - -NUM, 4 0. 45. YES NO 4 73. 9 - -NUM, 4 0. 45. YES NO |----------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL MOMENT=5978000.50 Kg cm AT 0.00 (cm)LOAD 1| | REQD STEEL= 24.17 (cm2)ROW=0.0107 ROWMX=0.0190 ROWMN=0.0026 | | REQD COMP STEEL= 0.00 (cm2) | | MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 24.46/ 2.54/ 2.72 (cm) | | COMP MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 0.00/ 0.00/ 0.00 (cm) | | BASIC/REQD. DEVELOPMENT LENGTH = 32.00/ 44.81(cm) | |----------------------------------------------------------------| Cracked Moment of Inertia Iz at above location = 1008728.7 cm^4 REQUIRED REINF. STEEL SUMMARY :

International Design Codes Manual 661

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987

------------------------------SECTION REINF STEEL(+VE/-VE) MOMENTS(+VE/-VE) LOAD(+VE/VE) ( CM ) (SQ. CM ) (KG -CM ) 0.00 24.67/ 24.67 5978000./ 5978000.50 0/ 0 525.00 24.67/ 24.67 5978000./ 5978000.50 0/ 0 B E A M N O. 1 D E S I G N R E S U L T S SHEAR AT START SUPPORT - Vu=41850.00 Kg Vc= 6074.49 Kg Vs=44719.39 Kg Tu= 0.00 Kg cm Tc= 0.00 Kg cm Ts= 0.00 Kg cm LOAD 0 NO STIRRUPS ARE REQUIRED FOR TORSION. REINFORCEMENT IS REQUIRED FOR SHEAR. PROVIDE NUM. 2.5 2-LEGGED STIRRUPS AT 7.(cm) C/C FOR 176.(cm) ADDITIONAL LONGITUDINAL STEEL REQD. FOR TORSIONAL RESISTANCE = 0.00 (cm2) AT END SUPPORT - Vu=37450.00 Kg Vc= 6074.49 Kg Vs=39219.39 Kg Tu= 0.00 Kg cm Tc= 0.00 Kg cm Ts= 0.00 Kg cm LOAD 0 NO STIRRUPS ARE REQUIRED FOR TORSION. REINFORCEMENT IS REQUIRED FOR SHEAR. PROVIDE NUM. 2.5 2-LEGGED STIRRUPS AT 8.(cm) C/C FOR 176.(cm) ADDITIONAL LONGITUDINAL STEEL REQD. FOR TORSIONAL RESISTANCE = 0.00 (cm2)

662 STAAD.Pro

11A.6 Column Design


Columns design in STAAD per the Mexican code is performed for axial force and uniaxial as well as biaxial moments. All active loadings are checked to compute reinforcement. The loading which produces the largest amount of reinforcement is called the critical load. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. For rectangular and circular sections, reinforcement is always assumed to be equally distributed on all faces. This means that the total number of bars for these sections will always be a multiple of four (4). If the MMAGx & -MMAGy parameters are specified, the column moments are multiplied by the corresponding MMAG value to arrive at the ultimate moments on the column. Minimum eccentricity conditions to be satisfied according to section 2.1.3.a are checked. Method used: Bresler Load Contour Method Known Values: Pu, Muy, Muz, B, D, Clear cover, Fc, Fy Ultimate Strain for concrete : 0.003 Steps involved: 1. Assume some reinforcement. Minimum reinforcement (1% for ductile design or according to section 4.2.2 ) is a good amount to start with. 2. Find an approximate arrangement of bars for the assumed reinforcement. 3. Calculate PNMAX = Po, where Po is the maximum axial load capacity of the section. Ensure that the actual nominal load on the column does not exceed PNMAX. If PNMAX is less than the axial force Pu/FR, (FR is the strength reduction factor) increase the reinforcement and repeat steps 2 and 3. If the reinforcement exceeds 6% (or 4% for ductile design), the column cannot be designed with its current dimensions. 4. For the assumed reinforcement, bar arrangement and axial load, find the uniaxial moment capacities of the column for the Y and the Z axes, independently. These values are referred to as MYCAP and MZCAP respectively. 5. Solve the Interaction Bresler equation: (M /M
ny ycap

) +(M /M
nz

zcap

Where = 1.24. If the column is subjected to uniaxial moment: = 1 6. If the Interaction equation is satisfied, find an arrangement with available bar

International Design Codes Manual 663

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987

sizes, find the uniaxial capacities and solve the interaction equation again. If the equation is satisfied now, the reinforcement details are written tothe output file. 7. If the interaction equation is not satisfied, the assumed reinforcement is increased (ensuring that it is under 6% or 4% respectively)and steps 2 to 6 are repeated. By the moment to check shear and torsion for columns the sections have to be checked as beams and the most strict of both shear and torsion reinforcement adopted.

11A.7 Column Interaction


The column interaction values may be obtained by using the design parameter TRACK 1.0 or TRACK 2.0 for the column member. If a value of 2.0 is used for the TRACK parameter, 12 different Pn-Mn pairs, each representing a different point on the Pn-Mn curve are printed. Each of these points represents one of the several Pn-Mn combinations that this column is capable of carrying about the given axis, for the actual reinforcement that the column has been designed for. In the case of circular columns, the values are for any of the radial axes. The values printed for the TRACK 1.0 output are:
l

P0 = Maximum allowable pure axial load on the column (moment zero). Pnmax = Maximum allowable axial load on the column. P_bal = Axial load capacity of balanced strain condition. M_bal = Uniaxial moment capacity of balanced strain condition. E_bal = M_bal / P_bal = Eccentricity of balanced strain condition. M0 = Moment capacity at zero axial load. P_tens = Maximum permissible tensile load on the column. Des. Pn = Pu/FR where FR is the Strength Reduction Factor and Pu is the axial load for the critical load case. Des.Mnx = Mux*MMAGx/FR where FR is the Strength Reduction Factor and Mu is the bending moment for the appropriate axis for the critical load case. Mu = (Mux.Mmagx)+ (Muy.Mmagy) e/h = (Mn/Pn)/h where h is the length of the column

664 STAAD.Pro

11A.8 Column Design Output


The next table illustrates different levels of the column design output. The output is generated without any TRACK specification:

================================================== COLUMN NO. 1 DESIGN PER - AXIAL + BENDING FY -4200.0 FC - 294.1 Kg/cm2 CIRC SIZE 100.0(cm)DIAMETER AREA OF STEEL REQUIRED = 128.506 BAR CONFIGURATION REINF PCT. LOAD LOCATION PHI ---------------------------------------------------------46 - NUMBER 6 1.669 1 END 0.700 (EQUALLY SPACED) TRACK=1 generates the following additional output: COLUMN INTERACTION: MOMENT ABOUT Z/Y -AXIS (Kg-cm ) -------------------------------------------------------P0 Pn max P-bal. M-bal. e-bal.(cm) 2095196.38 2095196.38 727411.12 29235398.00 40.2 M0 P-tens. Des.Pn 'Des.Mn e/h 20606994.00 -550620.00 0.00 20000000.00 NaN -------------------------------------------------------TRACK=2 generates the following output in addition to all the above: Pn Mn Pn Mn | 1934027.38 5373253.50 967013.69 27278232.00

International Design Codes Manual 665

Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987

P0 |* 1772858.50 11408365.00 805844.75 28658428.00 | * 1611689.50 16296947.00 644675.81 29473708.00 Pn,max|__* 1450520.62 20083028.00 483506.84 28901764.00 | * 1289351.62 23117562.00 322337.91 27205616.00 Pn | * 1128182.62 25462606.00 161168.95 24433192.00 NOMINAL| * AXIAL| * COMPRESSION| * Pb|-------*Mb | * ___________|____*_______ | * M0 Mn, | * BENDING P-tens|* MOMENT

11A.9 Slab Design


Slabs are designed per Mexican NTC specifications. To design a slab, it must be modeled using finite elements. Element design will be performed only for the moments MX and MY at the center of the element. Design will not be performed for FX, FY, FXY, MXY. Also, design is not performed at any other point on the surface of the element. Shear is checked with Q. A typical example of element design output is shown below. The reinforcement required to resist Mx moment is denoted as longitudinal reinforcement and the reinforcement required to resist My moment is denoted as transverse reinforcement. The parameters FYMAIN, FC, CLB, CLS, CLT, DIM, and EXP listed in Table 11A.1 are relevant to slab design. Other parameters mentioned are not used in slab design.

666 STAAD.Pro

Figure 11.2 - Element moments: Longitudinal (L) and Transverse (T)

ELEMENT DESIGN SUMMARY ---------------------ELEMENT LONG. REINF MOM-X /LOAD TRANS. REINF MOM-Y /LOAD (SQ.CM/M ) (T -M /M ) (SQ.CM/M ) (T -M /M ) 1 TOP : Longitudinal direction - Only minimum steel required. 1 BOTT: Transverse direction - Only minimum steel required. 1 TOP : 2.239 0.00 / 0 3.252 983.00 / 1 BOTT: 3.758 983.00 / 1 1.684 0.00 / 0 1 SHEAR CAPACITY 3794.73 Kg ***PASS***

International Design Codes Manual 667

668 STAAD.Pro

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code


11B.1 General
The program is based in: Complementary Technical Standards for the Design and Construction of Steel Structures Dec. 1987. (Normas Tcnicas Complementarias para Diseo y construccin de Estructuras Metlicas) of the Mexican Construction Code for the Federal District Aug. 1993 (Reglamento de Construcciones para el Distrito Federal) (hereafter referred to as NTC1987). The design philosophy considered is that of the Load Cases and Resistance Method or Limit States Design usually known as Load and Resistance Factor Design (LRFD). Structures are designed and proportioned taking into consideration the limit states at which they would become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit-state are recognized--ultimate and serviceability. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability, while that in serviceability is deflection. Appropriate load and resistance factors are used so that a uniform reliability is achieved for all steel structures under various loading conditions and at the same time the chances of limits being surpassed are acceptably remote. In the STAAD implementation of the Mexican Standards for steel structures, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength, and stability. It allows to check deformation to verify serviceability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria as augmented by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type, or other such parameters. The code checking portion of the program checks that main code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The following sections describe the salient features of the Mexican specifications as implemented in STAAD steel design. A brief description of the fundamental concepts is presented here.

International Design Codes Manual 669

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code

11B.2 Limit States Design Fundamentals


The primary objective of the Limit States Design Specification is to provide a uniform reliability for all steel structures under various loading conditions. The Limit States Design Method uses separate factors for each load and resistance. Because the different factors reflect the degree of uncertainty of different loads and combinations of loads and of the accuracy of predicted strength, a more uniform reliability is possible. The method may be summarized by the inequality Y Q R FR
i i n

On the left side of the inequality, the required strength is the summation of the various load effects, Q , multiplied by their respective load factors, Y . The design i i strength, on the right side, is the nominal strength or resistance, R , multiplied by n a resistance factor, FR. In the STAAD implementation of the Mexican Standards, it is assumed that the user will use appropriate load factors and create the load combinations necessary for analysis. The design portion of the program will take into consideration the load effects (forces and moments) obtained from analysis. In calculation of resistances of various elements (beams, columns etc.), resistance (nominal strength) and applicable resistance factor will be automatically considered.

11B.3 Member End Forces and Moments


Member end forces and moments in the member result from loads applied to the structure. These forces are in the local member coordinate system. the following figures show the member end actions with their directions. Refer to Section 1.19 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details.

11B.4 Section Classification


The Limit States Design specification allows inelastic deformation of section elements. Thus local buckling becomes an important criterion. Steel sections are classified as compact (type 2), noncompact (type 3), or slender element (type 4), sections depending upon their local buckling characteristics, besides sections type 1 are able for plastic design. This classification is a function of the geometric properties of the section. The design procedures are different depending on the

670 STAAD.Pro

section class. STAAD is capable of determining the section classification for the standard shapes and design accordingly.

11B.5 Member in Axial Tension


The criteria governing the capacity of tension members is based on two limit states. The limit state of yielding in the gross section is intended to prevent excessive elongation of the member. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net section area may be specified by the user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 11B.1), that always refers to the gross section. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a given member based on these two limit states and proceeds with member selection or code check accordingly. In addition to the tension resistance criterion, the user defines if tension members are required to satisfy slenderness limitations which are a function of the nature of use of the member (main load resisting component, bracing member, etc.). In both the member selection and code checking process, STAAD immediately does a slenderness check on appropriate members before continuing with other procedures for determining the adequacy of a given member.

11B.6 Axial Compression


The column strength equations take into account inelastic deformation and other recent research in column behavior. Two equations governing column strength are available, one for inelastic buckling and the other for elastic or Euler buckling. Both equations include the effects of residual stresses and initial out-of-straightness. Compression strength for a particular member is calculated by STAAD according to the procedure outlined in Section 3.2 of the NTC. For slender elements, the procedure described in Section 2.3.6.NTC is also used. The procedures of Section 3.2 of the Commentaries, design helps and examples of the Complementary Technical Standards for the Design and Construction of Steel Structures (de los Comentarios, ayudas de diseo y ejemplos de las Normas Tcnicas Complementarias para el Diseo y Construccin de Estructuras Metlicas, DDF (Comentarios - Julio 1993) were implemented for the determination of design strength for these limit states. Effective length for calculation of compression resistance may be provided through the use of the parameters KY, KZ and/or LY, LZ. If not provided, the entire member length will be taken into consideration.

International Design Codes Manual 671

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code

In addition to the compression resistance criterion, compression members are required to satisfy slenderness limitations which are a function of the nature of use of the member (main load resisting component, bracing member, etc.). In both the member selection and code checking process, STAAD immediately does a slenderness check on appropriate members before continuing with other procedures for determining the adequacy of a given member.

11B.7 Flexural Design Strength


In the Limit States Design Method, the flexural design strength of a member is determined mainly by the limit state of lateral torsional buckling. Inelastic bending is allowed and the basic measure of flexural capacity is the plastic moment capacity of the section. The flexural resistance is a function of plastic moment capacity, actual laterally unbraced length, limiting laterally unbraced length, buckling moment and the bending coefficient. The limiting laterally unbraced length Lu and flexural resistance Mr are functions of the section geometry and are calculated as per the procedure of Section 3.3.2 of the NTC. The purpose of bending coefficient Cb is to account for the influence of the moment gradient on lateral-torsional buckling. This coefficient can be specified by the user through the use of parameter CB or CBy (see Table 11B.1) or may be calculated by the program (according to LRDF USA specification) if CB is specified as 0.0. In the absence of the parameter CB, a default value of 1.0 will be used. To specify laterally unsupported length, either of the parameters UNL and UNF (see Table 10B.1) can be used. It is taken into account the reduction of flexural resistance due to slender web according to section 4.5.8 of the NTC For the sections where the web and flange are slender the LRDF USA specification was used. Stress areas due to bending about y axis (MY)

672 STAAD.Pro

Note: The local X axis goes into the page; the Global Y axis is vertical upwards; the shaded area indicates area under compression; the area not shaded indicates area under tension. Stress areas due to bending about Z axis (MZ)

11B.8 Design for Shear


The procedure of Sect. 3.3.3 of the NTC is used in STAAD to design for shear forces in members. Besides combined bending and shear is checked according to section 3.3.4 of the NTC, considering also the limits for stiffeners of the web according to sections 4.5.6/7 of the NTC. Shear in wide flanges and channel sections is resisted by the area of the web/s..

International Design Codes Manual 673

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code

11B.9 Combined Compression Axial Force and Bending


The interaction of flexure and axial forces in singly and doubly symmetric shapes is governed by formulas of the Section 3.4 of the NTC. These interaction formulas cover the general case of biaxial bending combined with axial force. They are also valid for uniaxial bending and axial force. It is considered that the frames are part of structures that have shear walls or rigid elements so that the lateral displacements of a floor could be disregarded. The program has included formulas to include structures with lateral displacements in the future considering for B2 the columns individually and not the complete floor analysis. It is taken into account if the elements have transverse loads and if the ends are angularly restrained.

11B.10 Combined Tension Axial Force and Bending


Based on Section 3.5 4 of the NTC.

11B.11 Design Parameters


Design per Mexican Standards is requested by using the CODE. Other applicable parameters are summarized in Table 11B.1 below. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program and thus allow the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. The parameters DMAX and DMIN may only be used for member selection only. Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

674 STAAD.Pro

Table 11B.1 - Design Parameters According to Mexican NTC Standards - Steel Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as MEXICAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

KX KY KZ LX LY

1.0 1.0 1.0 Member length Member length

K value for flexural-torsional buckling K value in local Y axis- Usually minor axis K value in local Z axis- Usually major axis Length for flexural-torsional buckling Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Z axis. Minimum Yield strength of steel Ultimate tensile strength of steel Net section factor for tension members Unsupported length (L) of the top* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the top flange.

LZ

Member length

FYLD FU NSF UNT

2530 kg/cm2 4230 Kg/cm2 1 Member length

International Design Codes Manual 675

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code Parameter Name UNB Default Value Description

Member length

Unsupported length (L) of the bottom* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the bottom flange. Spacing of stiffeners for beams for shear design Coefficient C defined per section 3.3.2.2. If Cb is set to 0.0 it will be calculated by the program according to LRFD USA (CbMex=1/CbUSA). Any other value will be directly used in the design. 0 = Suppress all design strengths 1 = Print all design strengths 2 = Print expanded design output

STIFF Cb y Cby

Member length 1

TRACK

DMAX DMIN RATIO BEAM

114 cm 0.0 cm 1.0 0

Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Permissible ratio of actual load effect and design strength 0: Design at ends and those locations specified by SECTION command. 1: Design at ends and at every y cada 1/12th point along member length

Rigid_to_ H_Loads

TRUE

Defines if the structure has elements to bear the wind load

676 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

( shear walls, wind trusses or bracing rigid elements ) that restrict lateral displacements and allow to disregard slenderness effects. IRREG 0 Variable defined for the whole structure indicating if it is regular or irregular according to section 3.4 of the NTC. IRREG=1 for columns being part of irregular structures. I_NO_OXIG 0 Defined for I shapes or tubes Curve Definition according to NTC.3.2.2.1a) I_NO_OXIG.= 0 implies n=1.4 laminated I shapes, tubes or built up with 3 or 4 welded plates obtained from wider plates cuts with oxygen. I_NO_OXIG.= 1 implies n=1 I shapes, tubes or built up with 3 or 4 welded plates n is defined by the program IMAIN_MEM 0 IMAIN_MEM=0 MAIN MEMBER IMAIN_MEM=1 Secondary and wind trusses Ccomb 1 Cfactor for combined forces when there are transverse

International Design Codes Manual 677

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

loads in the members. Section 3.4.3.3.ii NTC Ccomb=1 If members ends are restricted angularly. Ccomb=0.85 If members ends DUCTILE_ SEISMIC _ DESIGN TRUE are not restricted angularly. DUCTILE FRAMES ACCORDING TO SECTION 11. Main design conditions are considered (not including, at the moment, geometric ones) K value for flexural-torsional buckling K value in local Y axis- Usually minor axis K value in local Z axis- Usually major axis Length for flexural-torsional buckling Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Z axis. Minimum Yield strength of steel Ultimate tensile strength of steel

KX KY KZ LX LY

1.0 1.0 1.0 Member length Member length

LZ

Member length

FYLD FU

2530 kg/cm2 4230 Kg/cm2

678 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name NSF UNT

Default Value

Description

1 Member length

Net section factor for tension members Unsupported length (L) of the top* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the top flange. Unsupported length (L) of the bottom* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the bottom flange. Spacing of stiffeners for beams for shear design Coefficient C defined per section 3.3.2.2. If Cb is set to 0.0 it will be calculated by the program according to LRFD USA (CbMex=1/CbUSA). Any other value will be directly 0 = Supress all design strengths used in the design. 1 = Print all design strengths 2 = Print expanded design output

UNB

Member length

STIFF Cb y Cby

Member length 1

TRACK

DMAX DMIN RATIO BEAM

114 cm 0.0 cm 1.0 0

Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Permissible ratio of actual load effect and design strength 0: Design at ends and those locations specified by International Design Codes Manual 679

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

SECTION command. 1: Design at ends and at every y cada 1/12th point along member length Rigid_to_ H_Loads TRUE Defines if the structure has elements to bear the wind load ( shear walls, wind trusses or bracing rigid elements ) that restrict lateral displacements and allow to disregard slenderness effects. Variable defined for the whole structure indicating if it is regular or irregular according to section 3.4 of the NTC. IRREG=1 for columns being part of irregular structures. I_NO_OXIG 0 Defined for I shapes or tubes Curve Definition according to NTC.3.2.2.1a) I_NO_OXIG.= 0 implies n=1.4 laminated I shapes, tubes or built up with 3 or 4 welded plates obtained from wider

IRREG

plates cuts with oxygen.

I shapes, tubes or built up with

I_NO_OXIG.= 1 implies n=1 680 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

3 or 4 welded plates

n is defined by the program IMAIN_MEM 0 IMAIN_MEM=0 MAIN MEMBER IMAIN_MEM=1 Secondary and wind trusses Ccomb 1 Cfactor for combined forces when there are transverse loads in the members. Section 3.4.3.3.ii NTC Ccomb=1 If members ends are restricted angularly. Ccomb=0.85 If members ends DUCTILE_ SEISMIC _ DESIGN TRUE are not restricted angularly. DUCTILE FRAMES ACCORDING TO SECTION 11. Main design conditions are considered (not including, at the moment, geometric ones)

* Top and Bottom represent the positive and negative side of the local Y axis (local Z axis if SET Z UP is used. For deflection check, parameters DFF, DJ1 and DJ2 from Table 2.1 may be used. All requirements remain the same.

11B.12 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available in STAAD Mexican Standards implementation. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

International Design Codes Manual 681

Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code

Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

11B.13 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


Results of code checking and member selection are presented in a tabular format. CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the Mexican NTC which governed the design. If the TRACK is set to 1.0, member design strengths will be printed out.

682 STAAD.Pro

Section 12

Russian Codes

International Design Codes Manual 683

684 STAAD.Pro

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)


12A.1 General
Russian Code SNiP 2.03.0184* Plain concrete and concrete structures is based on the method of limit states. Code SNiP 2.03.0184* defines two groups of limit states. Analysis according to the first group of limit states is performed to avoid the following phenomena:
l

brittle, plastic or other type of failure, loss by structure of stable form or position, fatigue failure, failure due to the action of load actions and unfavorable environmental effects.

Analysis according to the second group of limit states is performed to avoid the following phenomena:
l

excessive and long-term opening of cracks if they are allowed according to service conditions, excessive displacements.

Analysis of structures for the first group of limit states is performed with the use of the maximum (design) loads and actions. Analysis of structures for the second group of limit states is made in accordance with the operational (normative) loads and actions. Ratio between design and normative loads is called reliability coefficient for loads which is determined according to SNiP 2.01.07.-85 Loads and actions. Reliability coefficient for destination according to SNiP 2.01.07.-85 shall be n considered in determination of loads and their combinations. Program STAAD.Pro makes it possible to calculate reinforcement for concrete members according to codes of many countries round the World and Russian Code SNiP 2.03.01-84* inclusive. Algorithms for calculation of reinforcement of concrete linear (beams, columns) and 2D (two dimensional) (slabs, walls, shells) members

International Design Codes Manual 685

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

are incorporated in program STAAD.Pro. Not only Code SNiP 2.03.01-84* but also the Guide for design of plain concrete and reinforced concrete structures from normal weight and lightweight concrete (to SNiP 2.03.01-84) have been used in creation of these algorithms. It is possible using program STAAD.Pro to calculate reinforcement for beams of rectangular or T section and for columns of rectangular or circular section (Fig.1).

Figure 12A.1 - Notation of dimensions for rectangular, circular and T sections Flange of T-shape beams may be situated at the top zone of the section if the angle BETA=0, or at the bottom zone of the section, if BETA=180.

12A.2 Design Parameters and Input Data


Entry of data of cross-sections of beams and columns is made by the use of MEMBER PROPERTIES command, and thicknesses of 2D members are entered by ELEMENT PROPERTY command. Example:
UNITMM MEMBERPROPERTIES *COLUMNS OF RECTANGULAR CROSS-SECTION 1TO16PRIYD350.ZD350. *COLUMNS OF CIRCULAR CROSS-SECTION 17TO22PRIYD350. *BEAMS OF T CROSS-SECTION 23TO40PRIYD450.ZD550.YB230.ZB200. UNITMETER ELEMENTPROPERTY

686 STAAD.Pro

41TO100 THICKNESS0.14 101TO252 THICKNESS0.16 * FLANGE OF T BEAMS IS LOCATED AT THE BOTTOM ZONE OF CROSS-SECTION BETA180.MEMB23TO40 COMMANDS FOR CALCULATION OF REINFORCEMENT ARE LOCATED IN THE INPUT DATA FILE AFTER THE COMMAND OF ANALYSIS AND AS A RULE, AFTER OUTPUT COMMANDS TO PRINT RESULTS OF CALCULATION.

Example:
* COMMAND OF ANALYSIS PERFORMANALYSIS . .* OUTPUT COMMAND TO PRINT RESULTS OF CALCULATION (ACCORDING TO USERS JUDGMENT) . *COMMAND OF LOADING AND THEIR COMBINATIONS CONSIDERED IN DESIGN LOADLIST15TO9 *COMMAND TO START REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION PROCEDURE STARTCONCRETEDESIGN CODERUSSIAN .* LIST OF PARAMETERS BEING USED IN REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION . . BCL20.MEMB17TO22 CL10.04MEMB1TO40 DD210.MEMB23TO40 CRA 0.036MEMB41TO252 .

International Design Codes Manual 687

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

. . * COMMAND OF BEAM REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION DESIGNBEAM23TO40 * COMMAND OF COLUMN REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION DESIGNCOLUMN1TO22 * COMMAND OF CALCULATION 2D ELEMENTS (SLABS, WALLS, SHELLS) DESIGNELEMENT41TO 252 * COMMAND OF INTERRUPTION REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION ENDCONCRETEDESIGN

In tables 1, 2 and 3 information about parameters used for calculation of reinforcement for beams, columns and 2D (two dimensional) members is presented. Values of parameters do not depend on UNIT command. In the file of input data only such parameters have to be taken, the values of which differ from determined in the program. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 12A.1 - Names of parameters for Concrete design according to Russian Code - 2.03.01-84* for beams. No. Parameter Default name Value 1 2 NLT RCL 1 3 Description

Number of long-term loading case Class of longitudinal reinforcement:


l

RCL = 1, if class of reinforcement is A-I; RCL = 2, if class of reinforcement is A-II; RCL = 3, if class of

688 STAAD.Pro

No. Parameter Default name Value

Description

reinforcement is A-III;
l

RCL = 33, if class of reinforcement is A-IIIb; RCL = 4, if class of reinforcement is A-IV; RCL = 5, if class of reinforcement is A-V; RCL = 6, if class of reinforcement is A-VI; RCL = 7, if class of reinforcement is A-VII; RCL = 77, if class of reinforcement is K-7; RCL = 8, if class of reinforcement is B-II; RCL = 9, if class of reinforcement is Bp-II; RCL = 10, if class of reinforcement is Bp-I; RCL = 19, if class of reinforcement is K-19

RCL

Class of longitudinal reinforcement: Russian Grade:


l

1 = A240; 2 = A300; 3 = A400; 4 = A500; 5 = B500; 6 = A500SP;

International Design Codes Manual 689

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default name Value Description

European Grade:
l

11 = S240; 12 = S400; 13 = S500;

USM

1.

Total product of service conditions coefficients for longitudinal reinforcement (g )


s

4 5

UB2 DD1

0.9 16.

Specific service conditions coefficient for concrete (g )


b2

Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars in beam tension zone Diameter of shear reinforcement bars for beam; Compression class of concrete Compression Class of concrete.
l

6 7 7

DD2 BCL BCL

16. 15. 15.

10 = B10; 15 = B15 20 = B20; 25 = B25; 30 = B30; 35 = B35; 40 = B40; 45 = B45; 50 = B50; 55 = B55; 60 = B60; 8.10 = C8/10

690 STAAD.Pro

No. Parameter Default name Value


l

Description

12.15 = C12/15; 16.20 = C16/20 25.30 = C25/30 30.37 = C30/37 35.45 = C35/45 40.50 = C50/50 45.55 = C45/55 50.60 = C50/60 60.75 = C60/75 70.85 = C70/85 80.95 = C80/95 90.105 = C90/105

UBM

1.

Product of service conditions coefficients for concrete, except UB2 (g )


b

TEM

0.

Parameter of concrete hardening conditions:


l

TEM=0, for natural hardening conditions; TEM=1, for steam hardening conditions

10

CL1

0.05

Distance from top/bottom fiber of beam cross section to the center of longitudinal reinforcement bar; Distance from left/right side of beam cross section to the center of longitudinal reinforcement bar Ultimate width of short-term crack Ultimate width of long-term crack

11

CL2

0.05

12 13

WST WLT

0.4 0.3

International Design Codes Manual 691

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default name Value 14 SSE 0 Description

Limit state parameter for beam design


l

SSE=0, if calculation of reinforcement amount must be carried out according to the requirements of load carrying capacity (the first limit state); SSE=1, if calculation of reinforcement amount must be carried out according to the cracking requirements (the second limit state)

15

RSH

Class of shear reinforcement:


l

RSH = 1, if class of reinforcement is A-I; RSH = 2, if class of reinforcement is A-II; RSH = 3, if class of reinforcement is A-III; RSH = 33, if class of reinforcement is A-IIIb; RSH = 4, if class of reinforcement is A-IV; RSH = 5, if class of reinforcement is A-V; RSH = 6, if class of reinforcement is A-VI; RSH = 7, if class of reinforcement is A-VII;

692 STAAD.Pro

No. Parameter Default name Value


l

Description

RSH = 77, if class of reinforcement is K-7; RSH = 8, if class of reinforcement is B-II; RSH = 9, if class of reinforcement is Bp-II; RSH = 10, if class of reinforcement is Bp-I; RSH = 19, if class of reinforcement is K-19

15

RSH

Class of shear reinforcement: Russian Grade:


l

1 = A240; 2 = A300; 3 = A400; 4 = A500; 5 = B500; 6 = A500SP;

European grade:
l

11 = S240; 12 = S400; 13 = S500;

16

FWT

ZD

Design width of beam top flange. Use for beam design only with default value provided as ZD in member properties. Design width of beam bottom flange. Use for beam design only with default value provided as ZB

17

FWB

ZB

International Design Codes Manual 693

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default name Value Description

in member properties. 18 DEP YD Design depth of beam section. Use for beam design only with default value provided as YD in member properties. Face of support location at the start of the beam. Use for beam design only. Face of support location at the end of the beam. Use for beam design only. Number of equally-spaced sections for beam design. Use for beam design only. Upper limit is equal to 20.

19

SFA

0.

20

EFA

0.

21

NSE

13

Table 12A.2 - Names of parameters for Concrete design according to Russian Code 2.03.01-84* for columns No. Parameter Default Name Value 1 2 NLT RCL 1 3 Description

Number of long-term loading case Class of longitudinal reinforcement: Russian Grade:


l

1 = A240; 2 = A300; 3 = A400; 4 = A500; 5 = B500; 6 = A500SP;

European Grade:

694 STAAD.Pro

No. Parameter Default Name Value


l

Description

11 = S240; 12 = S400; 13 = S500;

USM

1.

Total product of service conditions coefficients for longitudinal reinforcement (g )


s

4 5 6 7

UB2 DD1 DD2 BCL

0.9 16. 16. 15.

Specific service conditions coefficient for concrete (g )


b2

Minimum diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars for column Maximum diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars for column Compression class of concrete:
l

10 = B10; 15 = B15 20 = B20; 25 = B25; 30 = B30; 35 = B35; 40 = B40; 45 = B45; 50 = B50; 55 = B55; 60 = B60; 8.10 = C8/10 12.15 = C12/15; 16.20 = C16/20 25.30 = C25/30

International Design Codes Manual 695

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value
l

Description

30.37 = C30/37 35.45 = C35/45 40.50 = C50/50 45.55 = C45/55 50.60 = C50/60 60.75 = C60/75 70.85 = C70/85 80.95 = C80/95 90.105 = C90/105

UBM

1.

Product of service conditions coefficients for concrete, except UB2 (g )


b

TEM

0.

Parameter of concrete hardening conditions:


l

TEM=0, for natural hardening conditions; TEM=1, for steam hardening conditions

10

CL1

0.05

Distance from edge of column cross section to the center of longitudinal reinforcement bar Column's length coefficient to evaluate slenderness effect in local Y axis Column's length coefficient to evaluate slenderness effect in local Z axis Class of shear reinforcement: Russian Grade:

11

ELY

1.

12

ELZ

1.

13

RSH

1.

696 STAAD.Pro

No. Parameter Default Name Value


l

Description

1 = A240; 2 = A300; 3 = A400; 4 = A500; 5 = B500; 6 = A500SP;

European grade:
l

11 = S240; 12 = S400; 13 = S500;

Table 12A.3 - Names of parameters for Concrete design according to Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) for slabs and/or walls No. Parameter Default Name Value 1 2 NLT RCL 1 3 Description

Number of long-term loading case Class of longitudinal reinforcement: Russian Grade:


l

1 = A240; 2 = A300; 3 = A400; 4 = A500; 5 = B500; 6 = A500SP;

European Grade:
l

11 = S240; 12 = S400;

International Design Codes Manual 697

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value
l

Description

13 = S500;

USM

1.

Total product of service conditions coefficients for longitudinal reinforcement (g )


s

4 5

UB2 SDX

0.9 16.

Specific service conditions coefficient for concrete (g )


b2

Diameter of reinforcing bars located in the first local (X) direction of slab/wall Diameter of reinforcing bars located in the second local (Y) direction of slab/wall Compression class of concrete:
l

SDY

16.

BCL

15.

10 = B10; 15 = B15 20 = B20; 25 = B25; 30 = B30; 35 = B35; 40 = B40; 45 = B45; 50 = B50; 55 = B55; 60 = B60; 8.10 = C8/10 12.15 = C12/15; 16.20 = C16/20 25.30 = C25/30 30.37 = C30/37

698 STAAD.Pro

No. Parameter Default Name Value


l

Description

35.45 = C35/45 40.50 = C50/50 45.55 = C45/55 50.60 = C50/60 60.75 = C60/75 70.85 = C70/85 80.95 = C80/95 90.105 = C90/105

UBM

1.

Product of service conditions coefficients for concrete, except UB2 (g )


b

TEM

0.

Parameter of concrete hardening conditions:


l

TEM=0, for natural hardening conditions; TEM=1, for steam hardening conditions

10

CL

0.05

Distance from top/bottom face of slab/wall element to the center of longitudinal reinforcing bars located in first local (X) direction. (Main thickness of top/bottom concrete cover for slab/wall element) Distance from top/bottom face of slab/wall element to the center of transverse reinforcing bars located in second local (Y) direction (Secondary thickness of top/bottom concrete cover for slab/wall)

11

CRA

0.05

International Design Codes Manual 699

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value 12 13 14 WST WLT STA 0.4 0.3 0 Description

Ultimate width of short-term crack Ultimate width of long-term crack Parameter of limit state for slab/wall design:
l

STA=0, if calculation of nonsymmetrical reinforcement must be carried out according to the requirements of load carrying capacity (the first limit state); STA=1, if calculation of symmetrical reinforcement must be carried out according to the requirements of load carrying capacity (the first limit state); STA=2, if calculation of nonsymmetrical reinforcement must be carried according to the cracking requirements (the second limit state); STA=3, if calculation of symmetrical reinforcement must be carried according to the cracking requirements (the second limit state)

15

SELX

0.

Design length of wall member to evaluate slenderness effect in local X axis

700 STAAD.Pro

No. Parameter Default Name Value 16 SELY 0.

Description

Design length of wall member to evaluate slenderness effect in local Y axis Design parameter of slab/wall reinforcement:
l

17

MMA

MMA=0, if reinforcement calculation must be applied by stresses in local axis; MMA=1, if reinforcement calculation must be applied by principal stresses

18

MMB

Design parameter of slab/wall reinforcement:


l

MMB=0, if the effect of additional eccentricity is not taken into account; MMB=1, if the effect of additional eccentricity is taken into account

19

RSH

1.

Class of shear reinforcement: Russian Grade:


l

1 = A240; 2 = A300; 3 = A400; 4 = A500; 5 = B500; 6 = A500SP;

European grade:
l

11 = S240;

International Design Codes Manual 701

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value
l

Description

12 = S400; 13 = S500;

12A.3 Beams
Reinforcement for beams of rectangular and T cross-section can be calculated. In calculation of longitudinal reinforcement bending moment about local axis and torsional moments are considered, but influence of longitudinal forces and bending moments in relation to local axis is ignored. In calculation of transverse reinforcement shear forces parallel to local axis and torsional moments are taken into account. Reinforcement for beams can be calculated either from conditions of strength or from conditions of open crack width limitation (see parameter SSE). Parameters SFA and FA are considered only in calculation of transverse reinforcement. In general case calculation of reinforcement for beams is carried out two times according to strength conditions and according to conditions of open crack width limitation. In reinforcement calculations from conditions of strength design values of load have to be taken and in calculations from conditions of crack width limitation characteristic (normative) load values are used. Both calculations can be carried out in one session with the use multiple analysis possibility of the program STAAD.Pro. In most cases calculation of reinforcement is carried out with account only of a part of loadings. In such cases command LOAD LIST is used, in which numbers of loads considered in calculation are indicated. Number of permanent and longterm loads equal to parameter NLT must be included into the list of considered loads. It has to be noted, that values of parameters DD1 and DD2 have influence not only on the width of opened crack but also in some cases, on design and normative reinforcement resistances. Parameter BCL can be equal to any value of concrete compression strength class given in SNiP 2.03.01-84* and to any intermediate value as well.

702 STAAD.Pro

It should be remembered, that accuracy of results of calculation of transverse reinforcement increases with the value of parameter NSE. Parameters SFA and FA are considered only in calculations of transverse reinforcement. Beam 1 is shown in Figure 2 with rigid intervals the lengths of which are: at the start of the beam 0.3m and at the end 0.2m. In modeling of the beam the following command can be used.
MEMBER OFFSET 1 START 0.3 0 0 1 END -0.2 0 0

Figure 12A.2 - Diagram of a beam with rigid intervals When command MEMBER OFFSET is used forces corresponding to the beam the length of which is equal to the distance between points a and b are calculated and then used in calculation of reinforcement. In such case it is necessary to take into account default values of parameters SFA and FA equal to zero. When command MEMBER OFFSET is not used forces corresponding to the beam the length of which is equal to the distance between points 10 and 11 are calculated and then used in calculation of reinforcement. In this case it is necessary to consider values of parameters SFA=0.3 and FA=0,2 in reinforcement calculation. In both cases calculated quantity of transverse reinforcement will be the same. Calculated quantity of longitudinal reinforcement in the second case will be greater. For beam the following output is generated:
l

beam number;

International Design Codes Manual 703

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

method of calculation (according to conditions of strength or limitations of opened crack width);


l l

length and cross-sectional dimensions;

distance from resultant of forces acting in bottom/top reinforcement to bottom/top edge of the section;
l

distance from the side edge of cross-section of the beam web to the centroid of longitudinal bars located at this edge;
l l

concrete class; class of longitudinal and transverse reinforcement;

assumed in calculations bar diameters of longitudinal and transverse reinforcement;


l

calculation results of longitudinal and transverse reinforcement (in two tables).


l

In nine columns of the first table the following results are presented: Table 12A.4 - Beam design output 1 Result Section Description distance of the section from the start of the beam, cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement in the bottom zone of cross-section of the beam, if angle BETA=0, or in the top zone, if

As-

BETA=180 , sq.cm As+


cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement in the top zone of cross-section of the beam , if angle BETA=0, or in the top zone, if

BETA=180 , sq.cm Moments (-/+) Load. N. (-/+)


Acrc1 Acrc2 values of bending moments, determining cross-sectional areas of longitudinal reinforcement As- and As+ , kNm numbers of loading versions, determining cross-sectional areas of longitudinal reinforcement short-term opened crack width*, mm long-term opened crack width*, mm

704 STAAD.Pro

* Opened crack width is presented only in the case when calculation is performed according to conditions limiting opened crack width. In ten columns of second table the following results are presented: Table 12A.5 - Beam design output 2 Result Section Qsw Asw Q T Load N. Description distance of the section from the start of the beam, mm intensity of transverse reinforcement, kN/m cross-sectional area of transverse bars, sq.cm, if their step is 10, 15, 20, 25 or 30 cm value of shear force parallel to the local axis, kN value of torsional moment, kNm number of loading version, determining intensity of transverse reinforcement An example of output of calculation results is presented below. BEAM NO. 23 DESIGN RESULTS (by limitation of crack width) Length - 6000 mm. Section: BF1= 550 mm, B= 200 mm, HF1=220 mm, H=450 mm. Distance from top/bottom surface of beam to center of longitudinal reinforcement - 40 mm. Distance from side surface of beam to center of longitudinal reinforcement - 30 mm. Concrete class - 25.0 (Rb=13.05 MPa; Rbt=0.94 MPa; Gb2=0.9). Class of longitudinal reinforcement - -III (Rs=365.0 MPa; Rsc=365.0 MPa). Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars D=16 mm. Class of shear reinforcement - -I (Rsw=175.0 MPa). Diameter of shear reinforcement bars Dw=10 mm. L O N G I T U D I N A L R E I N F O R C E M E N T

International Design Codes Manual 705

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

SectionAs-As+ Moments(-/+)Load.N.(-/+) Acrc1 Acrc2 mm sq.cm kNm mm mm --------------------------------------------------------------------0. 500. 1000. 1500. 2000. 2500. 3000. 3500. 4000. 4500. 5000. 5500. 6000. 10.92 4.74 1.13 1.13 1.13 0.41 0.41 1.13 6.41 9.24 -152. / 2. -60. / 0. -5. / 17. -8. / 75. -11. / 115. -14. / 139. -18. / 144. -21. / 132. -24. / 103. -27. / 56. -39. / 9. 124. 16.89 0.41 226. S H E A R R E I N F O R C E M E N T SectionQswAsw, cm^2, if Sw= Q T Load / 0. 5 / 0 0.155 0.078 / 0. 6 / 4 0.237 0.121 5 / 0 0.294 0.157 4 / 6 0.000 0.000 4 / 6 0.295 0.147 4 / 6 0.298 0.149 4 / 6 0.271 0.134 4 / 6 0.263 0.127 4 / 6 0.277 0.130 4 / 6 0.296 0.129 4 / 6 0.299 0.093 5 / 3 0.293 0.157 5 / 0 0.271 0.142

1.13 11.53 1.19 12.16 1.41 10.86 1.63 1.95 3.23 0.74 8.28 4.54 0.58 0.41

mmkN/m10cm15cm20cm25cm30cmkN kNm N. 2.15 2.87 0. 251.3 1.44 2.15 2.87 500. 251.3 1.44 1.50 1.99 1000. 174.5 1.00 0.55 0.73 1500. 63.9 0.36 Minimum detailing 3.59 4.31 203.9 0.0 6 3.59 4.31 168.9 0.0 6 2.49 2.99 133.9 0.0 6 0.91 1.09 98.9 0.0 6 -

706 STAAD.Pro

2000. requirements ! Minimum detailing 2500. requirements ! Minimum detailing 3000. requirements ! Minimum detailing 3500. requirements ! Minimum detailing 4000. requirements ! 95.0 4500. 0.55 2.08 2.77 5000. 242.5 1.39 2.59 3.46 5500. 302.5 1.73 2.59 3.46 6000. 302.5 1.73 4.32 5.19 216.1 0.0 5 4.32 5.19 187.7 0.0 5 3.46 4.16 152.7 0.0 5 0.82 1.09 1.37 1.64 117.7 0.0 5

63.9 0.0 6 28.9 0.0 6 12.7 0.0 5 47.7 0.0 5 82.7 0.0 5

Here Minimum detailing requirements! means that reinforcement is not required according to calculation.

12A.4 Columns
Reinforcement for columns of rectangular or circular cross-section can be calculated. Flexibility of columns can be evaluated in two ways. In the case of usual analysis (command PERFORM ANALYSIS) flexibility is assessed by parameters ELY and ELZ, values of which should conform with recommendation of the Code SNiP 2.03.01-84*. If P-DELTA (analysis according to deformed diagram) or NONLINEAR (nonlinear geometry) analysis is performed, values of parameters ELY and ELZ should be close to zero, for example ELY = ELZ=0.01. Longitudinal reinforcement for columns is calculated only from condition of strength. Longitudinal forces and bending moments in relation to local axes and are taken into account in longitudinal reinforcement calculations. For rectangular columns the following output is generated:

International Design Codes Manual 707

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

column number; column length and cross-sectional dimensions;

distance of centroid of each longitudinal bar from the nearest edge of the cross-section;
l l

concrete class; longitudinal reinforcement class; range of longitudinal reinforcement bar diameters assumed in calculation; diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars obtained in calculation; total quantity of longitudinal bars; quantity of longitudinal bars at each cross-section edge, directed parallel to ;

the local axis


l

quantity of longitudinal bars at each cross-section edge, directed parallel to .

the local axis

In nine columns of the table under the heading LONGITUDINAL REINFORCEMENT the following output is presented: Table 12A.6 - Column design output 1 Result Section Astot Asy Asz Percent Nx, Mz, My distance of the section from the start of the column, mm total cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement, sq.cm cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement bars at each edge of section, directed parallel to the local axis directed parallel to the local axis , sq.cm , sq.cm cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement bars at each edge of section, reinforcement percentage in the section respective values of longitudinal force and bending moments in relation to the local axes and reinforcement Load.N. reinforcement An example of output of calculation results is presented below. 708 STAAD.Pro , determining cross-sectional area of longitudinal

number of loading version, determining cross-sectional area of longitudinal

COLUMN NO. 97 DESIGN RESULTS (rectangular section) Length - 4000 mm. Section: B= 350 mm, H=350 mm. Distance from edge of column cross section to center of each longitudinal reinforcement bar - 40 mm. Concrete class - 25.0 (Rb=13.05 Pa; Gb2=0.9). Class of longitudinal reinforcement - -III (Rs=365.0 Pa; Rsc=365.0 Pa). Diameter range of longitudinal reinforcement bars: Dmin=16 mm . . . Dmax=32 mm Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars from calculation d=20 mm. Total number of reinforcement bars Ntot=6. Number of longitudinal bars at each section edge parallel to the local Y axis Nyy =2. Number of longitudinal bars at each section edge parallel to the local Z axis Nzz =3. L O N G I T U D I N A L R E I N F O R C E M E N T Section Astot Asy Asz Percent Nx m 0. 4000. sq.cm 16.42 15.35 sq.cm 3.01 3.01 sq.cm 6.20 5.67 % 1.34 1.25 kN 285.5 397.3

Mz kNm 81.9 95.3

My kNm 0.0 0.0

Load N 6 5

Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars, total quantity of longitudinal bars as well as quantity of longitudinal bars at each edge of the section obtained from calculation should be considered as recommendation. In this case arrangement of reinforcement in the section depends on the orientation of the local axes and is as follows:

International Design Codes Manual 709

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

Calculated values of reinforcement cross-sectional areas are presented in the table and they may differ from recommended on the lower side. When it is not possible according to detailing provisions to arrange in the column longitudinal reinforcement determined from calculation additional message is derived. For columns of circular section the following output is generated:
l

column number; column length and diameter of cross-section; distance of centroid of each longitudinal bar to the edge of cross-section; longitudinal reinforcement class;

assumed in calculation range of diameters of longitudinal reinforcement bars;


l l

diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars obtained from calculation; quantity of longitudinal bars.

In seven columns of the table under the heading LONGITUDINAL REINFORCEMENT the following results are presented: Section distance of the section from the start of the column, mm Astot Per cent Nx, respective values of longitudinal force and bending moments in , determining cross-sectional area Mz, My relation to local axis and of longitudinal reinforcement N. longitudinal reinforcement total cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement, sq.cm percentage of longitudinal reinforcement

Load. number of loading version, determining cross-sectional area of

710 STAAD.Pro

An example of output of calculation results for a column of circular section is presented below. COLUMN NO. 80 DESIGN RESULTS (circular section) Length - 4000 mm. Diameter: D= 350 mm. Distance from edge of column cross section to center of each longitudinal reinforcement bar - 50 mm. Concrete class - 20.0 (Rb=10.35 Pa; Gb2=0.9). Class of longitudinal reinforcement - -III (Rs=365.0 Pa; Rsc=365.0 Pa). Diameter range of longitudinal reinforcement bars: Dmin=16 mm . . . Dmax=32 mm Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars from calculation D=20 mm. Total number of reinforcement bars Ntot =7. L O N G I T U D I N A L R E I N F O R C E M E N T Section Astot Percent Nx Mz My m 0. 4000. sq.cm 17.96 21.86 % 1.87 2.27 kN 195.1 195.1 kNm 59.8 80.2 kNm 0.0 0.0

Load N 5 5

Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars, total quantity of longitudinal bars as well as quantity of longitudinal bars at each edge of the section should be considered as recommendation. Arrangement of reinforcement in section in this case is shown below:

Calculated cross-sectional areas of reinforcement presented in the table may differ from recommended on the lower side.

International Design Codes Manual 711

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

When according to detailing provisions it is not possible to arrange in the column longitudinal reinforcement obtained from calculation additional message is derived.

12A.5 Two DimensionalElement (slabs, walls, shells)


In general case calculation of reinforcement for 2D members is carried out two times according to conditions of strength and conditions of limiting opened width of cracks. If reinforcement is calculated according to conditions of strength, design values of loads have to be used, and for conditions of limiting crack width characteristic (normative) loads are employed. Both calculations can be made in one session taking advantage of multiple analysis possibility of the program STAAD.Pro. Symmetric or nonsymmetrical reinforcement of 2D members is calculated according to conditions of strength or according to conditions of limiting opened crack width (see for example STA). In reinforcement calculation for 2D members it is necessary to pay attention to arrangement of local axes of member and direction of reinforcement (see for example CL and CRA).

An example of output of calculation results is presented bellow. SLAB/WALL DESIGN RESULTS (by stresses in local axes for limitation of crack width) Element Asx Mx Nx Load.N. Asy sq.cm/m kNm/m kN/m (X) sq.cm/m

My kNm/m

Ny kN/m

Load N. (Y)

712 STAAD.Pro

60 TOP BOT 61 TOP BOT 62 TOP BOT Here:

0.00 3.53 0.00 3.87 0.00 4.10

- 4.9 - 9.9 - 5.3 - 10.7 - 5.6 - 11.2

0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00

1 3 1 3 1 3

0.00 3.46 0.00 3.65 0.00 3.77

- 4.5 - 8.9 - 4.7 - 9.4 - 4.8 - 9.6

0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00

1 3 1 3 1 3

Table 12A.7 - Slab design output Result Element Description number of finite element, TOP - top zone of member, BOT bottom zone of member (top zone of member is determined by positive direction of local axis -see Fig.2) intensity of reinforcing in the first direction (parallel to the local axis Mx Nx Load N.(X) Asy My Ny Load N.(Y) ), sq.cm/m , distributed bending moment in respect to the local axis kNm/m

Asx

distributed longitudinal force directed parallel to the axis , kNm/m number of loading version, determining intensity of reinforcing in the first direction intensity of reinforcing in the second direction (parallel to the local axis ), sq.cm/m distributed bending moment in respect to the local axis kNm/m distributed longitudinal force directed parallel to the local axis kN/m number of loading version, determining intensity of reinforcing in the second direction

International Design Codes Manual 713

Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*)

Figure 2 - Local coordinate system of 2D member and notation of forces

714 STAAD.Pro

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)
12B.1 General
Design Code SNiP Steel Structures as majority of modern codes is based on the method of limit states. The following groups of limit states are defined in the Code. The first group is concerned with losses of general shape and stability, failure, qualitative changes in configuration of structure. Appearance of nonallowable residual deformations, displacements, yielding of materials or opening of cracks.
l

The second group is concerned with states of structures making worse normal their service or reducing durability due to not allowable deflections, deviations, settlements, vibrations, etc.
l

Analysis of structures for the first limit state is performed using the maximum (design) loads and actions, which can cause failure of structures. Analysis of structures for the second limit state is performed using service (normative) loads and actions. Relation between design and normative loads is referred to as coefficient of load reliability, which is defined in SNiP 2.01.07.- 85 Loads and Actions. Coefficient of reliability for destination GAMA n according to SNiP 2.01.07.- 85 shall be taken in to account determining loads or their combinations. In this version of the program only members from rolled, tube and roll-formed assortment sections and also from compound such as double angles of T-type sections, double channels are presented. Design of other members of compound section will be presented in other versions of the program. Economy of selected section is indicated by ratio (RATIO) /R y presented in y c calculation results. A section is economical when said ratio equals to 0,9 0,95.

12B.2 Built-in Russian Steel Section Library


Typical sections of members being checked and selected according to SNiP 2.01.07.- 81* are presented in the following tables.

International Design Codes Manual 715

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Table 12B.1 - Typical Sections for Russian Steel Design Section Section Type Designation form

I-beam (GOST 8239-89) Regular I-beam (GOST 26020-83) Broad-flanged I-beam (GOST 26020-83) Column I-beam (GOST 26020-83) Channel (GOST 8240-89)

ST I12 ST B1-10 ST SH1-23 ST K1-20 ST C14

Equal legs angle (GOST 8509-89)

ST L100x100x7 RA L100x100x7

Unequal legs angle (GOST 8510-89)

ST L125x80x10 RA L125x80x10

Pipes (welded and for gas piping)

ST PIP102x5.5 or ST PIPE OD 0.102 ID 0.055

Roll-formed square and rectangular tubes

ST TUB160x120x3 or

716 STAAD.Pro

Section

Section Type

Designation form

ST TUBE TH 0.003 WT 0.12 DT 0.16

Table 12B.2 - Compound Sections for Russian Steel Design Section Section Type Designation form D C14 SP 0.01 (SP clear distance between channel walls) Double equal legs angles LD L100x100x7 SP 0.01 (SP clear distance between angle walls) Double unequal legs angles with long legs back to back LD L125x80x10 SP 0.01 (SP clear distance between angle walls) Double unequal legs angles with short legs back to back SD L125x80x10 SP 0.01 (SP clear

Double channels

International Design Codes Manual 717

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Section Section Type Designation form distance between angle walls) Tee with flange at the top Note: Flange of Tee beam is at the top part of cross-section if beta angle = 0, or at the bottom part if beta angle = 180. T I12 T B1-10 T SH1-23 T K1-20

For entry of cross-sectional dimensions command MEMBER PROPERTIES RUSSIAN is used.

Example
UNITS METER MEMBER PROPERTY RUSSIAN * I-BEAM 1 TO 6 TABLE ST B1-10 * CHANNEL 7 TO 11 TABLE ST C14 * UNEQUAL LEGS ANGLE 12 TO 30 TABLE RA L125X80X10 * ROUND ASSORTMENT PIPE 31 TO 46 TABLE ST PIP102X5.5 * ROUND PIPE OF CROSS-SECTIONAL DIMENSIONS DEFINED BY CLIENT 47 TO 60 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.102 ID 0.055 * SQUARE TUBE FROM ASSORTMENT 61 TO 68 TABLE ST TUB120X120X3

718 STAAD.Pro

* RECTANGULAR TUBE OF CROSS-SECTIONAL DIMENSION DEFINED BY CLIENT 69 TO 95 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.003 WT 0.12 DT 0.16 * DOUBLE CHANNEL (DISTANCE BETWEEN WALLS 10 ) 96 TO 103 TABLE D C14 SP 0.01 * DOUBLE UNEQUAL LEGS ANGLES WITH SHORT LEGS BACK-TOBACK (DISTANCE BETWEEN WALLS 10 ) 104 TO 105 TABLE SD L125X80X10 SP 0.01 * MEMBER OF TEE SECTION 106 TO 126 TABLE T SH1-23 * FLANGE OF T-BEAMS AT THE BOTTOM OF CROSS-SECTION BETA 180. MEMB 116 TO 126 * ORIENTATION OF THE LOCAL ANGLE AXES IN RELATION TO THE GLOBAL AXES OF THE STRUCTURE BETA RANGLE MEMB 12 TO 30 COMMANDS OF OUTPUT DATA FOR CHECK AND SELECTION OF SECTIONS ARE LOCATED AFTER COMMANDS OF ANALYSIS AND, AS A RULE, AFTER OUTPUT COMMAND TO PRINT RESULTS OF CALCULATION.

12B.3 Member Capacities


Algorithms for selection and review of sections for steel members according to assortments and databases of the main rolled steel producers from given countries and according to international standards as well are included in STAAD.Pro program. In this program version only assortment sections can be utilized.

Example
* COMMAND OF ANALYSIS PERFORM ANALYSIS * COMMAND OF LOADINGS AND THEIR COMBINATIONS CONSIDERED IN DESIGN LOAD LIST 1 5 TO 9

International Design Codes Manual 719

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)

* COMMAND TO START DESIGN ACCORDING TO RUSSIAN CODE PARAMETER CODE RUSSIAN * LIST OF PARAMETERS USED IN CHECKING AND SELECTING BEAM 1. ALL

Obligatory parameter
LY 4. MEMB 1 TO 4 LZ 4. MEM 1 TO 4 MAIN 1. ALL SGR 3. ALL SBLT 0 ALL * PARAMETER OF OUTPUT AMOUNT OF INFORMATION ON CALCULATION RESULTS TRACK 2. ALL . * COMMAND TO START SECTION CHECK PROCEDURE CHECK CODE ALL * COMMAND TO START SECTION SELECTION PROCEDURE SELECT ALL . * COMMAND OF OUTPUT TO PRINT CONTENT OF ASSORTMENT TABLES PRINT ENTIRE TABLE * COMMAND OF OUTPUT TO PRINT SUMMARY OF STEEL ACCORDING TO SECTIONS STEEL TAKE OFF * COMMAND OF OUTPUT TO PRINT SUMMARY OF STEEL ACCORDING TO MEMBERS AND SECTIONS STEEL MEMBER TAKE OFF

720 STAAD.Pro

12B.3.1 Axial tension members


Stress in a section of axial tension member shall not exceed design strength R of y selected steel multiplied by coefficient of service conditions (KY and KZ), table 6 c of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*. Slenderness of tension member (CMM) shall not exceed slenderness limit indicated in table 20 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81* (default value = u 200, but another value can be defined). Net section factor (ratio A /A (NSF)) net gross is used for tension member to allow for reduction of design cross-section area.

12B.3.2 Axial compression members


All axial compression members are calculated as long bars, i.e., with allowance for slenderness ( = l /i ). The calculation is performed in accordance with the 0 min clause 5.3 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*, buckling coefficient is determined by formula 8-10. Effective bar lengths (within and out of plane) taking in to account role and location of the bar in the structure, as well as fixation of ends (l = l), are 0 determined according to requirements of chapter 6 or addition 6 to SNiP 2.01.07.81* and are set by specification of members. Slenderness of compression members (CMN) shall not exceed limit values given in table 19 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*. Value of coefficient being used in table 19 is taken within limits from 0,5 to 1,0. Limit slenderness value depends on stress acting in the member, section area, buckling coefficient and design resistance of steel. Since slenderness can be different in various planes the greatest slenderness is assumed in calculations.

12B.3.3 Flexural members


Members subjected to the action of bending moments and shear forces are called flexural members. Calculation of flexural members consists of verification of strength, stability and deflection. Normal and tangential stresses are verified by strength calculation of members. Normal stresses are calculated in the outermost section fibres. Tangential stresses are verified in the neutral axis zone of the same section. If normal stresses do not exceed design steel strength and tangential stresses do not exceed design value of steel shear strength R then according to clause 5.14 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81* s s principal stresses are checked.

International Design Codes Manual 721

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)

General stability of member subjected to bending in one plane are calculated in accordance with clause 5.15 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*, and subjected to bending in two planes in accordance with Guide to design of steel structures (to SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*). Coefficient value is determined according to appendix 7 of b SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*. Additional data about load (concentrated or distributed), numbers of bracing restrains of compression flanges, location of applied load are required. For closed sections it is assumed that coefficient = 1.0.
b

Simply supported (non-continuous) beams can be calculated in elastic as well as in elastic-plastic state according to requirements of clause 5.18 of SNiP 2.01.07.81*. Calculation can be selected by specification of structure in input data. Stiffness of flexural members is verified comparing input value of deflection limit (through parameter DFF) with maximum displacement of a section of flexural member allowing for load reliability coefficient, which is specified, in input data. Limit values of deflection are determined in accordance with SNiP 2.01.07.- 85 Loads and Actions. Addition chapter 10. Deflections and displacements. Verification of deflection is performed only in the case of review (CHECK) problem.

12B.3.4 Eccentric compression/tension members


Eccentric compression or tension members are subjected to simultaneous action of axial force and bending moment. Bending moment appears due to eccentric application of longitudinal force or due to transverse force. Stress in eccentric compression/tension members is obtained as a sum of stresses due to axial force and bending. Following the requirements of clause 5.25 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81* resistance of eccentric compression/tension member taking into consideration condition R < y 530 MPa, < 0.5R and N/(A R ) > 0.1 is calculated by formula 49, and in other s n y cases-by formula 50. Calculations of stability verification are performed according to requirements of clauses 5.27, 5.30, 5.32 or 5.34. Calculation for strength of eccentric tension members is made according to formula 50 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*. When reduced relative eccentricity m > 20 eccentric compression members are ef calculated as flexural members (N = 0), when m < 20 strength by formula 49 is ef not verified (clause 5.24).

722 STAAD.Pro

12B.4 Design Parameters


Information on parameters, data used for check and selection of sections in design of steel structures according to Russian Code is presented in the following table. In this version of calculation according to requirements of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81* there is common database of equal legs angles and unequal legs angles, therefore solution of section selection problem may give equal legs angle as well as unequal legs angle irrespective of set at the beginning. The same is and with rectangular and square tubes. Values of parameters do not depend on command UNIT. Only these values of parameters, which differ from, defined in the program need to be included in the input data file. Review of sections (command CHECK) can be performed according to the first and the second group of limit states. Selection of section (command SELECT) can be performed only according to the first group of limit states with subsequent recalculation and verification of selected section with allowance for deflection. Calculation for the first group of limit states involves selection of members according to strength and stability. Parameters CMN and CMM give opportunity to set slenderness limit for compression and tension members respectively for their stability calculation, or refuse consideration of slenderness by setting default parameters. In this case selection of sections will be performed with consideration only of strength check. Check for deflection performed by setting parameter DFF (maximum allowable relative deflection value) different from set in the program. In the case of application of steel not defined by SNiP and/or GOST it is necessary to set their design strength by parameters UNL and PY. In determination of steel parameters SBLT and MAIN shall be approved (see Table 12B.4). Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 723

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Table 12B.3 - Parameters for Steel design according to Russian Code (SNiP II 23 81*, edition 1990) Parameter Default Name Value Description Member design parameter:
l

BEAM = 0, Design members for forces at their ends or at the sections defined by SECTION command; BEAM = 1, Calculate the major axis moment Mz at 13 points along the beam and design beam at the location of maximum Mz; BEAM = 2, Same as BEAM=1, but additional checks are carried out at beam ends and at critical inter mediate section; BEAM = 3, Calculate forces at 13 points and perform design checks at all locations including the ends

BEAM

1
l

Place of loading on beam: CB 1


l

CB = 1, for loading on top flange; CB = 2, for loading on bottom flange

724 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Default Name Value

Description Slenderness limit value for tension members:


l

MM = 0, if slenderness is suppressed; MM = 2, if ultimate slenderness value is "150"; MM = 2, if ultimate slenderness value is "200"; MM = 3, if ultimate slenderness value is "250"; MM = 4, if ultimate slenderness value is "300"; MM = 5, if ultimate slenderness value is "350"; MM = 6, if ultimate slenderness value is "400

MM

0
l

Set slenderness limit value not equal to "0" for design with evaluation of buckling effect

International Design Codes Manual 725

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Parameter Default Name Value

Description Slenderness limit value for compression members:


l

MN = 0, if slenderness is suppressed; MN = 1, if slenderness limit value is "120"; MN = 2, if slenderness limit value is "210-60a"; MN = 3, if slenderness limit value is "220-40a"; MN = 4, if slenderness limit value is "220"; MN = 5, if slenderness limit value is "180-60a"; MN = 6, if slenderness limit value is "210-60a"; MN = 7, if slenderness limit value is "210-60a"; MN = 8, if slenderness limit value is "200"; MN = 9, if slenderness limit value is "150";

CMN

Set slenderness limit value not equal to "0" for design with evaluation of buckling effect

726 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Default Name Value

Description Allowable limit of relative local deflection (Member length/Deflection Ratio):

DFF

0.

Default value 0 is valid if design is applied without deflection limitation. Set for deflection check only

DMAX 1. [m] DMIN 0. [m] GAMC1 GAMC2 KY KZ 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 Specific service condition coefficient for buckling design Specific service condition coefficient for strength design Coefficient of effective length in respect to local axis Y (in plane XZ) Coefficient of effective length in respect to local axis Z (in plane XY) Type and position of loading on beam:
l

Maximum allowable section depth

Minimum allowable section depth

LEG = 1, for loading concentrated in the middle span; LEG = 2, for loading concentrated in the quarter of the span; LEG = 3, for loading concentrated at the end of bracket; LEG = 4, for loading uniformly distributed on beam; LEG = 5, for loading uniformly distributed on bracket

LEG

International Design Codes Manual 727

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Parameter Default Name Value LY [m] LZ [m]

Description

Effective length in respect to local axis Y Member (in plane XZ) length Default is selected member's length Effective length in respect to local axis Z Member (in plane XY) length Default is selected member's length Standard of steel grade (GOST):
l

MAIN = 1, if Standard of steel grade is GOST27772-88; MAIN = 2, if Standard of steel grade is GOST10705-80; MAIN = 3, if Standard of steel grade is GOST10706-76; MAIN = 4, if Standard of steel grade is GOST8731-87; MAIN = 5, if Standard of steel grade is TY14-3-567-76

MAIN

NSF

1.0

Net section factor for tension members or web section area weakening factor for bending members Design steel strength (yield strength):

PY 0 [MPa]

If parameters MAIN according to Standard of steel grade (GOST) and by SGR according to Steel grade (STAL) are not defined Ratio between design and characteristic loads values

RATIO

1.0

728 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Default Name Value

Description Number of lateral bracing restraints along the span:


l

SBLT = 0, if beam not fixed; SBLT = 1, one restraint in the middle of the span; SBLT = 2, 3, etc. number of uniformly spaced lateral supports along the span

SBLT

SGR

Steel grade (STAL). Refer to Table 12B.4 below.

Indication of elastic or elastic-plastic calculation:


l

TB = 0, for elastic calculation TB = 1, for elastic-plastic calculation

TB

Set for members under bending or nonaxial compression/tension only.

International Design Codes Manual 729

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Parameter Default Name Value

Description Output parameter:


l

TRACK = 0, for suppressed output information; TRACK = 1, for extended output information; TRACK = 2, for advanced output information

TRACK

Design steel strength (ultimate strength): UNL 0 [MPa] If parameters MAIN according to Standard of steel grade (GOST) and by SGR according to Steel grade (STAL) are not defined

Table 12B.4 - Steel types for design of steel structures according to SNiP 2.01.07.-81* (table 51 and 51a) SGR Value 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Steel Parameter MAIN 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 GOST GOST 27772-88 For members* GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F F

C235 C245 C255 C275 C285 C345 C345K C375 C390

730 STAAD.Pro

SGR Value 10 11 12 13 14

Steel C390K C440 C590 C590 BSt3kp

Parameter MAIN 1 1 1 1 2

GOST

For members* F F F F Tube

GOST 10705-80* GOST 10705-80*

2 15 BSt3ps 3

Tube GOST 10706-76* GOST 10705-80* Tube 3 GOST 10706-76* GOST 873187 Tube

2 16 BSt3sp

17 18

20

16G2F 5

TY 14-3-567Tube 76

*GT members from sheet and roll-formed tubes F rolled section steel

12B.5 Member Selection and Code Check


Both code checking and member selection options are available in SNiP 2.23-81*. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

International Design Codes Manual 731

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)

Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. Output of selection and check results are given in suppressed, extended and advanced forms. Form of output results depends on value of parameter TRACK. Results are presented in tables. Three versions of output results are possible: suppressed results according the critical strength condition (TRACK=0), extended - results according to all check conditions (TRACK=1) and advanced complete information on results of member design (TRACK=2). In tables of results common data for all TRACKs are indicated: (TRACK=2). In tables of results common data for all TRACKs are indicated: number of member; type and number of cross-section; result obtained (ACCEPTED requirements are met, FAILURE are not met); abbreviated name of normative document (code, standard) (SNiP); number of check clause; safety of strength (ratio between design and normative values); number of the most unfavorable loading; value of longitudinal force acting in the member with subscript indicating its direction (C compression, P tension); bending moments in relation to local member axes Z and Y; distance to section, in which the most unfavorable combination of forces acts.

Example of TRACK 0 output


In suppressed form (TRACK 0) results are presented according to the critical check for given member with indication of SNiP clause number, according to which strength safety of the member is minimum.
======================================================================== MEMBER CROSS RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ SECTION NO. FX MZ MY LOCATION

732 STAAD.Pro

======================================================================== 1 I60 PASS SNiP- 5.18 0.68 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00

Example of TRACK 1 output


In extended form (TRACK 1) results are presented on the basis of all required by SNiP checks for given stress state.
======================================================================== MEMBER CROSS RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ SECTION NO. FX MZ MY LOCATION ======================================================================== 1 I60 PASS SNiP- 5.18 0.68 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00 1 I60 PASS SNiP- DISPL 0.36 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00

Example of a TRACK 2 output


In advanced form (TRACK=2) in addition to tabled results supplementary information is presented.
l

Material characteristics: Steel; Design resistance; Elasticity modulus; Section characteristics: Length of member; Section area; Net area; Inertia moment (second moment of area) (I); Section modulus (W); First moment of area (S); Radius of gyration; Effective length; Slenderness; Results are presented in two columns, Z and Y respectively. Design forces:

International Design Codes Manual 733

Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)

Longitudinal force; Moments; Shear force.

Signs + and - indicate direction of acting longitudinal force, bending moments and shear forces in accordance with sign rules assumed in program STAAD. Check results in advanced form are presented with values of intermediate parameters by formulas in analytical and numerical expression with indication of SNiP clause.
======================================================================== MEMBER CROSS RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ SECTION NO. FX MZ MY LOCATION ======================================================================== 1 I60 PASS SNiP- 5.18 0.68 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00 1 I60 PASS SNiP- DISPL 0.36 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00 MATERIAL DATA Steel =C245 Modulus of elasticity = 206.E+06 KPA Design Strength (Ry) = 240.E+03 KPA SECTION PROPERTIES (units - m) Member Length = 6.00E+00 Gross Area = 1.38E-02 Net Area = 1.38E-02 z-axis y-axis Moment of inertia (I) : 768.E-06 173.E-07 Section modulus (W) : 256.E-05 182.E-06 First moment of area (S) : 149.E-05 156.E-06 Radius of gyration (i) : 236.E-03 354.E-04 Effective Length : 600.E-02 600.E-02 Slenderness : 0.00E+00 0.00E+00 DESIGN DATA (units -kN,m)SNiP II-23-81*/1998 Axial force : 0.00E+00 z-axis y-axis Moments : -465.E+00 0.00E+00 Shear force : 0.00E+00 500.E-02 CRITICAL CONDITIONS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK F.(39) M/(C1*Wmin)=-465.0E+00/ 1.12E+00* 2.56E-03= 162.1E+03 F.(41) Q/(H*T)= 500.0E-02/ 6.00E-01* 1.20E-02= 694.E+00 RY*GAMAC= 240.0E+03 ACTUAL SECTION DISPLACEMENT = 1.094E-02 M MAXIMUM MEMBER DEFLECTION = 1.094E-02 M Loading No. 1 ULTIMATE ALLOWABLE DEFLECTION VALUE = 3.000E-02 M

Conventional notations assumed in presentation of results: +, -, /, *,**, SQRT, their respective meanings (i.e., addition, subtraction, division,

734 STAAD.Pro

multiplication, raising to the second power (squared), and square root). Conventional notations of stresses, coefficients and characteristics of steel resistance comply with accepted in the SNiP standard. Only Greek letters are changed by their names (e.g., , -GAMAC; -ALPHA; -BETA, -ETA, -PHI, etc.).
c

International Design Codes Manual 735

736 STAAD.Pro

Section 13

South African Codes

International Design Codes Manual 737

738 STAAD.Pro

South African Codes - Concrete Design Per SABS-0100-1


13A.1 Design Operations
STAAD has the capability for performing design of concrete beams and columns according to the South African code SABS 0100-1. The 2000 revision of the code is currently implemented. Design can be performed for beams (flexure, shear and torsion) and columns (axial load + biaxial bending). Given the width and depth (or diameter for circular columns) of a section, STAAD will calculate the required reinforcement.

13A.2 Design Parameters


The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to SABS 0100-1. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 13A.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 13A.1 - South African Concrete Design SABS 0100-1 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as SABS0100. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BRACE

0.0

Column bracing: 0. Column braced in both directions.

International Design Codes Manual 739

South African Codes - Concrete Design Per SABS-0100-1 Parameter Name Default Value Description

1. Column braced about local Y direction only 2. Column unbraced about local Z direction only 3. Column unbraced in both Y and Z directions CLB CLS CLT DEPTH 20mm 20mm 20mm YD Clear Cover for outermost bottom reinforcement Clear Cover for outermost side reinforcement Clear Cover for outermost top reinforcement Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units.

ELY ELZ FC FYMAIN FYSEC

1.0 1.0 30N/mm2

450 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units. 450N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above.

MAXMAIN

50mm

740 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name MINMAIN

Default Value 8mm

Description

Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 28 32 36 40 50 60 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Output detail 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. Output of TRACK 1.0 List of design sag/hog moments and corresponding required steel area at each section of member

MINSEC

8mm

TRACK

0.0

WIDTH

ZD

Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.

13A.3 Member Dimensions


Concrete members that are to be designed by STAAD must have certain section properties input under the MEMBER PROPERTIES command. The following example demonstrates the required input:
UNIT MM MEMBER PROPERTIES

International Design Codes Manual 741

South African Codes - Concrete Design Per SABS-0100-1

*RECTANGULAR COLUMN 300MM WIDE X 450MM DEEP 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 300. *CIRCULAR COLUMN 300MM DIAMETER 11 13 PR YD 300. * T-SECTION - FLANGE 1000.X 200.(YD-YB) * - STEM 250(THICK) X 350.(DEEP) 14 PRISM YD 550. ZD 1000. YB 350. ZB 250.

In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450mm depth x 300mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 300mm diameter. Note that area (AX) is not provided for these members. If shear area areas (AY & AZ ) are to be considered in analysis, the user may provide them along with YD and ZD. Also note that if moments of inertias are not provided, the program will calculate them from YD and ZD. Finally a T section can be considered by using the third definition above.

13A.4 Beam Design


Beam design includes flexure, shear and torsion. For all types of beam action, all active beam loadings are scanned to create moment and shear envelopes and locate the critical sections. The total number of sections considered is thirteen. From the critical moment values, the required positive and negative bar pattern is developed. Design for flexure is carried out as per clause no. 4.3.3.4. Shear design as per SABS 0100 clause 4.3.4 has been followed and the procedure includes computation of critical shear values. From these values, stirrup sizes are calculated with proper spacing. If torsion is present, the program will also consider the provisions of SABS 0100 clause 4.3.5. Torsional reinforcement is separately reported. A TRACK 2 design output is presented below. B E A M N O. 4 D E S I G N R E S U L T S M20 Fe450 (Main) Fe450 (Sec.) LENGTH: 7500.0 mm SIZE: 380.0 mm X 715.0 mm COVER: 25.0 mm DESIGN LOAD SUMMARY (KN MET)

742 STAAD.Pro

-------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION |FLEXURE (Maxm. Sagging/Hogging moments)| SHEAR (in mm) | MZ Load Case MX Load Case | VY P Load Case -------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 135.75 5 -3.44 5 | 152.06 50.62 4 | -295.92 4 | 625.0 | 189.16 5 -3.43 5 | 133.95 48.87 4 | -236.52 4 | 1250.0 | 231.25 5 -3.41 5 | 115.84 47.12 4 | -188.44 4 | 1875.0 | 262.01 5 -3.40 5 | 97.73 45.37 4 | -151.68 4 | 2500.0 | 281.46 5 -3.39 5 | 79.61 43.63 4 | -126.24 4 | 3125.0 | 289.59 5 -3.37 5 | 61.50 41.88 4 | -112.12 4 | 3750.0 | 286.39 5 -3.36 4 | -62.13 40.13 5 | -109.32 4 | 4375.0 | 271.88 5 -3.37 4 | -80.25 41.88 5 | -117.84 4 | 5000.0 | 246.05 5 -3.39 4 | -98.36 43.63 5 | -137.68 4 | 5625.0 | 208.89 5 -3.40 4 | -116.47 45.37 5 | -168.84 4 | 6250.0 | 160.42 5 -3.41 4 | -134.58 47.12 5 | -211.33 4 |

International Design Codes Manual 743

South African Codes - Concrete Design Per SABS-0100-1

6875.0 | 100.62 5 -3.43 4 | -152.70 48.87 5 | -265.13 4 | 7500.0 | 29.50 4 -3.44 4 | -170.81 29.63 4 | -330.25 5 | SUMMARY OF REINF. AREA FOR FLEXURE DESIGN (Sq.mm) -------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | TOP | BOTTOM | STIRRUPS (in mm) | Reqd./Provided reinf. | Reqd./Provided reinf. | (2 legged) -------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 1232.70/1256.64( 4-20 )| 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 8 @ 425 mm 625.0 | 960.90/ 981.74( 2-25 )| 754.32/ 791.70( 7-12 )| 8 @ 510 mm 1250.0 | 751.24/ 791.70( 7-12 )| 937.49/ 942.48( 3-20 )| 8 @ 510 mm 1875.0 | 596.52/ 603.18( 3-16 )| 1075.72/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 510 mm 2500.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1165.13/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 510 mm 3125.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1203.00/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 3750.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1188.08/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 4375.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1120.87/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 5000.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1003.50/1005.30( 5-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 5625.0 | 668.18/ 678.60( 6-12 )| 839.38/ 904.80( 8-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm

744 STAAD.Pro

6250.0 | 849.99/ 904.80( 8-12 )| 632.84/ 678.60( 6-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm 6875.0 | 1089.94/1206.36( 6-16 )| 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm 7500.0 | 1397.16/1407.42( 7-16 )| 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm -------------------------------------------------------------------TORSION REINFORCEMENT: Not required

13A.5 Column Design


Columns are designed for axial force and biaxial bending at the ends. All active loadings are tested to calculate reinforcement. The loading which produces maximum reinforcement is called the critical load and is displayed. The requirements of SABS 0100-1 clause 4.7 are followed, with the user having control on the effective length in each direction by using the ELZ and ELY parameters as described in table 12A.1. Bracing conditions are controlled by using the BRACE parameter. The program will then decide whether or not the column is short or slender and whether it requires additional moment calculations. For biaxial bending, the recommendations of 4.7.4.4 of the code are considered. Column design is done for square, rectangular and circular sections. For rectangular and square sections, the reinforcement is always assumed to be arranged symmetrically. This causes slightly conservative results in certain cases. Table 12A.3 shows typical column design results. Using parameter TRACK 1.0, the detailed output below is obtained. TRACK 0.0 would merely give the bar configuration, required steel area and percentage, column size and critical load case. TABLE 12A.3 -COLUMN DESIGN OUTPUT ======================================================================= C O L U M N N O. 1 D E S I G N R E S U L T S M20 Fe450 (Main) Fe450 (Sec.)

International Design Codes Manual 745

South African Codes - Concrete Design Per SABS-0100-1

LENGTH: 3660.0 mm CROSS SECTION: 750.0 mm X 460.0 mm COVER:40.0mm ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 4 END JOINT: 1 SHORT COLUMN DESIGN FORCES (KNS-MET) ----------------------DESIGN AXIAL FORCE (Pu) : 915.6 About Z About Y

INITIAL MOMENTS : 0.00 0.00 MOMENTS DUE TO MINIMUM ECC. : 18.31 18.31 SLENDERNESS RATIOS : 7.96 4.88 ADDITION MOMENTS (Maddz and Maddy) : 0.00 0.00 TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 555.13 21.91 REQD. STEEL AREA : 3349.20 Sq.mm. REQD. CONCRETE AREA: 114451.62 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 32 - 12 dia. (1.05%, 3619.20 Sq.mm.) (Equally Distributed) TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 8 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 140 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY BASED ON REINFORCEMENT REQUIRED (KNS-MET) ---------------------------------------------------------Puz : 2160.42 Muz1 : 570.23 Muy1 : 563.74

746 STAAD.Pro

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993


13B.1 General
The South African Steel Design facility in STAAD is based on the SAB Standard SAB0162-1: 1993, Limit States Design of Steel Structures. A steel section library consisting of South African Standards shapes is available for member property specification. The design philosophy embodied in this specification is based on the concept of limit state design. Structures are designed and proportioned taking into consideration the limit states at which they would become unfit for their intended use. Two major categories of limit-state are recognized - ultimate and serviceability. The primary considerations in ultimate limit state design are strength and stability, while that in serviceability is deflection. Appropriate load and resistance factors are used so that a uniform reliability is achieved for all steel structures under various loading conditions and at the same time the chances of limits being surpassed are acceptably remote. In the STAAD implementation, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength, stability and serviceability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria as augmented by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type, or other such parameters. The code checking portion of the program checks whether code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The next few sections describe the salient features of the STAAD implementation of SAB0162-1: 1993. A detailed description of the design process along with its underlying concepts and assumptions is available in the specification document.

13B.2 Analysis Methodology


Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis or P-Delta

International Design Codes Manual 747

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results. Refer to Section 5.37 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information.

13B.3 Member Property Specifications


For specification of member properties, the steel section library available in STAAD may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

13B.4 Built-in Steel Section Library


The following information is provided for use when the built-in steel tables are to be referenced for member property specification. These properties are stored in a database file. If called for, the properties are also used for member design. Since the shear areas are built into these tables, shear deformation is always considered during the analysis of these members. Refer to Section 1.7.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information.

I Shapes
The following example illustrates the specification of I- shapes.
1 TO 15 TABLE ST IPE-AA100

H shapes
Designation of H shapes in STAAD is as follows. For example,
18 TO 20 TABLE ST 152X37UC

748 STAAD.Pro

PG shapes
Designation of PG shapes in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST 720X200PG

Channel Sections (C & MC shapes)


C and MC shapes are designated as shown in the following example.
3 TABLE ST 127X64X15C

Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are specified by preceding the section designation by the letter D. For example, a back to back double channel section PFC140X60 without spacing in between should be specified as:
100 TO 150 TABLE D PFC140X60

A back-to-back double channel section 140X60X16C with spacing 0.01unitlength in between should be specified as:
100 TO 150 TABLE D 140X60X16C SP 0.01

Note: The specification SP after the section designation is used for providing the spacing. The spacing should always be provided in the current length unit.

Angles
To specify angles, the letter L succeeds the angle name. Thus, a 70X70 angle with a 25mm thickness is designated as 70X70X8L. The following examples illustrate angle specifications.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST 70X70X8L

International Design Codes Manual 749

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

Note that the above specification is for standard angles. In this specification, the local z-axis (see Fig. 2.6 in the Technical Reference Manual) corresponds to the YY axis shown in the CSA table. Another common practice of specifying angles assumes the local y-axis to correspond to the Y-Y axis. To specify angles in accordance with this convention, the reverse angle designation facility has been provided. A reverse angle may be specified by substituting the word ST with the word RA. Refer to the following example for details.
100 TO 150 TABLE RA 45X45X3L

The local axis systems for STANDARD and REVERSE angles are shown in Fig. 2.6 of the STAAD Technical Reference manual.

Double Angles
To specify double angles, the specification ST should be substituted with LD (for long leg back-to-back) or SD (short leg back-to-back). For equal angles, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. Spacing between angles may be provided by using the word SP followed by the value of spacing (in current length unit) after section designation.
100 TO 150 TABLE LD 50X50X3L 3 TABLE LD 40X40X5L SP 0.01

The second example above describes a double angle section consisting of 40X40X5 angles with a spacing of 0.01 length units.

Tees
Tee sections obtained by cutting W sections may be specified by using the T specification instead of ST before the name of the W shape. For example:
100 TO 150 TABLE T IPE-AA180

will describe a T section cut from a IPE-AA180 section.

750 STAAD.Pro

Rectangular Hollow Sections


These sections may be specified in two possible ways. Those sections listed in the SAB tables may be specified as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST TUB60X30X2.5

In addition, any tube section may be specified by using the DT(for depth), WT(for width), and TH(for thickness) specifications. For example:
100 TO 150 TABLE ST TUBE TH 3 WT 100 DT 50

will describe a tube with a depth of 50mm, width of 100mm. and a wall thickness of 3mm. Note that the values of depth, width and thickness must be provided in current length unit.

Circular Hollow Sections


Sections listed in the SAB tables may be provided as follows:
100 TO 150 TABLE ST PIP34X3.0CHS

In addition to sections listed in the SAB tables, circular hollow sections may be specified by using the OD (outside diameter) and ID (inside diameter) specifications. For example:
100 TO 150 TABLE ST PIPE OD 50 ID 48

International Design Codes Manual 751

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

will describe a pipe with an outside diameter of 50 length units and inside diameter of 48 length units. Note that the values of outside and inside diameters must be provided in terms of current length unit. Sample input file to demonstrate usage of South African shapes is shown below.
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-MAR-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 9 0 0; 3 0 6 0; 4 3 6 0; 5 6 6 0; 6 9 6 0; 7 0 10.5 0; 8 9 10.5 0; 9 2.25 10.5 0; 10 6.75 10.5 0; 11 4.5 10.5 0; 12 1.5 11.4 0; 13 7.5 11.4 0; 14 3 12.3 0; 15 6 12.3 0; 16 4.5 13.2 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 7; 3 2 6; 4 6 8; 5 3 4; 6 4 5; 7 5 6; 8 7 12; 9 12 14; 10 14 16; 11 15 16; 12 13 15; 13 8 13; 14 9 12; 15 9 14; 16 11 14; 17 11 15; 18 10 15; 19 10 13; 20 7 9; 21 9 11; 22 10 11; 23 8 10; MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 TABLE ST IPE-AA100 2 TABLE T IPE120 3 TABLE ST 152X23UC 4 TABLE T 152X23UC 5 TABLE ST 812X200PG 6 TABLE T 812X200PG 7 TABLE ST 178X54X15C 8 TABLE D 178X54X15C 9 TABLE D 178X54X15C SP 0.1 10 TABLE ST 25X25X5L 11 TABLE RA 25X25X5L

752 STAAD.Pro

12 TABLE LD 25X25X5L 13 TABLE SD 25X25X5L 14 TABLE LD 25X25X5L SP 0.1 15 TABLE SD 25X25X5L SP 0.1 16 TABLE ST TUB40X2.5SHS 17 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0 WT 0 DT 50 18 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.02 WT 100 DT 50 20 TABLE ST PIP48X2.0CHS 21 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.5 ID 0.48 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH

13B.5 Section Classification


The SAB specification allows inelastic deformation of section elements. Thus, local buckling becomes an important criterion. Steel sections are classified as plastic (Class 1), compact (Class 2), noncompact (Class 3), or slender element (Class 4) sections depending upon their local buckling characteristics (See Clause 11.2 and Table 1 of SAB0162-1:1993). This classification is a function of the geometric properties of the section. The design procedures are different depending on the section class. STAAD determines the section classification for the standard shapes and user specified shapes. Design is performed for sections that fall into the category of Class 1,2, or 3 sections only. Class 4 sections are not designed by STAAD.

13B.6 Member Resistances


The member resistances are calculated in STAAD according to the procedures outlined in section 13 of the specification. These depend on several factors such as members unsupported lengths, cross-sectional properties, slenderness factors, unsupported width to thickness ratios and so on. Note that the program automatically takes into consideration appropriate resistance factors to calculate member resistances. Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating the member resistances. All the members are checked against allowable slenderness ratio as per Cl.10.2 of SAB0162-1: 1993.

International Design Codes Manual 753

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

Axial Tension
The criterion governing the capacity of tension members is based on two limit states. The limit state of yielding in the gross section is intended to prevent excessive elongation of the member. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net section area may be specified by the user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 13B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limits states per Cl.13.2 of SAB0162-1: 1993. Parameters FYLD, FU, and NSF are applicable for these calculations.

Axial Compression
The compressive resistance of columns is determined based on Clause 13.3 of the code. The equations presented in this section of the code assume that the compressive resistance is a function of the compressive strength of the gross section (Gross section Area times the Yield Strength) as well as the slenderness factor (KL/r ratios). The effective length for the calculation of compression resistance may be provided through the use of the parameters KX, KY, KZ, LX, LY, and LZ (see Table 13B.1). Some of the aspects of the axial compression capacity calculations are: 1. For frame members not subjected to any bending, and for truss members, the axial compression capacity in general column flexural buckling is calculated from Cl.13.3.1 using the slenderness ratios for the local Y-Y and Z-Z axis. The parameters KY, LY, KZ, and LZ are applicable for this. 2. For single angles, asymmetric or cruciform sections are checked as to whether torsional-flexural buckling is critical. But for KL/r ratio exceeding 50,as torsional flexural buckling is not critical, the axial compression capacities are calculated by using Cl.13.3. The reason for this is that the South African code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. The parameters KY, LY, KZ, and LZ are applicable for this. 3. The axial compression capacity is also calculated by taking flexural-torsional buckling into account. Parameters KX and LX may be used to provide the effective length factor and effective length value for flexural-torsional buckling. Flexural-torsional buckling capacity is computed for single channels, single angles, Tees and Double angles.

754 STAAD.Pro

4. While computing the general column flexural buckling capacity of sections with axial compression + bending, the special provisions of 13.8.1(a), 13.8.1(b) and 13.8.1(c) are applied. For example, Lambda = 0 for 13.8.1(a), K=1 for 13.8.1(b), etc.)

Bending
The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange for the purpose of computing the factored moment resistance is specified in STAAD with the help of the parameter UNL. If UNL is less than one tenth the member length (member length is the distance between the joints of the member), the member is treated as being continuously laterally supported. In this case, the moment resistance is computed from Clause 13.5 of the code. If UNL is greater than or equal to onetenth the member length, its value is used as the laterally unsupported length. The equations of Clause 13.6 of the code are used to arrive at the moment of resistance of laterally unsupported members. Some of the aspects of the bending capacity calculations are: 1. The weak axis bending capacity of all sections except single angles is calculated as: For Class 1 & 2 sections Phi*Py*Fy For Class 3 sections Phi*Sy*Fy Where: Phi = Resistance factor = 0.9 Py = Plastic section modulus about the local Y axis Sy = Elastic section modulus about the local Y axis Fy = Yield stress of steel 2. Single angles sections are not designed by STAAD, as the South African code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. 3. For calculating the bending capacity about the Z-Z axis of singly symmetric

International Design Codes Manual 755

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

shapes such as Tees and Double angles, SAB0162-1: 1993 stipulates in Clause 13.6(b), page 31, that a rational method.

Axial compression and bending


The member strength for sections subjected to axial compression and uniaxial or biaxial bending is obtained through the use of interaction equations. In these equations, the additional bending caused by the action of the axial load is accounted for by using amplification factors. Clause 13.8 of the code provides the equations for this purpose. If the summation of the left hand side of these equations exceeds 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 13B.1), the member is considered to have FAILed under the loading condition.

Axial tension and bending


Members subjected to axial tension and bending are also designed using interaction equations. Clause 13.9 of the code is used to perform these checks. The actual RATIO is determined as the value of the left hand side of the critical equation.

Shear
The shear resistance of the cross section is determined using the equations of Clause 13.4 of the code. Once this is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on the cross section to the shear resistance of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 13B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear. The code also requires that the slenderness ratio of the web be within a certain limit (See Cl.13.4.1.3, page 29 of SABS 0162-1:1993). Checks for safety in shear are performed only if this value is within the allowable limit. Users may by-pass this limitation by specifying a value of 2.0 for the MAIN parameter.

13B.7 Design Parameters


The design parameters outlined in table below may be used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program and thus allow the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs.

756 STAAD.Pro

The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 13B.1 - South African Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified SAB0162. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manu

BEAM

0 - Perform design at ends and those locations spec

1 - Perform design at ends and 1/12th section locati CB 1.0

Greater than 0.0 and less than 2.5,Value of Omega_ calculation Equal to 0.0: Calculate Omega_2

CMY

1.0

1 - Do not calculate Omega-1 for local Y axis. 2 - Calculate Omega-1 for local Y axis

CMZ

1.0

1 - Do not calculate Omega-1 for local Z axis. 2 - Calculate Omega-1 for local Z axis

DFF DJ1 DJ2 DMAX DMIN

0 0 0 1000 0

Default is 0 indicating that deflection check is not pe

Start node of physical member for determining defle and should be set along with DFF parameter

End node of physical member for determining deflec and should be set along with DFF parameter Maximum allowable depth Minimum required depth

International Design Codes Manual 757

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993 Parameter Name FYLD FU KT KY KZ LT LY LZ MAIN Default Value Description

300Mpa 345Mpa 1.0 1.0 1.0 Member length Member length Member length 0

Yield strength of steel Ultimate strength of steel K value for flexural torsional buckling K value in local Y-axis, usually minor axis K value in local Z-axis, usually major axis Length for flexural torsional buckling Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Flag for controlling slenderness check 0 - For Check for slenderness. 1 - For Do not check for slenderness

NSF RATIO

1.0 1.0

Net section factor for tension members Permissible ratio of applied load to section capacity

Used in altering the RHS of critical interaction equat SSY 0 Sidesway parameter 0 - Sideway about local Y-axis. 1 - No sideway about local Y-axis. SSZ 0 Sidesway parameter 0 - Sideway about local Z-axis. 1 - No sideway about local Z-axis. TRACK 0 Track parameter 0. Print the design output at the minimum detail

1. Print the design output at the intermediate de 2. Print the design output at maximum detail lev

758 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name UNB UNT

Default Value

Description

Member Length Member Length

Unsupported length in bending compression of bott resistance Unsupported length in bending compression of top resistance

13B.8 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to determine whether the current section properties of the members are adequate to carry the forces obtained from the most recent analysis. The adequacy is checked as per the SAB0162-1: 1993 requirements. Code checking is done using forces and moments at specified sections of the members. If the BEAM parameter for a member is set to 1 (which is also its default value), moments are calculated at every twelfth point along the beam. When no section locations are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero, design will be based on member start and end forces only. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from the start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Using the TRACK parameter can control the extent of detail of the output. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

Example
Sample input data for South African Code Design
PARAMETER CODE SAB0162 MAIN 1 ALL LY 4 MEMB 1 LZ 4 MEMB 1 UNL 4 MEMB 1

International Design Codes Manual 759

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

CB 0 MEMB 1 TO 23 CMZ MEMB 2 1 TO 23 CMY MEMB2 1 TO 23 SSY 0 MEMB 1 TO 23 SSZ 0 MEMB 1 TO 23 FU 450000 MEMB 1 TO 23 BEAM 1 ALL NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 1.0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 1 TO 23 CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

13B.9 Member Selection


The member selection process involves determination of the least weight member that PASSes the code checking procedure based on the forces and moments of the most recent analysis. The section selected will be of the same type as that specified initially. For example, a member specified initially as a channel will have a channel selected for it. Selection of members whose properties are originally provided from a user table will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members listed as PRISMATIC. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

13B.10 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


Results of code checking and member selection are presented in a tabular format. The term CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the SAB0162-1: 1993 specification, which governed the design.

760 STAAD.Pro

If the TRACK parameter is set to 1.0, the output will be displayed as follows:
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 ST 406X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) PASS SAB-13.8 0.543 1 0.00 0.00 -191.90 4.08 |--------------------------------------------------------------------| | FACTORED RESISTANCES FOR MEMBER1 UNIT - KN,M PHI = 0.90 | | MRZ= 353.27 MRY= 63.99 | | CR= 453.21 TR= 2308.50 VR= 642.00 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------| MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-

Factored member resistances will be printed out. Following is a description of some of the items printed out. Output Term MRZ MRY CR TR VR Description Factored moment of resistance in z direction Factored moment of resistance in y direction Factored compressive resistance for column Factored tensile capacity Factored shear resistance

Further details can be obtained by setting TRACK to 2.0. A typical output of track 2.0 parameter is as follows.
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED)

International Design Codes Manual 761

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

MEMBER ING/ TION

TABLE

RESULT/ FX

CRITICAL COND/ MY

RATIO/ MZ

LOADLOCA-

======================================================================= 1 ST 406X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) PASS SAB-13.8 0.543 1 0.00 0.00 -191.90 4.08 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 7.00E+02 IZ = 2.43E+04 SZ = 1.19E+03 PZ = 1.35E+03 IY = 1.36E+03 SY = 1.52E+02 PY = 2.37E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 4.532E+02 CRZ = 2.016E+03 CTORFLX = 4.532E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 2.308E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 4.532E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.399E+01 MRZ = 3.533E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 6.420E+02 VRZ = 6.075E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 85.000 KL/RY = 175.514 KL/RZ = 41.522 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 4.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.75 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = -6.305E+01 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 4.33E+01

Following is a description of some of the items printed out. Output Term CRY CRZ CTORFLX TENSILE CAPACITY Description Factored compressive resistance for column buckling about the local y axis Factored compressive resistance for column buckling about the local z axis Factored compressive resistance against torsional flexural buckling Factored tensile capacity

762 STAAD.Pro

Output Term COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE

Description Factored compressive capacity MRY = Factored moment of resistance in y direction MRZ = Factored moment of resistance in z direction VRY = Factored shear resistance in y direction VRZ = Factored shear resistance in z direction

13B.11 Verification Problems


In the next few pages are included three verification examples for reference purposes.

13B.11 Verification Problem No. 1


Determine the capacity of a South African I-section column in axial compression per South African steel design code (SAB:0162-1(1993)). Column is braced at its ends for both axes.

Reference
Example 4.3.4.1, page 4.18, Structural Steel Design to SAB:0162-1(1993)(Limit state Design) by Greg Parrott, 1st edition, Shades Technical publication

Given
FYLD = 300 Mpa Length = 6000 mm

International Design Codes Manual 763

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

Comparison
Table 13B.2 - SAB0162-1:1993 Verification Problem 1 Source Axial Compressive Strength (kN) 1516 1516 None

Reference STAAD.Pro Difference

Input File
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 6 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 TABLE ST 356X67UB DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 1.99947E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8191 ALPHA 6E-006 DAMP 0.03

764 STAAD.Pro

TYPE STEEL STRENGTH FY 248210 FU 399894 RY 1.5 RT 1.2 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL UNIT METER KN SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY -1500 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER 1 CODE SABS0162 LZ 6 ALL LY 3 ALL FU 450000 ALL BEAM 1 ALL NSF 0.85 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
(SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION =======================================================================

International Design Codes Manual 765

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993


1 ST 356X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) COMPRESSION 0.989 0.00 0.00

PASS 1500.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 IZ = 1.95E+04 SZ = 1.07E+03 IY = 1.36E+03 SY = 1.57E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0

1 0.00

MEMBER LENGTH = PZ = 1.21E+03 PY = 2.43E+02

6.00E+02

SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 1.516E+03 CRZ = 2.038E+03 CTORFLX = 1.516E+03 TENSILE CAPACITY = 1.918E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 1.516E+03 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.561E+01 MRZ = 1.991E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 5.903E+02 VRZ = 6.461E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 0.850 KL/RY = 75.220 KL/RZ = 39.730 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 6.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 0.000E+00 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 3.65E+01

13B.11 Verification Problem No. 2


Determine the capacity of a South African I-section beam in bending per South African steel design code (SAB:0162-1(1993)). The beam has torsional and simple lateral rotational restraint at the supports, and the applied point load provides effective lateral restraint at the point of application is braced at its ends for both axes.

Reference
Example 4.5, page 4.37, Structural Steel Design to SAB:0162-1(1993)(Limit state Design) by Greg Parrott, 1st edition, Shades Technical publication

Given
FYLD = 300 Mpa

766 STAAD.Pro

Comparison
Table 13B.3 - SAB0162-1:1993 Verification Problem 2 Source Major Axis Bending Resistance (kN) 353.4 353.3 Negligible

Reference STAAD.Pro Difference

Input File
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 10 0 0; 3 7 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 2 MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 2 TABLE ST 406X67UB DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC MATERIAL1 E 2.00E+008 POISSON 3 DENSITY 977 ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.00E+008

International Design Codes Manual 767

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

POISSON 3 DENSITY 8195 ALPHA 2E-005 DAMP 03 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 1 2 UNIT METER KN SUPPORTS 1 3 PINNED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 CON GY -104 4 1 UNI GY -4 2 UNI GY -2 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE SABS0162 CB 0 ALL UNL 4 MEMB 1 FU 450000 ALL BEAM 1 ALL NSF 85 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 1 FINISH

768 STAAD.Pro

Output
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST 406X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) PASS SAB-13.8 0.543 1 0.00 0.00 -191.90 4.08 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 7.00E+02 IZ = 2.43E+04 SZ = 1.19E+03 PZ = 1.35E+03 IY = 1.36E+03 SY = 1.52E+02 PY = 2.37E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 4.532E+02 CRZ = 2.016E+03 CTORFLX = 4.532E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 2.308E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 4.532E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.399E+01 MRZ = 3.533E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 6.420E+02 VRZ = 6.075E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 85.000 KL/RY = 175.514 KL/RZ = 41.522 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 4.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.75 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = -6.305E+01 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 4.33E+01

13B.11 Verification Problem No. 3


Determine the elastic shear capacity per South African steel design code (SAB:0162-1(1993))of a South African I-section which is simply supported over the span of 8 m.

International Design Codes Manual 769

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

Reference
Example 4.6.5, page 4.54, Structural Steel Design to SAB:0162-1(1993)(Limit state Design) by Greg Parrott, 1st edition, Shades Technical publication

Given
FYLD = 300 Mpa

Comparison
Table 13B.4 - SAB0162-1:1993 Verification Problem 3 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Shear Capacity (kN) 687.1 687.1 None

Input File
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 8 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 TABLE ST 457X67UB

770 STAAD.Pro

DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC MATERIAL1 E 2E+008 POISSON 3 DENSITY 977 ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2E+008 POISSON 3 DENSITY 8195 ALPHA 2E-005 DAMP 03 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 1 UNIT METER KN SUPPORTS 1 2 PINNED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -70 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE SABS0162 FU 450000 ALL BEAM 1 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

International Design Codes Manual 771

South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993

Output
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= * 1 ST 457X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) FAIL SAB-13.8 4.134 1 0.00 0.00 -560.00 4.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 8.00E+02 IZ = 2.94E+04 SZ = 1.30E+03 PZ = 1.47E+03 IY = 1.45E+03 SY = 1.53E+02 PY = 2.37E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 3.738E+02 CRZ = 1.996E+03 CTORFLX = 3.738E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 2.257E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 3.738E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.399E+01 MRZ = 1.355E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 6.871E+02 VRZ = 5.730E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 194.263 KL/RZ = 43.142 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 8.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 0.000E+00 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 5.04E+01

772 STAAD.Pro

Section 14

American Aluminum Code


14.1 General
STAAD is equipped with the facilities to perform design based on the specifications for Aluminum Structures. The requirements of the Allowable Stress Design, Sixth edition, October 1994, have been implemented. The various issues related to the implementation of this code in STAAD are explained in the next few sections.

14.2 Member Properties


In order to do this design in STAAD, the members in the structure must have their properties specified from Section VI of the above-mentioned manual. The section names are mentioned in Tables 5 through 28 of that manual. All of those tables except Table 10 (Wing Channels) and Table 20 (Bulb Angles) are available in STAAD. Described below is the command specification for various sections:

International Design Codes Manual 773

Standard single section


MEMB-LIST TA ST SECTION-NAME

Example:
1 TO 5 TA ST CS12X11.8 9 TA ST I8.00X13.1 11 33 45 67 TA ST LS8.00X8.00X0.625 18 TA ST 1.50PIPEX160 15 TA ST T(A-N)6.00X8.00X11.2 23 25 29 TA ST 20X12RECTX.500WALL

Double channel back-to-back


MEMB-LIST TA BACK SECTION-NAME SPACING VALUE

Example
3 TA BACK C(A-N)7X3.61 SPACING 1.5 5 TA BACK C15X17.33 SP 0.75

Double channel front-to-front


MEMB-LIST TA FRONT SECTION-NAME SPACING VALUE

Example
2 TA FRONT CS12X10.3 SP 1.0 4 TA FR CS10X10.1 SP 0.5

Double angle long leg back-to-back


MEMB-LIST TA LD SECTION-NAME SPACING VALUE

Example

774 STAAD.Pro

14 TA LD LS4.00X3.00X0.375 SP 1.5

Double angle short leg back-to-back


MEMB-LIST TA SD SECTION-NAME SPACING VALUE

Example
12 TA SD L3.5X3X0.5 SP 0.25 13 TA SD L8X6X0.75 SP 1.0

14.3 Design Procedure


The design is done according to the rules specified in Sections 4.1, 4.2 and 4.4 on pages I-A-41 and I-A-42 of the Aluminum code. The allowable stresses for the various sections are computed according to the equations shown in Section 3.4.1 through 3.4.21 on pages I-A-27 through I-A-40. The adequacy of the member is checked by calculating the value of the left-hand side of equations 4.1.1-1, 4.1.1-2, 4.1.1-3, 4.1.2-1, 4.4-1 and 4.4-2. This left-hand side value is termed as RATIO. If the highest RATIO among these equations turns out to be less than or equal to 1.0, the member is declared as having PASSed. If it exceeds 1.0, the member has FAILed the design requirements. Note: The check for torsion per Clause 4.3 for open sections is currently not implemented in STAAD.Pro.

14.4 Design Parameters


The following are the parameters for specifying the values for variables associated with the design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 775

Table 14A.1 - Aluminum Design Parameters Parameter Name Default Value Description

CODE

Must be specified as ALUMINUM Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

ALCLAD

This variable can take on a value of either 0 or 1. 0 - Material used in the section is not an Alclad. 1 - Material used in the section is an Alclad.

ALLOY

34

This variable can take on a value from 1 through 40. The default value represents the alloy 6061-T6. See Table 14A.2 below for a list of values for this parameter and the alloy they represent. Table 3.3-1 in Section I-B of the Aluminum specifications provides information on the properties of the various alloys.

776 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value 0.0

Description

BEAM

If this parameter is set to 1.0, the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member. If the BEAM value is 0.0, the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details). If neither the BEAM parameter nor any SECTION command is specified, STAAD will terminate the run and ask the user to provide one of those 2 commands. This rule is not enforced for TRUSS members. Maximum depth permissible for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Minimum depth required for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units.

DMAX

1000 in.

DMIN

0.0 in

International Design Codes Manual 777

Parameter Name

Default Value 1.0

Description

KT

Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. See Equation 3.4.7.2-6 on page I-A-28 of the Aluminum specifications for details.

KY

1.0

Effective length factor for overall column buckling in the local Y-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression.

778 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value 1.0

Description

KZ

Effective length factor for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. See Equation 3.4.7.2-6 on page I-A-28 of the Aluminum specifications for details.

LT

Member length

International Design Codes Manual 779

Parameter Name

Default Value Member length

Description

LY

Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression.

LZ

Member length

780 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value 1

Description

PRODUCT

This variable can take on a value from 1 through 4. They represent: 1 - All 2 - Extrusions 3 - Drawn Tube 4 - Pipe The default value stands for All. The PRODUCT parameter finds mention in Table 3.3-1 in Section I-B of the Aluminum specifications.

International Design Codes Manual 781

Parameter Name

Default Value 0.0

Description

SSY

Factor that indicates whether or not the structure is subjected to sidesway along the local Y axis of the member. The values are: 0 - Sidesway is present along the local Y-axis of the member 1 - There is no sidesway along the local Y-axis of the member. The sidesway condition is used to determine the value of Cm explained in Section 4.1.1, page I-A41 of the Aluminum specifications.

782 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value 0.0

Description

SSZ

Factor that indicates whether or not the structure is subjected to sidesway along the local Z axis of the member. The values are: 0 - Sidesway is present along the local Z-axis of the member 1 - There is no sidesway along the local Z-axis of the member. The sidesway condition is used to determine the value of Cm explained in Section 4.1.1, page I-A41 of the Aluminum specifications.

STIFF

Member length

Spacing in the longitudinal direction of shear stiffeners for stiffened flat webs. It is input in the current units of length. See section 3.4.21 on page I-A-40 of the Aluminum specifications for information regarding this parameter.

International Design Codes Manual 783

Parameter Name

Default Value 1

Description

STRUCTURE

In Table 3.4-1 in Section I-A of the Aluminum specifications, it is mentioned that the value of coefficients nu, ny and na are dependent upon whether the structure being designed is a building or a bridge. Users may convey this information to STAAD using the parameter STRUCTURE. The values that can be assigned to this parameter are: 1 - Buildings and similar type structures 2 - Bridges and similar type structures

784 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value 2

Description

TRACK

This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 1 - Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 2 - Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 1 3 - Prints the member properties and alloy properties in addition to that printed byTRACK 2. 4 - Prints the values of variables used in design in addition to that printed by TRACK 3.

UNL

Member length

Distance between points where the compression flange is braced against buckling or twisting. This value must be provided in the current units. This value is used to compute the allowable stress in bending compression.

International Design Codes Manual 785

Parameter Name

Default Value 0

Description

WELD

In Table 3.4-2 in Section I-A of the Aluminum specifications, it is mentioned that the value of coefficients Kt and Kc are dependent upon whether or not, the location of the section where design is done is within 1.0 inch of a weld. The WELD parameter is used in STAAD for this purpose. The values that can be assigned to this parameter are: 0 - Region is farther than 1.0in from a weld 1 - Region is within 1.0in from a weld

Aluminum Alloys available in STAAD Table 14A.2 - Alloy Parameters Value 1 2 3 4 5 6 Name 1100-H12 1100-H14 2014-T6 2014-T6510 2014-T6511 2014-T651

786 STAAD.Pro

Value 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30

Name 3003-H12 3003-H14 3003-H16 3003-H18 3004-H32 3004-H34 3004-H36 3004-H38 5005-H12 5005-H14 5005-H32 5005-H34 5050-H32 5050-H34 5052-H32 5052-H34 5083-H111 5086-H111 5086-H116 5086-H32 5086-H34 5454-H111 5454-H112 5456-H111

International Design Codes Manual 787

Value 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40

Name 5456-H112 6005-T5 6105-T5 6061-T6 6061-T6510 6061-T6511 6061-T651 6063-T5 6063-T6 6351-T5

14.5 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to determine whether the initially specified member properties are adequate to carry the forces transmitted to the member due to the loads on the structure. Code checking is done at the locations specified by either the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter described above. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Example Problem 1 in the Getting Started and Tutorials Manual for STAAD provides an example on the usage of the CHECK CODE command.

Example
Sample input data for Aluminum Design
PARAMETER CODE ALUMINUM BEAM 1 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4

788 STAAD.Pro

ALLOY 35 ALL PRODUCT 2 ALL TRACK 3 ALL SELECT ALL ALCLAD 1 ALL STRUCT 1 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

14.6 Member Selection


The member selection process involves the determination of the least weight member that PASSes the code checking procedure based on the forces and moments of the most recent analysis. The section selected will be of the same type as that specified initially. For example, a member specified initially as a channel will have a channel selected for it. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. Example Problem 1 in the Getting Started and Tutorials Manual for STAAD provides an example on the usage of the SELECT MEMBER command.

International Design Codes Manual 789

790 STAAD.Pro

Section 15

American Transmission Tower Code

International Design Codes Manual 791

792 STAAD.Pro

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97


15A.1 General Comments
The design of structural steel members in accordance with the specifications of ASCE Standard 10-97 Design of Latticed Steel Transmission Structures is now implemented. This code is meant to supercede the older edition of the code, available under the name ASCE Publication 52. However, in the interests of backward compatibility, both codes are currently accessible in STAAD.Pro. To access the ASCE 52 code, use the commands
PARAMETER CODE ASCE 52

To access the ASCE 10-97 code, use the commands


PARAMETER CODE ASCE

In general, the concepts followed in MEMBER SELECTION and CODE CHECKING procedures are similar to that of the AISC based design. It is assumed that the user is familiar with the basic concepts of steel design facilities available in STAAD. Please refer to Section 2 of the STAAD Technical Reference Manual for detailed information on this topic. This section specifically addresses the implementation of steel design based on ASCE 10-97. Design is available for all standard sections listed in the AISC ASD 9th edition manual, namely, Wide Flanges, S, M, HP, Tees, Channels, Single Angles, Double Angles, Tubes and Pipes. Design of HSS sections (those listed in the 3rd edition AISC LRFD manual) and Composite beams (I shapes with concrete slab on top) is not supported.

15A.2 Allowable Stresses per ASCE 10 - 97


Member selection and code checking operations in the STAAD implementation of ASCE 10-97 are done to resist loads at stresses approaching yielding, buckling, fracture and other limiting conditions specified in the standard. Those stresses are

International Design Codes Manual 793

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97

referred to in the standard as Design Stresses. The appropriate sections of the ASCE standard where the procedure for calculating the design stresses is explained are as follows.

Design Axial Tensile Stress


Design tensile stresses are calculated on the basis of the procedure described in section 3.10. The NSF parameter (see the Parameters table shown later in this section) may be used if the section area needs to be reduced to account for bolt holes.

Design Axial Compressive Stress


Design compressive stress calculation is based on the procedures of section 3.6 through 3.9. For angle members under compression, the procedures of sections 3.7 and 3.8 have been implemented. Capacity of the section is computed for column buckling and wherever applicable, torsional buckling. The user may control the effective lengths for buckling using the LT, LY, LZ and/or KT, KY, KZ parameters (see the Parameters table shown later in this section).

Design Bending Compressive Stress


Calculations for design bending compressive stress about the major axis and minor axis are based on the procedures of section 3.14. Procedures outlined in sections 3.14.1 through 3.14.6 have been implemented.

Design Bending Tensile Stress


Calculations for design bending tensile stress about the major and minor axis are based on the procedures of section 3.14.2.

Design Shear Stress


Calculation of the design shear stress is based on the procedure outlined in section 3.15 of the ASCE 10-97. The procedure of section 3.15.2 is followed for angles and the procedure of section 3.15.1 is followed for all other sections.

794 STAAD.Pro

15A.3 Critical Conditions used as criteria to determine Pass/Fail status


These are Clause 3.4 for slenderness limits, Clause 3.12 for Axial Compression and Bending, Clause 3.13 for Axial Tension and Bending, Clause 3.9.2 for Maximum w/t ratios and Clause 3.15 for Shear.

15A.4 Design Parameters


Design per ASCE (10-97) must be initiated by using the command CODE ASCE. This command should be the first command after the PARAMETER statement. Other applicable parameters are summarized in the table shown later in this section. These parameters may be used to control the design process to suit specific modeling needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 15A.1 - Steel Design Parameters for ASCE 10-97 Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as ASCE to design per ASCE 10-97. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

1.0

0 = Perform design at beam ends and section locations specified according to the SECTION command 1 = Perform design at the ends and eleven intermediate sections of the beam

International Design Codes Manual 795

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97 Parameter Name CMY CMZ Default Value 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 45.0 in. 0.75 in. Description

Cm value in local y and z axes as defined in equation 3.12-1 on p.10 of ASCE 10-97.

DMAX DBL

Maximum allowable depth for member selection Diameter of bolt for calculation of number of bolts required and the net section factor. Minimum allowable depth for member selection Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used from among Equations 3.7-4 thru 3.7-7 to determine the KL/R ratio. 1. EQN.3.7-4, Page 4 (VALID FOR LEG MEMBERS ONLY) 2. EQN.3.7-5, Page 4 3. EQN.3.7-6, Page 4 4. EQN.3.7-7, Page 5

DMIN ELA

0.0 in. 4

ELB

Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used from among Equations. 3.7-8 thru 3.710 and 3.7-12 thru 3.7-14 to determine the KL/R ratio. 1. EQN.3.7-8, Page 5, EQN.3.712, Page 5 2. EQN.3.7-9, Page 5, EQN.3.713, Page 5

796 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

3. EQN.3.7-10, Page 5, EQN.3.7-14,Page 5 FVB FYB FYLD KT 30 KSI 36 KSI 36.0 KSI 1.0 Shear strength of bolt. Yield strength of bolt. Yield Strength of steel Effective length coefficient for warping restraint (clause 3.14.4, pg 11) Effective length factor (K) for compression buckling about the Yaxis (minor axis) Effective length factor (K) for compression buckling about the Zaxis (major axis) This parameter is meant for plain angles. 0. indicates that the angle is connected by both legs and allowable stress in axial tension is 1.0FYLD. 1. indicates that the angle is connected only by the shorter leg and allowable tensile stress is computed per clause 3.10.2 as 0.9FYLD. 2. indicates that the angle is connected by the longer leg. LT LY Member Length Member Length Effective length for warping. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about the Y-axis

KY

1.0

KZ

1.0

LEG

0.0

International Design Codes Manual 797

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97 Parameter Name Default Value Description

(minor axis) LZ Member Length 2 Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about the Z-axis (major axis) Parameter that indicates the member type for the purpose of calculating the KL/R ratio (SEE CLAUSE 3.4, PAGE 3, ASCE 10-97) 1. Leg member, KL/R <= 150 2. Compression member, KL/R <= 200 3. Tension member, KL/R <= 500 4. Hanger member, KL/R <= 375 (Clause 4C.4, page 43) 5. Redundant member, KL/R <= 250 10. Do not perform the KL/R Check NHL 0 Number of bolt holes on the cross section that should be used to determine the net section factor for tension capacity. Net section factor for tension members Permissible ratio that determines the cut off point for pass/fail status. A value below this quantity indicates PASS while a value greater than this quantity indicates FAILURE.

MAIN

NSF RATIO

1.0 1.0

798 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name SSY

Default Value 0.0

Description

0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis 1.0 = No sidesway

SSZ TRACK

0.0 0.0

Same as above except in local zaxis 0.0 = Suppresses printing of allowable stresses 1.0 = Prints all allowable stresses

UNB

Member Length

Unsupported length of the bottom flange for calculating flexural strength. Will be used only if flexural compression is on the bottom flange. Same as UNL, but provided as a fraction of the member length Unsupported length of member for calculation of allowable bending stress

UNF UNL

1.0 Member Length

UNT

Member Length

Unsupported length of the top flange for calculating flexural strength. Will be used only if flexural compression is on the top flange.

Note: All values must be provided in the current unit system.

15A.5 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available in the ASCE 10-97 implementation.

International Design Codes Manual 799

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97

Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

800 STAAD.Pro

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports
15B.1 General Comments
This document presents some general statements regarding the implementation of the Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports on Engineering Practice No. 52 Guide for Design of Steel Transmission Towers, Second Edition. The design philosophy and procedural logistics for member selection and code checking is based upon the principles of allowable stress design. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing and failure by stability considerations. The following sections describe the salient features regarding the process of calculation of the relevant allowable stresses and the stability criteria being used. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the allowable stresses and the most economical section is selected based on the least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program also checks the slenderness requirements, the minimum metal thickness requirements and the width-thickness requirements. It is generally assumed that the user will take care of the detailing requirements like provision of stiffeners and check the local effects like flange buckling, web crippling, etc. It general, it may be noted that the concepts followed in MEMBER SELECTION and CODE CHECKING procedures are similar to that of the AISC based design. It is assumed that the user is familiar with the basic concepts of Steel Design facilities available in STAAD. Please refer to Section 3 of the STAAD Technical Reference Manual for detailed information on this topic. This document specifically addresses the implementation of steel design based on ASCE Pub. 52.

15B.2 Allowable Stresses per ASCE (Pub. 52)


The member design and code checking in the STAAD implementation of ASCE (Pub. 52) is based upon the allowable stress design method. Appropriate sections of this publication are referenced below.

Allowable Axial Tensile Stress


Allowable tensile stresses are calculated on the basis of the procedure described in section 4.10. The NSF parameter (Table 1.1) may be used if the net section area needs to be used.

International Design Codes Manual 801

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports

Allowable Axial Compressive Stress


Allowable compressive stress calculation is based on the procedures of section 4.6 through 4.9. For angle members under compression, the procedures of sections 4.7 and 4.8 have been implemented. Capacity of the section is computed for column buckling and wherever applicable, torsional buckling. The user may control the effective lengths for buckling using the LX, LY, LZ and/or KX, KY, KZ parameters (Table 1.1).

Allowable Bending Compressive Stress


Calculations for allowable bending compressive stress about the major axis and minor axis are based on the procedures of section 4.14. Procedures outlined in sections 4.14.1 through 4.14.6 have been implemented.

Allowable Bending Tensile Stress


Calculations for allowable bending tensile stress about the major and minor axis are based on the procedures of Section 4.14.2.

Allowable Shear Stress


Calculation of the allowable shear stress is based on the procedure outlined in section 4.15 of the ASCE Pub. 52. The procedure of section 4.15.2 is followed for angles and the procedure of section 4.15.1 is followed for all other sections.

Critical Conditions used as criteria to determine Pass/Fail status


These are Clause 4.4 for slenderness limits, Equation 4.12-1 for Axial Compression and Bending, Equation 4.13-1 for Axial Tension and Bending, Clause 4.9.2 for Maximum w/t ratios and Clause 4.15 for Shear.

15B.3 Design Parameters


Design per ASCE (Pub. 52) must be initiated by using the command CODE ASCE 52. This command should be the first command after the PARAMETER statement. Other applicable parameters are summarized in Table 15A.1. These parameters may be used to control the design process to suit specific modeling needs. The

802 STAAD.Pro

default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design.

15B.4 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available in the ASCE Pub. 52 implementation. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

15B.5 Parameter Definition Table


Table 15B.1 - Steel Design Parameters for ASCE (Pub. 52) Based Design Parameter Default Name Value KY KZ KT LY LZ LT FYLD NSF UNL 1.0 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length Member Length 36.0 KSI 1.0 Member Length Description Effective length factor (K) for compression buckling about the Y-axis (minor axis) Effective length factor (K) for compression buckling about the Z-axis (major axis) Effective length coefficient for warping restraint (clause 4.14.4, pg 36) Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about the Y-axis (minor axis) Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about the Z-axis (major axis) Effective length for warping. Yield Strength of steel Net section factor for tension members Unsupported length of member for calculation of allowable bending stress

International Design Codes Manual 803

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports Parameter Default Name Value UNF TRACK 1.0 0.0 Description Same as UNL, but provided as a fraction of the member length 0.0 = Suppresses printing of allowable stresses 1.0 = Prints all allowable stresses Maximum allowable depth for member selection Minimum allowable depth for member selection Permissible ratio that determines the cut off point for pass/fail status. A value below this quantity indicates PASS while a value greater than this quantity indicates FAILURE. 2.0 = Perform design using the section locations specified according to the SECTION
command

DMAX DMIN RATIO

45.0 in. 0.0 in. 1.0

BEAM

0.0

3.0 = Perform design at the ends and eleven intermediate sections of the beam

804 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Default Name Value MAIN 2

Description Parameter that indicates the member type for the purpose of calculating the KL/R ratio (SEE CLAUSE 4.4, PAGE 25) = 10 : DO NOT PERFORM THE KL/R CHECK = 1 : LEG MEMBER KL/R <= 150 = 2 : COMPRESSION MEMBER KL/R <= 200 = 3 : TENSION MEMBER KL/R <= 500 = 4 : HANGAR MEMBERS KL/R <= 375 (Clause 4C.4, page 43) = 5 : REDUNDANT MEMBERS KL/R <= 250 Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used From among Equations 4.7-4 thru 4.7-7 to determine the the KL/R ratio. ELA=1 : EQN.4.7-4, Page 26 (VALID FOR LEG MEMBERS ONLY) ELA=2 : EQN.4.7-5, Page 27 ELA=3 : EQN.4.7-6, Page 27 ELA=4 : EQN.4.7-7, Page 27

ELA

International Design Codes Manual 805

American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports Parameter Default Name Value ELB 1 Description Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used from among Equations. 4.7-8 thru 4.7-10 to determine the KL/R ratio. ELB=1 : EQN.4.7-8, Page 27, EQN.4.712, Page 28 ELB=2 : EQN.4.7-9, Page 27, EQN.4.713, Page 28 ELB=3 : EQN.4.7-10, Page 27, EQN.4.714,Page28 This parameter is meant for plain angles. 3.0 = indicates that the angle is connected by both legs and allowable stress in
axial tension is 1.0 FYLD.

LEG

0.0

4.0 = indicates that the angle is connected only by the shorter leg and allowable
tensile stress is computed per clause 4.10.2 as 0.9FYLD.

DBL FYB FVB NHL

5.0 = indicates that the angle is connected by the longer leg. 0.75 in. Diameter of bolt for calculation of number of bolts required and the net section factor. 36 KSI Yield strength of bolt. 30 KSI Shear strength of bolt. 0 Number of bolt holes on the cross section that should be used to determine the net section
factor for tension capacity.

Notes:
l

All values must be provided in the current unit system. Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

806 STAAD.Pro

Section 16

Steel Design per American Petroleum Institute Code


The API Steel Design facility in STAAD is based on the API 2A-WSD standard, titled "Recommended Practice for Planning, Design and Constructing Fixed Offshore Platforms-Working Stress Design," 21st Edition.

16.1 Design Operations


STAAD contains a broad set of facilities for the design of structural members as individual components of an analyzed structure. The member design facilities provide the user with the ability to carry out a number of different design operations. These facilities may be used selectively in accordance with the requirements of the design problem. The operations to perform a design are:
l

Specify the members and the load cases to be considered in the design; Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection;

International Design Codes Manual 807

Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values; and Specify design parameters to carry out punching shear checks.

These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements, but care should be taken when coupled with manipulation of the punching shear LEG parameter. The basic process is as follows: 1. Define the STAAD model geometry, loading and analysis. 2. Define the API code parameters with LEG 1.0. 3. Run the analysis and API design which creates the Geometry file and give preliminary design results. 4. Check and modify the Geometry file as necessary. 5. Reset the LEG parameter to 2.0 and re-run the analysis to read the modified Geometry file for the final design results.

16.2 Allowables per API Code


For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as defined by the American Petroleum Institute (API-RP2A) Code. The 21st edition of API Code, as published in 2007, is used as the basis of this design (except for tension stress).

16.2.1 Tension Stress


Allowable tension stresses, as calculated in STAAD, are based on the API Code, clause (3.2.1-1). Allowable tension stress on the net section F = 0.60F
t y

16.2.2 Shear Stress


Beam Shear Stress
Allowable beam shear stress on the gross section must conform to Clause 3.2.4-2 of the APIcode:

808 STAAD.Pro

F = 0.4F
v

The maximum applied beam shear stress is per Eqn 3.2.4-1: f = V / 0.5 A
v

Torsional Shear Stress


Allowable torsional shear stress per Eqn. 3.2.4-4: F
vt vt

= 0.4F

F is the maximum torsional shear stress per Clause 3.2.4-3 of the API code.

16.2.3 Stress Due to Compression


The allowable compressive stress on the gross section of axially loaded compression members is calculated based on the formula 3.2.2-1 in the API Code when the largest effective slenderness ratio, Kl/ris less than or equal to C . If Kl/r c exceeds C , then the allowable compressive stress is increased as per formula c (3.2.2-2) of the Code. Where:

For D/t > 60, the lesser of F Where:

xe

or F

xc

is substituted for F .
xy

F = the elastic local buckling stress calculated with C, the critical xe elastic buckling coefficient = 0.3 (3.2.2-3) F
xc

= the inelastic local buckling stress. (3.2.2-4)

16.2.4 Bending Stress


The allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a symmetrical member loaded in the plane of its minor axis, as given in Clause 3.2.3 of the API code, is: a. When D/t 1,500/F (Imperial Units),
y

F = 0.75F
b

International Design Codes Manual 809

b. When 1,500/F <D/t 3,000/F (Imperial Units),


y y

F = [0.84 - 1.74 F D/(Et)]F


b y y

c. When 3,000/F <D/t 300 (Imperial Units), F = [0.72 - 0.58 F D/(Et)]F


b y y

16.2.5 Combined Compression and Bending


Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are proportioned to satisfy API formula 3.3.1-1 and 3.3.1-2 when f /F > 0.15, a a otherwise formula 3.3.1-3 applies. It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F > 1.0, the program does not compute the second a a 3.3.1-1/2.

16.6 Design Parameters


The program contains a large number of parameter names which are required to perform design and code checks. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in Table 16.1. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements for an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. For example, by default the KZ value (k value in local z-axis) of a member is set to 1.0, wile in the real structure it may be 1.5. In that case, the KZ value in the program can be changed to 1.5, as shown in the input instruction (Section 5). Similarly, the TRACK value of a member is set to 0.0, which means no allowable stresses of the member will be printed. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 16C.1 - American (API) Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as API

810 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 1.0 0.0 = design only for end moments or those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate moments at twelfth points along the beam, and use the maximum Mz location for design. 2.0 = Same for BEAM1.0, but additional check is made at each end. CB 1.0 Cb value as used in Section 1.5 of AISC 0.0 = Cb value to be calculated Any other value will mean the value to be used in design CMY CMZ DMAX DMIN 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.0 0.0 Cm value in local y & z axes Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable

International Design Codes Manual 811

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

depth FYLD KY 36 KSI 1.0 Yield strength of steel. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. KZ 1.0 K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. LEG 1.0 2.0 To write out external parameters file. To read in the external parameters file. LY Member Length Length in local Y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Length in local Z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. 1.0 = Main member 2.0 = Secondary member NSF RATIO 1.0 1.0 Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses

LZ

Member Length

MAIN

0.0

812 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name SSY

Default Value

Description

0.0

0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis 1.0 = No sidesway

SSZ TRACK

0.0 0.0

Same as above except in local z-axis 1.0 = Print all critical member stresses 100.0 = Suppress all checks except punching shear

UNL

Member Length

Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length

UNF

1.0

WELD

1 for closed sections Weld type, as explained in section 3.1.1. 2 for open sections 1. = Welding is one side only except for wide flange or tee sections, where the web is always assumed to be welded on both sides. 2. = Welding is both sides. For closed sections like pipe or tube,

International Design Codes Manual 813

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

the welding will be only on one side. WSTR WMIN 0.4 X FLYD 1.16 in. Allowable welding stress Minimum thickness

Note: The parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used for member selection.

16.7 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to ascertain whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate as per API. Code checking is done using the forces and moments at specific sections of the members. If no sections are specified, the program uses the start and end forces for code checking. When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks, the critical condition of API code (like any of the API specifications for compression, tension, shear, etc.), the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value), the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the number of forces in the member) where the critical condition occurs. Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2.2, American Steel Design, of the Technical Reference manual. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.

16.8 Member Selection


STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section, i.e., the lightest section which fulfills the code requirements for the specified member. The section selected will be of the same type section as

814 STAAD.Pro

originally designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN which limits the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Member selection can be performed with all types of hollow steel sections. Selection of members whose properties are originally input from a user created table will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

16.9 Truss Members


A truss member is capable of carrying only axial force. So in design, no time is wasted calculating the allowable bending or shear stresses, thus reducing design time considerably. Therefore, if there is any truss member in an analysis (like bracing or strut, etc.), it is wise to declare it as a truss member rather than as a regular frame member with both ends pinned.

16.10 Punching Shear


For tubular members, punching shear may be checked in accordance with the American Petroleum Institute (API) RP 2A 20th Edition Section 4. The parameter PUNCH is used to identify joint types for each end of the member where the punching shear check is required. The PUNCH parameter is only read in from the external geometry file. The external geometry file is described in section 16.13. The PUNCH parameter is not specified within the STAAD input file ( .STD file extension). Table 16C.2 - Joint identification for punching shear check Type of Joint and Geometry Req. Value of Parameter PUNCH K (overlap) K (gap) 1.0 2.0

International Design Codes Manual 815

Type of Joint and Geometry

Req. Value of Parameter PUNCH

T&Y CROSS CROSS (with/diaphragms)

3.0 4.0 5.0

Note: A value representing joint type and geometry must be provided for parameter PUNCH, in the external file. On the first run where no external table is present, LEG must equal 1.0.

16.11 Generation of the Geometry File


Automatic selection of the chord and brace members is performed with the parameter LEG 1.0. Two tubular members are used by the program to identify the chord member. The chord members must be collinear (5 degree tolerance). The chord member must have a greater diameter and thickness than the brace member being considered. The punching shear check is performed on the joint treating it as a T/Y joint. The yield stress of the brace is used. In the 50% strength check the brace and chord yield are assumed to be the same. The major moment axis Mz is taken as In Plane Bending (IPB). To change this, the parameter SWAP 1 should be used in the external geometry file. Note: The in-plane/out-of-plane correspondence can be set by using the BETA angle. If the punching shear cannot be performed at the joint for the member being considered, a message is written to the output file <filename>.ANL. If a punching shear check is performed with the parameter LEG 1.0 used, then the geometry data used to perform the check is written to the default external output file APIPUN.

816 STAAD.Pro

The default external output/input file name can be changed by using the command line: CODE API <filename>. This external output data file can be edited and used as an external input file to reperform the check using the parameter PUNCH 1.0 to 5.0. This external input file allows can/stub geometry data to be specified and chords to be assigned geometry where they could not be identified in the Automatic selection. The parameter LEG 2.0 must be used to read an external input file where the default name is APIPUN. The yield strength of the brace is used in the punching shear check. This can be changed in the external geometry file. The user should ensure that the correct cord member has been selected for the check.

16.12 Chord Selection and Q Paramf eter


Q is a factor to account for the presence of nominal longitudinal stress in the f chord. When calculating Q for the joints, the moments used in the chord stress f calculation will be from the computer node results and not the representative moments underneath the brace. If the moment varies significantly along the chord, it is more accurate to use the actual chord moment in the middle of the brace foot print. The tests reported in Reference I[1] were performed with a constant moment along the chord. Thus for a local joint check, the local chord moment (under the brace) should be used. STAAD calculates Q based on the moment at the chord member. The chord f member can be selected automatically by initial screening by the program (based on geometry and independent of loading) or specified in the External file. In the automatic selection of the chord two collinear members (5 degree tolerance) are used to identify the chord. The chord is then selected from one of the two members based on the larger diameter then thickness or then by the minimum framing angle; for T joints the first member modeled will be selected as the chord. You should confirm that the chord either be assigned by the program or the user is representative of the local chord moment for the brace in question.

International Design Codes Manual 817

Reference
1 Ref I: Boone, TJ. Yura, JA. and Hoadley, PW. Ultimate Strength if Tubular Joints Chord Stress Effects, OTC 4828, 1984

16.13 External Geometry File


An example of the external geometry file is shown below:
BRACE 209 209 212 CHORD 211 210 202 PUNCH 3 3 3 D 17.992 17.992 17.992 T 0.984 0.984 0.787 D 12.752 12.752 12.752 T 0.787 0.787 0.787 GAP 0.000 0.000 0.000 FYLD 50.00 50.00 50.00

THETA 0.00 0.00 0.00

The parameters used in the external file are defined as follows: Table 16C.3 - External File Parameter Name PUNCH BRACE CHORD D T d T GAP Description Parameter for punching shear (See Section 12.10) Member number of brace Member number of chord Chord Diameter in inches Chord Thickness in inches Brace Diameter in inches Brace Thickness in inches Gap in inches (must be negative for overlap K-joint)

818 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name FYLD THETAT TW

Description Local yield strength used for joint in KIPS Angle of through brace in overlap K-joint in Degrees

Used in overlap K-joint, taken as the lesser of the weld throat thickn thinner brace in inches

SWAP

If parameter SWAP 0 is used then major moment Mz is taken for In SWAP 1 uses the minor moment My as the IPB.

Notes:
l

For overlap K-joints, the through brace is assumed to be the same diameter as the brace being checked. If any of the parameters for diameter and thickness specified in the external file are less than that for members being checked, then the member properties specified in the STAAD file shall be used. The member diameter and thickness should be used in API equation (4.1-1); in this check it has been assumed that the yield strength of the chord and brace members are the same. The geometry file name is currently limited to eight characters (4 if an extension as .TXT is used).

The overall process of performing punching shear checks consists of two steps. These steps are explained in section 16.16.

16.14 Limitations
The parameter SELECT 1.0 should not be used while carrying out punching shear checks. It can be used in initial runs for member selection. No classification of the joint is performed using the loading. No hydrostatic checks are performed.

International Design Codes Manual 819

16.15 Tabulated Results of Steel Design


For code checking or member selection, the program produces the results in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. Member refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b. TABLE refers to AISC steel section name which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c. RESULTS prints whether the member has PASSed or FAILed. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark on front of the member. d. CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the AISC code which governs the design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis, and the moment in local Z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. i. If the parameter TRACK is set to 1.0, the program will block out part of the table and will print the allowable bending stressed in compression (FCY & FCZ) and tension (FTY & FTZ), allowable axial stress in compression (FA), and allowable shear stress (FV).

16.16 The Two-Step Process


The overall procedure for performing the code check per the API code is as follows:

820 STAAD.Pro

Step 1
Creating the geometry data file. This is done by specifying the name of the geometry data file alongside the command line CODE API. If a file name is not specified, STAAD automatically assigns the file name APIPUN to the geometry data file. The parameter instructions in the .STD file should contain the LEG parameter and it should be assigned the value 1.0. Example Reading External Geometry File
UNIT INCHES KIPS PARAMETERS * ALL JOINT DATA WILL BE WRITTEN TO EXTERNAL FILE GEOM1 FOR PUNCHING SHEAR. CODE API GEOM1 LEG 1.0 * JOINTS TO BE CONSIDERED AS T AND Y, I.E., PUNCH IS SET TO 3.0. FYLD 50.0 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL RATIO 1.0 ALL BEAM 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

After ensuring that your STAAD input file contains the above data, run the analysis. Once the analysis is completed, you will find that a file by the name GEOM1 has been created and is located in the same folder as the one where your .std file is located. (In case you did not specify a file name - GEOM1 shown in the earlier example - STAAD will create the file named APIPUN.

Step 2
The geometry data file (GEOM 1 or otherwise) should be inspected and modified as required such as changing the PUNCH values and local section properties for the punching shear checks. Modify the .STD file so it reruns the code check process by reading the instructions of the GEOM file. This message is conveyed by changing the value of the LEG

International Design Codes Manual 821

parameter to 2.0. After making this change, a re-analysis will result in the program using the information in the geometry data file (GEOM1, APIPUN, or otherwise) for performing the code check. Example Reading an existing Joint Geometry Data File, GEOM1
UNIT INCHES KIPS PARAMETERS * ALL JOINT DATA WILL BE READ FROM THE EXTERNAL FILE GEOM1 FOR PUNCHING SHEAR. CODE API GEOM1 LEG 2.0 FYLD 50.0 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL RATIO 1.0 ALL BEAM 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

822 STAAD.Pro

Section 17

ANSI/AISC N690 Design Codes

International Design Codes Manual 823

824 STAAD.Pro

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code


17A.1 General Comments
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as defined by ANSI/AISC N690-1994 and as amended by Supplement No. 2 to the Specification of the Design, Fabrication and Erection of Steel Safety-Related Structures for Nuclear Facilities (ANSI/AISC N690 1994(R2004)s2). All the design steps are done as described in section 2.3 Allowable per AISC-ASD (Ninth Edition) Code of Technical Reference manual except for allowable stress in compression for AUSTENlTlC STAINLESS STEEL. Section Q1.5.9 is used to calculate allowable compressive stress for Austenitic Stainless Steel. Correction made in Supplementary s1 published in April 15, 2002 has been applied. Note: By default, N690 code uses Stainless Steel material in the design. Care should be taken to assign the proper Stainless Steel material properties to the members for the analysis. There is a parameter STYPE to change material type to either Stainless Steel (STYPE=1) or Carbon Steel (STYPE=0).

Design Process
Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are proportioned to satisfy equation Q1.6-1a: SFCf /F +SMYC
a a my by

f /[(1 - f /F' )F ] +SMZC


a ey by

mz bz

f /[(1 - f /F' )F ] 1.0


a ez bz

and Q1.6-1b: SFCf /(0.6F ) +SMYf /F


a y by a a by

+SMZf /F
bz

bz

1.0

when, f /F > 0.15, as per section Q1.6.1 of the code. Otherwise, equation Q1.6-2 must be satisfied: SFCf /F +SMYf /F
a a by by

+ SMZf /F
bz

bz

1.0

It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and [0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2)], but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway.

International Design Codes Manual 825

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code

Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy equation Q1.6-3: SFTf /(0.6F ) +SMYf /F
a y by by

+SMZf /F
bz

bz

1.0

Where SFC, SFT, SMZ, and SMY are stress limit coefficient parameters used to control the components of the interaction equations. Refer to Table 17A.1 for details.

17A.2 Design Parameters


The program contains a large number of parameter names which are required to perform design and code checks. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in the following table. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements for an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure

Table 17A.1 - Design Parameters for ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as AISC N690 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

Beam parameter 0. Perform design at ends and those locations in the SECTIONcommand. 1. Perform design at ends and at 1/12th section locations along the member length.

CAN

Used for Deflection Check only (i.e., when DFFis specified).

826 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

0. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient, as specified in Chapter Fof AISCASD. 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0 Cm value in local y & z axes

COMPOSITE

Composite action with connectors (CMP) 0. No composite action 1. Composite action 2. Ignore positive moments during design

CONDIA CONHEIGHT CYCLES

0.625 in 2.5 in 500,000

Diameter of shear connectors (DIA), in current units. Height of shear connectors after welding (HGT), in current units. Cycles of maximum stress to which the shear connector is

International Design Codes Manual 827

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

subject(CYC). DFF None "Deflection Length" / Maximum (Mandatory allowable local deflection for deflection check) Start Joint of member End Joint of member 0.4 Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Ratio of moment due to dead load applied after the concrete hardens to the total moment (DR2). Ratio of moment due to dead load applied before the concrete hardens to the total moment (DR1). Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Effective width of concrete slab (WID). Yield strength of steel in current units. Compressive strength of concrete at 28 days, in current units. Full section shear for welding. 0. False 1. True

DJ1 DJ2 DLR2

DLRATIO

0.4

DMAX DMIN EFFWIDTH

45 inch 0.0 inch 1/4 Member Length 36 KSI 3 KSI 1

FYLD FPC FSS

828 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name FU FYLD KX KY

Default Value 60 KSI 46 KSI 1.0 1.0

Description

Ultimate tensile strength of steel, in current units. Yield strength of steel, in current units. Effective length factor for flexural torsional buckling. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length for flexural torsional buckling. Length to calculate slenderness ratio (KL/r) for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). Design for slenderness: 0. check for slenderness 1. suppress slenderness check

KZ

1.0

LX LY

Member Length Member Length Member Length 0.0

LZ MAIN

NSF OVR

1.0 1.0

Net section Factor for tension members Factor by which all allowable stresses/capacities should be multiplied. Default of 1.0 indicates that no overstressing is allowed. Thickness of the cover plate welded to the bottom flange of the com-

PLTHICK

International Design Codes Manual 829

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

posite beam (PLT), in current units. PLTWIDTH 0 Width of the cover plate welded to the bottom flange of the composite beam (PLT), in current units. Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Height of ribs of form steel deck (RBH), in current units. Width of ribs of form steel deck (RBW), in current units. Stress limit coefficient for compression (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for tension (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Shear stress calculation option 0. Computes the actual shear stress using VQ/It 1. Computes the actual shear stress using V(Ay or Az) SHORING 0 Temporary shoring during construction 0. Without shoring 1. With shoring SLABTHICK 4 in Thickness of concrete slab or thick-

PROFILE

None

RATIO RIBHEIGHT RIBWIDTH SFC

1.0 0 0 1.0

SFT SHE

1.0 0

830 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

ness of concrete slab above the form steel deck (THK), in current units. SMY 1.0 Stress limit coefficient for minor axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for major axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Design for sidesway in the local y axis. 0. Sidesway 1. No sidesway SSZ 0 Design for sidesway in the local z axis. 0. Sidesway 1. No sidesway STIFF Member length or depth whichever is greater 0.0 Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design, in current units.

SMZ

1.0

SSY

STYPE

Type of steel material 0. Normal Steel 1. Austenitic Stainless Steel

TAPER

Design for tapered member. 0. Design for tapered I-section based on rules in Chapter F and Appendix B. 1. Design for tapered section

International Design Codes Manual 831

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

based on Appendix F. TMAIN 240 for main member 300 for Truss member TORSION 0 Design for torsion. 0. Do not design for torsion. 1. Design for torsion. TRACK 0.0 Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0. Minimum detail 1. Intermediate detail level 2. Maximum detail UNB Member Length Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange. Design for weld. 0. Closed sections. 1. Open sections. Slenderness limit under tension

UNT

Member Length

WELD

832 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name WMAX WMIN WSTR

Default Value 1 in 0.625 in 0.4Fyld

Description

Maximum weld thickness, in current units. Minimum weld thickness, in current units. Allowable welding stress, in current units.

Notes
1. All values are entered in the current units 2. parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command

17B.3 Examples
These example problems are included for the verification of design results.

17.3.1 Example 1
Solution
Allowable Compressive Stress: Maximum Slenderness Ratio, (Kl/r) Yield Stress of Steel, F = 36 ksi
y max

= 171.31

C =
c

[(22E)/F ]1/2 y

= 127.68

Allowable Compressive Stress for Austentic Stainless Steel, As, (Kl/r)


a max

>C

c max

F = (122E)/[23(Kl/r)

] = 5.21 ksi

International Design Codes Manual 833

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code

Comparison
Table 17A.2 - ANSI-AISC N690-1994 Code Verification Problem 1 Value of F (ks)
a

Reference STAAD.Pro Difference

5.21

5.22

Negligible

Input File
This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\N690\N690_CASE1.STD
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-NOV-07 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 4 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN

834 STAAD.Pro

1 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 PINNED 2 FIXED BUT FX MY MZ LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 CON GY -10 2 UNIT METER KIP UNIT METER KN LOAD 2 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 2 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -1 LOAD COMB 3 COMBINATION LOAD CASE 3 1 1.0 2 9.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS UNIT METER KIP PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
The corresponding TRACK 2 output is shown below:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ANSI N690-1994) v1.0 ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES |

International Design Codes Manual 835

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code


|************* | IN INCH UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 1 * | AISC SECTIONS | | AX = 3.55 | | * | ST W6X12 | | --Z AY = 1.25 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 1.50 | |ANSI N690-94* =============================== ===|=== SY = 1.50 | | * SZ = 7.33 | | * |<---LENGTH (FT)= 13.12 --->| RY = 0.92 | |************* RZ = 2.50 | | | | 7.4 (KIP-FEET) | |PARAMETER | L1 STRESSES | |IN KIP INCH | IN KIP INCH | |--------------- + L1 L1 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 171.31 | FA = 5.22 | | KL/R-Z= 63.12 + L1 L1 fa = 0.60 | | UNL = 157.48 | FCZ = 14.15 | | CB = 1.00 + L1 L1 FTZ = 21.60 | | CMY = 0.85 | L1 L1 FCY = 27.00 | | CMZ = 0.85 + FTY = 27.00 | | FYLD = 36.00 |L0 L0 fbz = 12.07 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 0.00 | | DFF = 0.00 -0.4 Fey = 4.65 | | dff= 0.00 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE Fez = 34.26 | | (KL/R)max = 171.31 (WITH LOAD NO.) FV = 14.40 | | fv = 0.90 | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | | | VALUE 2.1 1.1 0.0 0.0 7.4 | | LOCATION 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 6.6 | | LOADING 3 1 0 0 1 | | | |**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS ANSI Q1.6-2 0.968 3 | | 2.14 C 0.00 -7.38 6.56 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

836 STAAD.Pro

17.3.2 Example 2
Solution
Allowable Compressive Stress: Maximum Slenderness Ratio, (Kl/r) Yield Stress of Steel, F = 36 ksi
y max

= 85.65

C =
c

[(22E)/F ]1/2 y

= 127.68

Allowable Compressive Stress for Austentic Stainless Steel, As, (Kl/r)


a max y

< 120.0
y max

F = (F /2.15) - {[(F /2.15) - 6.0]/120.0}x(Kl/r)

= 9.07 ksi

Comparison
Table 17A.3 - ANSI-AISC N690-1994 Code Verification Problem 2 Value of F (ks)
a

Reference STAAD.Pro Difference

9.07

9.08

Negligible

Input File
This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\N690\N690_CASE2.STD
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-NOV-07 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES

International Design Codes Manual 837

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code

3 0 0 1; 4 2 0 1; MEMBER INCIDENCES 2 3 4; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 2 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 3 PINNED 4 FIXED BUT FX MY MZ LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD UNIT METER KIP 2 CON GY -2.24809 1 UNIT METER KN LOAD 2 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 2 JOINT LOAD 4 FX -1 LOAD COMB 3 COMBINATION LOAD CASE 3 1 1.0 2 9.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS

838 STAAD.Pro

UNIT METER KIP PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
The corresponding TRACK 2 output is shown below:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ANSI N690-1994) v1.0 ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN INCH UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 2 * | AISC SECTIONS | | AX = 3.55 | | * | ST W6X12 | | --Z AY = 1.25 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 1.50 | |ANSI N690-94* =============================== ===|=== SY = 1.50 | | * SZ = 7.33 | | * |<---LENGTH (FT)= 6.56 --->| RY = 0.92 | |************* RZ = 2.50 | | | | 3.7 (KIP-FEET) | |PARAMETER | L1 STRESSES | |IN KIP INCH | IN KIP INCH | |--------------- + L1 L1 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 85.65 | FA = 9.08 | | KL/R-Z= 31.56 + L1 fa = 0.60 | | UNL = 78.74 | L1 FCZ = 21.60 | | CB = 1.00 + L1 L1 FTZ = 21.60 | | CMY = 0.85 | L1 FCY = 27.00 | | CMZ = 0.85 + L1 FTY = 27.00 | | FYLD = 36.00 |L0 L0 fbz = 6.04 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 0.00 | | DFF = 0.00 -0.2 Fey = 18.60 | | dff= 0.00 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE Fez = 137.05 | | (KL/R)max = 85.65 (WITH LOAD NO.) FV = 14.40 | | fv = 0.90 | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | |

International Design Codes Manual 839

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code


| VALUE 2.1 1.1 0.0 0.0 3.7 | | LOCATION 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 3.3 | | LOADING 3 1 0 0 1 | | | |**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS ANSI Q1.6-2 0.346 3 | | 2.14 C 0.00 -3.69 3.28 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

17.3.3 Example 3
Solution
Allowable Compressive Stress: Maximum Slenderness Ratio, (Kl/r) Yield Stress of Steel, F = 36 ksi
y max

= 122.06

C =
c

[(22E)/F ]1/2 y

= 127.68

Allowable Compressive Stress for Austentic Stainless Steel, As, 120.0 <(Kl/r)
a y max

<C

c max

F = F [0.4 - (1/600)x(Kl/r)

] = 7.08 ksi

Comparison
Table 17A.4 - ANSI-AISC N690-1994 Code Verification Problem 3 Value of F (ks)
a

Reference STAAD.Pro Difference

7.08

7.08

None

840 STAAD.Pro

Input File
This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\N690\N690_CASE3.STD
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-NOV-07 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 2.85 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 PINNED 2 FIXED BUT FX MY MZ LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1

International Design Codes Manual 841

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code

MEMBER LOAD 1 CON GY -10 2 UNIT METER KIP UNIT METER KN LOAD 2 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 2 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -1 LOAD COMB 3 COMBINATION LOAD CASE 3 1 1.0 2 9.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS UNIT METER KIP PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
The corresponding TRACK 2 output is shown below:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ANSI N690-1994) v1.0 ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN INCH UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 1 * | AISC SECTIONS | | AX = 3.55 | | * | ST W6X12 | | --Z AY = 1.25 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 1.50 | |ANSI N690-94* =============================== ===|=== SY = 1.50 | | * SZ = 7.33 | | * |<---LENGTH (FT)= 9.35 --->| RY = 0.92 | |************* RZ = 2.50 | | | | 4.2 (KIP-FEET) | |PARAMETER | L1 STRESSES | |IN KIP INCH | L1 IN KIP INCH |

842 STAAD.Pro

|--------------- + L1 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 122.06 | L1 FA = 7.08 | | KL/R-Z= 44.97 + L1 fa = 0.60 | | UNL = 112.20 | FCZ = 19.86 | | CB = 1.00 + L1 L1 FTZ = 21.60 | | CMY = 0.85 | L1 FCY = 27.00 | | CMZ = 0.85 + L1 FTY = 27.00 | | FYLD = 36.00 |L0 L0 fbz = 6.84 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 0.00 | | DFF = 0.00 -0.2 Fey = 9.16 | | dff= 0.00 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE Fez = 67.49 | | (KL/R)max = 122.06 (WITH LOAD NO.) FV = 14.40 | | fv = 0.54 | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | | | VALUE 2.1 1.6 0.0 0.0 4.2 | | LOCATION 0.0 7.0 0.0 0.0 6.2 | | LOADING 3 1 0 0 1 | | | |**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS ANSI Q1.6-2 0.429 3 | | 2.14 C 0.00 -4.18 6.23 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|

International Design Codes Manual 843

844 STAAD.Pro

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code


17B.1 General Comments
For code checking of steel members, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as defined by the "ANSI/AISC N690-1984:Nuclear Facilities Steel Safety-Related Structures for Design, Fabrication, and Erection." A brief description of some of the major allowable stresses is described herein.

17B.2 Design Process


The following Checks are to be performed on a Steel Member as per this AISC N690 1984 Code. When a design is performed, the output file the reports the maximum utilization from all of the checks.

17B.2.1. Slenderness
The maximum allowable slenderness ratio in Compression (KL/r_min), as per clause Q1.8.4 of the code shall not exceed 200. And the maximum allowable slenderness ratio in Tension (L/r_min) shall not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for bracing members and other secondary members. This can be controlled by using the existing MAIN and TMAIN parameters respectively. The default value of MAIN is 200 and for TMAIN is 240.

17B.2.2. Check for Element Slenderness and Stress Reduction Factors


The permissible Width-to-Thickness Ratio of Un-stiffened Elements under Compression is determined as per section Q1.9.1 and that of Stiffened Elements under Compression is determined as per section Q1.9.2 of the code. The permissible WidthThickness Ratio of web is determined as per section Q1.10.2.

17B.2.3. Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as 0.60F , but not more
y

International Design Codes Manual 845

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

than 0.5F on the Effective Net area, as per section Q1.5.1.1.


u

The Net Area (An) shall be determined in accordance with Q1.14, and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (Ae) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. Q1.14), A = C A
e t n

Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section Q1.14. The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.

17B.2.4. Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns which meet the provisions of section Q1.9, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by Q1.5.1.3. The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be in accordance to section Q1.5.9. A. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) C,
c

F = [1 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2)]F / {5/3 + [3(Kl/r)/(8C )] a c y c [(Kl/r)3/(8C 3)]}


c

Where: C = [(22E)/F ] 1/2


c y

2. When (Kl/r) > C , F =


a

c 2E/[23(kL/r)2] 12

B. Gross sections of columns fabricated from Austenitic Stainless steel:

846 STAAD.Pro

1. When (Kl/r) 120, F = F /2.15 - [(F /2.16 - 6)/120](kL/r)


a y y

2. When (Kl/r) > 120, F = F [12 - (KL/r)/20]


a y

If the provisions of the section Q1.9 are not satisfied, A. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor Q is introduced. s Detailed values of Qs for different shapes are given in Section QC2. B. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width b is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness: b = 253t/F {1 - (50.3/[(b/t)F ]} b
e y y

2. For other uniformly compressed elements: b = 253t/F {1 - (44.3/[(b/t)F ]} b


e y y

Consequently, a reduction factor Q is introduced and is equal to the a effective area divided by the actual area. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or unstiffened elements shall not exceed F = Q Q [1 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2)]F / {5/3 + [3(Kl/r)/(8C )] a s a c y c [(Kl/r)3/(8C 3)]}
c

Where: C' = [(22E)/(Q Q F )] 1/2


c s a y

17B.2.5.Bending Stress
Allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a structural member, as given in section Q1.5.1.4 is:

International Design Codes Manual 847

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

A. Along Major Axis: 1. Tension and compression on extreme fibers of compact hot rolled or built-up members symmetrical about and loaded in the plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection Q1.5.1.4.1.1 to 7, shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66F
b y

If meeting the requirements of this member of: a. Width-thickness ratio of unstiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 65/F .
y

b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F .
y

c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F
y a y a y

0.16

d/t = 257/F when f /F > 0.16


y a y

d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor 20000/(d/A )F .
f y f y

2. For noncompact and slender elements, section Q1.5.1.4.2 is followed. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60F
b y

B. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of section Q1.5.1.4.1, maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed the following value as per section Q1.5.1.4.3: F = 0.75F
b y

2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of section Q1.5.1.4.1, except where b /2t > 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not y exceed: F = F [0.79 0.002(b /2t )F ]
b y f f y

848 STAAD.Pro

17B.2.6. Combined Interaction Check


Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are proportioned to satisfy equation Q1.6-1a: SFCf /F +SMYC
a a my by

f /[(1 - f /F' )F ] +SMZC


a ey by

mz bz

f /[(1 - f /F' )F ] 1.0


a ez bz

and Q1.6-1b SFCf /(0.6F ) +SMYf /F


a y by a a by

+SMZf /F
bz

bz

1.0

when, f /F > 0.15, as per section Q1.6.1 of the code. Otherwise, equation Q1.6-2 must be satisfied: SFCf /F +SMYf /F
a a by by

+ SMZf /F
bz

bz

1.0

It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and [0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2)], but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy equation Q 1.6-1b: SFTf /(0.6F ) +SMYf /F
a y by by

+SMZf /F
bz

bz

1.0

Where SFC, SFT, SMZ, and SMY are stress limit coefficient parameters used to control the components of the interaction equations. Refer to Table 17B.1 for details.

17B.2.7. Shear Stress


Allowable shear stress on the gross section [ref. section Q1.10.5.2] is calculated as F = (F /2.89)C 0.4F
v y v y

Where: C = (45,000k)/[F (h/t)2], when h/t 0.8


v v y

C = [190/(h/t)](k/F ), when h/t > 0.8 k = 4.00 +


y [5.34/(a/h)2],

when a/h 1.0

International Design Codes Manual 849

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code k = 5.34 + [4.00/(a/h)2], when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.

17B.4 Member Property Specification


For specification of member properties, the specified steel section available in Steel Section Library of STAAD may be used, namely: I-shaped section, Channel, Tee, HSS Tube, HSS Pipe, Angle, Double Angle, and Double Channel sections. Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility except for the General and Prismatic member. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

17B.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a large number of parameter names which are required to perform design and code checks. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in the following table. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements for an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure

Table 17B.1 - Design Parameters for ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as AISC N690 1984 to use the ANSI/AISC N6901984 code for checking purposes. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

CAN

Used for Deflection Check only.

850 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.75 Cm value in local y & z axes

CT

Reduction Coefficient in computing net effective net area of an axially loaded tension member.

DFF

None "Deflection Length" / Maximum (Mandatory allowable local deflection for deflection check) Start Joint of member End Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length"

DJ1 DJ2

International Design Codes Manual 851

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code Parameter Name DMAX DMIN FU FYLD KY Default Value 45 inch 0.0 inch 60 KSI 36 KSI 1.0 Description

Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. Yield strength of steel in current units. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). Design for slenderness. 0. Check for slenderness 1. Suppress slenderness check

KZ

1.0

LY LZ MAIN

Member Length Member Length 0.0

NSF PROFILE

1.0 None

Net section Factor for tension members Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Stress limit coefficient for com-

RATIO SFC

1.0 1.0

852 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

pression (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. SFT SMY 1.0 1.0 Stress limit coefficient for tension (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for minor axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for major axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design

SMZ

1.0

STIFF

Member length or depth whichever is greater 0.0

STYPE

0.0 = Normal Steel 1.0 = Austenitic Stainless Steel

TMAIN

240 for main member 300 for Truss member

Slenderness limit under tension

TRACK

0.0

Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0 = Minimum detail 1 = Intermediate detail level 2 = Maximum detail

UNB

Member Length

Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable

International Design Codes Manual 853

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. UNT Member Length Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.

Notes
1. All values are entered in the current units 2. parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command

17B.5 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available with the AISC N690 1984 code. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

17B.6 Examples
These example problems are included for the verification of design results.

17B.6.1 Example 1 - Pipe Section


This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\NUCLEAR CODE SAMPLES\N690_1984_PIPE_SECTION.STD

854 STAAD.Pro

Problem
A 10 ft long simply supported beam subject to axial (+/- 10 kip) and bending loads (3 kip/ft) in both the local y and z axis. The beam is a 5" diameter, Schedule 40 Pipe section made from Grade 36 steel.

Solution
Section Properties: A = 4.30 in.2
x

I = I = 15.20 in.4
y z

r = (15.20/4.30)1/2 = 1.88 in. O.D. = 5.56 in., t = 0.26 in. S = S = 15.20 in.42/5.56 in. = 5.468 in.3
x y

Load Case 1: Tension-only


Allowable Tensile Stress: F = min(0.6F , 0.5F ) = 0.6(36 ksi) = 21.60 ksi
t y u

Actual Tensile Stress: f = P/A


t e

Where: A = C A = 0.75(4.30 in.2) = 3.23 in.2


e t n

f = 10 kip/ 3.23 in.2 = 3.10 ksi


t

Stress Ratio = 3.10 ksi/21.60 ksi = 0.144 < 1.0, OK.

Load Case 2: Compression-only


Allowable Compressive Stress: Maximum Slenderness Ratio, (Kl/r) = 1.0(10 ft)(12 ft/in.)/1.88in. = max 63.83 <200, OK. Yield Stress of Steel, F = 36 ksi
y

International Design Codes Manual 855

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code C = [(22E)/F ]1/2 = 127.68


c y

(Kl/r)
a

max y

<C

c c 2/[2(127.68)2]/{5/3 (63.83) c c

F = F [1.0 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2]/[5/3 +3(Kl/r)/(8C ) - (Kl/r)3/(2C 3)] = 36.0 ksi{1.0 +3(63.83)/[8(127.68)] (63.83)3/[8(127.68)3]} = 36.0 ksi (0.875/1.835) = 17.06 ksi Actual Compressive Stress: f = 10 kip/4.30 in.2 = 2.33 ksi
a

Stress Ratio = 2.33 ksi/17.06 ksi = 0.136 < 1.0, OK.

Load Case 3: Tension +Bending


Allowable Bending Stress: F
by

=F

bz

= 0.66F = 0.66(36 ksi) = 23.76 ksi


y

Actual Bending Stress (include member selfweight in Y dir.): M = 0.315 kip/ft (10 ft)2/8 (12 in./ft) = 47.2 inkip
y z

M = 0.3 kip/ft (10 ft)2/8 (12 in./ft) = 45.0 inkip f = 47.2 inkip/5.468 in.3 = 8.63 ksi
by bz

= 45.0 inkip/5.468 in.3 = 8.23 ksi

Stress Ratio = 8.63 ksi/ 23.76 ksi = 0.363 < 1.0 Stress Ratio = 8.23 ksi/ 23.76 ksi = 0.346 < 1.0 Combined Stress Check: f /(0.6F ) +f /F +f /F = 3.10 ksi/[0.6(36 ksi)] +0.363 +0.346 = a y by by bz bz 0.853

Load Case 4:Compression +Bending


Combined Stress Check: f /F = 0.136 < 0.15
a a a a

f /F +f /F
by

by

+f /F
bz

bz

= 0.136 +0.363 + 0.346 = 0.845 <1.0, OK

856 STAAD.Pro

Comparison
Table 17B.2 - ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code Verification Problem 1 Condition Tension Reference STAAD.Pro Difference 0.144 (0.107, CT = 1.0) Compression Tension +Bending 0.136 0.853 (0.817, CT = 1.0) 0.845 0.844 Negligible 0.136 0.815 None 2.51% 0.108

Compression +Bending

Input File
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 09-DEC-09 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 10 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 4.176E+006

International Design Codes Manual 857

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 0.489024 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT INCHES KIP MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST PIPS50 UNIT FEET KIP CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 PINNED 2 FIXED BUT FX LOAD 1 TENSION ONLY JOINT LOAD 2 FX 10 LOAD 2 COMPRESSION ONLY JOINT LOAD 2 FX -10 LOAD 3 TENSION+BENDING SELFWEIGHT Y -1 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -0.3 JOINT LOAD 2 FX 10 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GZ 0.3 LOAD 4 COMPRESSION+BENDING SELFWEIGHT Y -1

858 STAAD.Pro

MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -0.3 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -10 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GZ 0.3 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES ALL UNIT INCHES KIP LOAD LIST 1 PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

International Design Codes Manual 859

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

** FOLLOWING TO CHECK IF THE NET AREA IS USED IN CALCULATING TENSILE STRESS PARAMETER 11 CODE AISC N690 1984 FU 40 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST 2 PARAMETER 2 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST 3 PARAMETER 3 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL

860 STAAD.Pro

CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST 4 PARAMETER 4 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL

International Design Codes Manual 861

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST ALL PARAMETER 5 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
The TRACK 2 output for the final parameter set is shown here: 862 STAAD.Pro

STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0

AISC N690 1984)

******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 ST PIPS50 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS Q1.6-Eqn 2 0.844 4 10.00 C 44.84 47.02 120.00 |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 63.83 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.71E+01 FCZ: 2.38E+01 FCY: 2.38E+01 FTZ: 2.38E+01 FTY: 2.38E+01 | | SHEAR: 1.44E+01 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 2.33E+00 FBZ: 8.60E+00 FBY: 8.20E+00 SHEAR: 9.12E-01 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 4.30 AYY: 2.27 AZZ: 2.27 RZZ: 1.88 RYY: 1.88 | | SZZ: 5.46 SYY: 5.46 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 63.83 KL/R-Y: 63.83 UNL: 30.0 CMZ: 0.60 CMY: 0.60 | | CB: 1.00 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 1.00 | | CT: 0.75 STEEL TYPE: 0.0 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.108 1 1.00E+01 | INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-

International Design Codes Manual 863

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

| COMPRESSION 0.136 2 1.00E+01 | | COMP&BEND 0.844 4 1.00E+01 4.70E+01 4.48E+01 | | TEN&BEND 0.815 3 1.00E+01 4.70E+01 4.48E+01 | | SHEAR-Y 0.063 3 1.96E+00 | | SHEAR-Z 0.060 3 1.87E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------|

17B.6.2 Example 2 - W-Section


This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\NUCLEAR CODE SAMPLES\N690_1984_W-SECTION.STD

Problem
A 12 ft long simply supported beam subject to uniform load (3 kip/ft). The beam is a W6x12 section made from Grade 36 steel.

Solution
Section Properties: A = 3.55 in.2 d = 6.03 in. t = 0.230 in.
w

S = 7.31 in.3
z

Allowable Bending Stress: F


bz

= 0.66F = 0.66(36 ksi) = 23.76 ksi


y

Actual Bending Stress (include member selfweight in Y dir.): M = 0.312 kip/ft (12 ft)2/8 (12 in./ft) = 67.4 inkip
z

bz

= 67.4 inkip/7.31 in.3 = 9.22 ksi

Stress Ratio = 9.22 ksi/ 23.76 ksi = 0.388 < 1.0, OK Allowable Shear Stress:

864 STAAD.Pro

F = 0.4F = 0.4(36 ksi) = 14.40 ksi


v y

Actual Shear Stress: V = 0.5(12 ft)(0.312 kip/ft) = 1.872 kip


z

vz

= 1.872 kip/(6.03 in. x 0.230 in.) = 1.35 ksi

Stress Ratio = 1.35 ksi/ 14.40 ksi = 0.094 <1.0, OK.

Comparison
Table 17B.3 - ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code Verification Problem 3 Condition Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Bending Shear 0.388 0.094 0.387 0.094 Negligible None

Input File
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 09-DEC-09 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 12 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 4.176E+006 POISSON 0.3

International Design Codes Manual 865

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

DENSITY 0.489024 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 2 PINNED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 ALL MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -0.3 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES ALL *UNIT KIP INCH PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL

866 STAAD.Pro

TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 3 ALL UNT 3 ALL UNIT KIP INCH CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

Output
The TRACK 2 output for the final parameter set is shown here:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 ST W6X12 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS Q1.6-Eqn 2 0.387 1 0.00 T 0.00 -67.40 72.00 |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 156.64 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 300.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 6.09E+00 FCZ: 2.38E+01 FCY: 2.70E+01 FTZ: 2.38E+01 FTY: 2.70E+01 | | SHEAR: 1.44E+01 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 0.00E+00 FBZ: 9.20E+00 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 0.00E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 3.55 AYY: 1.39 AZZ: 1.49 RZZ: 2.50 RYY: 0.92 | INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCAAISC N690 1984)

International Design Codes Manual 867

ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code

7.33 SYY: 1.50 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 57.71 KL/R-Y:156.64 UNL: 36.0 CMZ: 0.60 CMY: 0.60 | | CB: 1.00 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 1.00 | | CT: 0.75 STEEL TYPE: 0.0 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.387 1 0.00E+00 6.74E+01 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 0.00E+00 6.74E+01 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.094 1 1.87E+00 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------|

| SZZ:

868 STAAD.Pro

Section 18

American Society of Mechanical Engineers Nuclear Facility (ASME NF) Codes

International Design Codes Manual 869

870 STAAD.Pro

ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes


18A.1 General Comments
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as defined by the American Society of Mechanical Engineers Nuclear Facility (ASME NF) Code. The ASME NF-3000 1974 Code is used as the basis of this design. From design point of view, there are no major differences between NF-3000 1974 and NF-3000 1977 version of codes. A brief description of some of the major allowable stresses is described herein.

18A.2 Design Process


The design process follows the following design checks 1. Slenderness 2. Tension 3. Compression 4. Bending Stress 5. Combined Interaction Check 6. Shear Stress Each one of the checks are described in the following sections. When a design is performed, the output file the reports the maximum utilization from all of the checks.

18A.2.1Slenderness
As per clause XVII-2223 of NF-3000 1974, the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.

International Design Codes Manual 871

ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes

18A.2.2Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60*F ), but not more y than (0.5*F ) on the Net area.
u

The Net Area (An) shall be determined in accordance with the clause XVII-2283 of NF-3000 1974, and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.

18A.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns shall be as required by clause XVII2213 of NF-3000 1974. a. Gross Sections of Columns: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) <C,
c

Where:

2. When (Kl/r) > C ,


c

3. When (Kl/r) > 120,

b. Member elements other than columns:

872 STAAD.Pro

1. For Plate Girder Stiffeners, F = 0.60F


a

2. For webs of rolled shapes, F = 0.75F


a

The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of clause XVII-2224 of NF-3000 1974. If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor, Q , is introduced. s Detailed values of Q for different shapes are given in the clause XVII-2225.2 s of NF-3000 1974. b. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width, b , is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness:

2. For other uniformly compressed elements:

Consequently, a reduction factor, Q , equal to the effective area divided by a the actual area is introduced. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or un-stiffened elements shall not exceed

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 873

ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes

18A.2.4Bending Stress
Allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a structural member, as given in XVII-2214 of NF-3000 1974 is: a. Along Major Axis: a. For Compact Sections, tension and compression on extreme fibers of compact hot rolled or built-up members symmetrical about and loaded in the plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection NF shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66*F
b y

If meeting the requirements of this member of: a. Width-thickness ratio of un-stiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 52.2/F .
y

b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F .
y

c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (412/F )[1 2.33(F /F )]
y a y

except that it need not be less than 257/F .


y

d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor f y 20000/(d/A )F .
f y

b. For noncompact and slender elements, clause XVII-2214.2 and XVII-2214.5 of NF-3000 1974 are followed respectively. c. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60*F
b y

b. Along Minor Axis: For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of XVII2214.1(a) and (b) of NF-3000 1974, maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75*F
b y

874 STAAD.Pro

18A.2.5Combined Interaction Check


Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are proportioned to satisfy

and

when f /F > 0.15,


a a

otherwise

It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy

18A.2.6Shear Stress
Allowable shear stress on the gross section [ref. XVII-2263.2 of NF-3000 1974] is calculated as

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 875

ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes

, when C < 0.8


v

, when C > 0.8


v

, when a/h < 1.0 , when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.

18A.3 Member Property Specification


For specification of member properties, the specified steel section available in Steel Section Library of STAAD may be used namely I-shaped section, Channel, Tee, HSS Tube, HSS Pipe, Angle, Double Angle, Double Channel section. Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility except for the General and Prismatic member. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

18A.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a large number of parameter names which are required to perform design and code checks. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in the following table. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements for an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. For example, by default the KZ value (k value in local z-axis) of a member is set to 1.0, while in the real structure it may be 1.5. In that case, the KZ value in the program can be changed to 1.5, as shown in the input instruction (Section 5). Similarly, the TRACK value of a member is set to 0.0, which means no allowable stresses of the member will be printed. If the allowable stresses are to be printed, the TRACK value must be set to 1.0.

876 STAAD.Pro

Table 18A.1 - ASME NF 3000 Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as CODE NF3000 1974 or CODE NF3000 1977 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

CAN

Used for Deflection Check only. 0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type

CB

1.0

Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted.

CMY CMZ

0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member

Cm value in local y & z axes

DFF

"Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection

DJ1

Joint No. denoting starting point

International Design Codes Manual 877

ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes Parameter Name Default Value Description

for calculation of "Deflection Length" DJ2 DMAX End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length" 45 inch Maximum allowable depth. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Minimum allowable depth. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Yield strength of steel in current units. Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check NSF PROFILE 1.0 None Net Section Factor for tension member. Used in member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details.

DMIN

0.0 inch

FYLD FU KY KZ LY LZ MAIN

36 KSI 60 KSI 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 0.0

878 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name RATIO STIFF

Default Value 1.0

Description

Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses.

Member Spacing of stiffeners for plate length or girder design depth whichever is greater 240 for main member 300 for Truss member Slenderness limit under tension

TMAIN

TRACK

0.0

Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0. Minimum detail 1. Intermediate detail level 2. Maximum detail

UNB

Member Length

Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.

UNT

Member Length

18A.5 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available with the ASME NF3000 1974 and ASME NF-3000 1977 codes.

International Design Codes Manual 879

ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes

Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

18A.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 30 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and 5 kip lateral load. The beam is assigned with W24X104 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 1974. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below:
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT INCHES KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 30 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST W24X104

880 STAAD.Pro

CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 FY -5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT SUPPORT REACTION PRINT JOINT DISPLACEMENTS PRINT MEMBER FORCES PARAMETER 1 CODE NF3000 1974 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 0.9 ALL KZ 0.9 ALL NSF 0.85 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

The corresponding TRACK 2 output is as follows:


STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ASME NF3000-74) ******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE v1.0

INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST W24X104 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS NF-74-EQN-21 0.032 1 5.00 C 0.00 150.00 0.00 |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 9.28 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 |

International Design Codes Manual 881

ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes


| ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 2.07E+01 FCZ: 2.38E+01 FCY: 2.70E+01 FTZ: 2.38E+01 FTY: 2.70E+01 | | SHEAR: 1.44E+01 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.63E-01 FBZ: 5.82E-01 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 4.16E-01 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 30.60 AYY: 12.03 AZZ: 12.75 RZZ: 10.07 RYY: 2.91 | | SZZ: 257.69 SYY: 40.63 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 2.68 KL/R-Y: 9.28 UNL: 30.0 CMZ: 1.00 CMY: 1.00 | | CB: 1.75 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 0.85 | | | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.009 1 5.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.008 1 5.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.032 1 5.00E+00 1.50E+02 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 5.00E+00 1.50E+02 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.029 1 5.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|

882 STAAD.Pro

ASME NF 3000 - 1989 Code


18B.1 General Comments
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as defined by the American Society of Mechanical Engineers Nuclear Facility (ASME NF) Code. The ASME NF-3000 1989 Code is used as the basis of this design. A brief description of some of the major allowable stresses is described herein.

18B.2 Design Process


The design process follows the following design checks. 1. Slenderness 2. Tension 3. Compression 4. Bending Stress 5. Combined Interaction Check 6. Shear Stress Each one of the checks are described in the following sections. When a design is performed, the output file the reports the maximum utilization from all of the checks.

18B.2.1 Slenderness
As per NF-3322.2(c), the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.

18B.2.2 Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60*F ), but not more y than (0.5*F ) on the Effective Net area. u

International Design Codes Manual 883

The Net Area (A ) shall be determined in accordance with NF-3322.8(c)(1) - (a), n (b) and (c), and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (A ) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is e transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. NF-3322.8(c)(1)(d)), A =C *A e t n Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)(1), (2) and (3). The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.

18B.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(1). The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(2). The allowable compressive stress for member elements other than columns constructed by any material, including austenitic stainless steel, shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(3). a. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) <C,
c

Where:

2. When (Kl/r) > C ,


c

884 STAAD.Pro

3. When (Kl/r) > 120,

b. Gross sections of columns fabricated from Austenitic Stainless steel: 1. When (Kl/r) 120,

2. When (Kl/r) > 120,

c. Member elements other than columns: 1. For Plate Girder Stiffeners, F = 0.60F
a y

2. For webs of rolled shapes, F = 0.75F


a

The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of NF-3322.2(d). If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor, Q , is introduced. s Detailed values of Q for different shapes are given in NF-3322.2(e)(2)(a) to s NF-3322.2(e)(2)(d). b. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width, b , is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness:

International Design Codes Manual 885

2. For other uniformly compressed elements:

Consequently, a reduction factor, Q , equal to the effective area divided by a the actual area is introduced. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or un-stiffened elements shall not exceed

Where:

18B.2.4 Bending Stress


Allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a structural member, as given in NF-3322.1(d) is: a. Along Major Axis: 1. For Compact Sections, tension and compression on extreme fibres of compact hot rolled or built-up members symmetrical about and loaded in the plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection NF shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66*F b y If meeting the requirements of this member of: a. Width-thickness ratio of unstiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 65/F . y b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F . y c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed

886 STAAD.Pro

d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F <=0.16 y a y a y d/t = 257/F when f /F > 0.16 y a y d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor f y 20000/(d/A )F . f y 2. For noncompact and slender elements, NF-3322.1(d)(5) and NF3322.1(d)(3) are followed respectively. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60*F b y b. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a) and (b), maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75*F b y 2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a), except where b /2t exceeds 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: y F = F [1.075 0.005(b /2t )F ] b y f f y

18B.2.5 Combined Interaction Check


Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are proportioned to satisfy

and

when f /F > 0.15,


a a

otherwise

International Design Codes Manual 887

It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy

18B.2.6 Shear Stress


Allowable shear stress on the gross section [ref. NF-3322.6(e)(2)] is calculated as

Where: , when C < 0.8


v

, when C > 0.8


v

, when a/h < 1.0 , when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.

18B.3 Member Property Specification


For specification of member properties, the specified steel section available in Steel Section Library of STAAD may be used namely I-shaped section, Channel, Tee, HSS Tube, HSS Pipe, Angle, Double Angle, Double Channel section.

888 STAAD.Pro

Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility except for the General and Prismatic member. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

18B.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a large number of parameter names which are required to perform design and code checks. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in the following table. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements for an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. For example, by default the KZ value (k value in local z-axis) of a member is set to 1.0, while in the real structure it may be 1.5. In that case, the KZ value in the program can be changed to 1.5, as shown in the input instruction (Section 5). Similarly, the TRACK value of a member is set to 0.0, which means no allowable stresses of the member will be printed. If the allowable stresses are to be printed, the TRACK value must be set to 1.0. Table 18B.1 - ASME NF 3000 Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as NF3000 1989. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

CAN

Used for Deflection Check only. 0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever

International Design Codes Manual 889

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CT 0.75 Reduction Coefficient in computing effective net area of an axially loaded tension member. [Refer NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)] Cm value in local y & z axes

CMY CMZ

0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member End Joint of member 45 inch

DFF

"Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection

DJ1

Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Maximum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Minimum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Yield strength of steel in current

DJ2 DMAX

DMIN

0.0 inch

FYLD

36 KSI

890 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

units. FU KY KZ LY 60 KSI 1.0 1.0 Member Length Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check NSF PROFILE 1.0 None Net Section Factor for tension member. Used in member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design

LZ MAIN

Member Length 0.0

RATIO STIFF

1.0 Member length or depth whichever is greater 0.0

STYPE

0.0 = Normal Steel 1.0 = Austenitic Stainless Steel

TMAIN

240 for main

Slenderness limit under tension

International Design Codes Manual 891

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

member 300 for Truss member TRACK 0.0 Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0 = Minimum detail 1 = Intermediate detail level 2 = Maximum detail UNB Member Length Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.

UNT

Member Length

18B.5 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available with the ASME NF3000 1989 code. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

892 STAAD.Pro

18B.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 100 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and a uniformly distributed load of 1 kip/inch over the whole span. The beam is assigned with B571806 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 1989. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below:
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 360 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST B571806 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1

International Design Codes Manual 893

JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -1.0 0 100 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT SUPPORT REACTION PARAMETER 1 CODE NF3000 1989 STYPE 1 ALL FYLD 36 ALL KY 0.75 ALL KZ 0.75 ALL FU 58 ALL NSF 0.9 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

The corresponding TRACK 2 output is as follows:


STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ASME NF3000-89) ******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE v1.0

INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST B571806 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS SHEAR Y 0.770 1 5.00 C 0.00 5000.00 0.00 |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 75.08 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.13E+01 FCZ: 2.08E+01 FCY: 2.31E+01 FTZ: 2.16E+01 FTY: 2.31E+01 | | SHEAR: 5.18E+00 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.06E-01 FBZ: 5.86E+00 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 3.99E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) |

894 STAAD.Pro

| AXX: 47.00 AYY: 25.08 AZZ: 15.00 RZZ: 22.80 RYY: 3.60 | | SZZ: 853.77 SYY: 67.54 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 11.84 KL/R-Y: 75.08 UNL: 360.0 CMZ: 1.00 CMY: 1.00 | | CB: 1.75 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 0.90 | | CT: 0.75 STEEL TYPE: 1.0 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.005 1 5.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.009 1 5.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.290 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.770 1 1.00E+02 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|

International Design Codes Manual 895

896 STAAD.Pro

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code


18C.1 General Comments
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as defined by the American Society of Mechanical Engineers Nuclear Facility (ASME NF) Code. The ASME NF-3000 1998 Code is used as the basis of this design. A brief description of some of the major allowable stresses is described herein.

18C.2 Design Process


The design process follows the following design checks. 1. Slenderness 2. Tension 3. Compression 4. Bending Stress 5. Combined Interaction Check 6. Shear Stress Each one of the checks are described in the following sections. When a design is performed, the output file the reports the maximum utilization from all of the checks.

18C.2.1 Slenderness
As per NF-3322.2(c), the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.

18C.2.2 Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60*F ), but not more y than (0.5*F ) on the Effective Net area. u

International Design Codes Manual 897

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

The Net Area (A ) shall be determined in accordance with NF-3322.8(c)(1) - (a), n (b) and (c), and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (A ) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is e transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. NF-3322.8(c)(1)(d)), A =C *A e t n Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)(1), (2) and (3). The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.

18C.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(1). The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(2). The allowable compressive stress for member elements other than columns constructed by any material, including austenitic stainless steel, shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(3). a. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) <C,
c

Where:

2. When (Kl/r) > C ,


c

898 STAAD.Pro

3. When (Kl/r) > 120,

b. Gross sections of columns fabricated from Austenitic Stainless steel: 1. When (Kl/r) 120,

2. When (Kl/r) > 120,

c. Member elements other than columns: 1. For Plate Girder Stiffeners, F = 0.60F
a y

2. For webs of rolled shapes, F = 0.75F


a

The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of NF-3322.2(d). If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor, Q , is introduced. s Detailed values of Q for different shapes are given in NF-3322.2(e)(2)(a) to s NF-3322.2(e)(2)(d). In the case for angles or plates projecting from compression members and for projecting elements of compression flanges of girder, When ,

When

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 899

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

when h/t > 70, otherwise, kc = 1.0. b. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width, b , is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness:

2. For other uniformly compressed elements:

Consequently, a reduction factor, Q , equal to the effective area divided by a the actual area is introduced. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or un-stiffened elements shall not exceed

Where:

18C.2.4 Bending Stress


Allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a structural member, as given in NF-3322.1(d) is: a. Along Major Axis: 1. For Compact Sections, tension and compression on extreme fibres of compact hot rolled or built-up members symmetrical about and loaded in the

900 STAAD.Pro

plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection NF shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66*F b y If meeting the requirements of this member of: a. Width-thickness ratio of unstiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 65/F . y b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F . y c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F <=0.16 y a y a y d/t = 257/F when f /F > 0.16 y a y d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor f y 20000/(d/A )F . f y 2. For noncompact and slender elements, NF-3322.1(d)(5) and NF3322.1(d)(3) are followed respectively. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60*F b y b. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a) and (b), maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75*F b y 2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a), except where b /2t exceeds 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: y F = F [1.075 0.005(b /2t )F ] b y f f y

18C.2.5 Combined Interaction Check


Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are

International Design Codes Manual 901

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

proportioned to satisfy

and

when f /F > 0.15,


a a

otherwise

It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy

18C.2.6 Shear Stress


Allowable shear stress on the gross section [ref. NF-3322.6(e)(2)] is calculated as

Where: , when C < 0.8


v

, when C > 0.8


v

, when a/h < 1.0

902 STAAD.Pro

, when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.

18C.3 Member Property Specification


For specification of member properties, the specified steel section available in Steel Section Library of STAAD may be used namely I-shaped section, Channel, Tee, HSS Tube, HSS Pipe, Angle, Double Angle, Double Channel section. Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility except for the General and Prismatic member. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

18C.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a large number of parameter names which are required to perform design and code checks. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in the following table. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements for an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. For example, by default the KZ value (k value in local z-axis) of a member is set to 1.0, while in the real structure it may be 1.5. In that case, the KZ value in the program can be changed to 1.5, as shown in the input instruction (Section 5). Similarly, the TRACK value of a member is set to 0.0, which means no allowable stresses of the member will be printed. If the allowable stresses are to be printed, the TRACK value must be set to 1.0. Table 18C.1 - ASME NF 3000 1998 Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as NF3000 1998. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the

International Design Codes Manual 903

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

Technical Reference Manual. CAN 0 Used for Deflection Check only. 0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ CT 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.75 Cm value in local y & z axes

Reduction Coefficient in computing effective net area of an axially loaded tension member. [Refer NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)] "Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length"

DFF

None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member

DJ1

904 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name DJ2

Default Value

Description

End Joint of member 45 inch

Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Maximum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Minimum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Yield strength of steel in current units. Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in zaxis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check

DMAX

DMIN

0.0 inch

FYLD FU KY KZ LY

36 KSI 60 KSI 1.0 1.0 Member Length

LZ MAIN

Member Length 0.0

NSF PROFILE

1.0 None

Net Section Factor for tension member. Used in member selection.

International Design Codes Manual 905

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code Parameter Name Default Value Description

See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. STIFF Member length or Spacing of stiffeners for depth whichever is plate girder design greater 0.0 0.0 = Normal Steel 1.0 = Austenitic Stainless Steel TMAIN 240 for main member 300 for Truss member TRACK 0.0 Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0 = Minimum detail 1 = Intermediate detail level 2 = Maximum detail RATIO UNB 1.0 Member Length Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating Slenderness limit under tension

STYPE

UNT

Member Length

906 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange. Notes 1. All values are entered in the current units. 2. The parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command.

18C.5 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available with the ASME NF3000 1998 code. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

18C.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 100 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and a uniformly distributed load of 1 kip/inch over the whole span. The beam is assigned with B571806 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 1998. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below:
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION

International Design Codes Manual 907

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

UNIT INCHES KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 100 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST B571806 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -1.0 0 100 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER 1 CODE NF3000 1998 STYPE 1 ALL FYLD 36 ALL KY 0.75 ALL

908 STAAD.Pro

KZ 0.75 ALL FU 58 ALL NSF 0.9 ALL CT 0.85 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

The corresponding TRACK 2 output is as follows:


STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ASME NF3000-98) ******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE v1.0

INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST B571806 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS SHEAR Y 0.635 1 5.00 C 0.00 5000.00 0.00 |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 20.85 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.20E+01 FCZ: 2.22E+01 FCY: 2.31E+01 FTZ: 2.22E+01 FTY: 2.31E+01 | | SHEAR: 6.28E+00 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.06E-01 FBZ: 5.86E+00 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 3.99E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 47.00 AYY: 25.08 AZZ: 15.00 RZZ: 22.80 RYY: 3.60 | | SZZ: 853.77 SYY: 67.54 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 3.29 KL/R-Y: 20.85 UNL: 100.0 CMZ: 1.00 CMY: 1.00 | | CB: 1.75 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 0.90 | | CT: 0.85 STEEL TYPE: 1.0 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.005 1 5.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.009 1 5.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.272 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.635 1 1.00E+02 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|

International Design Codes Manual 909

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code


18D.1 General Comments
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as defined by the American Society of Mechanical Engineers Nuclear Facility (ASME NF) Code. The ASME NF-3000 2004 Code is used as the basis of this design. A brief description of some of the major allowable stresses is described herein. Note: This feature requires STAAD.Pro V8i (SELECTseries 2) NRC (build 20.07.07.30)or higher.

18D.2 Design Process


The design process follows the following design checks. 1. Slenderness 2. Tension 3. Compression 4. Bending Stress 5. Combined Interaction Check 6. Shear Stress Each one of the checks is described in the following sections. When a design is performed, the output file the reports the maximum utilization from all of the checks.

18D.2.1 Slenderness
As per NF-3322.2(c), the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.

910 STAAD.Pro

18D.2.2 Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60F ), but not more y than (0.5F ) on the Effective Net area.
u

The Net Area (A ) shall be determined in accordance with NF-3322.8(c)(1) - (a), n (b) and (c), and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (A ) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is e transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. NF-3322.8(c)(1)(d)), A =C A
e t n

Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)(1), (2) and (3). The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.

18D.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(1). The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(2). The allowable compressive stress for member elements other than columns constructed by any material, including austenitic stainless steel, shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(3). A. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) C,
c

F = [1 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2)]F / {5/3 + [3(Kl/r)/(8C )] a c y c [(Kl/r)3/(8C 3)]}


c

(Eq. A1) Where:

International Design Codes Manual 911

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code C = [(22E)/F ] 1/2


c y

2. When (Kl/r) > C , F =


a

c 2E/[23(kL/r)2] 12

(Eq. A2) 3. When (Kl/r) > 120, F


as

= F [(Eq.A1) or (Eq. A2)]/{1.6 - [l/(200r)]}


a

B. Gross sections of columns fabricated from Austenitic Stainless steel: 1. When (Kl/r) 120, F = F [0.47 - (Kl/r)/444]
a y

2. When (Kl/r) > 120, F = F [0.40 - (Kl/r)/600]


a y

C. Member elements other than columns: 1. For Plate Girder Stiffeners, F = 0.60F
a y

2. For webs of rolled shapes, F = 0.75F


a y

The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of NF-3322.2(d).. If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, A reduction factor Q is introduced. Detailed values of Q for different shapes s s are given in NF-3322.2(e)(2)(a) to NF-3322.2(e)(2)(d). In the case for angles or plates projecting from compression members and for projecting elements of compression flanges of girder, When 95/(F /kc)1/2 < b/t < 195/(F /kc)1/2, Q = 1.293 y y s 0.00309(b/t)(F /kc)1/2
y

Whenb/t > 195/(F /kc)1/2, Q = 26,200kc/[F (b/t)2)]


y s y

912 STAAD.Pro

Where: kc = 4.05/[(h/t)0.46] if h/t >70, otherwise kc = 1.0. b. For stiffened compression element, A reduced effective width b is introduced.
e

1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness: b = 253t/(f){1 - 50.3/[(b/t)(f)]} b
e

2. For other uniformly compressed elements: b = 253t/(f){1 - 44.3/[(b/t)(f)]} b


e

Consequently, a reduction factor Q is introduced and is equal to the a effective area divided by the actual area. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or unstiffened elements shall not exceed F = Q Q [1 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2)]F / {5/3 + [3(Kl/r)/(8C )] a s a c y c [(Kl/r)3/(8C 3)]}
c

Where: C' = [(22E)/(Q Q F )] 1/2


c s a y

18D.2.4 Bending Stress


Allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a structural member, as given in NF-3322.1(d) is: A. Along Major Axis: 1. For Compact Sections, tension and compression on extreme fibres of compact hot rolled or built-up members symmetrical about and loaded in the plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection NF shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66F
b y

If meeting the requirements of this member of:

International Design Codes Manual 913

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

a. Width-thickness ratio of unstiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 65/F .
y

b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F .
y

c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F 0.16
y a y a y

d/t = 257/F when f /F > 0.16


y a y

d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor 20000/(d/A )F .
f y f y

2. For noncompact and slender elements, NF-3322.1(d)(5) and NF3322.1(d)(3) are followed respectively. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.75F
b y

B. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF-3322.1(d)(1)(a) and (b), maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75F
b y

2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF-3322.1(d)(1)(a), except where b /2t > 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not y exceed: F = F [1.075 0.005(b /2t )F ]
b y f f y

18D.2.5 Combined Interaction Check


Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are proportioned to satisfy

914 STAAD.Pro

and

when f /F > 0.15,


a a

otherwise

It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy

18D.2.6 Shear Stress


Allowable shear stress on the gross section [ref. NF-3322.6(e)(2)] is calculated as

Where: , when C < 0.8


v

, when C > 0.8


v

, when a/h < 1.0 , when a/h > 1.0

International Design Codes Manual 915

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.

18D.3 Member Property Specification


For specification of member properties, the specified steel section available in Steel Section Library of STAAD may be used namely I-shaped section, Channel, Tee, HSS Tube, HSS Pipe, Angle, Double Angle, Double Channel section. Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility except for the General and Prismatic member. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.

18D.4 Design Parameters


The program contains a large number of parameter names which are required to perform design and code checks. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in the following table. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements for an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. For example, by default the KZ value (k value in local z-axis) of a member is set to 1.0, while in the real structure it may be 1.5. In that case, the KZ value in the program can be changed to 1.5, as shown in the input instruction (Section 5). Similarly, the TRACK value of a member is set to 0.0, which means no allowable stresses of the member will be printed. If the allowable stresses are to be printed, the TRACK value must be set to 1.0. Table 18C.2 - ASME NF 3000 2004 Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as NF3000 2004 Specified design code is followed for code checking purpose. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical

916 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

Reference Manual. CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.75 Cm value in local y & z axes

CT

Reduction Coefficient in computing effective net area of an axially loaded tension member. [Refer NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)] "Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection

DFF

None (Mandatory for deflection check)

DJ1

Start Joint of the member End Joint of the member 45 inch 0.0 inch

Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth

DJ2

DMAX DMIN

International Design Codes Manual 917

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code Parameter Name FYLD FU KY KZ LY LZ MAIN Default Value 36 KSI 60 KSI 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 0.0 Description

Yield strength of steel in current units. Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check

NSF RATIO STIFF

1.0 1.0 Member length or depth whichever is greater 0.0

Net Section Factor for tension member. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design

STYPE

0.0 = Normal Steel 1.0 = Austenitic Stainless Steel

TRACK

0.0

Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0. Minimum detail 1. Intermediate detail level

918 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

2. Maximum detail UNB Member Length Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.

UNT

Member Length

Notes 1. All values are entered in the current units. 2. The parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command.

18D.5 Code Checking and Member Selection


Both code checking and member selection options are available with the ASME NF3000 2004 code. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.

18D.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 100 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and a uniformly distributed load of 1 kip/inch over the whole span. The beam is assigned with B571806 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 2004. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below: International Design Codes Manual 919

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT INCHES KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 100 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST B571806 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -1.0 0 100 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER 1

920 STAAD.Pro

CODE NF3000 2004 STYPE 1 ALL FYLD 36 ALL KY 0.75 ALL KZ 0.75 ALL FU 58 ALL NSF 0.9 ALL CT 0.85 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH

The corresponding TRACK 2 output is as follows:


STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 ST B571806 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS NF-3322.1(b) 0.635 1 5.00 C 0.00 5000.00 0.00 |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 20.85 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.20E+01 FCZ: 2.22E+01 FCY: 2.31E+01 FTZ: 2.22E+01 FTY: 2.31E+01 | | SHEAR: 6.28E+00 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.06E-01 FBZ: 5.86E+00 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 3.99E+00 | INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCAASME NF3000-04)

International Design Codes Manual 921

ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code

|----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 47.00 AYY: 25.08 AZZ: 15.00 RZZ: 22.80 RYY: 3.60 | | SZZ: 853.77 SYY: 67.54 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 3.29 KL/R-Y: 20.85 UNL: 100.0 CMZ: 1.00 CMY: 1.00 | | CB: 1.75 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 0.90 | | CT: 0.85 STEEL TYPE: 1.0 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.005 1 5.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.009 1 5.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.272 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.635 1 1.00E+02 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------|

922 STAAD.Pro

Section 19

Norwegian Codes

International Design Codes Manual 923

924 STAAD.Pro

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD


19A.1 - General Notes
This user manual presents a description of the design basis, parameters and theory applied to STAAD.Pro for performing code checks according to NS 3472 ref. [1] and NPD ref. [5]. The code checks include:
l

stability check (buckling) lateral buckling check yield check (von Mises) stability check including local plate buckling of un-stiffened pipe walls according to NPD

The code check is available for the following cross-section types:


l

wide flange profiles (HEA, HEB, IPE etc.) pipe (OD xx ID xx) tube (RHS, HUP) channel angle type (only RA) rectangular massive box (prismatic) user table (wide flange, I-sections, tapered I, tube, channel and RA angle)

The code check is not available for the following cross-section types:
l

Double angles Tapered tubes Prismatic sections with too few section parameters defined Other sections that are not in the available list above

Please note the following:


l

NS 3472 and NPD code checking covered in this document are available through two separate STAAD.Pro Code check packages.

International Design Codes Manual 925

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

This document is not a lecture in use of NS 3472 or NPD. This document explains how, and which parts of, the Norwegian steel codes that have been implemented in STAAD.Pro. When L-sections are used, the Code Check requires RA angle definition. Weld design is not included in the Norwegian code checks. The prismatic section defined in the code check (rectangular massive box) is not identical to the general prismatic profile defined in the STAAD.Pro analysis package.

EDR does not accept any liability for loss or damage from or in consequence for use of the program.

Nomenclature
NS - refers to NS 3472 ref. [1] NS2 - refers to NS 3472 ref. [6] NPD - refers to NPD94 ref. [5]

References
1. NS 3472 3.utg. 2001 Prosjektering av stlkonstruksjoner Beregning og dimensjonering 2. STAAD.Pro Technical Reference Manual, Release 2002 3. NS 3472 1.utg. 1973 Prosjektering av stlkonstruksjoner Beregning og dimensjonering 4. Roark &Young`s 5th edition 5. NPD utg. 1994 Veiledning om utforming, beregning og dimensjonering av stlkonstruksjoner. Sist endret 1. oktober 1993.

926 STAAD.Pro

6. NS 3472 2.utg.1984 Prosjektering av stlkonstruksjoner Beregning og dimensjonering

19A.2 - Basis for Code Checking


19A.2.1 General
This section presents general information regarding the implementation of the Norwegian codes of practice for structural steel design. This manual describes the procedures and theory used for both NS and NPD. In general NS is used for all cross sections and shapes listed in section 1 of this manual. An exception is the treatment and check of pipe members in framed structures. NS does not give specific details about the treatment of pipes. Section 3.4 explains how this is adopted when NS is selected for code checking. The NPD however have a more thorough check of pipe members, and consider the effect of local buckling of the pipe wall in conjunction with the stability check. In addition, the NPD code gives joint capacity formulae for brace to chord connections for pipe members. The design philosophy and procedural logistics are based on the principles of elastic analysis and ultimate limit state design. Two major failure modes are recognized:
l

failure by overstressing failure by stability considerations

The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the characteristic stresses or capacities and the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. It is generally assumed that the user will take care of the detailing requirements like the provision of stiffeners and check the local effects like flange buckling, web crippling, etc. The user is allowed complete control over the design process through the use of the parameters listed in Table 2.1. Default values of parameters will yield reasonable results in most circumstances. However, the user should control the design and verify results through the use of the design parameters.

International Design Codes Manual 927

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

19A.2.2 Calculation of Forces and Bending Moments


Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary loading conditions and combinations provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary load combinations.

19A.2.3 Members with Axial Forces


For tension only members, axial tension capacity is checked for the ultimate limit stress. For compression members, axial compression capacity is checked in addition to lateral buckling and ultimate limit stress. The largest slenderness ratio () shall not be greater than 250 according to NS 11.7 Stability is checked as per the procedure of NS 12.3. The buckling curves of NS fig. 3 have been incorporated into the STAAD.Pro code check. The coefficient (as per NS Table 10) can be specified in both directions through the use of parameters CY and CZ. In the absence of parameters CY and /or CZ, default a- value will be according to NS table 11.

19A.2.4 Members with Axial Force and Bending Moments


For compression members with bending, interaction formulae of NS table 12.3.4.2 are checked for appropriate loading situation. All compression capacities are calculated per the procedure of NS 12.3. The equivalent moment factor is calculated using the procedure of NS table 12. Two different approaches are used depending upon whether the members can sway or not. Conditions for sidesway and transverse loading can be specified through the use of parameters SSY and SSZ. For members that cannot sway, without transverse loading, coefficients b are calculated and proper dimensioning moments are used in the interaction formulae.

19A.2.5 Lateral Buckling


Lateral torsional buckling is checked as per the procedure of NS 12.3.4. The procedure for calculation of ideal buckling moment for sections with two axis of symmetry has been implemented. The coefficient can be provided by the user through the use of parameter CB. In the absence of CB, a value of 1.0 will be used.

928 STAAD.Pro

Torsional properties for cross sections (torsional constant and warping constant) are calculated using formulae from NS 3472. This results in slightly conservative estimates of torsional parameters. The program will automatically select the maximum moment in cases where M is less than M .
vd zd

19A.2.6 Von Mises Yield Criterion


Combined effect of axial, bending, horizontal/vertical shear and torsional shear stress is calculated at 13 sections on a member and up to 9 critical points at a section. The worst stress value is checked against yield stress divided by appropriate material factor. The von Mises calculates as:

19A.2.7 Material Factor and nominal stresses


The design resistances are obtained by dividing the characteristic material strength by the material factor.

NS 3472
The material factor default value is 1.10. Other values may be input with the MF parameter. The nominal stresses should satisfy

NPD
The general requirement is according to NPD 3.1.1. For stability the NPD 3.1.1 and 3.1.3 requires that the structural coefficient is considered.

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 929

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

S = reference stress or load effect resultant


d

f = characteristic capacity
k

kd m

= design capacity

= material coefficient
m mk

= structural coefficient

is default set to 1.10. shall be equal to 1.0 for frames. For pipe members is a function of the mk mk reduced slenderness. In the STAAD.Pro implemented NPD code this is calculated automatically.

19A.2.8 Code checking according to NPD


The following parts of Chapter 3 in the NPD guidelines have been implemented. a. Control of nominal stresses. (NPD 3.1.2). b. Buckling of pipe members in braced frames, including interaction with local shell buckling (NPD 3.2.2, 3.2.3). c. Buckling of un-stiffened closed cylindrical shells, including interaction with overall column buckling (NPD 3.4.4, 3.4.6, 3.4.7 and 3.4.9). d. Joint capacity check for gap as well as for overlap joints (NPD 3.5.2). Check b) provides the unity check based on the beam-column buckling interaction formulae in NPD 3.2.2. The interaction between global and local buckling due to axial load and hydrostatic pressure is accounted for through computation of an axial characteristic capacity to replace the yield stress inn the beam-column buckling formulae. Note: Check b) handles members subjected to axial loads, bending moments and hydrostatic pressure. In other words, check b) assumes that stresses resulting from shear and torsion are of minor importance, e.g., in jacket braces. Check c) provides the unity check based on the stability requirement for unstiffened cylindrical shells subjected to axial compression or tension, bending, circumferential compression or tension, torsion or shear. The unity check refers to

930 STAAD.Pro

the interaction formulae in NPD 3.4.4.1. The stability requirement is given in NPD 3.4.7.

19A.2.9 Aluminum Check


STAAD.Pro performs a stability check on aluminum alloys according to buckling curve in ECCS (European recommendation for aluminum ally structures 1978). It is possible to select heat-treated or non heat-treated alloy from the parameter list in the STAAD.Pro input file. For heat-treated use CY = CZ = 0.1590, and for non heat-treated use CY = CZ = 0.2420. Tracks 1.0 and 9.0 print buckling curve H for heat-treated, and buckling curve N for non neat-treated. The yield check is the same as for steel.

19A.3 Design Parameters


Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular structure. Table 19A.1 - Design Parameters for Norwegian Steel design code Parameter Name CODE Default Value none Description Reference

Must be secified as either NS3472 for NS or NPD for NPD (NOR may also be used for both). Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BEAM

0.0

Parameter BEAM 1.0 ALL Sec. NS tells the program to calculate 12.2.2 von Mises at 13 sections along each member, and up to 8 points at each section. (Depending on what kind of shape is used.)

International Design Codes Manual 931

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD Parameter Name Default Value Description Reference

Note: Must be set to 1.0 BY 1.0 Buckling length coefficient, Fig. NS 3 for weak axis buckling (y-y) Sec. NS (NOTE: BY > 0.0) 12.3 Buckling length coefficient, , for strong axis buckling (z-z) (NOTE: BZ > 0.0) Lateral buckling coefficient, Y. Used to calculate the ideal buckling moments, M
vi

BZ

1.0

Fig. NS 3 Sec. NS 12.3 Sec. NS2 A5.5.2 Fig. NS2 A5.5.2a)e) Valid for the NPD code only Sec. NS 12.3.4 Fig. NS 6. Fig. NS 3 Sec. NS 12.2 NS Table 11

CB

1.0

CMY

1.0

Water depth in meters for hydrostatic pressure calculation for pipe members for sections in conLT nection with lateral buckling Buckling curve coefficient, a about local z-axis (strong axis). Represent the a, a0, b, c, d curve. Maximum allowable depth of steel section. Minimum allowable depth of steel section. Yield strength of steel, fy (St37) [N/mm2 ]

CMZ

0.49

CY CZ

Default see NS 3472 100.0 [cm] 0.0 [cm] 235

DMAX DMIN FYLD MF

Tab. NS 3 Sec. NS 10.4.2

1.1 Material factor / Resistance (NS3472) factor,


m

932 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value 1.15 (NPD)

Description

Reference

Sec. NPD 3.1 Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = No sidesway. calculated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis weak axis =SSY
M

RATIO SSY

1.0 0.0

Sec. NS 12.3.4.2 Sec. NS 12.3.4 Tab. NS 12 Sec. NPD 3.2.1.4

SSZ

0.0

0.0 = No sidesway. calSec. NS culated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in 12.3.4 local y-axis weak axis Tab. NS M 12 Sec NPD 3.2.1.4 0.0 = Supress critical member stresses. 1.0 = Print all critical member stresses, i.e., DESIGN VALUES 2.0 = Print von Mises stresses. 9.0 = Large output, 1 page for each member. See section 7 and Appendix A for complete list of available TRACKs and print examples. Effective length for lateral Sec. NS buckling calculations (spec- 12.3 ify buckling length). Distance between fork supports or between effective side supports for the beam

TRACK

0.0

UNL

Member length

International Design Codes Manual 933

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

The parameter CMY will, when given with negative value, define an inside pressure in pipe members. The pressure corresponds to given water depth in meters. The parameter CB defines the value with respect to calculation of the ideal lateral buckling moment for single symmetric wide flange profiles, ref. NS app. 5.2.2.

Example
Note: This is a partial example containing only the information pertaining to the Norwegian steel design code; used at the end of the input file.

* CODE CHECK ACCORDING TO NS3472 PARAMETERS CODE NS3472 BEAM 1.0 ALL FYLD 340 ALL MF 1.10 ALL CY 0.49 MEMB 1 CZ 0.49 MEMB 1 BY 0.9 MEMB 1 BZ 0.7 MEMB 1 SSY 1.1 MEMB 1 SSZ 1.3 MEMB 1 CB 0.9 MEMB 1 RATIO 1.0 ALL TRACK 9.0 ALL UNIT KNS METER LOAD LIST 1 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 FINISH

934 STAAD.Pro

19A.4 - Stability Check According to NS 3472


19A.4.1 General Description
The stability check is based on the assumption that both ends of the member are structural nodes. Buckling lengths and results for member with joints between the structural nodes have to be evaluated in each separate case. Effects from local buckling or external hydrostatic pressure on pipes and tubes are not included. The general stability criteria is: (ref. NS 12.3)

Buckling
n
max

+k m +k m 1
z z y y

Lateral Buckling

i = z,y

International Design Codes Manual 935

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

19A.4.2 Determination of and


z

The equivalent moment factor (for z and y) is calculated dependant on moment distributions as shown in the following table:

936 STAAD.Pro

Table 19A.2 - for different moment distributions Moment diagram


M

( )
LT

= 1.8 - 0.7

M0

= 1.3

M0

= 1.4

The user can override the calculated factor with the following parameters: =SSY
y z

=SSZ

19A.4.3 Lateral buckling


The Ideal lateral buckling moment is calculated according to NS2 A5.5.2

International Design Codes Manual 937

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

concern double symmetric cross sections where y is given in NS fig. A5.5.2, (input parameter CB), L = member length for lateral buckling (input parameter UNL), Cw and Ix , see section 5. For single symmetric cross sections, the ideal lateral buckling moment is

Where:

= distance from profile CoG to point where the load is acting, assumed to be on top flange. The parameter (ref NS fig. A5.5.2.g) is controlled by the input parameter CB.

Fig A - -koeffisienter for enkel bjelke

938 STAAD.Pro

Fig B - -koeffisienter for delvis innspent bjelke

International Design Codes Manual 939

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

Fig B - -koeffisienter for tilnrmet fulltinnspente bjelke

940 STAAD.Pro

Fig B - -koeffisienter for utraget bjelke med enkel last og fordelt last. Stiplede kurver gjelder last p overflens.

19A.4.4 Stability check of pipe members


The stability criteria applied for members with pipe cross section is:

Where:

and

are given in NS 5.4.2.


E vd

For the print output option TRACK 9.0 K 1.0 and M

International Design Codes Manual 941

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

19A.4.5 Angle profiles type RA (reverse angle)


The axial contribution to the total interaction ratio is checked according to the modified EECS-method, see NS A5.4. The stability criterion is:

Where:

N and N are found from NS 3472 fig. 5.4.la C-curve for y- and zkyd kzd axis, respectively.

Possible lateral buckling effects and torsional buckling (NS A5.4.5) is not included in the code check. This has to be evaluated by the user separately.

942 STAAD.Pro

19A.4.6 Stability check of members with tapered section


Stability of members with tapered cross section is calculated as described in section 3.1. The cross section properties used in the formulae are calculated based on the average profile height. (i.e., I , I values are taken from the middle of the member.)
z y

19A.4.7 Lateral buckling for tension members


When compressive stress caused by large bending moment about strong axis is greater than tension stress from axial tension force, lateral buckling is considered as defined below. = N/A (+ tension, - compression)
a

bz

= M /W
z a

z b z a b

warp

= | + | W for + < 0 (compression)


warp

IR = M

/M

vd

+M

y,max

/M

yd

1.0

19A.5 - Stability Check According to NPD


19A.5.1 Buckling of pipe members
Tubular beam-columns subjected to compression and lateral loading or end moments shall be designed in accordance with NPD 3.2.2

Where: = N/A = axial compressive stress


c

mk

= structural coefficient

B = bending amplification factor = 1/ (1 - ), B is taken as the larger of B and B


z z y

B = bending amplification factor about the Z-axis B = bending amplification factor about the Y-axis
y

International Design Codes Manual 943

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

l = kl
k

k = effective length factor f = characteristic buckling capacity according to NS fig. 5.4.1a, curve k A.

19A.5.1.1 Interaction with local buckling, NPD 3.2.3


If the below conditions are not satisfied, the yield strength will be replaced with characteristic buckling stress given in NPD 3.4. a. members subjected to axial compression and external pressure

b. members subjected to axial compression only

19A.5.2 Calculation of buckling resistance of cylinders


The characteristic buckling resistance is defined in accordance with NPD 3.4.4

944 STAAD.Pro

Where:

= design axial stress in the shell due to axial forces (tension positive)
a

= design bending stress in the shell due to global bending moment b (tension positive) = = design circumferential stress in the shell due to external p pressure (tension positive) = design shear stress in the shell due to torsional moments and shear S force. f , f , f and f are the elastic buckling resistances of curved panels ea eb ep e or circular cylindrical shells subjected to axial compression forces, global bending moments, lateral pressure, and torsional moments and/or shear forces respectively.

International Design Codes Manual 945

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

19A.5.3 Elastic buckling resistance for un-stiffened, closed cylinders


The elastic buckling resistance for un-stiffened closed cylinders according to NPD 3.4.6 is:

where k is a buckling coefficient dependent on loading condition, aspect ratio, curvature, boundary conditions, and geometrical imperfections. The buckling coefficient is:

The values of , and p are given in Table 4.1 for the most important loading cases. Table 19A.3 - Table 4.1 Buckling coefficients for un-stiffened cylindrical shells Axial stress 1 0.702 Z p

Bending

0.702 Z

Torsion and shear force 5.34 0.856 Z0.75 0.6 Lateral pressure Hyrdostatic pressure 4 2 1.04 Z0.5 1.04 Z0.5 0.6 0.6

The curvature parameter is defined by

946 STAAD.Pro

For long shells the elastic buckling resistance against shear stresses is independent

of shell length. For cases with taken as:

, the elastic buckling resistance may be

19A.5.4 Stability requirements


The stability requirement for curved panels and un-stiffened cylindrical shells subjected to axial compression or tension, bending, circumferential compression or tension, torsion or shear is given by NPD 3.4.7: <f
j kd

where the design buckling resistance is

19A.5.5 Column buckling, NPD 3.4.9


For long cylindrical shells it is possible that interaction between shell buckling and overall column buckling may occur because second-order effects of axial compression alter the stress distribution as compared to that calculated from linear theory. It is necessary to take this effect into account in the shell buckling analysis when the reduced slenderness of the cylinder as a column exceeds 0,2 according to NPD 3.4.4.1. shall be increased by an additional compressive stress which may be taken as:
b

Where:

International Design Codes Manual 947

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

= slenderness of the cylinder as a column. B, , and are calculated in accordance with NPD 3.2.2.
a b

19A.6 - Yield Check


The yield check is performed at member ends and at 11 equally spaced intermediate sections along the member length. At each section the following forces are applied: F max. axial force along member
x

F actual shear in local y-direction at section


y z

F actual shear in local z-direction at section M max. torsional moment along member
x

M actual bending about local y-axis at section


y z

M actual bending about local z-axis at section For all profiles other than angle sections absolute values of the stresses are used. For double symmetric profiles there will always be one stresspoint. The stresses are calculated in several stress points at each member section. At each stress point the von Mises stress is checked as follows:

948 STAAD.Pro

Where:
tot p

=| +
x

by

bz

stress from hydrostatic pressure.

19A.6.1 Double symmetric wide flange profile


The von Mises stress is checked at 4 stress points as shown in figure below.

Section Properties
A , I , I and I are taken from STAAD.Pro database
x x y z

A = h s Applied in STAAD.Pro print option PRINT MEMBER y STRESSES

A and A are not used in the code check


y z

International Design Codes Manual 949

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

ref. NS app. C3 T = dA z
y z

T = dA y

General Stress calculation

Stress calculation at selected stress points

In general wide flange profiles are not suitable for large torsional moments. The reported torsional stresses are indicative only. For members with major torsional stresses a separate evaluation has to be carried out. Actual torsional stress distribution is largely dependent on surface curvature at stress point and warping resistance.

950 STAAD.Pro

19A.6.2 Single symmetric wide flange profile and tapered section


The von Mises stress is checked at 9 stress points as shown in figure below.

Section properties
A , I , I and I are taken from STAAD.Pro database, except for x x y z tapered sections where these values are calculated for each section checked. (i.e., Iz, Iy values are taken from the middle of the member.) A = h s Applied in STAAD.Pro print option PRINT MEMBER y STRESSES

A and A are not used in the code check


y z

ref. NS app. C3

International Design Codes Manual 951

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

T = dA z
y z

T = dA y

General Stress calculation

Stress calculation at selected stress points

952 STAAD.Pro

In general wide flange profiles are not suitable for large torsional moments. The reported torsional stresses are indicative only. For members with major torsional stresses a separate evaluation has to be carried out. Actual torsional stress distribution is largely dependent on surface curvature at stress point and warping resistance.

19A.6.3 Pipe profile


The von Mises stress is checked in 3 stress points as shown in figure below.

Section properties
d = D - 2t r = 0.5 ( D-t )

International Design Codes Manual 953

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD a = tan-1 M /M Ax = /4


y z

z y (D2 - d2) x

A = A = 0.5A
x z

I = 2I =/32 (D4 - d4) I = I = /64 (D4 - d4)


y z

Note: In the STAAD.Pro analysis package slightly different values are used for A , A and I , however this has insignificant influence y z x on the force distribution. A = A = 0.6A
Y z

I = 2R3t
x

Stress calculation at selected stress points

19A.6.4 Tube profile


Tube sections are rectangular or quadratic hollow uniform profiles. Critical stress is checked at 5 locations as shown in figure below.

954 STAAD.Pro

Section Properties

International Design Codes Manual 955

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

Stress calculation at selected stress points

The general stress formulation is given in sec. 5.2.

19A.6.5 Channel profile


For channel profiles the von Mises stress is checked at 6 locations as shown in the figure below.

956 STAAD.Pro

International Design Codes Manual 957

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

Cross section properties

Stress calculations at selected stress points

958 STAAD.Pro

The general stress formulation is given in sec. 5.2.f

19A.6.6 Angle profile type RA (reverse angle)


For angle profiles the von Mises check is checked at 8 stress points as shown in figure below.

Axes y and z are principal axes. Axes u and w are local axes.

International Design Codes Manual 959

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

Cross section properties

Section forces
The section forces from the STAAD.Pro analysis are about the principle axis y and z. The second moment of area (Ty L TZ): T =AZ
y z

T =AY

960 STAAD.Pro

Stress calculation at selected stress points

An additional torsional moment is calculated based on: M = F Z4


T T y z

M = F Y4 This torsion moment is included in M if F and F exist.


x y Z

Beta-rotation of equal & unequal legged angles


Note: The order of the joint numbers in the member incidence command specifies the direction of the local x-axis.

International Design Codes Manual 961

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

962 STAAD.Pro

19A.6.7 Rectangular massive box (prismatic)


Code check of the general purpose prismatic cross section defined in the STAAD.Pro analysis package is not available. The prismatic section is assumed to be a rectangular massive box and the von Mises stress is checked at 3 locations as shown in figure below.

Note: Note that b may not be much greater than h. If that is the case, define the member with h > b and Beta angle 90 instead.

Section Properties

International Design Codes Manual 963

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

General Stress Calculation

ref. [4] tab. 20, case 4 at midpoint the largest side i.e., point 2

Stress calculation at selected stress points

19A.7 - Tubular Joint Check, NPD 3.5


For pipe members, punching shear capacity is checked in accordance with the NPD sections 3.5.1 to 3.5.2, except 3.5.2.4. The chord is defined as the member with the greater diameter in the joint. If the diameters are the same the program selects the member with the greater thickness of the two. The chord members must be collinear by 5 degrees. The punching shear run sequence is performed in two steps. The program will first identify all tubular joints and classify them as T type joints (TRACK99). The joints to be checked will be listed in a file specified in the CODE NPD parameter list,

964 STAAD.Pro

below called GEOM1. This file is used as input in the second run. The file is an editable ACSII file saved under the file name given in the CODE NPD parameter. The TRACK parameter is then set to 98 which directs the program to read from the file GEOM1 file and use it as input to the second run, i.e., the joint capacity checking. The program will check the capacity for both chord members entering the joint. The local y and z moments will be transformed into the plane defined by the joint itself and the far end joints of the brace and chord, defined as in- and out-of plane moments. The ASCII file should be edited to reflect the correct classification of the joints, gap, can or stub dimensions, yield stress and other geometric options if required. The program will not change the brace or chord definition if this is changed or modified in the input file GEOM1. See Appendix A page xx for GEOM1 example file. Joint classification parameters in the file GEOM1 are: KO K joint overlapped KG K joint with gap TY T or Y joint X X joint Input example for the classification run.
*CLASSIFICATION OF JOINTS, TRACK 99 UNITS MM NEWTON PARAMETER CODE NPD GEOM1 FYLD 350 ALL TRACK 99 ALL BEAM 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL

6.1 Static strength of tubular joints


The basic consideration is the chord strength. The required chord wall thickness shall be determined when the other dimensions are given.

International Design Codes Manual 965

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

The following symbols are used: T = Cord wall thickness t = Brace wall thickness R = Outer radius of chord r = Outer radius of brace = Angel between chord and considered brace D = Outer diameter of chord d = Outer diameter of brace a = Gap (clear distance) between considered brace and nearest loadcarrying brace measured along chord outer surface = r/R g = R/T g = a/D f = Yield stress
y

Q = Factor
f

Q = See table 6.1


g

Q = See table 6.1


u

Q d = See table 6.1 N = Design axial force in brace M = Design in-plane bending moment in brace
IP

OP

= Design out-of plane bending moment in brace

N = Characteristic axial load capacity of brace (as governed by the k chord strength) M = Characteristic out-of-plane bending moment capacity of brace OPk (as governed by the chord strength)
ax IP

= Design axial stress in chord

= Design in-plane bending stress in chord

966 STAAD.Pro

OP

= Design out-of-plane bending stress in chord

This section gives design formulae for simple tubular joints without overlap and without gussets, diaphragms or stiffeners. Tubular joints in a space frame structure shall satisfy:

Q is given in Table 6.1. Qf is a factor to account for the nominal longitudinal stress u in the chord.

Table 19A.4 - Values for Q Type of joint and geometry

Type of load in brace member Axial In-plane bending Out-ofplane bending 3.2/(1-0.81)

T and Y X K

2.5 +19 (2.7 +13)Q

5.0()

0.90(2+21)Q

International Design Codes Manual 967

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

but in no case shall Q be taken as less than 1.0.


g

When 0.9, Q is set to 1.0. This is also applicable for moment loading. For f cases with tension in the chord, Qf is set to 1.0. This is also applicable for moment loading. The brace end moments shall be accounted for in the following cases: a. Out-of-plane bending moment when > 0.85 b. When the brace acts as a cantilever c. When the rotational stiffness of the connection is considered in the determination of effective buckling length, and / or the structural coefficient mk = 1.00 for the beam-column design of the brace or chord. See Section 3.1.3. The characteristic capacity of the brace subjected to in-plane bending moment shall be determined by:

The characteristic capacity of the brace subjected to out-of-plane bending moment shall be determined by:

968 STAAD.Pro

For combined axial and bending loads in the brace, the following interaction equation should be satisfied:

For overlapping tubular joints without gussets, diaphragms, or stiffeners, the total load component normal to the chord, NN, shall not exceed

where (see NPD fig. 3.10) l = circumference for that portion of the brace in contact with the chord l (actual length) l = circumference of brace contact with chord, neglecting presence of overlap N = characteristic axial load capacity of brace
k

t = the lesser of the throat thickness of the overlapping weld or the w thickness t of the thinner brace l = length as shown in NPD fig. 3.10
2

The above formula for the capacity of overlapping joints is valid only for K joints, where compression in a brace is essentially balanced by tension in brace(s) in the same side of the joint.

19A.8 - Tabulated Results/ TRACKs


This section presents a table with the various TRACKs available with respect to print out from the code check. Example prints and explanation to the information / heading given on the print out is given in Appendix A.

International Design Codes Manual 969

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD Table 19A.5 - Available TRACKs TRACK no. 0 1 2 3 9 Description

Brief print of member utilizations (2 lines for each member) sorted with highest utilized members first Based on TRACK 3 with additional information regarding stability factors and capacities Simple print of stresses, incl von Mises stress Brief print of member utilizations (2 lines for each member) Comprehensive print with detailed information about member and member utilization(one page for each member) Used in connection with tubular joint check according to NPD. This TRACK identifies tubular joints to be checked and classifies all members entering the joint as T connection Used in connection with tubular joint check according to NPD. This TRACK performs the joint capacity check Prints member end forces for members entering each joint (at the end of the member connected to the joint) Prints maximum and minimum member end forces (axial force defines max and min) at member end 1 Prints maximum and minimum member end forces (axial force defines max and min) at member end 2

99

98 49 31 32

970 STAAD.Pro

Tracks for member code checking


TRACK = 0.0

International Design Codes Manual 971

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

TRACK = 1.0

972 STAAD.Pro

TRACK = 2.0

International Design Codes Manual 973

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

TRACK = 3.0

TRACK = 9.0
Member in tension:

974 STAAD.Pro

Member in compression:

International Design Codes Manual 975

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

976 STAAD.Pro

Member in compression (pipe - NPD):

International Design Codes Manual 977

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

978 STAAD.Pro

Tracks for joint capacity code checking


TRACK = 99

International Design Codes Manual 979

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

TRACK = 98

980 STAAD.Pro

Special prints (not code check)


TRACK = 49

TRACK = 31

International Design Codes Manual 981

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD

TRACK = 32

982 STAAD.Pro

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004


19B.1 - General Notes
This section presents a description of the design basis, parameters, and theory used in STAAD.Pro for performing code checks for tubular members according to NORSOK N-004 Rev 2, October 2004 (hereafter referred to as N-004). Please note the following:
l

The code check is available for the pipe cross sections only. The design of conical transitions and joints with joint cans is not performed.

19B.2 Member Resistances


The implementation of the NORSOK N-004 code in STAAD.Pro considers sections 4, 5, 6 & 7 in of that document. The details of the various clauses implemented from these sections is presented here for member checking and design.

General Provisions
The general safety check is per Section 4. Checks are made to ensure that the design action effect (S ) is less than or equal to the design resistance (R ):
d d

S R
d

The design resistance is evaluated for each condition and this check is applied as described in the following sections.

Steel selection and non destructive testing


Section 5 deals with the choice of design class for structural joints and components. The choice of design class will determine the choice of steel grade & quality and also the determination of inspection category for fatigue. The choice of design class (as per Table 5-1 of the code) is left to you and does not have any direct impact on how STAAD.Pro performs design checks.

International Design Codes Manual 983

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

Ultimate Limit States


Clause 6.1 primarily deals with the section of material factors to be used in the various conditions or checks. The material factors chosen are dependent on the section class of a cross section. N-004 does not explicitly specify how to classify various cross sections. Therefore, the section classification is made as given in Section 5.5 of EN 1993-1-1:2005, except when specified explicitly along with member checks (See Member Subject to Axial Compression). Also, N-004 does not specify steel grades to be used. Therefore, this STAAD.Pro uses the steel grades per EN 1993-1-1:2005 for designs per N-004. Note: Ring stiffener design to CL. 6.3.6.2 is not included for this implementation.

Tubular Members
Clause 6.3.1 deals with the general considerations while using tubular members. Warning: Only tubular sections can be used with the N-004 code in STAAD.Pro. A warning is presented for any other section type. The dimensions of the tubular sections are limited as follows:
l

The thickness t 6 mm. The thickness t <150 mm. The slenderness ratio of the cross section D/t < 120. Where D is the diameter and t is the wall thickness of the section.

The yield strength for tubular member 500 N/mm2.

If any of these conditions are not met for a member selected for design, a warning will be issued by the engine and the design of that member is aborted. Note: N-004 uses Y to define the action effects that is in plane and Z to define out of plane effects. This is the opposite to what STAAD uses, where Z defines the in plane effects and Y the out of plane effects. This document will follow the STAAD.Pro convention for the Z and Y axes.

984 STAAD.Pro

The N-004 code also segregates members into those that are subject to hydrostatic pressure and those that are not subject to hydrostatic pressure. The program allows you to specify whether a member is subject to hydrostatic pressure or not and, if so, to specify the hydrostatic pressure for the element. By default the program will assume that all members are not subject to any hydrostatic pressure. The design parameter HYD is used to specify the maximum water level with respect to the origin. If the HYD parameter is specified, the program will take that to be the water level and will evaluate the pressure distribution on each element assuming a linear increase in pressure with depth (The density of water is assumed to be 9.8 KN/m3). Also, if the HYD parameter is specified, the program will assume that the hydrostatic loads have not been included in the analysis. For members that are subject to a combination of loads (i.e., bending plus compression) along with a hydrostatic pressure, the design will be done according to Clause 6.3.9 of the code. In the absence of any hydrostatic pressure on the member the design will be performed in accordance with Clause 6.3.8 of the code.

19B.2.1 Ultimate Limit State


Axial Tension
Clause 6.3.2 states that tubular members subject to axial tension shall satisfy the following condition: N Where: N
Sd Sd

t,Rd

= A f /
y

= Design axial force (tension positive)

f = Characteristic yield strength


y

A = Cross section area = Default material factor = 1.15


m

Axial Compression
Clause 6.3.3 states that tubular members subject to axial compression shall satisfy the following condition:

International Design Codes Manual 985

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

N Where: N

Sd

c,Rd

= A f /
c

Sd

= Design axial force (compression positive)

f = Characteristic axial compressive strength


c

= Refer to clause 6.3.7


m

The design axial compressive strength for a member that is not subject to any hydrostatic pressure will be taken as the smaller of in plane or out of plane buckling strengths determined by the equations given below: f = [1.0 - 028 2]f when 1.34
c c y

f =

0.9/2
cl E

f when > 1.34


y cl

= (f /f ) = k l/( i)(f /E) Where: f = Characteristic local buckling strength


cl

= Column slenderness parameter f = Smaller Euler buckling strength in y or z direction.


E

E = Young's modulus of elasticity = 2.1x105 MPa k = Effective length factor, refer to Clause 6.3.8.2 l = Longer unbraced length in y or z direction i = Radius of gyration. The characteristic local buckling strength is determined from: f = f when f /f
cl y y cle

0.170 (Plastic yielding)

f = [1.047 - 0.274 f /f ] f when 0.170 < f /f 1.911 cl y cle y y cle (Elastic/Plastic) f =f


cl cle

when f /f

y cle

> 1.911 (Elastic buckling)

Where: f
cle e

= 2C E t/D (Characteristic elastic local buckling strength)


e

C = 0.3 (Critical elastic buckling coefficient)

986 STAAD.Pro

D = Outside diameter t = wall thickness For a member that is subject to pure compression, if f /f > 0.170, the section will y cle be classed as a CLASS 4 (slender section). In such cases, the value of the material factor ( ) used in the above checks is increased according to equation 6.22 (Cl. m 6.3.7) of the code.

Bending
Clause 6.3.4 states that tubular members subject to pure bending alone shall satisfy: M Where: M
Sd Sd

Rd

=f

W/

= Design bending moment

f = Characteristic bending strength


m

W = Elastic section modulus = Refer to clause 6.3.7


m

The bending strength f is calculated as:


m

f = Z/W f when f D/(E t) 0.0517


m y y

f = [1.13 - 2.58 f D/(E t)] Z/W f when 0.0517 < f D/(E t) m y y y 0.1034 f = [0.94 - 0.76 f D/(E t)] Z/W f when 0.1034 < f D/(E t) m y y y 120 f /E
y

Shear
Clause 6.3.5 states that tubular members subject to shear shall satisfy: V
Sd

Rd

= A f /(23
y

m)

Where: V
Sd

= Design shear force

International Design Codes Manual 987

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

f = Yield strength
y

A = Cross section area = Default material factor = 1.15


m

When torsional shear stresses are present, the following condition shall also be satisfied: M Where: M
T,Sd T,Sd

T,Rd

= 2 I f /(D3
py

m)

= Design bending moment

I = Polar moment of inertia


p

Hydrostatic Pressure
Clause 6.3.6 states that tubular members subject to an external pressure shall primarily be checked for hoop buckling. The condition to be satisfied is:
p,Sd

h,Rd

= f /
h

m)

Where: p
p,Sd Sd

=p

Sd

D/(2 t)

= Design hydrostatic pressure

f = Characteristic hoop buckling strength


h

m)

= Refer to clause 6.3.7


h

The characteristic hoop buckling strength f , will be calculated as follows: f = f when f


h h h y he

> 2.44 f

f = 0.7 f (f /f f =f
he

y he y he

y 0.4 when )

2.44 f f
y

he

> 0.55 f

when f

0.55 f

y he

The elastic hoop buckling strength f f


he

will be worked out as follows:

= 2C E t/D
h

Where:

988 STAAD.Pro

C = 0.44 t/D when 1.6 D/t


h h h h

C = 0.44 t/D + 0.21 (D/t)3/4 when 0.825 D/t <1.6 D/t C = 0.737/( - 0.579) when 1.5 < 0.825 D/t C = 0.8 when <1.5 = Geometric Parameter = L/D(2 D/t) L = Length of tubular member between stiffening rings, diaphragms, or end connections.

Combined Axial Tension and Bending (without Hydrostatic Pressure)


Clause 6.3.8.1 states that tubular members subject to axial tension and bending shall be designed to satisfy the following condition:

Where: M M N
y,Sd z,Sd

is the design bending moment about the y axis (out-of plane axis) is the design bending moment about the z axis (in plane axis)

Sd Rd

is the design axial force is the moment resistance (as determined by Clause 6.3.4)

N is the tension capacity of the section (as determined by Clause t,Rd 6.3.2)

Combined Axial Compression and Bending (without Hydrostatic Pressure)


Clause 6.3.8.2 states that tubular members subject to axial tension and bending shall be designed to satisfy the following conditions:

International Design Codes Manual 989

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

and

Where: N
Sd

is the design axial compression

C and C are the reduction factors corresponding to the Y and Z my mz axes respectively. You may specify a value for these using the CMY and CMZ design parameters, respectively (default is 0.85 for both). N and N are the Euler buckling loads about y & z axes and are ey ez given by:

k is the effective length factor and is given in table 6-2 of the code. N
cl, Rd

is the design axial local buckling resistance given by:

f is the characteristic local buckling strength(as determined by Clause cl 6.3.3) The reduction factors used in this clause depend on the structural element type and will be as given in Table 6-2 of N-004. This requires the member to be classified under any one of the section types given in the table.

990 STAAD.Pro

Combined Bending and Shear (without Hydrostatic Pressure)


Clauses 6.3.8.3 & 6.3.8.4 state that tubular members subject to beam shear force (excluding shear due to torsion) and bending moments shall satisfy: M /M
Sd Sd Rd Rd

(1.4 - V /V ) when V /V 0.4


Sd Rd Sd Rd

M /M

1.0 when V /V < 0.4


Sd Rd

If the member is subject to shear forces due to torsion along with bending moments, the condition to be satisfied is: M /M
Sd Sd Red,Rd Red,Rd

(1.4 - V /V ) when V /V 0.4


Sd Rd Sd Rd

M /M Where: M f

1.0 when V /V < 0.4


Sd Rd

Red,Rd

=W f
m

m,Red

m,Red T,Sd

= f [1 - 3(
T,Sd

=M
y

/(2

T,Sd d R2 t)

/f )2]

f = f /
d

R = Radius of the tubular member = Refer to clause 6.3.7


m

Combined Loads with Hydrostatic Pressure


Clause 6.3.9 of NS-004 describes two methods to check for members subject to combined forces in the presence of hydrostatic pressure: depending on whether the hydrostatic forces were included as nodal forces in the analysis or not. If the hydrostatic forces have not been included in the analysis as nodal forces, Method A given in the code is used. If, however, the hydrostatic forces have been included in the analysis, then Method B in the code is used. Prior to proceeding with the checks described in the sections below, the section is verified for hoop stress limit per clause 6.3.6 (see Hydrostatic Pressure above). The choice of method for checking members subject to combined forces and hydrostatic pressure used by STAAD.Pro will depend on the HYD parameter specified as a design parameter. If the HYD parameter has been specified, then the

International Design Codes Manual 991

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

program will assume that the hydrostatic forces have not been included in the analysis and will perform the necessary checks as per Method A in code. If, on the other hand, the HYD parameter has not been specified, the program will use the section forces and use Method B in the code.

Combined Axial Tension, Bending, and Hydrostatic Pressure


Checks per Clause 6.3.9.1: A. When HYDis specified: The following condition is to be satisfied: a. For the net axial tension condition (
a,Sd

q,Sd

Where: is the design axial stress, excluding any axial a,Sd compression from hydrostatic pressure. is the design axial compressive stress due to q,Sd hydrostatic pressure. (i.e., the axial load arising from the hydrostatic pressure being applied as nodal loads). f f
my,Sd mz,Sd

is the out of plane bending stress is the in plane bending stress


y m

th,RD

= f / [(1 +0.09 B2 - B2) - 0.3B] = f / [(1 +0.09 B2 - B2) - 0.3B]


m m

mh,RD

B=

psd

/f

h,Rd h y a,Sd

= 5 - 4 f /f

b. For the net axial compression condition (

<

q,Sd

992 STAAD.Pro

Where: f
cl,Rd

= f /
cl

f is the characteristic local buckling strength(as cl determined by Clause 6.3.3) Additionally, when:
c,Sd

> 0.5 f /
he

and f
cle

>0.5 f

he

the following condition shall be satisfied in addition to the above check(s):

Where:
c,Sd

is the maximum compressive stress at that section.

B. When HYD has not been specified:

Where:
ac,Sd

is the axial stress in the member

Combined Axial Compression, Bending, and Hydrostatic Pressure


Checks per Clause 6.3.9.2:

International Design Codes Manual 993

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

A. Method used when HYDhas been specified: The following condition is to be satisfied:

and

Where: is the design axial stress that excludes the stress from a,Sd hydrostatic pressure

Additionally, when:
c,Sd

> 0.5 f /
he

and f
cle

>0.5 f

he

the following condition shall be satisfied in addition to the above check(s):

994 STAAD.Pro

B. Method used when HYD has not been specified: The following condition is to be satisfied: a. For the net axial tension condition (
ac,Sd

q,Sd

and

(Refer to the previous section for an explanation of these terms). b. For the net axial compression condition (
ac,Sd

<

q,Sd

(Refer to the previous section for an explanation of these terms). Additionally, when:
c,Sd

> 0.5 f /
he

and f / >0.5 f /
cle m he m

the following condition shall be satisfied in addition to the above check(s):

International Design Codes Manual 995

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

Where:
c,Sd

is the maximum compressive stress at that section.

19B.4 Design Parameters


Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular structure. Table 19B.1 - Design Parameters for NORSOK N-004 design code Parameter Name CODE Default Value none Description

Must be specified as NORSOK. Note: Do not use the shortened NOR, as this initiates an NS3472 design.

FYLD

235 [MPa]

Yield strength of steel, f (St37)


y

Note: Note, if the SGR value is specified, then the associated value of f for that steel grade will y be used for a member in lieu of the FYLD value. KY KZ LY 1.0 1.0 Member Length Effective length factor, k, in local Yaxis, usually minor axis. Effective length factor, k, in local Zaxis, usually major axis. Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r

996 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name LZ CMY CMZ LSR

Default Value Member Length 0.85 0.85

Description

Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Reduction factor C corresponding m to the Y axis. Reduction factor C corresponding m to the Z axis. Length of Tubular between Stiffening Rings. This value is required to calculate Design Hoop Stress due to Hydrostatic Pressure to check Hoop Buckling as per clause 6.3.6.1.

HYD

0.0

The Y-coordinate, current units, of the maximum water level with respect to the origin. Note: If SETZUP command has been specified, then yi will be the Z co-ordinate of the max water level. For HYD > 0, the value of max. hydrostatic pressure calculated is reported for each member in a TRACK 2.0 output.

PSD SGR

0.0 0.0

Water pressure at each section in absence of HYD. Steel Grade per EC3 (EN 1993-11:2005): 0.0 = S 235 grade steel 1.0 = S 275 grade steel 2.0 = S 355 grade steel

International Design Codes Manual 997

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004 Parameter Name Default Value Description

3.0 = S 420 grade steel 4.0 = S 460 grade steel DMAX DMIN DFF 100.0 [cm] Maximum allowable depth of steel section. 0.0 [cm] Minimum allowable depth of steel section.

None (Man- "Deflection length"/maximum allowdatory for able local deflection. deflection check) 0.0 Option to design for slenderness. 0.0 = Check for slenderness 1.0 = Do not check for slenderness Any value greater than 1.0 is used as the limit for slenderness in compression.

MAIN

TMAIN

180.0

Slenderness limit in tension. Slenderness limit is checked based the MAIN parameter. Output detail: 0.0 = Only a summary of the design checks performed is printed. 2.0 = All the details of the member checks and the various clause checks performed are printed.

TRACK

0.0

998 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name RATIO BEAM

Default Value 1.0 0.0

Description

Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Beam segment locations for design: 0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION command. 1.0 = Perform design for moments at twelfth points along the beam.

DJ1 DJ2

Start Joint of member End Joint of member

Joint No. denoting start point for calculation of deflection length Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of deflection length

Notes
a. C1 and C2 Parameters The default values of these coefficients are taken from Table 6-4 of N-004 and depend on the joint and load type: Table 19B.2 - Default values for C1 and C2 parameters Joint Type T or Y joints under brace axial load X joints under brace axial load K joints under balanced axial load C1 C2 25 11 20 22 20 22

All joints under brace moment load- 25 30 ing

International Design Codes Manual 999

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

Note: These values can be changed by setting the K, X, and Y values in the external geometry file.

Example
Note: This is a partial example containing only the information pertaining to the NORSOK N-004 steel design code; used at the end of the input file.

* CHECK TUBULAR MEMBERS ACCORDING NORSOK N-004 CODENORSOK HYD 3.0 MEMB 1 TO 3 PSD 10 MEMB 7 10 SGR 2 MEMB 1 TO 3 7 10 TRACK 2 MEMB 1 TO 3 7 10 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 TO 3 7 10

19B.5 Code Checking


The purpose of code checking is to ascertain whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate as per N-004. Code checking is done using the forces and moments at specific sections of the members. If no sections are specified, the program uses the start and end forces for code checking. When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks, the critical condition of NORSOK code, the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value), the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the number of forces in the member) where the critical condition occurs.

19B.6 Member Selection


STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section (i.e., the lightest section which fulfills the code requirements for the specified member). The section selected will be of the same type section as originally

1000 STAAD.Pro

designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN which limit the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Selection of members whose properties are originally input from a user created table will be limited to sections in the user table.

19B.7 Tubular Joint Checking


The design of tubular joints for this implementation shall be based on section 6.4 of N-004 and will be applicable to joints formed from a connection of two or more members.

Figure - Typical Tubular Joint (Fig 6-1 in N004) Prior to completing a joint design, the joint should be classified into one of the three categories given by the code. Joint classification is the process whereby a BRACE member connecting into a CHORD member is classified into one of these categories based on the axial force components in the brace. The classification normally considers all the members at a joint that lie in a plane. N-004 defines three joint classification categories: K, X, or Y (or a combination of these). Joint Classification K Description

The axial force in the brace should be balanced by forces in the other braces in the same

International Design Codes Manual 1001

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004 Joint Classification Description

plane and on the same side of the joint. The code allows a 10% tolerance in the balancing force. X The axial force in the brace is reacted as a beam shear in the chord. The axial force in the brace is carried through the chord to braces in the opposite side.

Note: Typical examples of these joint types are given in Figure 6-3 of the N004 code. It is worth noting that the joint class for each brace will be different for each load case.

Note: STAAD.Pro does not perform an automatic classification of the joints. This is left up to the engineer. All joints will initially be classified as Y in the generation of the external geometry file. Joints should be re-classified as necessary before performing the final joint capacity checks. The checks for joint capacity are given in Cl. 6.4.3.2 to 6.4.3.6 and STAAD.Pro performs the checks as per these clauses. However, the program does not deal with conical joint transitions and joints with joint cans. The code also specifies checks and limits for the gaps and eccentricity of joints. This implementation will not perform such geometry checks. The details of the checks done and the methodology will be discussed in the following sections.

Identification and Classification of CHORD and BRACE Members


This is a two step process where the program automatically identifies the CHORD and BRACE members at a joint and perform a default joint check. The input variables used for the initial joint checks will be generated in an external text file.

1002 STAAD.Pro

You can then use this text file to edit or modify the input variables and perform a final check as necessary. The following syntax is used to initiate the joint checking in the engine. LOAD LIST load_list PARAMETER 1 CHECK JOINT { node_list | ALL } Where:

load_list = a list of load case numbers to be check against node_list = the NODE numbers to be checked. Specifying the ALL keyword option will cause the program to perform the joint check at all the nodes.
For each node specified in the CHECK JOINT command, the program automatically separates out all the members at the node into one CHORD member and one or more BRACE members. The section with the biggest diameter is assumed to be the CHORD and all the other members are assumed as BRACE members. If two or more possible CHORD members have the same diameter, the member with the maximum thickness is considered as the CHORD. The angle between the two members should be within the range of 30 and 90 (inclusive). Once all the CHORD and BRACE members are identified, the program considers every CHORD to BRACE connection as a separate JOINT. The program the automatically creates the joints and initially considers all the joints as joint class Y. The program then performs all the necessary joint checks as detailed in the following sections and produces the design output. The program will also produce an output file called FILENAME_ JOINTS.TXT, where "filename" will be the name of the .STD file. This format of this text file is explained in Section 19B.8. You can then edit this text file to set up the necessary design parameters. Once the program finds of the _JOINTS.TXT file, it will read in the necessary parameters from this file and perform the subsequent design checks. Note: This file will be produced only once (i.e., when this file does not exist). If this file exists, it is assumed that you have already done a joint design check and hence the program reads the values from this file and uses these for joint checks.

International Design Codes Manual 1003

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

19B.7 Tubular Joint Resistance


Basic Joint Resistances
The characteristic joint resistance between a chord and a brace is given by:

Where: N
Rd Rd

is the joint design axial resistance is the joint design bending moment resistance.

M
y

f is the yield strength = Default material resistance =1.15


m

is the angle between the chord and the brace (max = 90 degrees) Q = Strength factor which varies with the joint type and the action u type in the brace. Refer to Table 6-3 and Clause 6.4.3.3 of N-004 for these equations. Q = 1.0 A2
f

p,Sd

is the design axial stress in the chord is the design in-plane bending stress in the chord is the design out-of-plane bending stress in the chord

my,Sd mz,Sd

C1 is the coefficient used for the axial stress term in calculating the joint resistance. C2 is the coefficient used for the bending stress term in calculating the joint resistance. The default values of C1 and C2 are as given in Table 6-4 of N-004. The actual values used are dependent

1004 STAAD.Pro

on the values of K, X, and Y specified for the joint in the external geometry file. See also Figures 6-3 to 6-6 of N-004 for definition of the various terms for various joint classes.

Strength Check for Joints


Each brace to chord joint to be checked will have to satisfy the following condition:

Where: N N
Sd Rd

is the design axial force in the brace, is the joint design axial resistance is the in plane bending moment in the brace is the out of plane bending moment in the brace is the in plane bending moment resistance is the out of plane bending moment resistance

M M M M

z,Sd y,Sd z,Rd y,Rd

19B.7 External Geometry File


The data contained in the FILENAME_JOINTS.NGO file should meet the following format. The overall process of performing punching shear checks consists of two steps which are explained in section 19B.7.

General Format
LOAD LIST load_list JOINT NODE K X Y CHORD CLEN D T BRACE BLEN d t GAP j# n# K% X% Y% C# CLEN D T B# BLEN d t gap Where: j# = the joint number

International Design Codes Manual 1005

Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004

n# = the node number K%, X%, and Y% = The fractional contributions of K-type, X type and Y-type, respectively. Initially the joints will be classed as Y (i.e., K=0, X=0 and Y=1). C# = the member numbers of the CHORD CLEN = the length of chord member D, T = Diameter and thickness of CHORD B# = the member number of the brace BLEN = the length of chord member d, t = Diameter and thickness of BRACE gap = Distance required to calculate gap factor for K bracing. Initially, the value of GAP is assumed as 0.

Example
LOAD LIST 1 2 4 JOINT NODE K BLEN D T 1 3 0 0.140 0.010 0 2 3 0 0.075 0.005 0

X GAP 0 0

Y 1 1

CHORD 2 2

CLEN 5.0 5.0

D 0.168 0.168

T 0.10 0.10

BRACE 1 16 4.0 6.043

19B.5 Tabulated Results


For code checking or member selection, the program produces the results in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. Member refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b. TABLE refers to the steel section name which has been checked against the N-004 code or has been selected. c. RESULTS prints whether the member has PASSed or FAILed. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark on front of the member. d. CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the N-004 code which governs the

1006 STAAD.Pro

design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis, and the moment in local Z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. i. If the parameter TRACK is set to 2.0, the program will block out part of the table and will print the allowable bending stressed in compression (FCY & FCZ) and tension (FTY & FTZ), allowable axial stress in compression (FA), and allowable shear stress (FV).

Sample TRACK 2.0 Output


STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - NORSOK-N004 (V1.0) ************************************************ ALL UNITS ARE - KN MEMBER TABLE METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED)

RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST PIP13910.0 (BRITISH SECTIONS) PASS Eq. 6.44 0.170 1 0.01 C 1.01 6.39 0.00 ======================================================================= MATERIAL DATA Grade of steel = S 355 Modulus of elasticity = 204999.98 N/mm2 Design Strength (py) =355.00 N/mm2 SECTION PROPERTIES (units - cm) Member Length = 400.00 Gross Area of cross section =

40.70 z-axis 862.000 168.554 y-axis 862.000 168.554

Moment of inertia Plastic modulus

: :

International Design Codes Manual 1007

Norwegian Codes - Concrete Design per NS 3473


Elastic modulus Radius of gyration Effective Length DESIGN PARAMETER (units Height of water lavel CMZ : 0.85 CMY KZ : 1.00 KY SECTION CLASSIFICATION : : : 123.407 4.602 400.000 123.407 4.602 400.000

- m) N004/2004 : 3.000 : 0.85 : 1.00 : Class 1

CAPACITIES (units - kN,m) Tension Capacity : Compression Capacity : Bending Capacity : Shear Capacity : Shear Capacity due to torsional moment:

1256.4 790.1 52.0 362.7 44.0

HYDROSTATIC PRESSURE CALCULATION (units - N,mm) - Cl.6.3.6 Max design hydrostatic pressure, (psd) : 0.000 Max design hoop stress, (sigma_psd)) : 0.000 CRITICAL LOAD FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (units - kN,m): CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY Cl:6.3.2 0.000 1 0.0 Cl:6.3.3 0.000 1 0.0 Cl:6.3.4 0.102 1 -5.3 0.0 Cl:6.3.5 0.031 1 -11.2 0.5 Cl:6.3.8.(1 & 2) 0.124 1 0.0 6.4 1.0 Cl:6.3.8.(3 & 4) 0.102 1 -0.5 0.5 -5.3 0.0 Cl:6.3.9 0.170 1 0.0 6.4 1.0 =======================================================================

Norwegian Codes - Concrete Design per NS 3473


19C.1 - General Notes
This section presents a description of the parameters used by STAAD.Pro for performing code checks members according to Norwegian Standard NS 3473 "Concrete Structures - Design and detailing rules" (hereafter referred to as NS 3473).

19C.2 Design Parameters


Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular

1008 STAAD.Pro

structure. Table 19B.3 - Design Parameters for NS 3473 design code Parameter Default Name Value CODE none Description

Must be specified as NS3473 Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

ACTAGE BRACE

70 years 0

Enter the actual age, in years. Column Brace Parameter 0. Beam/Column braced in both directions. 1. One-way plate/ Column unbraced about the local z axis only. 2. Column unbraced about the local y axis only. 3. Column unbraced in both directions.

CLEAR DRYCIR EFACE ELY ELZ ENVIR

25 mm 100% 0 1 1 2

Clear cover to outermost reinforcing bar. Drying exposure, in percent. Distance from the end node of the beam to face of support for shear design. Member length factor about the local y direction. Member length factor about the local z direction Environment class 1. LA Least aggressive 2. NA Aggressive

International Design Codes Manual 1009

Norwegian Codes - Concrete Design per NS 3473 Parameter Default Name Value Description

3. MA Very aggressive FC FYMAIN LAGE MAXMAIN MINMAIN MOY MOZ NMAG REIANG RELHUM RFACE 0 70% 1 35 N/mm2 500 N/mm2 7 days 32 10 Compressive strength of concrete. Yield strength of main reinforcing steel. Age when loaded, in days. Maximum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. Minimum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. moy factor moz factor nmag factor Reinforcement angle, in degrees. Relative humidity, in percent. Column bar arrangement 1. Four longitudinal bars. 2. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 3. Two faced distribution about major axis. 4. Faced symmetric distribution SFACE STIRANG STIRDIA TORANG 0 90 10 mm 45 Distance from the start node of the beam to face of support for shear design. Stirrup angle, in degrees. Stirrup diameter Torsion angle, in degrees.

1010 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Default Name Value TRACK 10

Description

Track parameter to control output detail 10. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit state design & Slab Two-way plate design 11. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit statedesign with tension stiffening. 12. Beam Ultimate limit statedesign only 20. Slab Plane stress design. 30. Slab Simplified membrane design.

International Design Codes Manual 1011

1012 STAAD.Pro

Section 20

Cypriot Codes
Cypriot Codes - Concrete Design in Cyprus
20.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to the concrete code of Cyprus. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 20A.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 1013

Table 20C.1 - Cypriot Concrete Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as CYPRUS. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BRACE

0.0

Bracing parameter for column design: 0. Column braced in both directions 1. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 2. Column braced in only the local Z direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.

CLEAR

20 mm

Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.

DEPTH

YD

EFACE

0.0

ELY ELZ FC

1.0 1.0 4.0 ksi

Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units

1014 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name FYMAIN

Default Value 60 ksi

Description

Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams. Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 23. Serviceability checks: 0. No serviceability check performed. 1. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever

FYSEC

60 ksi

MAXMAIN

50 mm

MINMAIN

8 mm

MINSEC

8 mm

MMAG NSECTION

1.0 12

SERV

0.0

International Design Codes Manual 1015

Parameter Name

Default Value beams.

Description

SFACE

0.0

Face of support location at start of beam, in current units. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) Skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. Two special values are also considered: 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design.

SRA

0.0

TRACK

0.0

Controls level of detail in output: 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. Beam design only. Details of reinforcement at sections defined by the NSECTION parameter.

1016 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name WIDTH

Default Value ZD

Description

Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.

International Design Codes Manual 1017

1018 STAAD.Pro

Section 21

Danish Codes
Danish Codes - Steel Design per DS412
21.1 Design Parameters
The design parameters outlined in Table 21.1 may be used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program and thus allow you to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 1019

Table 21D.1 - Danish Steel Design DS412 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description Must be specified as DS412 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 1.0 1.0 = Calculatevon Mises at twelfth points along the beam. Buckling length coefficient, Beta, about the local Y axis. Buckling length coefficient, Beta, about the local Z axis. Lateral buckling coefficient. Used to calculate the ideal buckling moment. Water depth, in meters, for hydrostatic pressure calculation for pipe members.

BY

1.0

BZ

1.0

CB

1.0

CMY

1.0

1020 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name CMZ

Default Value 0.21

Description AlphaT in connection with lateral buckling. Buckling curve coefficient, Alpha, about local Y-axis. Buckling curve coefficient, Alpha, about local Z-axis.

CY

CZ

DMAX

1,000 mm

Maximum allowable depth (Applicable for member selection) Minimum required depth (Applicable for member selection) Yield strength of steel. Ratio of material factor to resistance factor. Permissible ratio of actual load effect to the design strength. Equivalent moment factor, BetaM, for local Y-axis. Valid

DMIN

0.0 mm

FYLD MF

235 N/mm2 1.15

RATIO

1.0

SSY

International Design Codes Manual 1021

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description values between 0 and 2.5.

SSZ

Equivalent moment factor, BetaM, for local Z-axis. Valid values between 0 and 2.5. 0.0 Used to specify a level of detail in output: 0. Report only minimum design results. 1. Report design strengths also. 2. Provide full details of design.

TRACK

UNL

Member Length

Unsupported length in bending compression of the bottom flange for calculating moment resistance.

1022 STAAD.Pro

Section 22

Dutch Codes
Dutch Codes - Steel Design per NEN 6770
22.1 Design Parameters
Available design parameters to be used in conjunction with NEN 6770 are listed in table 22.1 along with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 22E.1 - Dutch Steel Design NEN 6770 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description Must be specified as DUTCH Design Code to follow.

International Design Codes Manual 1023

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. Used to specify the number of sections to be check along the length of the beam: 0. Check sections with end forces only. 1. Check at location of maximum Mz along beam. 2. Check sections with end forces and forces at location of BEAM= 1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th point of the beam and report the maximum. Loading type per Tables F.1.1 and F.1.2 1. Pin ended member with uniform loading 2. Fix ended member with uniform loading 3. Pin ended member with central point load. 4. Fix ended member with central point load. 5. Pin ended member with point loads at third points. 6. Pin ended member with varying end moments. Used to describe the end restraints: 1.0 = No fixity

BEAM

3.0

CMM

1.0

CMN

1.0

1024 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description 0.7 = One end fixed, the other free. 0.5 = Both ends fixed. "Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection

DFF

DJ1

DJ2

DMAX DMIN KY KZ LY

LZ

NSF PY RATIO

None (Mandatory for deflection check, See Note 1d in Section 2B.6. TRACK 4.0) Start Joint Joint No. denoting starting point of member for calculation of "Deflection Length" . See Note 1 below. End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length". See Note 1 below. 10,000 cm Maximum allowable depth 0.0 cm Minimum allowable depth 1.0 K factor value in local y - axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. 1.0 K factor value in local z - axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Member Length Length in local y - axis (current units) to calculate (KY)(LY)/Ryy slenderness ratio. Member Length Length in local z - axis (current units) to calculate (KZ)(LZ)/Rzz slenderness ratio. 1.0 Net section factor for tension members. Set according to Design strength of steel steel grade (SGR) 1.0 Permissible ratio of the actual capacities.

International Design Codes Manual 1025

Parameter Name SAME

Default Value 0.0

Description Controls the sections to try during a SELECT process. 0. Try every section of the same type as original 1. Try only those sections with a similar name as original (e.g., if the original is an HEA 100, then only HEA sections will be selected, even if there are HEMs in the same table). Identify Section type for section classification 0. Rolled Section

SBLT

0.0

SGR

0.0

1. Built up Section Steel Grade 0. Grade Fe 360 1. Grade Fe 430

TRACK

0.0

2. Grade Fe 510 Used to control the level output detail: 0. Output summary of results. 1. Output summary of results with member capacities. 2. Output detailed results.

UNL

3. Deflection Check (separate check to main select / check code) Member Length Unrestrained member length in lateral torsional buckling checks.

1026 STAAD.Pro

Section 23

Finnish Codes
Finnish Codes - Concrete Design per B4
23A.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to the B4 code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 26B.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 1027

Table 23F.1 - Finnish Concrete Design per B4 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as FINNISH. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

ACTAGE BRACE

70 0.0

Actual age of concrete, in years. Bracing parameter for design: 0. Beam or column braced in both directions 1. One-way plate or column braced in only the local Zdirection. 2. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.

CLEAR

25 mm

Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Drying exposure, in percent.

DRYCIR

100

EFACE

0.0

Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.

ELY ELZ

1.0 1.0

Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design.

1028 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name ENVIR

Default Value 2

Description

Environment class 1. LA Least aggressive 2. NA Aggressive 3. MA Very aggressive

FC FYMAIN LAGE MAXMAIN MINMAIN MOY MOZ NMAG REIANG RELHUM RFACE

35 N/mm2 500 N/mm2 7 days 32 10

Compressive strength of concrete. Yield strength of main reinforcing steel. Age when loaded, in days. Maximum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. Minimum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. moy factor moz factor nmag factor

0 40 1

Reinforcement angle, in degrees. Relative humidity, in percent. Column bar arrangement 1. Four longitudinal bars. 2. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 3. Two faced distribution about major axis. 4. Faced symmetric distribution

SFACE

Distance from the start node of the beam to face of support for shear design.

International Design Codes Manual 1029

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. STIRANG STIRDIA TORANG TRACK 90 10 mm 45 10 Stirrup angle, in degrees. Stirrup diameter Torsion angle, in degrees. Track parameter to control output detail 10. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit state design & Slab Two-way plate design 11. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit statedesign with tension stiffening. 12. Beam Ultimate limit statedesign only 20. Slab Plane stress design. 30. Slab Simplified membrane design.

Finnish Codes - Steel Design per B7


23B.1 Design Parameters
Design parameters communicate specific design decisions to the program. They are set to default values to begin with and may be altered to suite the particular structure. Table 23F.2 - Design Parameters for Norwegian Steel design code Parameter Name CODE Default Value none Description

Must be specified as either NS3472 for

1030 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

NS or NPD for NPD (NOR may also be used for both). Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 0.0 Parameter BEAM 1.0 ALL tells the program to calculate von Mises at 13 sections along each member, and up to 8 points at each section. (Depending on what kind of shape is used.) Note: Must be set to 1.0 BY BZ 1.0 1.0 Buckling length coefficient, for weak axis buckling (y-y) (NOTE: BY > 0.0) Buckling length coefficient, , for strong axis buckling (z-z) (NOTE: BZ > 0.0) Lateral buckling coefficient, Y. Used to calculate the ideal buckling moments, M
vi

CB

1.0

CMY CMZ CY CZ DMAX

1.0 0.49 Default see NS 3472 100.0 [cm]

Water depth in meters for hydrostatic pressure calculation for pipe members for sections in connection with latLT eral buckling Buckling curve coefficient, a about local z-axis (strong axis). Represent the a, a0, b, c, d curve. Maximum allowable depth of steel section.

International Design Codes Manual 1031

Parameter Name DMIN FYLD MF

Default Value 0.0 [cm] 235

Description

Minimum allowable depth of steel section. Yield strength of steel, fy (St37) [N/mm2 ]

1.1 Material factor / Resistance factor, m (NS3472) 1.15 (NPD) 1.0 0.0 Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = No sidesway. calculated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis weak axis =SSY
M

RATIO SSY

SSZ

0.0

0.0 = No sidesway. calculated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis weak axis
M

TRACK

0.0

0.0 = Supress critical member stresses. 1.0 = Print all critical member stresses, i.e., DESIGN VALUES 2.0 = Print von Mises stresses. 9.0 = Large output, 1 page for each member. See section 7 and Appendix A for complete list of available TRACKs and print examples. Effective length for lateral buckling calculations (specify buckling length). Distance between fork supports or between effective side supports for the beam

UNL

Member length

The parameter CMY will, when given with negative value, define an inside pressure in pipe members. The pressure corresponds to given water depth in meters.

1032 STAAD.Pro

The parameter CB defines the value with respect to calculation of the ideal lateral buckling moment for single symmetric wide flange profiles, ref. NS app. 5.2.2.

International Design Codes Manual 1033

1034 STAAD.Pro

Section 24

Singaporian Codes
Singaporean Codes - Concrete Design per CP65
24.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design per the CP65 code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 24.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 1035

Table 24G.1 - Singaporean Concrete Design CP65 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as CP65. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

BRACE

0.0

Bracing parameter for column design: 0. Column braced in both directions 1. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 2. Column braced in only the local Z direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.

CLEAR

20 mm

Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.

DEPTH

YD

EFACE

0.0

ELY ELZ FC

1.0 1.0 4.0 ksi

Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units

1036 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name FYMAIN

Default Value 60 ksi

Description

Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams. Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 23. Serviceability checks: 0. No serviceability check performed. 1. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever

FYSEC

60 ksi

MAXMAIN

50 mm

MINMAIN

8 mm

MINSEC

8 mm

MMAG NSECTION

1.0 12

SERV

0.0

International Design Codes Manual 1037

Parameter Name

Default Value beams.

Description

SFACE

0.0

Face of support location at start of beam, in current units. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) Skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. Two special values are also considered: 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design.

SRA

0.0

TRACK

0.0

Controls level of detail in output: 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. Beam design only. Details of reinforcement at sections defined by the NSECTION parameter.

1038 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name WIDTH

Default Value ZD

Description

Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.

International Design Codes Manual 1039

1040 STAAD.Pro

Section 25

Spanish Codes
Spanish Codes - Concrete Design per EHE
25B.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform design per the Espaola del Hormign Estructural (EHE)code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the engineer control over the actual design process. Default values, which are commonly used numbers in conventional design practice, have been used for simplicity. Table 25A.1 contains a list of available parameters and their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 1041

Table 25H.1 - Spanish Concrete Design per EHEParameters Parameter Default Name Value CLB CLS CLT DEPTH 1.5 in 1.5 in 1.5 in YD Description

Clear cover to reinforcing bar at bottom of cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar along the side of the cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar at top of cross section. Depth of the concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

EFACE

0.0 Distance of face of support from end Face of node of beam. Used for shear and Support torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.

FC FYMAIN FYSEC MAXMAIN MINMAIN MINSEC MMAG NSECTION

4.0 ksi 60 ksi 60 ksi

Specified compressive strength of concrete. Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel.

Number Maximum main reinforcement bar size. 55 bar Number Minimum main reinforcement bar size 10 bar Number Minimum secondary (stirrup) 10 bar reinforcement bar size. 1.0 12 A factor by which the column design moments will be magnified. Number of equally-spaced sections to be

1042 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Default Name Value

Description

considered in finding critical moments for beam design. REINF 0.0 Used to specify type of column shear reinforcement: 0. Tied Column. 1. Spiral Column. SFACE 0.0 Distance of face of support from start node of beam. Used for shear and torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. TRACK 0.0 Used to specify detail of output: 0. Only minimum details are printed for beam or column designs. 1. Beam Design:Intermediate level of detail. Column Design:TRACK 0 output plus intermediate level of detail. 2. Beam Design: TRACK1 detail plus steel required at 1/12th secitons. Column Design:detailed output. WIDTH ZD Width of the concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.

International Design Codes Manual 1043

1044 STAAD.Pro

Section 26

Swedish Codes
Swedish Codes - Concrete Design per BBK 94
26B.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to the BBK 94 code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 26B.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.

International Design Codes Manual 1045

Table 26I.1 - Swedish Concrete Design per BBK 94 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description

Must be specified as SWEDISH. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.

ACTAGE BRACE

70 0.0

Actual age of concrete, in years. Bracing parameter for design: 0. Beam or column braced in both directions 1. One-way plate or column braced in only the local Zdirection. 2. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.

CLEAR

25 mm

Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Drying exposure, in percent.

DRYCIR

100

EFACE

0.0

Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.

ELY ELZ

1.0 1.0

Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design.

1046 STAAD.Pro

Parameter Name ENVIR

Default Value 2

Description

Environment class 1. LA Least aggressive 2. NA Aggressive 3. MA Very aggressive

FC FYMAIN LAGE MAXMAIN MINMAIN MOY MOZ NMAG REIANG RELHUM RFACE

35 N/mm2 500 N/mm2 7 days 32 10

Compressive strength of concrete. Yield strength of main reinforcing steel. Age when loaded, in days. Maximum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. Minimum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. moy factor moz factor nmag factor

0 40 1

Reinforcement angle, in degrees. Relative humidity, in percent. Column bar arrangement 1. Four longitudinal bars. 2. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 3. Two faced distribution about major axis. 4. Faced symmetric distribution

SFACE

Distance from the start node of the beam to face of support for shear design.

International Design Codes Manual 1047

Parameter Name

Default Value

Description

Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. STIRANG STIRDIA TORANG TRACK 90 10 mm 45 10 Stirrup angle, in degrees. Stirrup diameter Torsion angle, in degrees. Track parameter to control output detail 10. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit state design & Slab Two-way plate design 11. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit statedesign with tension stiffening. 12. Beam Ultimate limit statedesign only 20. Slab Plane stress design. 30. Slab Simplified membrane design.

1048 STAAD.Pro

Technical Support
These resources are provided to help you answer support questions:
l

Service Ticket Manager http://www.bentley.com/serviceticketmanager Create and track a service ticket using Bentley Systems' online site for reporting problems or suggesting new features. You do not need to be a Bentley SELECT member to use Service Ticket Manager, however you do need to register as a user. Knowledge Base http://appsnet.bentley.com/kbase/ Search the Bentley Systems knowledge base for solutions for common problems. FAQs and TechNotes http://communities.bentley.com/Products/Structural/Structural_Analysis___ Design/w/Structural_Analysis_and_Design__Wiki/structural-product-technotes-and-faqs.aspx Here you can find detailed resolutions and answers to the most common questions posted to us by you. Ask Your Peers http://communities.bentley.com/forums/5932/ShowForum.aspx Post questions in the BeCommunity forums to receive help and advice from fellow users.

International Design Codes Manual 1049

1050 STAAD.Pro

Index
A AIJ 1991 AIJ 2002 AIJ 2005 AISC Alclad Aluminum Design SeeConcrete Design, AIJ 1991 SeeSteel Design, AIJ 2002 SeeSteel Design, AIJ 2005 97 776 773

Australian Codes Axial Compression Axial Tension Clause 3.13 stress

7, 9 266, 795 266, 795 795 266

Axially Loaded Members 288, 305, 307, 309 Design 288, 305, 307, 309 B British Codes National Annex British Codes BS 5950-5 57 SeeNational Annex, British 81-82, 108

American Transmission Tower Code795, 801, 803 Analysis PDelta ANSI/AISC N690 Codes AS 1170 AS 3600 AS 3600 - 2001 14 823 21 9 SeeConcrete Design, AS 3600

SeeSteel Design, BS 5950-5 337 96 SeeSteel Design, BS5400 SeeSteel Design, BS5950 SeeSteel Design, BS8007 SeeConcrete Design, BS8110

BS EN 1993-1-1 BS4360 BS5400 BS5950 BS8007 BS8110

AS 4100 - 1998 SeeSteel Design, AS 4100 ASCE 10 ASCE 10-97 ASCE Manuals ASME NF Codes 795 SeeSteel Design, ASCE 10-97 801, 803 869

International Design Codes Manual 1051

Index:CAN/CSA-086-01 Egyptian Codes

C CAN/CSA-086-01 SeeWood Design, CAN/CSA-08601 153

NTC 1987 SABS-0100-1 CSA CSA A23.3

651 739 156, 160 SeeConcrete Design, CSA A23.3 SeeSteel Design, CSA CAN/CSAS16-01

Canadian Codes

Canadian Wood Design Manual227 Changing Chinese Codes 266 247, 261, 266267

CSA CAN/CSA-S16-01

D DD ENV 284 283, 288

Cold Formed Steel IS801 Combined Loading stress Concrete Design AIJ 1991 AS 3600 BBK 94 BS8110 CP65 CSA A23.3 DIN 1045 Egyptian Code Eurocode EC2 GB50010 IS13920 IS456 603 9 1045 59, 62 1035 155 473 433 275 249 521 495 593 267 266

DD ENV 1993 Design

288, 305, 307, 309, 323 288, 305, 307, 309 459 459

Axially Loaded Members

Design Rules Structural Steelwork Dutch National Annex E EC5 ECCS205 Egyptian Section 2.6.3 Egyptian Codes

SeeNational Annex, Dutch

405 433

444 431

1052 STAAD.Pro

EN 1993 Equivalent slenderness Eurocode

301 89 IS801

IS456 SeeSteel Design, IS801 J Japanese Codes Concrete Design 601 SeeConcrete Design, AIJ 1991

283, 288, 303, 305, 307, 309, 323 288, 301, 305, 307, 309, 323

Steel Design

European Codes 273, 275, 303, 305, 307, 309, 323 Extrusions F Finnish National Annex French Codes Concrete Design National Annex Steel Design G GB 1591 GBJ 50017-2003 96 SeeSteel Design, GBJ 50017 451 453 SeeNational Annex, French 459 SeeNational Annex, Finnish 781

Steel Design

SeeSteel Design, AIJ 2005 M

Modulus of Elasticity N N690 Codes National Annex British Dutch Finnish French Norwegian Polish

29

823 302, 332, 336, 343 337 337 337 337 337 337

National Application Documents 275, 284 NEN-EN 1993 NF EN 1993-1-1 Norwegian Codes 923 337 337

I IS13920 IS456 SeeConcrete Design, IS13920 SeeConcrete Design,

International Design Codes Manual 1053

Index:NS-EN 1993 Stress

National Annex

SeeNational Annex, Norwegian 337

ASCE 10-97 BS 5950-5 BS5400 BS5950 BS8007 CSA CAN/CSA-S16-01

793 123 113 81, 108 119 163 481 1019 301 441 283, 288, 301, 303, 305, 307, 309, 323 459 261 593 1023 669 207 747 715 266 266 266 267 267

NS-EN 1993

NTC 1987 SeeConcrete Design, NTC 1987 P PN EN 1993-1-1 Polish National Annex S S136-94 SeeSteel Design, S136-94 SeeSteel Design, SAB0162-1 1993 SeeConcrete Design, SABS0100-1 337 SeeNational Annex, Polish 337

DIN DS412 EC3 Egyptian Code Eurocode

SAB0162-1 1993

French Code GBJ 50017 IS801 NEN 6770 NTC 1987 S136-94 SAB0162-1 1993 SNiP 2.23-81 Stress Axial Compression Axial Tension Bending Combined Loading

SABS-0100-1

SFS EN 1993-1-1 SNiP 2.23-81 Steel Design

SeeSteel Design, SNiP 2.23-81 288, 305, 307, 309, 323, 795, 801, 803 613 613, 632 825 19

AIJ 2002 AIJ 2005

ANSI/AISC N690-1994 AS 4100 1054 STAAD.Pro

Structural Steelwork Design Rules T Timber Design EC5 U UK National Annex V Verification Problem AIJ 2005 ASME NF 3000 1974 ASME NF 3000 1989 ASME NF 3000 1998 ASME NF 3000 2004 British Cold Formed Steel CSA CSA Wood EC5 SAB0162-1 W Weld Type

459 459

Wood Design CAN/CSA-086-01 Y Yield Strength 803 215

405

Young's Modulus SeeModulus of Elasticity

SeeNational Annex, British

643 880 893 907 919 137

185, 189, 193, 197 227 420, 425 763, 766, 769

97

Wood and Armer Moments 62, 121, 1016, 1038

International Design Codes Manual 1055

You might also like